services: Add nftables-service-type.
[jackhill/guix/guix.git] / doc / guix.texi
1 \input texinfo
2 @c -*-texinfo-*-
3
4 @c %**start of header
5 @setfilename guix.info
6 @documentencoding UTF-8
7 @settitle GNU Guix Reference Manual
8 @c %**end of header
9
10 @include version.texi
11
12 @c Identifier of the OpenPGP key used to sign tarballs and such.
13 @set OPENPGP-SIGNING-KEY-ID 3CE464558A84FDC69DB40CFB090B11993D9AEBB5
14 @set OPENPGP-SIGNING-KEY-URL https://sv.gnu.org/people/viewgpg.php?user_id=15145
15
16 @c Base URL for downloads.
17 @set BASE-URL https://ftp.gnu.org/gnu/guix
18
19 @c The official substitute server used by default.
20 @set SUBSTITUTE-SERVER ci.guix.gnu.org
21 @set SUBSTITUTE-URL https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}
22
23 @copying
24 Copyright @copyright{} 2012, 2013, 2014, 2015, 2016, 2017, 2018, 2019 Ludovic Courtès@*
25 Copyright @copyright{} 2013, 2014, 2016 Andreas Enge@*
26 Copyright @copyright{} 2013 Nikita Karetnikov@*
27 Copyright @copyright{} 2014, 2015, 2016 Alex Kost@*
28 Copyright @copyright{} 2015, 2016 Mathieu Lirzin@*
29 Copyright @copyright{} 2014 Pierre-Antoine Rault@*
30 Copyright @copyright{} 2015 Taylan Ulrich Bayırlı/Kammer@*
31 Copyright @copyright{} 2015, 2016, 2017, 2019 Leo Famulari@*
32 Copyright @copyright{} 2015, 2016, 2017, 2018, 2019 Ricardo Wurmus@*
33 Copyright @copyright{} 2016 Ben Woodcroft@*
34 Copyright @copyright{} 2016, 2017, 2018 Chris Marusich@*
35 Copyright @copyright{} 2016, 2017, 2018, 2019 Efraim Flashner@*
36 Copyright @copyright{} 2016 John Darrington@*
37 Copyright @copyright{} 2016, 2017 ng0@*
38 Copyright @copyright{} 2016, 2017, 2018, 2019 Jan Nieuwenhuizen@*
39 Copyright @copyright{} 2016 Julien Lepiller@*
40 Copyright @copyright{} 2016 Alex ter Weele@*
41 Copyright @copyright{} 2016, 2017, 2018, 2019 Christopher Baines@*
42 Copyright @copyright{} 2017, 2018 Clément Lassieur@*
43 Copyright @copyright{} 2017, 2018 Mathieu Othacehe@*
44 Copyright @copyright{} 2017 Federico Beffa@*
45 Copyright @copyright{} 2017, 2018 Carlo Zancanaro@*
46 Copyright @copyright{} 2017 Thomas Danckaert@*
47 Copyright @copyright{} 2017 humanitiesNerd@*
48 Copyright @copyright{} 2017 Christopher Allan Webber@*
49 Copyright @copyright{} 2017, 2018 Marius Bakke@*
50 Copyright @copyright{} 2017 Hartmut Goebel@*
51 Copyright @copyright{} 2017, 2019 Maxim Cournoyer@*
52 Copyright @copyright{} 2017, 2018, 2019 Tobias Geerinckx-Rice@*
53 Copyright @copyright{} 2017 George Clemmer@*
54 Copyright @copyright{} 2017 Andy Wingo@*
55 Copyright @copyright{} 2017, 2018, 2019 Arun Isaac@*
56 Copyright @copyright{} 2017 nee@*
57 Copyright @copyright{} 2018 Rutger Helling@*
58 Copyright @copyright{} 2018 Oleg Pykhalov@*
59 Copyright @copyright{} 2018 Mike Gerwitz@*
60 Copyright @copyright{} 2018 Pierre-Antoine Rouby@*
61 Copyright @copyright{} 2018, 2019 Gábor Boskovits@*
62 Copyright @copyright{} 2018, 2019 Florian Pelz@*
63 Copyright @copyright{} 2018 Laura Lazzati@*
64 Copyright @copyright{} 2018 Alex Vong@*
65 Copyright @copyright{} 2019 Josh Holland@*
66 Copyright @copyright{} 2019 Diego Nicola Barbato@*
67 Copyright @copyright{} 2019 Ivan Petkov@*
68 Copyright @copyright{} 2019 Jakob L. Kreuze@*
69
70 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
71 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
72 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
73 Invariant Sections, no Front-Cover Texts, and no Back-Cover Texts. A
74 copy of the license is included in the section entitled ``GNU Free
75 Documentation License''.
76 @end copying
77
78 @dircategory System administration
79 @direntry
80 * Guix: (guix). Manage installed software and system configuration.
81 * guix package: (guix)Invoking guix package. Installing, removing, and upgrading packages.
82 * guix gc: (guix)Invoking guix gc. Reclaiming unused disk space.
83 * guix pull: (guix)Invoking guix pull. Update the list of available packages.
84 * guix system: (guix)Invoking guix system. Manage the operating system configuration.
85 * guix deploy: (guix)Invoking guix deploy. Manage operating system configurations for remote hosts.
86 @end direntry
87
88 @dircategory Software development
89 @direntry
90 * guix environment: (guix)Invoking guix environment. Building development environments with Guix.
91 * guix build: (guix)Invoking guix build. Building packages.
92 * guix pack: (guix)Invoking guix pack. Creating binary bundles.
93 @end direntry
94
95 @titlepage
96 @title GNU Guix Reference Manual
97 @subtitle Using the GNU Guix Functional Package Manager
98 @author The GNU Guix Developers
99
100 @page
101 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
102 Edition @value{EDITION} @*
103 @value{UPDATED} @*
104
105 @insertcopying
106 @end titlepage
107
108 @contents
109
110 @c *********************************************************************
111 @node Top
112 @top GNU Guix
113
114 This document describes GNU Guix version @value{VERSION}, a functional
115 package management tool written for the GNU system.
116
117 @c TRANSLATORS: You can replace the following paragraph with information on
118 @c how to join your own translation team and how to report issues with the
119 @c translation.
120 This manual is also available in Simplified Chinese (@pxref{Top,,, guix.zh_CN,
121 GNU Guix参考手册}), French (@pxref{Top,,, guix.fr, Manuel de référence de GNU
122 Guix}), German (@pxref{Top,,, guix.de, Referenzhandbuch zu GNU Guix}),
123 Spanish (@pxref{Top,,, guix.es, Manual de referencia de GNU Guix}), and
124 Russian (@pxref{Top,,, guix.ru, Руководство GNU Guix}). If you
125 would like to translate it in your native language, consider joining the
126 @uref{https://translationproject.org/domain/guix-manual.html, Translation
127 Project}.
128
129 @menu
130 * Introduction:: What is Guix about?
131 * Installation:: Installing Guix.
132 * System Installation:: Installing the whole operating system.
133 * Package Management:: Package installation, upgrade, etc.
134 * Development:: Guix-aided software development.
135 * Programming Interface:: Using Guix in Scheme.
136 * Utilities:: Package management commands.
137 * System Configuration:: Configuring the operating system.
138 * Documentation:: Browsing software user manuals.
139 * Installing Debugging Files:: Feeding the debugger.
140 * Security Updates:: Deploying security fixes quickly.
141 * Bootstrapping:: GNU/Linux built from scratch.
142 * Porting:: Targeting another platform or kernel.
143 * Contributing:: Your help needed!
144
145 * Acknowledgments:: Thanks!
146 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license of this manual.
147 * Concept Index:: Concepts.
148 * Programming Index:: Data types, functions, and variables.
149
150 @detailmenu
151 --- The Detailed Node Listing ---
152
153 Introduction
154
155 * Managing Software the Guix Way:: What's special.
156 * GNU Distribution:: The packages and tools.
157
158 Installation
159
160 * Binary Installation:: Getting Guix running in no time!
161 * Requirements:: Software needed to build and run Guix.
162 * Running the Test Suite:: Testing Guix.
163 * Setting Up the Daemon:: Preparing the build daemon's environment.
164 * Invoking guix-daemon:: Running the build daemon.
165 * Application Setup:: Application-specific setup.
166
167 Setting Up the Daemon
168
169 * Build Environment Setup:: Preparing the isolated build environment.
170 * Daemon Offload Setup:: Offloading builds to remote machines.
171 * SELinux Support:: Using an SELinux policy for the daemon.
172
173 System Installation
174
175 * Limitations:: What you can expect.
176 * Hardware Considerations:: Supported hardware.
177 * USB Stick and DVD Installation:: Preparing the installation medium.
178 * Preparing for Installation:: Networking, partitioning, etc.
179 * Guided Graphical Installation:: Easy graphical installation.
180 * Manual Installation:: Manual installation for wizards.
181 * After System Installation:: When installation succeeded.
182 * Installing Guix in a VM:: Guix System playground.
183 * Building the Installation Image:: How this comes to be.
184
185 Manual Installation
186
187 * Keyboard Layout and Networking and Partitioning:: Initial setup.
188 * Proceeding with the Installation:: Installing.
189
190 Package Management
191
192 * Features:: How Guix will make your life brighter.
193 * Invoking guix package:: Package installation, removal, etc.
194 * Substitutes:: Downloading pre-built binaries.
195 * Packages with Multiple Outputs:: Single source package, multiple outputs.
196 * Invoking guix gc:: Running the garbage collector.
197 * Invoking guix pull:: Fetching the latest Guix and distribution.
198 * Channels:: Customizing the package collection.
199 * Inferiors:: Interacting with another revision of Guix.
200 * Invoking guix describe:: Display information about your Guix revision.
201 * Invoking guix archive:: Exporting and importing store files.
202
203 Substitutes
204
205 * Official Substitute Server:: One particular source of substitutes.
206 * Substitute Server Authorization:: How to enable or disable substitutes.
207 * Substitute Authentication:: How Guix verifies substitutes.
208 * Proxy Settings:: How to get substitutes via proxy.
209 * Substitution Failure:: What happens when substitution fails.
210 * On Trusting Binaries:: How can you trust that binary blob?
211
212 Development
213
214 * Invoking guix environment:: Setting up development environments.
215 * Invoking guix pack:: Creating software bundles.
216
217 Programming Interface
218
219 * Package Modules:: Packages from the programmer's viewpoint.
220 * Defining Packages:: Defining new packages.
221 * Build Systems:: Specifying how packages are built.
222 * The Store:: Manipulating the package store.
223 * Derivations:: Low-level interface to package derivations.
224 * The Store Monad:: Purely functional interface to the store.
225 * G-Expressions:: Manipulating build expressions.
226 * Invoking guix repl:: Fiddling with Guix interactively.
227
228 Defining Packages
229
230 * package Reference:: The package data type.
231 * origin Reference:: The origin data type.
232
233 Utilities
234
235 * Invoking guix build:: Building packages from the command line.
236 * Invoking guix edit:: Editing package definitions.
237 * Invoking guix download:: Downloading a file and printing its hash.
238 * Invoking guix hash:: Computing the cryptographic hash of a file.
239 * Invoking guix import:: Importing package definitions.
240 * Invoking guix refresh:: Updating package definitions.
241 * Invoking guix lint:: Finding errors in package definitions.
242 * Invoking guix size:: Profiling disk usage.
243 * Invoking guix graph:: Visualizing the graph of packages.
244 * Invoking guix publish:: Sharing substitutes.
245 * Invoking guix challenge:: Challenging substitute servers.
246 * Invoking guix copy:: Copying to and from a remote store.
247 * Invoking guix container:: Process isolation.
248 * Invoking guix weather:: Assessing substitute availability.
249 * Invoking guix processes:: Listing client processes.
250
251 Invoking @command{guix build}
252
253 * Common Build Options:: Build options for most commands.
254 * Package Transformation Options:: Creating variants of packages.
255 * Additional Build Options:: Options specific to 'guix build'.
256 * Debugging Build Failures:: Real life packaging experience.
257
258 System Configuration
259
260 * Using the Configuration System:: Customizing your GNU system.
261 * operating-system Reference:: Detail of operating-system declarations.
262 * File Systems:: Configuring file system mounts.
263 * Mapped Devices:: Block device extra processing.
264 * User Accounts:: Specifying user accounts.
265 * Keyboard Layout:: How the system interprets key strokes.
266 * Locales:: Language and cultural convention settings.
267 * Services:: Specifying system services.
268 * Setuid Programs:: Programs running with root privileges.
269 * X.509 Certificates:: Authenticating HTTPS servers.
270 * Name Service Switch:: Configuring libc's name service switch.
271 * Initial RAM Disk:: Linux-Libre bootstrapping.
272 * Bootloader Configuration:: Configuring the boot loader.
273 * Invoking guix system:: Instantiating a system configuration.
274 * Invoking guix deploy:: Deploying a system configuration to a remote host.
275 * Running Guix in a VM:: How to run Guix System in a virtual machine.
276 * Defining Services:: Adding new service definitions.
277
278 Services
279
280 * Base Services:: Essential system services.
281 * Scheduled Job Execution:: The mcron service.
282 * Log Rotation:: The rottlog service.
283 * Networking Services:: Network setup, SSH daemon, etc.
284 * X Window:: Graphical display.
285 * Printing Services:: Local and remote printer support.
286 * Desktop Services:: D-Bus and desktop services.
287 * Sound Services:: ALSA and Pulseaudio services.
288 * Database Services:: SQL databases, key-value stores, etc.
289 * Mail Services:: IMAP, POP3, SMTP, and all that.
290 * Messaging Services:: Messaging services.
291 * Telephony Services:: Telephony services.
292 * Monitoring Services:: Monitoring services.
293 * Kerberos Services:: Kerberos services.
294 * Web Services:: Web servers.
295 * Certificate Services:: TLS certificates via Let's Encrypt.
296 * DNS Services:: DNS daemons.
297 * VPN Services:: VPN daemons.
298 * Network File System:: NFS related services.
299 * Continuous Integration:: The Cuirass service.
300 * Power Management Services:: Extending battery life.
301 * Audio Services:: The MPD.
302 * Virtualization Services:: Virtualization services.
303 * Version Control Services:: Providing remote access to Git repositories.
304 * Game Services:: Game servers.
305 * Miscellaneous Services:: Other services.
306
307 Defining Services
308
309 * Service Composition:: The model for composing services.
310 * Service Types and Services:: Types and services.
311 * Service Reference:: API reference.
312 * Shepherd Services:: A particular type of service.
313
314 @end detailmenu
315 @end menu
316
317 @c *********************************************************************
318 @node Introduction
319 @chapter Introduction
320
321 @cindex purpose
322 GNU Guix@footnote{``Guix'' is pronounced like ``geeks'', or ``ɡiːks''
323 using the international phonetic alphabet (IPA).} is a package
324 management tool for and distribution of the GNU system.
325 Guix makes it easy for unprivileged
326 users to install, upgrade, or remove software packages, to roll back to a
327 previous package set, to build packages from source, and generally
328 assists with the creation and maintenance of software environments.
329
330 @cindex Guix System
331 @cindex GuixSD, now Guix System
332 @cindex Guix System Distribution, now Guix System
333 You can install GNU@tie{}Guix on top of an existing GNU/Linux system where it
334 complements the available tools without interference (@pxref{Installation}),
335 or you can use it as a standalone operating system distribution,
336 @dfn{Guix@tie{}System}@footnote{We used to refer to Guix System as ``Guix
337 System Distribution'' or ``GuixSD''. We now consider it makes more sense to
338 group everything under the ``Guix'' banner since, after all, Guix System is
339 readily available through the @command{guix system} command, even if you're
340 using a different distro underneath!}. @xref{GNU Distribution}.
341
342 @menu
343 * Managing Software the Guix Way:: What's special.
344 * GNU Distribution:: The packages and tools.
345 @end menu
346
347 @node Managing Software the Guix Way
348 @section Managing Software the Guix Way
349
350 @cindex user interfaces
351 Guix provides a command-line package management interface
352 (@pxref{Package Management}), tools to help with software development
353 (@pxref{Development}), command-line utilities for more advanced usage,
354 (@pxref{Utilities}), as well as Scheme programming interfaces
355 (@pxref{Programming Interface}).
356 @cindex build daemon
357 Its @dfn{build daemon} is responsible for building packages on behalf of
358 users (@pxref{Setting Up the Daemon}) and for downloading pre-built
359 binaries from authorized sources (@pxref{Substitutes}).
360
361 @cindex extensibility of the distribution
362 @cindex customization, of packages
363 Guix includes package definitions for many GNU and non-GNU packages, all
364 of which @uref{https://www.gnu.org/philosophy/free-sw.html, respect the
365 user's computing freedom}. It is @emph{extensible}: users can write
366 their own package definitions (@pxref{Defining Packages}) and make them
367 available as independent package modules (@pxref{Package Modules}). It
368 is also @emph{customizable}: users can @emph{derive} specialized package
369 definitions from existing ones, including from the command line
370 (@pxref{Package Transformation Options}).
371
372 @cindex functional package management
373 @cindex isolation
374 Under the hood, Guix implements the @dfn{functional package management}
375 discipline pioneered by Nix (@pxref{Acknowledgments}).
376 In Guix, the package build and installation process is seen
377 as a @emph{function}, in the mathematical sense. That function takes inputs,
378 such as build scripts, a compiler, and libraries, and
379 returns an installed package. As a pure function, its result depends
380 solely on its inputs---for instance, it cannot refer to software or
381 scripts that were not explicitly passed as inputs. A build function
382 always produces the same result when passed a given set of inputs. It
383 cannot alter the environment of the running system in
384 any way; for instance, it cannot create, modify, or delete files outside
385 of its build and installation directories. This is achieved by running
386 build processes in isolated environments (or @dfn{containers}), where only their
387 explicit inputs are visible.
388
389 @cindex store
390 The result of package build functions is @dfn{cached} in the file
391 system, in a special directory called @dfn{the store} (@pxref{The
392 Store}). Each package is installed in a directory of its own in the
393 store---by default under @file{/gnu/store}. The directory name contains
394 a hash of all the inputs used to build that package; thus, changing an
395 input yields a different directory name.
396
397 This approach is the foundation for the salient features of Guix: support
398 for transactional package upgrade and rollback, per-user installation, and
399 garbage collection of packages (@pxref{Features}).
400
401
402 @node GNU Distribution
403 @section GNU Distribution
404
405 @cindex Guix System
406 Guix comes with a distribution of the GNU system consisting entirely of
407 free software@footnote{The term ``free'' here refers to the
408 @url{https://www.gnu.org/philosophy/free-sw.html,freedom provided to
409 users of that software}.}. The
410 distribution can be installed on its own (@pxref{System Installation}),
411 but it is also possible to install Guix as a package manager on top of
412 an installed GNU/Linux system (@pxref{Installation}). When we need to
413 distinguish between the two, we refer to the standalone distribution as
414 Guix@tie{}System.
415
416 The distribution provides core GNU packages such as GNU libc, GCC, and
417 Binutils, as well as many GNU and non-GNU applications. The complete
418 list of available packages can be browsed
419 @url{https://www.gnu.org/software/guix/packages,on-line} or by
420 running @command{guix package} (@pxref{Invoking guix package}):
421
422 @example
423 guix package --list-available
424 @end example
425
426 Our goal is to provide a practical 100% free software distribution of
427 Linux-based and other variants of GNU, with a focus on the promotion and
428 tight integration of GNU components, and an emphasis on programs and
429 tools that help users exert that freedom.
430
431 Packages are currently available on the following platforms:
432
433 @table @code
434
435 @item x86_64-linux
436 Intel/AMD @code{x86_64} architecture, Linux-Libre kernel;
437
438 @item i686-linux
439 Intel 32-bit architecture (IA32), Linux-Libre kernel;
440
441 @item armhf-linux
442 ARMv7-A architecture with hard float, Thumb-2 and NEON,
443 using the EABI hard-float application binary interface (ABI),
444 and Linux-Libre kernel.
445
446 @item aarch64-linux
447 little-endian 64-bit ARMv8-A processors, Linux-Libre kernel.
448
449 @item mips64el-linux
450 little-endian 64-bit MIPS processors, specifically the Loongson series,
451 n32 ABI, and Linux-Libre kernel. This configuration is no longer fully
452 supported; in particular, the project's build farms no longer provide
453 substitutes for this architecture.
454
455 @end table
456
457 With Guix@tie{}System, you @emph{declare} all aspects of the operating system
458 configuration and Guix takes care of instantiating the configuration in a
459 transactional, reproducible, and stateless fashion (@pxref{System
460 Configuration}). Guix System uses the Linux-libre kernel, the Shepherd
461 initialization system (@pxref{Introduction,,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd
462 Manual}), the well-known GNU utilities and tool chain, as well as the
463 graphical environment or system services of your choice.
464
465 Guix System is available on all the above platforms except
466 @code{mips64el-linux}.
467
468 @noindent
469 For information on porting to other architectures or kernels,
470 @pxref{Porting}.
471
472 Building this distribution is a cooperative effort, and you are invited
473 to join! @xref{Contributing}, for information about how you can help.
474
475
476 @c *********************************************************************
477 @node Installation
478 @chapter Installation
479
480 @cindex installing Guix
481
482 @quotation Note
483 We recommend the use of this
484 @uref{https://git.savannah.gnu.org/cgit/guix.git/plain/etc/guix-install.sh,
485 shell installer script} to install Guix on top of a running GNU/Linux system,
486 thereafter called a @dfn{foreign distro}.@footnote{This section is concerned
487 with the installation of the package manager, which can be done on top of a
488 running GNU/Linux system. If, instead, you want to install the complete GNU
489 operating system, @pxref{System Installation}.} The script automates the
490 download, installation, and initial configuration of Guix. It should be run
491 as the root user.
492 @end quotation
493
494 @cindex foreign distro
495 @cindex directories related to foreign distro
496 When installed on a foreign distro, GNU@tie{}Guix complements the available
497 tools without interference. Its data lives exclusively in two directories,
498 usually @file{/gnu/store} and @file{/var/guix}; other files on your system,
499 such as @file{/etc}, are left untouched.
500
501 Once installed, Guix can be updated by running @command{guix pull}
502 (@pxref{Invoking guix pull}).
503
504 If you prefer to perform the installation steps manually or want to tweak
505 them, you may find the following subsections useful. They describe the
506 software requirements of Guix, as well as how to install it manually and get
507 ready to use it.
508
509 @menu
510 * Binary Installation:: Getting Guix running in no time!
511 * Requirements:: Software needed to build and run Guix.
512 * Running the Test Suite:: Testing Guix.
513 * Setting Up the Daemon:: Preparing the build daemon's environment.
514 * Invoking guix-daemon:: Running the build daemon.
515 * Application Setup:: Application-specific setup.
516 @end menu
517
518 @node Binary Installation
519 @section Binary Installation
520
521 @cindex installing Guix from binaries
522 @cindex installer script
523 This section describes how to install Guix on an arbitrary system from a
524 self-contained tarball providing binaries for Guix and for all its
525 dependencies. This is often quicker than installing from source, which
526 is described in the next sections. The only requirement is to have
527 GNU@tie{}tar and Xz.
528
529 @c Note duplicated from the ``Installation'' node.
530 @quotation Note
531 We recommend the use of this
532 @uref{https://git.savannah.gnu.org/cgit/guix.git/plain/etc/guix-install.sh,
533 shell installer script}. The script automates the download, installation, and
534 initial configuration steps described below. It should be run as the root
535 user.
536 @end quotation
537
538 Installing goes along these lines:
539
540 @enumerate
541 @item
542 @cindex downloading Guix binary
543 Download the binary tarball from
544 @indicateurl{@value{BASE-URL}/guix-binary-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.tar.xz},
545 where @var{system} is @code{x86_64-linux} for an @code{x86_64} machine
546 already running the kernel Linux, and so on.
547
548 @c The following is somewhat duplicated in ``System Installation''.
549 Make sure to download the associated @file{.sig} file and to verify the
550 authenticity of the tarball against it, along these lines:
551
552 @example
553 $ wget @value{BASE-URL}/guix-binary-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.tar.xz.sig
554 $ gpg --verify guix-binary-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.tar.xz.sig
555 @end example
556
557 If that command fails because you do not have the required public key,
558 then run this command to import it:
559
560 @example
561 $ wget @value{OPENPGP-SIGNING-KEY-URL} \
562 -qO - | gpg --import -
563 @end example
564
565 @noindent
566 and rerun the @code{gpg --verify} command.
567
568 Take note that a warning like ``This key is not certified with a trusted
569 signature!'' is normal.
570
571 @c end authentication part
572
573 @item
574 Now, you need to become the @code{root} user. Depending on your distribution,
575 you may have to run @code{su -} or @code{sudo -i}. As @code{root}, run:
576
577 @example
578 # cd /tmp
579 # tar --warning=no-timestamp -xf \
580 /path/to/guix-binary-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.tar.xz
581 # mv var/guix /var/ && mv gnu /
582 @end example
583
584 This creates @file{/gnu/store} (@pxref{The Store}) and @file{/var/guix}.
585 The latter contains a ready-to-use profile for @code{root} (see next
586 step.)
587
588 Do @emph{not} unpack the tarball on a working Guix system since that
589 would overwrite its own essential files.
590
591 The @code{--warning=no-timestamp} option makes sure GNU@tie{}tar does
592 not emit warnings about ``implausibly old time stamps'' (such
593 warnings were triggered by GNU@tie{}tar 1.26 and older; recent
594 versions are fine.)
595 They stem from the fact that all the
596 files in the archive have their modification time set to zero (which
597 means January 1st, 1970.) This is done on purpose to make sure the
598 archive content is independent of its creation time, thus making it
599 reproducible.
600
601 @item
602 Make the profile available under @file{~root/.config/guix/current}, which is
603 where @command{guix pull} will install updates (@pxref{Invoking guix pull}):
604
605 @example
606 # mkdir -p ~root/.config/guix
607 # ln -sf /var/guix/profiles/per-user/root/current-guix \
608 ~root/.config/guix/current
609 @end example
610
611 Source @file{etc/profile} to augment @code{PATH} and other relevant
612 environment variables:
613
614 @example
615 # GUIX_PROFILE="`echo ~root`/.config/guix/current" ; \
616 source $GUIX_PROFILE/etc/profile
617 @end example
618
619 @item
620 Create the group and user accounts for build users as explained below
621 (@pxref{Build Environment Setup}).
622
623 @item
624 Run the daemon, and set it to automatically start on boot.
625
626 If your host distro uses the systemd init system, this can be achieved
627 with these commands:
628
629 @c Versions of systemd that supported symlinked service files are not
630 @c yet widely deployed, so we should suggest that users copy the service
631 @c files into place.
632 @c
633 @c See this thread for more information:
634 @c https://lists.gnu.org/archive/html/guix-devel/2017-01/msg01199.html
635
636 @example
637 # cp ~root/.config/guix/current/lib/systemd/system/guix-daemon.service \
638 /etc/systemd/system/
639 # systemctl start guix-daemon && systemctl enable guix-daemon
640 @end example
641
642 If your host distro uses the Upstart init system:
643
644 @example
645 # initctl reload-configuration
646 # cp ~root/.config/guix/current/lib/upstart/system/guix-daemon.conf \
647 /etc/init/
648 # start guix-daemon
649 @end example
650
651 Otherwise, you can still start the daemon manually with:
652
653 @example
654 # ~root/.config/guix/current/bin/guix-daemon \
655 --build-users-group=guixbuild
656 @end example
657
658 @item
659 Make the @command{guix} command available to other users on the machine,
660 for instance with:
661
662 @example
663 # mkdir -p /usr/local/bin
664 # cd /usr/local/bin
665 # ln -s /var/guix/profiles/per-user/root/current-guix/bin/guix
666 @end example
667
668 It is also a good idea to make the Info version of this manual available
669 there:
670
671 @example
672 # mkdir -p /usr/local/share/info
673 # cd /usr/local/share/info
674 # for i in /var/guix/profiles/per-user/root/current-guix/share/info/* ;
675 do ln -s $i ; done
676 @end example
677
678 That way, assuming @file{/usr/local/share/info} is in the search path,
679 running @command{info guix} will open this manual (@pxref{Other Info
680 Directories,,, texinfo, GNU Texinfo}, for more details on changing the
681 Info search path.)
682
683 @item
684 @cindex substitutes, authorization thereof
685 To use substitutes from @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} or one of its mirrors
686 (@pxref{Substitutes}), authorize them:
687
688 @example
689 # guix archive --authorize < \
690 ~root/.config/guix/current/share/guix/@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}.pub
691 @end example
692
693 @item
694 Each user may need to perform a few additional steps to make their Guix
695 environment ready for use, @pxref{Application Setup}.
696 @end enumerate
697
698 Voilà, the installation is complete!
699
700 You can confirm that Guix is working by installing a sample package into
701 the root profile:
702
703 @example
704 # guix install hello
705 @end example
706
707 The binary installation tarball can be (re)produced and verified simply
708 by running the following command in the Guix source tree:
709
710 @example
711 make guix-binary.@var{system}.tar.xz
712 @end example
713
714 @noindent
715 ...@: which, in turn, runs:
716
717 @example
718 guix pack -s @var{system} --localstatedir \
719 --profile-name=current-guix guix
720 @end example
721
722 @xref{Invoking guix pack}, for more info on this handy tool.
723
724 @node Requirements
725 @section Requirements
726
727 This section lists requirements when building Guix from source. The
728 build procedure for Guix is the same as for other GNU software, and is
729 not covered here. Please see the files @file{README} and @file{INSTALL}
730 in the Guix source tree for additional details.
731
732 @cindex official website
733 GNU Guix is available for download from its website at
734 @url{https://www.gnu.org/software/guix/}.
735
736 GNU Guix depends on the following packages:
737
738 @itemize
739 @item @url{https://gnu.org/software/guile/, GNU Guile}, version 2.2.x;
740 @item @url{https://notabug.org/cwebber/guile-gcrypt, Guile-Gcrypt}, version
741 0.1.0 or later;
742 @item
743 @uref{https://gnutls.org/, GnuTLS}, specifically its Guile bindings
744 (@pxref{Guile Preparations, how to install the GnuTLS bindings for
745 Guile,, gnutls-guile, GnuTLS-Guile});
746 @item
747 @uref{https://notabug.org/guile-sqlite3/guile-sqlite3, Guile-SQLite3}, version 0.1.0
748 or later;
749 @item
750 @c FIXME: Specify a version number once a release has been made.
751 @uref{https://gitlab.com/guile-git/guile-git, Guile-Git}, from August
752 2017 or later;
753 @item @uref{https://savannah.nongnu.org/projects/guile-json/, Guile-JSON} 3.x;
754 @item @url{https://zlib.net, zlib};
755 @item @url{https://www.gnu.org/software/make/, GNU Make}.
756 @end itemize
757
758 The following dependencies are optional:
759
760 @itemize
761 @item
762 @c Note: We need at least 0.10.2 for 'channel-send-eof'.
763 Support for build offloading (@pxref{Daemon Offload Setup}) and
764 @command{guix copy} (@pxref{Invoking guix copy}) depends on
765 @uref{https://github.com/artyom-poptsov/guile-ssh, Guile-SSH},
766 version 0.10.2 or later.
767
768 @item
769 When @url{https://www.nongnu.org/lzip/lzlib.html, lzlib} is available, lzlib
770 substitutes can be used and @command{guix publish} can compress substitutes
771 with lzlib.
772
773 @item
774 When @url{http://www.bzip.org, libbz2} is available,
775 @command{guix-daemon} can use it to compress build logs.
776 @end itemize
777
778 Unless @code{--disable-daemon} was passed to @command{configure}, the
779 following packages are also needed:
780
781 @itemize
782 @item @url{https://gnupg.org/, GNU libgcrypt};
783 @item @url{https://sqlite.org, SQLite 3};
784 @item @url{https://gcc.gnu.org, GCC's g++}, with support for the
785 C++11 standard.
786 @end itemize
787
788 @cindex state directory
789 When configuring Guix on a system that already has a Guix installation,
790 be sure to specify the same state directory as the existing installation
791 using the @code{--localstatedir} option of the @command{configure}
792 script (@pxref{Directory Variables, @code{localstatedir},, standards,
793 GNU Coding Standards}). The @command{configure} script protects against
794 unintended misconfiguration of @var{localstatedir} so you do not
795 inadvertently corrupt your store (@pxref{The Store}).
796
797 @cindex Nix, compatibility
798 When a working installation of @url{https://nixos.org/nix/, the Nix package
799 manager} is available, you
800 can instead configure Guix with @code{--disable-daemon}. In that case,
801 Nix replaces the three dependencies above.
802
803 Guix is compatible with Nix, so it is possible to share the same store
804 between both. To do so, you must pass @command{configure} not only the
805 same @code{--with-store-dir} value, but also the same
806 @code{--localstatedir} value. The latter is essential because it
807 specifies where the database that stores metadata about the store is
808 located, among other things. The default values for Nix are
809 @code{--with-store-dir=/nix/store} and @code{--localstatedir=/nix/var}.
810 Note that @code{--disable-daemon} is not required if
811 your goal is to share the store with Nix.
812
813 @node Running the Test Suite
814 @section Running the Test Suite
815
816 @cindex test suite
817 After a successful @command{configure} and @code{make} run, it is a good
818 idea to run the test suite. It can help catch issues with the setup or
819 environment, or bugs in Guix itself---and really, reporting test
820 failures is a good way to help improve the software. To run the test
821 suite, type:
822
823 @example
824 make check
825 @end example
826
827 Test cases can run in parallel: you can use the @code{-j} option of
828 GNU@tie{}make to speed things up. The first run may take a few minutes
829 on a recent machine; subsequent runs will be faster because the store
830 that is created for test purposes will already have various things in
831 cache.
832
833 It is also possible to run a subset of the tests by defining the
834 @code{TESTS} makefile variable as in this example:
835
836 @example
837 make check TESTS="tests/store.scm tests/cpio.scm"
838 @end example
839
840 By default, tests results are displayed at a file level. In order to
841 see the details of every individual test cases, it is possible to define
842 the @code{SCM_LOG_DRIVER_FLAGS} makefile variable as in this example:
843
844 @example
845 make check TESTS="tests/base64.scm" SCM_LOG_DRIVER_FLAGS="--brief=no"
846 @end example
847
848 Upon failure, please email @email{bug-guix@@gnu.org} and attach the
849 @file{test-suite.log} file. Please specify the Guix version being used
850 as well as version numbers of the dependencies (@pxref{Requirements}) in
851 your message.
852
853 Guix also comes with a whole-system test suite that tests complete
854 Guix System instances. It can only run on systems where
855 Guix is already installed, using:
856
857 @example
858 make check-system
859 @end example
860
861 @noindent
862 or, again, by defining @code{TESTS} to select a subset of tests to run:
863
864 @example
865 make check-system TESTS="basic mcron"
866 @end example
867
868 These system tests are defined in the @code{(gnu tests @dots{})}
869 modules. They work by running the operating systems under test with
870 lightweight instrumentation in a virtual machine (VM). They can be
871 computationally intensive or rather cheap, depending on whether
872 substitutes are available for their dependencies (@pxref{Substitutes}).
873 Some of them require a lot of storage space to hold VM images.
874
875 Again in case of test failures, please send @email{bug-guix@@gnu.org}
876 all the details.
877
878 @node Setting Up the Daemon
879 @section Setting Up the Daemon
880
881 @cindex daemon
882 Operations such as building a package or running the garbage collector
883 are all performed by a specialized process, the @dfn{build daemon}, on
884 behalf of clients. Only the daemon may access the store and its
885 associated database. Thus, any operation that manipulates the store
886 goes through the daemon. For instance, command-line tools such as
887 @command{guix package} and @command{guix build} communicate with the
888 daemon (@i{via} remote procedure calls) to instruct it what to do.
889
890 The following sections explain how to prepare the build daemon's
891 environment. See also @ref{Substitutes}, for information on how to allow
892 the daemon to download pre-built binaries.
893
894 @menu
895 * Build Environment Setup:: Preparing the isolated build environment.
896 * Daemon Offload Setup:: Offloading builds to remote machines.
897 * SELinux Support:: Using an SELinux policy for the daemon.
898 @end menu
899
900 @node Build Environment Setup
901 @subsection Build Environment Setup
902
903 @cindex build environment
904 In a standard multi-user setup, Guix and its daemon---the
905 @command{guix-daemon} program---are installed by the system
906 administrator; @file{/gnu/store} is owned by @code{root} and
907 @command{guix-daemon} runs as @code{root}. Unprivileged users may use
908 Guix tools to build packages or otherwise access the store, and the
909 daemon will do it on their behalf, ensuring that the store is kept in a
910 consistent state, and allowing built packages to be shared among users.
911
912 @cindex build users
913 When @command{guix-daemon} runs as @code{root}, you may not want package
914 build processes themselves to run as @code{root} too, for obvious
915 security reasons. To avoid that, a special pool of @dfn{build users}
916 should be created for use by build processes started by the daemon.
917 These build users need not have a shell and a home directory: they will
918 just be used when the daemon drops @code{root} privileges in build
919 processes. Having several such users allows the daemon to launch
920 distinct build processes under separate UIDs, which guarantees that they
921 do not interfere with each other---an essential feature since builds are
922 regarded as pure functions (@pxref{Introduction}).
923
924 On a GNU/Linux system, a build user pool may be created like this (using
925 Bash syntax and the @code{shadow} commands):
926
927 @c See https://lists.gnu.org/archive/html/bug-guix/2013-01/msg00239.html
928 @c for why `-G' is needed.
929 @example
930 # groupadd --system guixbuild
931 # for i in `seq -w 1 10`;
932 do
933 useradd -g guixbuild -G guixbuild \
934 -d /var/empty -s `which nologin` \
935 -c "Guix build user $i" --system \
936 guixbuilder$i;
937 done
938 @end example
939
940 @noindent
941 The number of build users determines how many build jobs may run in
942 parallel, as specified by the @option{--max-jobs} option
943 (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon, @option{--max-jobs}}). To use
944 @command{guix system vm} and related commands, you may need to add the
945 build users to the @code{kvm} group so they can access @file{/dev/kvm},
946 using @code{-G guixbuild,kvm} instead of @code{-G guixbuild}
947 (@pxref{Invoking guix system}).
948
949 The @code{guix-daemon} program may then be run as @code{root} with the
950 following command@footnote{If your machine uses the systemd init system,
951 dropping the @file{@var{prefix}/lib/systemd/system/guix-daemon.service}
952 file in @file{/etc/systemd/system} will ensure that
953 @command{guix-daemon} is automatically started. Similarly, if your
954 machine uses the Upstart init system, drop the
955 @file{@var{prefix}/lib/upstart/system/guix-daemon.conf}
956 file in @file{/etc/init}.}:
957
958 @example
959 # guix-daemon --build-users-group=guixbuild
960 @end example
961
962 @cindex chroot
963 @noindent
964 This way, the daemon starts build processes in a chroot, under one of
965 the @code{guixbuilder} users. On GNU/Linux, by default, the chroot
966 environment contains nothing but:
967
968 @c Keep this list in sync with libstore/build.cc! -----------------------
969 @itemize
970 @item
971 a minimal @code{/dev} directory, created mostly independently from the
972 host @code{/dev}@footnote{``Mostly'', because while the set of files
973 that appear in the chroot's @code{/dev} is fixed, most of these files
974 can only be created if the host has them.};
975
976 @item
977 the @code{/proc} directory; it only shows the processes of the container
978 since a separate PID name space is used;
979
980 @item
981 @file{/etc/passwd} with an entry for the current user and an entry for
982 user @file{nobody};
983
984 @item
985 @file{/etc/group} with an entry for the user's group;
986
987 @item
988 @file{/etc/hosts} with an entry that maps @code{localhost} to
989 @code{127.0.0.1};
990
991 @item
992 a writable @file{/tmp} directory.
993 @end itemize
994
995 You can influence the directory where the daemon stores build trees
996 @i{via} the @code{TMPDIR} environment variable. However, the build tree
997 within the chroot is always called @file{/tmp/guix-build-@var{name}.drv-0},
998 where @var{name} is the derivation name---e.g., @code{coreutils-8.24}.
999 This way, the value of @code{TMPDIR} does not leak inside build
1000 environments, which avoids discrepancies in cases where build processes
1001 capture the name of their build tree.
1002
1003 @vindex http_proxy
1004 The daemon also honors the @code{http_proxy} environment variable for
1005 HTTP downloads it performs, be it for fixed-output derivations
1006 (@pxref{Derivations}) or for substitutes (@pxref{Substitutes}).
1007
1008 If you are installing Guix as an unprivileged user, it is still possible
1009 to run @command{guix-daemon} provided you pass @code{--disable-chroot}.
1010 However, build processes will not be isolated from one another, and not
1011 from the rest of the system. Thus, build processes may interfere with
1012 each other, and may access programs, libraries, and other files
1013 available on the system---making it much harder to view them as
1014 @emph{pure} functions.
1015
1016
1017 @node Daemon Offload Setup
1018 @subsection Using the Offload Facility
1019
1020 @cindex offloading
1021 @cindex build hook
1022 When desired, the build daemon can @dfn{offload} derivation builds to
1023 other machines running Guix, using the @code{offload} @dfn{build
1024 hook}@footnote{This feature is available only when
1025 @uref{https://github.com/artyom-poptsov/guile-ssh, Guile-SSH} is
1026 present.}. When that
1027 feature is enabled, a list of user-specified build machines is read from
1028 @file{/etc/guix/machines.scm}; every time a build is requested, for
1029 instance via @code{guix build}, the daemon attempts to offload it to one
1030 of the machines that satisfy the constraints of the derivation, in
1031 particular its system type---e.g., @file{x86_64-linux}. Missing
1032 prerequisites for the build are copied over SSH to the target machine,
1033 which then proceeds with the build; upon success the output(s) of the
1034 build are copied back to the initial machine.
1035
1036 The @file{/etc/guix/machines.scm} file typically looks like this:
1037
1038 @lisp
1039 (list (build-machine
1040 (name "eightysix.example.org")
1041 (system "x86_64-linux")
1042 (host-key "ssh-ed25519 AAAAC3Nza@dots{}")
1043 (user "bob")
1044 (speed 2.)) ;incredibly fast!
1045
1046 (build-machine
1047 (name "meeps.example.org")
1048 (system "mips64el-linux")
1049 (host-key "ssh-rsa AAAAB3Nza@dots{}")
1050 (user "alice")
1051 (private-key
1052 (string-append (getenv "HOME")
1053 "/.ssh/identity-for-guix"))))
1054 @end lisp
1055
1056 @noindent
1057 In the example above we specify a list of two build machines, one for
1058 the @code{x86_64} architecture and one for the @code{mips64el}
1059 architecture.
1060
1061 In fact, this file is---not surprisingly!---a Scheme file that is
1062 evaluated when the @code{offload} hook is started. Its return value
1063 must be a list of @code{build-machine} objects. While this example
1064 shows a fixed list of build machines, one could imagine, say, using
1065 DNS-SD to return a list of potential build machines discovered in the
1066 local network (@pxref{Introduction, Guile-Avahi,, guile-avahi, Using
1067 Avahi in Guile Scheme Programs}). The @code{build-machine} data type is
1068 detailed below.
1069
1070 @deftp {Data Type} build-machine
1071 This data type represents build machines to which the daemon may offload
1072 builds. The important fields are:
1073
1074 @table @code
1075
1076 @item name
1077 The host name of the remote machine.
1078
1079 @item system
1080 The system type of the remote machine---e.g., @code{"x86_64-linux"}.
1081
1082 @item user
1083 The user account to use when connecting to the remote machine over SSH.
1084 Note that the SSH key pair must @emph{not} be passphrase-protected, to
1085 allow non-interactive logins.
1086
1087 @item host-key
1088 This must be the machine's SSH @dfn{public host key} in OpenSSH format.
1089 This is used to authenticate the machine when we connect to it. It is a
1090 long string that looks like this:
1091
1092 @example
1093 ssh-ed25519 AAAAC3NzaC@dots{}mde+UhL hint@@example.org
1094 @end example
1095
1096 If the machine is running the OpenSSH daemon, @command{sshd}, the host
1097 key can be found in a file such as
1098 @file{/etc/ssh/ssh_host_ed25519_key.pub}.
1099
1100 If the machine is running the SSH daemon of GNU@tie{}lsh,
1101 @command{lshd}, the host key is in @file{/etc/lsh/host-key.pub} or a
1102 similar file. It can be converted to the OpenSSH format using
1103 @command{lsh-export-key} (@pxref{Converting keys,,, lsh, LSH Manual}):
1104
1105 @example
1106 $ lsh-export-key --openssh < /etc/lsh/host-key.pub
1107 ssh-rsa AAAAB3NzaC1yc2EAAAAEOp8FoQAAAQEAs1eB46LV@dots{}
1108 @end example
1109
1110 @end table
1111
1112 A number of optional fields may be specified:
1113
1114 @table @asis
1115
1116 @item @code{port} (default: @code{22})
1117 Port number of SSH server on the machine.
1118
1119 @item @code{private-key} (default: @file{~root/.ssh/id_rsa})
1120 The SSH private key file to use when connecting to the machine, in
1121 OpenSSH format. This key must not be protected with a passphrase.
1122
1123 Note that the default value is the private key @emph{of the root
1124 account}. Make sure it exists if you use the default.
1125
1126 @item @code{compression} (default: @code{"zlib@@openssh.com,zlib"})
1127 @itemx @code{compression-level} (default: @code{3})
1128 The SSH-level compression methods and compression level requested.
1129
1130 Note that offloading relies on SSH compression to reduce bandwidth usage
1131 when transferring files to and from build machines.
1132
1133 @item @code{daemon-socket} (default: @code{"/var/guix/daemon-socket/socket"})
1134 File name of the Unix-domain socket @command{guix-daemon} is listening
1135 to on that machine.
1136
1137 @item @code{parallel-builds} (default: @code{1})
1138 The number of builds that may run in parallel on the machine.
1139
1140 @item @code{speed} (default: @code{1.0})
1141 A ``relative speed factor''. The offload scheduler will tend to prefer
1142 machines with a higher speed factor.
1143
1144 @item @code{features} (default: @code{'()})
1145 A list of strings denoting specific features supported by the machine.
1146 An example is @code{"kvm"} for machines that have the KVM Linux modules
1147 and corresponding hardware support. Derivations can request features by
1148 name, and they will be scheduled on matching build machines.
1149
1150 @end table
1151 @end deftp
1152
1153 The @command{guix} command must be in the search path on the build
1154 machines. You can check whether this is the case by running:
1155
1156 @example
1157 ssh build-machine guix repl --version
1158 @end example
1159
1160 There is one last thing to do once @file{machines.scm} is in place. As
1161 explained above, when offloading, files are transferred back and forth
1162 between the machine stores. For this to work, you first need to
1163 generate a key pair on each machine to allow the daemon to export signed
1164 archives of files from the store (@pxref{Invoking guix archive}):
1165
1166 @example
1167 # guix archive --generate-key
1168 @end example
1169
1170 @noindent
1171 Each build machine must authorize the key of the master machine so that
1172 it accepts store items it receives from the master:
1173
1174 @example
1175 # guix archive --authorize < master-public-key.txt
1176 @end example
1177
1178 @noindent
1179 Likewise, the master machine must authorize the key of each build machine.
1180
1181 All the fuss with keys is here to express pairwise mutual trust
1182 relations between the master and the build machines. Concretely, when
1183 the master receives files from a build machine (and @i{vice versa}), its
1184 build daemon can make sure they are genuine, have not been tampered
1185 with, and that they are signed by an authorized key.
1186
1187 @cindex offload test
1188 To test whether your setup is operational, run this command on the
1189 master node:
1190
1191 @example
1192 # guix offload test
1193 @end example
1194
1195 This will attempt to connect to each of the build machines specified in
1196 @file{/etc/guix/machines.scm}, make sure Guile and the Guix modules are
1197 available on each machine, attempt to export to the machine and import
1198 from it, and report any error in the process.
1199
1200 If you want to test a different machine file, just specify it on the
1201 command line:
1202
1203 @example
1204 # guix offload test machines-qualif.scm
1205 @end example
1206
1207 Last, you can test the subset of the machines whose name matches a
1208 regular expression like this:
1209
1210 @example
1211 # guix offload test machines.scm '\.gnu\.org$'
1212 @end example
1213
1214 @cindex offload status
1215 To display the current load of all build hosts, run this command on the
1216 main node:
1217
1218 @example
1219 # guix offload status
1220 @end example
1221
1222
1223 @node SELinux Support
1224 @subsection SELinux Support
1225
1226 @cindex SELinux, daemon policy
1227 @cindex mandatory access control, SELinux
1228 @cindex security, guix-daemon
1229 Guix includes an SELinux policy file at @file{etc/guix-daemon.cil} that
1230 can be installed on a system where SELinux is enabled, in order to label
1231 Guix files and to specify the expected behavior of the daemon. Since
1232 Guix System does not provide an SELinux base policy, the daemon policy cannot
1233 be used on Guix System.
1234
1235 @subsubsection Installing the SELinux policy
1236 @cindex SELinux, policy installation
1237 To install the policy run this command as root:
1238
1239 @example
1240 semodule -i etc/guix-daemon.cil
1241 @end example
1242
1243 Then relabel the file system with @code{restorecon} or by a different
1244 mechanism provided by your system.
1245
1246 Once the policy is installed, the file system has been relabeled, and
1247 the daemon has been restarted, it should be running in the
1248 @code{guix_daemon_t} context. You can confirm this with the following
1249 command:
1250
1251 @example
1252 ps -Zax | grep guix-daemon
1253 @end example
1254
1255 Monitor the SELinux log files as you run a command like @code{guix build
1256 hello} to convince yourself that SELinux permits all necessary
1257 operations.
1258
1259 @subsubsection Limitations
1260 @cindex SELinux, limitations
1261
1262 This policy is not perfect. Here is a list of limitations or quirks
1263 that should be considered when deploying the provided SELinux policy for
1264 the Guix daemon.
1265
1266 @enumerate
1267 @item
1268 @code{guix_daemon_socket_t} isn’t actually used. None of the socket
1269 operations involve contexts that have anything to do with
1270 @code{guix_daemon_socket_t}. It doesn’t hurt to have this unused label,
1271 but it would be preferrable to define socket rules for only this label.
1272
1273 @item
1274 @code{guix gc} cannot access arbitrary links to profiles. By design,
1275 the file label of the destination of a symlink is independent of the
1276 file label of the link itself. Although all profiles under
1277 $localstatedir are labelled, the links to these profiles inherit the
1278 label of the directory they are in. For links in the user’s home
1279 directory this will be @code{user_home_t}. But for links from the root
1280 user’s home directory, or @file{/tmp}, or the HTTP server’s working
1281 directory, etc, this won’t work. @code{guix gc} would be prevented from
1282 reading and following these links.
1283
1284 @item
1285 The daemon’s feature to listen for TCP connections might no longer work.
1286 This might require extra rules, because SELinux treats network sockets
1287 differently from files.
1288
1289 @item
1290 Currently all files with a name matching the regular expression
1291 @code{/gnu/store/.+-(guix-.+|profile)/bin/guix-daemon} are assigned the
1292 label @code{guix_daemon_exec_t}; this means that @emph{any} file with
1293 that name in any profile would be permitted to run in the
1294 @code{guix_daemon_t} domain. This is not ideal. An attacker could
1295 build a package that provides this executable and convince a user to
1296 install and run it, which lifts it into the @code{guix_daemon_t} domain.
1297 At that point SELinux could not prevent it from accessing files that are
1298 allowed for processes in that domain.
1299
1300 We could generate a much more restrictive policy at installation time,
1301 so that only the @emph{exact} file name of the currently installed
1302 @code{guix-daemon} executable would be labelled with
1303 @code{guix_daemon_exec_t}, instead of using a broad regular expression.
1304 The downside is that root would have to install or upgrade the policy at
1305 installation time whenever the Guix package that provides the
1306 effectively running @code{guix-daemon} executable is upgraded.
1307 @end enumerate
1308
1309 @node Invoking guix-daemon
1310 @section Invoking @command{guix-daemon}
1311
1312 The @command{guix-daemon} program implements all the functionality to
1313 access the store. This includes launching build processes, running the
1314 garbage collector, querying the availability of a build result, etc. It
1315 is normally run as @code{root} like this:
1316
1317 @example
1318 # guix-daemon --build-users-group=guixbuild
1319 @end example
1320
1321 @noindent
1322 For details on how to set it up, @pxref{Setting Up the Daemon}.
1323
1324 @cindex chroot
1325 @cindex container, build environment
1326 @cindex build environment
1327 @cindex reproducible builds
1328 By default, @command{guix-daemon} launches build processes under
1329 different UIDs, taken from the build group specified with
1330 @code{--build-users-group}. In addition, each build process is run in a
1331 chroot environment that only contains the subset of the store that the
1332 build process depends on, as specified by its derivation
1333 (@pxref{Programming Interface, derivation}), plus a set of specific
1334 system directories. By default, the latter contains @file{/dev} and
1335 @file{/dev/pts}. Furthermore, on GNU/Linux, the build environment is a
1336 @dfn{container}: in addition to having its own file system tree, it has
1337 a separate mount name space, its own PID name space, network name space,
1338 etc. This helps achieve reproducible builds (@pxref{Features}).
1339
1340 When the daemon performs a build on behalf of the user, it creates a
1341 build directory under @file{/tmp} or under the directory specified by
1342 its @code{TMPDIR} environment variable. This directory is shared with
1343 the container for the duration of the build, though within the container,
1344 the build tree is always called @file{/tmp/guix-build-@var{name}.drv-0}.
1345
1346 The build directory is automatically deleted upon completion, unless the
1347 build failed and the client specified @option{--keep-failed}
1348 (@pxref{Invoking guix build, @option{--keep-failed}}).
1349
1350 The daemon listens for connections and spawns one sub-process for each session
1351 started by a client (one of the @command{guix} sub-commands.) The
1352 @command{guix processes} command allows you to get an overview of the activity
1353 on your system by viewing each of the active sessions and clients.
1354 @xref{Invoking guix processes}, for more information.
1355
1356 The following command-line options are supported:
1357
1358 @table @code
1359 @item --build-users-group=@var{group}
1360 Take users from @var{group} to run build processes (@pxref{Setting Up
1361 the Daemon, build users}).
1362
1363 @item --no-substitutes
1364 @cindex substitutes
1365 Do not use substitutes for build products. That is, always build things
1366 locally instead of allowing downloads of pre-built binaries
1367 (@pxref{Substitutes}).
1368
1369 When the daemon runs with @code{--no-substitutes}, clients can still
1370 explicitly enable substitution @i{via} the @code{set-build-options}
1371 remote procedure call (@pxref{The Store}).
1372
1373 @item --substitute-urls=@var{urls}
1374 @anchor{daemon-substitute-urls}
1375 Consider @var{urls} the default whitespace-separated list of substitute
1376 source URLs. When this option is omitted,
1377 @indicateurl{https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} is used.
1378
1379 This means that substitutes may be downloaded from @var{urls}, as long
1380 as they are signed by a trusted signature (@pxref{Substitutes}).
1381
1382 @cindex build hook
1383 @item --no-build-hook
1384 Do not use the @dfn{build hook}.
1385
1386 The build hook is a helper program that the daemon can start and to
1387 which it submits build requests. This mechanism is used to offload
1388 builds to other machines (@pxref{Daemon Offload Setup}).
1389
1390 @item --cache-failures
1391 Cache build failures. By default, only successful builds are cached.
1392
1393 When this option is used, @command{guix gc --list-failures} can be used
1394 to query the set of store items marked as failed; @command{guix gc
1395 --clear-failures} removes store items from the set of cached failures.
1396 @xref{Invoking guix gc}.
1397
1398 @item --cores=@var{n}
1399 @itemx -c @var{n}
1400 Use @var{n} CPU cores to build each derivation; @code{0} means as many
1401 as available.
1402
1403 The default value is @code{0}, but it may be overridden by clients, such
1404 as the @code{--cores} option of @command{guix build} (@pxref{Invoking
1405 guix build}).
1406
1407 The effect is to define the @code{NIX_BUILD_CORES} environment variable
1408 in the build process, which can then use it to exploit internal
1409 parallelism---for instance, by running @code{make -j$NIX_BUILD_CORES}.
1410
1411 @item --max-jobs=@var{n}
1412 @itemx -M @var{n}
1413 Allow at most @var{n} build jobs in parallel. The default value is
1414 @code{1}. Setting it to @code{0} means that no builds will be performed
1415 locally; instead, the daemon will offload builds (@pxref{Daemon Offload
1416 Setup}), or simply fail.
1417
1418 @item --max-silent-time=@var{seconds}
1419 When the build or substitution process remains silent for more than
1420 @var{seconds}, terminate it and report a build failure.
1421
1422 The default value is @code{0}, which disables the timeout.
1423
1424 The value specified here can be overridden by clients (@pxref{Common
1425 Build Options, @code{--max-silent-time}}).
1426
1427 @item --timeout=@var{seconds}
1428 Likewise, when the build or substitution process lasts for more than
1429 @var{seconds}, terminate it and report a build failure.
1430
1431 The default value is @code{0}, which disables the timeout.
1432
1433 The value specified here can be overridden by clients (@pxref{Common
1434 Build Options, @code{--timeout}}).
1435
1436 @item --rounds=@var{N}
1437 Build each derivation @var{n} times in a row, and raise an error if
1438 consecutive build results are not bit-for-bit identical. Note that this
1439 setting can be overridden by clients such as @command{guix build}
1440 (@pxref{Invoking guix build}).
1441
1442 When used in conjunction with @option{--keep-failed}, the differing
1443 output is kept in the store, under @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-check}.
1444 This makes it easy to look for differences between the two results.
1445
1446 @item --debug
1447 Produce debugging output.
1448
1449 This is useful to debug daemon start-up issues, but then it may be
1450 overridden by clients, for example the @code{--verbosity} option of
1451 @command{guix build} (@pxref{Invoking guix build}).
1452
1453 @item --chroot-directory=@var{dir}
1454 Add @var{dir} to the build chroot.
1455
1456 Doing this may change the result of build processes---for instance if
1457 they use optional dependencies found in @var{dir} when it is available,
1458 and not otherwise. For that reason, it is not recommended to do so.
1459 Instead, make sure that each derivation declares all the inputs that it
1460 needs.
1461
1462 @item --disable-chroot
1463 Disable chroot builds.
1464
1465 Using this option is not recommended since, again, it would allow build
1466 processes to gain access to undeclared dependencies. It is necessary,
1467 though, when @command{guix-daemon} is running under an unprivileged user
1468 account.
1469
1470 @item --log-compression=@var{type}
1471 Compress build logs according to @var{type}, one of @code{gzip},
1472 @code{bzip2}, or @code{none}.
1473
1474 Unless @code{--lose-logs} is used, all the build logs are kept in the
1475 @var{localstatedir}. To save space, the daemon automatically compresses
1476 them with bzip2 by default.
1477
1478 @item --disable-deduplication
1479 @cindex deduplication
1480 Disable automatic file ``deduplication'' in the store.
1481
1482 By default, files added to the store are automatically ``deduplicated'':
1483 if a newly added file is identical to another one found in the store,
1484 the daemon makes the new file a hard link to the other file. This can
1485 noticeably reduce disk usage, at the expense of slightly increased
1486 input/output load at the end of a build process. This option disables
1487 this optimization.
1488
1489 @item --gc-keep-outputs[=yes|no]
1490 Tell whether the garbage collector (GC) must keep outputs of live
1491 derivations.
1492
1493 @cindex GC roots
1494 @cindex garbage collector roots
1495 When set to ``yes'', the GC will keep the outputs of any live derivation
1496 available in the store---the @code{.drv} files. The default is ``no'',
1497 meaning that derivation outputs are kept only if they are reachable from a GC
1498 root. @xref{Invoking guix gc}, for more on GC roots.
1499
1500 @item --gc-keep-derivations[=yes|no]
1501 Tell whether the garbage collector (GC) must keep derivations
1502 corresponding to live outputs.
1503
1504 When set to ``yes'', as is the case by default, the GC keeps
1505 derivations---i.e., @code{.drv} files---as long as at least one of their
1506 outputs is live. This allows users to keep track of the origins of
1507 items in their store. Setting it to ``no'' saves a bit of disk space.
1508
1509 In this way, setting @code{--gc-keep-derivations} to ``yes'' causes liveness
1510 to flow from outputs to derivations, and setting @code{--gc-keep-outputs} to
1511 ``yes'' causes liveness to flow from derivations to outputs. When both are
1512 set to ``yes'', the effect is to keep all the build prerequisites (the
1513 sources, compiler, libraries, and other build-time tools) of live objects in
1514 the store, regardless of whether these prerequisites are reachable from a GC
1515 root. This is convenient for developers since it saves rebuilds or downloads.
1516
1517 @item --impersonate-linux-2.6
1518 On Linux-based systems, impersonate Linux 2.6. This means that the
1519 kernel's @code{uname} system call will report 2.6 as the release number.
1520
1521 This might be helpful to build programs that (usually wrongfully) depend
1522 on the kernel version number.
1523
1524 @item --lose-logs
1525 Do not keep build logs. By default they are kept under
1526 @code{@var{localstatedir}/guix/log}.
1527
1528 @item --system=@var{system}
1529 Assume @var{system} as the current system type. By default it is the
1530 architecture/kernel pair found at configure time, such as
1531 @code{x86_64-linux}.
1532
1533 @item --listen=@var{endpoint}
1534 Listen for connections on @var{endpoint}. @var{endpoint} is interpreted
1535 as the file name of a Unix-domain socket if it starts with
1536 @code{/} (slash sign). Otherwise, @var{endpoint} is interpreted as a
1537 host name or host name and port to listen to. Here are a few examples:
1538
1539 @table @code
1540 @item --listen=/gnu/var/daemon
1541 Listen for connections on the @file{/gnu/var/daemon} Unix-domain socket,
1542 creating it if needed.
1543
1544 @item --listen=localhost
1545 @cindex daemon, remote access
1546 @cindex remote access to the daemon
1547 @cindex daemon, cluster setup
1548 @cindex clusters, daemon setup
1549 Listen for TCP connections on the network interface corresponding to
1550 @code{localhost}, on port 44146.
1551
1552 @item --listen=128.0.0.42:1234
1553 Listen for TCP connections on the network interface corresponding to
1554 @code{128.0.0.42}, on port 1234.
1555 @end table
1556
1557 This option can be repeated multiple times, in which case
1558 @command{guix-daemon} accepts connections on all the specified
1559 endpoints. Users can tell client commands what endpoint to connect to
1560 by setting the @code{GUIX_DAEMON_SOCKET} environment variable
1561 (@pxref{The Store, @code{GUIX_DAEMON_SOCKET}}).
1562
1563 @quotation Note
1564 The daemon protocol is @emph{unauthenticated and unencrypted}. Using
1565 @code{--listen=@var{host}} is suitable on local networks, such as
1566 clusters, where only trusted nodes may connect to the build daemon. In
1567 other cases where remote access to the daemon is needed, we recommend
1568 using Unix-domain sockets along with SSH.
1569 @end quotation
1570
1571 When @code{--listen} is omitted, @command{guix-daemon} listens for
1572 connections on the Unix-domain socket located at
1573 @file{@var{localstatedir}/guix/daemon-socket/socket}.
1574 @end table
1575
1576
1577 @node Application Setup
1578 @section Application Setup
1579
1580 @cindex foreign distro
1581 When using Guix on top of GNU/Linux distribution other than Guix System---a
1582 so-called @dfn{foreign distro}---a few additional steps are needed to
1583 get everything in place. Here are some of them.
1584
1585 @subsection Locales
1586
1587 @anchor{locales-and-locpath}
1588 @cindex locales, when not on Guix System
1589 @vindex LOCPATH
1590 @vindex GUIX_LOCPATH
1591 Packages installed @i{via} Guix will not use the locale data of the
1592 host system. Instead, you must first install one of the locale packages
1593 available with Guix and then define the @code{GUIX_LOCPATH} environment
1594 variable:
1595
1596 @example
1597 $ guix install glibc-locales
1598 $ export GUIX_LOCPATH=$HOME/.guix-profile/lib/locale
1599 @end example
1600
1601 Note that the @code{glibc-locales} package contains data for all the
1602 locales supported by the GNU@tie{}libc and weighs in at around
1603 110@tie{}MiB. Alternatively, the @code{glibc-utf8-locales} is smaller but
1604 limited to a few UTF-8 locales.
1605
1606 The @code{GUIX_LOCPATH} variable plays a role similar to @code{LOCPATH}
1607 (@pxref{Locale Names, @code{LOCPATH},, libc, The GNU C Library Reference
1608 Manual}). There are two important differences though:
1609
1610 @enumerate
1611 @item
1612 @code{GUIX_LOCPATH} is honored only by the libc in Guix, and not by the libc
1613 provided by foreign distros. Thus, using @code{GUIX_LOCPATH} allows you
1614 to make sure the programs of the foreign distro will not end up loading
1615 incompatible locale data.
1616
1617 @item
1618 libc suffixes each entry of @code{GUIX_LOCPATH} with @code{/X.Y}, where
1619 @code{X.Y} is the libc version---e.g., @code{2.22}. This means that,
1620 should your Guix profile contain a mixture of programs linked against
1621 different libc version, each libc version will only try to load locale
1622 data in the right format.
1623 @end enumerate
1624
1625 This is important because the locale data format used by different libc
1626 versions may be incompatible.
1627
1628 @subsection Name Service Switch
1629
1630 @cindex name service switch, glibc
1631 @cindex NSS (name service switch), glibc
1632 @cindex nscd (name service caching daemon)
1633 @cindex name service caching daemon (nscd)
1634 When using Guix on a foreign distro, we @emph{strongly recommend} that
1635 the system run the GNU C library's @dfn{name service cache daemon},
1636 @command{nscd}, which should be listening on the
1637 @file{/var/run/nscd/socket} socket. Failing to do that, applications
1638 installed with Guix may fail to look up host names or user accounts, or
1639 may even crash. The next paragraphs explain why.
1640
1641 @cindex @file{nsswitch.conf}
1642 The GNU C library implements a @dfn{name service switch} (NSS), which is
1643 an extensible mechanism for ``name lookups'' in general: host name
1644 resolution, user accounts, and more (@pxref{Name Service Switch,,, libc,
1645 The GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
1646
1647 @cindex Network information service (NIS)
1648 @cindex NIS (Network information service)
1649 Being extensible, the NSS supports @dfn{plugins}, which provide new name
1650 lookup implementations: for example, the @code{nss-mdns} plugin allow
1651 resolution of @code{.local} host names, the @code{nis} plugin allows
1652 user account lookup using the Network information service (NIS), and so
1653 on. These extra ``lookup services'' are configured system-wide in
1654 @file{/etc/nsswitch.conf}, and all the programs running on the system
1655 honor those settings (@pxref{NSS Configuration File,,, libc, The GNU C
1656 Reference Manual}).
1657
1658 When they perform a name lookup---for instance by calling the
1659 @code{getaddrinfo} function in C---applications first try to connect to
1660 the nscd; on success, nscd performs name lookups on their behalf. If
1661 the nscd is not running, then they perform the name lookup by
1662 themselves, by loading the name lookup services into their own address
1663 space and running it. These name lookup services---the
1664 @file{libnss_*.so} files---are @code{dlopen}'d, but they may come from
1665 the host system's C library, rather than from the C library the
1666 application is linked against (the C library coming from Guix).
1667
1668 And this is where the problem is: if your application is linked against
1669 Guix's C library (say, glibc 2.24) and tries to load NSS plugins from
1670 another C library (say, @code{libnss_mdns.so} for glibc 2.22), it will
1671 likely crash or have its name lookups fail unexpectedly.
1672
1673 Running @command{nscd} on the system, among other advantages, eliminates
1674 this binary incompatibility problem because those @code{libnss_*.so}
1675 files are loaded in the @command{nscd} process, not in applications
1676 themselves.
1677
1678 @subsection X11 Fonts
1679
1680 @cindex fonts
1681 The majority of graphical applications use Fontconfig to locate and
1682 load fonts and perform X11-client-side rendering. The @code{fontconfig}
1683 package in Guix looks for fonts in @file{$HOME/.guix-profile}
1684 by default. Thus, to allow graphical applications installed with Guix
1685 to display fonts, you have to install fonts with Guix as well.
1686 Essential font packages include @code{gs-fonts}, @code{font-dejavu}, and
1687 @code{font-gnu-freefont-ttf}.
1688
1689 To display text written in Chinese languages, Japanese, or Korean in
1690 graphical applications, consider installing
1691 @code{font-adobe-source-han-sans} or @code{font-wqy-zenhei}. The former
1692 has multiple outputs, one per language family (@pxref{Packages with
1693 Multiple Outputs}). For instance, the following command installs fonts
1694 for Chinese languages:
1695
1696 @example
1697 guix install font-adobe-source-han-sans:cn
1698 @end example
1699
1700 @cindex @code{xterm}
1701 Older programs such as @command{xterm} do not use Fontconfig and instead
1702 rely on server-side font rendering. Such programs require to specify a
1703 full name of a font using XLFD (X Logical Font Description), like this:
1704
1705 @example
1706 -*-dejavu sans-medium-r-normal-*-*-100-*-*-*-*-*-1
1707 @end example
1708
1709 To be able to use such full names for the TrueType fonts installed in
1710 your Guix profile, you need to extend the font path of the X server:
1711
1712 @c Note: 'xset' does not accept symlinks so the trick below arranges to
1713 @c get at the real directory. See <https://bugs.gnu.org/30655>.
1714 @example
1715 xset +fp $(dirname $(readlink -f ~/.guix-profile/share/fonts/truetype/fonts.dir))
1716 @end example
1717
1718 @cindex @code{xlsfonts}
1719 After that, you can run @code{xlsfonts} (from @code{xlsfonts} package)
1720 to make sure your TrueType fonts are listed there.
1721
1722 @cindex @code{fc-cache}
1723 @cindex font cache
1724 After installing fonts you may have to refresh the font cache to use
1725 them in applications. The same applies when applications installed via
1726 Guix do not seem to find fonts. To force rebuilding of the font cache
1727 run @code{fc-cache -rv}. The @code{fc-cache} command is provided by
1728 the @code{fontconfig} package.
1729
1730 @subsection X.509 Certificates
1731
1732 @cindex @code{nss-certs}
1733 The @code{nss-certs} package provides X.509 certificates, which allow
1734 programs to authenticate Web servers accessed over HTTPS.
1735
1736 When using Guix on a foreign distro, you can install this package and
1737 define the relevant environment variables so that packages know where to
1738 look for certificates. @xref{X.509 Certificates}, for detailed
1739 information.
1740
1741 @subsection Emacs Packages
1742
1743 @cindex @code{emacs}
1744 When you install Emacs packages with Guix, the elisp files may be placed
1745 either in @file{$HOME/.guix-profile/share/emacs/site-lisp/} or in
1746 sub-directories of
1747 @file{$HOME/.guix-profile/share/emacs/site-lisp/guix.d/}. The latter
1748 directory exists because potentially there may exist thousands of Emacs
1749 packages and storing all their files in a single directory may not be
1750 reliable (because of name conflicts). So we think using a separate
1751 directory for each package is a good idea. It is very similar to how
1752 the Emacs package system organizes the file structure (@pxref{Package
1753 Files,,, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}).
1754
1755 By default, Emacs (installed with Guix) ``knows'' where these packages
1756 are placed, so you do not need to perform any configuration. If, for
1757 some reason, you want to avoid auto-loading Emacs packages installed
1758 with Guix, you can do so by running Emacs with @code{--no-site-file}
1759 option (@pxref{Init File,,, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}).
1760
1761 @subsection The GCC toolchain
1762
1763 @cindex GCC
1764 @cindex ld-wrapper
1765
1766 Guix offers individual compiler packages such as @code{gcc} but if you
1767 are in need of a complete toolchain for compiling and linking source
1768 code what you really want is the @code{gcc-toolchain} package. This
1769 package provides a complete GCC toolchain for C/C++ development,
1770 including GCC itself, the GNU C Library (headers and binaries, plus
1771 debugging symbols in the @code{debug} output), Binutils, and a linker
1772 wrapper.
1773
1774 The wrapper's purpose is to inspect the @code{-L} and @code{-l} switches
1775 passed to the linker, add corresponding @code{-rpath} arguments, and
1776 invoke the actual linker with this new set of arguments. You can instruct the
1777 wrapper to refuse to link against libraries not in the store by setting the
1778 @code{GUIX_LD_WRAPPER_ALLOW_IMPURITIES} environment variable to @code{no}.
1779
1780 @c TODO What else?
1781
1782 @c *********************************************************************
1783 @node System Installation
1784 @chapter System Installation
1785
1786 @cindex installing Guix System
1787 @cindex Guix System, installation
1788 This section explains how to install Guix System
1789 on a machine. Guix, as a package manager, can
1790 also be installed on top of a running GNU/Linux system,
1791 @pxref{Installation}.
1792
1793 @ifinfo
1794 @quotation Note
1795 @c This paragraph is for people reading this from tty2 of the
1796 @c installation image.
1797 You are reading this documentation with an Info reader. For details on
1798 how to use it, hit the @key{RET} key (``return'' or ``enter'') on the
1799 link that follows: @pxref{Top, Info reader,, info-stnd, Stand-alone GNU
1800 Info}. Hit @kbd{l} afterwards to come back here.
1801
1802 Alternately, run @command{info info} in another tty to keep the manual
1803 available.
1804 @end quotation
1805 @end ifinfo
1806
1807 @menu
1808 * Limitations:: What you can expect.
1809 * Hardware Considerations:: Supported hardware.
1810 * USB Stick and DVD Installation:: Preparing the installation medium.
1811 * Preparing for Installation:: Networking, partitioning, etc.
1812 * Guided Graphical Installation:: Easy graphical installation.
1813 * Manual Installation:: Manual installation for wizards.
1814 * After System Installation:: When installation succeeded.
1815 * Installing Guix in a VM:: Guix System playground.
1816 * Building the Installation Image:: How this comes to be.
1817 @end menu
1818
1819 @node Limitations
1820 @section Limitations
1821
1822 We consider Guix System to be ready for a wide range of ``desktop'' and server
1823 use cases. The reliability guarantees it provides---transactional upgrades
1824 and rollbacks, reproducibility---make it a solid foundation.
1825
1826 Nevertheless, before you proceed with the installation, be aware of the
1827 following noteworthy limitations applicable to version @value{VERSION}:
1828
1829 @itemize
1830 @item
1831 Support for the Logical Volume Manager (LVM) is missing.
1832
1833 @item
1834 More and more system services are provided (@pxref{Services}), but some
1835 may be missing.
1836
1837 @item
1838 GNOME, Xfce, LXDE, and Enlightenment are available (@pxref{Desktop Services}),
1839 as well as a number of X11 window managers. However, KDE is currently
1840 missing.
1841 @end itemize
1842
1843 More than a disclaimer, this is an invitation to report issues (and success
1844 stories!), and to join us in improving it. @xref{Contributing}, for more
1845 info.
1846
1847
1848 @node Hardware Considerations
1849 @section Hardware Considerations
1850
1851 @cindex hardware support on Guix System
1852 GNU@tie{}Guix focuses on respecting the user's computing freedom. It
1853 builds around the kernel Linux-libre, which means that only hardware for
1854 which free software drivers and firmware exist is supported. Nowadays,
1855 a wide range of off-the-shelf hardware is supported on
1856 GNU/Linux-libre---from keyboards to graphics cards to scanners and
1857 Ethernet controllers. Unfortunately, there are still areas where
1858 hardware vendors deny users control over their own computing, and such
1859 hardware is not supported on Guix System.
1860
1861 @cindex WiFi, hardware support
1862 One of the main areas where free drivers or firmware are lacking is WiFi
1863 devices. WiFi devices known to work include those using Atheros chips
1864 (AR9271 and AR7010), which corresponds to the @code{ath9k} Linux-libre
1865 driver, and those using Broadcom/AirForce chips (BCM43xx with
1866 Wireless-Core Revision 5), which corresponds to the @code{b43-open}
1867 Linux-libre driver. Free firmware exists for both and is available
1868 out-of-the-box on Guix System, as part of @code{%base-firmware}
1869 (@pxref{operating-system Reference, @code{firmware}}).
1870
1871 @cindex RYF, Respects Your Freedom
1872 The @uref{https://www.fsf.org/, Free Software Foundation} runs
1873 @uref{https://www.fsf.org/ryf, @dfn{Respects Your Freedom}} (RYF), a
1874 certification program for hardware products that respect your freedom
1875 and your privacy and ensure that you have control over your device. We
1876 encourage you to check the list of RYF-certified devices.
1877
1878 Another useful resource is the @uref{https://www.h-node.org/, H-Node}
1879 web site. It contains a catalog of hardware devices with information
1880 about their support in GNU/Linux.
1881
1882
1883 @node USB Stick and DVD Installation
1884 @section USB Stick and DVD Installation
1885
1886 An ISO-9660 installation image that can be written to a USB stick or
1887 burnt to a DVD can be downloaded from
1888 @indicateurl{@value{BASE-URL}/guix-system-install-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.iso.xz},
1889 where @var{system} is one of:
1890
1891 @table @code
1892 @item x86_64-linux
1893 for a GNU/Linux system on Intel/AMD-compatible 64-bit CPUs;
1894
1895 @item i686-linux
1896 for a 32-bit GNU/Linux system on Intel-compatible CPUs.
1897 @end table
1898
1899 @c start duplication of authentication part from ``Binary Installation''
1900 Make sure to download the associated @file{.sig} file and to verify the
1901 authenticity of the image against it, along these lines:
1902
1903 @example
1904 $ wget @value{BASE-URL}/guix-system-install-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.iso.xz.sig
1905 $ gpg --verify guix-system-install-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.iso.xz.sig
1906 @end example
1907
1908 If that command fails because you do not have the required public key,
1909 then run this command to import it:
1910
1911 @example
1912 $ wget @value{OPENPGP-SIGNING-KEY-URL} \
1913 -qO - | gpg --import -
1914 @end example
1915
1916 @noindent
1917 and rerun the @code{gpg --verify} command.
1918
1919 Take note that a warning like ``This key is not certified with a trusted
1920 signature!'' is normal.
1921
1922 @c end duplication
1923
1924 This image contains the tools necessary for an installation.
1925 It is meant to be copied @emph{as is} to a large-enough USB stick or DVD.
1926
1927 @unnumberedsubsec Copying to a USB Stick
1928
1929 To copy the image to a USB stick, follow these steps:
1930
1931 @enumerate
1932 @item
1933 Decompress the image using the @command{xz} command:
1934
1935 @example
1936 xz -d guix-system-install-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.iso.xz
1937 @end example
1938
1939 @item
1940 Insert a USB stick of 1@tie{}GiB or more into your machine, and determine
1941 its device name. Assuming that the USB stick is known as @file{/dev/sdX},
1942 copy the image with:
1943
1944 @example
1945 dd if=guix-system-install-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.iso of=/dev/sdX
1946 sync
1947 @end example
1948
1949 Access to @file{/dev/sdX} usually requires root privileges.
1950 @end enumerate
1951
1952 @unnumberedsubsec Burning on a DVD
1953
1954 To copy the image to a DVD, follow these steps:
1955
1956 @enumerate
1957 @item
1958 Decompress the image using the @command{xz} command:
1959
1960 @example
1961 xz -d guix-system-install-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.iso.xz
1962 @end example
1963
1964 @item
1965 Insert a blank DVD into your machine, and determine
1966 its device name. Assuming that the DVD drive is known as @file{/dev/srX},
1967 copy the image with:
1968
1969 @example
1970 growisofs -dvd-compat -Z /dev/srX=guix-system-install-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.iso
1971 @end example
1972
1973 Access to @file{/dev/srX} usually requires root privileges.
1974 @end enumerate
1975
1976 @unnumberedsubsec Booting
1977
1978 Once this is done, you should be able to reboot the system and boot from
1979 the USB stick or DVD. The latter usually requires you to get in the
1980 BIOS or UEFI boot menu, where you can choose to boot from the USB stick.
1981
1982 @xref{Installing Guix in a VM}, if, instead, you would like to install
1983 Guix System in a virtual machine (VM).
1984
1985
1986 @node Preparing for Installation
1987 @section Preparing for Installation
1988
1989 Once you have booted, you can use the guided graphical installer, which makes
1990 it easy to get started (@pxref{Guided Graphical Installation}). Alternately,
1991 if you are already familiar with GNU/Linux and if you want more control than
1992 what the graphical installer provides, you can choose the ``manual''
1993 installation process (@pxref{Manual Installation}).
1994
1995 The graphical installer is available on TTY1. You can obtain root shells on
1996 TTYs 3 to 6 by hitting @kbd{ctrl-alt-f3}, @kbd{ctrl-alt-f4}, etc. TTY2 shows
1997 this documentation and you can reach it with @kbd{ctrl-alt-f2}. Documentation
1998 is browsable using the Info reader commands (@pxref{Top,,, info-stnd,
1999 Stand-alone GNU Info}). The installation system runs the GPM mouse daemon,
2000 which allows you to select text with the left mouse button and to paste it
2001 with the middle button.
2002
2003 @quotation Note
2004 Installation requires access to the Internet so that any missing
2005 dependencies of your system configuration can be downloaded. See the
2006 ``Networking'' section below.
2007 @end quotation
2008
2009 @node Guided Graphical Installation
2010 @section Guided Graphical Installation
2011
2012 The graphical installer is a text-based user interface. It will guide you,
2013 with dialog boxes, through the steps needed to install GNU@tie{}Guix System.
2014
2015 The first dialog boxes allow you to set up the system as you use it during the
2016 installation: you can choose the language, keyboard layout, and set up
2017 networking, which will be used during the installation. The image below shows
2018 the networking dialog.
2019
2020 @image{images/installer-network,5in,, networking setup with the graphical installer}
2021
2022 Later steps allow you to partition your hard disk, as shown in the image
2023 below, to choose whether or not to use encrypted file systems, to enter the
2024 host name and root password, and to create an additional account, among other
2025 things.
2026
2027 @image{images/installer-partitions,5in,, partitioning with the graphical installer}
2028
2029 Note that, at any time, the installer allows you to exit the current
2030 installation step and resume at a previous step, as show in the image below.
2031
2032 @image{images/installer-resume,5in,, resuming the installation process}
2033
2034 Once you're done, the installer produces an operating system configuration and
2035 displays it (@pxref{Using the Configuration System}). At that point you can
2036 hit ``OK'' and installation will proceed. On success, you can reboot into the
2037 new system and enjoy. @xref{After System Installation}, for what's next!
2038
2039
2040 @node Manual Installation
2041 @section Manual Installation
2042
2043 This section describes how you would ``manually'' install GNU@tie{}Guix System
2044 on your machine. This option requires familiarity with GNU/Linux, with the
2045 shell, and with common administration tools. If you think this is not for
2046 you, consider using the guided graphical installer (@pxref{Guided Graphical
2047 Installation}).
2048
2049 The installation system provides root shells on TTYs 3 to 6; press
2050 @kbd{ctrl-alt-f3}, @kbd{ctrl-alt-f4}, and so on to reach them. It includes
2051 many common tools needed to install the system. But it is also a full-blown
2052 Guix System, which means that you can install additional packages, should you
2053 need it, using @command{guix package} (@pxref{Invoking guix package}).
2054
2055 @menu
2056 * Keyboard Layout and Networking and Partitioning:: Initial setup.
2057 * Proceeding with the Installation:: Installing.
2058 @end menu
2059
2060 @node Keyboard Layout and Networking and Partitioning
2061 @subsection Keyboard Layout, Networking, and Partitioning
2062
2063 Before you can install the system, you may want to adjust the keyboard layout,
2064 set up networking, and partition your target hard disk. This section will
2065 guide you through this.
2066
2067 @subsubsection Keyboard Layout
2068
2069 @cindex keyboard layout
2070 The installation image uses the US qwerty keyboard layout. If you want
2071 to change it, you can use the @command{loadkeys} command. For example,
2072 the following command selects the Dvorak keyboard layout:
2073
2074 @example
2075 loadkeys dvorak
2076 @end example
2077
2078 See the files under @file{/run/current-system/profile/share/keymaps} for
2079 a list of available keyboard layouts. Run @command{man loadkeys} for
2080 more information.
2081
2082 @subsubsection Networking
2083
2084 Run the following command to see what your network interfaces are called:
2085
2086 @example
2087 ifconfig -a
2088 @end example
2089
2090 @noindent
2091 @dots{} or, using the GNU/Linux-specific @command{ip} command:
2092
2093 @example
2094 ip a
2095 @end example
2096
2097 @c https://cgit.freedesktop.org/systemd/systemd/tree/src/udev/udev-builtin-net_id.c#n20
2098 Wired interfaces have a name starting with @samp{e}; for example, the
2099 interface corresponding to the first on-board Ethernet controller is
2100 called @samp{eno1}. Wireless interfaces have a name starting with
2101 @samp{w}, like @samp{w1p2s0}.
2102
2103 @table @asis
2104 @item Wired connection
2105 To configure a wired network run the following command, substituting
2106 @var{interface} with the name of the wired interface you want to use.
2107
2108 @example
2109 ifconfig @var{interface} up
2110 @end example
2111
2112 @item Wireless connection
2113 @cindex wireless
2114 @cindex WiFi
2115 To configure wireless networking, you can create a configuration file
2116 for the @command{wpa_supplicant} configuration tool (its location is not
2117 important) using one of the available text editors such as
2118 @command{nano}:
2119
2120 @example
2121 nano wpa_supplicant.conf
2122 @end example
2123
2124 As an example, the following stanza can go to this file and will work
2125 for many wireless networks, provided you give the actual SSID and
2126 passphrase for the network you are connecting to:
2127
2128 @example
2129 network=@{
2130 ssid="@var{my-ssid}"
2131 key_mgmt=WPA-PSK
2132 psk="the network's secret passphrase"
2133 @}
2134 @end example
2135
2136 Start the wireless service and run it in the background with the
2137 following command (substitute @var{interface} with the name of the
2138 network interface you want to use):
2139
2140 @example
2141 wpa_supplicant -c wpa_supplicant.conf -i @var{interface} -B
2142 @end example
2143
2144 Run @command{man wpa_supplicant} for more information.
2145 @end table
2146
2147 @cindex DHCP
2148 At this point, you need to acquire an IP address. On a network where IP
2149 addresses are automatically assigned @i{via} DHCP, you can run:
2150
2151 @example
2152 dhclient -v @var{interface}
2153 @end example
2154
2155 Try to ping a server to see if networking is up and running:
2156
2157 @example
2158 ping -c 3 gnu.org
2159 @end example
2160
2161 Setting up network access is almost always a requirement because the
2162 image does not contain all the software and tools that may be needed.
2163
2164 @cindex installing over SSH
2165 If you want to, you can continue the installation remotely by starting
2166 an SSH server:
2167
2168 @example
2169 herd start ssh-daemon
2170 @end example
2171
2172 Make sure to either set a password with @command{passwd}, or configure
2173 OpenSSH public key authentication before logging in.
2174
2175 @subsubsection Disk Partitioning
2176
2177 Unless this has already been done, the next step is to partition, and
2178 then format the target partition(s).
2179
2180 The installation image includes several partitioning tools, including
2181 Parted (@pxref{Overview,,, parted, GNU Parted User Manual}),
2182 @command{fdisk}, and @command{cfdisk}. Run it and set up your disk with
2183 the partition layout you want:
2184
2185 @example
2186 cfdisk
2187 @end example
2188
2189 If your disk uses the GUID Partition Table (GPT) format and you plan to
2190 install BIOS-based GRUB (which is the default), make sure a BIOS Boot
2191 Partition is available (@pxref{BIOS installation,,, grub, GNU GRUB
2192 manual}).
2193
2194 @cindex EFI, installation
2195 @cindex UEFI, installation
2196 @cindex ESP, EFI system partition
2197 If you instead wish to use EFI-based GRUB, a FAT32 @dfn{EFI System Partition}
2198 (ESP) is required. This partition can be mounted at @file{/boot/efi} for
2199 instance and must have the @code{esp} flag set. E.g., for @command{parted}:
2200
2201 @example
2202 parted /dev/sda set 1 esp on
2203 @end example
2204
2205 @quotation Note
2206 @vindex grub-bootloader
2207 @vindex grub-efi-bootloader
2208 Unsure whether to use EFI- or BIOS-based GRUB? If the directory
2209 @file{/sys/firmware/efi} exists in the installation image, then you should
2210 probably perform an EFI installation, using @code{grub-efi-bootloader}.
2211 Otherwise you should use the BIOS-based GRUB, known as
2212 @code{grub-bootloader}. @xref{Bootloader Configuration}, for more info on
2213 bootloaders.
2214 @end quotation
2215
2216 Once you are done partitioning the target hard disk drive, you have to
2217 create a file system on the relevant partition(s)@footnote{Currently
2218 Guix System only supports ext4 and btrfs file systems. In particular, code
2219 that reads file system UUIDs and labels only works for these file system
2220 types.}. For the ESP, if you have one and assuming it is
2221 @file{/dev/sda1}, run:
2222
2223 @example
2224 mkfs.fat -F32 /dev/sda1
2225 @end example
2226
2227 Preferably, assign file systems a label so that you can easily and
2228 reliably refer to them in @code{file-system} declarations (@pxref{File
2229 Systems}). This is typically done using the @code{-L} option of
2230 @command{mkfs.ext4} and related commands. So, assuming the target root
2231 partition lives at @file{/dev/sda2}, a file system with the label
2232 @code{my-root} can be created with:
2233
2234 @example
2235 mkfs.ext4 -L my-root /dev/sda2
2236 @end example
2237
2238 @cindex encrypted disk
2239 If you are instead planning to encrypt the root partition, you can use
2240 the Cryptsetup/LUKS utilities to do that (see @inlinefmtifelse{html,
2241 @uref{https://linux.die.net/man/8/cryptsetup, @code{man cryptsetup}},
2242 @code{man cryptsetup}} for more information.) Assuming you want to
2243 store the root partition on @file{/dev/sda2}, the command sequence would
2244 be along these lines:
2245
2246 @example
2247 cryptsetup luksFormat /dev/sda2
2248 cryptsetup open --type luks /dev/sda2 my-partition
2249 mkfs.ext4 -L my-root /dev/mapper/my-partition
2250 @end example
2251
2252 Once that is done, mount the target file system under @file{/mnt}
2253 with a command like (again, assuming @code{my-root} is the label of the
2254 root file system):
2255
2256 @example
2257 mount LABEL=my-root /mnt
2258 @end example
2259
2260 Also mount any other file systems you would like to use on the target
2261 system relative to this path. If you have opted for @file{/boot/efi} as an
2262 EFI mount point for example, mount it at @file{/mnt/boot/efi} now so it is
2263 found by @code{guix system init} afterwards.
2264
2265 Finally, if you plan to use one or more swap partitions (@pxref{Memory
2266 Concepts, swap space,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}), make
2267 sure to initialize them with @command{mkswap}. Assuming you have one
2268 swap partition on @file{/dev/sda3}, you would run:
2269
2270 @example
2271 mkswap /dev/sda3
2272 swapon /dev/sda3
2273 @end example
2274
2275 Alternatively, you may use a swap file. For example, assuming that in
2276 the new system you want to use the file @file{/swapfile} as a swap file,
2277 you would run@footnote{This example will work for many types of file
2278 systems (e.g., ext4). However, for copy-on-write file systems (e.g.,
2279 btrfs), the required steps may be different. For details, see the
2280 manual pages for @command{mkswap} and @command{swapon}.}:
2281
2282 @example
2283 # This is 10 GiB of swap space. Adjust "count" to change the size.
2284 dd if=/dev/zero of=/mnt/swapfile bs=1MiB count=10240
2285 # For security, make the file readable and writable only by root.
2286 chmod 600 /mnt/swapfile
2287 mkswap /mnt/swapfile
2288 swapon /mnt/swapfile
2289 @end example
2290
2291 Note that if you have encrypted the root partition and created a swap
2292 file in its file system as described above, then the encryption also
2293 protects the swap file, just like any other file in that file system.
2294
2295 @node Proceeding with the Installation
2296 @subsection Proceeding with the Installation
2297
2298 With the target partitions ready and the target root mounted on
2299 @file{/mnt}, we're ready to go. First, run:
2300
2301 @example
2302 herd start cow-store /mnt
2303 @end example
2304
2305 This makes @file{/gnu/store} copy-on-write, such that packages added to it
2306 during the installation phase are written to the target disk on @file{/mnt}
2307 rather than kept in memory. This is necessary because the first phase of
2308 the @command{guix system init} command (see below) entails downloads or
2309 builds to @file{/gnu/store} which, initially, is an in-memory file system.
2310
2311 Next, you have to edit a file and
2312 provide the declaration of the operating system to be installed. To
2313 that end, the installation system comes with three text editors. We
2314 recommend GNU nano (@pxref{Top,,, nano, GNU nano Manual}), which
2315 supports syntax highlighting and parentheses matching; other editors
2316 include GNU Zile (an Emacs clone), and
2317 nvi (a clone of the original BSD @command{vi} editor).
2318 We strongly recommend storing that file on the target root file system, say,
2319 as @file{/mnt/etc/config.scm}. Failing to do that, you will have lost your
2320 configuration file once you have rebooted into the newly-installed system.
2321
2322 @xref{Using the Configuration System}, for an overview of the
2323 configuration file. The example configurations discussed in that
2324 section are available under @file{/etc/configuration} in the
2325 installation image. Thus, to get started with a system configuration
2326 providing a graphical display server (a ``desktop'' system), you can run
2327 something along these lines:
2328
2329 @example
2330 # mkdir /mnt/etc
2331 # cp /etc/configuration/desktop.scm /mnt/etc/config.scm
2332 # nano /mnt/etc/config.scm
2333 @end example
2334
2335 You should pay attention to what your configuration file contains, and
2336 in particular:
2337
2338 @itemize
2339 @item
2340 Make sure the @code{bootloader-configuration} form refers to the target
2341 you want to install GRUB on. It should mention @code{grub-bootloader} if
2342 you are installing GRUB in the legacy way, or @code{grub-efi-bootloader}
2343 for newer UEFI systems. For legacy systems, the @code{target} field
2344 names a device, like @code{/dev/sda}; for UEFI systems it names a path
2345 to a mounted EFI partition, like @code{/boot/efi}; do make sure the path is
2346 currently mounted and a @code{file-system} entry is specified in your
2347 configuration.
2348
2349 @item
2350 Be sure that your file system labels match the value of their respective
2351 @code{device} fields in your @code{file-system} configuration, assuming
2352 your @code{file-system} configuration uses the @code{file-system-label}
2353 procedure in its @code{device} field.
2354
2355 @item
2356 If there are encrypted or RAID partitions, make sure to add a
2357 @code{mapped-devices} field to describe them (@pxref{Mapped Devices}).
2358 @end itemize
2359
2360 Once you are done preparing the configuration file, the new system must
2361 be initialized (remember that the target root file system is mounted
2362 under @file{/mnt}):
2363
2364 @example
2365 guix system init /mnt/etc/config.scm /mnt
2366 @end example
2367
2368 @noindent
2369 This copies all the necessary files and installs GRUB on
2370 @file{/dev/sdX}, unless you pass the @option{--no-bootloader} option. For
2371 more information, @pxref{Invoking guix system}. This command may trigger
2372 downloads or builds of missing packages, which can take some time.
2373
2374 Once that command has completed---and hopefully succeeded!---you can run
2375 @command{reboot} and boot into the new system. The @code{root} password
2376 in the new system is initially empty; other users' passwords need to be
2377 initialized by running the @command{passwd} command as @code{root},
2378 unless your configuration specifies otherwise
2379 (@pxref{user-account-password, user account passwords}).
2380 @xref{After System Installation}, for what's next!
2381
2382
2383 @node After System Installation
2384 @section After System Installation
2385
2386 Success, you've now booted into Guix System! From then on, you can update the
2387 system whenever you want by running, say:
2388
2389 @example
2390 guix pull
2391 sudo guix system reconfigure /etc/config.scm
2392 @end example
2393
2394 @noindent
2395 This builds a new system generation with the latest packages and services
2396 (@pxref{Invoking guix system}). We recommend doing that regularly so that
2397 your system includes the latest security updates (@pxref{Security Updates}).
2398
2399 @c See <https://lists.gnu.org/archive/html/guix-devel/2019-01/msg00268.html>.
2400 @quotation Note
2401 @cindex sudo vs. @command{guix pull}
2402 Note that @command{sudo guix} runs your user's @command{guix} command and
2403 @emph{not} root's, because @command{sudo} leaves @code{PATH} unchanged. To
2404 explicitly run root's @command{guix}, type @command{sudo -i guix @dots{}}.
2405 @end quotation
2406
2407 Join us on @code{#guix} on the Freenode IRC network or on
2408 @email{guix-devel@@gnu.org} to share your experience!
2409
2410
2411 @node Installing Guix in a VM
2412 @section Installing Guix in a Virtual Machine
2413
2414 @cindex virtual machine, Guix System installation
2415 @cindex virtual private server (VPS)
2416 @cindex VPS (virtual private server)
2417 If you'd like to install Guix System in a virtual machine (VM) or on a
2418 virtual private server (VPS) rather than on your beloved machine, this
2419 section is for you.
2420
2421 To boot a @uref{https://qemu.org/,QEMU} VM for installing Guix System in a
2422 disk image, follow these steps:
2423
2424 @enumerate
2425 @item
2426 First, retrieve and decompress the Guix system installation image as
2427 described previously (@pxref{USB Stick and DVD Installation}).
2428
2429 @item
2430 Create a disk image that will hold the installed system. To make a
2431 qcow2-formatted disk image, use the @command{qemu-img} command:
2432
2433 @example
2434 qemu-img create -f qcow2 guixsd.img 50G
2435 @end example
2436
2437 The resulting file will be much smaller than 50 GB (typically less than
2438 1 MB), but it will grow as the virtualized storage device is filled up.
2439
2440 @item
2441 Boot the USB installation image in an VM:
2442
2443 @example
2444 qemu-system-x86_64 -m 1024 -smp 1 -enable-kvm \
2445 -net user -net nic,model=virtio -boot menu=on \
2446 -drive file=guix-system-install-@value{VERSION}.@var{system}.iso \
2447 -drive file=guixsd.img
2448 @end example
2449
2450 The ordering of the drives matters. @code{-enable-kvm} is optional, but
2451 significantly improves performance, @pxref{Running Guix in a VM}.
2452
2453 In the VM console, quickly press the @kbd{F12} key to enter the boot
2454 menu. Then press the @kbd{2} key and the @kbd{RET} key to validate your
2455 selection.
2456
2457 @item
2458 You're now root in the VM, proceed with the installation process.
2459 @xref{Preparing for Installation}, and follow the instructions.
2460 @end enumerate
2461
2462 Once installation is complete, you can boot the system that's on your
2463 @file{guixsd.img} image. @xref{Running Guix in a VM}, for how to do
2464 that.
2465
2466 @node Building the Installation Image
2467 @section Building the Installation Image
2468
2469 @cindex installation image
2470 The installation image described above was built using the @command{guix
2471 system} command, specifically:
2472
2473 @example
2474 guix system disk-image --file-system-type=iso9660 \
2475 gnu/system/install.scm
2476 @end example
2477
2478 Have a look at @file{gnu/system/install.scm} in the source tree,
2479 and see also @ref{Invoking guix system} for more information
2480 about the installation image.
2481
2482 @section Building the Installation Image for ARM Boards
2483
2484 Many ARM boards require a specific variant of the
2485 @uref{https://www.denx.de/wiki/U-Boot/, U-Boot} bootloader.
2486
2487 If you build a disk image and the bootloader is not available otherwise
2488 (on another boot drive etc), it's advisable to build an image that
2489 includes the bootloader, specifically:
2490
2491 @example
2492 guix system disk-image --system=armhf-linux -e '((@@ (gnu system install) os-with-u-boot) (@@ (gnu system install) installation-os) "A20-OLinuXino-Lime2")'
2493 @end example
2494
2495 @code{A20-OLinuXino-Lime2} is the name of the board. If you specify an invalid
2496 board, a list of possible boards will be printed.
2497
2498 @c *********************************************************************
2499 @node Package Management
2500 @chapter Package Management
2501
2502 @cindex packages
2503 The purpose of GNU Guix is to allow users to easily install, upgrade, and
2504 remove software packages, without having to know about their build
2505 procedures or dependencies. Guix also goes beyond this obvious set of
2506 features.
2507
2508 This chapter describes the main features of Guix, as well as the
2509 package management tools it provides. Along with the command-line
2510 interface described below (@pxref{Invoking guix package, @code{guix
2511 package}}), you may also use the Emacs-Guix interface (@pxref{Top,,,
2512 emacs-guix, The Emacs-Guix Reference Manual}), after installing
2513 @code{emacs-guix} package (run @kbd{M-x guix-help} command to start
2514 with it):
2515
2516 @example
2517 guix install emacs-guix
2518 @end example
2519
2520 @menu
2521 * Features:: How Guix will make your life brighter.
2522 * Invoking guix package:: Package installation, removal, etc.
2523 * Substitutes:: Downloading pre-built binaries.
2524 * Packages with Multiple Outputs:: Single source package, multiple outputs.
2525 * Invoking guix gc:: Running the garbage collector.
2526 * Invoking guix pull:: Fetching the latest Guix and distribution.
2527 * Channels:: Customizing the package collection.
2528 * Inferiors:: Interacting with another revision of Guix.
2529 * Invoking guix describe:: Display information about your Guix revision.
2530 * Invoking guix archive:: Exporting and importing store files.
2531 @end menu
2532
2533 @node Features
2534 @section Features
2535
2536 When using Guix, each package ends up in the @dfn{package store}, in its
2537 own directory---something that resembles
2538 @file{/gnu/store/xxx-package-1.2}, where @code{xxx} is a base32 string.
2539
2540 Instead of referring to these directories, users have their own
2541 @dfn{profile}, which points to the packages that they actually want to
2542 use. These profiles are stored within each user's home directory, at
2543 @code{$HOME/.guix-profile}.
2544
2545 For example, @code{alice} installs GCC 4.7.2. As a result,
2546 @file{/home/alice/.guix-profile/bin/gcc} points to
2547 @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-gcc-4.7.2/bin/gcc}. Now, on the same machine,
2548 @code{bob} had already installed GCC 4.8.0. The profile of @code{bob}
2549 simply continues to point to
2550 @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-gcc-4.8.0/bin/gcc}---i.e., both versions of GCC
2551 coexist on the same system without any interference.
2552
2553 The @command{guix package} command is the central tool to manage
2554 packages (@pxref{Invoking guix package}). It operates on the per-user
2555 profiles, and can be used @emph{with normal user privileges}.
2556
2557 @cindex transactions
2558 The command provides the obvious install, remove, and upgrade
2559 operations. Each invocation is actually a @emph{transaction}: either
2560 the specified operation succeeds, or nothing happens. Thus, if the
2561 @command{guix package} process is terminated during the transaction,
2562 or if a power outage occurs during the transaction, then the user's
2563 profile remains in its previous state, and remains usable.
2564
2565 In addition, any package transaction may be @emph{rolled back}. So, if,
2566 for example, an upgrade installs a new version of a package that turns
2567 out to have a serious bug, users may roll back to the previous instance
2568 of their profile, which was known to work well. Similarly, the global
2569 system configuration on Guix is subject to
2570 transactional upgrades and roll-back
2571 (@pxref{Using the Configuration System}).
2572
2573 All packages in the package store may be @emph{garbage-collected}.
2574 Guix can determine which packages are still referenced by user
2575 profiles, and remove those that are provably no longer referenced
2576 (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}). Users may also explicitly remove old
2577 generations of their profile so that the packages they refer to can be
2578 collected.
2579
2580 @cindex reproducibility
2581 @cindex reproducible builds
2582 Guix takes a @dfn{purely functional} approach to package
2583 management, as described in the introduction (@pxref{Introduction}).
2584 Each @file{/gnu/store} package directory name contains a hash of all the
2585 inputs that were used to build that package---compiler, libraries, build
2586 scripts, etc. This direct correspondence allows users to make sure a
2587 given package installation matches the current state of their
2588 distribution. It also helps maximize @dfn{build reproducibility}:
2589 thanks to the isolated build environments that are used, a given build
2590 is likely to yield bit-identical files when performed on different
2591 machines (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon, container}).
2592
2593 @cindex substitutes
2594 This foundation allows Guix to support @dfn{transparent binary/source
2595 deployment}. When a pre-built binary for a @file{/gnu/store} item is
2596 available from an external source---a @dfn{substitute}, Guix just
2597 downloads it and unpacks it;
2598 otherwise, it builds the package from source, locally
2599 (@pxref{Substitutes}). Because build results are usually bit-for-bit
2600 reproducible, users do not have to trust servers that provide
2601 substitutes: they can force a local build and @emph{challenge} providers
2602 (@pxref{Invoking guix challenge}).
2603
2604 Control over the build environment is a feature that is also useful for
2605 developers. The @command{guix environment} command allows developers of
2606 a package to quickly set up the right development environment for their
2607 package, without having to manually install the dependencies of the
2608 package into their profile (@pxref{Invoking guix environment}).
2609
2610 @cindex replication, of software environments
2611 @cindex provenance tracking, of software artifacts
2612 All of Guix and its package definitions is version-controlled, and
2613 @command{guix pull} allows you to ``travel in time'' on the history of Guix
2614 itself (@pxref{Invoking guix pull}). This makes it possible to replicate a
2615 Guix instance on a different machine or at a later point in time, which in
2616 turn allows you to @emph{replicate complete software environments}, while
2617 retaining precise @dfn{provenance tracking} of the software.
2618
2619 @node Invoking guix package
2620 @section Invoking @command{guix package}
2621
2622 @cindex installing packages
2623 @cindex removing packages
2624 @cindex package installation
2625 @cindex package removal
2626 The @command{guix package} command is the tool that allows users to
2627 install, upgrade, and remove packages, as well as rolling back to
2628 previous configurations. It operates only on the user's own profile,
2629 and works with normal user privileges (@pxref{Features}). Its syntax
2630 is:
2631
2632 @example
2633 guix package @var{options}
2634 @end example
2635
2636 @cindex transactions
2637 Primarily, @var{options} specifies the operations to be performed during
2638 the transaction. Upon completion, a new profile is created, but
2639 previous @dfn{generations} of the profile remain available, should the user
2640 want to roll back.
2641
2642 For example, to remove @code{lua} and install @code{guile} and
2643 @code{guile-cairo} in a single transaction:
2644
2645 @example
2646 guix package -r lua -i guile guile-cairo
2647 @end example
2648
2649 @cindex aliases, for @command{guix package}
2650 For your convenience, we also provide the following aliases:
2651
2652 @itemize
2653 @item
2654 @command{guix search} is an alias for @command{guix package -s},
2655 @item
2656 @command{guix install} is an alias for @command{guix package -i},
2657 @item
2658 @command{guix remove} is an alias for @command{guix package -r},
2659 @item
2660 and @command{guix upgrade} is an alias for @command{guix package -u}.
2661 @end itemize
2662
2663 These aliases are less expressive than @command{guix package} and provide
2664 fewer options, so in some cases you'll probably want to use @command{guix
2665 package} directly.
2666
2667 @command{guix package} also supports a @dfn{declarative approach}
2668 whereby the user specifies the exact set of packages to be available and
2669 passes it @i{via} the @option{--manifest} option
2670 (@pxref{profile-manifest, @option{--manifest}}).
2671
2672 @cindex profile
2673 For each user, a symlink to the user's default profile is automatically
2674 created in @file{$HOME/.guix-profile}. This symlink always points to the
2675 current generation of the user's default profile. Thus, users can add
2676 @file{$HOME/.guix-profile/bin} to their @code{PATH} environment
2677 variable, and so on.
2678 @cindex search paths
2679 If you are not using Guix System, consider adding the
2680 following lines to your @file{~/.bash_profile} (@pxref{Bash Startup
2681 Files,,, bash, The GNU Bash Reference Manual}) so that newly-spawned
2682 shells get all the right environment variable definitions:
2683
2684 @example
2685 GUIX_PROFILE="$HOME/.guix-profile" ; \
2686 source "$HOME/.guix-profile/etc/profile"
2687 @end example
2688
2689 In a multi-user setup, user profiles are stored in a place registered as
2690 a @dfn{garbage-collector root}, which @file{$HOME/.guix-profile} points
2691 to (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}). That directory is normally
2692 @code{@var{localstatedir}/guix/profiles/per-user/@var{user}}, where
2693 @var{localstatedir} is the value passed to @code{configure} as
2694 @code{--localstatedir}, and @var{user} is the user name. The
2695 @file{per-user} directory is created when @command{guix-daemon} is
2696 started, and the @var{user} sub-directory is created by @command{guix
2697 package}.
2698
2699 The @var{options} can be among the following:
2700
2701 @table @code
2702
2703 @item --install=@var{package} @dots{}
2704 @itemx -i @var{package} @dots{}
2705 Install the specified @var{package}s.
2706
2707 Each @var{package} may specify either a simple package name, such as
2708 @code{guile}, or a package name followed by an at-sign and version number,
2709 such as @code{guile@@1.8.8} or simply @code{guile@@1.8} (in the latter
2710 case, the newest version prefixed by @code{1.8} is selected.)
2711
2712 If no version number is specified, the
2713 newest available version will be selected. In addition, @var{package}
2714 may contain a colon, followed by the name of one of the outputs of the
2715 package, as in @code{gcc:doc} or @code{binutils@@2.22:lib}
2716 (@pxref{Packages with Multiple Outputs}). Packages with a corresponding
2717 name (and optionally version) are searched for among the GNU
2718 distribution modules (@pxref{Package Modules}).
2719
2720 @cindex propagated inputs
2721 Sometimes packages have @dfn{propagated inputs}: these are dependencies
2722 that automatically get installed along with the required package
2723 (@pxref{package-propagated-inputs, @code{propagated-inputs} in
2724 @code{package} objects}, for information about propagated inputs in
2725 package definitions).
2726
2727 @anchor{package-cmd-propagated-inputs}
2728 An example is the GNU MPC library: its C header files refer to those of
2729 the GNU MPFR library, which in turn refer to those of the GMP library.
2730 Thus, when installing MPC, the MPFR and GMP libraries also get installed
2731 in the profile; removing MPC also removes MPFR and GMP---unless they had
2732 also been explicitly installed by the user.
2733
2734 Besides, packages sometimes rely on the definition of environment
2735 variables for their search paths (see explanation of
2736 @code{--search-paths} below). Any missing or possibly incorrect
2737 environment variable definitions are reported here.
2738
2739 @item --install-from-expression=@var{exp}
2740 @itemx -e @var{exp}
2741 Install the package @var{exp} evaluates to.
2742
2743 @var{exp} must be a Scheme expression that evaluates to a
2744 @code{<package>} object. This option is notably useful to disambiguate
2745 between same-named variants of a package, with expressions such as
2746 @code{(@@ (gnu packages base) guile-final)}.
2747
2748 Note that this option installs the first output of the specified
2749 package, which may be insufficient when needing a specific output of a
2750 multiple-output package.
2751
2752 @item --install-from-file=@var{file}
2753 @itemx -f @var{file}
2754 Install the package that the code within @var{file} evaluates to.
2755
2756 As an example, @var{file} might contain a definition like this
2757 (@pxref{Defining Packages}):
2758
2759 @lisp
2760 @verbatiminclude package-hello.scm
2761 @end lisp
2762
2763 Developers may find it useful to include such a @file{guix.scm} file
2764 in the root of their project source tree that can be used to test
2765 development snapshots and create reproducible development environments
2766 (@pxref{Invoking guix environment}).
2767
2768 @item --remove=@var{package} @dots{}
2769 @itemx -r @var{package} @dots{}
2770 Remove the specified @var{package}s.
2771
2772 As for @code{--install}, each @var{package} may specify a version number
2773 and/or output name in addition to the package name. For instance,
2774 @code{-r glibc:debug} would remove the @code{debug} output of
2775 @code{glibc}.
2776
2777 @item --upgrade[=@var{regexp} @dots{}]
2778 @itemx -u [@var{regexp} @dots{}]
2779 @cindex upgrading packages
2780 Upgrade all the installed packages. If one or more @var{regexp}s are
2781 specified, upgrade only installed packages whose name matches a
2782 @var{regexp}. Also see the @code{--do-not-upgrade} option below.
2783
2784 Note that this upgrades package to the latest version of packages found
2785 in the distribution currently installed. To update your distribution,
2786 you should regularly run @command{guix pull} (@pxref{Invoking guix
2787 pull}).
2788
2789 @item --do-not-upgrade[=@var{regexp} @dots{}]
2790 When used together with the @code{--upgrade} option, do @emph{not}
2791 upgrade any packages whose name matches a @var{regexp}. For example, to
2792 upgrade all packages in the current profile except those containing the
2793 substring ``emacs'':
2794
2795 @example
2796 $ guix package --upgrade . --do-not-upgrade emacs
2797 @end example
2798
2799 @item @anchor{profile-manifest}--manifest=@var{file}
2800 @itemx -m @var{file}
2801 @cindex profile declaration
2802 @cindex profile manifest
2803 Create a new generation of the profile from the manifest object
2804 returned by the Scheme code in @var{file}.
2805
2806 This allows you to @emph{declare} the profile's contents rather than
2807 constructing it through a sequence of @code{--install} and similar
2808 commands. The advantage is that @var{file} can be put under version
2809 control, copied to different machines to reproduce the same profile, and
2810 so on.
2811
2812 @c FIXME: Add reference to (guix profile) documentation when available.
2813 @var{file} must return a @dfn{manifest} object, which is roughly a list
2814 of packages:
2815
2816 @findex packages->manifest
2817 @lisp
2818 (use-package-modules guile emacs)
2819
2820 (packages->manifest
2821 (list emacs
2822 guile-2.0
2823 ;; Use a specific package output.
2824 (list guile-2.0 "debug")))
2825 @end lisp
2826
2827 @findex specifications->manifest
2828 In this example we have to know which modules define the @code{emacs}
2829 and @code{guile-2.0} variables to provide the right
2830 @code{use-package-modules} line, which can be cumbersome. We can
2831 instead provide regular package specifications and let
2832 @code{specifications->manifest} look up the corresponding package
2833 objects, like this:
2834
2835 @lisp
2836 (specifications->manifest
2837 '("emacs" "guile@@2.2" "guile@@2.2:debug"))
2838 @end lisp
2839
2840 @item --roll-back
2841 @cindex rolling back
2842 @cindex undoing transactions
2843 @cindex transactions, undoing
2844 Roll back to the previous @dfn{generation} of the profile---i.e., undo
2845 the last transaction.
2846
2847 When combined with options such as @code{--install}, roll back occurs
2848 before any other actions.
2849
2850 When rolling back from the first generation that actually contains
2851 installed packages, the profile is made to point to the @dfn{zeroth
2852 generation}, which contains no files apart from its own metadata.
2853
2854 After having rolled back, installing, removing, or upgrading packages
2855 overwrites previous future generations. Thus, the history of the
2856 generations in a profile is always linear.
2857
2858 @item --switch-generation=@var{pattern}
2859 @itemx -S @var{pattern}
2860 @cindex generations
2861 Switch to a particular generation defined by @var{pattern}.
2862
2863 @var{pattern} may be either a generation number or a number prefixed
2864 with ``+'' or ``-''. The latter means: move forward/backward by a
2865 specified number of generations. For example, if you want to return to
2866 the latest generation after @code{--roll-back}, use
2867 @code{--switch-generation=+1}.
2868
2869 The difference between @code{--roll-back} and
2870 @code{--switch-generation=-1} is that @code{--switch-generation} will
2871 not make a zeroth generation, so if a specified generation does not
2872 exist, the current generation will not be changed.
2873
2874 @item --search-paths[=@var{kind}]
2875 @cindex search paths
2876 Report environment variable definitions, in Bash syntax, that may be
2877 needed in order to use the set of installed packages. These environment
2878 variables are used to specify @dfn{search paths} for files used by some
2879 of the installed packages.
2880
2881 For example, GCC needs the @code{CPATH} and @code{LIBRARY_PATH}
2882 environment variables to be defined so it can look for headers and
2883 libraries in the user's profile (@pxref{Environment Variables,,, gcc,
2884 Using the GNU Compiler Collection (GCC)}). If GCC and, say, the C
2885 library are installed in the profile, then @code{--search-paths} will
2886 suggest setting these variables to @code{@var{profile}/include} and
2887 @code{@var{profile}/lib}, respectively.
2888
2889 The typical use case is to define these environment variables in the
2890 shell:
2891
2892 @example
2893 $ eval `guix package --search-paths`
2894 @end example
2895
2896 @var{kind} may be one of @code{exact}, @code{prefix}, or @code{suffix},
2897 meaning that the returned environment variable definitions will either
2898 be exact settings, or prefixes or suffixes of the current value of these
2899 variables. When omitted, @var{kind} defaults to @code{exact}.
2900
2901 This option can also be used to compute the @emph{combined} search paths
2902 of several profiles. Consider this example:
2903
2904 @example
2905 $ guix package -p foo -i guile
2906 $ guix package -p bar -i guile-json
2907 $ guix package -p foo -p bar --search-paths
2908 @end example
2909
2910 The last command above reports about the @code{GUILE_LOAD_PATH}
2911 variable, even though, taken individually, neither @file{foo} nor
2912 @file{bar} would lead to that recommendation.
2913
2914
2915 @item --profile=@var{profile}
2916 @itemx -p @var{profile}
2917 Use @var{profile} instead of the user's default profile.
2918
2919 @cindex collisions, in a profile
2920 @cindex colliding packages in profiles
2921 @cindex profile collisions
2922 @item --allow-collisions
2923 Allow colliding packages in the new profile. Use at your own risk!
2924
2925 By default, @command{guix package} reports as an error @dfn{collisions}
2926 in the profile. Collisions happen when two or more different versions
2927 or variants of a given package end up in the profile.
2928
2929 @item --bootstrap
2930 Use the bootstrap Guile to build the profile. This option is only
2931 useful to distribution developers.
2932
2933 @end table
2934
2935 In addition to these actions, @command{guix package} supports the
2936 following options to query the current state of a profile, or the
2937 availability of packages:
2938
2939 @table @option
2940
2941 @item --search=@var{regexp}
2942 @itemx -s @var{regexp}
2943 @cindex searching for packages
2944 List the available packages whose name, synopsis, or description matches
2945 @var{regexp} (in a case-insensitive fashion), sorted by relevance.
2946 Print all the metadata of matching packages in
2947 @code{recutils} format (@pxref{Top, GNU recutils databases,, recutils,
2948 GNU recutils manual}).
2949
2950 This allows specific fields to be extracted using the @command{recsel}
2951 command, for instance:
2952
2953 @example
2954 $ guix package -s malloc | recsel -p name,version,relevance
2955 name: jemalloc
2956 version: 4.5.0
2957 relevance: 6
2958
2959 name: glibc
2960 version: 2.25
2961 relevance: 1
2962
2963 name: libgc
2964 version: 7.6.0
2965 relevance: 1
2966 @end example
2967
2968 Similarly, to show the name of all the packages available under the
2969 terms of the GNU@tie{}LGPL version 3:
2970
2971 @example
2972 $ guix package -s "" | recsel -p name -e 'license ~ "LGPL 3"'
2973 name: elfutils
2974
2975 name: gmp
2976 @dots{}
2977 @end example
2978
2979 It is also possible to refine search results using several @code{-s} flags to
2980 @command{guix package}, or several arguments to @command{guix search}. For
2981 example, the following command returns a list of board games (this time using
2982 the @command{guix search} alias):
2983
2984 @example
2985 $ guix search '\<board\>' game | recsel -p name
2986 name: gnubg
2987 @dots{}
2988 @end example
2989
2990 If we were to omit @code{-s game}, we would also get software packages
2991 that deal with printed circuit boards; removing the angle brackets
2992 around @code{board} would further add packages that have to do with
2993 keyboards.
2994
2995 And now for a more elaborate example. The following command searches
2996 for cryptographic libraries, filters out Haskell, Perl, Python, and Ruby
2997 libraries, and prints the name and synopsis of the matching packages:
2998
2999 @example
3000 $ guix search crypto library | \
3001 recsel -e '! (name ~ "^(ghc|perl|python|ruby)")' -p name,synopsis
3002 @end example
3003
3004 @noindent
3005 @xref{Selection Expressions,,, recutils, GNU recutils manual}, for more
3006 information on @dfn{selection expressions} for @code{recsel -e}.
3007
3008 @item --show=@var{package}
3009 Show details about @var{package}, taken from the list of available packages, in
3010 @code{recutils} format (@pxref{Top, GNU recutils databases,, recutils, GNU
3011 recutils manual}).
3012
3013 @example
3014 $ guix package --show=python | recsel -p name,version
3015 name: python
3016 version: 2.7.6
3017
3018 name: python
3019 version: 3.3.5
3020 @end example
3021
3022 You may also specify the full name of a package to only get details about a
3023 specific version of it:
3024 @example
3025 $ guix package --show=python@@3.4 | recsel -p name,version
3026 name: python
3027 version: 3.4.3
3028 @end example
3029
3030
3031
3032 @item --list-installed[=@var{regexp}]
3033 @itemx -I [@var{regexp}]
3034 List the currently installed packages in the specified profile, with the
3035 most recently installed packages shown last. When @var{regexp} is
3036 specified, list only installed packages whose name matches @var{regexp}.
3037
3038 For each installed package, print the following items, separated by
3039 tabs: the package name, its version string, the part of the package that
3040 is installed (for instance, @code{out} for the default output,
3041 @code{include} for its headers, etc.), and the path of this package in
3042 the store.
3043
3044 @item --list-available[=@var{regexp}]
3045 @itemx -A [@var{regexp}]
3046 List packages currently available in the distribution for this system
3047 (@pxref{GNU Distribution}). When @var{regexp} is specified, list only
3048 installed packages whose name matches @var{regexp}.
3049
3050 For each package, print the following items separated by tabs: its name,
3051 its version string, the parts of the package (@pxref{Packages with
3052 Multiple Outputs}), and the source location of its definition.
3053
3054 @item --list-generations[=@var{pattern}]
3055 @itemx -l [@var{pattern}]
3056 @cindex generations
3057 Return a list of generations along with their creation dates; for each
3058 generation, show the installed packages, with the most recently
3059 installed packages shown last. Note that the zeroth generation is never
3060 shown.
3061
3062 For each installed package, print the following items, separated by
3063 tabs: the name of a package, its version string, the part of the package
3064 that is installed (@pxref{Packages with Multiple Outputs}), and the
3065 location of this package in the store.
3066
3067 When @var{pattern} is used, the command returns only matching
3068 generations. Valid patterns include:
3069
3070 @itemize
3071 @item @emph{Integers and comma-separated integers}. Both patterns denote
3072 generation numbers. For instance, @code{--list-generations=1} returns
3073 the first one.
3074
3075 And @code{--list-generations=1,8,2} outputs three generations in the
3076 specified order. Neither spaces nor trailing commas are allowed.
3077
3078 @item @emph{Ranges}. @code{--list-generations=2..9} prints the
3079 specified generations and everything in between. Note that the start of
3080 a range must be smaller than its end.
3081
3082 It is also possible to omit the endpoint. For example,
3083 @code{--list-generations=2..}, returns all generations starting from the
3084 second one.
3085
3086 @item @emph{Durations}. You can also get the last @emph{N}@tie{}days, weeks,
3087 or months by passing an integer along with the first letter of the
3088 duration. For example, @code{--list-generations=20d} lists generations
3089 that are up to 20 days old.
3090 @end itemize
3091
3092 @item --delete-generations[=@var{pattern}]
3093 @itemx -d [@var{pattern}]
3094 When @var{pattern} is omitted, delete all generations except the current
3095 one.
3096
3097 This command accepts the same patterns as @option{--list-generations}.
3098 When @var{pattern} is specified, delete the matching generations. When
3099 @var{pattern} specifies a duration, generations @emph{older} than the
3100 specified duration match. For instance, @code{--delete-generations=1m}
3101 deletes generations that are more than one month old.
3102
3103 If the current generation matches, it is @emph{not} deleted. Also, the
3104 zeroth generation is never deleted.
3105
3106 Note that deleting generations prevents rolling back to them.
3107 Consequently, this command must be used with care.
3108
3109 @end table
3110
3111 Finally, since @command{guix package} may actually start build
3112 processes, it supports all the common build options (@pxref{Common Build
3113 Options}). It also supports package transformation options, such as
3114 @option{--with-source} (@pxref{Package Transformation Options}).
3115 However, note that package transformations are lost when upgrading; to
3116 preserve transformations across upgrades, you should define your own
3117 package variant in a Guile module and add it to @code{GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH}
3118 (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
3119
3120 @node Substitutes
3121 @section Substitutes
3122
3123 @cindex substitutes
3124 @cindex pre-built binaries
3125 Guix supports transparent source/binary deployment, which means that it
3126 can either build things locally, or download pre-built items from a
3127 server, or both. We call these pre-built items @dfn{substitutes}---they
3128 are substitutes for local build results. In many cases, downloading a
3129 substitute is much faster than building things locally.
3130
3131 Substitutes can be anything resulting from a derivation build
3132 (@pxref{Derivations}). Of course, in the common case, they are
3133 pre-built package binaries, but source tarballs, for instance, which
3134 also result from derivation builds, can be available as substitutes.
3135
3136 @menu
3137 * Official Substitute Server:: One particular source of substitutes.
3138 * Substitute Server Authorization:: How to enable or disable substitutes.
3139 * Substitute Authentication:: How Guix verifies substitutes.
3140 * Proxy Settings:: How to get substitutes via proxy.
3141 * Substitution Failure:: What happens when substitution fails.
3142 * On Trusting Binaries:: How can you trust that binary blob?
3143 @end menu
3144
3145 @node Official Substitute Server
3146 @subsection Official Substitute Server
3147
3148 @cindex build farm
3149 The @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} server is a front-end to an official build farm
3150 that builds packages from Guix continuously for some
3151 architectures, and makes them available as substitutes. This is the
3152 default source of substitutes; it can be overridden by passing the
3153 @option{--substitute-urls} option either to @command{guix-daemon}
3154 (@pxref{daemon-substitute-urls,, @code{guix-daemon --substitute-urls}})
3155 or to client tools such as @command{guix package}
3156 (@pxref{client-substitute-urls,, client @option{--substitute-urls}
3157 option}).
3158
3159 Substitute URLs can be either HTTP or HTTPS.
3160 HTTPS is recommended because communications are encrypted; conversely,
3161 using HTTP makes all communications visible to an eavesdropper, who
3162 could use the information gathered to determine, for instance, whether
3163 your system has unpatched security vulnerabilities.
3164
3165 Substitutes from the official build farm are enabled by default when
3166 using Guix System (@pxref{GNU Distribution}). However,
3167 they are disabled by default when using Guix on a foreign distribution,
3168 unless you have explicitly enabled them via one of the recommended
3169 installation steps (@pxref{Installation}). The following paragraphs
3170 describe how to enable or disable substitutes for the official build
3171 farm; the same procedure can also be used to enable substitutes for any
3172 other substitute server.
3173
3174 @node Substitute Server Authorization
3175 @subsection Substitute Server Authorization
3176
3177 @cindex security
3178 @cindex substitutes, authorization thereof
3179 @cindex access control list (ACL), for substitutes
3180 @cindex ACL (access control list), for substitutes
3181 To allow Guix to download substitutes from @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} or a
3182 mirror thereof, you
3183 must add its public key to the access control list (ACL) of archive
3184 imports, using the @command{guix archive} command (@pxref{Invoking guix
3185 archive}). Doing so implies that you trust @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} to not
3186 be compromised and to serve genuine substitutes.
3187
3188 The public key for @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} is installed along with Guix, in
3189 @code{@var{prefix}/share/guix/@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}.pub}, where @var{prefix} is
3190 the installation prefix of Guix. If you installed Guix from source,
3191 make sure you checked the GPG signature of
3192 @file{guix-@value{VERSION}.tar.gz}, which contains this public key file.
3193 Then, you can run something like this:
3194
3195 @example
3196 # guix archive --authorize < @var{prefix}/share/guix/@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}.pub
3197 @end example
3198
3199 Once this is in place, the output of a command like @code{guix build}
3200 should change from something like:
3201
3202 @example
3203 $ guix build emacs --dry-run
3204 The following derivations would be built:
3205 /gnu/store/yr7bnx8xwcayd6j95r2clmkdl1qh688w-emacs-24.3.drv
3206 /gnu/store/x8qsh1hlhgjx6cwsjyvybnfv2i37z23w-dbus-1.6.4.tar.gz.drv
3207 /gnu/store/1ixwp12fl950d15h2cj11c73733jay0z-alsa-lib-1.0.27.1.tar.bz2.drv
3208 /gnu/store/nlma1pw0p603fpfiqy7kn4zm105r5dmw-util-linux-2.21.drv
3209 @dots{}
3210 @end example
3211
3212 @noindent
3213 to something like:
3214
3215 @example
3216 $ guix build emacs --dry-run
3217 112.3 MB would be downloaded:
3218 /gnu/store/pk3n22lbq6ydamyymqkkz7i69wiwjiwi-emacs-24.3
3219 /gnu/store/2ygn4ncnhrpr61rssa6z0d9x22si0va3-libjpeg-8d
3220 /gnu/store/71yz6lgx4dazma9dwn2mcjxaah9w77jq-cairo-1.12.16
3221 /gnu/store/7zdhgp0n1518lvfn8mb96sxqfmvqrl7v-libxrender-0.9.7
3222 @dots{}
3223 @end example
3224
3225 @noindent
3226 This indicates that substitutes from @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} are usable and
3227 will be downloaded, when possible, for future builds.
3228
3229 @cindex substitutes, how to disable
3230 The substitute mechanism can be disabled globally by running
3231 @code{guix-daemon} with @code{--no-substitutes} (@pxref{Invoking
3232 guix-daemon}). It can also be disabled temporarily by passing the
3233 @code{--no-substitutes} option to @command{guix package}, @command{guix
3234 build}, and other command-line tools.
3235
3236 @node Substitute Authentication
3237 @subsection Substitute Authentication
3238
3239 @cindex digital signatures
3240 Guix detects and raises an error when attempting to use a substitute
3241 that has been tampered with. Likewise, it ignores substitutes that are
3242 not signed, or that are not signed by one of the keys listed in the ACL.
3243
3244 There is one exception though: if an unauthorized server provides
3245 substitutes that are @emph{bit-for-bit identical} to those provided by
3246 an authorized server, then the unauthorized server becomes eligible for
3247 downloads. For example, assume we have chosen two substitute servers
3248 with this option:
3249
3250 @example
3251 --substitute-urls="https://a.example.org https://b.example.org"
3252 @end example
3253
3254 @noindent
3255 @cindex reproducible builds
3256 If the ACL contains only the key for @code{b.example.org}, and if
3257 @code{a.example.org} happens to serve the @emph{exact same} substitutes,
3258 then Guix will download substitutes from @code{a.example.org} because it
3259 comes first in the list and can be considered a mirror of
3260 @code{b.example.org}. In practice, independent build machines usually
3261 produce the same binaries, thanks to bit-reproducible builds (see
3262 below).
3263
3264 When using HTTPS, the server's X.509 certificate is @emph{not} validated
3265 (in other words, the server is not authenticated), contrary to what
3266 HTTPS clients such as Web browsers usually do. This is because Guix
3267 authenticates substitute information itself, as explained above, which
3268 is what we care about (whereas X.509 certificates are about
3269 authenticating bindings between domain names and public keys.)
3270
3271 @node Proxy Settings
3272 @subsection Proxy Settings
3273
3274 @vindex http_proxy
3275 Substitutes are downloaded over HTTP or HTTPS.
3276 The @code{http_proxy} environment
3277 variable can be set in the environment of @command{guix-daemon} and is
3278 honored for downloads of substitutes. Note that the value of
3279 @code{http_proxy} in the environment where @command{guix build},
3280 @command{guix package}, and other client commands are run has
3281 @emph{absolutely no effect}.
3282
3283 @node Substitution Failure
3284 @subsection Substitution Failure
3285
3286 Even when a substitute for a derivation is available, sometimes the
3287 substitution attempt will fail. This can happen for a variety of
3288 reasons: the substitute server might be offline, the substitute may
3289 recently have been deleted, the connection might have been interrupted,
3290 etc.
3291
3292 When substitutes are enabled and a substitute for a derivation is
3293 available, but the substitution attempt fails, Guix will attempt to
3294 build the derivation locally depending on whether or not
3295 @code{--fallback} was given (@pxref{fallback-option,, common build
3296 option @code{--fallback}}). Specifically, if @code{--fallback} was
3297 omitted, then no local build will be performed, and the derivation is
3298 considered to have failed. However, if @code{--fallback} was given,
3299 then Guix will attempt to build the derivation locally, and the success
3300 or failure of the derivation depends on the success or failure of the
3301 local build. Note that when substitutes are disabled or no substitute
3302 is available for the derivation in question, a local build will
3303 @emph{always} be performed, regardless of whether or not
3304 @code{--fallback} was given.
3305
3306 To get an idea of how many substitutes are available right now, you can
3307 try running the @command{guix weather} command (@pxref{Invoking guix
3308 weather}). This command provides statistics on the substitutes provided
3309 by a server.
3310
3311 @node On Trusting Binaries
3312 @subsection On Trusting Binaries
3313
3314 @cindex trust, of pre-built binaries
3315 Today, each individual's control over their own computing is at the
3316 mercy of institutions, corporations, and groups with enough power and
3317 determination to subvert the computing infrastructure and exploit its
3318 weaknesses. While using @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} substitutes can be
3319 convenient, we encourage users to also build on their own, or even run
3320 their own build farm, such that @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} is less of an
3321 interesting target. One way to help is by publishing the software you
3322 build using @command{guix publish} so that others have one more choice
3323 of server to download substitutes from (@pxref{Invoking guix publish}).
3324
3325 Guix has the foundations to maximize build reproducibility
3326 (@pxref{Features}). In most cases, independent builds of a given
3327 package or derivation should yield bit-identical results. Thus, through
3328 a diverse set of independent package builds, we can strengthen the
3329 integrity of our systems. The @command{guix challenge} command aims to
3330 help users assess substitute servers, and to assist developers in
3331 finding out about non-deterministic package builds (@pxref{Invoking guix
3332 challenge}). Similarly, the @option{--check} option of @command{guix
3333 build} allows users to check whether previously-installed substitutes
3334 are genuine by rebuilding them locally (@pxref{build-check,
3335 @command{guix build --check}}).
3336
3337 In the future, we want Guix to have support to publish and retrieve
3338 binaries to/from other users, in a peer-to-peer fashion. If you would
3339 like to discuss this project, join us on @email{guix-devel@@gnu.org}.
3340
3341 @node Packages with Multiple Outputs
3342 @section Packages with Multiple Outputs
3343
3344 @cindex multiple-output packages
3345 @cindex package outputs
3346 @cindex outputs
3347
3348 Often, packages defined in Guix have a single @dfn{output}---i.e., the
3349 source package leads to exactly one directory in the store. When running
3350 @command{guix install glibc}, one installs the default output of the
3351 GNU libc package; the default output is called @code{out}, but its name
3352 can be omitted as shown in this command. In this particular case, the
3353 default output of @code{glibc} contains all the C header files, shared
3354 libraries, static libraries, Info documentation, and other supporting
3355 files.
3356
3357 Sometimes it is more appropriate to separate the various types of files
3358 produced from a single source package into separate outputs. For
3359 instance, the GLib C library (used by GTK+ and related packages)
3360 installs more than 20 MiB of reference documentation as HTML pages.
3361 To save space for users who do not need it, the documentation goes to a
3362 separate output, called @code{doc}. To install the main GLib output,
3363 which contains everything but the documentation, one would run:
3364
3365 @example
3366 guix install glib
3367 @end example
3368
3369 @cindex documentation
3370 The command to install its documentation is:
3371
3372 @example
3373 guix install glib:doc
3374 @end example
3375
3376 Some packages install programs with different ``dependency footprints''.
3377 For instance, the WordNet package installs both command-line tools and
3378 graphical user interfaces (GUIs). The former depend solely on the C
3379 library, whereas the latter depend on Tcl/Tk and the underlying X
3380 libraries. In this case, we leave the command-line tools in the default
3381 output, whereas the GUIs are in a separate output. This allows users
3382 who do not need the GUIs to save space. The @command{guix size} command
3383 can help find out about such situations (@pxref{Invoking guix size}).
3384 @command{guix graph} can also be helpful (@pxref{Invoking guix graph}).
3385
3386 There are several such multiple-output packages in the GNU distribution.
3387 Other conventional output names include @code{lib} for libraries and
3388 possibly header files, @code{bin} for stand-alone programs, and
3389 @code{debug} for debugging information (@pxref{Installing Debugging
3390 Files}). The outputs of a packages are listed in the third column of
3391 the output of @command{guix package --list-available} (@pxref{Invoking
3392 guix package}).
3393
3394
3395 @node Invoking guix gc
3396 @section Invoking @command{guix gc}
3397
3398 @cindex garbage collector
3399 @cindex disk space
3400 Packages that are installed, but not used, may be @dfn{garbage-collected}.
3401 The @command{guix gc} command allows users to explicitly run the garbage
3402 collector to reclaim space from the @file{/gnu/store} directory. It is
3403 the @emph{only} way to remove files from @file{/gnu/store}---removing
3404 files or directories manually may break it beyond repair!
3405
3406 @cindex GC roots
3407 @cindex garbage collector roots
3408 The garbage collector has a set of known @dfn{roots}: any file under
3409 @file{/gnu/store} reachable from a root is considered @dfn{live} and
3410 cannot be deleted; any other file is considered @dfn{dead} and may be
3411 deleted. The set of garbage collector roots (``GC roots'' for short)
3412 includes default user profiles; by default, the symlinks under
3413 @file{/var/guix/gcroots} represent these GC roots. New GC roots can be
3414 added with @command{guix build --root}, for example (@pxref{Invoking
3415 guix build}). The @command{guix gc --list-roots} command lists them.
3416
3417 Prior to running @code{guix gc --collect-garbage} to make space, it is
3418 often useful to remove old generations from user profiles; that way, old
3419 package builds referenced by those generations can be reclaimed. This
3420 is achieved by running @code{guix package --delete-generations}
3421 (@pxref{Invoking guix package}).
3422
3423 Our recommendation is to run a garbage collection periodically, or when
3424 you are short on disk space. For instance, to guarantee that at least
3425 5@tie{}GB are available on your disk, simply run:
3426
3427 @example
3428 guix gc -F 5G
3429 @end example
3430
3431 It is perfectly safe to run as a non-interactive periodic job
3432 (@pxref{Scheduled Job Execution}, for how to set up such a job).
3433 Running @command{guix gc} with no arguments will collect as
3434 much garbage as it can, but that is often inconvenient: you may find
3435 yourself having to rebuild or re-download software that is ``dead'' from
3436 the GC viewpoint but that is necessary to build other pieces of
3437 software---e.g., the compiler tool chain.
3438
3439 The @command{guix gc} command has three modes of operation: it can be
3440 used to garbage-collect any dead files (the default), to delete specific
3441 files (the @code{--delete} option), to print garbage-collector
3442 information, or for more advanced queries. The garbage collection
3443 options are as follows:
3444
3445 @table @code
3446 @item --collect-garbage[=@var{min}]
3447 @itemx -C [@var{min}]
3448 Collect garbage---i.e., unreachable @file{/gnu/store} files and
3449 sub-directories. This is the default operation when no option is
3450 specified.
3451
3452 When @var{min} is given, stop once @var{min} bytes have been collected.
3453 @var{min} may be a number of bytes, or it may include a unit as a
3454 suffix, such as @code{MiB} for mebibytes and @code{GB} for gigabytes
3455 (@pxref{Block size, size specifications,, coreutils, GNU Coreutils}).
3456
3457 When @var{min} is omitted, collect all the garbage.
3458
3459 @item --free-space=@var{free}
3460 @itemx -F @var{free}
3461 Collect garbage until @var{free} space is available under
3462 @file{/gnu/store}, if possible; @var{free} denotes storage space, such
3463 as @code{500MiB}, as described above.
3464
3465 When @var{free} or more is already available in @file{/gnu/store}, do
3466 nothing and exit immediately.
3467
3468 @item --delete-generations[=@var{duration}]
3469 @itemx -d [@var{duration}]
3470 Before starting the garbage collection process, delete all the generations
3471 older than @var{duration}, for all the user profiles; when run as root, this
3472 applies to all the profiles @emph{of all the users}.
3473
3474 For example, this command deletes all the generations of all your profiles
3475 that are older than 2 months (except generations that are current), and then
3476 proceeds to free space until at least 10 GiB are available:
3477
3478 @example
3479 guix gc -d 2m -F 10G
3480 @end example
3481
3482 @item --delete
3483 @itemx -D
3484 Attempt to delete all the store files and directories specified as
3485 arguments. This fails if some of the files are not in the store, or if
3486 they are still live.
3487
3488 @item --list-failures
3489 List store items corresponding to cached build failures.
3490
3491 This prints nothing unless the daemon was started with
3492 @option{--cache-failures} (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon,
3493 @option{--cache-failures}}).
3494
3495 @item --list-roots
3496 List the GC roots owned by the user; when run as root, list @emph{all} the GC
3497 roots.
3498
3499 @item --list-busy
3500 List store items in use by currently running processes. These store
3501 items are effectively considered GC roots: they cannot be deleted.
3502
3503 @item --clear-failures
3504 Remove the specified store items from the failed-build cache.
3505
3506 Again, this option only makes sense when the daemon is started with
3507 @option{--cache-failures}. Otherwise, it does nothing.
3508
3509 @item --list-dead
3510 Show the list of dead files and directories still present in the
3511 store---i.e., files and directories no longer reachable from any root.
3512
3513 @item --list-live
3514 Show the list of live store files and directories.
3515
3516 @end table
3517
3518 In addition, the references among existing store files can be queried:
3519
3520 @table @code
3521
3522 @item --references
3523 @itemx --referrers
3524 @cindex package dependencies
3525 List the references (respectively, the referrers) of store files given
3526 as arguments.
3527
3528 @item --requisites
3529 @itemx -R
3530 @cindex closure
3531 List the requisites of the store files passed as arguments. Requisites
3532 include the store files themselves, their references, and the references
3533 of these, recursively. In other words, the returned list is the
3534 @dfn{transitive closure} of the store files.
3535
3536 @xref{Invoking guix size}, for a tool to profile the size of the closure
3537 of an element. @xref{Invoking guix graph}, for a tool to visualize
3538 the graph of references.
3539
3540 @item --derivers
3541 @cindex derivation
3542 Return the derivation(s) leading to the given store items
3543 (@pxref{Derivations}).
3544
3545 For example, this command:
3546
3547 @example
3548 guix gc --derivers `guix package -I ^emacs$ | cut -f4`
3549 @end example
3550
3551 @noindent
3552 returns the @file{.drv} file(s) leading to the @code{emacs} package
3553 installed in your profile.
3554
3555 Note that there may be zero matching @file{.drv} files, for instance
3556 because these files have been garbage-collected. There can also be more
3557 than one matching @file{.drv} due to fixed-output derivations.
3558 @end table
3559
3560 Lastly, the following options allow you to check the integrity of the
3561 store and to control disk usage.
3562
3563 @table @option
3564
3565 @item --verify[=@var{options}]
3566 @cindex integrity, of the store
3567 @cindex integrity checking
3568 Verify the integrity of the store.
3569
3570 By default, make sure that all the store items marked as valid in the
3571 database of the daemon actually exist in @file{/gnu/store}.
3572
3573 When provided, @var{options} must be a comma-separated list containing one
3574 or more of @code{contents} and @code{repair}.
3575
3576 When passing @option{--verify=contents}, the daemon computes the
3577 content hash of each store item and compares it against its hash in the
3578 database. Hash mismatches are reported as data corruptions. Because it
3579 traverses @emph{all the files in the store}, this command can take a
3580 long time, especially on systems with a slow disk drive.
3581
3582 @cindex repairing the store
3583 @cindex corruption, recovering from
3584 Using @option{--verify=repair} or @option{--verify=contents,repair}
3585 causes the daemon to try to repair corrupt store items by fetching
3586 substitutes for them (@pxref{Substitutes}). Because repairing is not
3587 atomic, and thus potentially dangerous, it is available only to the
3588 system administrator. A lightweight alternative, when you know exactly
3589 which items in the store are corrupt, is @command{guix build --repair}
3590 (@pxref{Invoking guix build}).
3591
3592 @item --optimize
3593 @cindex deduplication
3594 Optimize the store by hard-linking identical files---this is
3595 @dfn{deduplication}.
3596
3597 The daemon performs deduplication after each successful build or archive
3598 import, unless it was started with @code{--disable-deduplication}
3599 (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon, @code{--disable-deduplication}}). Thus,
3600 this option is primarily useful when the daemon was running with
3601 @code{--disable-deduplication}.
3602
3603 @end table
3604
3605 @node Invoking guix pull
3606 @section Invoking @command{guix pull}
3607
3608 @cindex upgrading Guix
3609 @cindex updating Guix
3610 @cindex @command{guix pull}
3611 @cindex pull
3612 Packages are installed or upgraded to the latest version available in
3613 the distribution currently available on your local machine. To update
3614 that distribution, along with the Guix tools, you must run @command{guix
3615 pull}: the command downloads the latest Guix source code and package
3616 descriptions, and deploys it. Source code is downloaded from a
3617 @uref{https://git-scm.com, Git} repository, by default the official
3618 GNU@tie{}Guix repository, though this can be customized.
3619
3620 On completion, @command{guix package} will use packages and package
3621 versions from this just-retrieved copy of Guix. Not only that, but all
3622 the Guix commands and Scheme modules will also be taken from that latest
3623 version. New @command{guix} sub-commands added by the update also
3624 become available.
3625
3626 Any user can update their Guix copy using @command{guix pull}, and the
3627 effect is limited to the user who ran @command{guix pull}. For
3628 instance, when user @code{root} runs @command{guix pull}, this has no
3629 effect on the version of Guix that user @code{alice} sees, and vice
3630 versa.
3631
3632 The result of running @command{guix pull} is a @dfn{profile} available
3633 under @file{~/.config/guix/current} containing the latest Guix. Thus,
3634 make sure to add it to the beginning of your search path so that you use
3635 the latest version, and similarly for the Info manual
3636 (@pxref{Documentation}):
3637
3638 @example
3639 export PATH="$HOME/.config/guix/current/bin:$PATH"
3640 export INFOPATH="$HOME/.config/guix/current/share/info:$INFOPATH"
3641 @end example
3642
3643 The @code{--list-generations} or @code{-l} option lists past generations
3644 produced by @command{guix pull}, along with details about their provenance:
3645
3646 @example
3647 $ guix pull -l
3648 Generation 1 Jun 10 2018 00:18:18
3649 guix 65956ad
3650 repository URL: https://git.savannah.gnu.org/git/guix.git
3651 branch: origin/master
3652 commit: 65956ad3526ba09e1f7a40722c96c6ef7c0936fe
3653
3654 Generation 2 Jun 11 2018 11:02:49
3655 guix e0cc7f6
3656 repository URL: https://git.savannah.gnu.org/git/guix.git
3657 branch: origin/master
3658 commit: e0cc7f669bec22c37481dd03a7941c7d11a64f1d
3659 2 new packages: keepalived, libnfnetlink
3660 6 packages upgraded: emacs-nix-mode@@2.0.4,
3661 guile2.0-guix@@0.14.0-12.77a1aac, guix@@0.14.0-12.77a1aac,
3662 heimdal@@7.5.0, milkytracker@@1.02.00, nix@@2.0.4
3663
3664 Generation 3 Jun 13 2018 23:31:07 (current)
3665 guix 844cc1c
3666 repository URL: https://git.savannah.gnu.org/git/guix.git
3667 branch: origin/master
3668 commit: 844cc1c8f394f03b404c5bb3aee086922373490c
3669 28 new packages: emacs-helm-ls-git, emacs-helm-mu, @dots{}
3670 69 packages upgraded: borg@@1.1.6, cheese@@3.28.0, @dots{}
3671 @end example
3672
3673 @xref{Invoking guix describe, @command{guix describe}}, for other ways to
3674 describe the current status of Guix.
3675
3676 This @code{~/.config/guix/current} profile works like any other profile
3677 created by @command{guix package} (@pxref{Invoking guix package}). That
3678 is, you can list generations, roll back to the previous
3679 generation---i.e., the previous Guix---and so on:
3680
3681 @example
3682 $ guix package -p ~/.config/guix/current --roll-back
3683 switched from generation 3 to 2
3684 $ guix package -p ~/.config/guix/current --delete-generations=1
3685 deleting /var/guix/profiles/per-user/charlie/current-guix-1-link
3686 @end example
3687
3688 The @command{guix pull} command is usually invoked with no arguments,
3689 but it supports the following options:
3690
3691 @table @code
3692 @item --url=@var{url}
3693 @itemx --commit=@var{commit}
3694 @itemx --branch=@var{branch}
3695 Download code for the @code{guix} channel from the specified @var{url}, at the
3696 given @var{commit} (a valid Git commit ID represented as a hexadecimal
3697 string), or @var{branch}.
3698
3699 @cindex @file{channels.scm}, configuration file
3700 @cindex configuration file for channels
3701 These options are provided for convenience, but you can also specify your
3702 configuration in the @file{~/.config/guix/channels.scm} file or using the
3703 @option{--channels} option (see below).
3704
3705 @item --channels=@var{file}
3706 @itemx -C @var{file}
3707 Read the list of channels from @var{file} instead of
3708 @file{~/.config/guix/channels.scm}. @var{file} must contain Scheme code that
3709 evaluates to a list of channel objects. @xref{Channels}, for more
3710 information.
3711
3712 @item --news
3713 @itemx -N
3714 Display the list of packages added or upgraded since the previous generation.
3715
3716 This is the same information as displayed upon @command{guix pull} completion,
3717 but without ellipses; it is also similar to the output of @command{guix pull
3718 -l} for the last generation (see below).
3719
3720 @item --list-generations[=@var{pattern}]
3721 @itemx -l [@var{pattern}]
3722 List all the generations of @file{~/.config/guix/current} or, if @var{pattern}
3723 is provided, the subset of generations that match @var{pattern}.
3724 The syntax of @var{pattern} is the same as with @code{guix package
3725 --list-generations} (@pxref{Invoking guix package}).
3726
3727 @xref{Invoking guix describe}, for a way to display information about the
3728 current generation only.
3729
3730 @item --profile=@var{profile}
3731 @itemx -p @var{profile}
3732 Use @var{profile} instead of @file{~/.config/guix/current}.
3733
3734 @item --dry-run
3735 @itemx -n
3736 Show which channel commit(s) would be used and what would be built or
3737 substituted but do not actually do it.
3738
3739 @item --system=@var{system}
3740 @itemx -s @var{system}
3741 Attempt to build for @var{system}---e.g., @code{i686-linux}---instead of
3742 the system type of the build host.
3743
3744 @item --verbose
3745 Produce verbose output, writing build logs to the standard error output.
3746
3747 @item --bootstrap
3748 Use the bootstrap Guile to build the latest Guix. This option is only
3749 useful to Guix developers.
3750 @end table
3751
3752 The @dfn{channel} mechanism allows you to instruct @command{guix pull} which
3753 repository and branch to pull from, as well as @emph{additional} repositories
3754 containing package modules that should be deployed. @xref{Channels}, for more
3755 information.
3756
3757 In addition, @command{guix pull} supports all the common build options
3758 (@pxref{Common Build Options}).
3759
3760 @node Channels
3761 @section Channels
3762
3763 @cindex channels
3764 @cindex @file{channels.scm}, configuration file
3765 @cindex configuration file for channels
3766 @cindex @command{guix pull}, configuration file
3767 @cindex configuration of @command{guix pull}
3768 Guix and its package collection are updated by running @command{guix pull}
3769 (@pxref{Invoking guix pull}). By default @command{guix pull} downloads and
3770 deploys Guix itself from the official GNU@tie{}Guix repository. This can be
3771 customized by defining @dfn{channels} in the
3772 @file{~/.config/guix/channels.scm} file. A channel specifies a URL and branch
3773 of a Git repository to be deployed, and @command{guix pull} can be instructed
3774 to pull from one or more channels. In other words, channels can be used to
3775 @emph{customize} and to @emph{extend} Guix, as we will see below.
3776
3777 @subsection Using a Custom Guix Channel
3778
3779 The channel called @code{guix} specifies where Guix itself---its command-line
3780 tools as well as its package collection---should be downloaded. For instance,
3781 suppose you want to update from your own copy of the Guix repository at
3782 @code{example.org}, and specifically the @code{super-hacks} branch, you can
3783 write in @code{~/.config/guix/channels.scm} this specification:
3784
3785 @lisp
3786 ;; Tell 'guix pull' to use my own repo.
3787 (list (channel
3788 (name 'guix)
3789 (url "https://example.org/my-guix.git")
3790 (branch "super-hacks")))
3791 @end lisp
3792
3793 @noindent
3794 From there on, @command{guix pull} will fetch code from the @code{super-hacks}
3795 branch of the repository at @code{example.org}.
3796
3797 @subsection Specifying Additional Channels
3798
3799 @cindex extending the package collection (channels)
3800 @cindex personal packages (channels)
3801 @cindex channels, for personal packages
3802 You can also specify @emph{additional channels} to pull from. Let's say you
3803 have a bunch of custom package variants or personal packages that you think
3804 would make little sense to contribute to the Guix project, but would like to
3805 have these packages transparently available to you at the command line. You
3806 would first write modules containing those package definitions (@pxref{Package
3807 Modules}), maintain them in a Git repository, and then you and anyone else can
3808 use it as an additional channel to get packages from. Neat, no?
3809
3810 @c What follows stems from discussions at
3811 @c <https://debbugs.gnu.org/cgi/bugreport.cgi?bug=22629#134> as well as
3812 @c earlier discussions on guix-devel@gnu.org.
3813 @quotation Warning
3814 Before you, dear user, shout---``woow this is @emph{soooo coool}!''---and
3815 publish your personal channel to the world, we would like to share a few words
3816 of caution:
3817
3818 @itemize
3819 @item
3820 Before publishing a channel, please consider contributing your package
3821 definitions to Guix proper (@pxref{Contributing}). Guix as a project is open
3822 to free software of all sorts, and packages in Guix proper are readily
3823 available to all Guix users and benefit from the project's quality assurance
3824 process.
3825
3826 @item
3827 When you maintain package definitions outside Guix, we, Guix developers,
3828 consider that @emph{the compatibility burden is on you}. Remember that
3829 package modules and package definitions are just Scheme code that uses various
3830 programming interfaces (APIs). We want to remain free to change these APIs to
3831 keep improving Guix, possibly in ways that break your channel. We never
3832 change APIs gratuitously, but we will @emph{not} commit to freezing APIs
3833 either.
3834
3835 @item
3836 Corollary: if you're using an external channel and that channel breaks, please
3837 @emph{report the issue to the channel authors}, not to the Guix project.
3838 @end itemize
3839
3840 You've been warned! Having said this, we believe external channels are a
3841 practical way to exert your freedom to augment Guix' package collection and to
3842 share your improvements, which are basic tenets of
3843 @uref{https://www.gnu.org/philosophy/free-sw.html, free software}. Please
3844 email us at @email{guix-devel@@gnu.org} if you'd like to discuss this.
3845 @end quotation
3846
3847 To use a channel, write @code{~/.config/guix/channels.scm} to instruct
3848 @command{guix pull} to pull from it @emph{in addition} to the default Guix
3849 channel(s):
3850
3851 @vindex %default-channels
3852 @lisp
3853 ;; Add my personal packages to those Guix provides.
3854 (cons (channel
3855 (name 'my-personal-packages)
3856 (url "https://example.org/personal-packages.git"))
3857 %default-channels)
3858 @end lisp
3859
3860 @noindent
3861 Note that the snippet above is (as always!)@: Scheme code; we use @code{cons} to
3862 add a channel the list of channels that the variable @code{%default-channels}
3863 is bound to (@pxref{Pairs, @code{cons} and lists,, guile, GNU Guile Reference
3864 Manual}). With this file in place, @command{guix pull} builds not only Guix
3865 but also the package modules from your own repository. The result in
3866 @file{~/.config/guix/current} is the union of Guix with your own package
3867 modules:
3868
3869 @example
3870 $ guix pull --list-generations
3871 @dots{}
3872 Generation 19 Aug 27 2018 16:20:48
3873 guix d894ab8
3874 repository URL: https://git.savannah.gnu.org/git/guix.git
3875 branch: master
3876 commit: d894ab8e9bfabcefa6c49d9ba2e834dd5a73a300
3877 my-personal-packages dd3df5e
3878 repository URL: https://example.org/personal-packages.git
3879 branch: master
3880 commit: dd3df5e2c8818760a8fc0bd699e55d3b69fef2bb
3881 11 new packages: my-gimp, my-emacs-with-cool-features, @dots{}
3882 4 packages upgraded: emacs-racket-mode@@0.0.2-2.1b78827, @dots{}
3883 @end example
3884
3885 @noindent
3886 The output of @command{guix pull} above shows that Generation@tie{}19 includes
3887 both Guix and packages from the @code{my-personal-packages} channel. Among
3888 the new and upgraded packages that are listed, some like @code{my-gimp} and
3889 @code{my-emacs-with-cool-features} might come from
3890 @code{my-personal-packages}, while others come from the Guix default channel.
3891
3892 To create a channel, create a Git repository containing your own package
3893 modules and make it available. The repository can contain anything, but a
3894 useful channel will contain Guile modules that export packages. Once you
3895 start using a channel, Guix will behave as if the root directory of that
3896 channel's Git repository has been added to the Guile load path (@pxref{Load
3897 Paths,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}). For example, if your channel
3898 contains a file at @file{my-packages/my-tools.scm} that defines a Guile
3899 module, then the module will be available under the name @code{(my-packages
3900 my-tools)}, and you will be able to use it like any other module
3901 (@pxref{Modules,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}).
3902
3903 @cindex dependencies, channels
3904 @cindex meta-data, channels
3905 @subsection Declaring Channel Dependencies
3906
3907 Channel authors may decide to augment a package collection provided by other
3908 channels. They can declare their channel to be dependent on other channels in
3909 a meta-data file @file{.guix-channel}, which is to be placed in the root of
3910 the channel repository.
3911
3912 The meta-data file should contain a simple S-expression like this:
3913
3914 @lisp
3915 (channel
3916 (version 0)
3917 (dependencies
3918 (channel
3919 (name some-collection)
3920 (url "https://example.org/first-collection.git"))
3921 (channel
3922 (name some-other-collection)
3923 (url "https://example.org/second-collection.git")
3924 (branch "testing"))))
3925 @end lisp
3926
3927 In the above example this channel is declared to depend on two other channels,
3928 which will both be fetched automatically. The modules provided by the channel
3929 will be compiled in an environment where the modules of all these declared
3930 channels are available.
3931
3932 For the sake of reliability and maintainability, you should avoid dependencies
3933 on channels that you don't control, and you should aim to keep the number of
3934 dependencies to a minimum.
3935
3936 @cindex subdirectory, channels
3937 @subsection Package Modules in a Sub-directory
3938
3939 As a channel author, you may want to keep your channel modules in a
3940 sub-directory. If your modules are in the sub-directory @file{guix}, you must
3941 add a meta-data file @file{.guix-channel} that contains:
3942
3943 @lisp
3944 (channel
3945 (version 0)
3946 (directory "guix"))
3947 @end lisp
3948
3949 @subsection Replicating Guix
3950
3951 @cindex pinning, channels
3952 @cindex replicating Guix
3953 @cindex reproducibility, of Guix
3954 The @command{guix pull --list-generations} output above shows precisely which
3955 commits were used to build this instance of Guix. We can thus replicate it,
3956 say, on another machine, by providing a channel specification in
3957 @file{~/.config/guix/channels.scm} that is ``pinned'' to these commits:
3958
3959 @lisp
3960 ;; Deploy specific commits of my channels of interest.
3961 (list (channel
3962 (name 'guix)
3963 (url "https://git.savannah.gnu.org/git/guix.git")
3964 (commit "d894ab8e9bfabcefa6c49d9ba2e834dd5a73a300"))
3965 (channel
3966 (name 'my-personal-packages)
3967 (url "https://example.org/personal-packages.git")
3968 (branch "dd3df5e2c8818760a8fc0bd699e55d3b69fef2bb")))
3969 @end lisp
3970
3971 The @command{guix describe --format=channels} command can even generate this
3972 list of channels directly (@pxref{Invoking guix describe}).
3973
3974 At this point the two machines run the @emph{exact same Guix}, with access to
3975 the @emph{exact same packages}. The output of @command{guix build gimp} on
3976 one machine will be exactly the same, bit for bit, as the output of the same
3977 command on the other machine. It also means both machines have access to all
3978 the source code of Guix and, transitively, to all the source code of every
3979 package it defines.
3980
3981 This gives you super powers, allowing you to track the provenance of binary
3982 artifacts with very fine grain, and to reproduce software environments at
3983 will---some sort of ``meta reproducibility'' capabilities, if you will.
3984 @xref{Inferiors}, for another way to take advantage of these super powers.
3985
3986 @node Inferiors
3987 @section Inferiors
3988
3989 @c TODO: Remove this once we're more confident about API stability.
3990 @quotation Note
3991 The functionality described here is a ``technology preview'' as of version
3992 @value{VERSION}. As such, the interface is subject to change.
3993 @end quotation
3994
3995 @cindex inferiors
3996 @cindex composition of Guix revisions
3997 Sometimes you might need to mix packages from the revision of Guix you're
3998 currently running with packages available in a different revision of Guix.
3999 Guix @dfn{inferiors} allow you to achieve that by composing different Guix
4000 revisions in arbitrary ways.
4001
4002 @cindex inferior packages
4003 Technically, an ``inferior'' is essentially a separate Guix process connected
4004 to your main Guix process through a REPL (@pxref{Invoking guix repl}). The
4005 @code{(guix inferior)} module allows you to create inferiors and to
4006 communicate with them. It also provides a high-level interface to browse and
4007 manipulate the packages that an inferior provides---@dfn{inferior packages}.
4008
4009 When combined with channels (@pxref{Channels}), inferiors provide a simple way
4010 to interact with a separate revision of Guix. For example, let's assume you
4011 want to install in your profile the current @code{guile} package, along with
4012 the @code{guile-json} as it existed in an older revision of Guix---perhaps
4013 because the newer @code{guile-json} has an incompatible API and you want to
4014 run your code against the old API@. To do that, you could write a manifest for
4015 use by @code{guix package --manifest} (@pxref{Invoking guix package}); in that
4016 manifest, you would create an inferior for that old Guix revision you care
4017 about, and you would look up the @code{guile-json} package in the inferior:
4018
4019 @lisp
4020 (use-modules (guix inferior) (guix channels)
4021 (srfi srfi-1)) ;for 'first'
4022
4023 (define channels
4024 ;; This is the old revision from which we want to
4025 ;; extract guile-json.
4026 (list (channel
4027 (name 'guix)
4028 (url "https://git.savannah.gnu.org/git/guix.git")
4029 (commit
4030 "65956ad3526ba09e1f7a40722c96c6ef7c0936fe"))))
4031
4032 (define inferior
4033 ;; An inferior representing the above revision.
4034 (inferior-for-channels channels))
4035
4036 ;; Now create a manifest with the current "guile" package
4037 ;; and the old "guile-json" package.
4038 (packages->manifest
4039 (list (first (lookup-inferior-packages inferior "guile-json"))
4040 (specification->package "guile")))
4041 @end lisp
4042
4043 On its first run, @command{guix package --manifest} might have to build the
4044 channel you specified before it can create the inferior; subsequent runs will
4045 be much faster because the Guix revision will be cached.
4046
4047 The @code{(guix inferior)} module provides the following procedures to open an
4048 inferior:
4049
4050 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} inferior-for-channels @var{channels} @
4051 [#:cache-directory] [#:ttl]
4052 Return an inferior for @var{channels}, a list of channels. Use the cache at
4053 @var{cache-directory}, where entries can be reclaimed after @var{ttl} seconds.
4054 This procedure opens a new connection to the build daemon.
4055
4056 As a side effect, this procedure may build or substitute binaries for
4057 @var{channels}, which can take time.
4058 @end deffn
4059
4060 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} open-inferior @var{directory} @
4061 [#:command "bin/guix"]
4062 Open the inferior Guix in @var{directory}, running
4063 @code{@var{directory}/@var{command} repl} or equivalent. Return @code{#f} if
4064 the inferior could not be launched.
4065 @end deffn
4066
4067 @cindex inferior packages
4068 The procedures listed below allow you to obtain and manipulate inferior
4069 packages.
4070
4071 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} inferior-packages @var{inferior}
4072 Return the list of packages known to @var{inferior}.
4073 @end deffn
4074
4075 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} lookup-inferior-packages @var{inferior} @var{name} @
4076 [@var{version}]
4077 Return the sorted list of inferior packages matching @var{name} in
4078 @var{inferior}, with highest version numbers first. If @var{version} is true,
4079 return only packages with a version number prefixed by @var{version}.
4080 @end deffn
4081
4082 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package? @var{obj}
4083 Return true if @var{obj} is an inferior package.
4084 @end deffn
4085
4086 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-name @var{package}
4087 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-version @var{package}
4088 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-synopsis @var{package}
4089 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-description @var{package}
4090 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-home-page @var{package}
4091 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-location @var{package}
4092 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-inputs @var{package}
4093 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-native-inputs @var{package}
4094 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-propagated-inputs @var{package}
4095 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-transitive-propagated-inputs @var{package}
4096 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-native-search-paths @var{package}
4097 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-transitive-native-search-paths @var{package}
4098 @deffnx {Scheme Procedure} inferior-package-search-paths @var{package}
4099 These procedures are the counterpart of package record accessors
4100 (@pxref{package Reference}). Most of them work by querying the inferior
4101 @var{package} comes from, so the inferior must still be live when you call
4102 these procedures.
4103 @end deffn
4104
4105 Inferior packages can be used transparently like any other package or
4106 file-like object in G-expressions (@pxref{G-Expressions}). They are also
4107 transparently handled by the @code{packages->manifest} procedure, which is
4108 commonly use in manifests (@pxref{Invoking guix package, the
4109 @option{--manifest} option of @command{guix package}}). Thus you can insert
4110 an inferior package pretty much anywhere you would insert a regular package:
4111 in manifests, in the @code{packages} field of your @code{operating-system}
4112 declaration, and so on.
4113
4114 @node Invoking guix describe
4115 @section Invoking @command{guix describe}
4116
4117 @cindex reproducibility
4118 @cindex replicating Guix
4119 Often you may want to answer questions like: ``Which revision of Guix am I
4120 using?'' or ``Which channels am I using?'' This is useful information in many
4121 situations: if you want to @emph{replicate} an environment on a different
4122 machine or user account, if you want to report a bug or to determine what
4123 change in the channels you are using caused it, or if you want to record your
4124 system state for reproducibility purposes. The @command{guix describe}
4125 command answers these questions.
4126
4127 When run from a @command{guix pull}ed @command{guix}, @command{guix describe}
4128 displays the channel(s) that it was built from, including their repository URL
4129 and commit IDs (@pxref{Channels}):
4130
4131 @example
4132 $ guix describe
4133 Generation 10 Sep 03 2018 17:32:44 (current)
4134 guix e0fa68c
4135 repository URL: https://git.savannah.gnu.org/git/guix.git
4136 branch: master
4137 commit: e0fa68c7718fffd33d81af415279d6ddb518f727
4138 @end example
4139
4140 If you're familiar with the Git version control system, this is similar in
4141 spirit to @command{git describe}; the output is also similar to that of
4142 @command{guix pull --list-generations}, but limited to the current generation
4143 (@pxref{Invoking guix pull, the @option{--list-generations} option}). Because
4144 the Git commit ID shown above unambiguously refers to a snapshot of Guix, this
4145 information is all it takes to describe the revision of Guix you're using, and
4146 also to replicate it.
4147
4148 To make it easier to replicate Guix, @command{guix describe} can also be asked
4149 to return a list of channels instead of the human-readable description above:
4150
4151 @example
4152 $ guix describe -f channels
4153 (list (channel
4154 (name 'guix)
4155 (url "https://git.savannah.gnu.org/git/guix.git")
4156 (commit
4157 "e0fa68c7718fffd33d81af415279d6ddb518f727")))
4158 @end example
4159
4160 @noindent
4161 You can save this to a file and feed it to @command{guix pull -C} on some
4162 other machine or at a later point in time, which will instantiate @emph{this
4163 exact Guix revision} (@pxref{Invoking guix pull, the @option{-C} option}).
4164 From there on, since you're able to deploy the same revision of Guix, you can
4165 just as well @emph{replicate a complete software environment}. We humbly
4166 think that this is @emph{awesome}, and we hope you'll like it too!
4167
4168 The details of the options supported by @command{guix describe} are as
4169 follows:
4170
4171 @table @code
4172 @item --format=@var{format}
4173 @itemx -f @var{format}
4174 Produce output in the specified @var{format}, one of:
4175
4176 @table @code
4177 @item human
4178 produce human-readable output;
4179 @item channels
4180 produce a list of channel specifications that can be passed to @command{guix
4181 pull -C} or installed as @file{~/.config/guix/channels.scm} (@pxref{Invoking
4182 guix pull});
4183 @item json
4184 @cindex JSON
4185 produce a list of channel specifications in JSON format;
4186 @item recutils
4187 produce a list of channel specifications in Recutils format.
4188 @end table
4189
4190 @item --profile=@var{profile}
4191 @itemx -p @var{profile}
4192 Display information about @var{profile}.
4193 @end table
4194
4195 @node Invoking guix archive
4196 @section Invoking @command{guix archive}
4197
4198 @cindex @command{guix archive}
4199 @cindex archive
4200 The @command{guix archive} command allows users to @dfn{export} files
4201 from the store into a single archive, and to later @dfn{import} them on
4202 a machine that runs Guix.
4203 In particular, it allows store files to be transferred from one machine
4204 to the store on another machine.
4205
4206 @quotation Note
4207 If you're looking for a way to produce archives in a format suitable for
4208 tools other than Guix, @pxref{Invoking guix pack}.
4209 @end quotation
4210
4211 @cindex exporting store items
4212 To export store files as an archive to standard output, run:
4213
4214 @example
4215 guix archive --export @var{options} @var{specifications}...
4216 @end example
4217
4218 @var{specifications} may be either store file names or package
4219 specifications, as for @command{guix package} (@pxref{Invoking guix
4220 package}). For instance, the following command creates an archive
4221 containing the @code{gui} output of the @code{git} package and the main
4222 output of @code{emacs}:
4223
4224 @example
4225 guix archive --export git:gui /gnu/store/...-emacs-24.3 > great.nar
4226 @end example
4227
4228 If the specified packages are not built yet, @command{guix archive}
4229 automatically builds them. The build process may be controlled with the
4230 common build options (@pxref{Common Build Options}).
4231
4232 To transfer the @code{emacs} package to a machine connected over SSH,
4233 one would run:
4234
4235 @example
4236 guix archive --export -r emacs | ssh the-machine guix archive --import
4237 @end example
4238
4239 @noindent
4240 Similarly, a complete user profile may be transferred from one machine
4241 to another like this:
4242
4243 @example
4244 guix archive --export -r $(readlink -f ~/.guix-profile) | \
4245 ssh the-machine guix archive --import
4246 @end example
4247
4248 @noindent
4249 However, note that, in both examples, all of @code{emacs} and the
4250 profile as well as all of their dependencies are transferred (due to
4251 @code{-r}), regardless of what is already available in the store on the
4252 target machine. The @code{--missing} option can help figure out which
4253 items are missing from the target store. The @command{guix copy}
4254 command simplifies and optimizes this whole process, so this is probably
4255 what you should use in this case (@pxref{Invoking guix copy}).
4256
4257 @cindex nar, archive format
4258 @cindex normalized archive (nar)
4259 Archives are stored in the ``normalized archive'' or ``nar'' format, which is
4260 comparable in spirit to `tar', but with differences
4261 that make it more appropriate for our purposes. First, rather than
4262 recording all Unix metadata for each file, the nar format only mentions
4263 the file type (regular, directory, or symbolic link); Unix permissions
4264 and owner/group are dismissed. Second, the order in which directory
4265 entries are stored always follows the order of file names according to
4266 the C locale collation order. This makes archive production fully
4267 deterministic.
4268
4269 When exporting, the daemon digitally signs the contents of the archive,
4270 and that digital signature is appended. When importing, the daemon
4271 verifies the signature and rejects the import in case of an invalid
4272 signature or if the signing key is not authorized.
4273 @c FIXME: Add xref to daemon doc about signatures.
4274
4275 The main options are:
4276
4277 @table @code
4278 @item --export
4279 Export the specified store files or packages (see below.) Write the
4280 resulting archive to the standard output.
4281
4282 Dependencies are @emph{not} included in the output, unless
4283 @code{--recursive} is passed.
4284
4285 @item -r
4286 @itemx --recursive
4287 When combined with @code{--export}, this instructs @command{guix
4288 archive} to include dependencies of the given items in the archive.
4289 Thus, the resulting archive is self-contained: it contains the closure
4290 of the exported store items.
4291
4292 @item --import
4293 Read an archive from the standard input, and import the files listed
4294 therein into the store. Abort if the archive has an invalid digital
4295 signature, or if it is signed by a public key not among the authorized
4296 keys (see @code{--authorize} below.)
4297
4298 @item --missing
4299 Read a list of store file names from the standard input, one per line,
4300 and write on the standard output the subset of these files missing from
4301 the store.
4302
4303 @item --generate-key[=@var{parameters}]
4304 @cindex signing, archives
4305 Generate a new key pair for the daemon. This is a prerequisite before
4306 archives can be exported with @code{--export}. Note that this operation
4307 usually takes time, because it needs to gather enough entropy to
4308 generate the key pair.
4309
4310 The generated key pair is typically stored under @file{/etc/guix}, in
4311 @file{signing-key.pub} (public key) and @file{signing-key.sec} (private
4312 key, which must be kept secret.) When @var{parameters} is omitted,
4313 an ECDSA key using the Ed25519 curve is generated, or, for Libgcrypt
4314 versions before 1.6.0, it is a 4096-bit RSA key.
4315 Alternatively, @var{parameters} can specify
4316 @code{genkey} parameters suitable for Libgcrypt (@pxref{General
4317 public-key related Functions, @code{gcry_pk_genkey},, gcrypt, The
4318 Libgcrypt Reference Manual}).
4319
4320 @item --authorize
4321 @cindex authorizing, archives
4322 Authorize imports signed by the public key passed on standard input.
4323 The public key must be in ``s-expression advanced format''---i.e., the
4324 same format as the @file{signing-key.pub} file.
4325
4326 The list of authorized keys is kept in the human-editable file
4327 @file{/etc/guix/acl}. The file contains
4328 @url{https://people.csail.mit.edu/rivest/Sexp.txt, ``advanced-format
4329 s-expressions''} and is structured as an access-control list in the
4330 @url{https://theworld.com/~cme/spki.txt, Simple Public-Key Infrastructure
4331 (SPKI)}.
4332
4333 @item --extract=@var{directory}
4334 @itemx -x @var{directory}
4335 Read a single-item archive as served by substitute servers
4336 (@pxref{Substitutes}) and extract it to @var{directory}. This is a
4337 low-level operation needed in only very narrow use cases; see below.
4338
4339 For example, the following command extracts the substitute for Emacs
4340 served by @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} to @file{/tmp/emacs}:
4341
4342 @example
4343 $ wget -O - \
4344 https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}/nar/@dots{}-emacs-24.5 \
4345 | bunzip2 | guix archive -x /tmp/emacs
4346 @end example
4347
4348 Single-item archives are different from multiple-item archives produced
4349 by @command{guix archive --export}; they contain a single store item,
4350 and they do @emph{not} embed a signature. Thus this operation does
4351 @emph{no} signature verification and its output should be considered
4352 unsafe.
4353
4354 The primary purpose of this operation is to facilitate inspection of
4355 archive contents coming from possibly untrusted substitute servers.
4356
4357 @end table
4358
4359
4360 @c *********************************************************************
4361 @node Development
4362 @chapter Development
4363
4364 @cindex software development
4365 If you are a software developer, Guix provides tools that you should find
4366 helpful---independently of the language you're developing in. This is what
4367 this chapter is about.
4368
4369 The @command{guix environment} command provides a convenient way to set up
4370 @dfn{development environments} containing all the dependencies and tools
4371 necessary to work on the software package of your choice. The @command{guix
4372 pack} command allows you to create @dfn{application bundles} that can be
4373 easily distributed to users who do not run Guix.
4374
4375 @menu
4376 * Invoking guix environment:: Setting up development environments.
4377 * Invoking guix pack:: Creating software bundles.
4378 @end menu
4379
4380 @node Invoking guix environment
4381 @section Invoking @command{guix environment}
4382
4383 @cindex reproducible build environments
4384 @cindex development environments
4385 @cindex @command{guix environment}
4386 @cindex environment, package build environment
4387 The purpose of @command{guix environment} is to assist hackers in
4388 creating reproducible development environments without polluting their
4389 package profile. The @command{guix environment} tool takes one or more
4390 packages, builds all of their inputs, and creates a shell
4391 environment to use them.
4392
4393 The general syntax is:
4394
4395 @example
4396 guix environment @var{options} @var{package}@dots{}
4397 @end example
4398
4399 The following example spawns a new shell set up for the development of
4400 GNU@tie{}Guile:
4401
4402 @example
4403 guix environment guile
4404 @end example
4405
4406 If the needed dependencies are not built yet, @command{guix environment}
4407 automatically builds them. The environment of the new shell is an augmented
4408 version of the environment that @command{guix environment} was run in.
4409 It contains the necessary search paths for building the given package
4410 added to the existing environment variables. To create a ``pure''
4411 environment, in which the original environment variables have been unset,
4412 use the @code{--pure} option@footnote{Users sometimes wrongfully augment
4413 environment variables such as @code{PATH} in their @file{~/.bashrc}
4414 file. As a consequence, when @code{guix environment} launches it, Bash
4415 may read @file{~/.bashrc}, thereby introducing ``impurities'' in these
4416 environment variables. It is an error to define such environment
4417 variables in @file{.bashrc}; instead, they should be defined in
4418 @file{.bash_profile}, which is sourced only by log-in shells.
4419 @xref{Bash Startup Files,,, bash, The GNU Bash Reference Manual}, for
4420 details on Bash start-up files.}.
4421
4422 @vindex GUIX_ENVIRONMENT
4423 @command{guix environment} defines the @code{GUIX_ENVIRONMENT}
4424 variable in the shell it spawns; its value is the file name of the
4425 profile of this environment. This allows users to, say, define a
4426 specific prompt for development environments in their @file{.bashrc}
4427 (@pxref{Bash Startup Files,,, bash, The GNU Bash Reference Manual}):
4428
4429 @example
4430 if [ -n "$GUIX_ENVIRONMENT" ]
4431 then
4432 export PS1="\u@@\h \w [dev]\$ "
4433 fi
4434 @end example
4435
4436 @noindent
4437 ...@: or to browse the profile:
4438
4439 @example
4440 $ ls "$GUIX_ENVIRONMENT/bin"
4441 @end example
4442
4443 Additionally, more than one package may be specified, in which case the
4444 union of the inputs for the given packages are used. For example, the
4445 command below spawns a shell where all of the dependencies of both Guile
4446 and Emacs are available:
4447
4448 @example
4449 guix environment guile emacs
4450 @end example
4451
4452 Sometimes an interactive shell session is not desired. An arbitrary
4453 command may be invoked by placing the @code{--} token to separate the
4454 command from the rest of the arguments:
4455
4456 @example
4457 guix environment guile -- make -j4
4458 @end example
4459
4460 In other situations, it is more convenient to specify the list of
4461 packages needed in the environment. For example, the following command
4462 runs @command{python} from an environment containing Python@tie{}2.7 and
4463 NumPy:
4464
4465 @example
4466 guix environment --ad-hoc python2-numpy python-2.7 -- python
4467 @end example
4468
4469 Furthermore, one might want the dependencies of a package and also some
4470 additional packages that are not build-time or runtime dependencies, but
4471 are useful when developing nonetheless. Because of this, the
4472 @code{--ad-hoc} flag is positional. Packages appearing before
4473 @code{--ad-hoc} are interpreted as packages whose dependencies will be
4474 added to the environment. Packages appearing after are interpreted as
4475 packages that will be added to the environment directly. For example,
4476 the following command creates a Guix development environment that
4477 additionally includes Git and strace:
4478
4479 @example
4480 guix environment guix --ad-hoc git strace
4481 @end example
4482
4483 Sometimes it is desirable to isolate the environment as much as
4484 possible, for maximal purity and reproducibility. In particular, when
4485 using Guix on a host distro that is not Guix System, it is desirable to
4486 prevent access to @file{/usr/bin} and other system-wide resources from
4487 the development environment. For example, the following command spawns
4488 a Guile REPL in a ``container'' where only the store and the current
4489 working directory are mounted:
4490
4491 @example
4492 guix environment --ad-hoc --container guile -- guile
4493 @end example
4494
4495 @quotation Note
4496 The @code{--container} option requires Linux-libre 3.19 or newer.
4497 @end quotation
4498
4499 The available options are summarized below.
4500
4501 @table @code
4502 @item --root=@var{file}
4503 @itemx -r @var{file}
4504 @cindex persistent environment
4505 @cindex garbage collector root, for environments
4506 Make @var{file} a symlink to the profile for this environment, and
4507 register it as a garbage collector root.
4508
4509 This is useful if you want to protect your environment from garbage
4510 collection, to make it ``persistent''.
4511
4512 When this option is omitted, the environment is protected from garbage
4513 collection only for the duration of the @command{guix environment}
4514 session. This means that next time you recreate the same environment,
4515 you could have to rebuild or re-download packages. @xref{Invoking guix
4516 gc}, for more on GC roots.
4517
4518 @item --expression=@var{expr}
4519 @itemx -e @var{expr}
4520 Create an environment for the package or list of packages that
4521 @var{expr} evaluates to.
4522
4523 For example, running:
4524
4525 @example
4526 guix environment -e '(@@ (gnu packages maths) petsc-openmpi)'
4527 @end example
4528
4529 starts a shell with the environment for this specific variant of the
4530 PETSc package.
4531
4532 Running:
4533
4534 @example
4535 guix environment --ad-hoc -e '(@@ (gnu) %base-packages)'
4536 @end example
4537
4538 starts a shell with all the base system packages available.
4539
4540 The above commands only use the default output of the given packages.
4541 To select other outputs, two element tuples can be specified:
4542
4543 @example
4544 guix environment --ad-hoc -e '(list (@@ (gnu packages bash) bash) "include")'
4545 @end example
4546
4547 @item --load=@var{file}
4548 @itemx -l @var{file}
4549 Create an environment for the package or list of packages that the code
4550 within @var{file} evaluates to.
4551
4552 As an example, @var{file} might contain a definition like this
4553 (@pxref{Defining Packages}):
4554
4555 @lisp
4556 @verbatiminclude environment-gdb.scm
4557 @end lisp
4558
4559 @item --manifest=@var{file}
4560 @itemx -m @var{file}
4561 Create an environment for the packages contained in the manifest object
4562 returned by the Scheme code in @var{file}.
4563
4564 This is similar to the same-named option in @command{guix package}
4565 (@pxref{profile-manifest, @option{--manifest}}) and uses the same
4566 manifest files.
4567
4568 @item --ad-hoc
4569 Include all specified packages in the resulting environment, as if an
4570 @i{ad hoc} package were defined with them as inputs. This option is
4571 useful for quickly creating an environment without having to write a
4572 package expression to contain the desired inputs.
4573
4574 For instance, the command:
4575
4576 @example
4577 guix environment --ad-hoc guile guile-sdl -- guile
4578 @end example
4579
4580 runs @command{guile} in an environment where Guile and Guile-SDL are
4581 available.
4582
4583 Note that this example implicitly asks for the default output of
4584 @code{guile} and @code{guile-sdl}, but it is possible to ask for a
4585 specific output---e.g., @code{glib:bin} asks for the @code{bin} output
4586 of @code{glib} (@pxref{Packages with Multiple Outputs}).
4587
4588 This option may be composed with the default behavior of @command{guix
4589 environment}. Packages appearing before @code{--ad-hoc} are interpreted
4590 as packages whose dependencies will be added to the environment, the
4591 default behavior. Packages appearing after are interpreted as packages
4592 that will be added to the environment directly.
4593
4594 @item --pure
4595 Unset existing environment variables when building the new environment, except
4596 those specified with @option{--preserve} (see below.) This has the effect of
4597 creating an environment in which search paths only contain package inputs.
4598
4599 @item --preserve=@var{regexp}
4600 @itemx -E @var{regexp}
4601 When used alongside @option{--pure}, preserve the environment variables
4602 matching @var{regexp}---in other words, put them on a ``white list'' of
4603 environment variables that must be preserved. This option can be repeated
4604 several times.
4605
4606 @example
4607 guix environment --pure --preserve=^SLURM --ad-hoc openmpi @dots{} \
4608 -- mpirun @dots{}
4609 @end example
4610
4611 This example runs @command{mpirun} in a context where the only environment
4612 variables defined are @code{PATH}, environment variables whose name starts
4613 with @code{SLURM}, as well as the usual ``precious'' variables (@code{HOME},
4614 @code{USER}, etc.)
4615
4616 @item --search-paths
4617 Display the environment variable definitions that make up the
4618 environment.
4619
4620 @item --system=@var{system}
4621 @itemx -s @var{system}
4622 Attempt to build for @var{system}---e.g., @code{i686-linux}.
4623
4624 @item --container
4625 @itemx -C
4626 @cindex container
4627 Run @var{command} within an isolated container. The current working
4628 directory outside the container is mapped inside the container.
4629 Additionally, unless overridden with @code{--user}, a dummy home
4630 directory is created that matches the current user's home directory, and
4631 @file{/etc/passwd} is configured accordingly.
4632
4633 The spawned process runs as the current user outside the container. Inside
4634 the container, it has the same UID and GID as the current user, unless
4635 @option{--user} is passed (see below.)
4636
4637 @item --network
4638 @itemx -N
4639 For containers, share the network namespace with the host system.
4640 Containers created without this flag only have access to the loopback
4641 device.
4642
4643 @item --link-profile
4644 @itemx -P
4645 For containers, link the environment profile to
4646 @file{~/.guix-profile} within the container. This is equivalent to
4647 running the command @command{ln -s $GUIX_ENVIRONMENT ~/.guix-profile}
4648 within the container. Linking will fail and abort the environment if
4649 the directory already exists, which will certainly be the case if
4650 @command{guix environment} was invoked in the user's home directory.
4651
4652 Certain packages are configured to look in
4653 @code{~/.guix-profile} for configuration files and data;@footnote{For
4654 example, the @code{fontconfig} package inspects
4655 @file{~/.guix-profile/share/fonts} for additional fonts.}
4656 @code{--link-profile} allows these programs to behave as expected within
4657 the environment.
4658
4659 @item --user=@var{user}
4660 @itemx -u @var{user}
4661 For containers, use the username @var{user} in place of the current
4662 user. The generated @file{/etc/passwd} entry within the container will
4663 contain the name @var{user}, the home directory will be
4664 @file{/home/@var{user}}, and no user GECOS data will be copied. Furthermore,
4665 the UID and GID inside the container are 1000. @var{user}
4666 need not exist on the system.
4667
4668 Additionally, any shared or exposed path (see @code{--share} and
4669 @code{--expose} respectively) whose target is within the current user's
4670 home directory will be remapped relative to @file{/home/USER}; this
4671 includes the automatic mapping of the current working directory.
4672
4673 @example
4674 # will expose paths as /home/foo/wd, /home/foo/test, and /home/foo/target
4675 cd $HOME/wd
4676 guix environment --container --user=foo \
4677 --expose=$HOME/test \
4678 --expose=/tmp/target=$HOME/target
4679 @end example
4680
4681 While this will limit the leaking of user identity through home paths
4682 and each of the user fields, this is only one useful component of a
4683 broader privacy/anonymity solution---not one in and of itself.
4684
4685 @item --no-cwd
4686 For containers, the default behavior is to share the current working
4687 directory with the isolated container and immediately change to that
4688 directory within the container. If this is undesirable, @code{--no-cwd}
4689 will cause the current working directory to @emph{not} be automatically
4690 shared and will change to the user's home directory within the container
4691 instead. See also @code{--user}.
4692
4693 @item --expose=@var{source}[=@var{target}]
4694 For containers, expose the file system @var{source} from the host system
4695 as the read-only file system @var{target} within the container. If
4696 @var{target} is not specified, @var{source} is used as the target mount
4697 point in the container.
4698
4699 The example below spawns a Guile REPL in a container in which the user's
4700 home directory is accessible read-only via the @file{/exchange}
4701 directory:
4702
4703 @example
4704 guix environment --container --expose=$HOME=/exchange --ad-hoc guile -- guile
4705 @end example
4706
4707 @item --share=@var{source}[=@var{target}]
4708 For containers, share the file system @var{source} from the host system
4709 as the writable file system @var{target} within the container. If
4710 @var{target} is not specified, @var{source} is used as the target mount
4711 point in the container.
4712
4713 The example below spawns a Guile REPL in a container in which the user's
4714 home directory is accessible for both reading and writing via the
4715 @file{/exchange} directory:
4716
4717 @example
4718 guix environment --container --share=$HOME=/exchange --ad-hoc guile -- guile
4719 @end example
4720 @end table
4721
4722 @command{guix environment}
4723 also supports all of the common build options that @command{guix
4724 build} supports (@pxref{Common Build Options}) as well as package
4725 transformation options (@pxref{Package Transformation Options}).
4726
4727 @node Invoking guix pack
4728 @section Invoking @command{guix pack}
4729
4730 Occasionally you want to pass software to people who are not (yet!)
4731 lucky enough to be using Guix. You'd tell them to run @command{guix
4732 package -i @var{something}}, but that's not possible in this case. This
4733 is where @command{guix pack} comes in.
4734
4735 @quotation Note
4736 If you are looking for ways to exchange binaries among machines that
4737 already run Guix, @pxref{Invoking guix copy}, @ref{Invoking guix
4738 publish}, and @ref{Invoking guix archive}.
4739 @end quotation
4740
4741 @cindex pack
4742 @cindex bundle
4743 @cindex application bundle
4744 @cindex software bundle
4745 The @command{guix pack} command creates a shrink-wrapped @dfn{pack} or
4746 @dfn{software bundle}: it creates a tarball or some other archive
4747 containing the binaries of the software you're interested in, and all
4748 its dependencies. The resulting archive can be used on any machine that
4749 does not have Guix, and people can run the exact same binaries as those
4750 you have with Guix. The pack itself is created in a bit-reproducible
4751 fashion, so anyone can verify that it really contains the build results
4752 that you pretend to be shipping.
4753
4754 For example, to create a bundle containing Guile, Emacs, Geiser, and all
4755 their dependencies, you can run:
4756
4757 @example
4758 $ guix pack guile emacs geiser
4759 @dots{}
4760 /gnu/store/@dots{}-pack.tar.gz
4761 @end example
4762
4763 The result here is a tarball containing a @file{/gnu/store} directory
4764 with all the relevant packages. The resulting tarball contains a
4765 @dfn{profile} with the three packages of interest; the profile is the
4766 same as would be created by @command{guix package -i}. It is this
4767 mechanism that is used to create Guix's own standalone binary tarball
4768 (@pxref{Binary Installation}).
4769
4770 Users of this pack would have to run
4771 @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-profile/bin/guile} to run Guile, which you may
4772 find inconvenient. To work around it, you can create, say, a
4773 @file{/opt/gnu/bin} symlink to the profile:
4774
4775 @example
4776 guix pack -S /opt/gnu/bin=bin guile emacs geiser
4777 @end example
4778
4779 @noindent
4780 That way, users can happily type @file{/opt/gnu/bin/guile} and enjoy.
4781
4782 @cindex relocatable binaries, with @command{guix pack}
4783 What if the recipient of your pack does not have root privileges on
4784 their machine, and thus cannot unpack it in the root file system? In
4785 that case, you will want to use the @code{--relocatable} option (see
4786 below). This option produces @dfn{relocatable binaries}, meaning they
4787 they can be placed anywhere in the file system hierarchy: in the example
4788 above, users can unpack your tarball in their home directory and
4789 directly run @file{./opt/gnu/bin/guile}.
4790
4791 @cindex Docker, build an image with guix pack
4792 Alternatively, you can produce a pack in the Docker image format using
4793 the following command:
4794
4795 @example
4796 guix pack -f docker guile emacs geiser
4797 @end example
4798
4799 @noindent
4800 The result is a tarball that can be passed to the @command{docker load}
4801 command. See the
4802 @uref{https://docs.docker.com/engine/reference/commandline/load/, Docker
4803 documentation} for more information.
4804
4805 @cindex Singularity, build an image with guix pack
4806 @cindex SquashFS, build an image with guix pack
4807 Yet another option is to produce a SquashFS image with the following
4808 command:
4809
4810 @example
4811 guix pack -f squashfs guile emacs geiser
4812 @end example
4813
4814 @noindent
4815 The result is a SquashFS file system image that can either be mounted or
4816 directly be used as a file system container image with the
4817 @uref{https://singularity.lbl.gov, Singularity container execution
4818 environment}, using commands like @command{singularity shell} or
4819 @command{singularity exec}.
4820
4821 Several command-line options allow you to customize your pack:
4822
4823 @table @code
4824 @item --format=@var{format}
4825 @itemx -f @var{format}
4826 Produce a pack in the given @var{format}.
4827
4828 The available formats are:
4829
4830 @table @code
4831 @item tarball
4832 This is the default format. It produces a tarball containing all the
4833 specified binaries and symlinks.
4834
4835 @item docker
4836 This produces a tarball that follows the
4837 @uref{https://github.com/docker/docker/blob/master/image/spec/v1.2.md,
4838 Docker Image Specification}.
4839
4840 @item squashfs
4841 This produces a SquashFS image containing all the specified binaries and
4842 symlinks, as well as empty mount points for virtual file systems like
4843 procfs.
4844 @end table
4845
4846 @cindex relocatable binaries
4847 @item --relocatable
4848 @itemx -R
4849 Produce @dfn{relocatable binaries}---i.e., binaries that can be placed
4850 anywhere in the file system hierarchy and run from there.
4851
4852 When this option is passed once, the resulting binaries require support for
4853 @dfn{user namespaces} in the kernel Linux; when passed
4854 @emph{twice}@footnote{Here's a trick to memorize it: @code{-RR}, which adds
4855 PRoot support, can be thought of as the abbreviation of ``Really
4856 Relocatable''. Neat, isn't it?}, relocatable binaries fall to back to PRoot
4857 if user namespaces are unavailable, and essentially work anywhere---see below
4858 for the implications.
4859
4860 For example, if you create a pack containing Bash with:
4861
4862 @example
4863 guix pack -RR -S /mybin=bin bash
4864 @end example
4865
4866 @noindent
4867 ...@: you can copy that pack to a machine that lacks Guix, and from your
4868 home directory as a normal user, run:
4869
4870 @example
4871 tar xf pack.tar.gz
4872 ./mybin/sh
4873 @end example
4874
4875 @noindent
4876 In that shell, if you type @code{ls /gnu/store}, you'll notice that
4877 @file{/gnu/store} shows up and contains all the dependencies of
4878 @code{bash}, even though the machine actually lacks @file{/gnu/store}
4879 altogether! That is probably the simplest way to deploy Guix-built
4880 software on a non-Guix machine.
4881
4882 @quotation Note
4883 By default, relocatable binaries rely on the @dfn{user namespace} feature of
4884 the kernel Linux, which allows unprivileged users to mount or change root.
4885 Old versions of Linux did not support it, and some GNU/Linux distributions
4886 turn it off.
4887
4888 To produce relocatable binaries that work even in the absence of user
4889 namespaces, pass @option{--relocatable} or @option{-R} @emph{twice}. In that
4890 case, binaries will try user namespace support and fall back to PRoot if user
4891 namespaces are not supported.
4892
4893 The @uref{https://proot-me.github.io/, PRoot} program provides the necessary
4894 support for file system virtualization. It achieves that by using the
4895 @code{ptrace} system call on the running program. This approach has the
4896 advantage to work without requiring special kernel support, but it incurs
4897 run-time overhead every time a system call is made.
4898 @end quotation
4899
4900 @cindex entry point, for Docker images
4901 @item --entry-point=@var{command}
4902 Use @var{command} as the @dfn{entry point} of the resulting pack, if the pack
4903 format supports it---currently @code{docker} and @code{squashfs} (Singularity)
4904 support it. @var{command} must be relative to the profile contained in the
4905 pack.
4906
4907 The entry point specifies the command that tools like @code{docker run} or
4908 @code{singularity run} automatically start by default. For example, you can
4909 do:
4910
4911 @example
4912 guix pack -f docker --entry-point=bin/guile guile
4913 @end example
4914
4915 The resulting pack can easily be loaded and @code{docker run} with no extra
4916 arguments will spawn @code{bin/guile}:
4917
4918 @example
4919 docker load -i pack.tar.gz
4920 docker run @var{image-id}
4921 @end example
4922
4923 @item --expression=@var{expr}
4924 @itemx -e @var{expr}
4925 Consider the package @var{expr} evaluates to.
4926
4927 This has the same purpose as the same-named option in @command{guix
4928 build} (@pxref{Additional Build Options, @code{--expression} in
4929 @command{guix build}}).
4930
4931 @item --manifest=@var{file}
4932 @itemx -m @var{file}
4933 Use the packages contained in the manifest object returned by the Scheme
4934 code in @var{file}.
4935
4936 This has a similar purpose as the same-named option in @command{guix
4937 package} (@pxref{profile-manifest, @option{--manifest}}) and uses the
4938 same manifest files. It allows you to define a collection of packages
4939 once and use it both for creating profiles and for creating archives
4940 for use on machines that do not have Guix installed. Note that you can
4941 specify @emph{either} a manifest file @emph{or} a list of packages,
4942 but not both.
4943
4944 @item --system=@var{system}
4945 @itemx -s @var{system}
4946 Attempt to build for @var{system}---e.g., @code{i686-linux}---instead of
4947 the system type of the build host.
4948
4949 @item --target=@var{triplet}
4950 @cindex cross-compilation
4951 Cross-build for @var{triplet}, which must be a valid GNU triplet, such
4952 as @code{"mips64el-linux-gnu"} (@pxref{Specifying target triplets, GNU
4953 configuration triplets,, autoconf, Autoconf}).
4954
4955 @item --compression=@var{tool}
4956 @itemx -C @var{tool}
4957 Compress the resulting tarball using @var{tool}---one of @code{gzip},
4958 @code{bzip2}, @code{xz}, @code{lzip}, or @code{none} for no compression.
4959
4960 @item --symlink=@var{spec}
4961 @itemx -S @var{spec}
4962 Add the symlinks specified by @var{spec} to the pack. This option can
4963 appear several times.
4964
4965 @var{spec} has the form @code{@var{source}=@var{target}}, where
4966 @var{source} is the symlink that will be created and @var{target} is the
4967 symlink target.
4968
4969 For instance, @code{-S /opt/gnu/bin=bin} creates a @file{/opt/gnu/bin}
4970 symlink pointing to the @file{bin} sub-directory of the profile.
4971
4972 @item --save-provenance
4973 Save provenance information for the packages passed on the command line.
4974 Provenance information includes the URL and commit of the channels in use
4975 (@pxref{Channels}).
4976
4977 Provenance information is saved in the
4978 @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-profile/manifest} file in the pack, along with the
4979 usual package metadata---the name and version of each package, their
4980 propagated inputs, and so on. It is useful information to the recipient of
4981 the pack, who then knows how the pack was (supposedly) obtained.
4982
4983 This option is not enabled by default because, like timestamps, provenance
4984 information contributes nothing to the build process. In other words, there
4985 is an infinity of channel URLs and commit IDs that can lead to the same pack.
4986 Recording such ``silent'' metadata in the output thus potentially breaks the
4987 source-to-binary bitwise reproducibility property.
4988
4989 @item --root=@var{file}
4990 @itemx -r @var{file}
4991 @cindex garbage collector root, for packs
4992 Make @var{file} a symlink to the resulting pack, and register it as a garbage
4993 collector root.
4994
4995 @item --localstatedir
4996 @itemx --profile-name=@var{name}
4997 Include the ``local state directory'', @file{/var/guix}, in the resulting
4998 pack, and notably the @file{/var/guix/profiles/per-user/root/@var{name}}
4999 profile---by default @var{name} is @code{guix-profile}, which corresponds to
5000 @file{~root/.guix-profile}.
5001
5002 @file{/var/guix} contains the store database (@pxref{The Store}) as well
5003 as garbage-collector roots (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}). Providing it in
5004 the pack means that the store is ``complete'' and manageable by Guix;
5005 not providing it pack means that the store is ``dead'': items cannot be
5006 added to it or removed from it after extraction of the pack.
5007
5008 One use case for this is the Guix self-contained binary tarball
5009 (@pxref{Binary Installation}).
5010
5011 @item --bootstrap
5012 Use the bootstrap binaries to build the pack. This option is only
5013 useful to Guix developers.
5014 @end table
5015
5016 In addition, @command{guix pack} supports all the common build options
5017 (@pxref{Common Build Options}) and all the package transformation
5018 options (@pxref{Package Transformation Options}).
5019
5020
5021 @c *********************************************************************
5022 @node Programming Interface
5023 @chapter Programming Interface
5024
5025 GNU Guix provides several Scheme programming interfaces (APIs) to
5026 define, build, and query packages. The first interface allows users to
5027 write high-level package definitions. These definitions refer to
5028 familiar packaging concepts, such as the name and version of a package,
5029 its build system, and its dependencies. These definitions can then be
5030 turned into concrete build actions.
5031
5032 Build actions are performed by the Guix daemon, on behalf of users. In a
5033 standard setup, the daemon has write access to the store---the
5034 @file{/gnu/store} directory---whereas users do not. The recommended
5035 setup also has the daemon perform builds in chroots, under a specific
5036 build users, to minimize interference with the rest of the system.
5037
5038 @cindex derivation
5039 Lower-level APIs are available to interact with the daemon and the
5040 store. To instruct the daemon to perform a build action, users actually
5041 provide it with a @dfn{derivation}. A derivation is a low-level
5042 representation of the build actions to be taken, and the environment in
5043 which they should occur---derivations are to package definitions what
5044 assembly is to C programs. The term ``derivation'' comes from the fact
5045 that build results @emph{derive} from them.
5046
5047 This chapter describes all these APIs in turn, starting from high-level
5048 package definitions.
5049
5050 @menu
5051 * Package Modules:: Packages from the programmer's viewpoint.
5052 * Defining Packages:: Defining new packages.
5053 * Build Systems:: Specifying how packages are built.
5054 * The Store:: Manipulating the package store.
5055 * Derivations:: Low-level interface to package derivations.
5056 * The Store Monad:: Purely functional interface to the store.
5057 * G-Expressions:: Manipulating build expressions.
5058 * Invoking guix repl:: Fiddling with Guix interactively.
5059 @end menu
5060
5061 @node Package Modules
5062 @section Package Modules
5063
5064 From a programming viewpoint, the package definitions of the
5065 GNU distribution are provided by Guile modules in the @code{(gnu packages
5066 @dots{})} name space@footnote{Note that packages under the @code{(gnu
5067 packages @dots{})} module name space are not necessarily ``GNU
5068 packages''. This module naming scheme follows the usual Guile module
5069 naming convention: @code{gnu} means that these modules are distributed
5070 as part of the GNU system, and @code{packages} identifies modules that
5071 define packages.} (@pxref{Modules, Guile modules,, guile, GNU Guile
5072 Reference Manual}). For instance, the @code{(gnu packages emacs)}
5073 module exports a variable named @code{emacs}, which is bound to a
5074 @code{<package>} object (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
5075
5076 The @code{(gnu packages @dots{})} module name space is
5077 automatically scanned for packages by the command-line tools. For
5078 instance, when running @code{guix install emacs}, all the @code{(gnu
5079 packages @dots{})} modules are scanned until one that exports a package
5080 object whose name is @code{emacs} is found. This package search
5081 facility is implemented in the @code{(gnu packages)} module.
5082
5083 @cindex customization, of packages
5084 @cindex package module search path
5085 Users can store package definitions in modules with different
5086 names---e.g., @code{(my-packages emacs)}@footnote{Note that the file
5087 name and module name must match. For instance, the @code{(my-packages
5088 emacs)} module must be stored in a @file{my-packages/emacs.scm} file
5089 relative to the load path specified with @option{--load-path} or
5090 @code{GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH}. @xref{Modules and the File System,,,
5091 guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}, for details.}. There are two ways to make
5092 these package definitions visible to the user interfaces:
5093
5094 @enumerate
5095 @item
5096 By adding the directory containing your package modules to the search path
5097 with the @code{-L} flag of @command{guix package} and other commands
5098 (@pxref{Common Build Options}), or by setting the @code{GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH}
5099 environment variable described below.
5100
5101 @item
5102 By defining a @dfn{channel} and configuring @command{guix pull} so that it
5103 pulls from it. A channel is essentially a Git repository containing package
5104 modules. @xref{Channels}, for more information on how to define and use
5105 channels.
5106 @end enumerate
5107
5108 @code{GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH} works similarly to other search path variables:
5109
5110 @defvr {Environment Variable} GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH
5111 This is a colon-separated list of directories to search for additional
5112 package modules. Directories listed in this variable take precedence
5113 over the own modules of the distribution.
5114 @end defvr
5115
5116 The distribution is fully @dfn{bootstrapped} and @dfn{self-contained}:
5117 each package is built based solely on other packages in the
5118 distribution. The root of this dependency graph is a small set of
5119 @dfn{bootstrap binaries}, provided by the @code{(gnu packages
5120 bootstrap)} module. For more information on bootstrapping,
5121 @pxref{Bootstrapping}.
5122
5123 @node Defining Packages
5124 @section Defining Packages
5125
5126 The high-level interface to package definitions is implemented in the
5127 @code{(guix packages)} and @code{(guix build-system)} modules. As an
5128 example, the package definition, or @dfn{recipe}, for the GNU Hello
5129 package looks like this:
5130
5131 @lisp
5132 (define-module (gnu packages hello)
5133 #:use-module (guix packages)
5134 #:use-module (guix download)
5135 #:use-module (guix build-system gnu)
5136 #:use-module (guix licenses)
5137 #:use-module (gnu packages gawk))
5138
5139 (define-public hello
5140 (package
5141 (name "hello")
5142 (version "2.10")
5143 (source (origin
5144 (method url-fetch)
5145 (uri (string-append "mirror://gnu/hello/hello-" version
5146 ".tar.gz"))
5147 (sha256
5148 (base32
5149 "0ssi1wpaf7plaswqqjwigppsg5fyh99vdlb9kzl7c9lng89ndq1i"))))
5150 (build-system gnu-build-system)
5151 (arguments '(#:configure-flags '("--enable-silent-rules")))
5152 (inputs `(("gawk" ,gawk)))
5153 (synopsis "Hello, GNU world: An example GNU package")
5154 (description "Guess what GNU Hello prints!")
5155 (home-page "https://www.gnu.org/software/hello/")
5156 (license gpl3+)))
5157 @end lisp
5158
5159 @noindent
5160 Without being a Scheme expert, the reader may have guessed the meaning
5161 of the various fields here. This expression binds the variable
5162 @code{hello} to a @code{<package>} object, which is essentially a record
5163 (@pxref{SRFI-9, Scheme records,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}).
5164 This package object can be inspected using procedures found in the
5165 @code{(guix packages)} module; for instance, @code{(package-name hello)}
5166 returns---surprise!---@code{"hello"}.
5167
5168 With luck, you may be able to import part or all of the definition of
5169 the package you are interested in from another repository, using the
5170 @code{guix import} command (@pxref{Invoking guix import}).
5171
5172 In the example above, @var{hello} is defined in a module of its own,
5173 @code{(gnu packages hello)}. Technically, this is not strictly
5174 necessary, but it is convenient to do so: all the packages defined in
5175 modules under @code{(gnu packages @dots{})} are automatically known to
5176 the command-line tools (@pxref{Package Modules}).
5177
5178 There are a few points worth noting in the above package definition:
5179
5180 @itemize
5181 @item
5182 The @code{source} field of the package is an @code{<origin>} object
5183 (@pxref{origin Reference}, for the complete reference).
5184 Here, the @code{url-fetch} method from @code{(guix download)} is used,
5185 meaning that the source is a file to be downloaded over FTP or HTTP.
5186
5187 The @code{mirror://gnu} prefix instructs @code{url-fetch} to use one of
5188 the GNU mirrors defined in @code{(guix download)}.
5189
5190 The @code{sha256} field specifies the expected SHA256 hash of the file
5191 being downloaded. It is mandatory, and allows Guix to check the
5192 integrity of the file. The @code{(base32 @dots{})} form introduces the
5193 base32 representation of the hash. You can obtain this information with
5194 @code{guix download} (@pxref{Invoking guix download}) and @code{guix
5195 hash} (@pxref{Invoking guix hash}).
5196
5197 @cindex patches
5198 When needed, the @code{origin} form can also have a @code{patches} field
5199 listing patches to be applied, and a @code{snippet} field giving a
5200 Scheme expression to modify the source code.
5201
5202 @item
5203 @cindex GNU Build System
5204 The @code{build-system} field specifies the procedure to build the
5205 package (@pxref{Build Systems}). Here, @var{gnu-build-system}
5206 represents the familiar GNU Build System, where packages may be
5207 configured, built, and installed with the usual @code{./configure &&
5208 make && make check && make install} command sequence.
5209
5210 @item
5211 The @code{arguments} field specifies options for the build system
5212 (@pxref{Build Systems}). Here it is interpreted by
5213 @var{gnu-build-system} as a request run @file{configure} with the
5214 @code{--enable-silent-rules} flag.
5215
5216 @cindex quote
5217 @cindex quoting
5218 @findex '
5219 @findex quote
5220 What about these quote (@code{'}) characters? They are Scheme syntax to
5221 introduce a literal list; @code{'} is synonymous with @code{quote}.
5222 @xref{Expression Syntax, quoting,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual},
5223 for details. Here the value of the @code{arguments} field is a list of
5224 arguments passed to the build system down the road, as with @code{apply}
5225 (@pxref{Fly Evaluation, @code{apply},, guile, GNU Guile Reference
5226 Manual}).
5227
5228 The hash-colon (@code{#:}) sequence defines a Scheme @dfn{keyword}
5229 (@pxref{Keywords,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}), and
5230 @code{#:configure-flags} is a keyword used to pass a keyword argument
5231 to the build system (@pxref{Coding With Keywords,,, guile, GNU Guile
5232 Reference Manual}).
5233
5234 @item
5235 The @code{inputs} field specifies inputs to the build process---i.e.,
5236 build-time or run-time dependencies of the package. Here, we define an
5237 input called @code{"gawk"} whose value is that of the @var{gawk}
5238 variable; @var{gawk} is itself bound to a @code{<package>} object.
5239
5240 @cindex backquote (quasiquote)
5241 @findex `
5242 @findex quasiquote
5243 @cindex comma (unquote)
5244 @findex ,
5245 @findex unquote
5246 @findex ,@@
5247 @findex unquote-splicing
5248 Again, @code{`} (a backquote, synonymous with @code{quasiquote}) allows
5249 us to introduce a literal list in the @code{inputs} field, while
5250 @code{,} (a comma, synonymous with @code{unquote}) allows us to insert a
5251 value in that list (@pxref{Expression Syntax, unquote,, guile, GNU Guile
5252 Reference Manual}).
5253
5254 Note that GCC, Coreutils, Bash, and other essential tools do not need to
5255 be specified as inputs here. Instead, @var{gnu-build-system} takes care
5256 of ensuring that they are present (@pxref{Build Systems}).
5257
5258 However, any other dependencies need to be specified in the
5259 @code{inputs} field. Any dependency not specified here will simply be
5260 unavailable to the build process, possibly leading to a build failure.
5261 @end itemize
5262
5263 @xref{package Reference}, for a full description of possible fields.
5264
5265 Once a package definition is in place, the
5266 package may actually be built using the @code{guix build} command-line
5267 tool (@pxref{Invoking guix build}), troubleshooting any build failures
5268 you encounter (@pxref{Debugging Build Failures}). You can easily jump back to the
5269 package definition using the @command{guix edit} command
5270 (@pxref{Invoking guix edit}).
5271 @xref{Packaging Guidelines}, for
5272 more information on how to test package definitions, and
5273 @ref{Invoking guix lint}, for information on how to check a definition
5274 for style conformance.
5275 @vindex GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH
5276 Lastly, @pxref{Channels}, for information
5277 on how to extend the distribution by adding your own package definitions
5278 in a ``channel''.
5279
5280 Finally, updating the package definition to a new upstream version
5281 can be partly automated by the @command{guix refresh} command
5282 (@pxref{Invoking guix refresh}).
5283
5284 Behind the scenes, a derivation corresponding to the @code{<package>}
5285 object is first computed by the @code{package-derivation} procedure.
5286 That derivation is stored in a @code{.drv} file under @file{/gnu/store}.
5287 The build actions it prescribes may then be realized by using the
5288 @code{build-derivations} procedure (@pxref{The Store}).
5289
5290 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} package-derivation @var{store} @var{package} [@var{system}]
5291 Return the @code{<derivation>} object of @var{package} for @var{system}
5292 (@pxref{Derivations}).
5293
5294 @var{package} must be a valid @code{<package>} object, and @var{system}
5295 must be a string denoting the target system type---e.g.,
5296 @code{"x86_64-linux"} for an x86_64 Linux-based GNU system. @var{store}
5297 must be a connection to the daemon, which operates on the store
5298 (@pxref{The Store}).
5299 @end deffn
5300
5301 @noindent
5302 @cindex cross-compilation
5303 Similarly, it is possible to compute a derivation that cross-builds a
5304 package for some other system:
5305
5306 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} package-cross-derivation @var{store} @
5307 @var{package} @var{target} [@var{system}]
5308 Return the @code{<derivation>} object of @var{package} cross-built from
5309 @var{system} to @var{target}.
5310
5311 @var{target} must be a valid GNU triplet denoting the target hardware
5312 and operating system, such as @code{"mips64el-linux-gnu"}
5313 (@pxref{Specifying Target Triplets,,, autoconf, Autoconf}).
5314 @end deffn
5315
5316 @cindex package transformations
5317 @cindex input rewriting
5318 @cindex dependency tree rewriting
5319 Packages can be manipulated in arbitrary ways. An example of a useful
5320 transformation is @dfn{input rewriting}, whereby the dependency tree of
5321 a package is rewritten by replacing specific inputs by others:
5322
5323 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} package-input-rewriting @var{replacements} @
5324 [@var{rewrite-name}]
5325 Return a procedure that, when passed a package, replaces its direct and
5326 indirect dependencies (but not its implicit inputs) according to
5327 @var{replacements}. @var{replacements} is a list of package pairs; the
5328 first element of each pair is the package to replace, and the second one
5329 is the replacement.
5330
5331 Optionally, @var{rewrite-name} is a one-argument procedure that takes
5332 the name of a package and returns its new name after rewrite.
5333 @end deffn
5334
5335 @noindent
5336 Consider this example:
5337
5338 @lisp
5339 (define libressl-instead-of-openssl
5340 ;; This is a procedure to replace OPENSSL by LIBRESSL,
5341 ;; recursively.
5342 (package-input-rewriting `((,openssl . ,libressl))))
5343
5344 (define git-with-libressl
5345 (libressl-instead-of-openssl git))
5346 @end lisp
5347
5348 @noindent
5349 Here we first define a rewriting procedure that replaces @var{openssl}
5350 with @var{libressl}. Then we use it to define a @dfn{variant} of the
5351 @var{git} package that uses @var{libressl} instead of @var{openssl}.
5352 This is exactly what the @option{--with-input} command-line option does
5353 (@pxref{Package Transformation Options, @option{--with-input}}).
5354
5355 The following variant of @code{package-input-rewriting} can match packages to
5356 be replaced by name rather than by identity.
5357
5358 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} package-input-rewriting/spec @var{replacements}
5359 Return a procedure that, given a package, applies the given @var{replacements} to
5360 all the package graph (excluding implicit inputs). @var{replacements} is a list of
5361 spec/procedures pair; each spec is a package specification such as @code{"gcc"} or
5362 @code{"guile@@2"}, and each procedure takes a matching package and returns a
5363 replacement for that package.
5364 @end deffn
5365
5366 The example above could be rewritten this way:
5367
5368 @lisp
5369 (define libressl-instead-of-openssl
5370 ;; Replace all the packages called "openssl" with LibreSSL.
5371 (package-input-rewriting/spec `(("openssl" . ,(const libressl)))))
5372 @end lisp
5373
5374 The key difference here is that, this time, packages are matched by spec and
5375 not by identity. In other words, any package in the graph that is called
5376 @code{openssl} will be replaced.
5377
5378 A more generic procedure to rewrite a package dependency graph is
5379 @code{package-mapping}: it supports arbitrary changes to nodes in the
5380 graph.
5381
5382 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} package-mapping @var{proc} [@var{cut?}]
5383 Return a procedure that, given a package, applies @var{proc} to all the packages
5384 depended on and returns the resulting package. The procedure stops recursion
5385 when @var{cut?} returns true for a given package.
5386 @end deffn
5387
5388 @menu
5389 * package Reference:: The package data type.
5390 * origin Reference:: The origin data type.
5391 @end menu
5392
5393
5394 @node package Reference
5395 @subsection @code{package} Reference
5396
5397 This section summarizes all the options available in @code{package}
5398 declarations (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
5399
5400 @deftp {Data Type} package
5401 This is the data type representing a package recipe.
5402
5403 @table @asis
5404 @item @code{name}
5405 The name of the package, as a string.
5406
5407 @item @code{version}
5408 The version of the package, as a string.
5409
5410 @item @code{source}
5411 An object telling how the source code for the package should be
5412 acquired. Most of the time, this is an @code{origin} object, which
5413 denotes a file fetched from the Internet (@pxref{origin Reference}). It
5414 can also be any other ``file-like'' object such as a @code{local-file},
5415 which denotes a file from the local file system (@pxref{G-Expressions,
5416 @code{local-file}}).
5417
5418 @item @code{build-system}
5419 The build system that should be used to build the package (@pxref{Build
5420 Systems}).
5421
5422 @item @code{arguments} (default: @code{'()})
5423 The arguments that should be passed to the build system. This is a
5424 list, typically containing sequential keyword-value pairs.
5425
5426 @item @code{inputs} (default: @code{'()})
5427 @itemx @code{native-inputs} (default: @code{'()})
5428 @itemx @code{propagated-inputs} (default: @code{'()})
5429 @cindex inputs, of packages
5430 These fields list dependencies of the package. Each one is a list of
5431 tuples, where each tuple has a label for the input (a string) as its
5432 first element, a package, origin, or derivation as its second element,
5433 and optionally the name of the output thereof that should be used, which
5434 defaults to @code{"out"} (@pxref{Packages with Multiple Outputs}, for
5435 more on package outputs). For example, the list below specifies three
5436 inputs:
5437
5438 @lisp
5439 `(("libffi" ,libffi)
5440 ("libunistring" ,libunistring)
5441 ("glib:bin" ,glib "bin")) ;the "bin" output of Glib
5442 @end lisp
5443
5444 @cindex cross compilation, package dependencies
5445 The distinction between @code{native-inputs} and @code{inputs} is
5446 necessary when considering cross-compilation. When cross-compiling,
5447 dependencies listed in @code{inputs} are built for the @emph{target}
5448 architecture; conversely, dependencies listed in @code{native-inputs}
5449 are built for the architecture of the @emph{build} machine.
5450
5451 @code{native-inputs} is typically used to list tools needed at
5452 build time, but not at run time, such as Autoconf, Automake, pkg-config,
5453 Gettext, or Bison. @command{guix lint} can report likely mistakes in
5454 this area (@pxref{Invoking guix lint}).
5455
5456 @anchor{package-propagated-inputs}
5457 Lastly, @code{propagated-inputs} is similar to @code{inputs}, but the
5458 specified packages will be automatically installed alongside the package
5459 they belong to (@pxref{package-cmd-propagated-inputs, @command{guix
5460 package}}, for information on how @command{guix package} deals with
5461 propagated inputs.)
5462
5463 For example this is necessary when a C/C++ library needs headers of
5464 another library to compile, or when a pkg-config file refers to another
5465 one @i{via} its @code{Requires} field.
5466
5467 Another example where @code{propagated-inputs} is useful is for languages
5468 that lack a facility to record the run-time search path akin to the
5469 @code{RUNPATH} of ELF files; this includes Guile, Python, Perl, and
5470 more. To ensure that libraries written in those languages can find
5471 library code they depend on at run time, run-time dependencies must be
5472 listed in @code{propagated-inputs} rather than @code{inputs}.
5473
5474 @item @code{outputs} (default: @code{'("out")})
5475 The list of output names of the package. @xref{Packages with Multiple
5476 Outputs}, for typical uses of additional outputs.
5477
5478 @item @code{native-search-paths} (default: @code{'()})
5479 @itemx @code{search-paths} (default: @code{'()})
5480 A list of @code{search-path-specification} objects describing
5481 search-path environment variables honored by the package.
5482
5483 @item @code{replacement} (default: @code{#f})
5484 This must be either @code{#f} or a package object that will be used as a
5485 @dfn{replacement} for this package. @xref{Security Updates, grafts},
5486 for details.
5487
5488 @item @code{synopsis}
5489 A one-line description of the package.
5490
5491 @item @code{description}
5492 A more elaborate description of the package.
5493
5494 @item @code{license}
5495 @cindex license, of packages
5496 The license of the package; a value from @code{(guix licenses)},
5497 or a list of such values.
5498
5499 @item @code{home-page}
5500 The URL to the home-page of the package, as a string.
5501
5502 @item @code{supported-systems} (default: @var{%supported-systems})
5503 The list of systems supported by the package, as strings of the form
5504 @code{architecture-kernel}, for example @code{"x86_64-linux"}.
5505
5506 @item @code{maintainers} (default: @code{'()})
5507 The list of maintainers of the package, as @code{maintainer} objects.
5508
5509 @item @code{location} (default: source location of the @code{package} form)
5510 The source location of the package. It is useful to override this when
5511 inheriting from another package, in which case this field is not
5512 automatically corrected.
5513 @end table
5514 @end deftp
5515
5516 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} this-package
5517 When used in the @emph{lexical scope} of a package field definition, this
5518 identifier resolves to the package being defined.
5519
5520 The example below shows how to add a package as a native input of itself when
5521 cross-compiling:
5522
5523 @lisp
5524 (package
5525 (name "guile")
5526 ;; ...
5527
5528 ;; When cross-compiled, Guile, for example, depends on
5529 ;; a native version of itself. Add it here.
5530 (native-inputs (if (%current-target-system)
5531 `(("self" ,this-package))
5532 '())))
5533 @end lisp
5534
5535 It is an error to refer to @code{this-package} outside a package definition.
5536 @end deffn
5537
5538 @node origin Reference
5539 @subsection @code{origin} Reference
5540
5541 This section summarizes all the options available in @code{origin}
5542 declarations (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
5543
5544 @deftp {Data Type} origin
5545 This is the data type representing a source code origin.
5546
5547 @table @asis
5548 @item @code{uri}
5549 An object containing the URI of the source. The object type depends on
5550 the @code{method} (see below). For example, when using the
5551 @var{url-fetch} method of @code{(guix download)}, the valid @code{uri}
5552 values are: a URL represented as a string, or a list thereof.
5553
5554 @item @code{method}
5555 A procedure that handles the URI.
5556
5557 Examples include:
5558
5559 @table @asis
5560 @item @var{url-fetch} from @code{(guix download)}
5561 download a file from the HTTP, HTTPS, or FTP URL specified in the
5562 @code{uri} field;
5563
5564 @vindex git-fetch
5565 @item @var{git-fetch} from @code{(guix git-download)}
5566 clone the Git version control repository, and check out the revision
5567 specified in the @code{uri} field as a @code{git-reference} object; a
5568 @code{git-reference} looks like this:
5569
5570 @lisp
5571 (git-reference
5572 (url "https://git.savannah.gnu.org/git/hello.git")
5573 (commit "v2.10"))
5574 @end lisp
5575 @end table
5576
5577 @item @code{sha256}
5578 A bytevector containing the SHA-256 hash of the source. Typically the
5579 @code{base32} form is used here to generate the bytevector from a
5580 base-32 string.
5581
5582 You can obtain this information using @code{guix download}
5583 (@pxref{Invoking guix download}) or @code{guix hash} (@pxref{Invoking
5584 guix hash}).
5585
5586 @item @code{file-name} (default: @code{#f})
5587 The file name under which the source code should be saved. When this is
5588 @code{#f}, a sensible default value will be used in most cases. In case
5589 the source is fetched from a URL, the file name from the URL will be
5590 used. For version control checkouts, it is recommended to provide the
5591 file name explicitly because the default is not very descriptive.
5592
5593 @item @code{patches} (default: @code{'()})
5594 A list of file names, origins, or file-like objects (@pxref{G-Expressions,
5595 file-like objects}) pointing to patches to be applied to the source.
5596
5597 This list of patches must be unconditional. In particular, it cannot
5598 depend on the value of @code{%current-system} or
5599 @code{%current-target-system}.
5600
5601 @item @code{snippet} (default: @code{#f})
5602 A G-expression (@pxref{G-Expressions}) or S-expression that will be run
5603 in the source directory. This is a convenient way to modify the source,
5604 sometimes more convenient than a patch.
5605
5606 @item @code{patch-flags} (default: @code{'("-p1")})
5607 A list of command-line flags that should be passed to the @code{patch}
5608 command.
5609
5610 @item @code{patch-inputs} (default: @code{#f})
5611 Input packages or derivations to the patching process. When this is
5612 @code{#f}, the usual set of inputs necessary for patching are provided,
5613 such as GNU@tie{}Patch.
5614
5615 @item @code{modules} (default: @code{'()})
5616 A list of Guile modules that should be loaded during the patching
5617 process and while running the code in the @code{snippet} field.
5618
5619 @item @code{patch-guile} (default: @code{#f})
5620 The Guile package that should be used in the patching process. When
5621 this is @code{#f}, a sensible default is used.
5622 @end table
5623 @end deftp
5624
5625
5626 @node Build Systems
5627 @section Build Systems
5628
5629 @cindex build system
5630 Each package definition specifies a @dfn{build system} and arguments for
5631 that build system (@pxref{Defining Packages}). This @code{build-system}
5632 field represents the build procedure of the package, as well as implicit
5633 dependencies of that build procedure.
5634
5635 Build systems are @code{<build-system>} objects. The interface to
5636 create and manipulate them is provided by the @code{(guix build-system)}
5637 module, and actual build systems are exported by specific modules.
5638
5639 @cindex bag (low-level package representation)
5640 Under the hood, build systems first compile package objects to
5641 @dfn{bags}. A @dfn{bag} is like a package, but with less
5642 ornamentation---in other words, a bag is a lower-level representation of
5643 a package, which includes all the inputs of that package, including some
5644 that were implicitly added by the build system. This intermediate
5645 representation is then compiled to a derivation (@pxref{Derivations}).
5646
5647 Build systems accept an optional list of @dfn{arguments}. In package
5648 definitions, these are passed @i{via} the @code{arguments} field
5649 (@pxref{Defining Packages}). They are typically keyword arguments
5650 (@pxref{Optional Arguments, keyword arguments in Guile,, guile, GNU
5651 Guile Reference Manual}). The value of these arguments is usually
5652 evaluated in the @dfn{build stratum}---i.e., by a Guile process launched
5653 by the daemon (@pxref{Derivations}).
5654
5655 The main build system is @var{gnu-build-system}, which implements the
5656 standard build procedure for GNU and many other packages. It
5657 is provided by the @code{(guix build-system gnu)} module.
5658
5659 @defvr {Scheme Variable} gnu-build-system
5660 @var{gnu-build-system} represents the GNU Build System, and variants
5661 thereof (@pxref{Configuration, configuration and makefile conventions,,
5662 standards, GNU Coding Standards}).
5663
5664 @cindex build phases
5665 In a nutshell, packages using it are configured, built, and installed with
5666 the usual @code{./configure && make && make check && make install}
5667 command sequence. In practice, a few additional steps are often needed.
5668 All these steps are split up in separate @dfn{phases},
5669 notably@footnote{Please see the @code{(guix build gnu-build-system)}
5670 modules for more details about the build phases.}:
5671
5672 @table @code
5673 @item unpack
5674 Unpack the source tarball, and change the current directory to the
5675 extracted source tree. If the source is actually a directory, copy it
5676 to the build tree, and enter that directory.
5677
5678 @item patch-source-shebangs
5679 Patch shebangs encountered in source files so they refer to the right
5680 store file names. For instance, this changes @code{#!/bin/sh} to
5681 @code{#!/gnu/store/@dots{}-bash-4.3/bin/sh}.
5682
5683 @item configure
5684 Run the @file{configure} script with a number of default options, such
5685 as @code{--prefix=/gnu/store/@dots{}}, as well as the options specified
5686 by the @code{#:configure-flags} argument.
5687
5688 @item build
5689 Run @code{make} with the list of flags specified with
5690 @code{#:make-flags}. If the @code{#:parallel-build?} argument is true
5691 (the default), build with @code{make -j}.
5692
5693 @item check
5694 Run @code{make check}, or some other target specified with
5695 @code{#:test-target}, unless @code{#:tests? #f} is passed. If the
5696 @code{#:parallel-tests?} argument is true (the default), run @code{make
5697 check -j}.
5698
5699 @item install
5700 Run @code{make install} with the flags listed in @code{#:make-flags}.
5701
5702 @item patch-shebangs
5703 Patch shebangs on the installed executable files.
5704
5705 @item strip
5706 Strip debugging symbols from ELF files (unless @code{#:strip-binaries?}
5707 is false), copying them to the @code{debug} output when available
5708 (@pxref{Installing Debugging Files}).
5709 @end table
5710
5711 @vindex %standard-phases
5712 The build-side module @code{(guix build gnu-build-system)} defines
5713 @var{%standard-phases} as the default list of build phases.
5714 @var{%standard-phases} is a list of symbol/procedure pairs, where the
5715 procedure implements the actual phase.
5716
5717 The list of phases used for a particular package can be changed with the
5718 @code{#:phases} parameter. For instance, passing:
5719
5720 @example
5721 #:phases (modify-phases %standard-phases (delete 'configure))
5722 @end example
5723
5724 means that all the phases described above will be used, except the
5725 @code{configure} phase.
5726
5727 In addition, this build system ensures that the ``standard'' environment
5728 for GNU packages is available. This includes tools such as GCC, libc,
5729 Coreutils, Bash, Make, Diffutils, grep, and sed (see the @code{(guix
5730 build-system gnu)} module for a complete list). We call these the
5731 @dfn{implicit inputs} of a package, because package definitions do not
5732 have to mention them.
5733 @end defvr
5734
5735 Other @code{<build-system>} objects are defined to support other
5736 conventions and tools used by free software packages. They inherit most
5737 of @var{gnu-build-system}, and differ mainly in the set of inputs
5738 implicitly added to the build process, and in the list of phases
5739 executed. Some of these build systems are listed below.
5740
5741 @defvr {Scheme Variable} ant-build-system
5742 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system ant)}. It
5743 implements the build procedure for Java packages that can be built with
5744 @url{https://ant.apache.org/, Ant build tool}.
5745
5746 It adds both @code{ant} and the @dfn{Java Development Kit} (JDK) as
5747 provided by the @code{icedtea} package to the set of inputs. Different
5748 packages can be specified with the @code{#:ant} and @code{#:jdk}
5749 parameters, respectively.
5750
5751 When the original package does not provide a suitable Ant build file,
5752 the parameter @code{#:jar-name} can be used to generate a minimal Ant
5753 build file @file{build.xml} with tasks to build the specified jar
5754 archive. In this case the parameter @code{#:source-dir} can be used to
5755 specify the source sub-directory, defaulting to ``src''.
5756
5757 The @code{#:main-class} parameter can be used with the minimal ant
5758 buildfile to specify the main class of the resulting jar. This makes the
5759 jar file executable. The @code{#:test-include} parameter can be used to
5760 specify the list of junit tests to run. It defaults to
5761 @code{(list "**/*Test.java")}. The @code{#:test-exclude} can be used to
5762 disable some tests. It defaults to @code{(list "**/Abstract*.java")},
5763 because abstract classes cannot be run as tests.
5764
5765 The parameter @code{#:build-target} can be used to specify the Ant task
5766 that should be run during the @code{build} phase. By default the
5767 ``jar'' task will be run.
5768
5769 @end defvr
5770
5771 @defvr {Scheme Variable} android-ndk-build-system
5772 @cindex Android distribution
5773 @cindex Android NDK build system
5774 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system android-ndk)}. It
5775 implements a build procedure for Android NDK (native development kit)
5776 packages using a Guix-specific build process.
5777
5778 The build system assumes that packages install their public interface
5779 (header) files to the subdirectory "include" of the "out" output and
5780 their libraries to the subdirectory "lib" of the "out" output.
5781
5782 It's also assumed that the union of all the dependencies of a package
5783 has no conflicting files.
5784
5785 For the time being, cross-compilation is not supported - so right now
5786 the libraries and header files are assumed to be host tools.
5787
5788 @end defvr
5789
5790 @defvr {Scheme Variable} asdf-build-system/source
5791 @defvrx {Scheme Variable} asdf-build-system/sbcl
5792 @defvrx {Scheme Variable} asdf-build-system/ecl
5793
5794 These variables, exported by @code{(guix build-system asdf)}, implement
5795 build procedures for Common Lisp packages using
5796 @url{https://common-lisp.net/project/asdf/, ``ASDF''}. ASDF is a system
5797 definition facility for Common Lisp programs and libraries.
5798
5799 The @code{asdf-build-system/source} system installs the packages in
5800 source form, and can be loaded using any common lisp implementation, via
5801 ASDF. The others, such as @code{asdf-build-system/sbcl}, install binary
5802 systems in the format which a particular implementation understands.
5803 These build systems can also be used to produce executable programs, or
5804 lisp images which contain a set of packages pre-loaded.
5805
5806 The build system uses naming conventions. For binary packages, the
5807 package name should be prefixed with the lisp implementation, such as
5808 @code{sbcl-} for @code{asdf-build-system/sbcl}.
5809
5810 Additionally, the corresponding source package should be labeled using
5811 the same convention as python packages (see @ref{Python Modules}), using
5812 the @code{cl-} prefix.
5813
5814 For binary packages, each system should be defined as a Guix package.
5815 If one package @code{origin} contains several systems, package variants
5816 can be created in order to build all the systems. Source packages,
5817 which use @code{asdf-build-system/source}, may contain several systems.
5818
5819 In order to create executable programs and images, the build-side
5820 procedures @code{build-program} and @code{build-image} can be used.
5821 They should be called in a build phase after the @code{create-symlinks}
5822 phase, so that the system which was just built can be used within the
5823 resulting image. @code{build-program} requires a list of Common Lisp
5824 expressions to be passed as the @code{#:entry-program} argument.
5825
5826 If the system is not defined within its own @code{.asd} file of the same
5827 name, then the @code{#:asd-file} parameter should be used to specify
5828 which file the system is defined in. Furthermore, if the package
5829 defines a system for its tests in a separate file, it will be loaded
5830 before the tests are run if it is specified by the
5831 @code{#:test-asd-file} parameter. If it is not set, the files
5832 @code{<system>-tests.asd}, @code{<system>-test.asd}, @code{tests.asd},
5833 and @code{test.asd} will be tried if they exist.
5834
5835 If for some reason the package must be named in a different way than the
5836 naming conventions suggest, the @code{#:asd-system-name} parameter can
5837 be used to specify the name of the system.
5838
5839 @end defvr
5840
5841 @defvr {Scheme Variable} cargo-build-system
5842 @cindex Rust programming language
5843 @cindex Cargo (Rust build system)
5844 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system cargo)}. It
5845 supports builds of packages using Cargo, the build tool of the
5846 @uref{https://www.rust-lang.org, Rust programming language}.
5847
5848 It adds @code{rustc} and @code{cargo} to the set of inputs.
5849 A different Rust package can be specified with the @code{#:rust} parameter.
5850
5851 Regular cargo dependencies should be added to the package definition via the
5852 @code{#:cargo-inputs} parameter as a list of name and spec pairs, where the
5853 spec can be a package or a source definition. Note that the spec must
5854 evaluate to a path to a gzipped tarball which includes a @code{Cargo.toml}
5855 file at its root, or it will be ignored. Similarly, cargo dev-dependencies
5856 should be added to the package definition via the
5857 @code{#:cargo-development-inputs} parameter.
5858
5859 In its @code{configure} phase, this build system will make any source inputs
5860 specified in the @code{#:cargo-inputs} and @code{#:cargo-development-inputs}
5861 parameters available to cargo. It will also remove an included
5862 @code{Cargo.lock} file to be recreated by @code{cargo} during the
5863 @code{build} phase. The @code{install} phase installs any crate the binaries
5864 if they are defined by the crate.
5865 @end defvr
5866
5867 @cindex Clojure (programming language)
5868 @cindex simple Clojure build system
5869 @defvr {Scheme Variable} clojure-build-system
5870 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system clojure)}. It implements
5871 a simple build procedure for @uref{https://clojure.org/, Clojure} packages
5872 using plain old @code{compile} in Clojure. Cross-compilation is not supported
5873 yet.
5874
5875 It adds @code{clojure}, @code{icedtea} and @code{zip} to the set of inputs.
5876 Different packages can be specified with the @code{#:clojure}, @code{#:jdk} and
5877 @code{#:zip} parameters, respectively.
5878
5879 A list of source directories, test directories and jar names can be specified
5880 with the @code{#:source-dirs}, @code{#:test-dirs} and @code{#:jar-names}
5881 parameters, respectively. Compile directory and main class can be specified
5882 with the @code{#:compile-dir} and @code{#:main-class} parameters, respectively.
5883 Other parameters are documented below.
5884
5885 This build system is an extension of @var{ant-build-system}, but with the
5886 following phases changed:
5887
5888 @table @code
5889
5890 @item build
5891 This phase calls @code{compile} in Clojure to compile source files and runs
5892 @command{jar} to create jars from both source files and compiled files
5893 according to the include list and exclude list specified in
5894 @code{#:aot-include} and @code{#:aot-exclude}, respectively. The exclude list
5895 has priority over the include list. These lists consist of symbols
5896 representing Clojure libraries or the special keyword @code{#:all} representing
5897 all Clojure libraries found under the source directories. The parameter
5898 @code{#:omit-source?} decides if source should be included into the jars.
5899
5900 @item check
5901 This phase runs tests according to the include list and exclude list specified
5902 in @code{#:test-include} and @code{#:test-exclude}, respectively. Their
5903 meanings are analogous to that of @code{#:aot-include} and
5904 @code{#:aot-exclude}, except that the special keyword @code{#:all} now
5905 stands for all Clojure libraries found under the test directories. The
5906 parameter @code{#:tests?} decides if tests should be run.
5907
5908 @item install
5909 This phase installs all jars built previously.
5910 @end table
5911
5912 Apart from the above, this build system also contains an additional phase:
5913
5914 @table @code
5915
5916 @item install-doc
5917 This phase installs all top-level files with base name matching
5918 @var{%doc-regex}. A different regex can be specified with the
5919 @code{#:doc-regex} parameter. All files (recursively) inside the documentation
5920 directories specified in @code{#:doc-dirs} are installed as well.
5921 @end table
5922 @end defvr
5923
5924 @defvr {Scheme Variable} cmake-build-system
5925 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system cmake)}. It
5926 implements the build procedure for packages using the
5927 @url{https://www.cmake.org, CMake build tool}.
5928
5929 It automatically adds the @code{cmake} package to the set of inputs.
5930 Which package is used can be specified with the @code{#:cmake}
5931 parameter.
5932
5933 The @code{#:configure-flags} parameter is taken as a list of flags
5934 passed to the @command{cmake} command. The @code{#:build-type}
5935 parameter specifies in abstract terms the flags passed to the compiler;
5936 it defaults to @code{"RelWithDebInfo"} (short for ``release mode with
5937 debugging information''), which roughly means that code is compiled with
5938 @code{-O2 -g}, as is the case for Autoconf-based packages by default.
5939 @end defvr
5940
5941 @defvr {Scheme Variable} dune-build-system
5942 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system dune)}. It
5943 supports builds of packages using @uref{https://dune.build/, Dune}, a build
5944 tool for the OCaml programming language. It is implemented as an extension
5945 of the @code{ocaml-build-system} which is described below. As such, the
5946 @code{#:ocaml} and @code{#:findlib} parameters can be passed to this build
5947 system.
5948
5949 It automatically adds the @code{dune} package to the set of inputs.
5950 Which package is used can be specified with the @code{#:dune}
5951 parameter.
5952
5953 There is no @code{configure} phase because dune packages typically don't
5954 need to be configured. The @code{#:build-flags} parameter is taken as a
5955 list of flags passed to the @code{dune} command during the build.
5956
5957 The @code{#:jbuild?} parameter can be passed to use the @code{jbuild}
5958 command instead of the more recent @code{dune} command while building
5959 a package. Its default value is @code{#f}.
5960
5961 The @code{#:package} parameter can be passed to specify a package name, which
5962 is useful when a package contains multiple packages and you want to build
5963 only one of them. This is equivalent to passing the @code{-p} argument to
5964 @code{dune}.
5965 @end defvr
5966
5967 @defvr {Scheme Variable} go-build-system
5968 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system go)}. It
5969 implements a build procedure for Go packages using the standard
5970 @url{https://golang.org/cmd/go/#hdr-Compile_packages_and_dependencies,
5971 Go build mechanisms}.
5972
5973 The user is expected to provide a value for the key @code{#:import-path}
5974 and, in some cases, @code{#:unpack-path}. The
5975 @url{https://golang.org/doc/code.html#ImportPaths, import path}
5976 corresponds to the file system path expected by the package's build
5977 scripts and any referring packages, and provides a unique way to
5978 refer to a Go package. It is typically based on a combination of the
5979 package source code's remote URI and file system hierarchy structure. In
5980 some cases, you will need to unpack the package's source code to a
5981 different directory structure than the one indicated by the import path,
5982 and @code{#:unpack-path} should be used in such cases.
5983
5984 Packages that provide Go libraries should install their source code into
5985 the built output. The key @code{#:install-source?}, which defaults to
5986 @code{#t}, controls whether or not the source code is installed. It can
5987 be set to @code{#f} for packages that only provide executable files.
5988 @end defvr
5989
5990 @defvr {Scheme Variable} glib-or-gtk-build-system
5991 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system glib-or-gtk)}. It
5992 is intended for use with packages making use of GLib or GTK+.
5993
5994 This build system adds the following two phases to the ones defined by
5995 @var{gnu-build-system}:
5996
5997 @table @code
5998 @item glib-or-gtk-wrap
5999 The phase @code{glib-or-gtk-wrap} ensures that programs in
6000 @file{bin/} are able to find GLib ``schemas'' and
6001 @uref{https://developer.gnome.org/gtk3/stable/gtk-running.html, GTK+
6002 modules}. This is achieved by wrapping the programs in launch scripts
6003 that appropriately set the @code{XDG_DATA_DIRS} and @code{GTK_PATH}
6004 environment variables.
6005
6006 It is possible to exclude specific package outputs from that wrapping
6007 process by listing their names in the
6008 @code{#:glib-or-gtk-wrap-excluded-outputs} parameter. This is useful
6009 when an output is known not to contain any GLib or GTK+ binaries, and
6010 where wrapping would gratuitously add a dependency of that output on
6011 GLib and GTK+.
6012
6013 @item glib-or-gtk-compile-schemas
6014 The phase @code{glib-or-gtk-compile-schemas} makes sure that all
6015 @uref{https://developer.gnome.org/gio/stable/glib-compile-schemas.html,
6016 GSettings schemas} of GLib are compiled. Compilation is performed by the
6017 @command{glib-compile-schemas} program. It is provided by the package
6018 @code{glib:bin} which is automatically imported by the build system.
6019 The @code{glib} package providing @command{glib-compile-schemas} can be
6020 specified with the @code{#:glib} parameter.
6021 @end table
6022
6023 Both phases are executed after the @code{install} phase.
6024 @end defvr
6025
6026 @defvr {Scheme Variable} guile-build-system
6027 This build system is for Guile packages that consist exclusively of Scheme
6028 code and that are so lean that they don't even have a makefile, let alone a
6029 @file{configure} script. It compiles Scheme code using @command{guild
6030 compile} (@pxref{Compilation,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}) and
6031 installs the @file{.scm} and @file{.go} files in the right place. It also
6032 installs documentation.
6033
6034 This build system supports cross-compilation by using the @code{--target}
6035 option of @command{guild compile}.
6036
6037 Packages built with @code{guile-build-system} must provide a Guile package in
6038 their @code{native-inputs} field.
6039 @end defvr
6040
6041 @defvr {Scheme Variable} julia-build-system
6042 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system julia)}. It implements
6043 the build procedure used by @uref{https://julialang.org/, julia} packages,
6044 which essentially is similar to running @command{julia -e 'using Pkg;
6045 Pkg.add(package)'} in an environment where @code{JULIA_LOAD_PATH} contains the
6046 paths to all Julia package inputs. Tests are run not run.
6047
6048 Julia packages require the source @code{file-name} to be the real name of the
6049 package, correctly capitalized.
6050
6051 For packages requiring shared library dependencies, you may need to write the
6052 @file{/deps/deps.jl} file manually. It's usually a line of @code{const
6053 variable = /gnu/store/libary.so} for each dependency, plus a void function
6054 @code{check_deps() = nothing}.
6055
6056 Some older packages that aren't using @file{Package.toml} yet, will require
6057 this file to be created, too. The function @code{julia-create-package-toml}
6058 helps creating the file. You need to pass the outputs and the source of the
6059 package, it's name (the same as the @code{file-name} parameter), the package
6060 uuid, the package version, and a list of dependencies specified by their name
6061 and their uuid.
6062 @end defvr
6063
6064 @defvr {Scheme Variable} minify-build-system
6065 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system minify)}. It
6066 implements a minification procedure for simple JavaScript packages.
6067
6068 It adds @code{uglify-js} to the set of inputs and uses it to compress
6069 all JavaScript files in the @file{src} directory. A different minifier
6070 package can be specified with the @code{#:uglify-js} parameter, but it
6071 is expected that the package writes the minified code to the standard
6072 output.
6073
6074 When the input JavaScript files are not all located in the @file{src}
6075 directory, the parameter @code{#:javascript-files} can be used to
6076 specify a list of file names to feed to the minifier.
6077 @end defvr
6078
6079 @defvr {Scheme Variable} ocaml-build-system
6080 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system ocaml)}. It implements
6081 a build procedure for @uref{https://ocaml.org, OCaml} packages, which consists
6082 of choosing the correct set of commands to run for each package. OCaml
6083 packages can expect many different commands to be run. This build system will
6084 try some of them.
6085
6086 When the package has a @file{setup.ml} file present at the top-level, it will
6087 run @code{ocaml setup.ml -configure}, @code{ocaml setup.ml -build} and
6088 @code{ocaml setup.ml -install}. The build system will assume that this file
6089 was generated by @uref{http://oasis.forge.ocamlcore.org/, OASIS} and will take
6090 care of setting the prefix and enabling tests if they are not disabled. You
6091 can pass configure and build flags with the @code{#:configure-flags} and
6092 @code{#:build-flags}. The @code{#:test-flags} key can be passed to change the
6093 set of flags used to enable tests. The @code{#:use-make?} key can be used to
6094 bypass this system in the build and install phases.
6095
6096 When the package has a @file{configure} file, it is assumed that it is a
6097 hand-made configure script that requires a different argument format than
6098 in the @code{gnu-build-system}. You can add more flags with the
6099 @code{#:configure-flags} key.
6100
6101 When the package has a @file{Makefile} file (or @code{#:use-make?} is
6102 @code{#t}), it will be used and more flags can be passed to the build and
6103 install phases with the @code{#:make-flags} key.
6104
6105 Finally, some packages do not have these files and use a somewhat standard
6106 location for its build system. In that case, the build system will run
6107 @code{ocaml pkg/pkg.ml} or @code{ocaml pkg/build.ml} and take care of
6108 providing the path to the required findlib module. Additional flags can
6109 be passed via the @code{#:build-flags} key. Install is taken care of by
6110 @command{opam-installer}. In this case, the @code{opam} package must
6111 be added to the @code{native-inputs} field of the package definition.
6112
6113 Note that most OCaml packages assume they will be installed in the same
6114 directory as OCaml, which is not what we want in guix. In particular, they
6115 will install @file{.so} files in their module's directory, which is usually
6116 fine because it is in the OCaml compiler directory. In guix though, these
6117 libraries cannot be found and we use @code{CAML_LD_LIBRARY_PATH}. This
6118 variable points to @file{lib/ocaml/site-lib/stubslibs} and this is where
6119 @file{.so} libraries should be installed.
6120 @end defvr
6121
6122 @defvr {Scheme Variable} python-build-system
6123 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system python)}. It
6124 implements the more or less standard build procedure used by Python
6125 packages, which consists in running @code{python setup.py build} and
6126 then @code{python setup.py install --prefix=/gnu/store/@dots{}}.
6127
6128 For packages that install stand-alone Python programs under @code{bin/},
6129 it takes care of wrapping these programs so that their @code{PYTHONPATH}
6130 environment variable points to all the Python libraries they depend on.
6131
6132 Which Python package is used to perform the build can be specified with
6133 the @code{#:python} parameter. This is a useful way to force a package
6134 to be built for a specific version of the Python interpreter, which
6135 might be necessary if the package is only compatible with a single
6136 interpreter version.
6137
6138 By default guix calls @code{setup.py} under control of
6139 @code{setuptools}, much like @command{pip} does. Some packages are not
6140 compatible with setuptools (and pip), thus you can disable this by
6141 setting the @code{#:use-setuptools?} parameter to @code{#f}.
6142 @end defvr
6143
6144 @defvr {Scheme Variable} perl-build-system
6145 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system perl)}. It
6146 implements the standard build procedure for Perl packages, which either
6147 consists in running @code{perl Build.PL --prefix=/gnu/store/@dots{}},
6148 followed by @code{Build} and @code{Build install}; or in running
6149 @code{perl Makefile.PL PREFIX=/gnu/store/@dots{}}, followed by
6150 @code{make} and @code{make install}, depending on which of
6151 @code{Build.PL} or @code{Makefile.PL} is present in the package
6152 distribution. Preference is given to the former if both @code{Build.PL}
6153 and @code{Makefile.PL} exist in the package distribution. This
6154 preference can be reversed by specifying @code{#t} for the
6155 @code{#:make-maker?} parameter.
6156
6157 The initial @code{perl Makefile.PL} or @code{perl Build.PL} invocation
6158 passes flags specified by the @code{#:make-maker-flags} or
6159 @code{#:module-build-flags} parameter, respectively.
6160
6161 Which Perl package is used can be specified with @code{#:perl}.
6162 @end defvr
6163
6164 @defvr {Scheme Variable} r-build-system
6165 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system r)}. It
6166 implements the build procedure used by @uref{https://r-project.org, R}
6167 packages, which essentially is little more than running @code{R CMD
6168 INSTALL --library=/gnu/store/@dots{}} in an environment where
6169 @code{R_LIBS_SITE} contains the paths to all R package inputs. Tests
6170 are run after installation using the R function
6171 @code{tools::testInstalledPackage}.
6172 @end defvr
6173
6174 @defvr {Scheme Variable} rakudo-build-system
6175 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system rakudo)}. It
6176 implements the build procedure used by @uref{https://rakudo.org/,
6177 Rakudo} for @uref{https://perl6.org/, Perl6} packages. It installs the
6178 package to @code{/gnu/store/@dots{}/NAME-VERSION/share/perl6} and
6179 installs the binaries, library files and the resources, as well as wrap
6180 the files under the @code{bin/} directory. Tests can be skipped by
6181 passing @code{#f} to the @code{tests?} parameter.
6182
6183 Which rakudo package is used can be specified with @code{rakudo}.
6184 Which perl6-tap-harness package used for the tests can be specified with
6185 @code{#:prove6} or removed by passing @code{#f} to the
6186 @code{with-prove6?} parameter.
6187 Which perl6-zef package used for tests and installing can be specified
6188 with @code{#:zef} or removed by passing @code{#f} to the
6189 @code{with-zef?} parameter.
6190 @end defvr
6191
6192 @defvr {Scheme Variable} texlive-build-system
6193 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system texlive)}. It is
6194 used to build TeX packages in batch mode with a specified engine. The
6195 build system sets the @code{TEXINPUTS} variable to find all TeX source
6196 files in the inputs.
6197
6198 By default it runs @code{luatex} on all files ending on @code{ins}. A
6199 different engine and format can be specified with the
6200 @code{#:tex-format} argument. Different build targets can be specified
6201 with the @code{#:build-targets} argument, which expects a list of file
6202 names. The build system adds only @code{texlive-bin} and
6203 @code{texlive-latex-base} (both from @code{(gnu packages tex}) to the
6204 inputs. Both can be overridden with the arguments @code{#:texlive-bin}
6205 and @code{#:texlive-latex-base}, respectively.
6206
6207 The @code{#:tex-directory} parameter tells the build system where to
6208 install the built files under the texmf tree.
6209 @end defvr
6210
6211 @defvr {Scheme Variable} ruby-build-system
6212 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system ruby)}. It
6213 implements the RubyGems build procedure used by Ruby packages, which
6214 involves running @code{gem build} followed by @code{gem install}.
6215
6216 The @code{source} field of a package that uses this build system
6217 typically references a gem archive, since this is the format that Ruby
6218 developers use when releasing their software. The build system unpacks
6219 the gem archive, potentially patches the source, runs the test suite,
6220 repackages the gem, and installs it. Additionally, directories and
6221 tarballs may be referenced to allow building unreleased gems from Git or
6222 a traditional source release tarball.
6223
6224 Which Ruby package is used can be specified with the @code{#:ruby}
6225 parameter. A list of additional flags to be passed to the @command{gem}
6226 command can be specified with the @code{#:gem-flags} parameter.
6227 @end defvr
6228
6229 @defvr {Scheme Variable} waf-build-system
6230 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system waf)}. It
6231 implements a build procedure around the @code{waf} script. The common
6232 phases---@code{configure}, @code{build}, and @code{install}---are
6233 implemented by passing their names as arguments to the @code{waf}
6234 script.
6235
6236 The @code{waf} script is executed by the Python interpreter. Which
6237 Python package is used to run the script can be specified with the
6238 @code{#:python} parameter.
6239 @end defvr
6240
6241 @defvr {Scheme Variable} scons-build-system
6242 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system scons)}. It
6243 implements the build procedure used by the SCons software construction
6244 tool. This build system runs @code{scons} to build the package,
6245 @code{scons test} to run tests, and then @code{scons install} to install
6246 the package.
6247
6248 Additional flags to be passed to @code{scons} can be specified with the
6249 @code{#:scons-flags} parameter. The version of Python used to run SCons
6250 can be specified by selecting the appropriate SCons package with the
6251 @code{#:scons} parameter.
6252 @end defvr
6253
6254 @defvr {Scheme Variable} haskell-build-system
6255 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system haskell)}. It
6256 implements the Cabal build procedure used by Haskell packages, which
6257 involves running @code{runhaskell Setup.hs configure
6258 --prefix=/gnu/store/@dots{}} and @code{runhaskell Setup.hs build}.
6259 Instead of installing the package by running @code{runhaskell Setup.hs
6260 install}, to avoid trying to register libraries in the read-only
6261 compiler store directory, the build system uses @code{runhaskell
6262 Setup.hs copy}, followed by @code{runhaskell Setup.hs register}. In
6263 addition, the build system generates the package documentation by
6264 running @code{runhaskell Setup.hs haddock}, unless @code{#:haddock? #f}
6265 is passed. Optional Haddock parameters can be passed with the help of
6266 the @code{#:haddock-flags} parameter. If the file @code{Setup.hs} is
6267 not found, the build system looks for @code{Setup.lhs} instead.
6268
6269 Which Haskell compiler is used can be specified with the @code{#:haskell}
6270 parameter which defaults to @code{ghc}.
6271 @end defvr
6272
6273 @defvr {Scheme Variable} dub-build-system
6274 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system dub)}. It
6275 implements the Dub build procedure used by D packages, which
6276 involves running @code{dub build} and @code{dub run}.
6277 Installation is done by copying the files manually.
6278
6279 Which D compiler is used can be specified with the @code{#:ldc}
6280 parameter which defaults to @code{ldc}.
6281 @end defvr
6282
6283 @defvr {Scheme Variable} emacs-build-system
6284 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system emacs)}. It
6285 implements an installation procedure similar to the packaging system
6286 of Emacs itself (@pxref{Packages,,, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}).
6287
6288 It first creates the @code{@var{package}-autoloads.el} file, then it
6289 byte compiles all Emacs Lisp files. Differently from the Emacs
6290 packaging system, the Info documentation files are moved to the standard
6291 documentation directory and the @file{dir} file is deleted. Each
6292 package is installed in its own directory under
6293 @file{share/emacs/site-lisp/guix.d}.
6294 @end defvr
6295
6296 @defvr {Scheme Variable} font-build-system
6297 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system font)}. It
6298 implements an installation procedure for font packages where upstream
6299 provides pre-compiled TrueType, OpenType, etc.@: font files that merely
6300 need to be copied into place. It copies font files to standard
6301 locations in the output directory.
6302 @end defvr
6303
6304 @defvr {Scheme Variable} meson-build-system
6305 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system meson)}. It
6306 implements the build procedure for packages that use
6307 @url{https://mesonbuild.com, Meson} as their build system.
6308
6309 It adds both Meson and @uref{https://ninja-build.org/, Ninja} to the set
6310 of inputs, and they can be changed with the parameters @code{#:meson}
6311 and @code{#:ninja} if needed. The default Meson is
6312 @code{meson-for-build}, which is special because it doesn't clear the
6313 @code{RUNPATH} of binaries and libraries when they are installed.
6314
6315 This build system is an extension of @var{gnu-build-system}, but with the
6316 following phases changed to some specific for Meson:
6317
6318 @table @code
6319
6320 @item configure
6321 The phase runs @code{meson} with the flags specified in
6322 @code{#:configure-flags}. The flag @code{--build-type} is always set to
6323 @code{plain} unless something else is specified in @code{#:build-type}.
6324
6325 @item build
6326 The phase runs @code{ninja} to build the package in parallel by default, but
6327 this can be changed with @code{#:parallel-build?}.
6328
6329 @item check
6330 The phase runs @code{ninja} with the target specified in @code{#:test-target},
6331 which is @code{"test"} by default.
6332
6333 @item install
6334 The phase runs @code{ninja install} and can not be changed.
6335 @end table
6336
6337 Apart from that, the build system also adds the following phases:
6338
6339 @table @code
6340
6341 @item fix-runpath
6342 This phase ensures that all binaries can find the libraries they need.
6343 It searches for required libraries in subdirectories of the package being
6344 built, and adds those to @code{RUNPATH} where needed. It also removes
6345 references to libraries left over from the build phase by
6346 @code{meson-for-build}, such as test dependencies, that aren't actually
6347 required for the program to run.
6348
6349 @item glib-or-gtk-wrap
6350 This phase is the phase provided by @code{glib-or-gtk-build-system}, and it
6351 is not enabled by default. It can be enabled with @code{#:glib-or-gtk?}.
6352
6353 @item glib-or-gtk-compile-schemas
6354 This phase is the phase provided by @code{glib-or-gtk-build-system}, and it
6355 is not enabled by default. It can be enabled with @code{#:glib-or-gtk?}.
6356 @end table
6357 @end defvr
6358
6359 @defvr {Scheme Variable} linux-module-build-system
6360 @var{linux-module-build-system} allows building Linux kernel modules.
6361
6362 @cindex build phases
6363 This build system is an extension of @var{gnu-build-system}, but with the
6364 following phases changed:
6365
6366 @table @code
6367
6368 @item configure
6369 This phase configures the environment so that the Linux kernel's Makefile
6370 can be used to build the external kernel module.
6371
6372 @item build
6373 This phase uses the Linux kernel's Makefile in order to build the external
6374 kernel module.
6375
6376 @item install
6377 This phase uses the Linux kernel's Makefile in order to install the external
6378 kernel module.
6379 @end table
6380
6381 It is possible and useful to specify the Linux kernel to use for building
6382 the module (in the "arguments" form of a package using the
6383 linux-module-build-system, use the key #:linux to specify it).
6384 @end defvr
6385
6386 @defvr {Scheme Variable} node-build-system
6387 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system node)}. It
6388 implements the build procedure used by @uref{http://nodejs.org,
6389 Node.js}, which implements an approximation of the @code{npm install}
6390 command, followed by an @code{npm test} command.
6391
6392 Which Node.js package is used to interpret the @code{npm} commands can
6393 be specified with the @code{#:node} parameter which defaults to
6394 @code{node}.
6395 @end defvr
6396
6397 Lastly, for packages that do not need anything as sophisticated, a
6398 ``trivial'' build system is provided. It is trivial in the sense that
6399 it provides basically no support: it does not pull any implicit inputs,
6400 and does not have a notion of build phases.
6401
6402 @defvr {Scheme Variable} trivial-build-system
6403 This variable is exported by @code{(guix build-system trivial)}.
6404
6405 This build system requires a @code{#:builder} argument. This argument
6406 must be a Scheme expression that builds the package output(s)---as
6407 with @code{build-expression->derivation} (@pxref{Derivations,
6408 @code{build-expression->derivation}}).
6409 @end defvr
6410
6411 @node The Store
6412 @section The Store
6413
6414 @cindex store
6415 @cindex store items
6416 @cindex store paths
6417
6418 Conceptually, the @dfn{store} is the place where derivations that have
6419 been built successfully are stored---by default, @file{/gnu/store}.
6420 Sub-directories in the store are referred to as @dfn{store items} or
6421 sometimes @dfn{store paths}. The store has an associated database that
6422 contains information such as the store paths referred to by each store
6423 path, and the list of @emph{valid} store items---results of successful
6424 builds. This database resides in @file{@var{localstatedir}/guix/db},
6425 where @var{localstatedir} is the state directory specified @i{via}
6426 @option{--localstatedir} at configure time, usually @file{/var}.
6427
6428 The store is @emph{always} accessed by the daemon on behalf of its clients
6429 (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon}). To manipulate the store, clients
6430 connect to the daemon over a Unix-domain socket, send requests to it,
6431 and read the result---these are remote procedure calls, or RPCs.
6432
6433 @quotation Note
6434 Users must @emph{never} modify files under @file{/gnu/store} directly.
6435 This would lead to inconsistencies and break the immutability
6436 assumptions of Guix's functional model (@pxref{Introduction}).
6437
6438 @xref{Invoking guix gc, @command{guix gc --verify}}, for information on
6439 how to check the integrity of the store and attempt recovery from
6440 accidental modifications.
6441 @end quotation
6442
6443 The @code{(guix store)} module provides procedures to connect to the
6444 daemon, and to perform RPCs. These are described below. By default,
6445 @code{open-connection}, and thus all the @command{guix} commands,
6446 connect to the local daemon or to the URI specified by the
6447 @code{GUIX_DAEMON_SOCKET} environment variable.
6448
6449 @defvr {Environment Variable} GUIX_DAEMON_SOCKET
6450 When set, the value of this variable should be a file name or a URI
6451 designating the daemon endpoint. When it is a file name, it denotes a
6452 Unix-domain socket to connect to. In addition to file names, the
6453 supported URI schemes are:
6454
6455 @table @code
6456 @item file
6457 @itemx unix
6458 These are for Unix-domain sockets.
6459 @code{file:///var/guix/daemon-socket/socket} is equivalent to
6460 @file{/var/guix/daemon-socket/socket}.
6461
6462 @item guix
6463 @cindex daemon, remote access
6464 @cindex remote access to the daemon
6465 @cindex daemon, cluster setup
6466 @cindex clusters, daemon setup
6467 These URIs denote connections over TCP/IP, without encryption nor
6468 authentication of the remote host. The URI must specify the host name
6469 and optionally a port number (by default port 44146 is used):
6470
6471 @example
6472 guix://master.guix.example.org:1234
6473 @end example
6474
6475 This setup is suitable on local networks, such as clusters, where only
6476 trusted nodes may connect to the build daemon at
6477 @code{master.guix.example.org}.
6478
6479 The @code{--listen} option of @command{guix-daemon} can be used to
6480 instruct it to listen for TCP connections (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon,
6481 @code{--listen}}).
6482
6483 @item ssh
6484 @cindex SSH access to build daemons
6485 These URIs allow you to connect to a remote daemon over
6486 SSH@footnote{This feature requires Guile-SSH (@pxref{Requirements}).}.
6487 A typical URL might look like this:
6488
6489 @example
6490 ssh://charlie@@guix.example.org:22
6491 @end example
6492
6493 As for @command{guix copy}, the usual OpenSSH client configuration files
6494 are honored (@pxref{Invoking guix copy}).
6495 @end table
6496
6497 Additional URI schemes may be supported in the future.
6498
6499 @c XXX: Remove this note when the protocol incurs fewer round trips
6500 @c and when (guix derivations) no longer relies on file system access.
6501 @quotation Note
6502 The ability to connect to remote build daemons is considered
6503 experimental as of @value{VERSION}. Please get in touch with us to
6504 share any problems or suggestions you may have (@pxref{Contributing}).
6505 @end quotation
6506 @end defvr
6507
6508 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} open-connection [@var{uri}] [#:reserve-space? #t]
6509 Connect to the daemon over the Unix-domain socket at @var{uri} (a string). When
6510 @var{reserve-space?} is true, instruct it to reserve a little bit of
6511 extra space on the file system so that the garbage collector can still
6512 operate should the disk become full. Return a server object.
6513
6514 @var{file} defaults to @code{%default-socket-path}, which is the normal
6515 location given the options that were passed to @command{configure}.
6516 @end deffn
6517
6518 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} close-connection @var{server}
6519 Close the connection to @var{server}.
6520 @end deffn
6521
6522 @defvr {Scheme Variable} current-build-output-port
6523 This variable is bound to a SRFI-39 parameter, which refers to the port
6524 where build and error logs sent by the daemon should be written.
6525 @end defvr
6526
6527 Procedures that make RPCs all take a server object as their first
6528 argument.
6529
6530 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} valid-path? @var{server} @var{path}
6531 @cindex invalid store items
6532 Return @code{#t} when @var{path} designates a valid store item and
6533 @code{#f} otherwise (an invalid item may exist on disk but still be
6534 invalid, for instance because it is the result of an aborted or failed
6535 build.)
6536
6537 A @code{&store-protocol-error} condition is raised if @var{path} is not
6538 prefixed by the store directory (@file{/gnu/store}).
6539 @end deffn
6540
6541 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} add-text-to-store @var{server} @var{name} @var{text} [@var{references}]
6542 Add @var{text} under file @var{name} in the store, and return its store
6543 path. @var{references} is the list of store paths referred to by the
6544 resulting store path.
6545 @end deffn
6546
6547 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} build-derivations @var{store} @var{derivations} @
6548 [@var{mode}]
6549 Build @var{derivations}, a list of @code{<derivation>} objects, @file{.drv}
6550 file names, or derivation/output pairs, using the specified
6551 @var{mode}---@code{(build-mode normal)} by default.
6552 @end deffn
6553
6554 Note that the @code{(guix monads)} module provides a monad as well as
6555 monadic versions of the above procedures, with the goal of making it
6556 more convenient to work with code that accesses the store (@pxref{The
6557 Store Monad}).
6558
6559 @c FIXME
6560 @i{This section is currently incomplete.}
6561
6562 @node Derivations
6563 @section Derivations
6564
6565 @cindex derivations
6566 Low-level build actions and the environment in which they are performed
6567 are represented by @dfn{derivations}. A derivation contains the
6568 following pieces of information:
6569
6570 @itemize
6571 @item
6572 The outputs of the derivation---derivations produce at least one file or
6573 directory in the store, but may produce more.
6574
6575 @item
6576 @cindex build-time dependencies
6577 @cindex dependencies, build-time
6578 The inputs of the derivations---i.e., its build-time dependencies---which may
6579 be other derivations or plain files in the store (patches, build scripts,
6580 etc.)
6581
6582 @item
6583 The system type targeted by the derivation---e.g., @code{x86_64-linux}.
6584
6585 @item
6586 The file name of a build script in the store, along with the arguments
6587 to be passed.
6588
6589 @item
6590 A list of environment variables to be defined.
6591
6592 @end itemize
6593
6594 @cindex derivation path
6595 Derivations allow clients of the daemon to communicate build actions to
6596 the store. They exist in two forms: as an in-memory representation,
6597 both on the client- and daemon-side, and as files in the store whose
6598 name end in @code{.drv}---these files are referred to as @dfn{derivation
6599 paths}. Derivations paths can be passed to the @code{build-derivations}
6600 procedure to perform the build actions they prescribe (@pxref{The
6601 Store}).
6602
6603 @cindex fixed-output derivations
6604 Operations such as file downloads and version-control checkouts for
6605 which the expected content hash is known in advance are modeled as
6606 @dfn{fixed-output derivations}. Unlike regular derivations, the outputs
6607 of a fixed-output derivation are independent of its inputs---e.g., a
6608 source code download produces the same result regardless of the download
6609 method and tools being used.
6610
6611 @cindex references
6612 @cindex run-time dependencies
6613 @cindex dependencies, run-time
6614 The outputs of derivations---i.e., the build results---have a set of
6615 @dfn{references}, as reported by the @code{references} RPC or the
6616 @command{guix gc --references} command (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}). References
6617 are the set of run-time dependencies of the build results. References are a
6618 subset of the inputs of the derivation; this subset is automatically computed
6619 by the build daemon by scanning all the files in the outputs.
6620
6621 The @code{(guix derivations)} module provides a representation of
6622 derivations as Scheme objects, along with procedures to create and
6623 otherwise manipulate derivations. The lowest-level primitive to create
6624 a derivation is the @code{derivation} procedure:
6625
6626 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} derivation @var{store} @var{name} @var{builder} @
6627 @var{args} [#:outputs '("out")] [#:hash #f] [#:hash-algo #f] @
6628 [#:recursive? #f] [#:inputs '()] [#:env-vars '()] @
6629 [#:system (%current-system)] [#:references-graphs #f] @
6630 [#:allowed-references #f] [#:disallowed-references #f] @
6631 [#:leaked-env-vars #f] [#:local-build? #f] @
6632 [#:substitutable? #t] [#:properties '()]
6633 Build a derivation with the given arguments, and return the resulting
6634 @code{<derivation>} object.
6635
6636 When @var{hash} and @var{hash-algo} are given, a
6637 @dfn{fixed-output derivation} is created---i.e., one whose result is
6638 known in advance, such as a file download. If, in addition,
6639 @var{recursive?} is true, then that fixed output may be an executable
6640 file or a directory and @var{hash} must be the hash of an archive
6641 containing this output.
6642
6643 When @var{references-graphs} is true, it must be a list of file
6644 name/store path pairs. In that case, the reference graph of each store
6645 path is exported in the build environment in the corresponding file, in
6646 a simple text format.
6647
6648 When @var{allowed-references} is true, it must be a list of store items
6649 or outputs that the derivation's output may refer to. Likewise,
6650 @var{disallowed-references}, if true, must be a list of things the
6651 outputs may @emph{not} refer to.
6652
6653 When @var{leaked-env-vars} is true, it must be a list of strings
6654 denoting environment variables that are allowed to ``leak'' from the
6655 daemon's environment to the build environment. This is only applicable
6656 to fixed-output derivations---i.e., when @var{hash} is true. The main
6657 use is to allow variables such as @code{http_proxy} to be passed to
6658 derivations that download files.
6659
6660 When @var{local-build?} is true, declare that the derivation is not a
6661 good candidate for offloading and should rather be built locally
6662 (@pxref{Daemon Offload Setup}). This is the case for small derivations
6663 where the costs of data transfers would outweigh the benefits.
6664
6665 When @var{substitutable?} is false, declare that substitutes of the
6666 derivation's output should not be used (@pxref{Substitutes}). This is
6667 useful, for instance, when building packages that capture details of the
6668 host CPU instruction set.
6669
6670 @var{properties} must be an association list describing ``properties'' of the
6671 derivation. It is kept as-is, uninterpreted, in the derivation.
6672 @end deffn
6673
6674 @noindent
6675 Here's an example with a shell script as its builder, assuming
6676 @var{store} is an open connection to the daemon, and @var{bash} points
6677 to a Bash executable in the store:
6678
6679 @lisp
6680 (use-modules (guix utils)
6681 (guix store)
6682 (guix derivations))
6683
6684 (let ((builder ; add the Bash script to the store
6685 (add-text-to-store store "my-builder.sh"
6686 "echo hello world > $out\n" '())))
6687 (derivation store "foo"
6688 bash `("-e" ,builder)
6689 #:inputs `((,bash) (,builder))
6690 #:env-vars '(("HOME" . "/homeless"))))
6691 @result{} #<derivation /gnu/store/@dots{}-foo.drv => /gnu/store/@dots{}-foo>
6692 @end lisp
6693
6694 As can be guessed, this primitive is cumbersome to use directly. A
6695 better approach is to write build scripts in Scheme, of course! The
6696 best course of action for that is to write the build code as a
6697 ``G-expression'', and to pass it to @code{gexp->derivation}. For more
6698 information, @pxref{G-Expressions}.
6699
6700 Once upon a time, @code{gexp->derivation} did not exist and constructing
6701 derivations with build code written in Scheme was achieved with
6702 @code{build-expression->derivation}, documented below. This procedure
6703 is now deprecated in favor of the much nicer @code{gexp->derivation}.
6704
6705 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} build-expression->derivation @var{store} @
6706 @var{name} @var{exp} @
6707 [#:system (%current-system)] [#:inputs '()] @
6708 [#:outputs '("out")] [#:hash #f] [#:hash-algo #f] @
6709 [#:recursive? #f] [#:env-vars '()] [#:modules '()] @
6710 [#:references-graphs #f] [#:allowed-references #f] @
6711 [#:disallowed-references #f] @
6712 [#:local-build? #f] [#:substitutable? #t] [#:guile-for-build #f]
6713 Return a derivation that executes Scheme expression @var{exp} as a
6714 builder for derivation @var{name}. @var{inputs} must be a list of
6715 @code{(name drv-path sub-drv)} tuples; when @var{sub-drv} is omitted,
6716 @code{"out"} is assumed. @var{modules} is a list of names of Guile
6717 modules from the current search path to be copied in the store,
6718 compiled, and made available in the load path during the execution of
6719 @var{exp}---e.g., @code{((guix build utils) (guix build
6720 gnu-build-system))}.
6721
6722 @var{exp} is evaluated in an environment where @code{%outputs} is bound
6723 to a list of output/path pairs, and where @code{%build-inputs} is bound
6724 to a list of string/output-path pairs made from @var{inputs}.
6725 Optionally, @var{env-vars} is a list of string pairs specifying the name
6726 and value of environment variables visible to the builder. The builder
6727 terminates by passing the result of @var{exp} to @code{exit}; thus, when
6728 @var{exp} returns @code{#f}, the build is considered to have failed.
6729
6730 @var{exp} is built using @var{guile-for-build} (a derivation). When
6731 @var{guile-for-build} is omitted or is @code{#f}, the value of the
6732 @code{%guile-for-build} fluid is used instead.
6733
6734 See the @code{derivation} procedure for the meaning of
6735 @var{references-graphs}, @var{allowed-references},
6736 @var{disallowed-references}, @var{local-build?}, and
6737 @var{substitutable?}.
6738 @end deffn
6739
6740 @noindent
6741 Here's an example of a single-output derivation that creates a directory
6742 containing one file:
6743
6744 @lisp
6745 (let ((builder '(let ((out (assoc-ref %outputs "out")))
6746 (mkdir out) ; create /gnu/store/@dots{}-goo
6747 (call-with-output-file (string-append out "/test")
6748 (lambda (p)
6749 (display '(hello guix) p))))))
6750 (build-expression->derivation store "goo" builder))
6751
6752 @result{} #<derivation /gnu/store/@dots{}-goo.drv => @dots{}>
6753 @end lisp
6754
6755
6756 @node The Store Monad
6757 @section The Store Monad
6758
6759 @cindex monad
6760
6761 The procedures that operate on the store described in the previous
6762 sections all take an open connection to the build daemon as their first
6763 argument. Although the underlying model is functional, they either have
6764 side effects or depend on the current state of the store.
6765
6766 The former is inconvenient: the connection to the build daemon has to be
6767 carried around in all those functions, making it impossible to compose
6768 functions that do not take that parameter with functions that do. The
6769 latter can be problematic: since store operations have side effects
6770 and/or depend on external state, they have to be properly sequenced.
6771
6772 @cindex monadic values
6773 @cindex monadic functions
6774 This is where the @code{(guix monads)} module comes in. This module
6775 provides a framework for working with @dfn{monads}, and a particularly
6776 useful monad for our uses, the @dfn{store monad}. Monads are a
6777 construct that allows two things: associating ``context'' with values
6778 (in our case, the context is the store), and building sequences of
6779 computations (here computations include accesses to the store). Values
6780 in a monad---values that carry this additional context---are called
6781 @dfn{monadic values}; procedures that return such values are called
6782 @dfn{monadic procedures}.
6783
6784 Consider this ``normal'' procedure:
6785
6786 @lisp
6787 (define (sh-symlink store)
6788 ;; Return a derivation that symlinks the 'bash' executable.
6789 (let* ((drv (package-derivation store bash))
6790 (out (derivation->output-path drv))
6791 (sh (string-append out "/bin/bash")))
6792 (build-expression->derivation store "sh"
6793 `(symlink ,sh %output))))
6794 @end lisp
6795
6796 Using @code{(guix monads)} and @code{(guix gexp)}, it may be rewritten
6797 as a monadic function:
6798
6799 @lisp
6800 (define (sh-symlink)
6801 ;; Same, but return a monadic value.
6802 (mlet %store-monad ((drv (package->derivation bash)))
6803 (gexp->derivation "sh"
6804 #~(symlink (string-append #$drv "/bin/bash")
6805 #$output))))
6806 @end lisp
6807
6808 There are several things to note in the second version: the @code{store}
6809 parameter is now implicit and is ``threaded'' in the calls to the
6810 @code{package->derivation} and @code{gexp->derivation} monadic
6811 procedures, and the monadic value returned by @code{package->derivation}
6812 is @dfn{bound} using @code{mlet} instead of plain @code{let}.
6813
6814 As it turns out, the call to @code{package->derivation} can even be
6815 omitted since it will take place implicitly, as we will see later
6816 (@pxref{G-Expressions}):
6817
6818 @lisp
6819 (define (sh-symlink)
6820 (gexp->derivation "sh"
6821 #~(symlink (string-append #$bash "/bin/bash")
6822 #$output)))
6823 @end lisp
6824
6825 @c See
6826 @c <https://syntaxexclamation.wordpress.com/2014/06/26/escaping-continuations/>
6827 @c for the funny quote.
6828 Calling the monadic @code{sh-symlink} has no effect. As someone once
6829 said, ``you exit a monad like you exit a building on fire: by running''.
6830 So, to exit the monad and get the desired effect, one must use
6831 @code{run-with-store}:
6832
6833 @lisp
6834 (run-with-store (open-connection) (sh-symlink))
6835 @result{} /gnu/store/...-sh-symlink
6836 @end lisp
6837
6838 Note that the @code{(guix monad-repl)} module extends the Guile REPL with
6839 new ``meta-commands'' to make it easier to deal with monadic procedures:
6840 @code{run-in-store}, and @code{enter-store-monad}. The former is used
6841 to ``run'' a single monadic value through the store:
6842
6843 @example
6844 scheme@@(guile-user)> ,run-in-store (package->derivation hello)
6845 $1 = #<derivation /gnu/store/@dots{}-hello-2.9.drv => @dots{}>
6846 @end example
6847
6848 The latter enters a recursive REPL, where all the return values are
6849 automatically run through the store:
6850
6851 @example
6852 scheme@@(guile-user)> ,enter-store-monad
6853 store-monad@@(guile-user) [1]> (package->derivation hello)
6854 $2 = #<derivation /gnu/store/@dots{}-hello-2.9.drv => @dots{}>
6855 store-monad@@(guile-user) [1]> (text-file "foo" "Hello!")
6856 $3 = "/gnu/store/@dots{}-foo"
6857 store-monad@@(guile-user) [1]> ,q
6858 scheme@@(guile-user)>
6859 @end example
6860
6861 @noindent
6862 Note that non-monadic values cannot be returned in the
6863 @code{store-monad} REPL.
6864
6865 The main syntactic forms to deal with monads in general are provided by
6866 the @code{(guix monads)} module and are described below.
6867
6868 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} with-monad @var{monad} @var{body} ...
6869 Evaluate any @code{>>=} or @code{return} forms in @var{body} as being
6870 in @var{monad}.
6871 @end deffn
6872
6873 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} return @var{val}
6874 Return a monadic value that encapsulates @var{val}.
6875 @end deffn
6876
6877 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} >>= @var{mval} @var{mproc} ...
6878 @dfn{Bind} monadic value @var{mval}, passing its ``contents'' to monadic
6879 procedures @var{mproc}@dots{}@footnote{This operation is commonly
6880 referred to as ``bind'', but that name denotes an unrelated procedure in
6881 Guile. Thus we use this somewhat cryptic symbol inherited from the
6882 Haskell language.}. There can be one @var{mproc} or several of them, as
6883 in this example:
6884
6885 @lisp
6886 (run-with-state
6887 (with-monad %state-monad
6888 (>>= (return 1)
6889 (lambda (x) (return (+ 1 x)))
6890 (lambda (x) (return (* 2 x)))))
6891 'some-state)
6892
6893 @result{} 4
6894 @result{} some-state
6895 @end lisp
6896 @end deffn
6897
6898 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} mlet @var{monad} ((@var{var} @var{mval}) ...) @
6899 @var{body} ...
6900 @deffnx {Scheme Syntax} mlet* @var{monad} ((@var{var} @var{mval}) ...) @
6901 @var{body} ...
6902 Bind the variables @var{var} to the monadic values @var{mval} in
6903 @var{body}, which is a sequence of expressions. As with the bind
6904 operator, this can be thought of as ``unpacking'' the raw, non-monadic
6905 value ``contained'' in @var{mval} and making @var{var} refer to that
6906 raw, non-monadic value within the scope of the @var{body}. The form
6907 (@var{var} -> @var{val}) binds @var{var} to the ``normal'' value
6908 @var{val}, as per @code{let}. The binding operations occur in sequence
6909 from left to right. The last expression of @var{body} must be a monadic
6910 expression, and its result will become the result of the @code{mlet} or
6911 @code{mlet*} when run in the @var{monad}.
6912
6913 @code{mlet*} is to @code{mlet} what @code{let*} is to @code{let}
6914 (@pxref{Local Bindings,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}).
6915 @end deffn
6916
6917 @deffn {Scheme System} mbegin @var{monad} @var{mexp} ...
6918 Bind @var{mexp} and the following monadic expressions in sequence,
6919 returning the result of the last expression. Every expression in the
6920 sequence must be a monadic expression.
6921
6922 This is akin to @code{mlet}, except that the return values of the
6923 monadic expressions are ignored. In that sense, it is analogous to
6924 @code{begin}, but applied to monadic expressions.
6925 @end deffn
6926
6927 @deffn {Scheme System} mwhen @var{condition} @var{mexp0} @var{mexp*} ...
6928 When @var{condition} is true, evaluate the sequence of monadic
6929 expressions @var{mexp0}..@var{mexp*} as in an @code{mbegin}. When
6930 @var{condition} is false, return @code{*unspecified*} in the current
6931 monad. Every expression in the sequence must be a monadic expression.
6932 @end deffn
6933
6934 @deffn {Scheme System} munless @var{condition} @var{mexp0} @var{mexp*} ...
6935 When @var{condition} is false, evaluate the sequence of monadic
6936 expressions @var{mexp0}..@var{mexp*} as in an @code{mbegin}. When
6937 @var{condition} is true, return @code{*unspecified*} in the current
6938 monad. Every expression in the sequence must be a monadic expression.
6939 @end deffn
6940
6941 @cindex state monad
6942 The @code{(guix monads)} module provides the @dfn{state monad}, which
6943 allows an additional value---the state---to be @emph{threaded} through
6944 monadic procedure calls.
6945
6946 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %state-monad
6947 The state monad. Procedures in the state monad can access and change
6948 the state that is threaded.
6949
6950 Consider the example below. The @code{square} procedure returns a value
6951 in the state monad. It returns the square of its argument, but also
6952 increments the current state value:
6953
6954 @lisp
6955 (define (square x)
6956 (mlet %state-monad ((count (current-state)))
6957 (mbegin %state-monad
6958 (set-current-state (+ 1 count))
6959 (return (* x x)))))
6960
6961 (run-with-state (sequence %state-monad (map square (iota 3))) 0)
6962 @result{} (0 1 4)
6963 @result{} 3
6964 @end lisp
6965
6966 When ``run'' through @var{%state-monad}, we obtain that additional state
6967 value, which is the number of @code{square} calls.
6968 @end defvr
6969
6970 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} current-state
6971 Return the current state as a monadic value.
6972 @end deffn
6973
6974 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} set-current-state @var{value}
6975 Set the current state to @var{value} and return the previous state as a
6976 monadic value.
6977 @end deffn
6978
6979 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} state-push @var{value}
6980 Push @var{value} to the current state, which is assumed to be a list,
6981 and return the previous state as a monadic value.
6982 @end deffn
6983
6984 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} state-pop
6985 Pop a value from the current state and return it as a monadic value.
6986 The state is assumed to be a list.
6987 @end deffn
6988
6989 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} run-with-state @var{mval} [@var{state}]
6990 Run monadic value @var{mval} starting with @var{state} as the initial
6991 state. Return two values: the resulting value, and the resulting state.
6992 @end deffn
6993
6994 The main interface to the store monad, provided by the @code{(guix
6995 store)} module, is as follows.
6996
6997 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %store-monad
6998 The store monad---an alias for @var{%state-monad}.
6999
7000 Values in the store monad encapsulate accesses to the store. When its
7001 effect is needed, a value of the store monad must be ``evaluated'' by
7002 passing it to the @code{run-with-store} procedure (see below.)
7003 @end defvr
7004
7005 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} run-with-store @var{store} @var{mval} [#:guile-for-build] [#:system (%current-system)]
7006 Run @var{mval}, a monadic value in the store monad, in @var{store}, an
7007 open store connection.
7008 @end deffn
7009
7010 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} text-file @var{name} @var{text} [@var{references}]
7011 Return as a monadic value the absolute file name in the store of the file
7012 containing @var{text}, a string. @var{references} is a list of store items that the
7013 resulting text file refers to; it defaults to the empty list.
7014 @end deffn
7015
7016 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} binary-file @var{name} @var{data} [@var{references}]
7017 Return as a monadic value the absolute file name in the store of the file
7018 containing @var{data}, a bytevector. @var{references} is a list of store
7019 items that the resulting binary file refers to; it defaults to the empty list.
7020 @end deffn
7021
7022 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} interned-file @var{file} [@var{name}] @
7023 [#:recursive? #t] [#:select? (const #t)]
7024 Return the name of @var{file} once interned in the store. Use
7025 @var{name} as its store name, or the basename of @var{file} if
7026 @var{name} is omitted.
7027
7028 When @var{recursive?} is true, the contents of @var{file} are added
7029 recursively; if @var{file} designates a flat file and @var{recursive?}
7030 is true, its contents are added, and its permission bits are kept.
7031
7032 When @var{recursive?} is true, call @code{(@var{select?} @var{file}
7033 @var{stat})} for each directory entry, where @var{file} is the entry's
7034 absolute file name and @var{stat} is the result of @code{lstat}; exclude
7035 entries for which @var{select?} does not return true.
7036
7037 The example below adds a file to the store, under two different names:
7038
7039 @lisp
7040 (run-with-store (open-connection)
7041 (mlet %store-monad ((a (interned-file "README"))
7042 (b (interned-file "README" "LEGU-MIN")))
7043 (return (list a b))))
7044
7045 @result{} ("/gnu/store/rwm@dots{}-README" "/gnu/store/44i@dots{}-LEGU-MIN")
7046 @end lisp
7047
7048 @end deffn
7049
7050 The @code{(guix packages)} module exports the following package-related
7051 monadic procedures:
7052
7053 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} package-file @var{package} [@var{file}] @
7054 [#:system (%current-system)] [#:target #f] @
7055 [#:output "out"]
7056 Return as a monadic
7057 value in the absolute file name of @var{file} within the @var{output}
7058 directory of @var{package}. When @var{file} is omitted, return the name
7059 of the @var{output} directory of @var{package}. When @var{target} is
7060 true, use it as a cross-compilation target triplet.
7061 @end deffn
7062
7063 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} package->derivation @var{package} [@var{system}]
7064 @deffnx {Monadic Procedure} package->cross-derivation @var{package} @
7065 @var{target} [@var{system}]
7066 Monadic version of @code{package-derivation} and
7067 @code{package-cross-derivation} (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
7068 @end deffn
7069
7070
7071 @node G-Expressions
7072 @section G-Expressions
7073
7074 @cindex G-expression
7075 @cindex build code quoting
7076 So we have ``derivations'', which represent a sequence of build actions
7077 to be performed to produce an item in the store (@pxref{Derivations}).
7078 These build actions are performed when asking the daemon to actually
7079 build the derivations; they are run by the daemon in a container
7080 (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon}).
7081
7082 @cindex strata of code
7083 It should come as no surprise that we like to write these build actions
7084 in Scheme. When we do that, we end up with two @dfn{strata} of Scheme
7085 code@footnote{The term @dfn{stratum} in this context was coined by
7086 Manuel Serrano et al.@: in the context of their work on Hop. Oleg
7087 Kiselyov, who has written insightful
7088 @url{http://okmij.org/ftp/meta-programming/#meta-scheme, essays and code
7089 on this topic}, refers to this kind of code generation as
7090 @dfn{staging}.}: the ``host code''---code that defines packages, talks
7091 to the daemon, etc.---and the ``build code''---code that actually
7092 performs build actions, such as making directories, invoking
7093 @command{make}, etc.
7094
7095 To describe a derivation and its build actions, one typically needs to
7096 embed build code inside host code. It boils down to manipulating build
7097 code as data, and the homoiconicity of Scheme---code has a direct
7098 representation as data---comes in handy for that. But we need more than
7099 the normal @code{quasiquote} mechanism in Scheme to construct build
7100 expressions.
7101
7102 The @code{(guix gexp)} module implements @dfn{G-expressions}, a form of
7103 S-expressions adapted to build expressions. G-expressions, or
7104 @dfn{gexps}, consist essentially of three syntactic forms: @code{gexp},
7105 @code{ungexp}, and @code{ungexp-splicing} (or simply: @code{#~},
7106 @code{#$}, and @code{#$@@}), which are comparable to
7107 @code{quasiquote}, @code{unquote}, and @code{unquote-splicing},
7108 respectively (@pxref{Expression Syntax, @code{quasiquote},, guile,
7109 GNU Guile Reference Manual}). However, there are major differences:
7110
7111 @itemize
7112 @item
7113 Gexps are meant to be written to a file and run or manipulated by other
7114 processes.
7115
7116 @item
7117 When a high-level object such as a package or derivation is unquoted
7118 inside a gexp, the result is as if its output file name had been
7119 introduced.
7120
7121 @item
7122 Gexps carry information about the packages or derivations they refer to,
7123 and these dependencies are automatically added as inputs to the build
7124 processes that use them.
7125 @end itemize
7126
7127 @cindex lowering, of high-level objects in gexps
7128 This mechanism is not limited to package and derivation
7129 objects: @dfn{compilers} able to ``lower'' other high-level objects to
7130 derivations or files in the store can be defined,
7131 such that these objects can also be inserted
7132 into gexps. For example, a useful type of high-level objects that can be
7133 inserted in a gexp is ``file-like objects'', which make it easy to
7134 add files to the store and to refer to them in
7135 derivations and such (see @code{local-file} and @code{plain-file}
7136 below.)
7137
7138 To illustrate the idea, here is an example of a gexp:
7139
7140 @lisp
7141 (define build-exp
7142 #~(begin
7143 (mkdir #$output)
7144 (chdir #$output)
7145 (symlink (string-append #$coreutils "/bin/ls")
7146 "list-files")))
7147 @end lisp
7148
7149 This gexp can be passed to @code{gexp->derivation}; we obtain a
7150 derivation that builds a directory containing exactly one symlink to
7151 @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.22/bin/ls}:
7152
7153 @lisp
7154 (gexp->derivation "the-thing" build-exp)
7155 @end lisp
7156
7157 As one would expect, the @code{"/gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.22"} string is
7158 substituted to the reference to the @var{coreutils} package in the
7159 actual build code, and @var{coreutils} is automatically made an input to
7160 the derivation. Likewise, @code{#$output} (equivalent to @code{(ungexp
7161 output)}) is replaced by a string containing the directory name of the
7162 output of the derivation.
7163
7164 @cindex cross compilation
7165 In a cross-compilation context, it is useful to distinguish between
7166 references to the @emph{native} build of a package---that can run on the
7167 host---versus references to cross builds of a package. To that end, the
7168 @code{#+} plays the same role as @code{#$}, but is a reference to a
7169 native package build:
7170
7171 @lisp
7172 (gexp->derivation "vi"
7173 #~(begin
7174 (mkdir #$output)
7175 (system* (string-append #+coreutils "/bin/ln")
7176 "-s"
7177 (string-append #$emacs "/bin/emacs")
7178 (string-append #$output "/bin/vi")))
7179 #:target "mips64el-linux-gnu")
7180 @end lisp
7181
7182 @noindent
7183 In the example above, the native build of @var{coreutils} is used, so
7184 that @command{ln} can actually run on the host; but then the
7185 cross-compiled build of @var{emacs} is referenced.
7186
7187 @cindex imported modules, for gexps
7188 @findex with-imported-modules
7189 Another gexp feature is @dfn{imported modules}: sometimes you want to be
7190 able to use certain Guile modules from the ``host environment'' in the
7191 gexp, so those modules should be imported in the ``build environment''.
7192 The @code{with-imported-modules} form allows you to express that:
7193
7194 @lisp
7195 (let ((build (with-imported-modules '((guix build utils))
7196 #~(begin
7197 (use-modules (guix build utils))
7198 (mkdir-p (string-append #$output "/bin"))))))
7199 (gexp->derivation "empty-dir"
7200 #~(begin
7201 #$build
7202 (display "success!\n")
7203 #t)))
7204 @end lisp
7205
7206 @noindent
7207 In this example, the @code{(guix build utils)} module is automatically
7208 pulled into the isolated build environment of our gexp, such that
7209 @code{(use-modules (guix build utils))} works as expected.
7210
7211 @cindex module closure
7212 @findex source-module-closure
7213 Usually you want the @emph{closure} of the module to be imported---i.e.,
7214 the module itself and all the modules it depends on---rather than just
7215 the module; failing to do that, attempts to use the module will fail
7216 because of missing dependent modules. The @code{source-module-closure}
7217 procedure computes the closure of a module by looking at its source file
7218 headers, which comes in handy in this case:
7219
7220 @lisp
7221 (use-modules (guix modules)) ;for 'source-module-closure'
7222
7223 (with-imported-modules (source-module-closure
7224 '((guix build utils)
7225 (gnu build vm)))
7226 (gexp->derivation "something-with-vms"
7227 #~(begin
7228 (use-modules (guix build utils)
7229 (gnu build vm))
7230 @dots{})))
7231 @end lisp
7232
7233 @cindex extensions, for gexps
7234 @findex with-extensions
7235 In the same vein, sometimes you want to import not just pure-Scheme
7236 modules, but also ``extensions'' such as Guile bindings to C libraries
7237 or other ``full-blown'' packages. Say you need the @code{guile-json}
7238 package available on the build side, here's how you would do it:
7239
7240 @lisp
7241 (use-modules (gnu packages guile)) ;for 'guile-json'
7242
7243 (with-extensions (list guile-json)
7244 (gexp->derivation "something-with-json"
7245 #~(begin
7246 (use-modules (json))
7247 @dots{})))
7248 @end lisp
7249
7250 The syntactic form to construct gexps is summarized below.
7251
7252 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} #~@var{exp}
7253 @deffnx {Scheme Syntax} (gexp @var{exp})
7254 Return a G-expression containing @var{exp}. @var{exp} may contain one
7255 or more of the following forms:
7256
7257 @table @code
7258 @item #$@var{obj}
7259 @itemx (ungexp @var{obj})
7260 Introduce a reference to @var{obj}. @var{obj} may have one of the
7261 supported types, for example a package or a
7262 derivation, in which case the @code{ungexp} form is replaced by its
7263 output file name---e.g., @code{"/gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.22}.
7264
7265 If @var{obj} is a list, it is traversed and references to supported
7266 objects are substituted similarly.
7267
7268 If @var{obj} is another gexp, its contents are inserted and its
7269 dependencies are added to those of the containing gexp.
7270
7271 If @var{obj} is another kind of object, it is inserted as is.
7272
7273 @item #$@var{obj}:@var{output}
7274 @itemx (ungexp @var{obj} @var{output})
7275 This is like the form above, but referring explicitly to the
7276 @var{output} of @var{obj}---this is useful when @var{obj} produces
7277 multiple outputs (@pxref{Packages with Multiple Outputs}).
7278
7279 @item #+@var{obj}
7280 @itemx #+@var{obj}:output
7281 @itemx (ungexp-native @var{obj})
7282 @itemx (ungexp-native @var{obj} @var{output})
7283 Same as @code{ungexp}, but produces a reference to the @emph{native}
7284 build of @var{obj} when used in a cross compilation context.
7285
7286 @item #$output[:@var{output}]
7287 @itemx (ungexp output [@var{output}])
7288 Insert a reference to derivation output @var{output}, or to the main
7289 output when @var{output} is omitted.
7290
7291 This only makes sense for gexps passed to @code{gexp->derivation}.
7292
7293 @item #$@@@var{lst}
7294 @itemx (ungexp-splicing @var{lst})
7295 Like the above, but splices the contents of @var{lst} inside the
7296 containing list.
7297
7298 @item #+@@@var{lst}
7299 @itemx (ungexp-native-splicing @var{lst})
7300 Like the above, but refers to native builds of the objects listed in
7301 @var{lst}.
7302
7303 @end table
7304
7305 G-expressions created by @code{gexp} or @code{#~} are run-time objects
7306 of the @code{gexp?} type (see below.)
7307 @end deffn
7308
7309 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} with-imported-modules @var{modules} @var{body}@dots{}
7310 Mark the gexps defined in @var{body}@dots{} as requiring @var{modules}
7311 in their execution environment.
7312
7313 Each item in @var{modules} can be the name of a module, such as
7314 @code{(guix build utils)}, or it can be a module name, followed by an
7315 arrow, followed by a file-like object:
7316
7317 @lisp
7318 `((guix build utils)
7319 (guix gcrypt)
7320 ((guix config) => ,(scheme-file "config.scm"
7321 #~(define-module @dots{}))))
7322 @end lisp
7323
7324 @noindent
7325 In the example above, the first two modules are taken from the search
7326 path, and the last one is created from the given file-like object.
7327
7328 This form has @emph{lexical} scope: it has an effect on the gexps
7329 directly defined in @var{body}@dots{}, but not on those defined, say, in
7330 procedures called from @var{body}@dots{}.
7331 @end deffn
7332
7333 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} with-extensions @var{extensions} @var{body}@dots{}
7334 Mark the gexps defined in @var{body}@dots{} as requiring
7335 @var{extensions} in their build and execution environment.
7336 @var{extensions} is typically a list of package objects such as those
7337 defined in the @code{(gnu packages guile)} module.
7338
7339 Concretely, the packages listed in @var{extensions} are added to the
7340 load path while compiling imported modules in @var{body}@dots{}; they
7341 are also added to the load path of the gexp returned by
7342 @var{body}@dots{}.
7343 @end deffn
7344
7345 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} gexp? @var{obj}
7346 Return @code{#t} if @var{obj} is a G-expression.
7347 @end deffn
7348
7349 G-expressions are meant to be written to disk, either as code building
7350 some derivation, or as plain files in the store. The monadic procedures
7351 below allow you to do that (@pxref{The Store Monad}, for more
7352 information about monads.)
7353
7354 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} gexp->derivation @var{name} @var{exp} @
7355 [#:system (%current-system)] [#:target #f] [#:graft? #t] @
7356 [#:hash #f] [#:hash-algo #f] @
7357 [#:recursive? #f] [#:env-vars '()] [#:modules '()] @
7358 [#:module-path @var{%load-path}] @
7359 [#:effective-version "2.2"] @
7360 [#:references-graphs #f] [#:allowed-references #f] @
7361 [#:disallowed-references #f] @
7362 [#:leaked-env-vars #f] @
7363 [#:script-name (string-append @var{name} "-builder")] @
7364 [#:deprecation-warnings #f] @
7365 [#:local-build? #f] [#:substitutable? #t] @
7366 [#:properties '()] [#:guile-for-build #f]
7367 Return a derivation @var{name} that runs @var{exp} (a gexp) with
7368 @var{guile-for-build} (a derivation) on @var{system}; @var{exp} is
7369 stored in a file called @var{script-name}. When @var{target} is true,
7370 it is used as the cross-compilation target triplet for packages referred
7371 to by @var{exp}.
7372
7373 @var{modules} is deprecated in favor of @code{with-imported-modules}.
7374 Its meaning is to
7375 make @var{modules} available in the evaluation context of @var{exp};
7376 @var{modules} is a list of names of Guile modules searched in
7377 @var{module-path} to be copied in the store, compiled, and made available in
7378 the load path during the execution of @var{exp}---e.g., @code{((guix
7379 build utils) (guix build gnu-build-system))}.
7380
7381 @var{effective-version} determines the string to use when adding extensions of
7382 @var{exp} (see @code{with-extensions}) to the search path---e.g., @code{"2.2"}.
7383
7384 @var{graft?} determines whether packages referred to by @var{exp} should be grafted when
7385 applicable.
7386
7387 When @var{references-graphs} is true, it must be a list of tuples of one of the
7388 following forms:
7389
7390 @example
7391 (@var{file-name} @var{package})
7392 (@var{file-name} @var{package} @var{output})
7393 (@var{file-name} @var{derivation})
7394 (@var{file-name} @var{derivation} @var{output})
7395 (@var{file-name} @var{store-item})
7396 @end example
7397
7398 The right-hand-side of each element of @var{references-graphs} is automatically made
7399 an input of the build process of @var{exp}. In the build environment, each
7400 @var{file-name} contains the reference graph of the corresponding item, in a simple
7401 text format.
7402
7403 @var{allowed-references} must be either @code{#f} or a list of output names and packages.
7404 In the latter case, the list denotes store items that the result is allowed to
7405 refer to. Any reference to another store item will lead to a build error.
7406 Similarly for @var{disallowed-references}, which can list items that must not be
7407 referenced by the outputs.
7408
7409 @var{deprecation-warnings} determines whether to show deprecation warnings while
7410 compiling modules. It can be @code{#f}, @code{#t}, or @code{'detailed}.
7411
7412 The other arguments are as for @code{derivation} (@pxref{Derivations}).
7413 @end deffn
7414
7415 @cindex file-like objects
7416 The @code{local-file}, @code{plain-file}, @code{computed-file},
7417 @code{program-file}, and @code{scheme-file} procedures below return
7418 @dfn{file-like objects}. That is, when unquoted in a G-expression,
7419 these objects lead to a file in the store. Consider this G-expression:
7420
7421 @lisp
7422 #~(system* #$(file-append glibc "/sbin/nscd") "-f"
7423 #$(local-file "/tmp/my-nscd.conf"))
7424 @end lisp
7425
7426 The effect here is to ``intern'' @file{/tmp/my-nscd.conf} by copying it
7427 to the store. Once expanded, for instance @i{via}
7428 @code{gexp->derivation}, the G-expression refers to that copy under
7429 @file{/gnu/store}; thus, modifying or removing the file in @file{/tmp}
7430 does not have any effect on what the G-expression does.
7431 @code{plain-file} can be used similarly; it differs in that the file
7432 content is directly passed as a string.
7433
7434 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} local-file @var{file} [@var{name}] @
7435 [#:recursive? #f] [#:select? (const #t)]
7436 Return an object representing local file @var{file} to add to the store; this
7437 object can be used in a gexp. If @var{file} is a relative file name, it is looked
7438 up relative to the source file where this form appears. @var{file} will be added to
7439 the store under @var{name}--by default the base name of @var{file}.
7440
7441 When @var{recursive?} is true, the contents of @var{file} are added recursively; if @var{file}
7442 designates a flat file and @var{recursive?} is true, its contents are added, and its
7443 permission bits are kept.
7444
7445 When @var{recursive?} is true, call @code{(@var{select?} @var{file}
7446 @var{stat})} for each directory entry, where @var{file} is the entry's
7447 absolute file name and @var{stat} is the result of @code{lstat}; exclude
7448 entries for which @var{select?} does not return true.
7449
7450 This is the declarative counterpart of the @code{interned-file} monadic
7451 procedure (@pxref{The Store Monad, @code{interned-file}}).
7452 @end deffn
7453
7454 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} plain-file @var{name} @var{content}
7455 Return an object representing a text file called @var{name} with the given
7456 @var{content} (a string or a bytevector) to be added to the store.
7457
7458 This is the declarative counterpart of @code{text-file}.
7459 @end deffn
7460
7461 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} computed-file @var{name} @var{gexp} @
7462 [#:options '(#:local-build? #t)]
7463 Return an object representing the store item @var{name}, a file or
7464 directory computed by @var{gexp}. @var{options}
7465 is a list of additional arguments to pass to @code{gexp->derivation}.
7466
7467 This is the declarative counterpart of @code{gexp->derivation}.
7468 @end deffn
7469
7470 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} gexp->script @var{name} @var{exp} @
7471 [#:guile (default-guile)] [#:module-path %load-path] @
7472 [#:system (%current-system)] [#:target #f]
7473 Return an executable script @var{name} that runs @var{exp} using
7474 @var{guile}, with @var{exp}'s imported modules in its search path.
7475 Look up @var{exp}'s modules in @var{module-path}.
7476
7477 The example below builds a script that simply invokes the @command{ls}
7478 command:
7479
7480 @lisp
7481 (use-modules (guix gexp) (gnu packages base))
7482
7483 (gexp->script "list-files"
7484 #~(execl #$(file-append coreutils "/bin/ls")
7485 "ls"))
7486 @end lisp
7487
7488 When ``running'' it through the store (@pxref{The Store Monad,
7489 @code{run-with-store}}), we obtain a derivation that produces an
7490 executable file @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-list-files} along these lines:
7491
7492 @example
7493 #!/gnu/store/@dots{}-guile-2.0.11/bin/guile -ds
7494 !#
7495 (execl "/gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.22"/bin/ls" "ls")
7496 @end example
7497 @end deffn
7498
7499 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} program-file @var{name} @var{exp} @
7500 [#:guile #f] [#:module-path %load-path]
7501 Return an object representing the executable store item @var{name} that
7502 runs @var{gexp}. @var{guile} is the Guile package used to execute that
7503 script. Imported modules of @var{gexp} are looked up in @var{module-path}.
7504
7505 This is the declarative counterpart of @code{gexp->script}.
7506 @end deffn
7507
7508 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} gexp->file @var{name} @var{exp} @
7509 [#:set-load-path? #t] [#:module-path %load-path] @
7510 [#:splice? #f] @
7511 [#:guile (default-guile)]
7512 Return a derivation that builds a file @var{name} containing @var{exp}.
7513 When @var{splice?} is true, @var{exp} is considered to be a list of
7514 expressions that will be spliced in the resulting file.
7515
7516 When @var{set-load-path?} is true, emit code in the resulting file to
7517 set @code{%load-path} and @code{%load-compiled-path} to honor
7518 @var{exp}'s imported modules. Look up @var{exp}'s modules in
7519 @var{module-path}.
7520
7521 The resulting file holds references to all the dependencies of @var{exp}
7522 or a subset thereof.
7523 @end deffn
7524
7525 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} scheme-file @var{name} @var{exp} [#:splice? #f]
7526 Return an object representing the Scheme file @var{name} that contains
7527 @var{exp}.
7528
7529 This is the declarative counterpart of @code{gexp->file}.
7530 @end deffn
7531
7532 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} text-file* @var{name} @var{text} @dots{}
7533 Return as a monadic value a derivation that builds a text file
7534 containing all of @var{text}. @var{text} may list, in addition to
7535 strings, objects of any type that can be used in a gexp: packages,
7536 derivations, local file objects, etc. The resulting store file holds
7537 references to all these.
7538
7539 This variant should be preferred over @code{text-file} anytime the file
7540 to create will reference items from the store. This is typically the
7541 case when building a configuration file that embeds store file names,
7542 like this:
7543
7544 @lisp
7545 (define (profile.sh)
7546 ;; Return the name of a shell script in the store that
7547 ;; initializes the 'PATH' environment variable.
7548 (text-file* "profile.sh"
7549 "export PATH=" coreutils "/bin:"
7550 grep "/bin:" sed "/bin\n"))
7551 @end lisp
7552
7553 In this example, the resulting @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-profile.sh} file
7554 will reference @var{coreutils}, @var{grep}, and @var{sed}, thereby
7555 preventing them from being garbage-collected during its lifetime.
7556 @end deffn
7557
7558 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} mixed-text-file @var{name} @var{text} @dots{}
7559 Return an object representing store file @var{name} containing
7560 @var{text}. @var{text} is a sequence of strings and file-like objects,
7561 as in:
7562
7563 @lisp
7564 (mixed-text-file "profile"
7565 "export PATH=" coreutils "/bin:" grep "/bin")
7566 @end lisp
7567
7568 This is the declarative counterpart of @code{text-file*}.
7569 @end deffn
7570
7571 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} file-union @var{name} @var{files}
7572 Return a @code{<computed-file>} that builds a directory containing all of @var{files}.
7573 Each item in @var{files} must be a two-element list where the first element is the
7574 file name to use in the new directory, and the second element is a gexp
7575 denoting the target file. Here's an example:
7576
7577 @lisp
7578 (file-union "etc"
7579 `(("hosts" ,(plain-file "hosts"
7580 "127.0.0.1 localhost"))
7581 ("bashrc" ,(plain-file "bashrc"
7582 "alias ls='ls --color=auto'"))))
7583 @end lisp
7584
7585 This yields an @code{etc} directory containing these two files.
7586 @end deffn
7587
7588 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} directory-union @var{name} @var{things}
7589 Return a directory that is the union of @var{things}, where @var{things} is a list of
7590 file-like objects denoting directories. For example:
7591
7592 @lisp
7593 (directory-union "guile+emacs" (list guile emacs))
7594 @end lisp
7595
7596 yields a directory that is the union of the @code{guile} and @code{emacs} packages.
7597 @end deffn
7598
7599 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} file-append @var{obj} @var{suffix} @dots{}
7600 Return a file-like object that expands to the concatenation of @var{obj}
7601 and @var{suffix}, where @var{obj} is a lowerable object and each
7602 @var{suffix} is a string.
7603
7604 As an example, consider this gexp:
7605
7606 @lisp
7607 (gexp->script "run-uname"
7608 #~(system* #$(file-append coreutils
7609 "/bin/uname")))
7610 @end lisp
7611
7612 The same effect could be achieved with:
7613
7614 @lisp
7615 (gexp->script "run-uname"
7616 #~(system* (string-append #$coreutils
7617 "/bin/uname")))
7618 @end lisp
7619
7620 There is one difference though: in the @code{file-append} case, the
7621 resulting script contains the absolute file name as a string, whereas in
7622 the second case, the resulting script contains a @code{(string-append
7623 @dots{})} expression to construct the file name @emph{at run time}.
7624 @end deffn
7625
7626
7627 Of course, in addition to gexps embedded in ``host'' code, there are
7628 also modules containing build tools. To make it clear that they are
7629 meant to be used in the build stratum, these modules are kept in the
7630 @code{(guix build @dots{})} name space.
7631
7632 @cindex lowering, of high-level objects in gexps
7633 Internally, high-level objects are @dfn{lowered}, using their compiler,
7634 to either derivations or store items. For instance, lowering a package
7635 yields a derivation, and lowering a @code{plain-file} yields a store
7636 item. This is achieved using the @code{lower-object} monadic procedure.
7637
7638 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} lower-object @var{obj} [@var{system}] @
7639 [#:target #f]
7640 Return as a value in @var{%store-monad} the derivation or store item
7641 corresponding to @var{obj} for @var{system}, cross-compiling for
7642 @var{target} if @var{target} is true. @var{obj} must be an object that
7643 has an associated gexp compiler, such as a @code{<package>}.
7644 @end deffn
7645
7646 @node Invoking guix repl
7647 @section Invoking @command{guix repl}
7648
7649 @cindex REPL, read-eval-print loop
7650 The @command{guix repl} command spawns a Guile @dfn{read-eval-print loop}
7651 (REPL) for interactive programming (@pxref{Using Guile Interactively,,, guile,
7652 GNU Guile Reference Manual}). Compared to just launching the @command{guile}
7653 command, @command{guix repl} guarantees that all the Guix modules and all its
7654 dependencies are available in the search path. You can use it this way:
7655
7656 @example
7657 $ guix repl
7658 scheme@@(guile-user)> ,use (gnu packages base)
7659 scheme@@(guile-user)> coreutils
7660 $1 = #<package coreutils@@8.29 gnu/packages/base.scm:327 3e28300>
7661 @end example
7662
7663 @cindex inferiors
7664 In addition, @command{guix repl} implements a simple machine-readable REPL
7665 protocol for use by @code{(guix inferior)}, a facility to interact with
7666 @dfn{inferiors}, separate processes running a potentially different revision
7667 of Guix.
7668
7669 The available options are as follows:
7670
7671 @table @code
7672 @item --type=@var{type}
7673 @itemx -t @var{type}
7674 Start a REPL of the given @var{TYPE}, which can be one of the following:
7675
7676 @table @code
7677 @item guile
7678 This is default, and it spawns a standard full-featured Guile REPL.
7679 @item machine
7680 Spawn a REPL that uses the machine-readable protocol. This is the protocol
7681 that the @code{(guix inferior)} module speaks.
7682 @end table
7683
7684 @item --listen=@var{endpoint}
7685 By default, @command{guix repl} reads from standard input and writes to
7686 standard output. When this option is passed, it will instead listen for
7687 connections on @var{endpoint}. Here are examples of valid options:
7688
7689 @table @code
7690 @item --listen=tcp:37146
7691 Accept connections on localhost on port 37146.
7692
7693 @item --listen=unix:/tmp/socket
7694 Accept connections on the Unix-domain socket @file{/tmp/socket}.
7695 @end table
7696 @end table
7697
7698 @c *********************************************************************
7699 @node Utilities
7700 @chapter Utilities
7701
7702 This section describes Guix command-line utilities. Some of them are
7703 primarily targeted at developers and users who write new package
7704 definitions, while others are more generally useful. They complement
7705 the Scheme programming interface of Guix in a convenient way.
7706
7707 @menu
7708 * Invoking guix build:: Building packages from the command line.
7709 * Invoking guix edit:: Editing package definitions.
7710 * Invoking guix download:: Downloading a file and printing its hash.
7711 * Invoking guix hash:: Computing the cryptographic hash of a file.
7712 * Invoking guix import:: Importing package definitions.
7713 * Invoking guix refresh:: Updating package definitions.
7714 * Invoking guix lint:: Finding errors in package definitions.
7715 * Invoking guix size:: Profiling disk usage.
7716 * Invoking guix graph:: Visualizing the graph of packages.
7717 * Invoking guix publish:: Sharing substitutes.
7718 * Invoking guix challenge:: Challenging substitute servers.
7719 * Invoking guix copy:: Copying to and from a remote store.
7720 * Invoking guix container:: Process isolation.
7721 * Invoking guix weather:: Assessing substitute availability.
7722 * Invoking guix processes:: Listing client processes.
7723 @end menu
7724
7725 @node Invoking guix build
7726 @section Invoking @command{guix build}
7727
7728 @cindex package building
7729 @cindex @command{guix build}
7730 The @command{guix build} command builds packages or derivations and
7731 their dependencies, and prints the resulting store paths. Note that it
7732 does not modify the user's profile---this is the job of the
7733 @command{guix package} command (@pxref{Invoking guix package}). Thus,
7734 it is mainly useful for distribution developers.
7735
7736 The general syntax is:
7737
7738 @example
7739 guix build @var{options} @var{package-or-derivation}@dots{}
7740 @end example
7741
7742 As an example, the following command builds the latest versions of Emacs
7743 and of Guile, displays their build logs, and finally displays the
7744 resulting directories:
7745
7746 @example
7747 guix build emacs guile
7748 @end example
7749
7750 Similarly, the following command builds all the available packages:
7751
7752 @example
7753 guix build --quiet --keep-going \
7754 `guix package -A | cut -f1,2 --output-delimiter=@@`
7755 @end example
7756
7757 @var{package-or-derivation} may be either the name of a package found in
7758 the software distribution such as @code{coreutils} or
7759 @code{coreutils@@8.20}, or a derivation such as
7760 @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.19.drv}. In the former case, a
7761 package with the corresponding name (and optionally version) is searched
7762 for among the GNU distribution modules (@pxref{Package Modules}).
7763
7764 Alternatively, the @code{--expression} option may be used to specify a
7765 Scheme expression that evaluates to a package; this is useful when
7766 disambiguating among several same-named packages or package variants is
7767 needed.
7768
7769 There may be zero or more @var{options}. The available options are
7770 described in the subsections below.
7771
7772 @menu
7773 * Common Build Options:: Build options for most commands.
7774 * Package Transformation Options:: Creating variants of packages.
7775 * Additional Build Options:: Options specific to 'guix build'.
7776 * Debugging Build Failures:: Real life packaging experience.
7777 @end menu
7778
7779 @node Common Build Options
7780 @subsection Common Build Options
7781
7782 A number of options that control the build process are common to
7783 @command{guix build} and other commands that can spawn builds, such as
7784 @command{guix package} or @command{guix archive}. These are the
7785 following:
7786
7787 @table @code
7788
7789 @item --load-path=@var{directory}
7790 @itemx -L @var{directory}
7791 Add @var{directory} to the front of the package module search path
7792 (@pxref{Package Modules}).
7793
7794 This allows users to define their own packages and make them visible to
7795 the command-line tools.
7796
7797 @item --keep-failed
7798 @itemx -K
7799 Keep the build tree of failed builds. Thus, if a build fails, its build
7800 tree is kept under @file{/tmp}, in a directory whose name is shown at
7801 the end of the build log. This is useful when debugging build issues.
7802 @xref{Debugging Build Failures}, for tips and tricks on how to debug
7803 build issues.
7804
7805 This option has no effect when connecting to a remote daemon with a
7806 @code{guix://} URI (@pxref{The Store, the @code{GUIX_DAEMON_SOCKET}
7807 variable}).
7808
7809 @item --keep-going
7810 @itemx -k
7811 Keep going when some of the derivations fail to build; return only once
7812 all the builds have either completed or failed.
7813
7814 The default behavior is to stop as soon as one of the specified
7815 derivations has failed.
7816
7817 @item --dry-run
7818 @itemx -n
7819 Do not build the derivations.
7820
7821 @anchor{fallback-option}
7822 @item --fallback
7823 When substituting a pre-built binary fails, fall back to building
7824 packages locally (@pxref{Substitution Failure}).
7825
7826 @item --substitute-urls=@var{urls}
7827 @anchor{client-substitute-urls}
7828 Consider @var{urls} the whitespace-separated list of substitute source
7829 URLs, overriding the default list of URLs of @command{guix-daemon}
7830 (@pxref{daemon-substitute-urls,, @command{guix-daemon} URLs}).
7831
7832 This means that substitutes may be downloaded from @var{urls}, provided
7833 they are signed by a key authorized by the system administrator
7834 (@pxref{Substitutes}).
7835
7836 When @var{urls} is the empty string, substitutes are effectively
7837 disabled.
7838
7839 @item --no-substitutes
7840 Do not use substitutes for build products. That is, always build things
7841 locally instead of allowing downloads of pre-built binaries
7842 (@pxref{Substitutes}).
7843
7844 @item --no-grafts
7845 Do not ``graft'' packages. In practice, this means that package updates
7846 available as grafts are not applied. @xref{Security Updates}, for more
7847 information on grafts.
7848
7849 @item --rounds=@var{n}
7850 Build each derivation @var{n} times in a row, and raise an error if
7851 consecutive build results are not bit-for-bit identical.
7852
7853 This is a useful way to detect non-deterministic builds processes.
7854 Non-deterministic build processes are a problem because they make it
7855 practically impossible for users to @emph{verify} whether third-party
7856 binaries are genuine. @xref{Invoking guix challenge}, for more.
7857
7858 Note that, currently, the differing build results are not kept around,
7859 so you will have to manually investigate in case of an error---e.g., by
7860 stashing one of the build results with @code{guix archive --export}
7861 (@pxref{Invoking guix archive}), then rebuilding, and finally comparing
7862 the two results.
7863
7864 @item --no-build-hook
7865 Do not attempt to offload builds @i{via} the ``build hook'' of the daemon
7866 (@pxref{Daemon Offload Setup}). That is, always build things locally
7867 instead of offloading builds to remote machines.
7868
7869 @item --max-silent-time=@var{seconds}
7870 When the build or substitution process remains silent for more than
7871 @var{seconds}, terminate it and report a build failure.
7872
7873 By default, the daemon's setting is honored (@pxref{Invoking
7874 guix-daemon, @code{--max-silent-time}}).
7875
7876 @item --timeout=@var{seconds}
7877 Likewise, when the build or substitution process lasts for more than
7878 @var{seconds}, terminate it and report a build failure.
7879
7880 By default, the daemon's setting is honored (@pxref{Invoking
7881 guix-daemon, @code{--timeout}}).
7882
7883 @c Note: This option is actually not part of %standard-build-options but
7884 @c most programs honor it.
7885 @cindex verbosity, of the command-line tools
7886 @cindex build logs, verbosity
7887 @item -v @var{level}
7888 @itemx --verbosity=@var{level}
7889 Use the given verbosity @var{level}, an integer. Choosing 0 means that no
7890 output is produced, 1 is for quiet output, and 2 shows all the build log
7891 output on standard error.
7892
7893 @item --cores=@var{n}
7894 @itemx -c @var{n}
7895 Allow the use of up to @var{n} CPU cores for the build. The special
7896 value @code{0} means to use as many CPU cores as available.
7897
7898 @item --max-jobs=@var{n}
7899 @itemx -M @var{n}
7900 Allow at most @var{n} build jobs in parallel. @xref{Invoking
7901 guix-daemon, @code{--max-jobs}}, for details about this option and the
7902 equivalent @command{guix-daemon} option.
7903
7904 @item --debug=@var{level}
7905 Produce debugging output coming from the build daemon. @var{level} must be an
7906 integer between 0 and 5; higher means more verbose output. Setting a level of
7907 4 or more may be helpful when debugging setup issues with the build daemon.
7908
7909 @end table
7910
7911 Behind the scenes, @command{guix build} is essentially an interface to
7912 the @code{package-derivation} procedure of the @code{(guix packages)}
7913 module, and to the @code{build-derivations} procedure of the @code{(guix
7914 derivations)} module.
7915
7916 In addition to options explicitly passed on the command line,
7917 @command{guix build} and other @command{guix} commands that support
7918 building honor the @code{GUIX_BUILD_OPTIONS} environment variable.
7919
7920 @defvr {Environment Variable} GUIX_BUILD_OPTIONS
7921 Users can define this variable to a list of command line options that
7922 will automatically be used by @command{guix build} and other
7923 @command{guix} commands that can perform builds, as in the example
7924 below:
7925
7926 @example
7927 $ export GUIX_BUILD_OPTIONS="--no-substitutes -c 2 -L /foo/bar"
7928 @end example
7929
7930 These options are parsed independently, and the result is appended to
7931 the parsed command-line options.
7932 @end defvr
7933
7934
7935 @node Package Transformation Options
7936 @subsection Package Transformation Options
7937
7938 @cindex package variants
7939 Another set of command-line options supported by @command{guix build}
7940 and also @command{guix package} are @dfn{package transformation
7941 options}. These are options that make it possible to define @dfn{package
7942 variants}---for instance, packages built from different source code.
7943 This is a convenient way to create customized packages on the fly
7944 without having to type in the definitions of package variants
7945 (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
7946
7947 @table @code
7948
7949 @item --with-source=@var{source}
7950 @itemx --with-source=@var{package}=@var{source}
7951 @itemx --with-source=@var{package}@@@var{version}=@var{source}
7952 Use @var{source} as the source of @var{package}, and @var{version} as
7953 its version number.
7954 @var{source} must be a file name or a URL, as for @command{guix
7955 download} (@pxref{Invoking guix download}).
7956
7957 When @var{package} is omitted,
7958 it is taken to be the package name specified on the
7959 command line that matches the base of @var{source}---e.g.,
7960 if @var{source} is @code{/src/guile-2.0.10.tar.gz}, the corresponding
7961 package is @code{guile}.
7962
7963 Likewise, when @var{version} is omitted, the version string is inferred from
7964 @var{source}; in the previous example, it is @code{2.0.10}.
7965
7966 This option allows users to try out versions of packages other than the
7967 one provided by the distribution. The example below downloads
7968 @file{ed-1.7.tar.gz} from a GNU mirror and uses that as the source for
7969 the @code{ed} package:
7970
7971 @example
7972 guix build ed --with-source=mirror://gnu/ed/ed-1.7.tar.gz
7973 @end example
7974
7975 As a developer, @code{--with-source} makes it easy to test release
7976 candidates:
7977
7978 @example
7979 guix build guile --with-source=../guile-2.0.9.219-e1bb7.tar.xz
7980 @end example
7981
7982 @dots{} or to build from a checkout in a pristine environment:
7983
7984 @example
7985 $ git clone git://git.sv.gnu.org/guix.git
7986 $ guix build guix --with-source=guix@@1.0=./guix
7987 @end example
7988
7989 @item --with-input=@var{package}=@var{replacement}
7990 Replace dependency on @var{package} by a dependency on
7991 @var{replacement}. @var{package} must be a package name, and
7992 @var{replacement} must be a package specification such as @code{guile}
7993 or @code{guile@@1.8}.
7994
7995 For instance, the following command builds Guix, but replaces its
7996 dependency on the current stable version of Guile with a dependency on
7997 the legacy version of Guile, @code{guile@@2.0}:
7998
7999 @example
8000 guix build --with-input=guile=guile@@2.0 guix
8001 @end example
8002
8003 This is a recursive, deep replacement. So in this example, both
8004 @code{guix} and its dependency @code{guile-json} (which also depends on
8005 @code{guile}) get rebuilt against @code{guile@@2.0}.
8006
8007 This is implemented using the @code{package-input-rewriting} Scheme
8008 procedure (@pxref{Defining Packages, @code{package-input-rewriting}}).
8009
8010 @item --with-graft=@var{package}=@var{replacement}
8011 This is similar to @code{--with-input} but with an important difference:
8012 instead of rebuilding the whole dependency chain, @var{replacement} is
8013 built and then @dfn{grafted} onto the binaries that were initially
8014 referring to @var{package}. @xref{Security Updates}, for more
8015 information on grafts.
8016
8017 For example, the command below grafts version 3.5.4 of GnuTLS onto Wget
8018 and all its dependencies, replacing references to the version of GnuTLS
8019 they currently refer to:
8020
8021 @example
8022 guix build --with-graft=gnutls=gnutls@@3.5.4 wget
8023 @end example
8024
8025 This has the advantage of being much faster than rebuilding everything.
8026 But there is a caveat: it works if and only if @var{package} and
8027 @var{replacement} are strictly compatible---for example, if they provide
8028 a library, the application binary interface (ABI) of those libraries
8029 must be compatible. If @var{replacement} is somehow incompatible with
8030 @var{package}, then the resulting package may be unusable. Use with
8031 care!
8032
8033 @item --with-git-url=@var{package}=@var{url}
8034 @cindex Git, using the latest commit
8035 @cindex latest commit, building
8036 Build @var{package} from the latest commit of the @code{master} branch of the
8037 Git repository at @var{url}. Git sub-modules of the repository are fetched,
8038 recursively.
8039
8040 For example, the following command builds the NumPy Python library against the
8041 latest commit of the master branch of Python itself:
8042
8043 @example
8044 guix build python-numpy \
8045 --with-git-url=python=https://github.com/python/cpython
8046 @end example
8047
8048 This option can also be combined with @code{--with-branch} or
8049 @code{--with-commit} (see below).
8050
8051 @cindex continuous integration
8052 Obviously, since it uses the latest commit of the given branch, the result of
8053 such a command varies over time. Nevertheless it is a convenient way to
8054 rebuild entire software stacks against the latest commit of one or more
8055 packages. This is particularly useful in the context of continuous
8056 integration (CI).
8057
8058 Checkouts are kept in a cache under @file{~/.cache/guix/checkouts} to speed up
8059 consecutive accesses to the same repository. You may want to clean it up once
8060 in a while to save disk space.
8061
8062 @item --with-branch=@var{package}=@var{branch}
8063 Build @var{package} from the latest commit of @var{branch}. If the
8064 @code{source} field of @var{package} is an origin with the @code{git-fetch}
8065 method (@pxref{origin Reference}) or a @code{git-checkout} object, the
8066 repository URL is taken from that @code{source}. Otherwise you have to use
8067 @code{--with-git-url} to specify the URL of the Git repository.
8068
8069 For instance, the following command builds @code{guile-sqlite3} from the
8070 latest commit of its @code{master} branch, and then builds @code{guix} (which
8071 depends on it) and @code{cuirass} (which depends on @code{guix}) against this
8072 specific @code{guile-sqlite3} build:
8073
8074 @example
8075 guix build --with-branch=guile-sqlite3=master cuirass
8076 @end example
8077
8078 @item --with-commit=@var{package}=@var{commit}
8079 This is similar to @code{--with-branch}, except that it builds from
8080 @var{commit} rather than the tip of a branch. @var{commit} must be a valid
8081 Git commit SHA1 identifier or a tag.
8082 @end table
8083
8084 @node Additional Build Options
8085 @subsection Additional Build Options
8086
8087 The command-line options presented below are specific to @command{guix
8088 build}.
8089
8090 @table @code
8091
8092 @item --quiet
8093 @itemx -q
8094 Build quietly, without displaying the build log; this is equivalent to
8095 @code{--verbosity=0}. Upon completion, the build log is kept in @file{/var}
8096 (or similar) and can always be retrieved using the @option{--log-file} option.
8097
8098 @item --file=@var{file}
8099 @itemx -f @var{file}
8100 Build the package, derivation, or other file-like object that the code within
8101 @var{file} evaluates to (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like objects}).
8102
8103 As an example, @var{file} might contain a package definition like this
8104 (@pxref{Defining Packages}):
8105
8106 @lisp
8107 @verbatiminclude package-hello.scm
8108 @end lisp
8109
8110 @item --expression=@var{expr}
8111 @itemx -e @var{expr}
8112 Build the package or derivation @var{expr} evaluates to.
8113
8114 For example, @var{expr} may be @code{(@@ (gnu packages guile)
8115 guile-1.8)}, which unambiguously designates this specific variant of
8116 version 1.8 of Guile.
8117
8118 Alternatively, @var{expr} may be a G-expression, in which case it is used
8119 as a build program passed to @code{gexp->derivation}
8120 (@pxref{G-Expressions}).
8121
8122 Lastly, @var{expr} may refer to a zero-argument monadic procedure
8123 (@pxref{The Store Monad}). The procedure must return a derivation as a
8124 monadic value, which is then passed through @code{run-with-store}.
8125
8126 @item --source
8127 @itemx -S
8128 Build the source derivations of the packages, rather than the packages
8129 themselves.
8130
8131 For instance, @code{guix build -S gcc} returns something like
8132 @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-gcc-4.7.2.tar.bz2}, which is the GCC
8133 source tarball.
8134
8135 The returned source tarball is the result of applying any patches and
8136 code snippets specified in the package @code{origin} (@pxref{Defining
8137 Packages}).
8138
8139 @item --sources
8140 Fetch and return the source of @var{package-or-derivation} and all their
8141 dependencies, recursively. This is a handy way to obtain a local copy
8142 of all the source code needed to build @var{packages}, allowing you to
8143 eventually build them even without network access. It is an extension
8144 of the @code{--source} option and can accept one of the following
8145 optional argument values:
8146
8147 @table @code
8148 @item package
8149 This value causes the @code{--sources} option to behave in the same way
8150 as the @code{--source} option.
8151
8152 @item all
8153 Build the source derivations of all packages, including any source that
8154 might be listed as @code{inputs}. This is the default value.
8155
8156 @example
8157 $ guix build --sources tzdata
8158 The following derivations will be built:
8159 /gnu/store/@dots{}-tzdata2015b.tar.gz.drv
8160 /gnu/store/@dots{}-tzcode2015b.tar.gz.drv
8161 @end example
8162
8163 @item transitive
8164 Build the source derivations of all packages, as well of all transitive
8165 inputs to the packages. This can be used e.g.@: to
8166 prefetch package source for later offline building.
8167
8168 @example
8169 $ guix build --sources=transitive tzdata
8170 The following derivations will be built:
8171 /gnu/store/@dots{}-tzcode2015b.tar.gz.drv
8172 /gnu/store/@dots{}-findutils-4.4.2.tar.xz.drv
8173 /gnu/store/@dots{}-grep-2.21.tar.xz.drv
8174 /gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.23.tar.xz.drv
8175 /gnu/store/@dots{}-make-4.1.tar.xz.drv
8176 /gnu/store/@dots{}-bash-4.3.tar.xz.drv
8177 @dots{}
8178 @end example
8179
8180 @end table
8181
8182 @item --system=@var{system}
8183 @itemx -s @var{system}
8184 Attempt to build for @var{system}---e.g., @code{i686-linux}---instead of
8185 the system type of the build host. The @command{guix build} command allows
8186 you to repeat this option several times, in which case it builds for all the
8187 specified systems; other commands ignore extraneous @option{-s} options.
8188
8189 @quotation Note
8190 The @code{--system} flag is for @emph{native} compilation and must not
8191 be confused with cross-compilation. See @code{--target} below for
8192 information on cross-compilation.
8193 @end quotation
8194
8195 An example use of this is on Linux-based systems, which can emulate
8196 different personalities. For instance, passing
8197 @code{--system=i686-linux} on an @code{x86_64-linux} system or
8198 @code{--system=armhf-linux} on an @code{aarch64-linux} system allows you
8199 to build packages in a complete 32-bit environment.
8200
8201 @quotation Note
8202 Building for an @code{armhf-linux} system is unconditionally enabled on
8203 @code{aarch64-linux} machines, although certain aarch64 chipsets do not
8204 allow for this functionality, notably the ThunderX.
8205 @end quotation
8206
8207 Similarly, when transparent emulation with QEMU and @code{binfmt_misc}
8208 is enabled (@pxref{Virtualization Services,
8209 @code{qemu-binfmt-service-type}}), you can build for any system for
8210 which a QEMU @code{binfmt_misc} handler is installed.
8211
8212 Builds for a system other than that of the machine you are using can
8213 also be offloaded to a remote machine of the right architecture.
8214 @xref{Daemon Offload Setup}, for more information on offloading.
8215
8216 @item --target=@var{triplet}
8217 @cindex cross-compilation
8218 Cross-build for @var{triplet}, which must be a valid GNU triplet, such
8219 as @code{"mips64el-linux-gnu"} (@pxref{Specifying Target Triplets, GNU
8220 configuration triplets,, autoconf, Autoconf}).
8221
8222 @anchor{build-check}
8223 @item --check
8224 @cindex determinism, checking
8225 @cindex reproducibility, checking
8226 Rebuild @var{package-or-derivation}, which are already available in the
8227 store, and raise an error if the build results are not bit-for-bit
8228 identical.
8229
8230 This mechanism allows you to check whether previously installed
8231 substitutes are genuine (@pxref{Substitutes}), or whether the build result
8232 of a package is deterministic. @xref{Invoking guix challenge}, for more
8233 background information and tools.
8234
8235 When used in conjunction with @option{--keep-failed}, the differing
8236 output is kept in the store, under @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-check}.
8237 This makes it easy to look for differences between the two results.
8238
8239 @item --repair
8240 @cindex repairing store items
8241 @cindex corruption, recovering from
8242 Attempt to repair the specified store items, if they are corrupt, by
8243 re-downloading or rebuilding them.
8244
8245 This operation is not atomic and thus restricted to @code{root}.
8246
8247 @item --derivations
8248 @itemx -d
8249 Return the derivation paths, not the output paths, of the given
8250 packages.
8251
8252 @item --root=@var{file}
8253 @itemx -r @var{file}
8254 @cindex GC roots, adding
8255 @cindex garbage collector roots, adding
8256 Make @var{file} a symlink to the result, and register it as a garbage
8257 collector root.
8258
8259 Consequently, the results of this @command{guix build} invocation are
8260 protected from garbage collection until @var{file} is removed. When
8261 that option is omitted, build results are eligible for garbage
8262 collection as soon as the build completes. @xref{Invoking guix gc}, for
8263 more on GC roots.
8264
8265 @item --log-file
8266 @cindex build logs, access
8267 Return the build log file names or URLs for the given
8268 @var{package-or-derivation}, or raise an error if build logs are
8269 missing.
8270
8271 This works regardless of how packages or derivations are specified. For
8272 instance, the following invocations are equivalent:
8273
8274 @example
8275 guix build --log-file `guix build -d guile`
8276 guix build --log-file `guix build guile`
8277 guix build --log-file guile
8278 guix build --log-file -e '(@@ (gnu packages guile) guile-2.0)'
8279 @end example
8280
8281 If a log is unavailable locally, and unless @code{--no-substitutes} is
8282 passed, the command looks for a corresponding log on one of the
8283 substitute servers (as specified with @code{--substitute-urls}.)
8284
8285 So for instance, imagine you want to see the build log of GDB on MIPS,
8286 but you are actually on an @code{x86_64} machine:
8287
8288 @example
8289 $ guix build --log-file gdb -s mips64el-linux
8290 https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}/log/@dots{}-gdb-7.10
8291 @end example
8292
8293 You can freely access a huge library of build logs!
8294 @end table
8295
8296 @node Debugging Build Failures
8297 @subsection Debugging Build Failures
8298
8299 @cindex build failures, debugging
8300 When defining a new package (@pxref{Defining Packages}), you will
8301 probably find yourself spending some time debugging and tweaking the
8302 build until it succeeds. To do that, you need to operate the build
8303 commands yourself in an environment as close as possible to the one the
8304 build daemon uses.
8305
8306 To that end, the first thing to do is to use the @option{--keep-failed}
8307 or @option{-K} option of @command{guix build}, which will keep the
8308 failed build tree in @file{/tmp} or whatever directory you specified as
8309 @code{TMPDIR} (@pxref{Invoking guix build, @code{--keep-failed}}).
8310
8311 From there on, you can @command{cd} to the failed build tree and source
8312 the @file{environment-variables} file, which contains all the
8313 environment variable definitions that were in place when the build
8314 failed. So let's say you're debugging a build failure in package
8315 @code{foo}; a typical session would look like this:
8316
8317 @example
8318 $ guix build foo -K
8319 @dots{} @i{build fails}
8320 $ cd /tmp/guix-build-foo.drv-0
8321 $ source ./environment-variables
8322 $ cd foo-1.2
8323 @end example
8324
8325 Now, you can invoke commands as if you were the daemon (almost) and
8326 troubleshoot your build process.
8327
8328 Sometimes it happens that, for example, a package's tests pass when you
8329 run them manually but they fail when the daemon runs them. This can
8330 happen because the daemon runs builds in containers where, unlike in our
8331 environment above, network access is missing, @file{/bin/sh} does not
8332 exist, etc. (@pxref{Build Environment Setup}).
8333
8334 In such cases, you may need to run inspect the build process from within
8335 a container similar to the one the build daemon creates:
8336
8337 @example
8338 $ guix build -K foo
8339 @dots{}
8340 $ cd /tmp/guix-build-foo.drv-0
8341 $ guix environment --no-grafts -C foo --ad-hoc strace gdb
8342 [env]# source ./environment-variables
8343 [env]# cd foo-1.2
8344 @end example
8345
8346 Here, @command{guix environment -C} creates a container and spawns a new
8347 shell in it (@pxref{Invoking guix environment}). The @command{--ad-hoc
8348 strace gdb} part adds the @command{strace} and @command{gdb} commands to
8349 the container, which would may find handy while debugging. The
8350 @option{--no-grafts} option makes sure we get the exact same
8351 environment, with ungrafted packages (@pxref{Security Updates}, for more
8352 info on grafts).
8353
8354 To get closer to a container like that used by the build daemon, we can
8355 remove @file{/bin/sh}:
8356
8357 @example
8358 [env]# rm /bin/sh
8359 @end example
8360
8361 (Don't worry, this is harmless: this is all happening in the throw-away
8362 container created by @command{guix environment}.)
8363
8364 The @command{strace} command is probably not in the search path, but we
8365 can run:
8366
8367 @example
8368 [env]# $GUIX_ENVIRONMENT/bin/strace -f -o log make check
8369 @end example
8370
8371 In this way, not only you will have reproduced the environment variables
8372 the daemon uses, you will also be running the build process in a container
8373 similar to the one the daemon uses.
8374
8375
8376 @node Invoking guix edit
8377 @section Invoking @command{guix edit}
8378
8379 @cindex @command{guix edit}
8380 @cindex package definition, editing
8381 So many packages, so many source files! The @command{guix edit} command
8382 facilitates the life of users and packagers by pointing their editor at
8383 the source file containing the definition of the specified packages.
8384 For instance:
8385
8386 @example
8387 guix edit gcc@@4.9 vim
8388 @end example
8389
8390 @noindent
8391 launches the program specified in the @code{VISUAL} or in the
8392 @code{EDITOR} environment variable to view the recipe of GCC@tie{}4.9.3
8393 and that of Vim.
8394
8395 If you are using a Guix Git checkout (@pxref{Building from Git}), or
8396 have created your own packages on @code{GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH}
8397 (@pxref{Package Modules}), you will be able to edit the package
8398 recipes. In other cases, you will be able to examine the read-only recipes
8399 for packages currently in the store.
8400
8401
8402 @node Invoking guix download
8403 @section Invoking @command{guix download}
8404
8405 @cindex @command{guix download}
8406 @cindex downloading package sources
8407 When writing a package definition, developers typically need to download
8408 a source tarball, compute its SHA256 hash, and write that
8409 hash in the package definition (@pxref{Defining Packages}). The
8410 @command{guix download} tool helps with this task: it downloads a file
8411 from the given URI, adds it to the store, and prints both its file name
8412 in the store and its SHA256 hash.
8413
8414 The fact that the downloaded file is added to the store saves bandwidth:
8415 when the developer eventually tries to build the newly defined package
8416 with @command{guix build}, the source tarball will not have to be
8417 downloaded again because it is already in the store. It is also a
8418 convenient way to temporarily stash files, which may be deleted
8419 eventually (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}).
8420
8421 The @command{guix download} command supports the same URIs as used in
8422 package definitions. In particular, it supports @code{mirror://} URIs.
8423 @code{https} URIs (HTTP over TLS) are supported @emph{provided} the
8424 Guile bindings for GnuTLS are available in the user's environment; when
8425 they are not available, an error is raised. @xref{Guile Preparations,
8426 how to install the GnuTLS bindings for Guile,, gnutls-guile,
8427 GnuTLS-Guile}, for more information.
8428
8429 @command{guix download} verifies HTTPS server certificates by loading
8430 the certificates of X.509 authorities from the directory pointed to by
8431 the @code{SSL_CERT_DIR} environment variable (@pxref{X.509
8432 Certificates}), unless @option{--no-check-certificate} is used.
8433
8434 The following options are available:
8435
8436 @table @code
8437 @item --format=@var{fmt}
8438 @itemx -f @var{fmt}
8439 Write the hash in the format specified by @var{fmt}. For more
8440 information on the valid values for @var{fmt}, @pxref{Invoking guix hash}.
8441
8442 @item --no-check-certificate
8443 Do not validate the X.509 certificates of HTTPS servers.
8444
8445 When using this option, you have @emph{absolutely no guarantee} that you
8446 are communicating with the authentic server responsible for the given
8447 URL, which makes you vulnerable to ``man-in-the-middle'' attacks.
8448
8449 @item --output=@var{file}
8450 @itemx -o @var{file}
8451 Save the downloaded file to @var{file} instead of adding it to the
8452 store.
8453 @end table
8454
8455 @node Invoking guix hash
8456 @section Invoking @command{guix hash}
8457
8458 @cindex @command{guix hash}
8459 The @command{guix hash} command computes the SHA256 hash of a file.
8460 It is primarily a convenience tool for anyone contributing to the
8461 distribution: it computes the cryptographic hash of a file, which can be
8462 used in the definition of a package (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
8463
8464 The general syntax is:
8465
8466 @example
8467 guix hash @var{option} @var{file}
8468 @end example
8469
8470 When @var{file} is @code{-} (a hyphen), @command{guix hash} computes the
8471 hash of data read from standard input. @command{guix hash} has the
8472 following options:
8473
8474 @table @code
8475
8476 @item --format=@var{fmt}
8477 @itemx -f @var{fmt}
8478 Write the hash in the format specified by @var{fmt}.
8479
8480 Supported formats: @code{nix-base32}, @code{base32}, @code{base16}
8481 (@code{hex} and @code{hexadecimal} can be used as well).
8482
8483 If the @option{--format} option is not specified, @command{guix hash}
8484 will output the hash in @code{nix-base32}. This representation is used
8485 in the definitions of packages.
8486
8487 @item --recursive
8488 @itemx -r
8489 Compute the hash on @var{file} recursively.
8490
8491 In this case, the hash is computed on an archive containing @var{file},
8492 including its children if it is a directory. Some of the metadata of
8493 @var{file} is part of the archive; for instance, when @var{file} is a
8494 regular file, the hash is different depending on whether @var{file} is
8495 executable or not. Metadata such as time stamps has no impact on the
8496 hash (@pxref{Invoking guix archive}).
8497 @c FIXME: Replace xref above with xref to an ``Archive'' section when
8498 @c it exists.
8499
8500 @item --exclude-vcs
8501 @itemx -x
8502 When combined with @option{--recursive}, exclude version control system
8503 directories (@file{.bzr}, @file{.git}, @file{.hg}, etc.)
8504
8505 @vindex git-fetch
8506 As an example, here is how you would compute the hash of a Git checkout,
8507 which is useful when using the @code{git-fetch} method (@pxref{origin
8508 Reference}):
8509
8510 @example
8511 $ git clone http://example.org/foo.git
8512 $ cd foo
8513 $ guix hash -rx .
8514 @end example
8515 @end table
8516
8517 @node Invoking guix import
8518 @section Invoking @command{guix import}
8519
8520 @cindex importing packages
8521 @cindex package import
8522 @cindex package conversion
8523 @cindex Invoking @command{guix import}
8524 The @command{guix import} command is useful for people who would like to
8525 add a package to the distribution with as little work as
8526 possible---a legitimate demand. The command knows of a few
8527 repositories from which it can ``import'' package metadata. The result
8528 is a package definition, or a template thereof, in the format we know
8529 (@pxref{Defining Packages}).
8530
8531 The general syntax is:
8532
8533 @example
8534 guix import @var{importer} @var{options}@dots{}
8535 @end example
8536
8537 @var{importer} specifies the source from which to import package
8538 metadata, and @var{options} specifies a package identifier and other
8539 options specific to @var{importer}.
8540
8541 Some of the importers rely on the ability to run the @command{gpgv} command.
8542 For these, GnuPG must be installed and in @code{$PATH}; run @code{guix install
8543 gnupg} if needed.
8544
8545 Currently, the available ``importers'' are:
8546
8547 @table @code
8548 @item gnu
8549 Import metadata for the given GNU package. This provides a template
8550 for the latest version of that GNU package, including the hash of its
8551 source tarball, and its canonical synopsis and description.
8552
8553 Additional information such as the package dependencies and its
8554 license needs to be figured out manually.
8555
8556 For example, the following command returns a package definition for
8557 GNU@tie{}Hello:
8558
8559 @example
8560 guix import gnu hello
8561 @end example
8562
8563 Specific command-line options are:
8564
8565 @table @code
8566 @item --key-download=@var{policy}
8567 As for @code{guix refresh}, specify the policy to handle missing OpenPGP
8568 keys when verifying the package signature. @xref{Invoking guix
8569 refresh, @code{--key-download}}.
8570 @end table
8571
8572 @item pypi
8573 @cindex pypi
8574 Import metadata from the @uref{https://pypi.python.org/, Python Package
8575 Index}. Information is taken from the JSON-formatted description
8576 available at @code{pypi.python.org} and usually includes all the relevant
8577 information, including package dependencies. For maximum efficiency, it
8578 is recommended to install the @command{unzip} utility, so that the
8579 importer can unzip Python wheels and gather data from them.
8580
8581 The command below imports metadata for the @code{itsdangerous} Python
8582 package:
8583
8584 @example
8585 guix import pypi itsdangerous
8586 @end example
8587
8588 @table @code
8589 @item --recursive
8590 @itemx -r
8591 Traverse the dependency graph of the given upstream package recursively
8592 and generate package expressions for all those packages that are not yet
8593 in Guix.
8594 @end table
8595
8596 @item gem
8597 @cindex gem
8598 Import metadata from @uref{https://rubygems.org/, RubyGems}. Information
8599 is taken from the JSON-formatted description available at
8600 @code{rubygems.org} and includes most relevant information, including
8601 runtime dependencies. There are some caveats, however. The metadata
8602 doesn't distinguish between synopses and descriptions, so the same string
8603 is used for both fields. Additionally, the details of non-Ruby
8604 dependencies required to build native extensions is unavailable and left
8605 as an exercise to the packager.
8606
8607 The command below imports metadata for the @code{rails} Ruby package:
8608
8609 @example
8610 guix import gem rails
8611 @end example
8612
8613 @table @code
8614 @item --recursive
8615 @itemx -r
8616 Traverse the dependency graph of the given upstream package recursively
8617 and generate package expressions for all those packages that are not yet
8618 in Guix.
8619 @end table
8620
8621 @item cpan
8622 @cindex CPAN
8623 Import metadata from @uref{https://www.metacpan.org/, MetaCPAN}.
8624 Information is taken from the JSON-formatted metadata provided through
8625 @uref{https://fastapi.metacpan.org/, MetaCPAN's API} and includes most
8626 relevant information, such as module dependencies. License information
8627 should be checked closely. If Perl is available in the store, then the
8628 @code{corelist} utility will be used to filter core modules out of the
8629 list of dependencies.
8630
8631 The command command below imports metadata for the @code{Acme::Boolean}
8632 Perl module:
8633
8634 @example
8635 guix import cpan Acme::Boolean
8636 @end example
8637
8638 @item cran
8639 @cindex CRAN
8640 @cindex Bioconductor
8641 Import metadata from @uref{https://cran.r-project.org/, CRAN}, the
8642 central repository for the @uref{https://r-project.org, GNU@tie{}R
8643 statistical and graphical environment}.
8644
8645 Information is extracted from the @code{DESCRIPTION} file of the package.
8646
8647 The command command below imports metadata for the @code{Cairo}
8648 R package:
8649
8650 @example
8651 guix import cran Cairo
8652 @end example
8653
8654 When @code{--recursive} is added, the importer will traverse the
8655 dependency graph of the given upstream package recursively and generate
8656 package expressions for all those packages that are not yet in Guix.
8657
8658 When @code{--archive=bioconductor} is added, metadata is imported from
8659 @uref{https://www.bioconductor.org/, Bioconductor}, a repository of R
8660 packages for for the analysis and comprehension of high-throughput
8661 genomic data in bioinformatics.
8662
8663 Information is extracted from the @code{DESCRIPTION} file contained in the
8664 package archive.
8665
8666 The command below imports metadata for the @code{GenomicRanges}
8667 R package:
8668
8669 @example
8670 guix import cran --archive=bioconductor GenomicRanges
8671 @end example
8672
8673 Finally, you can also import R packages that have not yet been published on
8674 CRAN or Bioconductor as long as they are in a git repository. Use
8675 @code{--archive=git} followed by the URL of the git repository:
8676
8677 @example
8678 guix import cran --archive=git https://github.com/immunogenomics/harmony
8679 @end example
8680
8681 @item texlive
8682 @cindex TeX Live
8683 @cindex CTAN
8684 Import metadata from @uref{https://www.ctan.org/, CTAN}, the
8685 comprehensive TeX archive network for TeX packages that are part of the
8686 @uref{https://www.tug.org/texlive/, TeX Live distribution}.
8687
8688 Information about the package is obtained through the XML API provided
8689 by CTAN, while the source code is downloaded from the SVN repository of
8690 the Tex Live project. This is done because the CTAN does not keep
8691 versioned archives.
8692
8693 The command command below imports metadata for the @code{fontspec}
8694 TeX package:
8695
8696 @example
8697 guix import texlive fontspec
8698 @end example
8699
8700 When @code{--archive=DIRECTORY} is added, the source code is downloaded
8701 not from the @file{latex} sub-directory of the @file{texmf-dist/source}
8702 tree in the TeX Live SVN repository, but from the specified sibling
8703 directory under the same root.
8704
8705 The command below imports metadata for the @code{ifxetex} package from
8706 CTAN while fetching the sources from the directory
8707 @file{texmf/source/generic}:
8708
8709 @example
8710 guix import texlive --archive=generic ifxetex
8711 @end example
8712
8713 @item json
8714 @cindex JSON, import
8715 Import package metadata from a local JSON file. Consider the following
8716 example package definition in JSON format:
8717
8718 @example
8719 @{
8720 "name": "hello",
8721 "version": "2.10",
8722 "source": "mirror://gnu/hello/hello-2.10.tar.gz",
8723 "build-system": "gnu",
8724 "home-page": "https://www.gnu.org/software/hello/",
8725 "synopsis": "Hello, GNU world: An example GNU package",
8726 "description": "GNU Hello prints a greeting.",
8727 "license": "GPL-3.0+",
8728 "native-inputs": ["gettext"]
8729 @}
8730 @end example
8731
8732 The field names are the same as for the @code{<package>} record
8733 (@xref{Defining Packages}). References to other packages are provided
8734 as JSON lists of quoted package specification strings such as
8735 @code{guile} or @code{guile@@2.0}.
8736
8737 The importer also supports a more explicit source definition using the
8738 common fields for @code{<origin>} records:
8739
8740 @example
8741 @{
8742 @dots{}
8743 "source": @{
8744 "method": "url-fetch",
8745 "uri": "mirror://gnu/hello/hello-2.10.tar.gz",
8746 "sha256": @{
8747 "base32": "0ssi1wpaf7plaswqqjwigppsg5fyh99vdlb9kzl7c9lng89ndq1i"
8748 @}
8749 @}
8750 @dots{}
8751 @}
8752 @end example
8753
8754 The command below reads metadata from the JSON file @code{hello.json}
8755 and outputs a package expression:
8756
8757 @example
8758 guix import json hello.json
8759 @end example
8760
8761 @item nix
8762 Import metadata from a local copy of the source of the
8763 @uref{https://nixos.org/nixpkgs/, Nixpkgs distribution}@footnote{This
8764 relies on the @command{nix-instantiate} command of
8765 @uref{https://nixos.org/nix/, Nix}.}. Package definitions in Nixpkgs are
8766 typically written in a mixture of Nix-language and Bash code. This
8767 command only imports the high-level package structure that is written in
8768 the Nix language. It normally includes all the basic fields of a
8769 package definition.
8770
8771 When importing a GNU package, the synopsis and descriptions are replaced
8772 by their canonical upstream variant.
8773
8774 Usually, you will first need to do:
8775
8776 @example
8777 export NIX_REMOTE=daemon
8778 @end example
8779
8780 @noindent
8781 so that @command{nix-instantiate} does not try to open the Nix database.
8782
8783 As an example, the command below imports the package definition of
8784 LibreOffice (more precisely, it imports the definition of the package
8785 bound to the @code{libreoffice} top-level attribute):
8786
8787 @example
8788 guix import nix ~/path/to/nixpkgs libreoffice
8789 @end example
8790
8791 @item hackage
8792 @cindex hackage
8793 Import metadata from the Haskell community's central package archive
8794 @uref{https://hackage.haskell.org/, Hackage}. Information is taken from
8795 Cabal files and includes all the relevant information, including package
8796 dependencies.
8797
8798 Specific command-line options are:
8799
8800 @table @code
8801 @item --stdin
8802 @itemx -s
8803 Read a Cabal file from standard input.
8804 @item --no-test-dependencies
8805 @itemx -t
8806 Do not include dependencies required only by the test suites.
8807 @item --cabal-environment=@var{alist}
8808 @itemx -e @var{alist}
8809 @var{alist} is a Scheme alist defining the environment in which the
8810 Cabal conditionals are evaluated. The accepted keys are: @code{os},
8811 @code{arch}, @code{impl} and a string representing the name of a flag.
8812 The value associated with a flag has to be either the symbol
8813 @code{true} or @code{false}. The value associated with other keys
8814 has to conform to the Cabal file format definition. The default value
8815 associated with the keys @code{os}, @code{arch} and @code{impl} is
8816 @samp{linux}, @samp{x86_64} and @samp{ghc}, respectively.
8817 @item --recursive
8818 @itemx -r
8819 Traverse the dependency graph of the given upstream package recursively
8820 and generate package expressions for all those packages that are not yet
8821 in Guix.
8822 @end table
8823
8824 The command below imports metadata for the latest version of the
8825 @code{HTTP} Haskell package without including test dependencies and
8826 specifying the value of the flag @samp{network-uri} as @code{false}:
8827
8828 @example
8829 guix import hackage -t -e "'((\"network-uri\" . false))" HTTP
8830 @end example
8831
8832 A specific package version may optionally be specified by following the
8833 package name by an at-sign and a version number as in the following example:
8834
8835 @example
8836 guix import hackage mtl@@2.1.3.1
8837 @end example
8838
8839 @item stackage
8840 @cindex stackage
8841 The @code{stackage} importer is a wrapper around the @code{hackage} one.
8842 It takes a package name, looks up the package version included in a
8843 long-term support (LTS) @uref{https://www.stackage.org, Stackage}
8844 release and uses the @code{hackage} importer to retrieve its metadata.
8845 Note that it is up to you to select an LTS release compatible with the
8846 GHC compiler used by Guix.
8847
8848 Specific command-line options are:
8849
8850 @table @code
8851 @item --no-test-dependencies
8852 @itemx -t
8853 Do not include dependencies required only by the test suites.
8854 @item --lts-version=@var{version}
8855 @itemx -l @var{version}
8856 @var{version} is the desired LTS release version. If omitted the latest
8857 release is used.
8858 @item --recursive
8859 @itemx -r
8860 Traverse the dependency graph of the given upstream package recursively
8861 and generate package expressions for all those packages that are not yet
8862 in Guix.
8863 @end table
8864
8865 The command below imports metadata for the @code{HTTP} Haskell package
8866 included in the LTS Stackage release version 7.18:
8867
8868 @example
8869 guix import stackage --lts-version=7.18 HTTP
8870 @end example
8871
8872 @item elpa
8873 @cindex elpa
8874 Import metadata from an Emacs Lisp Package Archive (ELPA) package
8875 repository (@pxref{Packages,,, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}).
8876
8877 Specific command-line options are:
8878
8879 @table @code
8880 @item --archive=@var{repo}
8881 @itemx -a @var{repo}
8882 @var{repo} identifies the archive repository from which to retrieve the
8883 information. Currently the supported repositories and their identifiers
8884 are:
8885 @itemize -
8886 @item
8887 @uref{https://elpa.gnu.org/packages, GNU}, selected by the @code{gnu}
8888 identifier. This is the default.
8889
8890 Packages from @code{elpa.gnu.org} are signed with one of the keys
8891 contained in the GnuPG keyring at
8892 @file{share/emacs/25.1/etc/package-keyring.gpg} (or similar) in the
8893 @code{emacs} package (@pxref{Package Installation, ELPA package
8894 signatures,, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}).
8895
8896 @item
8897 @uref{https://stable.melpa.org/packages, MELPA-Stable}, selected by the
8898 @code{melpa-stable} identifier.
8899
8900 @item
8901 @uref{https://melpa.org/packages, MELPA}, selected by the @code{melpa}
8902 identifier.
8903 @end itemize
8904
8905 @item --recursive
8906 @itemx -r
8907 Traverse the dependency graph of the given upstream package recursively
8908 and generate package expressions for all those packages that are not yet
8909 in Guix.
8910 @end table
8911
8912 @item crate
8913 @cindex crate
8914 Import metadata from the crates.io Rust package repository
8915 @uref{https://crates.io, crates.io}, as in this example:
8916
8917 @example
8918 guix import crate blake2-rfc
8919 @end example
8920
8921 The crate importer also allows you to specify a version string:
8922
8923 @example
8924 guix import crate constant-time-eq@@0.1.0
8925 @end example
8926
8927 @item opam
8928 @cindex OPAM
8929 @cindex OCaml
8930 Import metadata from the @uref{https://opam.ocaml.org/, OPAM} package
8931 repository used by the OCaml community.
8932 @end table
8933
8934 The structure of the @command{guix import} code is modular. It would be
8935 useful to have more importers for other package formats, and your help
8936 is welcome here (@pxref{Contributing}).
8937
8938 @node Invoking guix refresh
8939 @section Invoking @command{guix refresh}
8940
8941 @cindex @command {guix refresh}
8942 The primary audience of the @command{guix refresh} command is developers
8943 of the GNU software distribution. By default, it reports any packages
8944 provided by the distribution that are outdated compared to the latest
8945 upstream version, like this:
8946
8947 @example
8948 $ guix refresh
8949 gnu/packages/gettext.scm:29:13: gettext would be upgraded from 0.18.1.1 to 0.18.2.1
8950 gnu/packages/glib.scm:77:12: glib would be upgraded from 2.34.3 to 2.37.0
8951 @end example
8952
8953 Alternately, one can specify packages to consider, in which case a
8954 warning is emitted for packages that lack an updater:
8955
8956 @example
8957 $ guix refresh coreutils guile guile-ssh
8958 gnu/packages/ssh.scm:205:2: warning: no updater for guile-ssh
8959 gnu/packages/guile.scm:136:12: guile would be upgraded from 2.0.12 to 2.0.13
8960 @end example
8961
8962 @command{guix refresh} browses the upstream repository of each package and determines
8963 the highest version number of the releases therein. The command
8964 knows how to update specific types of packages: GNU packages, ELPA
8965 packages, etc.---see the documentation for @option{--type} below. There
8966 are many packages, though, for which it lacks a method to determine
8967 whether a new upstream release is available. However, the mechanism is
8968 extensible, so feel free to get in touch with us to add a new method!
8969
8970 @table @code
8971
8972 @item --recursive
8973 Consider the packages specified, and all the packages upon which they depend.
8974
8975 @example
8976 $ guix refresh --recursive coreutils
8977 gnu/packages/acl.scm:35:2: warning: no updater for acl
8978 gnu/packages/m4.scm:30:12: info: 1.4.18 is already the latest version of m4
8979 gnu/packages/xml.scm:68:2: warning: no updater for expat
8980 gnu/packages/multiprecision.scm:40:12: info: 6.1.2 is already the latest version of gmp
8981 @dots{}
8982 @end example
8983
8984 @end table
8985
8986 Sometimes the upstream name differs from the package name used in Guix,
8987 and @command{guix refresh} needs a little help. Most updaters honor the
8988 @code{upstream-name} property in package definitions, which can be used
8989 to that effect:
8990
8991 @lisp
8992 (define-public network-manager
8993 (package
8994 (name "network-manager")
8995 ;; @dots{}
8996 (properties '((upstream-name . "NetworkManager")))))
8997 @end lisp
8998
8999 When passed @code{--update}, it modifies distribution source files to
9000 update the version numbers and source tarball hashes of those package
9001 recipes (@pxref{Defining Packages}). This is achieved by downloading
9002 each package's latest source tarball and its associated OpenPGP
9003 signature, authenticating the downloaded tarball against its signature
9004 using @command{gpgv}, and finally computing its hash---note that GnuPG must be
9005 installed and in @code{$PATH}; run @code{guix install gnupg} if needed.
9006
9007 When the public
9008 key used to sign the tarball is missing from the user's keyring, an
9009 attempt is made to automatically retrieve it from a public key server;
9010 when this is successful, the key is added to the user's keyring; otherwise,
9011 @command{guix refresh} reports an error.
9012
9013 The following options are supported:
9014
9015 @table @code
9016
9017 @item --expression=@var{expr}
9018 @itemx -e @var{expr}
9019 Consider the package @var{expr} evaluates to.
9020
9021 This is useful to precisely refer to a package, as in this example:
9022
9023 @example
9024 guix refresh -l -e '(@@@@ (gnu packages commencement) glibc-final)'
9025 @end example
9026
9027 This command lists the dependents of the ``final'' libc (essentially all
9028 the packages.)
9029
9030 @item --update
9031 @itemx -u
9032 Update distribution source files (package recipes) in place. This is
9033 usually run from a checkout of the Guix source tree (@pxref{Running
9034 Guix Before It Is Installed}):
9035
9036 @example
9037 $ ./pre-inst-env guix refresh -s non-core -u
9038 @end example
9039
9040 @xref{Defining Packages}, for more information on package definitions.
9041
9042 @item --select=[@var{subset}]
9043 @itemx -s @var{subset}
9044 Select all the packages in @var{subset}, one of @code{core} or
9045 @code{non-core}.
9046
9047 The @code{core} subset refers to all the packages at the core of the
9048 distribution---i.e., packages that are used to build ``everything
9049 else''. This includes GCC, libc, Binutils, Bash, etc. Usually,
9050 changing one of these packages in the distribution entails a rebuild of
9051 all the others. Thus, such updates are an inconvenience to users in
9052 terms of build time or bandwidth used to achieve the upgrade.
9053
9054 The @code{non-core} subset refers to the remaining packages. It is
9055 typically useful in cases where an update of the core packages would be
9056 inconvenient.
9057
9058 @item --manifest=@var{file}
9059 @itemx -m @var{file}
9060 Select all the packages from the manifest in @var{file}. This is useful to
9061 check if any packages of the user manifest can be updated.
9062
9063 @item --type=@var{updater}
9064 @itemx -t @var{updater}
9065 Select only packages handled by @var{updater} (may be a comma-separated
9066 list of updaters). Currently, @var{updater} may be one of:
9067
9068 @table @code
9069 @item gnu
9070 the updater for GNU packages;
9071 @item gnome
9072 the updater for GNOME packages;
9073 @item kde
9074 the updater for KDE packages;
9075 @item xorg
9076 the updater for X.org packages;
9077 @item kernel.org
9078 the updater for packages hosted on kernel.org;
9079 @item elpa
9080 the updater for @uref{https://elpa.gnu.org/, ELPA} packages;
9081 @item cran
9082 the updater for @uref{https://cran.r-project.org/, CRAN} packages;
9083 @item bioconductor
9084 the updater for @uref{https://www.bioconductor.org/, Bioconductor} R packages;
9085 @item cpan
9086 the updater for @uref{https://www.cpan.org/, CPAN} packages;
9087 @item pypi
9088 the updater for @uref{https://pypi.python.org, PyPI} packages.
9089 @item gem
9090 the updater for @uref{https://rubygems.org, RubyGems} packages.
9091 @item github
9092 the updater for @uref{https://github.com, GitHub} packages.
9093 @item hackage
9094 the updater for @uref{https://hackage.haskell.org, Hackage} packages.
9095 @item stackage
9096 the updater for @uref{https://www.stackage.org, Stackage} packages.
9097 @item crate
9098 the updater for @uref{https://crates.io, Crates} packages.
9099 @item launchpad
9100 the updater for @uref{https://launchpad.net, Launchpad} packages.
9101 @end table
9102
9103 For instance, the following command only checks for updates of Emacs
9104 packages hosted at @code{elpa.gnu.org} and for updates of CRAN packages:
9105
9106 @example
9107 $ guix refresh --type=elpa,cran
9108 gnu/packages/statistics.scm:819:13: r-testthat would be upgraded from 0.10.0 to 0.11.0
9109 gnu/packages/emacs.scm:856:13: emacs-auctex would be upgraded from 11.88.6 to 11.88.9
9110 @end example
9111
9112 @end table
9113
9114 In addition, @command{guix refresh} can be passed one or more package
9115 names, as in this example:
9116
9117 @example
9118 $ ./pre-inst-env guix refresh -u emacs idutils gcc@@4.8
9119 @end example
9120
9121 @noindent
9122 The command above specifically updates the @code{emacs} and
9123 @code{idutils} packages. The @code{--select} option would have no
9124 effect in this case.
9125
9126 When considering whether to upgrade a package, it is sometimes
9127 convenient to know which packages would be affected by the upgrade and
9128 should be checked for compatibility. For this the following option may
9129 be used when passing @command{guix refresh} one or more package names:
9130
9131 @table @code
9132
9133 @item --list-updaters
9134 @itemx -L
9135 List available updaters and exit (see @option{--type} above.)
9136
9137 For each updater, display the fraction of packages it covers; at the
9138 end, display the fraction of packages covered by all these updaters.
9139
9140 @item --list-dependent
9141 @itemx -l
9142 List top-level dependent packages that would need to be rebuilt as a
9143 result of upgrading one or more packages.
9144
9145 @xref{Invoking guix graph, the @code{reverse-package} type of
9146 @command{guix graph}}, for information on how to visualize the list of
9147 dependents of a package.
9148
9149 @end table
9150
9151 Be aware that the @code{--list-dependent} option only
9152 @emph{approximates} the rebuilds that would be required as a result of
9153 an upgrade. More rebuilds might be required under some circumstances.
9154
9155 @example
9156 $ guix refresh --list-dependent flex
9157 Building the following 120 packages would ensure 213 dependent packages are rebuilt:
9158 hop@@2.4.0 geiser@@0.4 notmuch@@0.18 mu@@0.9.9.5 cflow@@1.4 idutils@@4.6 @dots{}
9159 @end example
9160
9161 The command above lists a set of packages that could be built to check
9162 for compatibility with an upgraded @code{flex} package.
9163
9164 @table @code
9165
9166 @item --list-transitive
9167 List all the packages which one or more packages depend upon.
9168
9169 @example
9170 $ guix refresh --list-transitive flex
9171 flex@@2.6.4 depends on the following 25 packages: perl@@5.28.0 help2man@@1.47.6
9172 bison@@3.0.5 indent@@2.2.10 tar@@1.30 gzip@@1.9 bzip2@@1.0.6 xz@@5.2.4 file@@5.33 @dots{}
9173 @end example
9174
9175 @end table
9176
9177 The command above lists a set of packages which, when changed, would cause
9178 @code{flex} to be rebuilt.
9179
9180 The following options can be used to customize GnuPG operation:
9181
9182 @table @code
9183
9184 @item --gpg=@var{command}
9185 Use @var{command} as the GnuPG 2.x command. @var{command} is searched
9186 for in @code{$PATH}.
9187
9188 @item --keyring=@var{file}
9189 Use @var{file} as the keyring for upstream keys. @var{file} must be in the
9190 @dfn{keybox format}. Keybox files usually have a name ending in @file{.kbx}
9191 and the GNU@tie{}Privacy Guard (GPG) can manipulate these files
9192 (@pxref{kbxutil, @command{kbxutil},, gnupg, Using the GNU Privacy Guard}, for
9193 information on a tool to manipulate keybox files).
9194
9195 When this option is omitted, @command{guix refresh} uses
9196 @file{~/.config/guix/upstream/trustedkeys.kbx} as the keyring for upstream
9197 signing keys. OpenPGP signatures are checked against keys from this keyring;
9198 missing keys are downloaded to this keyring as well (see
9199 @option{--key-download} below.)
9200
9201 You can export keys from your default GPG keyring into a keybox file using
9202 commands like this one:
9203
9204 @example
9205 gpg --export rms@@gnu.org | kbxutil --import-openpgp >> mykeyring.kbx
9206 @end example
9207
9208 Likewise, you can fetch keys to a specific keybox file like this:
9209
9210 @example
9211 gpg --no-default-keyring --keyring mykeyring.kbx \
9212 --recv-keys @value{OPENPGP-SIGNING-KEY-ID}
9213 @end example
9214
9215 @ref{GPG Configuration Options, @option{--keyring},, gnupg, Using the GNU
9216 Privacy Guard}, for more information on GPG's @option{--keyring} option.
9217
9218 @item --key-download=@var{policy}
9219 Handle missing OpenPGP keys according to @var{policy}, which may be one
9220 of:
9221
9222 @table @code
9223 @item always
9224 Always download missing OpenPGP keys from the key server, and add them
9225 to the user's GnuPG keyring.
9226
9227 @item never
9228 Never try to download missing OpenPGP keys. Instead just bail out.
9229
9230 @item interactive
9231 When a package signed with an unknown OpenPGP key is encountered, ask
9232 the user whether to download it or not. This is the default behavior.
9233 @end table
9234
9235 @item --key-server=@var{host}
9236 Use @var{host} as the OpenPGP key server when importing a public key.
9237
9238 @end table
9239
9240 The @code{github} updater uses the
9241 @uref{https://developer.github.com/v3/, GitHub API} to query for new
9242 releases. When used repeatedly e.g.@: when refreshing all packages,
9243 GitHub will eventually refuse to answer any further API requests. By
9244 default 60 API requests per hour are allowed, and a full refresh on all
9245 GitHub packages in Guix requires more than this. Authentication with
9246 GitHub through the use of an API token alleviates these limits. To use
9247 an API token, set the environment variable @code{GUIX_GITHUB_TOKEN} to a
9248 token procured from @uref{https://github.com/settings/tokens} or
9249 otherwise.
9250
9251
9252 @node Invoking guix lint
9253 @section Invoking @command{guix lint}
9254
9255 @cindex @command{guix lint}
9256 @cindex package, checking for errors
9257 The @command{guix lint} command is meant to help package developers avoid
9258 common errors and use a consistent style. It runs a number of checks on
9259 a given set of packages in order to find common mistakes in their
9260 definitions. Available @dfn{checkers} include (see
9261 @code{--list-checkers} for a complete list):
9262
9263 @table @code
9264 @item synopsis
9265 @itemx description
9266 Validate certain typographical and stylistic rules about package
9267 descriptions and synopses.
9268
9269 @item inputs-should-be-native
9270 Identify inputs that should most likely be native inputs.
9271
9272 @item source
9273 @itemx home-page
9274 @itemx mirror-url
9275 @itemx github-url
9276 @itemx source-file-name
9277 Probe @code{home-page} and @code{source} URLs and report those that are
9278 invalid. Suggest a @code{mirror://} URL when applicable. If the
9279 @code{source} URL redirects to a GitHub URL, recommend usage of the GitHub
9280 URL. Check that the source file name is meaningful, e.g.@: is not just a
9281 version number or ``git-checkout'', without a declared @code{file-name}
9282 (@pxref{origin Reference}).
9283
9284 @item source-unstable-tarball
9285 Parse the @code{source} URL to determine if a tarball from GitHub is
9286 autogenerated or if it is a release tarball. Unfortunately GitHub's
9287 autogenerated tarballs are sometimes regenerated.
9288
9289 @item archival
9290 @cindex Software Heritage, source code archive
9291 @cindex archival of source code, Software Heritage
9292 Checks whether the package's source code is archived at
9293 @uref{https://www.softwareheritage.org, Software Heritage}.
9294
9295 When the source code that is not archived comes from a version-control system
9296 (VCS)---e.g., it's obtained with @code{git-fetch}, send Software Heritage a
9297 ``save'' request so that it eventually archives it. This ensures that the
9298 source will remain available in the long term, and that Guix can fall back to
9299 Software Heritage should the source code disappear from its original host.
9300 The status of recent ``save'' requests can be
9301 @uref{https://archive.softwareheritage.org/save/#requests, viewed on-line}.
9302
9303 When source code is a tarball obtained with @code{url-fetch}, simply print a
9304 message when it is not archived. As of this writing, Software Heritage does
9305 not allow requests to save arbitrary tarballs; we are working on ways to
9306 ensure that non-VCS source code is also archived.
9307
9308 Software Heritage
9309 @uref{https://archive.softwareheritage.org/api/#rate-limiting, limits the
9310 request rate per IP address}. When the limit is reached, @command{guix lint}
9311 prints a message and the @code{archival} checker stops doing anything until
9312 that limit has been reset.
9313
9314 @item cve
9315 @cindex security vulnerabilities
9316 @cindex CVE, Common Vulnerabilities and Exposures
9317 Report known vulnerabilities found in the Common Vulnerabilities and
9318 Exposures (CVE) databases of the current and past year
9319 @uref{https://nvd.nist.gov/download.cfm#CVE_FEED, published by the US
9320 NIST}.
9321
9322 To view information about a particular vulnerability, visit pages such as:
9323
9324 @itemize
9325 @item
9326 @indicateurl{https://web.nvd.nist.gov/view/vuln/detail?vulnId=CVE-YYYY-ABCD}
9327 @item
9328 @indicateurl{https://cve.mitre.org/cgi-bin/cvename.cgi?name=CVE-YYYY-ABCD}
9329 @end itemize
9330
9331 @noindent
9332 where @code{CVE-YYYY-ABCD} is the CVE identifier---e.g.,
9333 @code{CVE-2015-7554}.
9334
9335 Package developers can specify in package recipes the
9336 @uref{https://nvd.nist.gov/cpe.cfm,Common Platform Enumeration (CPE)}
9337 name and version of the package when they differ from the name or version
9338 that Guix uses, as in this example:
9339
9340 @lisp
9341 (package
9342 (name "grub")
9343 ;; @dots{}
9344 ;; CPE calls this package "grub2".
9345 (properties '((cpe-name . "grub2")
9346 (cpe-version . "2.3")))
9347 @end lisp
9348
9349 @c See <https://www.openwall.com/lists/oss-security/2017/03/15/3>.
9350 Some entries in the CVE database do not specify which version of a
9351 package they apply to, and would thus ``stick around'' forever. Package
9352 developers who found CVE alerts and verified they can be ignored can
9353 declare them as in this example:
9354
9355 @lisp
9356 (package
9357 (name "t1lib")
9358 ;; @dots{}
9359 ;; These CVEs no longer apply and can be safely ignored.
9360 (properties `((lint-hidden-cve . ("CVE-2011-0433"
9361 "CVE-2011-1553"
9362 "CVE-2011-1554"
9363 "CVE-2011-5244")))))
9364 @end lisp
9365
9366 @item formatting
9367 Warn about obvious source code formatting issues: trailing white space,
9368 use of tabulations, etc.
9369 @end table
9370
9371 The general syntax is:
9372
9373 @example
9374 guix lint @var{options} @var{package}@dots{}
9375 @end example
9376
9377 If no package is given on the command line, then all packages are checked.
9378 The @var{options} may be zero or more of the following:
9379
9380 @table @code
9381 @item --list-checkers
9382 @itemx -l
9383 List and describe all the available checkers that will be run on packages
9384 and exit.
9385
9386 @item --checkers
9387 @itemx -c
9388 Only enable the checkers specified in a comma-separated list using the
9389 names returned by @code{--list-checkers}.
9390
9391 @end table
9392
9393 @node Invoking guix size
9394 @section Invoking @command{guix size}
9395
9396 @cindex size
9397 @cindex package size
9398 @cindex closure
9399 @cindex @command{guix size}
9400 The @command{guix size} command helps package developers profile the
9401 disk usage of packages. It is easy to overlook the impact of an
9402 additional dependency added to a package, or the impact of using a
9403 single output for a package that could easily be split (@pxref{Packages
9404 with Multiple Outputs}). Such are the typical issues that
9405 @command{guix size} can highlight.
9406
9407 The command can be passed one or more package specifications
9408 such as @code{gcc@@4.8}
9409 or @code{guile:debug}, or a file name in the store. Consider this
9410 example:
9411
9412 @example
9413 $ guix size coreutils
9414 store item total self
9415 /gnu/store/@dots{}-gcc-5.5.0-lib 60.4 30.1 38.1%
9416 /gnu/store/@dots{}-glibc-2.27 30.3 28.8 36.6%
9417 /gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.28 78.9 15.0 19.0%
9418 /gnu/store/@dots{}-gmp-6.1.2 63.1 2.7 3.4%
9419 /gnu/store/@dots{}-bash-static-4.4.12 1.5 1.5 1.9%
9420 /gnu/store/@dots{}-acl-2.2.52 61.1 0.4 0.5%
9421 /gnu/store/@dots{}-attr-2.4.47 60.6 0.2 0.3%
9422 /gnu/store/@dots{}-libcap-2.25 60.5 0.2 0.2%
9423 total: 78.9 MiB
9424 @end example
9425
9426 @cindex closure
9427 The store items listed here constitute the @dfn{transitive closure} of
9428 Coreutils---i.e., Coreutils and all its dependencies, recursively---as
9429 would be returned by:
9430
9431 @example
9432 $ guix gc -R /gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.23
9433 @end example
9434
9435 Here the output shows three columns next to store items. The first column,
9436 labeled ``total'', shows the size in mebibytes (MiB) of the closure of
9437 the store item---that is, its own size plus the size of all its
9438 dependencies. The next column, labeled ``self'', shows the size of the
9439 item itself. The last column shows the ratio of the size of the item
9440 itself to the space occupied by all the items listed here.
9441
9442 In this example, we see that the closure of Coreutils weighs in at
9443 79@tie{}MiB, most of which is taken by libc and GCC's run-time support
9444 libraries. (That libc and GCC's libraries represent a large fraction of
9445 the closure is not a problem @i{per se} because they are always available
9446 on the system anyway.)
9447
9448 When the package(s) passed to @command{guix size} are available in the
9449 store@footnote{More precisely, @command{guix size} looks for the
9450 @emph{ungrafted} variant of the given package(s), as returned by
9451 @code{guix build @var{package} --no-grafts}. @xref{Security Updates},
9452 for information on grafts.}, @command{guix size} queries the daemon to determine its
9453 dependencies, and measures its size in the store, similar to @command{du
9454 -ms --apparent-size} (@pxref{du invocation,,, coreutils, GNU
9455 Coreutils}).
9456
9457 When the given packages are @emph{not} in the store, @command{guix size}
9458 reports information based on the available substitutes
9459 (@pxref{Substitutes}). This makes it possible it to profile disk usage of
9460 store items that are not even on disk, only available remotely.
9461
9462 You can also specify several package names:
9463
9464 @example
9465 $ guix size coreutils grep sed bash
9466 store item total self
9467 /gnu/store/@dots{}-coreutils-8.24 77.8 13.8 13.4%
9468 /gnu/store/@dots{}-grep-2.22 73.1 0.8 0.8%
9469 /gnu/store/@dots{}-bash-4.3.42 72.3 4.7 4.6%
9470 /gnu/store/@dots{}-readline-6.3 67.6 1.2 1.2%
9471 @dots{}
9472 total: 102.3 MiB
9473 @end example
9474
9475 @noindent
9476 In this example we see that the combination of the four packages takes
9477 102.3@tie{}MiB in total, which is much less than the sum of each closure
9478 since they have a lot of dependencies in common.
9479
9480 The available options are:
9481
9482 @table @option
9483
9484 @item --substitute-urls=@var{urls}
9485 Use substitute information from @var{urls}.
9486 @xref{client-substitute-urls, the same option for @code{guix build}}.
9487
9488 @item --sort=@var{key}
9489 Sort lines according to @var{key}, one of the following options:
9490
9491 @table @code
9492 @item self
9493 the size of each item (the default);
9494 @item closure
9495 the total size of the item's closure.
9496 @end table
9497
9498 @item --map-file=@var{file}
9499 Write a graphical map of disk usage in PNG format to @var{file}.
9500
9501 For the example above, the map looks like this:
9502
9503 @image{images/coreutils-size-map,5in,, map of Coreutils disk usage
9504 produced by @command{guix size}}
9505
9506 This option requires that
9507 @uref{https://wingolog.org/software/guile-charting/, Guile-Charting} be
9508 installed and visible in Guile's module search path. When that is not
9509 the case, @command{guix size} fails as it tries to load it.
9510
9511 @item --system=@var{system}
9512 @itemx -s @var{system}
9513 Consider packages for @var{system}---e.g., @code{x86_64-linux}.
9514
9515 @end table
9516
9517 @node Invoking guix graph
9518 @section Invoking @command{guix graph}
9519
9520 @cindex DAG
9521 @cindex @command{guix graph}
9522 @cindex package dependencies
9523 Packages and their dependencies form a @dfn{graph}, specifically a
9524 directed acyclic graph (DAG). It can quickly become difficult to have a
9525 mental model of the package DAG, so the @command{guix graph} command
9526 provides a visual representation of the DAG. By default,
9527 @command{guix graph} emits a DAG representation in the input format of
9528 @uref{https://www.graphviz.org/, Graphviz}, so its output can be passed
9529 directly to the @command{dot} command of Graphviz. It can also emit an
9530 HTML page with embedded JavaScript code to display a ``chord diagram''
9531 in a Web browser, using the @uref{https://d3js.org/, d3.js} library, or
9532 emit Cypher queries to construct a graph in a graph database supporting
9533 the @uref{https://www.opencypher.org/, openCypher} query language.
9534 The general syntax is:
9535
9536 @example
9537 guix graph @var{options} @var{package}@dots{}
9538 @end example
9539
9540 For example, the following command generates a PDF file representing the
9541 package DAG for the GNU@tie{}Core Utilities, showing its build-time
9542 dependencies:
9543
9544 @example
9545 guix graph coreutils | dot -Tpdf > dag.pdf
9546 @end example
9547
9548 The output looks like this:
9549
9550 @image{images/coreutils-graph,2in,,Dependency graph of the GNU Coreutils}
9551
9552 Nice little graph, no?
9553
9554 But there is more than one graph! The one above is concise: it is the
9555 graph of package objects, omitting implicit inputs such as GCC, libc,
9556 grep, etc. It is often useful to have such a concise graph, but
9557 sometimes one may want to see more details. @command{guix graph} supports
9558 several types of graphs, allowing you to choose the level of detail:
9559
9560 @table @code
9561 @item package
9562 This is the default type used in the example above. It shows the DAG of
9563 package objects, excluding implicit dependencies. It is concise, but
9564 filters out many details.
9565
9566 @item reverse-package
9567 This shows the @emph{reverse} DAG of packages. For example:
9568
9569 @example
9570 guix graph --type=reverse-package ocaml
9571 @end example
9572
9573 ...@: yields the graph of packages that @emph{explicitly} depend on OCaml (if
9574 you are also interested in cases where OCaml is an implicit dependency, see
9575 @code{reverse-bag} below.)
9576
9577 Note that for core packages this can yield huge graphs. If all you want
9578 is to know the number of packages that depend on a given package, use
9579 @command{guix refresh --list-dependent} (@pxref{Invoking guix refresh,
9580 @option{--list-dependent}}).
9581
9582 @item bag-emerged
9583 This is the package DAG, @emph{including} implicit inputs.
9584
9585 For instance, the following command:
9586
9587 @example
9588 guix graph --type=bag-emerged coreutils | dot -Tpdf > dag.pdf
9589 @end example
9590
9591 ...@: yields this bigger graph:
9592
9593 @image{images/coreutils-bag-graph,,5in,Detailed dependency graph of the GNU Coreutils}
9594
9595 At the bottom of the graph, we see all the implicit inputs of
9596 @var{gnu-build-system} (@pxref{Build Systems, @code{gnu-build-system}}).
9597
9598 Now, note that the dependencies of these implicit inputs---that is, the
9599 @dfn{bootstrap dependencies} (@pxref{Bootstrapping})---are not shown
9600 here, for conciseness.
9601
9602 @item bag
9603 Similar to @code{bag-emerged}, but this time including all the bootstrap
9604 dependencies.
9605
9606 @item bag-with-origins
9607 Similar to @code{bag}, but also showing origins and their dependencies.
9608
9609 @item reverse-bag
9610 This shows the @emph{reverse} DAG of packages. Unlike @code{reverse-package},
9611 it also takes implicit dependencies into account. For example:
9612
9613 @example
9614 guix graph -t reverse-bag dune
9615 @end example
9616
9617 @noindent
9618 ...@: yields the graph of all packages that depend on Dune, directly or
9619 indirectly. Since Dune is an @emph{implicit} dependency of many packages
9620 @i{via} @code{dune-build-system}, this shows a large number of packages,
9621 whereas @code{reverse-package} would show very few if any.
9622
9623 @item derivation
9624 This is the most detailed representation: It shows the DAG of
9625 derivations (@pxref{Derivations}) and plain store items. Compared to
9626 the above representation, many additional nodes are visible, including
9627 build scripts, patches, Guile modules, etc.
9628
9629 For this type of graph, it is also possible to pass a @file{.drv} file
9630 name instead of a package name, as in:
9631
9632 @example
9633 guix graph -t derivation `guix system build -d my-config.scm`
9634 @end example
9635
9636 @item module
9637 This is the graph of @dfn{package modules} (@pxref{Package Modules}).
9638 For example, the following command shows the graph for the package
9639 module that defines the @code{guile} package:
9640
9641 @example
9642 guix graph -t module guile | dot -Tpdf > module-graph.pdf
9643 @end example
9644 @end table
9645
9646 All the types above correspond to @emph{build-time dependencies}. The
9647 following graph type represents the @emph{run-time dependencies}:
9648
9649 @table @code
9650 @item references
9651 This is the graph of @dfn{references} of a package output, as returned
9652 by @command{guix gc --references} (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}).
9653
9654 If the given package output is not available in the store, @command{guix
9655 graph} attempts to obtain dependency information from substitutes.
9656
9657 Here you can also pass a store file name instead of a package name. For
9658 example, the command below produces the reference graph of your profile
9659 (which can be big!):
9660
9661 @example
9662 guix graph -t references `readlink -f ~/.guix-profile`
9663 @end example
9664
9665 @item referrers
9666 This is the graph of the @dfn{referrers} of a store item, as returned by
9667 @command{guix gc --referrers} (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}).
9668
9669 This relies exclusively on local information from your store. For
9670 instance, let us suppose that the current Inkscape is available in 10
9671 profiles on your machine; @command{guix graph -t referrers inkscape}
9672 will show a graph rooted at Inkscape and with those 10 profiles linked
9673 to it.
9674
9675 It can help determine what is preventing a store item from being garbage
9676 collected.
9677
9678 @end table
9679
9680 The available options are the following:
9681
9682 @table @option
9683 @item --type=@var{type}
9684 @itemx -t @var{type}
9685 Produce a graph output of @var{type}, where @var{type} must be one of
9686 the values listed above.
9687
9688 @item --list-types
9689 List the supported graph types.
9690
9691 @item --backend=@var{backend}
9692 @itemx -b @var{backend}
9693 Produce a graph using the selected @var{backend}.
9694
9695 @item --list-backends
9696 List the supported graph backends.
9697
9698 Currently, the available backends are Graphviz and d3.js.
9699
9700 @item --expression=@var{expr}
9701 @itemx -e @var{expr}
9702 Consider the package @var{expr} evaluates to.
9703
9704 This is useful to precisely refer to a package, as in this example:
9705
9706 @example
9707 guix graph -e '(@@@@ (gnu packages commencement) gnu-make-final)'
9708 @end example
9709
9710 @item --system=@var{system}
9711 @itemx -s @var{system}
9712 Display the graph for @var{system}---e.g., @code{i686-linux}.
9713
9714 The package dependency graph is largely architecture-independent, but there
9715 are some architecture-dependent bits that this option allows you to visualize.
9716 @end table
9717
9718
9719
9720 @node Invoking guix publish
9721 @section Invoking @command{guix publish}
9722
9723 @cindex @command{guix publish}
9724 The purpose of @command{guix publish} is to enable users to easily share
9725 their store with others, who can then use it as a substitute server
9726 (@pxref{Substitutes}).
9727
9728 When @command{guix publish} runs, it spawns an HTTP server which allows
9729 anyone with network access to obtain substitutes from it. This means
9730 that any machine running Guix can also act as if it were a build farm,
9731 since the HTTP interface is compatible with Cuirass, the software behind
9732 the @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} build farm.
9733
9734 For security, each substitute is signed, allowing recipients to check
9735 their authenticity and integrity (@pxref{Substitutes}). Because
9736 @command{guix publish} uses the signing key of the system, which is only
9737 readable by the system administrator, it must be started as root; the
9738 @code{--user} option makes it drop root privileges early on.
9739
9740 The signing key pair must be generated before @command{guix publish} is
9741 launched, using @command{guix archive --generate-key} (@pxref{Invoking
9742 guix archive}).
9743
9744 The general syntax is:
9745
9746 @example
9747 guix publish @var{options}@dots{}
9748 @end example
9749
9750 Running @command{guix publish} without any additional arguments will
9751 spawn an HTTP server on port 8080:
9752
9753 @example
9754 guix publish
9755 @end example
9756
9757 Once a publishing server has been authorized (@pxref{Invoking guix
9758 archive}), the daemon may download substitutes from it:
9759
9760 @example
9761 guix-daemon --substitute-urls=http://example.org:8080
9762 @end example
9763
9764 By default, @command{guix publish} compresses archives on the fly as it
9765 serves them. This ``on-the-fly'' mode is convenient in that it requires
9766 no setup and is immediately available. However, when serving lots of
9767 clients, we recommend using the @option{--cache} option, which enables
9768 caching of the archives before they are sent to clients---see below for
9769 details. The @command{guix weather} command provides a handy way to
9770 check what a server provides (@pxref{Invoking guix weather}).
9771
9772 As a bonus, @command{guix publish} also serves as a content-addressed
9773 mirror for source files referenced in @code{origin} records
9774 (@pxref{origin Reference}). For instance, assuming @command{guix
9775 publish} is running on @code{example.org}, the following URL returns the
9776 raw @file{hello-2.10.tar.gz} file with the given SHA256 hash
9777 (represented in @code{nix-base32} format, @pxref{Invoking guix hash}):
9778
9779 @example
9780 http://example.org/file/hello-2.10.tar.gz/sha256/0ssi1@dots{}ndq1i
9781 @end example
9782
9783 Obviously, these URLs only work for files that are in the store; in
9784 other cases, they return 404 (``Not Found'').
9785
9786 @cindex build logs, publication
9787 Build logs are available from @code{/log} URLs like:
9788
9789 @example
9790 http://example.org/log/gwspk@dots{}-guile-2.2.3
9791 @end example
9792
9793 @noindent
9794 When @command{guix-daemon} is configured to save compressed build logs,
9795 as is the case by default (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon}), @code{/log}
9796 URLs return the compressed log as-is, with an appropriate
9797 @code{Content-Type} and/or @code{Content-Encoding} header. We recommend
9798 running @command{guix-daemon} with @code{--log-compression=gzip} since
9799 Web browsers can automatically decompress it, which is not the case with
9800 bzip2 compression.
9801
9802 The following options are available:
9803
9804 @table @code
9805 @item --port=@var{port}
9806 @itemx -p @var{port}
9807 Listen for HTTP requests on @var{port}.
9808
9809 @item --listen=@var{host}
9810 Listen on the network interface for @var{host}. The default is to
9811 accept connections from any interface.
9812
9813 @item --user=@var{user}
9814 @itemx -u @var{user}
9815 Change privileges to @var{user} as soon as possible---i.e., once the
9816 server socket is open and the signing key has been read.
9817
9818 @item --compression[=@var{method}[:@var{level}]]
9819 @itemx -C [@var{method}[:@var{level}]]
9820 Compress data using the given @var{method} and @var{level}. @var{method} is
9821 one of @code{lzip} and @code{gzip}; when @var{method} is omitted, @code{gzip}
9822 is used.
9823
9824 When @var{level} is zero, disable compression. The range 1 to 9 corresponds
9825 to different compression levels: 1 is the fastest, and 9 is the best
9826 (CPU-intensive). The default is 3.
9827
9828 Usually, @code{lzip} compresses noticeably better than @code{gzip} for a small
9829 increase in CPU usage; see
9830 @uref{https://nongnu.org/lzip/lzip_benchmark.html,benchmarks on the lzip Web
9831 page}.
9832
9833 Unless @option{--cache} is used, compression occurs on the fly and
9834 the compressed streams are not
9835 cached. Thus, to reduce load on the machine that runs @command{guix
9836 publish}, it may be a good idea to choose a low compression level, to
9837 run @command{guix publish} behind a caching proxy, or to use
9838 @option{--cache}. Using @option{--cache} has the advantage that it
9839 allows @command{guix publish} to add @code{Content-Length} HTTP header
9840 to its responses.
9841
9842 This option can be repeated, in which case every substitute gets compressed
9843 using all the selected methods, and all of them are advertised. This is
9844 useful when users may not support all the compression methods: they can select
9845 the one they support.
9846
9847 @item --cache=@var{directory}
9848 @itemx -c @var{directory}
9849 Cache archives and meta-data (@code{.narinfo} URLs) to @var{directory}
9850 and only serve archives that are in cache.
9851
9852 When this option is omitted, archives and meta-data are created
9853 on-the-fly. This can reduce the available bandwidth, especially when
9854 compression is enabled, since this may become CPU-bound. Another
9855 drawback of the default mode is that the length of archives is not known
9856 in advance, so @command{guix publish} does not add a
9857 @code{Content-Length} HTTP header to its responses, which in turn
9858 prevents clients from knowing the amount of data being downloaded.
9859
9860 Conversely, when @option{--cache} is used, the first request for a store
9861 item (@i{via} a @code{.narinfo} URL) returns 404 and triggers a
9862 background process to @dfn{bake} the archive---computing its
9863 @code{.narinfo} and compressing the archive, if needed. Once the
9864 archive is cached in @var{directory}, subsequent requests succeed and
9865 are served directly from the cache, which guarantees that clients get
9866 the best possible bandwidth.
9867
9868 The ``baking'' process is performed by worker threads. By default, one
9869 thread per CPU core is created, but this can be customized. See
9870 @option{--workers} below.
9871
9872 When @option{--ttl} is used, cached entries are automatically deleted
9873 when they have expired.
9874
9875 @item --workers=@var{N}
9876 When @option{--cache} is used, request the allocation of @var{N} worker
9877 threads to ``bake'' archives.
9878
9879 @item --ttl=@var{ttl}
9880 Produce @code{Cache-Control} HTTP headers that advertise a time-to-live
9881 (TTL) of @var{ttl}. @var{ttl} must denote a duration: @code{5d} means 5
9882 days, @code{1m} means 1 month, and so on.
9883
9884 This allows the user's Guix to keep substitute information in cache for
9885 @var{ttl}. However, note that @code{guix publish} does not itself
9886 guarantee that the store items it provides will indeed remain available
9887 for as long as @var{ttl}.
9888
9889 Additionally, when @option{--cache} is used, cached entries that have
9890 not been accessed for @var{ttl} and that no longer have a corresponding
9891 item in the store, may be deleted.
9892
9893 @item --nar-path=@var{path}
9894 Use @var{path} as the prefix for the URLs of ``nar'' files
9895 (@pxref{Invoking guix archive, normalized archives}).
9896
9897 By default, nars are served at a URL such as
9898 @code{/nar/gzip/@dots{}-coreutils-8.25}. This option allows you to
9899 change the @code{/nar} part to @var{path}.
9900
9901 @item --public-key=@var{file}
9902 @itemx --private-key=@var{file}
9903 Use the specific @var{file}s as the public/private key pair used to sign
9904 the store items being published.
9905
9906 The files must correspond to the same key pair (the private key is used
9907 for signing and the public key is merely advertised in the signature
9908 metadata). They must contain keys in the canonical s-expression format
9909 as produced by @command{guix archive --generate-key} (@pxref{Invoking
9910 guix archive}). By default, @file{/etc/guix/signing-key.pub} and
9911 @file{/etc/guix/signing-key.sec} are used.
9912
9913 @item --repl[=@var{port}]
9914 @itemx -r [@var{port}]
9915 Spawn a Guile REPL server (@pxref{REPL Servers,,, guile, GNU Guile
9916 Reference Manual}) on @var{port} (37146 by default). This is used
9917 primarily for debugging a running @command{guix publish} server.
9918 @end table
9919
9920 Enabling @command{guix publish} on Guix System is a one-liner: just
9921 instantiate a @code{guix-publish-service-type} service in the @code{services} field
9922 of the @code{operating-system} declaration (@pxref{guix-publish-service-type,
9923 @code{guix-publish-service-type}}).
9924
9925 If you are instead running Guix on a ``foreign distro'', follow these
9926 instructions:”
9927
9928 @itemize
9929 @item
9930 If your host distro uses the systemd init system:
9931
9932 @example
9933 # ln -s ~root/.guix-profile/lib/systemd/system/guix-publish.service \
9934 /etc/systemd/system/
9935 # systemctl start guix-publish && systemctl enable guix-publish
9936 @end example
9937
9938 @item
9939 If your host distro uses the Upstart init system:
9940
9941 @example
9942 # ln -s ~root/.guix-profile/lib/upstart/system/guix-publish.conf /etc/init/
9943 # start guix-publish
9944 @end example
9945
9946 @item
9947 Otherwise, proceed similarly with your distro's init system.
9948 @end itemize
9949
9950 @node Invoking guix challenge
9951 @section Invoking @command{guix challenge}
9952
9953 @cindex reproducible builds
9954 @cindex verifiable builds
9955 @cindex @command{guix challenge}
9956 @cindex challenge
9957 Do the binaries provided by this server really correspond to the source
9958 code it claims to build? Is a package build process deterministic?
9959 These are the questions the @command{guix challenge} command attempts to
9960 answer.
9961
9962 The former is obviously an important question: Before using a substitute
9963 server (@pxref{Substitutes}), one had better @emph{verify} that it
9964 provides the right binaries, and thus @emph{challenge} it. The latter
9965 is what enables the former: If package builds are deterministic, then
9966 independent builds of the package should yield the exact same result,
9967 bit for bit; if a server provides a binary different from the one
9968 obtained locally, it may be either corrupt or malicious.
9969
9970 We know that the hash that shows up in @file{/gnu/store} file names is
9971 the hash of all the inputs of the process that built the file or
9972 directory---compilers, libraries, build scripts,
9973 etc. (@pxref{Introduction}). Assuming deterministic build processes,
9974 one store file name should map to exactly one build output.
9975 @command{guix challenge} checks whether there is, indeed, a single
9976 mapping by comparing the build outputs of several independent builds of
9977 any given store item.
9978
9979 The command output looks like this:
9980
9981 @smallexample
9982 $ guix challenge --substitute-urls="https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER} https://guix.example.org"
9983 updating list of substitutes from 'https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}'... 100.0%
9984 updating list of substitutes from 'https://guix.example.org'... 100.0%
9985 /gnu/store/@dots{}-openssl-1.0.2d contents differ:
9986 local hash: 0725l22r5jnzazaacncwsvp9kgf42266ayyp814v7djxs7nk963q
9987 https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}/nar/@dots{}-openssl-1.0.2d: 0725l22r5jnzazaacncwsvp9kgf42266ayyp814v7djxs7nk963q
9988 https://guix.example.org/nar/@dots{}-openssl-1.0.2d: 1zy4fmaaqcnjrzzajkdn3f5gmjk754b43qkq47llbyak9z0qjyim
9989 /gnu/store/@dots{}-git-2.5.0 contents differ:
9990 local hash: 00p3bmryhjxrhpn2gxs2fy0a15lnip05l97205pgbk5ra395hyha
9991 https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}/nar/@dots{}-git-2.5.0: 069nb85bv4d4a6slrwjdy8v1cn4cwspm3kdbmyb81d6zckj3nq9f
9992 https://guix.example.org/nar/@dots{}-git-2.5.0: 0mdqa9w1p6cmli6976v4wi0sw9r4p5prkj7lzfd1877wk11c9c73
9993 /gnu/store/@dots{}-pius-2.1.1 contents differ:
9994 local hash: 0k4v3m9z1zp8xzzizb7d8kjj72f9172xv078sq4wl73vnq9ig3ax
9995 https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}/nar/@dots{}-pius-2.1.1: 0k4v3m9z1zp8xzzizb7d8kjj72f9172xv078sq4wl73vnq9ig3ax
9996 https://guix.example.org/nar/@dots{}-pius-2.1.1: 1cy25x1a4fzq5rk0pmvc8xhwyffnqz95h2bpvqsz2mpvlbccy0gs
9997
9998 @dots{}
9999
10000 6,406 store items were analyzed:
10001 - 4,749 (74.1%) were identical
10002 - 525 (8.2%) differed
10003 - 1,132 (17.7%) were inconclusive
10004 @end smallexample
10005
10006 @noindent
10007 In this example, @command{guix challenge} first scans the store to
10008 determine the set of locally-built derivations---as opposed to store
10009 items that were downloaded from a substitute server---and then queries
10010 all the substitute servers. It then reports those store items for which
10011 the servers obtained a result different from the local build.
10012
10013 @cindex non-determinism, in package builds
10014 As an example, @code{guix.example.org} always gets a different answer.
10015 Conversely, @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} agrees with local builds, except in the
10016 case of Git. This might indicate that the build process of Git is
10017 non-deterministic, meaning that its output varies as a function of
10018 various things that Guix does not fully control, in spite of building
10019 packages in isolated environments (@pxref{Features}). Most common
10020 sources of non-determinism include the addition of timestamps in build
10021 results, the inclusion of random numbers, and directory listings sorted
10022 by inode number. See @uref{https://reproducible-builds.org/docs/}, for
10023 more information.
10024
10025 To find out what is wrong with this Git binary, we can do something along
10026 these lines (@pxref{Invoking guix archive}):
10027
10028 @example
10029 $ wget -q -O - https://@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}/nar/@dots{}-git-2.5.0 \
10030 | guix archive -x /tmp/git
10031 $ diff -ur --no-dereference /gnu/store/@dots{}-git.2.5.0 /tmp/git
10032 @end example
10033
10034 This command shows the difference between the files resulting from the
10035 local build, and the files resulting from the build on
10036 @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} (@pxref{Overview, Comparing and Merging Files,,
10037 diffutils, Comparing and Merging Files}). The @command{diff} command
10038 works great for text files. When binary files differ, a better option
10039 is @uref{https://diffoscope.org/, Diffoscope}, a tool that helps
10040 visualize differences for all kinds of files.
10041
10042 Once you have done that work, you can tell whether the differences are due
10043 to a non-deterministic build process or to a malicious server. We try
10044 hard to remove sources of non-determinism in packages to make it easier
10045 to verify substitutes, but of course, this is a process that
10046 involves not just Guix, but a large part of the free software community.
10047 In the meantime, @command{guix challenge} is one tool to help address
10048 the problem.
10049
10050 If you are writing packages for Guix, you are encouraged to check
10051 whether @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} and other substitute servers obtain the
10052 same build result as you did with:
10053
10054 @example
10055 $ guix challenge @var{package}
10056 @end example
10057
10058 @noindent
10059 where @var{package} is a package specification such as
10060 @code{guile@@2.0} or @code{glibc:debug}.
10061
10062 The general syntax is:
10063
10064 @example
10065 guix challenge @var{options} [@var{packages}@dots{}]
10066 @end example
10067
10068 When a difference is found between the hash of a locally-built item and
10069 that of a server-provided substitute, or among substitutes provided by
10070 different servers, the command displays it as in the example above and
10071 its exit code is 2 (other non-zero exit codes denote other kinds of
10072 errors.)
10073
10074 The one option that matters is:
10075
10076 @table @code
10077
10078 @item --substitute-urls=@var{urls}
10079 Consider @var{urls} the whitespace-separated list of substitute source
10080 URLs to compare to.
10081
10082 @item --verbose
10083 @itemx -v
10084 Show details about matches (identical contents) in addition to
10085 information about mismatches.
10086
10087 @end table
10088
10089 @node Invoking guix copy
10090 @section Invoking @command{guix copy}
10091
10092 @cindex copy, of store items, over SSH
10093 @cindex SSH, copy of store items
10094 @cindex sharing store items across machines
10095 @cindex transferring store items across machines
10096 The @command{guix copy} command copies items from the store of one
10097 machine to that of another machine over a secure shell (SSH)
10098 connection@footnote{This command is available only when Guile-SSH was
10099 found. @xref{Requirements}, for details.}. For example, the following
10100 command copies the @code{coreutils} package, the user's profile, and all
10101 their dependencies over to @var{host}, logged in as @var{user}:
10102
10103 @example
10104 guix copy --to=@var{user}@@@var{host} \
10105 coreutils `readlink -f ~/.guix-profile`
10106 @end example
10107
10108 If some of the items to be copied are already present on @var{host},
10109 they are not actually sent.
10110
10111 The command below retrieves @code{libreoffice} and @code{gimp} from
10112 @var{host}, assuming they are available there:
10113
10114 @example
10115 guix copy --from=@var{host} libreoffice gimp
10116 @end example
10117
10118 The SSH connection is established using the Guile-SSH client, which is
10119 compatible with OpenSSH: it honors @file{~/.ssh/known_hosts} and
10120 @file{~/.ssh/config}, and uses the SSH agent for authentication.
10121
10122 The key used to sign items that are sent must be accepted by the remote
10123 machine. Likewise, the key used by the remote machine to sign items you
10124 are retrieving must be in @file{/etc/guix/acl} so it is accepted by your
10125 own daemon. @xref{Invoking guix archive}, for more information about
10126 store item authentication.
10127
10128 The general syntax is:
10129
10130 @example
10131 guix copy [--to=@var{spec}|--from=@var{spec}] @var{items}@dots{}
10132 @end example
10133
10134 You must always specify one of the following options:
10135
10136 @table @code
10137 @item --to=@var{spec}
10138 @itemx --from=@var{spec}
10139 Specify the host to send to or receive from. @var{spec} must be an SSH
10140 spec such as @code{example.org}, @code{charlie@@example.org}, or
10141 @code{charlie@@example.org:2222}.
10142 @end table
10143
10144 The @var{items} can be either package names, such as @code{gimp}, or
10145 store items, such as @file{/gnu/store/@dots{}-idutils-4.6}.
10146
10147 When specifying the name of a package to send, it is first built if
10148 needed, unless @option{--dry-run} was specified. Common build options
10149 are supported (@pxref{Common Build Options}).
10150
10151
10152 @node Invoking guix container
10153 @section Invoking @command{guix container}
10154 @cindex container
10155 @cindex @command{guix container}
10156 @quotation Note
10157 As of version @value{VERSION}, this tool is experimental. The interface
10158 is subject to radical change in the future.
10159 @end quotation
10160
10161 The purpose of @command{guix container} is to manipulate processes
10162 running within an isolated environment, commonly known as a
10163 ``container'', typically created by the @command{guix environment}
10164 (@pxref{Invoking guix environment}) and @command{guix system container}
10165 (@pxref{Invoking guix system}) commands.
10166
10167 The general syntax is:
10168
10169 @example
10170 guix container @var{action} @var{options}@dots{}
10171 @end example
10172
10173 @var{action} specifies the operation to perform with a container, and
10174 @var{options} specifies the context-specific arguments for the action.
10175
10176 The following actions are available:
10177
10178 @table @code
10179 @item exec
10180 Execute a command within the context of a running container.
10181
10182 The syntax is:
10183
10184 @example
10185 guix container exec @var{pid} @var{program} @var{arguments}@dots{}
10186 @end example
10187
10188 @var{pid} specifies the process ID of the running container.
10189 @var{program} specifies an executable file name within the root file
10190 system of the container. @var{arguments} are the additional options that
10191 will be passed to @var{program}.
10192
10193 The following command launches an interactive login shell inside a
10194 Guix system container, started by @command{guix system container}, and whose
10195 process ID is 9001:
10196
10197 @example
10198 guix container exec 9001 /run/current-system/profile/bin/bash --login
10199 @end example
10200
10201 Note that the @var{pid} cannot be the parent process of a container. It
10202 must be PID 1 of the container or one of its child processes.
10203
10204 @end table
10205
10206 @node Invoking guix weather
10207 @section Invoking @command{guix weather}
10208
10209 Occasionally you're grumpy because substitutes are lacking and you end
10210 up building packages by yourself (@pxref{Substitutes}). The
10211 @command{guix weather} command reports on substitute availability on the
10212 specified servers so you can have an idea of whether you'll be grumpy
10213 today. It can sometimes be useful info as a user, but it is primarily
10214 useful to people running @command{guix publish} (@pxref{Invoking guix
10215 publish}).
10216
10217 @cindex statistics, for substitutes
10218 @cindex availability of substitutes
10219 @cindex substitute availability
10220 @cindex weather, substitute availability
10221 Here's a sample run:
10222
10223 @example
10224 $ guix weather --substitute-urls=https://guix.example.org
10225 computing 5,872 package derivations for x86_64-linux...
10226 looking for 6,128 store items on https://guix.example.org..
10227 updating list of substitutes from 'https://guix.example.org'... 100.0%
10228 https://guix.example.org
10229 43.4% substitutes available (2,658 out of 6,128)
10230 7,032.5 MiB of nars (compressed)
10231 19,824.2 MiB on disk (uncompressed)
10232 0.030 seconds per request (182.9 seconds in total)
10233 33.5 requests per second
10234
10235 9.8% (342 out of 3,470) of the missing items are queued
10236 867 queued builds
10237 x86_64-linux: 518 (59.7%)
10238 i686-linux: 221 (25.5%)
10239 aarch64-linux: 128 (14.8%)
10240 build rate: 23.41 builds per hour
10241 x86_64-linux: 11.16 builds per hour
10242 i686-linux: 6.03 builds per hour
10243 aarch64-linux: 6.41 builds per hour
10244 @end example
10245
10246 @cindex continuous integration, statistics
10247 As you can see, it reports the fraction of all the packages for which
10248 substitutes are available on the server---regardless of whether
10249 substitutes are enabled, and regardless of whether this server's signing
10250 key is authorized. It also reports the size of the compressed archives
10251 (``nars'') provided by the server, the size the corresponding store
10252 items occupy in the store (assuming deduplication is turned off), and
10253 the server's throughput. The second part gives continuous integration
10254 (CI) statistics, if the server supports it. In addition, using the
10255 @option{--coverage} option, @command{guix weather} can list ``important''
10256 package substitutes missing on the server (see below).
10257
10258 To achieve that, @command{guix weather} queries over HTTP(S) meta-data
10259 (@dfn{narinfos}) for all the relevant store items. Like @command{guix
10260 challenge}, it ignores signatures on those substitutes, which is
10261 innocuous since the command only gathers statistics and cannot install
10262 those substitutes.
10263
10264 The general syntax is:
10265
10266 @example
10267 guix weather @var{options}@dots{} [@var{packages}@dots{}]
10268 @end example
10269
10270 When @var{packages} is omitted, @command{guix weather} checks the availability
10271 of substitutes for @emph{all} the packages, or for those specified with
10272 @option{--manifest}; otherwise it only considers the specified packages. It
10273 is also possible to query specific system types with @option{--system}. The
10274 available options are listed below.
10275
10276 @table @code
10277 @item --substitute-urls=@var{urls}
10278 @var{urls} is the space-separated list of substitute server URLs to
10279 query. When this option is omitted, the default set of substitute
10280 servers is queried.
10281
10282 @item --system=@var{system}
10283 @itemx -s @var{system}
10284 Query substitutes for @var{system}---e.g., @code{aarch64-linux}. This
10285 option can be repeated, in which case @command{guix weather} will query
10286 substitutes for several system types.
10287
10288 @item --manifest=@var{file}
10289 Instead of querying substitutes for all the packages, only ask for those
10290 specified in @var{file}. @var{file} must contain a @dfn{manifest}, as
10291 with the @code{-m} option of @command{guix package} (@pxref{Invoking
10292 guix package}).
10293
10294 @item --coverage[=@var{count}]
10295 @itemx -c [@var{count}]
10296 Report on substitute coverage for packages: list packages with at least
10297 @var{count} dependents (zero by default) for which substitutes are
10298 unavailable. Dependent packages themselves are not listed: if @var{b} depends
10299 on @var{a} and @var{a} has no substitutes, only @var{a} is listed, even though
10300 @var{b} usually lacks substitutes as well. The result looks like this:
10301
10302 @example
10303 $ guix weather --substitute-urls=@value{SUBSTITUTE-URL} -c 10
10304 computing 8,983 package derivations for x86_64-linux...
10305 looking for 9,343 store items on @value{SUBSTITUTE-URL}...
10306 updating substitutes from '@value{SUBSTITUTE-URL}'... 100.0%
10307 @value{SUBSTITUTE-URL}
10308 64.7% substitutes available (6,047 out of 9,343)
10309 @dots{}
10310 2502 packages are missing from '@value{SUBSTITUTE-URL}' for 'x86_64-linux', among which:
10311 58 kcoreaddons@@5.49.0 /gnu/store/@dots{}-kcoreaddons-5.49.0
10312 46 qgpgme@@1.11.1 /gnu/store/@dots{}-qgpgme-1.11.1
10313 37 perl-http-cookiejar@@0.008 /gnu/store/@dots{}-perl-http-cookiejar-0.008
10314 @dots{}
10315 @end example
10316
10317 What this example shows is that @code{kcoreaddons} and presumably the 58
10318 packages that depend on it have no substitutes at @code{ci.guix.info};
10319 likewise for @code{qgpgme} and the 46 packages that depend on it.
10320
10321 If you are a Guix developer, or if you are taking care of this build farm,
10322 you'll probably want to have a closer look at these packages: they may simply
10323 fail to build.
10324 @end table
10325
10326 @node Invoking guix processes
10327 @section Invoking @command{guix processes}
10328
10329 The @command{guix processes} command can be useful to developers and system
10330 administrators, especially on multi-user machines and on build farms: it lists
10331 the current sessions (connections to the daemon), as well as information about
10332 the processes involved@footnote{Remote sessions, when @command{guix-daemon} is
10333 started with @option{--listen} specifying a TCP endpoint, are @emph{not}
10334 listed.}. Here's an example of the information it returns:
10335
10336 @example
10337 $ sudo guix processes
10338 SessionPID: 19002
10339 ClientPID: 19090
10340 ClientCommand: guix environment --ad-hoc python
10341
10342 SessionPID: 19402
10343 ClientPID: 19367
10344 ClientCommand: guix publish -u guix-publish -p 3000 -C 9 @dots{}
10345
10346 SessionPID: 19444
10347 ClientPID: 19419
10348 ClientCommand: cuirass --cache-directory /var/cache/cuirass @dots{}
10349 LockHeld: /gnu/store/@dots{}-perl-ipc-cmd-0.96.lock
10350 LockHeld: /gnu/store/@dots{}-python-six-bootstrap-1.11.0.lock
10351 LockHeld: /gnu/store/@dots{}-libjpeg-turbo-2.0.0.lock
10352 ChildProcess: 20495: guix offload x86_64-linux 7200 1 28800
10353 ChildProcess: 27733: guix offload x86_64-linux 7200 1 28800
10354 ChildProcess: 27793: guix offload x86_64-linux 7200 1 28800
10355 @end example
10356
10357 In this example we see that @command{guix-daemon} has three clients:
10358 @command{guix environment}, @command{guix publish}, and the Cuirass continuous
10359 integration tool; their process identifier (PID) is given by the
10360 @code{ClientPID} field. The @code{SessionPID} field gives the PID of the
10361 @command{guix-daemon} sub-process of this particular session.
10362
10363 The @code{LockHeld} fields show which store items are currently locked by this
10364 session, which corresponds to store items being built or substituted (the
10365 @code{LockHeld} field is not displayed when @command{guix processes} is not
10366 running as root.) Last, by looking at the @code{ChildProcess} field, we
10367 understand that these three builds are being offloaded (@pxref{Daemon Offload
10368 Setup}).
10369
10370 The output is in Recutils format so we can use the handy @command{recsel}
10371 command to select sessions of interest (@pxref{Selection Expressions,,,
10372 recutils, GNU recutils manual}). As an example, the command shows the command
10373 line and PID of the client that triggered the build of a Perl package:
10374
10375 @example
10376 $ sudo guix processes | \
10377 recsel -p ClientPID,ClientCommand -e 'LockHeld ~ "perl"'
10378 ClientPID: 19419
10379 ClientCommand: cuirass --cache-directory /var/cache/cuirass @dots{}
10380 @end example
10381
10382
10383 @node System Configuration
10384 @chapter System Configuration
10385
10386 @cindex system configuration
10387 Guix System supports a consistent whole-system configuration
10388 mechanism. By that we mean that all aspects of the global system
10389 configuration---such as the available system services, timezone and
10390 locale settings, user accounts---are declared in a single place. Such
10391 a @dfn{system configuration} can be @dfn{instantiated}---i.e., effected.
10392
10393 One of the advantages of putting all the system configuration under the
10394 control of Guix is that it supports transactional system upgrades, and
10395 makes it possible to roll back to a previous system instantiation,
10396 should something go wrong with the new one (@pxref{Features}). Another
10397 advantage is that it makes it easy to replicate the exact same configuration
10398 across different machines, or at different points in time, without
10399 having to resort to additional administration tools layered on top of
10400 the own tools of the system.
10401 @c Yes, we're talking of Puppet, Chef, & co. here. ↑
10402
10403 This section describes this mechanism. First we focus on the system
10404 administrator's viewpoint---explaining how the system is configured and
10405 instantiated. Then we show how this mechanism can be extended, for
10406 instance to support new system services.
10407
10408 @menu
10409 * Using the Configuration System:: Customizing your GNU system.
10410 * operating-system Reference:: Detail of operating-system declarations.
10411 * File Systems:: Configuring file system mounts.
10412 * Mapped Devices:: Block device extra processing.
10413 * User Accounts:: Specifying user accounts.
10414 * Keyboard Layout:: How the system interprets key strokes.
10415 * Locales:: Language and cultural convention settings.
10416 * Services:: Specifying system services.
10417 * Setuid Programs:: Programs running with root privileges.
10418 * X.509 Certificates:: Authenticating HTTPS servers.
10419 * Name Service Switch:: Configuring libc's name service switch.
10420 * Initial RAM Disk:: Linux-Libre bootstrapping.
10421 * Bootloader Configuration:: Configuring the boot loader.
10422 * Invoking guix system:: Instantiating a system configuration.
10423 * Invoking guix deploy:: Deploying a system configuration to a remote host.
10424 * Running Guix in a VM:: How to run Guix System in a virtual machine.
10425 * Defining Services:: Adding new service definitions.
10426 @end menu
10427
10428 @node Using the Configuration System
10429 @section Using the Configuration System
10430
10431 The operating system is configured by providing an
10432 @code{operating-system} declaration in a file that can then be passed to
10433 the @command{guix system} command (@pxref{Invoking guix system}). A
10434 simple setup, with the default system services, the default Linux-Libre
10435 kernel, initial RAM disk, and boot loader looks like this:
10436
10437 @findex operating-system
10438 @lisp
10439 @include os-config-bare-bones.texi
10440 @end lisp
10441
10442 This example should be self-describing. Some of the fields defined
10443 above, such as @code{host-name} and @code{bootloader}, are mandatory.
10444 Others, such as @code{packages} and @code{services}, can be omitted, in
10445 which case they get a default value.
10446
10447 Below we discuss the effect of some of the most important fields
10448 (@pxref{operating-system Reference}, for details about all the available
10449 fields), and how to @dfn{instantiate} the operating system using
10450 @command{guix system}.
10451
10452 @unnumberedsubsec Bootloader
10453
10454 @cindex legacy boot, on Intel machines
10455 @cindex BIOS boot, on Intel machines
10456 @cindex UEFI boot
10457 @cindex EFI boot
10458 The @code{bootloader} field describes the method that will be used to boot
10459 your system. Machines based on Intel processors can boot in ``legacy'' BIOS
10460 mode, as in the example above. However, more recent machines rely instead on
10461 the @dfn{Unified Extensible Firmware Interface} (UEFI) to boot. In that case,
10462 the @code{bootloader} field should contain something along these lines:
10463
10464 @lisp
10465 (bootloader-configuration
10466 (bootloader grub-efi-bootloader)
10467 (target "/boot/efi"))
10468 @end lisp
10469
10470 @xref{Bootloader Configuration}, for more information on the available
10471 configuration options.
10472
10473 @unnumberedsubsec Globally-Visible Packages
10474
10475 @vindex %base-packages
10476 The @code{packages} field lists packages that will be globally visible
10477 on the system, for all user accounts---i.e., in every user's @code{PATH}
10478 environment variable---in addition to the per-user profiles
10479 (@pxref{Invoking guix package}). The @code{%base-packages} variable
10480 provides all the tools one would expect for basic user and administrator
10481 tasks---including the GNU Core Utilities, the GNU Networking Utilities,
10482 the GNU Zile lightweight text editor, @command{find}, @command{grep},
10483 etc. The example above adds GNU@tie{}Screen to those,
10484 taken from the @code{(gnu packages screen)}
10485 module (@pxref{Package Modules}). The
10486 @code{(list package output)} syntax can be used to add a specific output
10487 of a package:
10488
10489 @lisp
10490 (use-modules (gnu packages))
10491 (use-modules (gnu packages dns))
10492
10493 (operating-system
10494 ;; ...
10495 (packages (cons (list bind "utils")
10496 %base-packages)))
10497 @end lisp
10498
10499 @findex specification->package
10500 Referring to packages by variable name, like @code{bind} above, has
10501 the advantage of being unambiguous; it also allows typos and such to be
10502 diagnosed right away as ``unbound variables''. The downside is that one
10503 needs to know which module defines which package, and to augment the
10504 @code{use-package-modules} line accordingly. To avoid that, one can use
10505 the @code{specification->package} procedure of the @code{(gnu packages)}
10506 module, which returns the best package for a given name or name and
10507 version:
10508
10509 @lisp
10510 (use-modules (gnu packages))
10511
10512 (operating-system
10513 ;; ...
10514 (packages (append (map specification->package
10515 '("tcpdump" "htop" "gnupg@@2.0"))
10516 %base-packages)))
10517 @end lisp
10518
10519 @unnumberedsubsec System Services
10520
10521 @cindex services
10522 @vindex %base-services
10523 The @code{services} field lists @dfn{system services} to be made
10524 available when the system starts (@pxref{Services}).
10525 The @code{operating-system} declaration above specifies that, in
10526 addition to the basic services, we want the OpenSSH secure shell
10527 daemon listening on port 2222 (@pxref{Networking Services,
10528 @code{openssh-service-type}}). Under the hood,
10529 @code{openssh-service-type} arranges so that @command{sshd} is started with the
10530 right command-line options, possibly with supporting configuration files
10531 generated as needed (@pxref{Defining Services}).
10532
10533 @cindex customization, of services
10534 @findex modify-services
10535 Occasionally, instead of using the base services as is, you will want to
10536 customize them. To do this, use @code{modify-services} (@pxref{Service
10537 Reference, @code{modify-services}}) to modify the list.
10538
10539 For example, suppose you want to modify @code{guix-daemon} and Mingetty
10540 (the console log-in) in the @code{%base-services} list (@pxref{Base
10541 Services, @code{%base-services}}). To do that, you can write the
10542 following in your operating system declaration:
10543
10544 @lisp
10545 (define %my-services
10546 ;; My very own list of services.
10547 (modify-services %base-services
10548 (guix-service-type config =>
10549 (guix-configuration
10550 (inherit config)
10551 (use-substitutes? #f)
10552 (extra-options '("--gc-keep-derivations"))))
10553 (mingetty-service-type config =>
10554 (mingetty-configuration
10555 (inherit config)))))
10556
10557 (operating-system
10558 ;; @dots{}
10559 (services %my-services))
10560 @end lisp
10561
10562 This changes the configuration---i.e., the service parameters---of the
10563 @code{guix-service-type} instance, and that of all the
10564 @code{mingetty-service-type} instances in the @code{%base-services} list.
10565 Observe how this is accomplished: first, we arrange for the original
10566 configuration to be bound to the identifier @code{config} in the
10567 @var{body}, and then we write the @var{body} so that it evaluates to the
10568 desired configuration. In particular, notice how we use @code{inherit}
10569 to create a new configuration which has the same values as the old
10570 configuration, but with a few modifications.
10571
10572 @cindex encrypted disk
10573 The configuration for a typical ``desktop'' usage, with an encrypted
10574 root partition, the X11 display
10575 server, GNOME and Xfce (users can choose which of these desktop
10576 environments to use at the log-in screen by pressing @kbd{F1}), network
10577 management, power management, and more, would look like this:
10578
10579 @lisp
10580 @include os-config-desktop.texi
10581 @end lisp
10582
10583 A graphical system with a choice of lightweight window managers
10584 instead of full-blown desktop environments would look like this:
10585
10586 @lisp
10587 @include os-config-lightweight-desktop.texi
10588 @end lisp
10589
10590 This example refers to the @file{/boot/efi} file system by its UUID,
10591 @code{1234-ABCD}. Replace this UUID with the right UUID on your system,
10592 as returned by the @command{blkid} command.
10593
10594 @xref{Desktop Services}, for the exact list of services provided by
10595 @code{%desktop-services}. @xref{X.509 Certificates}, for background
10596 information about the @code{nss-certs} package that is used here.
10597
10598 Again, @code{%desktop-services} is just a list of service objects. If
10599 you want to remove services from there, you can do so using the
10600 procedures for list filtering (@pxref{SRFI-1 Filtering and
10601 Partitioning,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}). For instance, the
10602 following expression returns a list that contains all the services in
10603 @code{%desktop-services} minus the Avahi service:
10604
10605 @lisp
10606 (remove (lambda (service)
10607 (eq? (service-kind service) avahi-service-type))
10608 %desktop-services)
10609 @end lisp
10610
10611 @unnumberedsubsec Instantiating the System
10612
10613 Assuming the @code{operating-system} declaration
10614 is stored in the @file{my-system-config.scm}
10615 file, the @command{guix system reconfigure my-system-config.scm} command
10616 instantiates that configuration, and makes it the default GRUB boot
10617 entry (@pxref{Invoking guix system}).
10618
10619 The normal way to change the system configuration is by updating this
10620 file and re-running @command{guix system reconfigure}. One should never
10621 have to touch files in @file{/etc} or to run commands that modify the
10622 system state such as @command{useradd} or @command{grub-install}. In
10623 fact, you must avoid that since that would not only void your warranty
10624 but also prevent you from rolling back to previous versions of your
10625 system, should you ever need to.
10626
10627 @cindex roll-back, of the operating system
10628 Speaking of roll-back, each time you run @command{guix system
10629 reconfigure}, a new @dfn{generation} of the system is created---without
10630 modifying or deleting previous generations. Old system generations get
10631 an entry in the bootloader boot menu, allowing you to boot them in case
10632 something went wrong with the latest generation. Reassuring, no? The
10633 @command{guix system list-generations} command lists the system
10634 generations available on disk. It is also possible to roll back the
10635 system via the commands @command{guix system roll-back} and
10636 @command{guix system switch-generation}.
10637
10638 Although the @command{guix system reconfigure} command will not modify
10639 previous generations, you must take care when the current generation is not
10640 the latest (e.g., after invoking @command{guix system roll-back}), since
10641 the operation might overwrite a later generation (@pxref{Invoking guix
10642 system}).
10643
10644 @unnumberedsubsec The Programming Interface
10645
10646 At the Scheme level, the bulk of an @code{operating-system} declaration
10647 is instantiated with the following monadic procedure (@pxref{The Store
10648 Monad}):
10649
10650 @deffn {Monadic Procedure} operating-system-derivation os
10651 Return a derivation that builds @var{os}, an @code{operating-system}
10652 object (@pxref{Derivations}).
10653
10654 The output of the derivation is a single directory that refers to all
10655 the packages, configuration files, and other supporting files needed to
10656 instantiate @var{os}.
10657 @end deffn
10658
10659 This procedure is provided by the @code{(gnu system)} module. Along
10660 with @code{(gnu services)} (@pxref{Services}), this module contains the
10661 guts of Guix System. Make sure to visit it!
10662
10663
10664 @node operating-system Reference
10665 @section @code{operating-system} Reference
10666
10667 This section summarizes all the options available in
10668 @code{operating-system} declarations (@pxref{Using the Configuration
10669 System}).
10670
10671 @deftp {Data Type} operating-system
10672 This is the data type representing an operating system configuration.
10673 By that, we mean all the global system configuration, not per-user
10674 configuration (@pxref{Using the Configuration System}).
10675
10676 @table @asis
10677 @item @code{kernel} (default: @var{linux-libre})
10678 The package object of the operating system kernel to use@footnote{Currently
10679 only the Linux-libre kernel is supported. In the future, it will be
10680 possible to use the GNU@tie{}Hurd.}.
10681
10682 @item @code{kernel-arguments} (default: @code{'("quiet")})
10683 List of strings or gexps representing additional arguments to pass on
10684 the command-line of the kernel---e.g., @code{("console=ttyS0")}.
10685
10686 @item @code{bootloader}
10687 The system bootloader configuration object. @xref{Bootloader Configuration}.
10688
10689 @item @code{label}
10690 This is the label (a string) as it appears in the bootloader's menu entry.
10691 The default label includes the kernel name and version.
10692
10693 @item @code{keyboard-layout} (default: @code{#f})
10694 This field specifies the keyboard layout to use in the console. It can be
10695 either @code{#f}, in which case the default keyboard layout is used (usually
10696 US English), or a @code{<keyboard-layout>} record.
10697
10698 This keyboard layout is in effect as soon as the kernel has booted. For
10699 instance, it is the keyboard layout in effect when you type a passphrase if
10700 your root file system is on a @code{luks-device-mapping} mapped device
10701 (@pxref{Mapped Devices}).
10702
10703 @quotation Note
10704 This does @emph{not} specify the keyboard layout used by the bootloader, nor
10705 that used by the graphical display server. @xref{Bootloader Configuration},
10706 for information on how to specify the bootloader's keyboard layout. @xref{X
10707 Window}, for information on how to specify the keyboard layout used by the X
10708 Window System.
10709 @end quotation
10710
10711 @item @code{initrd-modules} (default: @code{%base-initrd-modules})
10712 @cindex initrd
10713 @cindex initial RAM disk
10714 The list of Linux kernel modules that need to be available in the
10715 initial RAM disk. @xref{Initial RAM Disk}.
10716
10717 @item @code{initrd} (default: @code{base-initrd})
10718 A procedure that returns an initial RAM disk for the Linux
10719 kernel. This field is provided to support low-level customization and
10720 should rarely be needed for casual use. @xref{Initial RAM Disk}.
10721
10722 @item @code{firmware} (default: @code{%base-firmware})
10723 @cindex firmware
10724 List of firmware packages loadable by the operating system kernel.
10725
10726 The default includes firmware needed for Atheros- and Broadcom-based
10727 WiFi devices (Linux-libre modules @code{ath9k} and @code{b43-open},
10728 respectively). @xref{Hardware Considerations}, for more info on
10729 supported hardware.
10730
10731 @item @code{host-name}
10732 The host name.
10733
10734 @item @code{hosts-file}
10735 @cindex hosts file
10736 A file-like object (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like objects}) for use as
10737 @file{/etc/hosts} (@pxref{Host Names,,, libc, The GNU C Library
10738 Reference Manual}). The default is a file with entries for
10739 @code{localhost} and @var{host-name}.
10740
10741 @item @code{mapped-devices} (default: @code{'()})
10742 A list of mapped devices. @xref{Mapped Devices}.
10743
10744 @item @code{file-systems}
10745 A list of file systems. @xref{File Systems}.
10746
10747 @item @code{swap-devices} (default: @code{'()})
10748 @cindex swap devices
10749 A list of strings identifying devices or files to be used for ``swap
10750 space'' (@pxref{Memory Concepts,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference
10751 Manual}). For example, @code{'("/dev/sda3")} or @code{'("/swapfile")}.
10752 It is possible to specify a swap file in a file system on a mapped
10753 device, provided that the necessary device mapping and file system are
10754 also specified. @xref{Mapped Devices} and @ref{File Systems}.
10755
10756 @item @code{users} (default: @code{%base-user-accounts})
10757 @itemx @code{groups} (default: @code{%base-groups})
10758 List of user accounts and groups. @xref{User Accounts}.
10759
10760 If the @code{users} list lacks a user account with UID@tie{}0, a
10761 ``root'' account with UID@tie{}0 is automatically added.
10762
10763 @item @code{skeletons} (default: @code{(default-skeletons)})
10764 A list target file name/file-like object tuples (@pxref{G-Expressions,
10765 file-like objects}). These are the skeleton files that will be added to
10766 the home directory of newly-created user accounts.
10767
10768 For instance, a valid value may look like this:
10769
10770 @lisp
10771 `((".bashrc" ,(plain-file "bashrc" "echo Hello\n"))
10772 (".guile" ,(plain-file "guile"
10773 "(use-modules (ice-9 readline))
10774 (activate-readline)")))
10775 @end lisp
10776
10777 @item @code{issue} (default: @code{%default-issue})
10778 A string denoting the contents of the @file{/etc/issue} file, which is
10779 displayed when users log in on a text console.
10780
10781 @item @code{packages} (default: @code{%base-packages})
10782 The set of packages installed in the global profile, which is accessible
10783 at @file{/run/current-system/profile}.
10784
10785 The default set includes core utilities and it is good practice to
10786 install non-core utilities in user profiles (@pxref{Invoking guix
10787 package}).
10788
10789 @item @code{timezone}
10790 A timezone identifying string---e.g., @code{"Europe/Paris"}.
10791
10792 You can run the @command{tzselect} command to find out which timezone
10793 string corresponds to your region. Choosing an invalid timezone name
10794 causes @command{guix system} to fail.
10795
10796 @item @code{locale} (default: @code{"en_US.utf8"})
10797 The name of the default locale (@pxref{Locale Names,,, libc, The GNU C
10798 Library Reference Manual}). @xref{Locales}, for more information.
10799
10800 @item @code{locale-definitions} (default: @code{%default-locale-definitions})
10801 The list of locale definitions to be compiled and that may be used at
10802 run time. @xref{Locales}.
10803
10804 @item @code{locale-libcs} (default: @code{(list @var{glibc})})
10805 The list of GNU@tie{}libc packages whose locale data and tools are used
10806 to build the locale definitions. @xref{Locales}, for compatibility
10807 considerations that justify this option.
10808
10809 @item @code{name-service-switch} (default: @code{%default-nss})
10810 Configuration of the libc name service switch (NSS)---a
10811 @code{<name-service-switch>} object. @xref{Name Service Switch}, for
10812 details.
10813
10814 @item @code{services} (default: @code{%base-services})
10815 A list of service objects denoting system services. @xref{Services}.
10816
10817 @cindex essential services
10818 @item @code{essential-services} (default: ...)
10819 The list of ``essential services''---i.e., things like instances of
10820 @code{system-service-type} and @code{host-name-service-type} (@pxref{Service
10821 Reference}), which are derived from the operating system definition itself.
10822 As a user you should @emph{never} need to touch this field.
10823
10824 @item @code{pam-services} (default: @code{(base-pam-services)})
10825 @cindex PAM
10826 @cindex pluggable authentication modules
10827 Linux @dfn{pluggable authentication module} (PAM) services.
10828 @c FIXME: Add xref to PAM services section.
10829
10830 @item @code{setuid-programs} (default: @var{%setuid-programs})
10831 List of string-valued G-expressions denoting setuid programs.
10832 @xref{Setuid Programs}.
10833
10834 @item @code{sudoers-file} (default: @var{%sudoers-specification})
10835 @cindex sudoers file
10836 The contents of the @file{/etc/sudoers} file as a file-like object
10837 (@pxref{G-Expressions, @code{local-file} and @code{plain-file}}).
10838
10839 This file specifies which users can use the @command{sudo} command, what
10840 they are allowed to do, and what privileges they may gain. The default
10841 is that only @code{root} and members of the @code{wheel} group may use
10842 @code{sudo}.
10843
10844 @end table
10845
10846 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} this-operating-system
10847 When used in the @emph{lexical scope} of an operating system field definition,
10848 this identifier resolves to the operating system being defined.
10849
10850 The example below shows how to refer to the operating system being defined in
10851 the definition of the @code{label} field:
10852
10853 @lisp
10854 (use-modules (gnu) (guix))
10855
10856 (operating-system
10857 ;; ...
10858 (label (package-full-name
10859 (operating-system-kernel this-operating-system))))
10860 @end lisp
10861
10862 It is an error to refer to @code{this-operating-system} outside an operating
10863 system definition.
10864 @end deffn
10865
10866 @end deftp
10867
10868 @node File Systems
10869 @section File Systems
10870
10871 The list of file systems to be mounted is specified in the
10872 @code{file-systems} field of the operating system declaration
10873 (@pxref{Using the Configuration System}). Each file system is declared
10874 using the @code{file-system} form, like this:
10875
10876 @lisp
10877 (file-system
10878 (mount-point "/home")
10879 (device "/dev/sda3")
10880 (type "ext4"))
10881 @end lisp
10882
10883 As usual, some of the fields are mandatory---those shown in the example
10884 above---while others can be omitted. These are described below.
10885
10886 @deftp {Data Type} file-system
10887 Objects of this type represent file systems to be mounted. They
10888 contain the following members:
10889
10890 @table @asis
10891 @item @code{type}
10892 This is a string specifying the type of the file system---e.g.,
10893 @code{"ext4"}.
10894
10895 @item @code{mount-point}
10896 This designates the place where the file system is to be mounted.
10897
10898 @item @code{device}
10899 This names the ``source'' of the file system. It can be one of three
10900 things: a file system label, a file system UUID, or the name of a
10901 @file{/dev} node. Labels and UUIDs offer a way to refer to file
10902 systems without having to hard-code their actual device
10903 name@footnote{Note that, while it is tempting to use
10904 @file{/dev/disk/by-uuid} and similar device names to achieve the same
10905 result, this is not recommended: These special device nodes are created
10906 by the udev daemon and may be unavailable at the time the device is
10907 mounted.}.
10908
10909 @findex file-system-label
10910 File system labels are created using the @code{file-system-label}
10911 procedure, UUIDs are created using @code{uuid}, and @file{/dev} node are
10912 plain strings. Here's an example of a file system referred to by its
10913 label, as shown by the @command{e2label} command:
10914
10915 @lisp
10916 (file-system
10917 (mount-point "/home")
10918 (type "ext4")
10919 (device (file-system-label "my-home")))
10920 @end lisp
10921
10922 @findex uuid
10923 UUIDs are converted from their string representation (as shown by the
10924 @command{tune2fs -l} command) using the @code{uuid} form@footnote{The
10925 @code{uuid} form expects 16-byte UUIDs as defined in
10926 @uref{https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4122, RFC@tie{}4122}. This is the
10927 form of UUID used by the ext2 family of file systems and others, but it
10928 is different from ``UUIDs'' found in FAT file systems, for instance.},
10929 like this:
10930
10931 @lisp
10932 (file-system
10933 (mount-point "/home")
10934 (type "ext4")
10935 (device (uuid "4dab5feb-d176-45de-b287-9b0a6e4c01cb")))
10936 @end lisp
10937
10938 When the source of a file system is a mapped device (@pxref{Mapped
10939 Devices}), its @code{device} field @emph{must} refer to the mapped
10940 device name---e.g., @file{"/dev/mapper/root-partition"}.
10941 This is required so that
10942 the system knows that mounting the file system depends on having the
10943 corresponding device mapping established.
10944
10945 @item @code{flags} (default: @code{'()})
10946 This is a list of symbols denoting mount flags. Recognized flags
10947 include @code{read-only}, @code{bind-mount}, @code{no-dev} (disallow
10948 access to special files), @code{no-suid} (ignore setuid and setgid
10949 bits), @code{no-atime} (do not update file access times), and @code{no-exec}
10950 (disallow program execution). @xref{Mount-Unmount-Remount,,, libc, The GNU C
10951 Library Reference Manual}, for more information on these flags.
10952
10953 @item @code{options} (default: @code{#f})
10954 This is either @code{#f}, or a string denoting mount options passed to the
10955 file system driver. @xref{Mount-Unmount-Remount,,, libc, The GNU C Library
10956 Reference Manual}, for details and run @command{man 8 mount} for options for
10957 various file systems.
10958
10959 @item @code{mount?} (default: @code{#t})
10960 This value indicates whether to automatically mount the file system when
10961 the system is brought up. When set to @code{#f}, the file system gets
10962 an entry in @file{/etc/fstab} (read by the @command{mount} command) but
10963 is not automatically mounted.
10964
10965 @item @code{needed-for-boot?} (default: @code{#f})
10966 This Boolean value indicates whether the file system is needed when
10967 booting. If that is true, then the file system is mounted when the
10968 initial RAM disk (initrd) is loaded. This is always the case, for
10969 instance, for the root file system.
10970
10971 @item @code{check?} (default: @code{#t})
10972 This Boolean indicates whether the file system needs to be checked for
10973 errors before being mounted.
10974
10975 @item @code{create-mount-point?} (default: @code{#f})
10976 When true, the mount point is created if it does not exist yet.
10977
10978 @item @code{dependencies} (default: @code{'()})
10979 This is a list of @code{<file-system>} or @code{<mapped-device>} objects
10980 representing file systems that must be mounted or mapped devices that
10981 must be opened before (and unmounted or closed after) this one.
10982
10983 As an example, consider a hierarchy of mounts: @file{/sys/fs/cgroup} is
10984 a dependency of @file{/sys/fs/cgroup/cpu} and
10985 @file{/sys/fs/cgroup/memory}.
10986
10987 Another example is a file system that depends on a mapped device, for
10988 example for an encrypted partition (@pxref{Mapped Devices}).
10989 @end table
10990 @end deftp
10991
10992 The @code{(gnu system file-systems)} exports the following useful
10993 variables.
10994
10995 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %base-file-systems
10996 These are essential file systems that are required on normal systems,
10997 such as @var{%pseudo-terminal-file-system} and @var{%immutable-store} (see
10998 below.) Operating system declarations should always contain at least
10999 these.
11000 @end defvr
11001
11002 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %pseudo-terminal-file-system
11003 This is the file system to be mounted as @file{/dev/pts}. It supports
11004 @dfn{pseudo-terminals} created @i{via} @code{openpty} and similar
11005 functions (@pxref{Pseudo-Terminals,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference
11006 Manual}). Pseudo-terminals are used by terminal emulators such as
11007 @command{xterm}.
11008 @end defvr
11009
11010 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %shared-memory-file-system
11011 This file system is mounted as @file{/dev/shm} and is used to support
11012 memory sharing across processes (@pxref{Memory-mapped I/O,
11013 @code{shm_open},, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
11014 @end defvr
11015
11016 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %immutable-store
11017 This file system performs a read-only ``bind mount'' of
11018 @file{/gnu/store}, making it read-only for all the users including
11019 @code{root}. This prevents against accidental modification by software
11020 running as @code{root} or by system administrators.
11021
11022 The daemon itself is still able to write to the store: it remounts it
11023 read-write in its own ``name space.''
11024 @end defvr
11025
11026 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %binary-format-file-system
11027 The @code{binfmt_misc} file system, which allows handling of arbitrary
11028 executable file types to be delegated to user space. This requires the
11029 @code{binfmt.ko} kernel module to be loaded.
11030 @end defvr
11031
11032 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %fuse-control-file-system
11033 The @code{fusectl} file system, which allows unprivileged users to mount
11034 and unmount user-space FUSE file systems. This requires the
11035 @code{fuse.ko} kernel module to be loaded.
11036 @end defvr
11037
11038 @node Mapped Devices
11039 @section Mapped Devices
11040
11041 @cindex device mapping
11042 @cindex mapped devices
11043 The Linux kernel has a notion of @dfn{device mapping}: a block device,
11044 such as a hard disk partition, can be @dfn{mapped} into another device,
11045 usually in @code{/dev/mapper/},
11046 with additional processing over the data that flows through
11047 it@footnote{Note that the GNU@tie{}Hurd makes no difference between the
11048 concept of a ``mapped device'' and that of a file system: both boil down
11049 to @emph{translating} input/output operations made on a file to
11050 operations on its backing store. Thus, the Hurd implements mapped
11051 devices, like file systems, using the generic @dfn{translator} mechanism
11052 (@pxref{Translators,,, hurd, The GNU Hurd Reference Manual}).}. A
11053 typical example is encryption device mapping: all writes to the mapped
11054 device are encrypted, and all reads are deciphered, transparently.
11055 Guix extends this notion by considering any device or set of devices that
11056 are @dfn{transformed} in some way to create a new device; for instance,
11057 RAID devices are obtained by @dfn{assembling} several other devices, such
11058 as hard disks or partitions, into a new one that behaves as one partition.
11059 Other examples, not yet implemented, are LVM logical volumes.
11060
11061 Mapped devices are declared using the @code{mapped-device} form,
11062 defined as follows; for examples, see below.
11063
11064 @deftp {Data Type} mapped-device
11065 Objects of this type represent device mappings that will be made when
11066 the system boots up.
11067
11068 @table @code
11069 @item source
11070 This is either a string specifying the name of the block device to be mapped,
11071 such as @code{"/dev/sda3"}, or a list of such strings when several devices
11072 need to be assembled for creating a new one.
11073
11074 @item target
11075 This string specifies the name of the resulting mapped device. For
11076 kernel mappers such as encrypted devices of type @code{luks-device-mapping},
11077 specifying @code{"my-partition"} leads to the creation of
11078 the @code{"/dev/mapper/my-partition"} device.
11079 For RAID devices of type @code{raid-device-mapping}, the full device name
11080 such as @code{"/dev/md0"} needs to be given.
11081
11082 @item type
11083 This must be a @code{mapped-device-kind} object, which specifies how
11084 @var{source} is mapped to @var{target}.
11085 @end table
11086 @end deftp
11087
11088 @defvr {Scheme Variable} luks-device-mapping
11089 This defines LUKS block device encryption using the @command{cryptsetup}
11090 command from the package with the same name. It relies on the
11091 @code{dm-crypt} Linux kernel module.
11092 @end defvr
11093
11094 @defvr {Scheme Variable} raid-device-mapping
11095 This defines a RAID device, which is assembled using the @code{mdadm}
11096 command from the package with the same name. It requires a Linux kernel
11097 module for the appropriate RAID level to be loaded, such as @code{raid456}
11098 for RAID-4, RAID-5 or RAID-6, or @code{raid10} for RAID-10.
11099 @end defvr
11100
11101 @cindex disk encryption
11102 @cindex LUKS
11103 The following example specifies a mapping from @file{/dev/sda3} to
11104 @file{/dev/mapper/home} using LUKS---the
11105 @url{https://gitlab.com/cryptsetup/cryptsetup,Linux Unified Key Setup}, a
11106 standard mechanism for disk encryption.
11107 The @file{/dev/mapper/home}
11108 device can then be used as the @code{device} of a @code{file-system}
11109 declaration (@pxref{File Systems}).
11110
11111 @lisp
11112 (mapped-device
11113 (source "/dev/sda3")
11114 (target "home")
11115 (type luks-device-mapping))
11116 @end lisp
11117
11118 Alternatively, to become independent of device numbering, one may obtain
11119 the LUKS UUID (@dfn{unique identifier}) of the source device by a
11120 command like:
11121
11122 @example
11123 cryptsetup luksUUID /dev/sda3
11124 @end example
11125
11126 and use it as follows:
11127
11128 @lisp
11129 (mapped-device
11130 (source (uuid "cb67fc72-0d54-4c88-9d4b-b225f30b0f44"))
11131 (target "home")
11132 (type luks-device-mapping))
11133 @end lisp
11134
11135 @cindex swap encryption
11136 It is also desirable to encrypt swap space, since swap space may contain
11137 sensitive data. One way to accomplish that is to use a swap file in a
11138 file system on a device mapped via LUKS encryption. In this way, the
11139 swap file is encrypted because the entire device is encrypted.
11140 @xref{Preparing for Installation,,Disk Partitioning}, for an example.
11141
11142 A RAID device formed of the partitions @file{/dev/sda1} and @file{/dev/sdb1}
11143 may be declared as follows:
11144
11145 @lisp
11146 (mapped-device
11147 (source (list "/dev/sda1" "/dev/sdb1"))
11148 (target "/dev/md0")
11149 (type raid-device-mapping))
11150 @end lisp
11151
11152 The @file{/dev/md0} device can then be used as the @code{device} of a
11153 @code{file-system} declaration (@pxref{File Systems}).
11154 Note that the RAID level need not be given; it is chosen during the
11155 initial creation and formatting of the RAID device and is determined
11156 automatically later.
11157
11158
11159 @node User Accounts
11160 @section User Accounts
11161
11162 @cindex users
11163 @cindex accounts
11164 @cindex user accounts
11165 User accounts and groups are entirely managed through the
11166 @code{operating-system} declaration. They are specified with the
11167 @code{user-account} and @code{user-group} forms:
11168
11169 @lisp
11170 (user-account
11171 (name "alice")
11172 (group "users")
11173 (supplementary-groups '("wheel" ;allow use of sudo, etc.
11174 "audio" ;sound card
11175 "video" ;video devices such as webcams
11176 "cdrom")) ;the good ol' CD-ROM
11177 (comment "Bob's sister")
11178 (home-directory "/home/alice"))
11179 @end lisp
11180
11181 When booting or upon completion of @command{guix system reconfigure},
11182 the system ensures that only the user accounts and groups specified in
11183 the @code{operating-system} declaration exist, and with the specified
11184 properties. Thus, account or group creations or modifications made by
11185 directly invoking commands such as @command{useradd} are lost upon
11186 reconfiguration or reboot. This ensures that the system remains exactly
11187 as declared.
11188
11189 @deftp {Data Type} user-account
11190 Objects of this type represent user accounts. The following members may
11191 be specified:
11192
11193 @table @asis
11194 @item @code{name}
11195 The name of the user account.
11196
11197 @item @code{group}
11198 @cindex groups
11199 This is the name (a string) or identifier (a number) of the user group
11200 this account belongs to.
11201
11202 @item @code{supplementary-groups} (default: @code{'()})
11203 Optionally, this can be defined as a list of group names that this
11204 account belongs to.
11205
11206 @item @code{uid} (default: @code{#f})
11207 This is the user ID for this account (a number), or @code{#f}. In the
11208 latter case, a number is automatically chosen by the system when the
11209 account is created.
11210
11211 @item @code{comment} (default: @code{""})
11212 A comment about the account, such as the account owner's full name.
11213
11214 @item @code{home-directory}
11215 This is the name of the home directory for the account.
11216
11217 @item @code{create-home-directory?} (default: @code{#t})
11218 Indicates whether the home directory of this account should be created
11219 if it does not exist yet.
11220
11221 @item @code{shell} (default: Bash)
11222 This is a G-expression denoting the file name of a program to be used as
11223 the shell (@pxref{G-Expressions}).
11224
11225 @item @code{system?} (default: @code{#f})
11226 This Boolean value indicates whether the account is a ``system''
11227 account. System accounts are sometimes treated specially; for instance,
11228 graphical login managers do not list them.
11229
11230 @anchor{user-account-password}
11231 @cindex password, for user accounts
11232 @item @code{password} (default: @code{#f})
11233 You would normally leave this field to @code{#f}, initialize user
11234 passwords as @code{root} with the @command{passwd} command, and then let
11235 users change it with @command{passwd}. Passwords set with
11236 @command{passwd} are of course preserved across reboot and
11237 reconfiguration.
11238
11239 If you @emph{do} want to set an initial password for an account, then
11240 this field must contain the encrypted password, as a string. You can use the
11241 @code{crypt} procedure for this purpose:
11242
11243 @lisp
11244 (user-account
11245 (name "charlie")
11246 (group "users")
11247
11248 ;; Specify a SHA-512-hashed initial password.
11249 (password (crypt "InitialPassword!" "$6$abc")))
11250 @end lisp
11251
11252 @quotation Note
11253 The hash of this initial password will be available in a file in
11254 @file{/gnu/store}, readable by all the users, so this method must be used with
11255 care.
11256 @end quotation
11257
11258 @xref{Passphrase Storage,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}, for
11259 more information on password encryption, and @ref{Encryption,,, guile, GNU
11260 Guile Reference Manual}, for information on Guile's @code{crypt} procedure.
11261
11262 @end table
11263 @end deftp
11264
11265 @cindex groups
11266 User group declarations are even simpler:
11267
11268 @lisp
11269 (user-group (name "students"))
11270 @end lisp
11271
11272 @deftp {Data Type} user-group
11273 This type is for, well, user groups. There are just a few fields:
11274
11275 @table @asis
11276 @item @code{name}
11277 The name of the group.
11278
11279 @item @code{id} (default: @code{#f})
11280 The group identifier (a number). If @code{#f}, a new number is
11281 automatically allocated when the group is created.
11282
11283 @item @code{system?} (default: @code{#f})
11284 This Boolean value indicates whether the group is a ``system'' group.
11285 System groups have low numerical IDs.
11286
11287 @item @code{password} (default: @code{#f})
11288 What, user groups can have a password? Well, apparently yes. Unless
11289 @code{#f}, this field specifies the password of the group.
11290
11291 @end table
11292 @end deftp
11293
11294 For convenience, a variable lists all the basic user groups one may
11295 expect:
11296
11297 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %base-groups
11298 This is the list of basic user groups that users and/or packages expect
11299 to be present on the system. This includes groups such as ``root'',
11300 ``wheel'', and ``users'', as well as groups used to control access to
11301 specific devices such as ``audio'', ``disk'', and ``cdrom''.
11302 @end defvr
11303
11304 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %base-user-accounts
11305 This is the list of basic system accounts that programs may expect to
11306 find on a GNU/Linux system, such as the ``nobody'' account.
11307
11308 Note that the ``root'' account is not included here. It is a
11309 special-case and is automatically added whether or not it is specified.
11310 @end defvr
11311
11312 @node Keyboard Layout
11313 @section Keyboard Layout
11314
11315 @cindex keyboard layout
11316 @cindex keymap
11317 To specify what each key of your keyboard does, you need to tell the operating
11318 system what @dfn{keyboard layout} you want to use. The default, when nothing
11319 is specified, is the US English QWERTY layout for 105-key PC keyboards.
11320 However, German speakers will usually prefer the German QWERTZ layout, French
11321 speakers will want the AZERTY layout, and so on; hackers might prefer Dvorak
11322 or bépo, and they might even want to further customize the effect of some of
11323 the keys. This section explains how to get that done.
11324
11325 @cindex keyboard layout, definition
11326 There are three components that will want to know about your keyboard layout:
11327
11328 @itemize
11329 @item
11330 The @emph{bootloader} may want to know what keyboard layout you want to use
11331 (@pxref{Bootloader Configuration, @code{keyboard-layout}}). This is useful if
11332 you want, for instance, to make sure that you can type the passphrase of your
11333 encrypted root partition using the right layout.
11334
11335 @item
11336 The @emph{operating system kernel}, Linux, will need that so that the console
11337 is properly configured (@pxref{operating-system Reference,
11338 @code{keyboard-layout}}).
11339
11340 @item
11341 The @emph{graphical display server}, usually Xorg, also has its own idea of
11342 the keyboard layout (@pxref{X Window, @code{keyboard-layout}}).
11343 @end itemize
11344
11345 Guix allows you to configure all three separately but, fortunately, it allows
11346 you to share the same keyboard layout for all three components.
11347
11348 @cindex XKB, keyboard layouts
11349 Keyboard layouts are represented by records created by the
11350 @code{keyboard-layout} procedure of @code{(gnu system keyboard)}. Following
11351 the X Keyboard extension (XKB), each layout has four attributes: a name (often
11352 a language code such as ``fi'' for Finnish or ``jp'' for Japanese), an
11353 optional variant name, an optional keyboard model name, and a possibly empty
11354 list of additional options. In most cases the layout name is all you care
11355 about. Here are a few example:
11356
11357 @lisp
11358 ;; The German QWERTZ layout. Here we assume a standard
11359 ;; "pc105" keyboard model.
11360 (keyboard-layout "de")
11361
11362 ;; The bépo variant of the French layout.
11363 (keyboard-layout "fr" "bepo")
11364
11365 ;; The Catalan layout.
11366 (keyboard-layout "es" "cat")
11367
11368 ;; The Latin American Spanish layout. In addition, the
11369 ;; "Caps Lock" key is used as an additional "Ctrl" key,
11370 ;; and the "Menu" key is used as a "Compose" key to enter
11371 ;; accented letters.
11372 (keyboard-layout "latam"
11373 #:options '("ctrl:nocaps" "compose:menu"))
11374
11375 ;; The Russian layout for a ThinkPad keyboard.
11376 (keyboard-layout "ru" #:model "thinkpad")
11377
11378 ;; The "US international" layout, which is the US layout plus
11379 ;; dead keys to enter accented characters. This is for an
11380 ;; Apple MacBook keyboard.
11381 (keyboard-layout "us" "intl" #:model "macbook78")
11382 @end lisp
11383
11384 See the @file{share/X11/xkb} directory of the @code{xkeyboard-config} package
11385 for a complete list of supported layouts, variants, and models.
11386
11387 @cindex keyboard layout, configuration
11388 Let's say you want your system to use the Turkish keyboard layout throughout
11389 your system---bootloader, console, and Xorg. Here's what your system
11390 configuration would look like:
11391
11392 @findex set-xorg-configuration
11393 @lisp
11394 ;; Using the Turkish layout for the bootloader, the console,
11395 ;; and for Xorg.
11396
11397 (operating-system
11398 ;; ...
11399 (keyboard-layout (keyboard-layout "tr")) ;for the console
11400 (bootloader (bootloader-configuration
11401 (bootloader grub-efi-bootloader)
11402 (target "/boot/efi")
11403 (keyboard-layout keyboard-layout))) ;for GRUB
11404 (services (cons (set-xorg-configuration
11405 (xorg-configuration ;for Xorg
11406 (keyboard-layout keyboard-layout)))
11407 %desktop-services)))
11408 @end lisp
11409
11410 In the example above, for GRUB and for Xorg, we just refer to the
11411 @code{keyboard-layout} field defined above, but we could just as well refer to
11412 a different layout. The @code{set-xorg-configuration} procedure communicates
11413 the desired Xorg configuration to the graphical log-in manager, by default
11414 GDM.
11415
11416 We've discussed how to specify the @emph{default} keyboard layout of your
11417 system when it starts, but you can also adjust it at run time:
11418
11419 @itemize
11420 @item
11421 If you're using GNOME, its settings panel has a ``Region & Language'' entry
11422 where you can select one or more keyboard layouts.
11423
11424 @item
11425 Under Xorg, the @command{setxkbmap} command (from the same-named package)
11426 allows you to change the current layout. For example, this is how you would
11427 change the layout to US Dvorak:
11428
11429 @example
11430 setxkbmap us dvorak
11431 @end example
11432
11433 @item
11434 The @code{loadkeys} command changes the keyboard layout in effect in the Linux
11435 console. However, note that @code{loadkeys} does @emph{not} use the XKB
11436 keyboard layout categorization described above. The command below loads the
11437 French bépo layout:
11438
11439 @example
11440 loadkeys fr-bepo
11441 @end example
11442 @end itemize
11443
11444 @node Locales
11445 @section Locales
11446
11447 @cindex locale
11448 A @dfn{locale} defines cultural conventions for a particular language
11449 and region of the world (@pxref{Locales,,, libc, The GNU C Library
11450 Reference Manual}). Each locale has a name that typically has the form
11451 @code{@var{language}_@var{territory}.@var{codeset}}---e.g.,
11452 @code{fr_LU.utf8} designates the locale for the French language, with
11453 cultural conventions from Luxembourg, and using the UTF-8 encoding.
11454
11455 @cindex locale definition
11456 Usually, you will want to specify the default locale for the machine
11457 using the @code{locale} field of the @code{operating-system} declaration
11458 (@pxref{operating-system Reference, @code{locale}}).
11459
11460 The selected locale is automatically added to the @dfn{locale
11461 definitions} known to the system if needed, with its codeset inferred
11462 from its name---e.g., @code{bo_CN.utf8} will be assumed to use the
11463 @code{UTF-8} codeset. Additional locale definitions can be specified in
11464 the @code{locale-definitions} slot of @code{operating-system}---this is
11465 useful, for instance, if the codeset could not be inferred from the
11466 locale name. The default set of locale definitions includes some widely
11467 used locales, but not all the available locales, in order to save space.
11468
11469 For instance, to add the North Frisian locale for Germany, the value of
11470 that field may be:
11471
11472 @lisp
11473 (cons (locale-definition
11474 (name "fy_DE.utf8") (source "fy_DE"))
11475 %default-locale-definitions)
11476 @end lisp
11477
11478 Likewise, to save space, one might want @code{locale-definitions} to
11479 list only the locales that are actually used, as in:
11480
11481 @lisp
11482 (list (locale-definition
11483 (name "ja_JP.eucjp") (source "ja_JP")
11484 (charset "EUC-JP")))
11485 @end lisp
11486
11487 @vindex LOCPATH
11488 The compiled locale definitions are available at
11489 @file{/run/current-system/locale/X.Y}, where @code{X.Y} is the libc
11490 version, which is the default location where the GNU@tie{}libc provided
11491 by Guix looks for locale data. This can be overridden using the
11492 @code{LOCPATH} environment variable (@pxref{locales-and-locpath,
11493 @code{LOCPATH} and locale packages}).
11494
11495 The @code{locale-definition} form is provided by the @code{(gnu system
11496 locale)} module. Details are given below.
11497
11498 @deftp {Data Type} locale-definition
11499 This is the data type of a locale definition.
11500
11501 @table @asis
11502
11503 @item @code{name}
11504 The name of the locale. @xref{Locale Names,,, libc, The GNU C Library
11505 Reference Manual}, for more information on locale names.
11506
11507 @item @code{source}
11508 The name of the source for that locale. This is typically the
11509 @code{@var{language}_@var{territory}} part of the locale name.
11510
11511 @item @code{charset} (default: @code{"UTF-8"})
11512 The ``character set'' or ``code set'' for that locale,
11513 @uref{https://www.iana.org/assignments/character-sets, as defined by
11514 IANA}.
11515
11516 @end table
11517 @end deftp
11518
11519 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %default-locale-definitions
11520 A list of commonly used UTF-8 locales, used as the default
11521 value of the @code{locale-definitions} field of @code{operating-system}
11522 declarations.
11523
11524 @cindex locale name
11525 @cindex normalized codeset in locale names
11526 These locale definitions use the @dfn{normalized codeset} for the part
11527 that follows the dot in the name (@pxref{Using gettextized software,
11528 normalized codeset,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}). So for
11529 instance it has @code{uk_UA.utf8} but @emph{not}, say,
11530 @code{uk_UA.UTF-8}.
11531 @end defvr
11532
11533 @subsection Locale Data Compatibility Considerations
11534
11535 @cindex incompatibility, of locale data
11536 @code{operating-system} declarations provide a @code{locale-libcs} field
11537 to specify the GNU@tie{}libc packages that are used to compile locale
11538 declarations (@pxref{operating-system Reference}). ``Why would I
11539 care?'', you may ask. Well, it turns out that the binary format of
11540 locale data is occasionally incompatible from one libc version to
11541 another.
11542
11543 @c See <https://sourceware.org/ml/libc-alpha/2015-09/msg00575.html>
11544 @c and <https://lists.gnu.org/archive/html/guix-devel/2015-08/msg00737.html>.
11545 For instance, a program linked against libc version 2.21 is unable to
11546 read locale data produced with libc 2.22; worse, that program
11547 @emph{aborts} instead of simply ignoring the incompatible locale
11548 data@footnote{Versions 2.23 and later of GNU@tie{}libc will simply skip
11549 the incompatible locale data, which is already an improvement.}.
11550 Similarly, a program linked against libc 2.22 can read most, but not
11551 all, of the locale data from libc 2.21 (specifically, @code{LC_COLLATE}
11552 data is incompatible); thus calls to @code{setlocale} may fail, but
11553 programs will not abort.
11554
11555 The ``problem'' with Guix is that users have a lot of freedom: They can
11556 choose whether and when to upgrade software in their profiles, and might
11557 be using a libc version different from the one the system administrator
11558 used to build the system-wide locale data.
11559
11560 Fortunately, unprivileged users can also install their own locale data
11561 and define @var{GUIX_LOCPATH} accordingly (@pxref{locales-and-locpath,
11562 @code{GUIX_LOCPATH} and locale packages}).
11563
11564 Still, it is best if the system-wide locale data at
11565 @file{/run/current-system/locale} is built for all the libc versions
11566 actually in use on the system, so that all the programs can access
11567 it---this is especially crucial on a multi-user system. To do that, the
11568 administrator can specify several libc packages in the
11569 @code{locale-libcs} field of @code{operating-system}:
11570
11571 @lisp
11572 (use-package-modules base)
11573
11574 (operating-system
11575 ;; @dots{}
11576 (locale-libcs (list glibc-2.21 (canonical-package glibc))))
11577 @end lisp
11578
11579 This example would lead to a system containing locale definitions for
11580 both libc 2.21 and the current version of libc in
11581 @file{/run/current-system/locale}.
11582
11583
11584 @node Services
11585 @section Services
11586
11587 @cindex system services
11588 An important part of preparing an @code{operating-system} declaration is
11589 listing @dfn{system services} and their configuration (@pxref{Using the
11590 Configuration System}). System services are typically daemons launched
11591 when the system boots, or other actions needed at that time---e.g.,
11592 configuring network access.
11593
11594 Guix has a broad definition of ``service'' (@pxref{Service
11595 Composition}), but many services are managed by the GNU@tie{}Shepherd
11596 (@pxref{Shepherd Services}). On a running system, the @command{herd}
11597 command allows you to list the available services, show their status,
11598 start and stop them, or do other specific operations (@pxref{Jump
11599 Start,,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}). For example:
11600
11601 @example
11602 # herd status
11603 @end example
11604
11605 The above command, run as @code{root}, lists the currently defined
11606 services. The @command{herd doc} command shows a synopsis of the given
11607 service and its associated actions:
11608
11609 @example
11610 # herd doc nscd
11611 Run libc's name service cache daemon (nscd).
11612
11613 # herd doc nscd action invalidate
11614 invalidate: Invalidate the given cache--e.g., 'hosts' for host name lookups.
11615 @end example
11616
11617 The @command{start}, @command{stop}, and @command{restart} sub-commands
11618 have the effect you would expect. For instance, the commands below stop
11619 the nscd service and restart the Xorg display server:
11620
11621 @example
11622 # herd stop nscd
11623 Service nscd has been stopped.
11624 # herd restart xorg-server
11625 Service xorg-server has been stopped.
11626 Service xorg-server has been started.
11627 @end example
11628
11629 The following sections document the available services, starting with
11630 the core services, that may be used in an @code{operating-system}
11631 declaration.
11632
11633 @menu
11634 * Base Services:: Essential system services.
11635 * Scheduled Job Execution:: The mcron service.
11636 * Log Rotation:: The rottlog service.
11637 * Networking Services:: Network setup, SSH daemon, etc.
11638 * X Window:: Graphical display.
11639 * Printing Services:: Local and remote printer support.
11640 * Desktop Services:: D-Bus and desktop services.
11641 * Sound Services:: ALSA and Pulseaudio services.
11642 * Database Services:: SQL databases, key-value stores, etc.
11643 * Mail Services:: IMAP, POP3, SMTP, and all that.
11644 * Messaging Services:: Messaging services.
11645 * Telephony Services:: Telephony services.
11646 * Monitoring Services:: Monitoring services.
11647 * Kerberos Services:: Kerberos services.
11648 * LDAP Services:: LDAP services.
11649 * Web Services:: Web servers.
11650 * Certificate Services:: TLS certificates via Let's Encrypt.
11651 * DNS Services:: DNS daemons.
11652 * VPN Services:: VPN daemons.
11653 * Network File System:: NFS related services.
11654 * Continuous Integration:: The Cuirass service.
11655 * Power Management Services:: Extending battery life.
11656 * Audio Services:: The MPD.
11657 * Virtualization Services:: Virtualization services.
11658 * Version Control Services:: Providing remote access to Git repositories.
11659 * Game Services:: Game servers.
11660 * Miscellaneous Services:: Other services.
11661 @end menu
11662
11663 @node Base Services
11664 @subsection Base Services
11665
11666 The @code{(gnu services base)} module provides definitions for the basic
11667 services that one expects from the system. The services exported by
11668 this module are listed below.
11669
11670 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %base-services
11671 This variable contains a list of basic services (@pxref{Service Types
11672 and Services}, for more information on service objects) one would
11673 expect from the system: a login service (mingetty) on each tty, syslogd,
11674 the libc name service cache daemon (nscd), the udev device manager, and
11675 more.
11676
11677 This is the default value of the @code{services} field of
11678 @code{operating-system} declarations. Usually, when customizing a
11679 system, you will want to append services to @code{%base-services}, like
11680 this:
11681
11682 @lisp
11683 (append (list (service avahi-service-type)
11684 (service openssh-service-type))
11685 %base-services)
11686 @end lisp
11687 @end defvr
11688
11689 @defvr {Scheme Variable} special-files-service-type
11690 This is the service that sets up ``special files'' such as
11691 @file{/bin/sh}; an instance of it is part of @code{%base-services}.
11692
11693 The value associated with @code{special-files-service-type} services
11694 must be a list of tuples where the first element is the ``special file''
11695 and the second element is its target. By default it is:
11696
11697 @cindex @file{/bin/sh}
11698 @cindex @file{sh}, in @file{/bin}
11699 @lisp
11700 `(("/bin/sh" ,(file-append bash "/bin/sh")))
11701 @end lisp
11702
11703 @cindex @file{/usr/bin/env}
11704 @cindex @file{env}, in @file{/usr/bin}
11705 If you want to add, say, @code{/usr/bin/env} to your system, you can
11706 change it to:
11707
11708 @lisp
11709 `(("/bin/sh" ,(file-append bash "/bin/sh"))
11710 ("/usr/bin/env" ,(file-append coreutils "/bin/env")))
11711 @end lisp
11712
11713 Since this is part of @code{%base-services}, you can use
11714 @code{modify-services} to customize the set of special files
11715 (@pxref{Service Reference, @code{modify-services}}). But the simple way
11716 to add a special file is @i{via} the @code{extra-special-file} procedure
11717 (see below.)
11718 @end defvr
11719
11720 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} extra-special-file @var{file} @var{target}
11721 Use @var{target} as the ``special file'' @var{file}.
11722
11723 For example, adding the following lines to the @code{services} field of
11724 your operating system declaration leads to a @file{/usr/bin/env}
11725 symlink:
11726
11727 @lisp
11728 (extra-special-file "/usr/bin/env"
11729 (file-append coreutils "/bin/env"))
11730 @end lisp
11731 @end deffn
11732
11733 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} host-name-service @var{name}
11734 Return a service that sets the host name to @var{name}.
11735 @end deffn
11736
11737 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} login-service @var{config}
11738 Return a service to run login according to @var{config}, a
11739 @code{<login-configuration>} object, which specifies the message of the day,
11740 among other things.
11741 @end deffn
11742
11743 @deftp {Data Type} login-configuration
11744 This is the data type representing the configuration of login.
11745
11746 @table @asis
11747
11748 @item @code{motd}
11749 @cindex message of the day
11750 A file-like object containing the ``message of the day''.
11751
11752 @item @code{allow-empty-passwords?} (default: @code{#t})
11753 Allow empty passwords by default so that first-time users can log in when
11754 the 'root' account has just been created.
11755
11756 @end table
11757 @end deftp
11758
11759 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} mingetty-service @var{config}
11760 Return a service to run mingetty according to @var{config}, a
11761 @code{<mingetty-configuration>} object, which specifies the tty to run, among
11762 other things.
11763 @end deffn
11764
11765 @deftp {Data Type} mingetty-configuration
11766 This is the data type representing the configuration of Mingetty, which
11767 provides the default implementation of virtual console log-in.
11768
11769 @table @asis
11770
11771 @item @code{tty}
11772 The name of the console this Mingetty runs on---e.g., @code{"tty1"}.
11773
11774 @item @code{auto-login} (default: @code{#f})
11775 When true, this field must be a string denoting the user name under
11776 which the system automatically logs in. When it is @code{#f}, a
11777 user name and password must be entered to log in.
11778
11779 @item @code{login-program} (default: @code{#f})
11780 This must be either @code{#f}, in which case the default log-in program
11781 is used (@command{login} from the Shadow tool suite), or a gexp denoting
11782 the name of the log-in program.
11783
11784 @item @code{login-pause?} (default: @code{#f})
11785 When set to @code{#t} in conjunction with @var{auto-login}, the user
11786 will have to press a key before the log-in shell is launched.
11787
11788 @item @code{mingetty} (default: @var{mingetty})
11789 The Mingetty package to use.
11790
11791 @end table
11792 @end deftp
11793
11794 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} agetty-service @var{config}
11795 Return a service to run agetty according to @var{config}, an
11796 @code{<agetty-configuration>} object, which specifies the tty to run,
11797 among other things.
11798 @end deffn
11799
11800 @deftp {Data Type} agetty-configuration
11801 This is the data type representing the configuration of agetty, which
11802 implements virtual and serial console log-in. See the @code{agetty(8)}
11803 man page for more information.
11804
11805 @table @asis
11806
11807 @item @code{tty}
11808 The name of the console this agetty runs on, as a string---e.g.,
11809 @code{"ttyS0"}. This argument is optional, it will default to
11810 a reasonable default serial port used by the kernel Linux.
11811
11812 For this, if there is a value for an option @code{agetty.tty} in the kernel
11813 command line, agetty will extract the device name of the serial port
11814 from it and use that.
11815
11816 If not and if there is a value for an option @code{console} with a tty in
11817 the Linux command line, agetty will extract the device name of the
11818 serial port from it and use that.
11819
11820 In both cases, agetty will leave the other serial device settings
11821 (baud rate etc.)@: alone---in the hope that Linux pinned them to the
11822 correct values.
11823
11824 @item @code{baud-rate} (default: @code{#f})
11825 A string containing a comma-separated list of one or more baud rates, in
11826 descending order.
11827
11828 @item @code{term} (default: @code{#f})
11829 A string containing the value used for the @code{TERM} environment
11830 variable.
11831
11832 @item @code{eight-bits?} (default: @code{#f})
11833 When @code{#t}, the tty is assumed to be 8-bit clean, and parity detection is
11834 disabled.
11835
11836 @item @code{auto-login} (default: @code{#f})
11837 When passed a login name, as a string, the specified user will be logged
11838 in automatically without prompting for their login name or password.
11839
11840 @item @code{no-reset?} (default: @code{#f})
11841 When @code{#t}, don't reset terminal cflags (control modes).
11842
11843 @item @code{host} (default: @code{#f})
11844 This accepts a string containing the "login_host", which will be written
11845 into the @file{/var/run/utmpx} file.
11846
11847 @item @code{remote?} (default: @code{#f})
11848 When set to @code{#t} in conjunction with @var{host}, this will add an
11849 @code{-r} fakehost option to the command line of the login program
11850 specified in @var{login-program}.
11851
11852 @item @code{flow-control?} (default: @code{#f})
11853 When set to @code{#t}, enable hardware (RTS/CTS) flow control.
11854
11855 @item @code{no-issue?} (default: @code{#f})
11856 When set to @code{#t}, the contents of the @file{/etc/issue} file will
11857 not be displayed before presenting the login prompt.
11858
11859 @item @code{init-string} (default: @code{#f})
11860 This accepts a string that will be sent to the tty or modem before
11861 sending anything else. It can be used to initialize a modem.
11862
11863 @item @code{no-clear?} (default: @code{#f})
11864 When set to @code{#t}, agetty will not clear the screen before showing
11865 the login prompt.
11866
11867 @item @code{login-program} (default: (file-append shadow "/bin/login"))
11868 This must be either a gexp denoting the name of a log-in program, or
11869 unset, in which case the default value is the @command{login} from the
11870 Shadow tool suite.
11871
11872 @item @code{local-line} (default: @code{#f})
11873 Control the CLOCAL line flag. This accepts one of three symbols as
11874 arguments, @code{'auto}, @code{'always}, or @code{'never}. If @code{#f},
11875 the default value chosen by agetty is @code{'auto}.
11876
11877 @item @code{extract-baud?} (default: @code{#f})
11878 When set to @code{#t}, instruct agetty to try to extract the baud rate
11879 from the status messages produced by certain types of modems.
11880
11881 @item @code{skip-login?} (default: @code{#f})
11882 When set to @code{#t}, do not prompt the user for a login name. This
11883 can be used with @var{login-program} field to use non-standard login
11884 systems.
11885
11886 @item @code{no-newline?} (default: @code{#f})
11887 When set to @code{#t}, do not print a newline before printing the
11888 @file{/etc/issue} file.
11889
11890 @c Is this dangerous only when used with login-program, or always?
11891 @item @code{login-options} (default: @code{#f})
11892 This option accepts a string containing options that are passed to the
11893 login program. When used with the @var{login-program}, be aware that a
11894 malicious user could try to enter a login name containing embedded
11895 options that could be parsed by the login program.
11896
11897 @item @code{login-pause} (default: @code{#f})
11898 When set to @code{#t}, wait for any key before showing the login prompt.
11899 This can be used in conjunction with @var{auto-login} to save memory by
11900 lazily spawning shells.
11901
11902 @item @code{chroot} (default: @code{#f})
11903 Change root to the specified directory. This option accepts a directory
11904 path as a string.
11905
11906 @item @code{hangup?} (default: @code{#f})
11907 Use the Linux system call @code{vhangup} to do a virtual hangup of the
11908 specified terminal.
11909
11910 @item @code{keep-baud?} (default: @code{#f})
11911 When set to @code{#t}, try to keep the existing baud rate. The baud
11912 rates from @var{baud-rate} are used when agetty receives a @key{BREAK}
11913 character.
11914
11915 @item @code{timeout} (default: @code{#f})
11916 When set to an integer value, terminate if no user name could be read
11917 within @var{timeout} seconds.
11918
11919 @item @code{detect-case?} (default: @code{#f})
11920 When set to @code{#t}, turn on support for detecting an uppercase-only
11921 terminal. This setting will detect a login name containing only
11922 uppercase letters as indicating an uppercase-only terminal and turn on
11923 some upper-to-lower case conversions. Note that this will not support
11924 Unicode characters.
11925
11926 @item @code{wait-cr?} (default: @code{#f})
11927 When set to @code{#t}, wait for the user or modem to send a
11928 carriage-return or linefeed character before displaying
11929 @file{/etc/issue} or login prompt. This is typically used with the
11930 @var{init-string} option.
11931
11932 @item @code{no-hints?} (default: @code{#f})
11933 When set to @code{#t}, do not print hints about Num, Caps, and Scroll
11934 locks.
11935
11936 @item @code{no-hostname?} (default: @code{#f})
11937 By default, the hostname is printed. When this option is set to
11938 @code{#t}, no hostname will be shown at all.
11939
11940 @item @code{long-hostname?} (default: @code{#f})
11941 By default, the hostname is only printed until the first dot. When this
11942 option is set to @code{#t}, the fully qualified hostname by
11943 @code{gethostname} or @code{getaddrinfo} is shown.
11944
11945 @item @code{erase-characters} (default: @code{#f})
11946 This option accepts a string of additional characters that should be
11947 interpreted as backspace when the user types their login name.
11948
11949 @item @code{kill-characters} (default: @code{#f})
11950 This option accepts a string that should be interpreted to mean "ignore
11951 all previous characters" (also called a "kill" character) when the user
11952 types their login name.
11953
11954 @item @code{chdir} (default: @code{#f})
11955 This option accepts, as a string, a directory path that will be changed
11956 to before login.
11957
11958 @item @code{delay} (default: @code{#f})
11959 This options accepts, as an integer, the number of seconds to sleep
11960 before opening the tty and displaying the login prompt.
11961
11962 @item @code{nice} (default: @code{#f})
11963 This option accepts, as an integer, the nice value with which to run the
11964 @command{login} program.
11965
11966 @item @code{extra-options} (default: @code{'()})
11967 This option provides an "escape hatch" for the user to provide arbitrary
11968 command-line arguments to @command{agetty} as a list of strings.
11969
11970 @end table
11971 @end deftp
11972
11973 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} kmscon-service-type @var{config}
11974 Return a service to run @uref{https://www.freedesktop.org/wiki/Software/kmscon,kmscon}
11975 according to @var{config}, a @code{<kmscon-configuration>} object, which
11976 specifies the tty to run, among other things.
11977 @end deffn
11978
11979 @deftp {Data Type} kmscon-configuration
11980 This is the data type representing the configuration of Kmscon, which
11981 implements virtual console log-in.
11982
11983 @table @asis
11984
11985 @item @code{virtual-terminal}
11986 The name of the console this Kmscon runs on---e.g., @code{"tty1"}.
11987
11988 @item @code{login-program} (default: @code{#~(string-append #$shadow "/bin/login")})
11989 A gexp denoting the name of the log-in program. The default log-in program is
11990 @command{login} from the Shadow tool suite.
11991
11992 @item @code{login-arguments} (default: @code{'("-p")})
11993 A list of arguments to pass to @command{login}.
11994
11995 @item @code{auto-login} (default: @code{#f})
11996 When passed a login name, as a string, the specified user will be logged
11997 in automatically without prompting for their login name or password.
11998
11999 @item @code{hardware-acceleration?} (default: #f)
12000 Whether to use hardware acceleration.
12001
12002 @item @code{kmscon} (default: @var{kmscon})
12003 The Kmscon package to use.
12004
12005 @end table
12006 @end deftp
12007
12008 @cindex name service cache daemon
12009 @cindex nscd
12010 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} nscd-service [@var{config}] [#:glibc glibc] @
12011 [#:name-services '()]
12012 Return a service that runs the libc name service cache daemon (nscd) with the
12013 given @var{config}---an @code{<nscd-configuration>} object. @xref{Name
12014 Service Switch}, for an example.
12015
12016 For convenience, the Shepherd service for nscd provides the following actions:
12017
12018 @table @code
12019 @item invalidate
12020 @cindex cache invalidation, nscd
12021 @cindex nscd, cache invalidation
12022 This invalidate the given cache. For instance, running:
12023
12024 @example
12025 herd invalidate nscd hosts
12026 @end example
12027
12028 @noindent
12029 invalidates the host name lookup cache of nscd.
12030
12031 @item statistics
12032 Running @command{herd statistics nscd} displays information about nscd usage
12033 and caches.
12034 @end table
12035
12036 @end deffn
12037
12038 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %nscd-default-configuration
12039 This is the default @code{<nscd-configuration>} value (see below) used
12040 by @code{nscd-service}. It uses the caches defined by
12041 @var{%nscd-default-caches}; see below.
12042 @end defvr
12043
12044 @deftp {Data Type} nscd-configuration
12045 This is the data type representing the name service cache daemon (nscd)
12046 configuration.
12047
12048 @table @asis
12049
12050 @item @code{name-services} (default: @code{'()})
12051 List of packages denoting @dfn{name services} that must be visible to
12052 the nscd---e.g., @code{(list @var{nss-mdns})}.
12053
12054 @item @code{glibc} (default: @var{glibc})
12055 Package object denoting the GNU C Library providing the @command{nscd}
12056 command.
12057
12058 @item @code{log-file} (default: @code{"/var/log/nscd.log"})
12059 Name of the nscd log file. This is where debugging output goes when
12060 @code{debug-level} is strictly positive.
12061
12062 @item @code{debug-level} (default: @code{0})
12063 Integer denoting the debugging levels. Higher numbers mean that more
12064 debugging output is logged.
12065
12066 @item @code{caches} (default: @var{%nscd-default-caches})
12067 List of @code{<nscd-cache>} objects denoting things to be cached; see
12068 below.
12069
12070 @end table
12071 @end deftp
12072
12073 @deftp {Data Type} nscd-cache
12074 Data type representing a cache database of nscd and its parameters.
12075
12076 @table @asis
12077
12078 @item @code{database}
12079 This is a symbol representing the name of the database to be cached.
12080 Valid values are @code{passwd}, @code{group}, @code{hosts}, and
12081 @code{services}, which designate the corresponding NSS database
12082 (@pxref{NSS Basics,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
12083
12084 @item @code{positive-time-to-live}
12085 @itemx @code{negative-time-to-live} (default: @code{20})
12086 A number representing the number of seconds during which a positive or
12087 negative lookup result remains in cache.
12088
12089 @item @code{check-files?} (default: @code{#t})
12090 Whether to check for updates of the files corresponding to
12091 @var{database}.
12092
12093 For instance, when @var{database} is @code{hosts}, setting this flag
12094 instructs nscd to check for updates in @file{/etc/hosts} and to take
12095 them into account.
12096
12097 @item @code{persistent?} (default: @code{#t})
12098 Whether the cache should be stored persistently on disk.
12099
12100 @item @code{shared?} (default: @code{#t})
12101 Whether the cache should be shared among users.
12102
12103 @item @code{max-database-size} (default: 32@tie{}MiB)
12104 Maximum size in bytes of the database cache.
12105
12106 @c XXX: 'suggested-size' and 'auto-propagate?' seem to be expert
12107 @c settings, so leave them out.
12108
12109 @end table
12110 @end deftp
12111
12112 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %nscd-default-caches
12113 List of @code{<nscd-cache>} objects used by default by
12114 @code{nscd-configuration} (see above).
12115
12116 It enables persistent and aggressive caching of service and host name
12117 lookups. The latter provides better host name lookup performance,
12118 resilience in the face of unreliable name servers, and also better
12119 privacy---often the result of host name lookups is in local cache, so
12120 external name servers do not even need to be queried.
12121 @end defvr
12122
12123 @anchor{syslog-configuration-type}
12124 @cindex syslog
12125 @cindex logging
12126 @deftp {Data Type} syslog-configuration
12127 This data type represents the configuration of the syslog daemon.
12128
12129 @table @asis
12130 @item @code{syslogd} (default: @code{#~(string-append #$inetutils "/libexec/syslogd")})
12131 The syslog daemon to use.
12132
12133 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{%default-syslog.conf})
12134 The syslog configuration file to use.
12135
12136 @end table
12137 @end deftp
12138
12139 @anchor{syslog-service}
12140 @cindex syslog
12141 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} syslog-service @var{config}
12142 Return a service that runs a syslog daemon according to @var{config}.
12143
12144 @xref{syslogd invocation,,, inetutils, GNU Inetutils}, for more
12145 information on the configuration file syntax.
12146 @end deffn
12147
12148 @defvr {Scheme Variable} guix-service-type
12149 This is the type of the service that runs the build daemon,
12150 @command{guix-daemon} (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon}). Its value must be a
12151 @code{guix-configuration} record as described below.
12152 @end defvr
12153
12154 @anchor{guix-configuration-type}
12155 @deftp {Data Type} guix-configuration
12156 This data type represents the configuration of the Guix build daemon.
12157 @xref{Invoking guix-daemon}, for more information.
12158
12159 @table @asis
12160 @item @code{guix} (default: @var{guix})
12161 The Guix package to use.
12162
12163 @item @code{build-group} (default: @code{"guixbuild"})
12164 Name of the group for build user accounts.
12165
12166 @item @code{build-accounts} (default: @code{10})
12167 Number of build user accounts to create.
12168
12169 @item @code{authorize-key?} (default: @code{#t})
12170 @cindex substitutes, authorization thereof
12171 Whether to authorize the substitute keys listed in
12172 @code{authorized-keys}---by default that of @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}}
12173 (@pxref{Substitutes}).
12174
12175 @vindex %default-authorized-guix-keys
12176 @item @code{authorized-keys} (default: @code{%default-authorized-guix-keys})
12177 The list of authorized key files for archive imports, as a list of
12178 string-valued gexps (@pxref{Invoking guix archive}). By default, it
12179 contains that of @code{@value{SUBSTITUTE-SERVER}} (@pxref{Substitutes}).
12180
12181 @item @code{use-substitutes?} (default: @code{#t})
12182 Whether to use substitutes.
12183
12184 @item @code{substitute-urls} (default: @code{%default-substitute-urls})
12185 The list of URLs where to look for substitutes by default.
12186
12187 @item @code{max-silent-time} (default: @code{0})
12188 @itemx @code{timeout} (default: @code{0})
12189 The number of seconds of silence and the number of seconds of activity,
12190 respectively, after which a build process times out. A value of zero
12191 disables the timeout.
12192
12193 @item @code{log-compression} (default: @code{'bzip2})
12194 The type of compression used for build logs---one of @code{gzip},
12195 @code{bzip2}, or @code{none}.
12196
12197 @item @code{extra-options} (default: @code{'()})
12198 List of extra command-line options for @command{guix-daemon}.
12199
12200 @item @code{log-file} (default: @code{"/var/log/guix-daemon.log"})
12201 File where @command{guix-daemon}'s standard output and standard error
12202 are written.
12203
12204 @item @code{http-proxy} (default: @code{#f})
12205 The HTTP proxy used for downloading fixed-output derivations and
12206 substitutes.
12207
12208 @item @code{tmpdir} (default: @code{#f})
12209 A directory path where the @command{guix-daemon} will perform builds.
12210
12211 @end table
12212 @end deftp
12213
12214 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} udev-service [#:udev @var{eudev} #:rules @code{'()}]
12215 Run @var{udev}, which populates the @file{/dev} directory dynamically.
12216 udev rules can be provided as a list of files through the @var{rules}
12217 variable. The procedures @code{udev-rule} and @code{file->udev-rule} from
12218 @code{(gnu services base)} simplify the creation of such rule files.
12219 @end deffn
12220
12221 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} udev-rule [@var{file-name} @var{contents}]
12222 Return a udev-rule file named @var{file-name} containing the rules
12223 defined by the @var{contents} literal.
12224
12225 In the following example, a rule for a USB device is defined to be
12226 stored in the file @file{90-usb-thing.rules}. The rule runs a script
12227 upon detecting a USB device with a given product identifier.
12228
12229 @lisp
12230 (define %example-udev-rule
12231 (udev-rule
12232 "90-usb-thing.rules"
12233 (string-append "ACTION==\"add\", SUBSYSTEM==\"usb\", "
12234 "ATTR@{product@}==\"Example\", "
12235 "RUN+=\"/path/to/script\"")))
12236 @end lisp
12237
12238 The @command{herd rules udev} command, as root, returns the name of the
12239 directory containing all the active udev rules.
12240 @end deffn
12241
12242 Here we show how the default @var{udev-service} can be extended with it.
12243
12244 @lisp
12245 (operating-system
12246 ;; @dots{}
12247 (services
12248 (modify-services %desktop-services
12249 (udev-service-type config =>
12250 (udev-configuration (inherit config)
12251 (rules (append (udev-configuration-rules config)
12252 (list %example-udev-rule))))))))
12253 @end lisp
12254
12255 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} file->udev-rule [@var{file-name} @var{file}]
12256 Return a udev file named @var{file-name} containing the rules defined
12257 within @var{file}, a file-like object.
12258
12259 The following example showcases how we can use an existing rule file.
12260
12261 @lisp
12262 (use-modules (guix download) ;for url-fetch
12263 (guix packages) ;for origin
12264 ;; @dots{})
12265
12266 (define %android-udev-rules
12267 (file->udev-rule
12268 "51-android-udev.rules"
12269 (let ((version "20170910"))
12270 (origin
12271 (method url-fetch)
12272 (uri (string-append "https://raw.githubusercontent.com/M0Rf30/"
12273 "android-udev-rules/" version "/51-android.rules"))
12274 (sha256
12275 (base32 "0lmmagpyb6xsq6zcr2w1cyx9qmjqmajkvrdbhjx32gqf1d9is003"))))))
12276 @end lisp
12277 @end deffn
12278
12279 Additionally, Guix package definitions can be included in @var{rules} in
12280 order to extend the udev rules with the definitions found under their
12281 @file{lib/udev/rules.d} sub-directory. In lieu of the previous
12282 @var{file->udev-rule} example, we could have used the
12283 @var{android-udev-rules} package which exists in Guix in the @code{(gnu
12284 packages android)} module.
12285
12286 The following example shows how to use the @var{android-udev-rules}
12287 package so that the Android tool @command{adb} can detect devices
12288 without root privileges. It also details how to create the
12289 @code{adbusers} group, which is required for the proper functioning of
12290 the rules defined within the @var{android-udev-rules} package. To
12291 create such a group, we must define it both as part of the
12292 @var{supplementary-groups} of our @var{user-account} declaration, as
12293 well as in the @var{groups} field of the @var{operating-system} record.
12294
12295 @lisp
12296 (use-modules (gnu packages android) ;for android-udev-rules
12297 (gnu system shadow) ;for user-group
12298 ;; @dots{})
12299
12300 (operating-system
12301 ;; @dots{}
12302 (users (cons (user-acount
12303 ;; @dots{}
12304 (supplementary-groups
12305 '("adbusers" ;for adb
12306 "wheel" "netdev" "audio" "video"))
12307 ;; @dots{})))
12308
12309 (groups (cons (user-group (system? #t) (name "adbusers"))
12310 %base-groups))
12311
12312 ;; @dots{}
12313
12314 (services
12315 (modify-services %desktop-services
12316 (udev-service-type
12317 config =>
12318 (udev-configuration (inherit config)
12319 (rules (cons android-udev-rules
12320 (udev-configuration-rules config))))))))
12321 @end lisp
12322
12323 @defvr {Scheme Variable} urandom-seed-service-type
12324 Save some entropy in @var{%random-seed-file} to seed @file{/dev/urandom}
12325 when rebooting. It also tries to seed @file{/dev/urandom} from
12326 @file{/dev/hwrng} while booting, if @file{/dev/hwrng} exists and is
12327 readable.
12328 @end defvr
12329
12330 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %random-seed-file
12331 This is the name of the file where some random bytes are saved by
12332 @var{urandom-seed-service} to seed @file{/dev/urandom} when rebooting.
12333 It defaults to @file{/var/lib/random-seed}.
12334 @end defvr
12335
12336 @cindex mouse
12337 @cindex gpm
12338 @defvr {Scheme Variable} gpm-service-type
12339 This is the type of the service that runs GPM, the @dfn{general-purpose
12340 mouse daemon}, which provides mouse support to the Linux console. GPM
12341 allows users to use the mouse in the console, notably to select, copy,
12342 and paste text.
12343
12344 The value for services of this type must be a @code{gpm-configuration}
12345 (see below). This service is not part of @code{%base-services}.
12346 @end defvr
12347
12348 @deftp {Data Type} gpm-configuration
12349 Data type representing the configuration of GPM.
12350
12351 @table @asis
12352 @item @code{options} (default: @code{%default-gpm-options})
12353 Command-line options passed to @command{gpm}. The default set of
12354 options instruct @command{gpm} to listen to mouse events on
12355 @file{/dev/input/mice}. @xref{Command Line,,, gpm, gpm manual}, for
12356 more information.
12357
12358 @item @code{gpm} (default: @code{gpm})
12359 The GPM package to use.
12360
12361 @end table
12362 @end deftp
12363
12364 @anchor{guix-publish-service-type}
12365 @deffn {Scheme Variable} guix-publish-service-type
12366 This is the service type for @command{guix publish} (@pxref{Invoking
12367 guix publish}). Its value must be a @code{guix-publish-configuration}
12368 object, as described below.
12369
12370 This assumes that @file{/etc/guix} already contains a signing key pair as
12371 created by @command{guix archive --generate-key} (@pxref{Invoking guix
12372 archive}). If that is not the case, the service will fail to start.
12373 @end deffn
12374
12375 @deftp {Data Type} guix-publish-configuration
12376 Data type representing the configuration of the @code{guix publish}
12377 service.
12378
12379 @table @asis
12380 @item @code{guix} (default: @code{guix})
12381 The Guix package to use.
12382
12383 @item @code{port} (default: @code{80})
12384 The TCP port to listen for connections.
12385
12386 @item @code{host} (default: @code{"localhost"})
12387 The host (and thus, network interface) to listen to. Use
12388 @code{"0.0.0.0"} to listen on all the network interfaces.
12389
12390 @item @code{compression} (default: @code{'(("gzip" 3))})
12391 This is a list of compression method/level tuple used when compressing
12392 substitutes. For example, to compress all substitutes with @emph{both} lzip
12393 at level 7 and gzip at level 9, write:
12394
12395 @lisp
12396 '(("lzip" 7) ("gzip" 9))
12397 @end lisp
12398
12399 Level 9 achieves the best compression ratio at the expense of increased CPU
12400 usage, whereas level 1 achieves fast compression.
12401
12402 An empty list disables compression altogether.
12403
12404 @item @code{nar-path} (default: @code{"nar"})
12405 The URL path at which ``nars'' can be fetched. @xref{Invoking guix
12406 publish, @code{--nar-path}}, for details.
12407
12408 @item @code{cache} (default: @code{#f})
12409 When it is @code{#f}, disable caching and instead generate archives on
12410 demand. Otherwise, this should be the name of a directory---e.g.,
12411 @code{"/var/cache/guix/publish"}---where @command{guix publish} caches
12412 archives and meta-data ready to be sent. @xref{Invoking guix publish,
12413 @option{--cache}}, for more information on the tradeoffs involved.
12414
12415 @item @code{workers} (default: @code{#f})
12416 When it is an integer, this is the number of worker threads used for
12417 caching; when @code{#f}, the number of processors is used.
12418 @xref{Invoking guix publish, @option{--workers}}, for more information.
12419
12420 @item @code{ttl} (default: @code{#f})
12421 When it is an integer, this denotes the @dfn{time-to-live} in seconds
12422 of the published archives. @xref{Invoking guix publish, @option{--ttl}},
12423 for more information.
12424 @end table
12425 @end deftp
12426
12427 @anchor{rngd-service}
12428 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} rngd-service [#:rng-tools @var{rng-tools}] @
12429 [#:device "/dev/hwrng"]
12430 Return a service that runs the @command{rngd} program from @var{rng-tools}
12431 to add @var{device} to the kernel's entropy pool. The service will fail if
12432 @var{device} does not exist.
12433 @end deffn
12434
12435 @anchor{pam-limits-service}
12436 @cindex session limits
12437 @cindex ulimit
12438 @cindex priority
12439 @cindex realtime
12440 @cindex jackd
12441 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} pam-limits-service [#:limits @code{'()}]
12442
12443 Return a service that installs a configuration file for the
12444 @uref{http://linux-pam.org/Linux-PAM-html/sag-pam_limits.html,
12445 @code{pam_limits} module}. The procedure optionally takes a list of
12446 @code{pam-limits-entry} values, which can be used to specify
12447 @code{ulimit} limits and nice priority limits to user sessions.
12448
12449 The following limits definition sets two hard and soft limits for all
12450 login sessions of users in the @code{realtime} group:
12451
12452 @lisp
12453 (pam-limits-service
12454 (list
12455 (pam-limits-entry "@@realtime" 'both 'rtprio 99)
12456 (pam-limits-entry "@@realtime" 'both 'memlock 'unlimited)))
12457 @end lisp
12458
12459 The first entry increases the maximum realtime priority for
12460 non-privileged processes; the second entry lifts any restriction of the
12461 maximum address space that can be locked in memory. These settings are
12462 commonly used for real-time audio systems.
12463 @end deffn
12464
12465 @node Scheduled Job Execution
12466 @subsection Scheduled Job Execution
12467
12468 @cindex cron
12469 @cindex mcron
12470 @cindex scheduling jobs
12471 The @code{(gnu services mcron)} module provides an interface to
12472 GNU@tie{}mcron, a daemon to run jobs at scheduled times (@pxref{Top,,,
12473 mcron, GNU@tie{}mcron}). GNU@tie{}mcron is similar to the traditional
12474 Unix @command{cron} daemon; the main difference is that it is
12475 implemented in Guile Scheme, which provides a lot of flexibility when
12476 specifying the scheduling of jobs and their actions.
12477
12478 The example below defines an operating system that runs the
12479 @command{updatedb} (@pxref{Invoking updatedb,,, find, Finding Files})
12480 and the @command{guix gc} commands (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}) daily, as
12481 well as the @command{mkid} command on behalf of an unprivileged user
12482 (@pxref{mkid invocation,,, idutils, ID Database Utilities}). It uses
12483 gexps to introduce job definitions that are passed to mcron
12484 (@pxref{G-Expressions}).
12485
12486 @lisp
12487 (use-modules (guix) (gnu) (gnu services mcron))
12488 (use-package-modules base idutils)
12489
12490 (define updatedb-job
12491 ;; Run 'updatedb' at 3AM every day. Here we write the
12492 ;; job's action as a Scheme procedure.
12493 #~(job '(next-hour '(3))
12494 (lambda ()
12495 (execl (string-append #$findutils "/bin/updatedb")
12496 "updatedb"
12497 "--prunepaths=/tmp /var/tmp /gnu/store"))))
12498
12499 (define garbage-collector-job
12500 ;; Collect garbage 5 minutes after midnight every day.
12501 ;; The job's action is a shell command.
12502 #~(job "5 0 * * *" ;Vixie cron syntax
12503 "guix gc -F 1G"))
12504
12505 (define idutils-job
12506 ;; Update the index database as user "charlie" at 12:15PM
12507 ;; and 19:15PM. This runs from the user's home directory.
12508 #~(job '(next-minute-from (next-hour '(12 19)) '(15))
12509 (string-append #$idutils "/bin/mkid src")
12510 #:user "charlie"))
12511
12512 (operating-system
12513 ;; @dots{}
12514 (services (cons (service mcron-service-type
12515 (mcron-configuration
12516 (jobs (list garbage-collector-job
12517 updatedb-job
12518 idutils-job))))
12519 %base-services)))
12520 @end lisp
12521
12522 For more complex jobs defined in Scheme where you need control over the top
12523 level, for instance to introduce a @code{use-modules} form, you can move your
12524 code to a separate program using the @code{program-file} procedure of the
12525 @code{(guix gexp)} module (@pxref{G-Expressions}). The example below
12526 illustrates that.
12527
12528 @lisp
12529 (define %battery-alert-job
12530 ;; Beep when the battery percentage falls below %MIN-LEVEL.
12531 #~(job
12532 '(next-minute (range 0 60 1))
12533 #$(program-file
12534 "battery-alert.scm"
12535 (with-imported-modules (source-module-closure
12536 '((guix build utils)))
12537 #~(begin
12538 (define %min-level 20)
12539 (use-modules (guix build utils)
12540 (ice-9 popen)
12541 (ice-9 regex)
12542 (ice-9 textual-ports)
12543 (srfi srfi-2))
12544 (setenv "LC_ALL" "C") ;ensure English output
12545 (and-let* ((input-pipe (open-pipe*
12546 OPEN_READ
12547 #$(file-append acpi "/bin/acpi")))
12548 (output (get-string-all input-pipe))
12549 (m (string-match "Discharging, ([0-9]+)%" output))
12550 (level (string->number (match:substring m 1)))
12551 ((< level %min-level)))
12552 (format #t "warning: Battery level is low (~a%)~%" level)
12553 (invoke #$(file-append beep "/bin/beep") "-r5")))))))
12554 @end lisp
12555
12556 @xref{Guile Syntax, mcron job specifications,, mcron, GNU@tie{}mcron},
12557 for more information on mcron job specifications. Below is the
12558 reference of the mcron service.
12559
12560 On a running system, you can use the @code{schedule} action of the service to
12561 visualize the mcron jobs that will be executed next:
12562
12563 @example
12564 # herd schedule mcron
12565 @end example
12566
12567 @noindent
12568 The example above lists the next five tasks that will be executed, but you can
12569 also specify the number of tasks to display:
12570
12571 @example
12572 # herd schedule mcron 10
12573 @end example
12574
12575 @defvr {Scheme Variable} mcron-service-type
12576 This is the type of the @code{mcron} service, whose value is an
12577 @code{mcron-configuration} object.
12578
12579 This service type can be the target of a service extension that provides
12580 it additional job specifications (@pxref{Service Composition}). In
12581 other words, it is possible to define services that provide additional
12582 mcron jobs to run.
12583 @end defvr
12584
12585 @deftp {Data Type} mcron-configuration
12586 Data type representing the configuration of mcron.
12587
12588 @table @asis
12589 @item @code{mcron} (default: @var{mcron})
12590 The mcron package to use.
12591
12592 @item @code{jobs}
12593 This is a list of gexps (@pxref{G-Expressions}), where each gexp
12594 corresponds to an mcron job specification (@pxref{Syntax, mcron job
12595 specifications,, mcron, GNU@tie{}mcron}).
12596 @end table
12597 @end deftp
12598
12599
12600 @node Log Rotation
12601 @subsection Log Rotation
12602
12603 @cindex rottlog
12604 @cindex log rotation
12605 @cindex logging
12606 Log files such as those found in @file{/var/log} tend to grow endlessly,
12607 so it's a good idea to @dfn{rotate} them once in a while---i.e., archive
12608 their contents in separate files, possibly compressed. The @code{(gnu
12609 services admin)} module provides an interface to GNU@tie{}Rot[t]log, a
12610 log rotation tool (@pxref{Top,,, rottlog, GNU Rot[t]log Manual}).
12611
12612 The example below defines an operating system that provides log rotation
12613 with the default settings, for commonly encountered log files.
12614
12615 @lisp
12616 (use-modules (guix) (gnu))
12617 (use-service-modules admin mcron)
12618 (use-package-modules base idutils)
12619
12620 (operating-system
12621 ;; @dots{}
12622 (services (cons (service rottlog-service-type)
12623 %base-services)))
12624 @end lisp
12625
12626 @defvr {Scheme Variable} rottlog-service-type
12627 This is the type of the Rottlog service, whose value is a
12628 @code{rottlog-configuration} object.
12629
12630 Other services can extend this one with new @code{log-rotation} objects
12631 (see below), thereby augmenting the set of files to be rotated.
12632
12633 This service type can define mcron jobs (@pxref{Scheduled Job
12634 Execution}) to run the rottlog service.
12635 @end defvr
12636
12637 @deftp {Data Type} rottlog-configuration
12638 Data type representing the configuration of rottlog.
12639
12640 @table @asis
12641 @item @code{rottlog} (default: @code{rottlog})
12642 The Rottlog package to use.
12643
12644 @item @code{rc-file} (default: @code{(file-append rottlog "/etc/rc")})
12645 The Rottlog configuration file to use (@pxref{Mandatory RC Variables,,,
12646 rottlog, GNU Rot[t]log Manual}).
12647
12648 @item @code{rotations} (default: @code{%default-rotations})
12649 A list of @code{log-rotation} objects as defined below.
12650
12651 @item @code{jobs}
12652 This is a list of gexps where each gexp corresponds to an mcron job
12653 specification (@pxref{Scheduled Job Execution}).
12654 @end table
12655 @end deftp
12656
12657 @deftp {Data Type} log-rotation
12658 Data type representing the rotation of a group of log files.
12659
12660 Taking an example from the Rottlog manual (@pxref{Period Related File
12661 Examples,,, rottlog, GNU Rot[t]log Manual}), a log rotation might be
12662 defined like this:
12663
12664 @lisp
12665 (log-rotation
12666 (frequency 'daily)
12667 (files '("/var/log/apache/*"))
12668 (options '("storedir apache-archives"
12669 "rotate 6"
12670 "notifempty"
12671 "nocompress")))
12672 @end lisp
12673
12674 The list of fields is as follows:
12675
12676 @table @asis
12677 @item @code{frequency} (default: @code{'weekly})
12678 The log rotation frequency, a symbol.
12679
12680 @item @code{files}
12681 The list of files or file glob patterns to rotate.
12682
12683 @item @code{options} (default: @code{'()})
12684 The list of rottlog options for this rotation (@pxref{Configuration
12685 parameters,,, rottlog, GNU Rot[t]lg Manual}).
12686
12687 @item @code{post-rotate} (default: @code{#f})
12688 Either @code{#f} or a gexp to execute once the rotation has completed.
12689 @end table
12690 @end deftp
12691
12692 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %default-rotations
12693 Specifies weekly rotation of @var{%rotated-files} and of
12694 @file{/var/log/guix-daemon.log}.
12695 @end defvr
12696
12697 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %rotated-files
12698 The list of syslog-controlled files to be rotated. By default it is:
12699 @code{'("/var/log/messages" "/var/log/secure" "/var/log/debug" \
12700 "/var/log/maillog")}.
12701 @end defvr
12702
12703 @node Networking Services
12704 @subsection Networking Services
12705
12706 The @code{(gnu services networking)} module provides services to configure
12707 the network interface.
12708
12709 @cindex DHCP, networking service
12710 @defvr {Scheme Variable} dhcp-client-service-type
12711 This is the type of services that run @var{dhcp}, a Dynamic Host Configuration
12712 Protocol (DHCP) client, on all the non-loopback network interfaces. Its value
12713 is the DHCP client package to use, @code{isc-dhcp} by default.
12714 @end defvr
12715
12716 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} dhcpd-service-type
12717 This type defines a service that runs a DHCP daemon. To create a
12718 service of this type, you must supply a @code{<dhcpd-configuration>}.
12719 For example:
12720
12721 @lisp
12722 (service dhcpd-service-type
12723 (dhcpd-configuration
12724 (config-file (local-file "my-dhcpd.conf"))
12725 (interfaces '("enp0s25"))))
12726 @end lisp
12727 @end deffn
12728
12729 @deftp {Data Type} dhcpd-configuration
12730 @table @asis
12731 @item @code{package} (default: @code{isc-dhcp})
12732 The package that provides the DHCP daemon. This package is expected to
12733 provide the daemon at @file{sbin/dhcpd} relative to its output
12734 directory. The default package is the
12735 @uref{https://www.isc.org/products/DHCP, ISC's DHCP server}.
12736 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{#f})
12737 The configuration file to use. This is required. It will be passed to
12738 @code{dhcpd} via its @code{-cf} option. This may be any ``file-like''
12739 object (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like objects}). See @code{man
12740 dhcpd.conf} for details on the configuration file syntax.
12741 @item @code{version} (default: @code{"4"})
12742 The DHCP version to use. The ISC DHCP server supports the values ``4'',
12743 ``6'', and ``4o6''. These correspond to the @code{dhcpd} program
12744 options @code{-4}, @code{-6}, and @code{-4o6}. See @code{man dhcpd} for
12745 details.
12746 @item @code{run-directory} (default: @code{"/run/dhcpd"})
12747 The run directory to use. At service activation time, this directory
12748 will be created if it does not exist.
12749 @item @code{pid-file} (default: @code{"/run/dhcpd/dhcpd.pid"})
12750 The PID file to use. This corresponds to the @code{-pf} option of
12751 @code{dhcpd}. See @code{man dhcpd} for details.
12752 @item @code{interfaces} (default: @code{'()})
12753 The names of the network interfaces on which dhcpd should listen for
12754 broadcasts. If this list is not empty, then its elements (which must be
12755 strings) will be appended to the @code{dhcpd} invocation when starting
12756 the daemon. It may not be necessary to explicitly specify any
12757 interfaces here; see @code{man dhcpd} for details.
12758 @end table
12759 @end deftp
12760
12761 @defvr {Scheme Variable} static-networking-service-type
12762 This is the type for statically-configured network interfaces.
12763 @c TODO Document <static-networking> data structures.
12764 @end defvr
12765
12766 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} static-networking-service @var{interface} @var{ip} @
12767 [#:netmask #f] [#:gateway #f] [#:name-servers @code{'()}] @
12768 [#:requirement @code{'(udev)}]
12769 Return a service that starts @var{interface} with address @var{ip}. If
12770 @var{netmask} is true, use it as the network mask. If @var{gateway} is true,
12771 it must be a string specifying the default network gateway. @var{requirement}
12772 can be used to declare a dependency on another service before configuring the
12773 interface.
12774
12775 This procedure can be called several times, one for each network
12776 interface of interest. Behind the scenes what it does is extend
12777 @code{static-networking-service-type} with additional network interfaces
12778 to handle.
12779
12780 For example:
12781
12782 @lisp
12783 (static-networking-service "eno1" "192.168.1.82"
12784 #:gateway "192.168.1.2"
12785 #:name-servers '("192.168.1.2"))
12786 @end lisp
12787 @end deffn
12788
12789 @cindex wicd
12790 @cindex wireless
12791 @cindex WiFi
12792 @cindex network management
12793 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} wicd-service [#:wicd @var{wicd}]
12794 Return a service that runs @url{https://launchpad.net/wicd,Wicd}, a network
12795 management daemon that aims to simplify wired and wireless networking.
12796
12797 This service adds the @var{wicd} package to the global profile, providing
12798 several commands to interact with the daemon and configure networking:
12799 @command{wicd-client}, a graphical user interface, and the @command{wicd-cli}
12800 and @command{wicd-curses} user interfaces.
12801 @end deffn
12802
12803 @cindex ModemManager
12804
12805 @defvr {Scheme Variable} modem-manager-service-type
12806 This is the service type for the
12807 @uref{https://wiki.gnome.org/Projects/ModemManager, ModemManager}
12808 service. The value for this service type is a
12809 @code{modem-manager-configuration} record.
12810
12811 This service is part of @code{%desktop-services} (@pxref{Desktop
12812 Services}).
12813 @end defvr
12814
12815 @deftp {Data Type} modem-manager-configuration
12816 Data type representing the configuration of ModemManager.
12817
12818 @table @asis
12819 @item @code{modem-manager} (default: @code{modem-manager})
12820 The ModemManager package to use.
12821
12822 @end table
12823 @end deftp
12824
12825 @cindex USB_ModeSwitch
12826 @cindex Modeswitching
12827
12828 @defvr {Scheme Variable} usb-modeswitch-service-type
12829 This is the service type for the
12830 @uref{http://www.draisberghof.de/usb_modeswitch/, USB_ModeSwitch} service. The
12831 value for this service type is a @code{usb-modeswitch-configuration} record.
12832
12833 When plugged in, some USB modems (and other USB devices) initially present
12834 themselves as a read-only storage medium and not as a modem. They need to be
12835 @dfn{modeswitched} before they are usable. The USB_ModeSwitch service type
12836 installs udev rules to automatically modeswitch these devices when they are
12837 plugged in.
12838
12839 This service is part of @code{%desktop-services} (@pxref{Desktop
12840 Services}).
12841 @end defvr
12842
12843 @deftp {Data Type} usb-modeswitch-configuration
12844 Data type representing the configuration of USB_ModeSwitch.
12845
12846 @table @asis
12847 @item @code{usb-modeswitch} (default: @code{usb-modeswitch})
12848 The USB_ModeSwitch package providing the binaries for modeswitching.
12849
12850 @item @code{usb-modeswitch-data} (default: @code{usb-modeswitch-data})
12851 The package providing the device data and udev rules file used by
12852 USB_ModeSwitch.
12853
12854 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{#~(string-append #$usb-modeswitch:dispatcher "/etc/usb_modeswitch.conf")})
12855 Which config file to use for the USB_ModeSwitch dispatcher. By default the
12856 config file shipped with USB_ModeSwitch is used which disables logging to
12857 @file{/var/log} among other default settings. If set to @code{#f}, no config
12858 file is used.
12859
12860 @end table
12861 @end deftp
12862
12863 @cindex NetworkManager
12864
12865 @defvr {Scheme Variable} network-manager-service-type
12866 This is the service type for the
12867 @uref{https://wiki.gnome.org/Projects/NetworkManager, NetworkManager}
12868 service. The value for this service type is a
12869 @code{network-manager-configuration} record.
12870
12871 This service is part of @code{%desktop-services} (@pxref{Desktop
12872 Services}).
12873 @end defvr
12874
12875 @deftp {Data Type} network-manager-configuration
12876 Data type representing the configuration of NetworkManager.
12877
12878 @table @asis
12879 @item @code{network-manager} (default: @code{network-manager})
12880 The NetworkManager package to use.
12881
12882 @item @code{dns} (default: @code{"default"})
12883 Processing mode for DNS, which affects how NetworkManager uses the
12884 @code{resolv.conf} configuration file.
12885
12886 @table @samp
12887 @item default
12888 NetworkManager will update @code{resolv.conf} to reflect the nameservers
12889 provided by currently active connections.
12890
12891 @item dnsmasq
12892 NetworkManager will run @code{dnsmasq} as a local caching nameserver, using a
12893 @dfn{conditional forwarding} configuration if you are connected to a VPN, and
12894 then update @code{resolv.conf} to point to the local nameserver.
12895
12896 With this setting, you can share your network connection. For example when
12897 you want to share your network connection to another laptop @i{via} an
12898 Ethernet cable, you can open @command{nm-connection-editor} and configure the
12899 Wired connection's method for IPv4 and IPv6 to be ``Shared to other computers''
12900 and reestablish the connection (or reboot).
12901
12902 You can also set up a @dfn{host-to-guest connection} to QEMU VMs
12903 (@pxref{Installing Guix in a VM}). With a host-to-guest connection, you can
12904 e.g.@: access a Web server running on the VM (@pxref{Web Services}) from a Web
12905 browser on your host system, or connect to the VM @i{via} SSH
12906 (@pxref{Networking Services, @code{openssh-service-type}}). To set up a
12907 host-to-guest connection, run this command once:
12908
12909 @example
12910 nmcli connection add type tun \
12911 connection.interface-name tap0 \
12912 tun.mode tap tun.owner $(id -u) \
12913 ipv4.method shared \
12914 ipv4.addresses 172.28.112.1/24
12915 @end example
12916
12917 Then each time you launch your QEMU VM (@pxref{Running Guix in a VM}), pass
12918 @option{-nic tap,ifname=tap0,script=no,downscript=no} to
12919 @command{qemu-system-...}.
12920
12921 @item none
12922 NetworkManager will not modify @code{resolv.conf}.
12923 @end table
12924
12925 @item @code{vpn-plugins} (default: @code{'()})
12926 This is the list of available plugins for virtual private networks
12927 (VPNs). An example of this is the @code{network-manager-openvpn}
12928 package, which allows NetworkManager to manage VPNs @i{via} OpenVPN.
12929
12930 @end table
12931 @end deftp
12932
12933 @cindex Connman
12934 @deffn {Scheme Variable} connman-service-type
12935 This is the service type to run @url{https://01.org/connman,Connman},
12936 a network connection manager.
12937
12938 Its value must be an
12939 @code{connman-configuration} record as in this example:
12940
12941 @lisp
12942 (service connman-service-type
12943 (connman-configuration
12944 (disable-vpn? #t)))
12945 @end lisp
12946
12947 See below for details about @code{connman-configuration}.
12948 @end deffn
12949
12950 @deftp {Data Type} connman-configuration
12951 Data Type representing the configuration of connman.
12952
12953 @table @asis
12954 @item @code{connman} (default: @var{connman})
12955 The connman package to use.
12956
12957 @item @code{disable-vpn?} (default: @code{#f})
12958 When true, disable connman's vpn plugin.
12959 @end table
12960 @end deftp
12961
12962 @cindex WPA Supplicant
12963 @defvr {Scheme Variable} wpa-supplicant-service-type
12964 This is the service type to run @url{https://w1.fi/wpa_supplicant/,WPA
12965 supplicant}, an authentication daemon required to authenticate against
12966 encrypted WiFi or ethernet networks.
12967 @end defvr
12968
12969 @deftp {Data Type} wpa-supplicant-configuration
12970 Data type representing the configuration of WPA Supplicant.
12971
12972 It takes the following parameters:
12973
12974 @table @asis
12975 @item @code{wpa-supplicant} (default: @code{wpa-supplicant})
12976 The WPA Supplicant package to use.
12977
12978 @item @code{dbus?} (default: @code{#t})
12979 Whether to listen for requests on D-Bus.
12980
12981 @item @code{pid-file} (default: @code{"/var/run/wpa_supplicant.pid"})
12982 Where to store the PID file.
12983
12984 @item @code{interface} (default: @code{#f})
12985 If this is set, it must specify the name of a network interface that
12986 WPA supplicant will control.
12987
12988 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{#f})
12989 Optional configuration file to use.
12990
12991 @item @code{extra-options} (default: @code{'()})
12992 List of additional command-line arguments to pass to the daemon.
12993 @end table
12994 @end deftp
12995
12996 @cindex iptables
12997 @defvr {Scheme Variable} iptables-service-type
12998 This is the service type to set up an iptables configuration. iptables is a
12999 packet filtering framework supported by the Linux kernel. This service
13000 supports configuring iptables for both IPv4 and IPv6. A simple example
13001 configuration rejecting all incoming connections except those to the ssh port
13002 22 is shown below.
13003
13004 @lisp
13005 (service iptables-service-type
13006 (iptables-configuration
13007 (ipv4-rules (plain-file "iptables.rules" "*filter
13008 :INPUT ACCEPT
13009 :FORWARD ACCEPT
13010 :OUTPUT ACCEPT
13011 -A INPUT -p tcp --dport 22 -j ACCEPT
13012 -A INPUT -j REJECT --reject-with icmp-port-unreachable
13013 COMMIT
13014 "))
13015 (ipv6-rules (plain-file "ip6tables.rules" "*filter
13016 :INPUT ACCEPT
13017 :FORWARD ACCEPT
13018 :OUTPUT ACCEPT
13019 -A INPUT -p tcp --dport 22 -j ACCEPT
13020 -A INPUT -j REJECT --reject-with icmp6-port-unreachable
13021 COMMIT
13022 "))))
13023 @end lisp
13024 @end defvr
13025
13026 @deftp {Data Type} iptables-configuration
13027 The data type representing the configuration of iptables.
13028
13029 @table @asis
13030 @item @code{iptables} (default: @code{iptables})
13031 The iptables package that provides @code{iptables-restore} and
13032 @code{ip6tables-restore}.
13033 @item @code{ipv4-rules} (default: @code{%iptables-accept-all-rules})
13034 The iptables rules to use. It will be passed to @code{iptables-restore}.
13035 This may be any ``file-like'' object (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like
13036 objects}).
13037 @item @code{ipv6-rules} (default: @code{%iptables-accept-all-rules})
13038 The ip6tables rules to use. It will be passed to @code{ip6tables-restore}.
13039 This may be any ``file-like'' object (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like
13040 objects}).
13041 @end table
13042 @end deftp
13043
13044 @cindex nftables
13045 @defvr {Scheme Variable} nftables-service-type
13046 This is the service type to set up a nftables configuration. nftables is a
13047 netfilter project that aims to replace the existing iptables, ip6tables,
13048 arptables and ebtables framework. It provides a new packet filtering
13049 framework, a new user-space utility @command{nft}, and a compatibility layer
13050 for iptables. This service comes with a default ruleset
13051 @code{%default-nftables-ruleset} that rejecting all incomming connections
13052 except those to the ssh port 22. To use it, simply write:
13053
13054 @lisp
13055 (service nftables-service-type)
13056 @end lisp
13057 @end defvr
13058
13059 @deftp {Data Type} nftables-configuration
13060 The data type representing the configuration of nftables.
13061
13062 @table @asis
13063 @item @code{package} (default: @code{nftables})
13064 The nftables package that provides @command{nft}.
13065 @item @code{ruleset} (default: @code{%default-nftables-ruleset})
13066 The nftables ruleset to use. This may be any ``file-like'' object
13067 (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like objects}).
13068 @end table
13069 @end deftp
13070
13071 @cindex NTP (Network Time Protocol), service
13072 @cindex ntpd, service for the Network Time Protocol daemon
13073 @cindex real time clock
13074 @defvr {Scheme Variable} ntp-service-type
13075 This is the type of the service running the @uref{http://www.ntp.org,
13076 Network Time Protocol (NTP)} daemon, @command{ntpd}. The daemon will keep the
13077 system clock synchronized with that of the specified NTP servers.
13078
13079 The value of this service is an @code{ntpd-configuration} object, as described
13080 below.
13081 @end defvr
13082
13083 @deftp {Data Type} ntp-configuration
13084 This is the data type for the NTP service configuration.
13085
13086 @table @asis
13087 @item @code{servers} (default: @code{%ntp-servers})
13088 This is the list of servers (@code{<ntp-server>} records) with which
13089 @command{ntpd} will be synchronized. See the @code{ntp-server} data type
13090 definition below.
13091
13092 @item @code{allow-large-adjustment?} (default: @code{#t})
13093 This determines whether @command{ntpd} is allowed to make an initial
13094 adjustment of more than 1,000 seconds.
13095
13096 @item @code{ntp} (default: @code{ntp})
13097 The NTP package to use.
13098 @end table
13099 @end deftp
13100
13101 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %ntp-servers
13102 List of host names used as the default NTP servers. These are servers of the
13103 @uref{https://www.ntppool.org/en/, NTP Pool Project}.
13104 @end defvr
13105
13106 @deftp {Data Type} ntp-server
13107 The data type representing the configuration of a NTP server.
13108
13109 @table @asis
13110 @item @code{type} (default: @code{'server})
13111 The type of the NTP server, given as a symbol. One of @code{'pool},
13112 @code{'server}, @code{'peer}, @code{'broadcast} or @code{'manycastclient}.
13113
13114 @item @code{address}
13115 The address of the server, as a string.
13116
13117 @item @code{options}
13118 NTPD options to use with that specific server, given as a list of option names
13119 and/or of option names and values tuples. The following example define a server
13120 to use with the options @option{iburst} and @option{prefer}, as well as
13121 @option{version} 3 and a @option{maxpoll} time of 16 seconds.
13122
13123 @example
13124 (ntp-server
13125 (type 'server)
13126 (address "some.ntp.server.org")
13127 (options `(iburst (version 3) (maxpoll 16) prefer))))
13128 @end example
13129 @end table
13130 @end deftp
13131
13132 @cindex OpenNTPD
13133 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} openntpd-service-type
13134 Run the @command{ntpd}, the Network Time Protocol (NTP) daemon, as implemented
13135 by @uref{http://www.openntpd.org, OpenNTPD}. The daemon will keep the system
13136 clock synchronized with that of the given servers.
13137
13138 @lisp
13139 (service
13140 openntpd-service-type
13141 (openntpd-configuration
13142 (listen-on '("127.0.0.1" "::1"))
13143 (sensor '("udcf0 correction 70000"))
13144 (constraint-from '("www.gnu.org"))
13145 (constraints-from '("https://www.google.com/"))
13146 (allow-large-adjustment? #t)))
13147
13148 @end lisp
13149 @end deffn
13150
13151 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %openntpd-servers
13152 This variable is a list of the server addresses defined in
13153 @var{%ntp-servers}.
13154 @end defvr
13155
13156 @deftp {Data Type} openntpd-configuration
13157 @table @asis
13158 @item @code{openntpd} (default: @code{(file-append openntpd "/sbin/ntpd")})
13159 The openntpd executable to use.
13160 @item @code{listen-on} (default: @code{'("127.0.0.1" "::1")})
13161 A list of local IP addresses or hostnames the ntpd daemon should listen on.
13162 @item @code{query-from} (default: @code{'()})
13163 A list of local IP address the ntpd daemon should use for outgoing queries.
13164 @item @code{sensor} (default: @code{'()})
13165 Specify a list of timedelta sensor devices ntpd should use. @code{ntpd}
13166 will listen to each sensor that actually exists and ignore non-existent ones.
13167 See @uref{https://man.openbsd.org/ntpd.conf, upstream documentation} for more
13168 information.
13169 @item @code{server} (default: @code{'()})
13170 Specify a list of IP addresses or hostnames of NTP servers to synchronize to.
13171 @item @code{servers} (default: @var{%openntp-servers})
13172 Specify a list of IP addresses or hostnames of NTP pools to synchronize to.
13173 @item @code{constraint-from} (default: @code{'()})
13174 @code{ntpd} can be configured to query the ‘Date’ from trusted HTTPS servers via TLS.
13175 This time information is not used for precision but acts as an authenticated
13176 constraint, thereby reducing the impact of unauthenticated NTP
13177 man-in-the-middle attacks.
13178 Specify a list of URLs, IP addresses or hostnames of HTTPS servers to provide
13179 a constraint.
13180 @item @code{constraints-from} (default: @code{'()})
13181 As with constraint from, specify a list of URLs, IP addresses or hostnames of
13182 HTTPS servers to provide a constraint. Should the hostname resolve to multiple
13183 IP addresses, @code{ntpd} will calculate a median constraint from all of them.
13184 @item @code{allow-large-adjustment?} (default: @code{#f})
13185 Determines if @code{ntpd} is allowed to make an initial adjustment of more
13186 than 180 seconds.
13187 @end table
13188 @end deftp
13189
13190 @cindex inetd
13191 @deffn {Scheme variable} inetd-service-type
13192 This service runs the @command{inetd} (@pxref{inetd invocation,,,
13193 inetutils, GNU Inetutils}) daemon. @command{inetd} listens for
13194 connections on internet sockets, and lazily starts the specified server
13195 program when a connection is made on one of these sockets.
13196
13197 The value of this service is an @code{inetd-configuration} object. The
13198 following example configures the @command{inetd} daemon to provide the
13199 built-in @command{echo} service, as well as an smtp service which
13200 forwards smtp traffic over ssh to a server @code{smtp-server} behind a
13201 gateway @code{hostname}:
13202
13203 @lisp
13204 (service
13205 inetd-service-type
13206 (inetd-configuration
13207 (entries (list
13208 (inetd-entry
13209 (name "echo")
13210 (socket-type 'stream)
13211 (protocol "tcp")
13212 (wait? #f)
13213 (user "root"))
13214 (inetd-entry
13215 (node "127.0.0.1")
13216 (name "smtp")
13217 (socket-type 'stream)
13218 (protocol "tcp")
13219 (wait? #f)
13220 (user "root")
13221 (program (file-append openssh "/bin/ssh"))
13222 (arguments
13223 '("ssh" "-qT" "-i" "/path/to/ssh_key"
13224 "-W" "smtp-server:25" "user@@hostname")))))
13225 @end lisp
13226
13227 See below for more details about @code{inetd-configuration}.
13228 @end deffn
13229
13230 @deftp {Data Type} inetd-configuration
13231 Data type representing the configuration of @command{inetd}.
13232
13233 @table @asis
13234 @item @code{program} (default: @code{(file-append inetutils "/libexec/inetd")})
13235 The @command{inetd} executable to use.
13236
13237 @item @code{entries} (default: @code{'()})
13238 A list of @command{inetd} service entries. Each entry should be created
13239 by the @code{inetd-entry} constructor.
13240 @end table
13241 @end deftp
13242
13243 @deftp {Data Type} inetd-entry
13244 Data type representing an entry in the @command{inetd} configuration.
13245 Each entry corresponds to a socket where @command{inetd} will listen for
13246 requests.
13247
13248 @table @asis
13249 @item @code{node} (default: @code{#f})
13250 Optional string, a comma-separated list of local addresses
13251 @command{inetd} should use when listening for this service.
13252 @xref{Configuration file,,, inetutils, GNU Inetutils} for a complete
13253 description of all options.
13254 @item @code{name}
13255 A string, the name must correspond to an entry in @code{/etc/services}.
13256 @item @code{socket-type}
13257 One of @code{'stream}, @code{'dgram}, @code{'raw}, @code{'rdm} or
13258 @code{'seqpacket}.
13259 @item @code{protocol}
13260 A string, must correspond to an entry in @code{/etc/protocols}.
13261 @item @code{wait?} (default: @code{#t})
13262 Whether @command{inetd} should wait for the server to exit before
13263 listening to new service requests.
13264 @item @code{user}
13265 A string containing the user (and, optionally, group) name of the user
13266 as whom the server should run. The group name can be specified in a
13267 suffix, separated by a colon or period, i.e.@: @code{"user"},
13268 @code{"user:group"} or @code{"user.group"}.
13269 @item @code{program} (default: @code{"internal"})
13270 The server program which will serve the requests, or @code{"internal"}
13271 if @command{inetd} should use a built-in service.
13272 @item @code{arguments} (default: @code{'()})
13273 A list strings or file-like objects, which are the server program's
13274 arguments, starting with the zeroth argument, i.e.@: the name of the
13275 program itself. For @command{inetd}'s internal services, this entry
13276 must be @code{'()} or @code{'("internal")}.
13277 @end table
13278
13279 @xref{Configuration file,,, inetutils, GNU Inetutils} for a more
13280 detailed discussion of each configuration field.
13281 @end deftp
13282
13283 @cindex Tor
13284 @defvr {Scheme Variable} tor-service-type
13285 This is the type for a service that runs the @uref{https://torproject.org,
13286 Tor} anonymous networking daemon. The service is configured using a
13287 @code{<tor-configuration>} record. By default, the Tor daemon runs as the
13288 @code{tor} unprivileged user, which is a member of the @code{tor} group.
13289
13290 @end defvr
13291
13292 @deftp {Data Type} tor-configuration
13293 @table @asis
13294 @item @code{tor} (default: @code{tor})
13295 The package that provides the Tor daemon. This package is expected to provide
13296 the daemon at @file{bin/tor} relative to its output directory. The default
13297 package is the @uref{https://www.torproject.org, Tor Project's}
13298 implementation.
13299
13300 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{(plain-file "empty" "")})
13301 The configuration file to use. It will be appended to a default configuration
13302 file, and the final configuration file will be passed to @code{tor} via its
13303 @code{-f} option. This may be any ``file-like'' object (@pxref{G-Expressions,
13304 file-like objects}). See @code{man tor} for details on the configuration file
13305 syntax.
13306
13307 @item @code{hidden-services} (default: @code{'()})
13308 The list of @code{<hidden-service>} records to use. For any hidden service
13309 you include in this list, appropriate configuration to enable the hidden
13310 service will be automatically added to the default configuration file. You
13311 may conveniently create @code{<hidden-service>} records using the
13312 @code{tor-hidden-service} procedure described below.
13313
13314 @item @code{socks-socket-type} (default: @code{'tcp})
13315 The default socket type that Tor should use for its SOCKS socket. This must
13316 be either @code{'tcp} or @code{'unix}. If it is @code{'tcp}, then by default
13317 Tor will listen on TCP port 9050 on the loopback interface (i.e., localhost).
13318 If it is @code{'unix}, then Tor will listen on the UNIX domain socket
13319 @file{/var/run/tor/socks-sock}, which will be made writable by members of the
13320 @code{tor} group.
13321
13322 If you want to customize the SOCKS socket in more detail, leave
13323 @code{socks-socket-type} at its default value of @code{'tcp} and use
13324 @code{config-file} to override the default by providing your own
13325 @code{SocksPort} option.
13326 @end table
13327 @end deftp
13328
13329 @cindex hidden service
13330 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} tor-hidden-service @var{name} @var{mapping}
13331 Define a new Tor @dfn{hidden service} called @var{name} and implementing
13332 @var{mapping}. @var{mapping} is a list of port/host tuples, such as:
13333
13334 @example
13335 '((22 "127.0.0.1:22")
13336 (80 "127.0.0.1:8080"))
13337 @end example
13338
13339 In this example, port 22 of the hidden service is mapped to local port 22, and
13340 port 80 is mapped to local port 8080.
13341
13342 This creates a @file{/var/lib/tor/hidden-services/@var{name}} directory, where
13343 the @file{hostname} file contains the @code{.onion} host name for the hidden
13344 service.
13345
13346 See @uref{https://www.torproject.org/docs/tor-hidden-service.html.en, the Tor
13347 project's documentation} for more information.
13348 @end deffn
13349
13350 The @code{(gnu services rsync)} module provides the following services:
13351
13352 You might want an rsync daemon if you have files that you want available
13353 so anyone (or just yourself) can download existing files or upload new
13354 files.
13355
13356 @deffn {Scheme Variable} rsync-service-type
13357 This is the service type for the @uref{https://rsync.samba.org, rsync} daemon,
13358 The value for this service type is a
13359 @command{rsync-configuration} record as in this example:
13360
13361 @lisp
13362 (service rsync-service-type)
13363 @end lisp
13364
13365 See below for details about @code{rsync-configuration}.
13366 @end deffn
13367
13368 @deftp {Data Type} rsync-configuration
13369 Data type representing the configuration for @code{rsync-service}.
13370
13371 @table @asis
13372 @item @code{package} (default: @var{rsync})
13373 @code{rsync} package to use.
13374
13375 @item @code{port-number} (default: @code{873})
13376 TCP port on which @command{rsync} listens for incoming connections. If port
13377 is less than @code{1024} @command{rsync} needs to be started as the
13378 @code{root} user and group.
13379
13380 @item @code{pid-file} (default: @code{"/var/run/rsyncd/rsyncd.pid"})
13381 Name of the file where @command{rsync} writes its PID.
13382
13383 @item @code{lock-file} (default: @code{"/var/run/rsyncd/rsyncd.lock"})
13384 Name of the file where @command{rsync} writes its lock file.
13385
13386 @item @code{log-file} (default: @code{"/var/log/rsyncd.log"})
13387 Name of the file where @command{rsync} writes its log file.
13388
13389 @item @code{use-chroot?} (default: @var{#t})
13390 Whether to use chroot for @command{rsync} shared directory.
13391
13392 @item @code{share-path} (default: @file{/srv/rsync})
13393 Location of the @command{rsync} shared directory.
13394
13395 @item @code{share-comment} (default: @code{"Rsync share"})
13396 Comment of the @command{rsync} shared directory.
13397
13398 @item @code{read-only?} (default: @var{#f})
13399 Read-write permissions to shared directory.
13400
13401 @item @code{timeout} (default: @code{300})
13402 I/O timeout in seconds.
13403
13404 @item @code{user} (default: @var{"root"})
13405 Owner of the @code{rsync} process.
13406
13407 @item @code{group} (default: @var{"root"})
13408 Group of the @code{rsync} process.
13409
13410 @item @code{uid} (default: @var{"rsyncd"})
13411 User name or user ID that file transfers to and from that module should take
13412 place as when the daemon was run as @code{root}.
13413
13414 @item @code{gid} (default: @var{"rsyncd"})
13415 Group name or group ID that will be used when accessing the module.
13416
13417 @end table
13418 @end deftp
13419
13420 Furthermore, @code{(gnu services ssh)} provides the following services.
13421 @cindex SSH
13422 @cindex SSH server
13423
13424 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} lsh-service [#:host-key "/etc/lsh/host-key"] @
13425 [#:daemonic? #t] [#:interfaces '()] [#:port-number 22] @
13426 [#:allow-empty-passwords? #f] [#:root-login? #f] @
13427 [#:syslog-output? #t] [#:x11-forwarding? #t] @
13428 [#:tcp/ip-forwarding? #t] [#:password-authentication? #t] @
13429 [#:public-key-authentication? #t] [#:initialize? #t]
13430 Run the @command{lshd} program from @var{lsh} to listen on port @var{port-number}.
13431 @var{host-key} must designate a file containing the host key, and readable
13432 only by root.
13433
13434 When @var{daemonic?} is true, @command{lshd} will detach from the
13435 controlling terminal and log its output to syslogd, unless one sets
13436 @var{syslog-output?} to false. Obviously, it also makes lsh-service
13437 depend on existence of syslogd service. When @var{pid-file?} is true,
13438 @command{lshd} writes its PID to the file called @var{pid-file}.
13439
13440 When @var{initialize?} is true, automatically create the seed and host key
13441 upon service activation if they do not exist yet. This may take long and
13442 require interaction.
13443
13444 When @var{initialize?} is false, it is up to the user to initialize the
13445 randomness generator (@pxref{lsh-make-seed,,, lsh, LSH Manual}), and to create
13446 a key pair with the private key stored in file @var{host-key} (@pxref{lshd
13447 basics,,, lsh, LSH Manual}).
13448
13449 When @var{interfaces} is empty, lshd listens for connections on all the
13450 network interfaces; otherwise, @var{interfaces} must be a list of host names
13451 or addresses.
13452
13453 @var{allow-empty-passwords?} specifies whether to accept log-ins with empty
13454 passwords, and @var{root-login?} specifies whether to accept log-ins as
13455 root.
13456
13457 The other options should be self-descriptive.
13458 @end deffn
13459
13460 @cindex SSH
13461 @cindex SSH server
13462 @deffn {Scheme Variable} openssh-service-type
13463 This is the type for the @uref{http://www.openssh.org, OpenSSH} secure
13464 shell daemon, @command{sshd}. Its value must be an
13465 @code{openssh-configuration} record as in this example:
13466
13467 @lisp
13468 (service openssh-service-type
13469 (openssh-configuration
13470 (x11-forwarding? #t)
13471 (permit-root-login 'without-password)
13472 (authorized-keys
13473 `(("alice" ,(local-file "alice.pub"))
13474 ("bob" ,(local-file "bob.pub"))))))
13475 @end lisp
13476
13477 See below for details about @code{openssh-configuration}.
13478
13479 This service can be extended with extra authorized keys, as in this
13480 example:
13481
13482 @lisp
13483 (service-extension openssh-service-type
13484 (const `(("charlie"
13485 ,(local-file "charlie.pub")))))
13486 @end lisp
13487 @end deffn
13488
13489 @deftp {Data Type} openssh-configuration
13490 This is the configuration record for OpenSSH's @command{sshd}.
13491
13492 @table @asis
13493 @item @code{pid-file} (default: @code{"/var/run/sshd.pid"})
13494 Name of the file where @command{sshd} writes its PID.
13495
13496 @item @code{port-number} (default: @code{22})
13497 TCP port on which @command{sshd} listens for incoming connections.
13498
13499 @item @code{permit-root-login} (default: @code{#f})
13500 This field determines whether and when to allow logins as root. If
13501 @code{#f}, root logins are disallowed; if @code{#t}, they are allowed.
13502 If it's the symbol @code{'without-password}, then root logins are
13503 permitted but not with password-based authentication.
13504
13505 @item @code{allow-empty-passwords?} (default: @code{#f})
13506 When true, users with empty passwords may log in. When false, they may
13507 not.
13508
13509 @item @code{password-authentication?} (default: @code{#t})
13510 When true, users may log in with their password. When false, they have
13511 other authentication methods.
13512
13513 @item @code{public-key-authentication?} (default: @code{#t})
13514 When true, users may log in using public key authentication. When
13515 false, users have to use other authentication method.
13516
13517 Authorized public keys are stored in @file{~/.ssh/authorized_keys}.
13518 This is used only by protocol version 2.
13519
13520 @item @code{x11-forwarding?} (default: @code{#f})
13521 When true, forwarding of X11 graphical client connections is
13522 enabled---in other words, @command{ssh} options @option{-X} and
13523 @option{-Y} will work.
13524
13525 @item @code{allow-agent-forwarding?} (default: @code{#t})
13526 Whether to allow agent forwarding.
13527
13528 @item @code{allow-tcp-forwarding?} (default: @code{#t})
13529 Whether to allow TCP forwarding.
13530
13531 @item @code{gateway-ports?} (default: @code{#f})
13532 Whether to allow gateway ports.
13533
13534 @item @code{challenge-response-authentication?} (default: @code{#f})
13535 Specifies whether challenge response authentication is allowed (e.g.@: via
13536 PAM).
13537
13538 @item @code{use-pam?} (default: @code{#t})
13539 Enables the Pluggable Authentication Module interface. If set to
13540 @code{#t}, this will enable PAM authentication using
13541 @code{challenge-response-authentication?} and
13542 @code{password-authentication?}, in addition to PAM account and session
13543 module processing for all authentication types.
13544
13545 Because PAM challenge response authentication usually serves an
13546 equivalent role to password authentication, you should disable either
13547 @code{challenge-response-authentication?} or
13548 @code{password-authentication?}.
13549
13550 @item @code{print-last-log?} (default: @code{#t})
13551 Specifies whether @command{sshd} should print the date and time of the
13552 last user login when a user logs in interactively.
13553
13554 @item @code{subsystems} (default: @code{'(("sftp" "internal-sftp"))})
13555 Configures external subsystems (e.g.@: file transfer daemon).
13556
13557 This is a list of two-element lists, each of which containing the
13558 subsystem name and a command (with optional arguments) to execute upon
13559 subsystem request.
13560
13561 The command @command{internal-sftp} implements an in-process SFTP
13562 server. Alternately, one can specify the @command{sftp-server} command:
13563 @lisp
13564 (service openssh-service-type
13565 (openssh-configuration
13566 (subsystems
13567 `(("sftp" ,(file-append openssh "/libexec/sftp-server"))))))
13568 @end lisp
13569
13570 @item @code{accepted-environment} (default: @code{'()})
13571 List of strings describing which environment variables may be exported.
13572
13573 Each string gets on its own line. See the @code{AcceptEnv} option in
13574 @code{man sshd_config}.
13575
13576 This example allows ssh-clients to export the @code{COLORTERM} variable.
13577 It is set by terminal emulators, which support colors. You can use it in
13578 your shell's ressource file to enable colors for the prompt and commands
13579 if this variable is set.
13580
13581 @lisp
13582 (service openssh-service-type
13583 (openssh-configuration
13584 (accepted-environment '("COLORTERM"))))
13585 @end lisp
13586
13587 @item @code{authorized-keys} (default: @code{'()})
13588 @cindex authorized keys, SSH
13589 @cindex SSH authorized keys
13590 This is the list of authorized keys. Each element of the list is a user
13591 name followed by one or more file-like objects that represent SSH public
13592 keys. For example:
13593
13594 @lisp
13595 (openssh-configuration
13596 (authorized-keys
13597 `(("rekado" ,(local-file "rekado.pub"))
13598 ("chris" ,(local-file "chris.pub"))
13599 ("root" ,(local-file "rekado.pub") ,(local-file "chris.pub")))))
13600 @end lisp
13601
13602 @noindent
13603 registers the specified public keys for user accounts @code{rekado},
13604 @code{chris}, and @code{root}.
13605
13606 Additional authorized keys can be specified @i{via}
13607 @code{service-extension}.
13608
13609 Note that this does @emph{not} interfere with the use of
13610 @file{~/.ssh/authorized_keys}.
13611
13612 @item @code{log-level} (default: @code{'info})
13613 This is a symbol specifying the logging level: @code{quiet}, @code{fatal},
13614 @code{error}, @code{info}, @code{verbose}, @code{debug}, etc. See the man
13615 page for @file{sshd_config} for the full list of level names.
13616
13617 @item @code{extra-content} (default: @code{""})
13618 This field can be used to append arbitrary text to the configuration file. It
13619 is especially useful for elaborate configurations that cannot be expressed
13620 otherwise. This configuration, for example, would generally disable root
13621 logins, but permit them from one specific IP address:
13622
13623 @lisp
13624 (openssh-configuration
13625 (extra-content "\
13626 Match Address 192.168.0.1
13627 PermitRootLogin yes"))
13628 @end lisp
13629
13630 @end table
13631 @end deftp
13632
13633 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} dropbear-service [@var{config}]
13634 Run the @uref{https://matt.ucc.asn.au/dropbear/dropbear.html,Dropbear SSH
13635 daemon} with the given @var{config}, a @code{<dropbear-configuration>}
13636 object.
13637
13638 For example, to specify a Dropbear service listening on port 1234, add
13639 this call to the operating system's @code{services} field:
13640
13641 @lisp
13642 (dropbear-service (dropbear-configuration
13643 (port-number 1234)))
13644 @end lisp
13645 @end deffn
13646
13647 @deftp {Data Type} dropbear-configuration
13648 This data type represents the configuration of a Dropbear SSH daemon.
13649
13650 @table @asis
13651 @item @code{dropbear} (default: @var{dropbear})
13652 The Dropbear package to use.
13653
13654 @item @code{port-number} (default: 22)
13655 The TCP port where the daemon waits for incoming connections.
13656
13657 @item @code{syslog-output?} (default: @code{#t})
13658 Whether to enable syslog output.
13659
13660 @item @code{pid-file} (default: @code{"/var/run/dropbear.pid"})
13661 File name of the daemon's PID file.
13662
13663 @item @code{root-login?} (default: @code{#f})
13664 Whether to allow @code{root} logins.
13665
13666 @item @code{allow-empty-passwords?} (default: @code{#f})
13667 Whether to allow empty passwords.
13668
13669 @item @code{password-authentication?} (default: @code{#t})
13670 Whether to enable password-based authentication.
13671 @end table
13672 @end deftp
13673
13674 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %facebook-host-aliases
13675 This variable contains a string for use in @file{/etc/hosts}
13676 (@pxref{Host Names,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}). Each
13677 line contains a entry that maps a known server name of the Facebook
13678 on-line service---e.g., @code{www.facebook.com}---to the local
13679 host---@code{127.0.0.1} or its IPv6 equivalent, @code{::1}.
13680
13681 This variable is typically used in the @code{hosts-file} field of an
13682 @code{operating-system} declaration (@pxref{operating-system Reference,
13683 @file{/etc/hosts}}):
13684
13685 @lisp
13686 (use-modules (gnu) (guix))
13687
13688 (operating-system
13689 (host-name "mymachine")
13690 ;; ...
13691 (hosts-file
13692 ;; Create a /etc/hosts file with aliases for "localhost"
13693 ;; and "mymachine", as well as for Facebook servers.
13694 (plain-file "hosts"
13695 (string-append (local-host-aliases host-name)
13696 %facebook-host-aliases))))
13697 @end lisp
13698
13699 This mechanism can prevent programs running locally, such as Web
13700 browsers, from accessing Facebook.
13701 @end defvr
13702
13703 The @code{(gnu services avahi)} provides the following definition.
13704
13705 @defvr {Scheme Variable} avahi-service-type
13706 This is the service that runs @command{avahi-daemon}, a system-wide
13707 mDNS/DNS-SD responder that allows for service discovery and
13708 ``zero-configuration'' host name lookups (see @uref{https://avahi.org/}).
13709 Its value must be a @code{zero-configuration} record---see below.
13710
13711 This service extends the name service cache daemon (nscd) so that it can
13712 resolve @code{.local} host names using
13713 @uref{http://0pointer.de/lennart/projects/nss-mdns/, nss-mdns}. @xref{Name
13714 Service Switch}, for information on host name resolution.
13715
13716 Additionally, add the @var{avahi} package to the system profile so that
13717 commands such as @command{avahi-browse} are directly usable.
13718 @end defvr
13719
13720 @deftp {Data Type} avahi-configuration
13721 Data type representation the configuration for Avahi.
13722
13723 @table @asis
13724
13725 @item @code{host-name} (default: @code{#f})
13726 If different from @code{#f}, use that as the host name to
13727 publish for this machine; otherwise, use the machine's actual host name.
13728
13729 @item @code{publish?} (default: @code{#t})
13730 When true, allow host names and services to be published (broadcast) over the
13731 network.
13732
13733 @item @code{publish-workstation?} (default: @code{#t})
13734 When true, @command{avahi-daemon} publishes the machine's host name and IP
13735 address via mDNS on the local network. To view the host names published on
13736 your local network, you can run:
13737
13738 @example
13739 avahi-browse _workstation._tcp
13740 @end example
13741
13742 @item @code{wide-area?} (default: @code{#f})
13743 When true, DNS-SD over unicast DNS is enabled.
13744
13745 @item @code{ipv4?} (default: @code{#t})
13746 @itemx @code{ipv6?} (default: @code{#t})
13747 These fields determine whether to use IPv4/IPv6 sockets.
13748
13749 @item @code{domains-to-browse} (default: @code{'()})
13750 This is a list of domains to browse.
13751 @end table
13752 @end deftp
13753
13754 @deffn {Scheme Variable} openvswitch-service-type
13755 This is the type of the @uref{https://www.openvswitch.org, Open vSwitch}
13756 service, whose value should be an @code{openvswitch-configuration}
13757 object.
13758 @end deffn
13759
13760 @deftp {Data Type} openvswitch-configuration
13761 Data type representing the configuration of Open vSwitch, a multilayer
13762 virtual switch which is designed to enable massive network automation
13763 through programmatic extension.
13764
13765 @table @asis
13766 @item @code{package} (default: @var{openvswitch})
13767 Package object of the Open vSwitch.
13768
13769 @end table
13770 @end deftp
13771
13772 @node X Window
13773 @subsection X Window
13774
13775 @cindex X11
13776 @cindex X Window System
13777 @cindex login manager
13778 Support for the X Window graphical display system---specifically
13779 Xorg---is provided by the @code{(gnu services xorg)} module. Note that
13780 there is no @code{xorg-service} procedure. Instead, the X server is
13781 started by the @dfn{login manager}, by default the GNOME Display Manager (GDM).
13782
13783 @cindex GDM
13784 @cindex GNOME, login manager
13785 GDM of course allows users to log in into window managers and desktop
13786 environments other than GNOME; for those using GNOME, GDM is required for
13787 features such as automatic screen locking.
13788
13789 @cindex window manager
13790 To use X11, you must install at least one @dfn{window manager}---for
13791 example the @code{windowmaker} or @code{openbox} packages---preferably
13792 by adding it to the @code{packages} field of your operating system
13793 definition (@pxref{operating-system Reference, system-wide packages}).
13794
13795 @defvr {Scheme Variable} gdm-service-type
13796 This is the type for the @uref{https://wiki.gnome.org/Projects/GDM/, GNOME
13797 Desktop Manager} (GDM), a program that manages graphical display servers and
13798 handles graphical user logins. Its value must be a @code{gdm-configuration}
13799 (see below.)
13800
13801 @cindex session types (X11)
13802 @cindex X11 session types
13803 GDM looks for @dfn{session types} described by the @file{.desktop} files in
13804 @file{/run/current-system/profile/share/xsessions} and allows users to choose
13805 a session from the log-in screen. Packages such as @code{gnome}, @code{xfce},
13806 and @code{i3} provide @file{.desktop} files; adding them to the system-wide
13807 set of packages automatically makes them available at the log-in screen.
13808
13809 In addition, @file{~/.xsession} files are honored. When available,
13810 @file{~/.xsession} must be an executable that starts a window manager
13811 and/or other X clients.
13812 @end defvr
13813
13814 @deftp {Data Type} gdm-configuration
13815 @table @asis
13816 @item @code{auto-login?} (default: @code{#f})
13817 @itemx @code{default-user} (default: @code{#f})
13818 When @code{auto-login?} is false, GDM presents a log-in screen.
13819
13820 When @code{auto-login?} is true, GDM logs in directly as
13821 @code{default-user}.
13822
13823 @item @code{gnome-shell-assets} (default: ...)
13824 List of GNOME Shell assets needed by GDM: icon theme, fonts, etc.
13825
13826 @item @code{xorg-configuration} (default: @code{(xorg-configuration)})
13827 Configuration of the Xorg graphical server.
13828
13829 @item @code{xsession} (default: @code{(xinitrc)})
13830 Script to run before starting a X session.
13831
13832 @item @code{dbus-daemon} (default: @code{dbus-daemon-wrapper})
13833 File name of the @code{dbus-daemon} executable.
13834
13835 @item @code{gdm} (default: @code{gdm})
13836 The GDM package to use.
13837 @end table
13838 @end deftp
13839
13840 @defvr {Scheme Variable} slim-service-type
13841 This is the type for the SLiM graphical login manager for X11.
13842
13843 Like GDM, SLiM looks for session types described by @file{.desktop} files and
13844 allows users to choose a session from the log-in screen using @kbd{F1}. It
13845 also honors @file{~/.xsession} files.
13846
13847 Unlike GDM, SLiM does not spawn the user session on a different VT after
13848 logging in, which means that you can only start one graphical session. If you
13849 want to be able to run multiple graphical sessions at the same time you have
13850 to add multiple SLiM services to your system services. The following example
13851 shows how to replace the default GDM service with two SLiM services on tty7
13852 and tty8.
13853
13854 @lisp
13855 (use-modules (gnu services)
13856 (gnu services desktop)
13857 (gnu services xorg)
13858 (srfi srfi-1)) ;for 'remove'
13859
13860 (operating-system
13861 ;; ...
13862 (services (cons* (service slim-service-type (slim-configuration
13863 (display ":0")
13864 (vt "vt7")))
13865 (service slim-service-type (slim-configuration
13866 (display ":1")
13867 (vt "vt8")))
13868 (remove (lambda (service)
13869 (eq? (service-kind service) gdm-service-type))
13870 %desktop-services))))
13871 @end lisp
13872
13873 @end defvr
13874
13875 @deftp {Data Type} slim-configuration
13876 Data type representing the configuration of @code{slim-service-type}.
13877
13878 @table @asis
13879 @item @code{allow-empty-passwords?} (default: @code{#t})
13880 Whether to allow logins with empty passwords.
13881
13882 @item @code{auto-login?} (default: @code{#f})
13883 @itemx @code{default-user} (default: @code{""})
13884 When @code{auto-login?} is false, SLiM presents a log-in screen.
13885
13886 When @code{auto-login?} is true, SLiM logs in directly as
13887 @code{default-user}.
13888
13889 @item @code{theme} (default: @code{%default-slim-theme})
13890 @itemx @code{theme-name} (default: @code{%default-slim-theme-name})
13891 The graphical theme to use and its name.
13892
13893 @item @code{auto-login-session} (default: @code{#f})
13894 If true, this must be the name of the executable to start as the default
13895 session---e.g., @code{(file-append windowmaker "/bin/windowmaker")}.
13896
13897 If false, a session described by one of the available @file{.desktop}
13898 files in @code{/run/current-system/profile} and @code{~/.guix-profile}
13899 will be used.
13900
13901 @quotation Note
13902 You must install at least one window manager in the system profile or in
13903 your user profile. Failing to do that, if @code{auto-login-session} is
13904 false, you will be unable to log in.
13905 @end quotation
13906
13907 @item @code{xorg-configuration} (default @code{(xorg-configuration)})
13908 Configuration of the Xorg graphical server.
13909
13910 @item @code{display} (default @code{":0"})
13911 The display on which to start the Xorg graphical server.
13912
13913 @item @code{vt} (default @code{"vt7"})
13914 The VT on which to start the Xorg graphical server.
13915
13916 @item @code{xauth} (default: @code{xauth})
13917 The XAuth package to use.
13918
13919 @item @code{shepherd} (default: @code{shepherd})
13920 The Shepherd package used when invoking @command{halt} and
13921 @command{reboot}.
13922
13923 @item @code{sessreg} (default: @code{sessreg})
13924 The sessreg package used in order to register the session.
13925
13926 @item @code{slim} (default: @code{slim})
13927 The SLiM package to use.
13928 @end table
13929 @end deftp
13930
13931 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %default-theme
13932 @defvrx {Scheme Variable} %default-theme-name
13933 The default SLiM theme and its name.
13934 @end defvr
13935
13936
13937 @deftp {Data Type} sddm-configuration
13938 This is the data type representing the sddm service configuration.
13939
13940 @table @asis
13941 @item @code{display-server} (default: "x11")
13942 Select display server to use for the greeter. Valid values are "x11"
13943 or "wayland".
13944
13945 @item @code{numlock} (default: "on")
13946 Valid values are "on", "off" or "none".
13947
13948 @item @code{halt-command} (default @code{#~(string-apppend #$shepherd "/sbin/halt")})
13949 Command to run when halting.
13950
13951 @item @code{reboot-command} (default @code{#~(string-append #$shepherd "/sbin/reboot")})
13952 Command to run when rebooting.
13953
13954 @item @code{theme} (default "maldives")
13955 Theme to use. Default themes provided by SDDM are "elarun" or "maldives".
13956
13957 @item @code{themes-directory} (default "/run/current-system/profile/share/sddm/themes")
13958 Directory to look for themes.
13959
13960 @item @code{faces-directory} (default "/run/current-system/profile/share/sddm/faces")
13961 Directory to look for faces.
13962
13963 @item @code{default-path} (default "/run/current-system/profile/bin")
13964 Default PATH to use.
13965
13966 @item @code{minimum-uid} (default: 1000)
13967 Minimum UID displayed in SDDM and allowed for log-in.
13968
13969 @item @code{maximum-uid} (default: 2000)
13970 Maximum UID to display in SDDM.
13971
13972 @item @code{remember-last-user?} (default #t)
13973 Remember last user.
13974
13975 @item @code{remember-last-session?} (default #t)
13976 Remember last session.
13977
13978 @item @code{hide-users} (default "")
13979 Usernames to hide from SDDM greeter.
13980
13981 @item @code{hide-shells} (default @code{#~(string-append #$shadow "/sbin/nologin")})
13982 Users with shells listed will be hidden from the SDDM greeter.
13983
13984 @item @code{session-command} (default @code{#~(string-append #$sddm "/share/sddm/scripts/wayland-session")})
13985 Script to run before starting a wayland session.
13986
13987 @item @code{sessions-directory} (default "/run/current-system/profile/share/wayland-sessions")
13988 Directory to look for desktop files starting wayland sessions.
13989
13990 @item @code{xorg-configuration} (default @code{(xorg-configuration)})
13991 Configuration of the Xorg graphical server.
13992
13993 @item @code{xauth-path} (default @code{#~(string-append #$xauth "/bin/xauth")})
13994 Path to xauth.
13995
13996 @item @code{xephyr-path} (default @code{#~(string-append #$xorg-server "/bin/Xephyr")})
13997 Path to Xephyr.
13998
13999 @item @code{xdisplay-start} (default @code{#~(string-append #$sddm "/share/sddm/scripts/Xsetup")})
14000 Script to run after starting xorg-server.
14001
14002 @item @code{xdisplay-stop} (default @code{#~(string-append #$sddm "/share/sddm/scripts/Xstop")})
14003 Script to run before stopping xorg-server.
14004
14005 @item @code{xsession-command} (default: @code{xinitrc})
14006 Script to run before starting a X session.
14007
14008 @item @code{xsessions-directory} (default: "/run/current-system/profile/share/xsessions")
14009 Directory to look for desktop files starting X sessions.
14010
14011 @item @code{minimum-vt} (default: 7)
14012 Minimum VT to use.
14013
14014 @item @code{auto-login-user} (default "")
14015 User to use for auto-login.
14016
14017 @item @code{auto-login-session} (default "")
14018 Desktop file to use for auto-login.
14019
14020 @item @code{relogin?} (default #f)
14021 Relogin after logout.
14022
14023 @end table
14024 @end deftp
14025
14026 @cindex login manager
14027 @cindex X11 login
14028 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} sddm-service config
14029 Return a service that spawns the SDDM graphical login manager for config of
14030 type @code{<sddm-configuration>}.
14031
14032 @example
14033 (sddm-service (sddm-configuration
14034 (auto-login-user "Alice")
14035 (auto-login-session "xfce.desktop")))
14036 @end example
14037 @end deffn
14038
14039 @cindex Xorg, configuration
14040 @deftp {Data Type} xorg-configuration
14041 This data type represents the configuration of the Xorg graphical display
14042 server. Note that there is not Xorg service; instead, the X server is started
14043 by a ``display manager'' such as GDM, SDDM, and SLiM. Thus, the configuration
14044 of these display managers aggregates an @code{xorg-configuration} record.
14045
14046 @table @asis
14047 @item @code{modules} (default: @code{%default-xorg-modules})
14048 This is a list of @dfn{module packages} loaded by the Xorg
14049 server---e.g., @code{xf86-video-vesa}, @code{xf86-input-keyboard}, and so on.
14050
14051 @item @code{fonts} (default: @code{%default-xorg-fonts})
14052 This is a list of font directories to add to the server's @dfn{font path}.
14053
14054 @item @code{drivers} (default: @code{'()})
14055 This must be either the empty list, in which case Xorg chooses a graphics
14056 driver automatically, or a list of driver names that will be tried in this
14057 order---e.g., @code{("modesetting" "vesa")}.
14058
14059 @item @code{resolutions} (default: @code{'()})
14060 When @code{resolutions} is the empty list, Xorg chooses an appropriate screen
14061 resolution. Otherwise, it must be a list of resolutions---e.g., @code{((1024
14062 768) (640 480))}.
14063
14064 @cindex keyboard layout, for Xorg
14065 @cindex keymap, for Xorg
14066 @item @code{keyboard-layout} (default: @code{#f})
14067 If this is @code{#f}, Xorg uses the default keyboard layout---usually US
14068 English (``qwerty'') for a 105-key PC keyboard.
14069
14070 Otherwise this must be a @code{keyboard-layout} object specifying the keyboard
14071 layout in use when Xorg is running. @xref{Keyboard Layout}, for more
14072 information on how to specify the keyboard layout.
14073
14074 @item @code{extra-config} (default: @code{'()})
14075 This is a list of strings or objects appended to the configuration file. It
14076 is used to pass extra text to be added verbatim to the configuration file.
14077
14078 @item @code{server} (default: @code{xorg-server})
14079 This is the package providing the Xorg server.
14080
14081 @item @code{server-arguments} (default: @code{%default-xorg-server-arguments})
14082 This is the list of command-line arguments to pass to the X server. The
14083 default is @code{-nolisten tcp}.
14084 @end table
14085 @end deftp
14086
14087 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} set-xorg-configuration @var{config} @
14088 [@var{login-manager-service-type}]
14089 Tell the log-in manager (of type @var{login-manager-service-type}) to use
14090 @var{config}, an @code{<xorg-configuration>} record.
14091
14092 Since the Xorg configuration is embedded in the log-in manager's
14093 configuration---e.g., @code{gdm-configuration}---this procedure provides a
14094 shorthand to set the Xorg configuration.
14095 @end deffn
14096
14097 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} xorg-start-command [@var{config}]
14098 Return a @code{startx} script in which the modules, fonts, etc. specified
14099 in @var{config}, are available. The result should be used in place of
14100 @code{startx}.
14101
14102 Usually the X server is started by a login manager.
14103 @end deffn
14104
14105
14106 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} screen-locker-service @var{package} [@var{program}]
14107 Add @var{package}, a package for a screen locker or screen saver whose
14108 command is @var{program}, to the set of setuid programs and add a PAM entry
14109 for it. For example:
14110
14111 @lisp
14112 (screen-locker-service xlockmore "xlock")
14113 @end lisp
14114
14115 makes the good ol' XlockMore usable.
14116 @end deffn
14117
14118
14119 @node Printing Services
14120 @subsection Printing Services
14121
14122 @cindex printer support with CUPS
14123 The @code{(gnu services cups)} module provides a Guix service definition
14124 for the CUPS printing service. To add printer support to a Guix
14125 system, add a @code{cups-service} to the operating system definition:
14126
14127 @deffn {Scheme Variable} cups-service-type
14128 The service type for the CUPS print server. Its value should be a valid
14129 CUPS configuration (see below). To use the default settings, simply
14130 write:
14131 @lisp
14132 (service cups-service-type)
14133 @end lisp
14134 @end deffn
14135
14136 The CUPS configuration controls the basic things about your CUPS
14137 installation: what interfaces it listens on, what to do if a print job
14138 fails, how much logging to do, and so on. To actually add a printer,
14139 you have to visit the @url{http://localhost:631} URL, or use a tool such
14140 as GNOME's printer configuration services. By default, configuring a
14141 CUPS service will generate a self-signed certificate if needed, for
14142 secure connections to the print server.
14143
14144 Suppose you want to enable the Web interface of CUPS and also add
14145 support for Epson printers @i{via} the @code{escpr} package and for HP
14146 printers @i{via} the @code{hplip-minimal} package. You can do that directly,
14147 like this (you need to use the @code{(gnu packages cups)} module):
14148
14149 @lisp
14150 (service cups-service-type
14151 (cups-configuration
14152 (web-interface? #t)
14153 (extensions
14154 (list cups-filters escpr hplip-minimal))))
14155 @end lisp
14156
14157 Note: If you wish to use the Qt5 based GUI which comes with the hplip
14158 package then it is suggested that you install the @code{hplip} package,
14159 either in your OS configuration file or as your user.
14160
14161 The available configuration parameters follow. Each parameter
14162 definition is preceded by its type; for example, @samp{string-list foo}
14163 indicates that the @code{foo} parameter should be specified as a list of
14164 strings. There is also a way to specify the configuration as a string,
14165 if you have an old @code{cupsd.conf} file that you want to port over
14166 from some other system; see the end for more details.
14167
14168 @c The following documentation was initially generated by
14169 @c (generate-documentation) in (gnu services cups). Manually maintained
14170 @c documentation is better, so we shouldn't hesitate to edit below as
14171 @c needed. However if the change you want to make to this documentation
14172 @c can be done in an automated way, it's probably easier to change
14173 @c (generate-documentation) than to make it below and have to deal with
14174 @c the churn as CUPS updates.
14175
14176
14177 Available @code{cups-configuration} fields are:
14178
14179 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} package cups
14180 The CUPS package.
14181 @end deftypevr
14182
14183 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} package-list extensions
14184 Drivers and other extensions to the CUPS package.
14185 @end deftypevr
14186
14187 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} files-configuration files-configuration
14188 Configuration of where to write logs, what directories to use for print
14189 spools, and related privileged configuration parameters.
14190
14191 Available @code{files-configuration} fields are:
14192
14193 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} log-location access-log
14194 Defines the access log filename. Specifying a blank filename disables
14195 access log generation. The value @code{stderr} causes log entries to be
14196 sent to the standard error file when the scheduler is running in the
14197 foreground, or to the system log daemon when run in the background. The
14198 value @code{syslog} causes log entries to be sent to the system log
14199 daemon. The server name may be included in filenames using the string
14200 @code{%s}, as in @code{/var/log/cups/%s-access_log}.
14201
14202 Defaults to @samp{"/var/log/cups/access_log"}.
14203 @end deftypevr
14204
14205 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} file-name cache-dir
14206 Where CUPS should cache data.
14207
14208 Defaults to @samp{"/var/cache/cups"}.
14209 @end deftypevr
14210
14211 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} string config-file-perm
14212 Specifies the permissions for all configuration files that the scheduler
14213 writes.
14214
14215 Note that the permissions for the printers.conf file are currently
14216 masked to only allow access from the scheduler user (typically root).
14217 This is done because printer device URIs sometimes contain sensitive
14218 authentication information that should not be generally known on the
14219 system. There is no way to disable this security feature.
14220
14221 Defaults to @samp{"0640"}.
14222 @end deftypevr
14223
14224 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} log-location error-log
14225 Defines the error log filename. Specifying a blank filename disables
14226 error log generation. The value @code{stderr} causes log entries to be
14227 sent to the standard error file when the scheduler is running in the
14228 foreground, or to the system log daemon when run in the background. The
14229 value @code{syslog} causes log entries to be sent to the system log
14230 daemon. The server name may be included in filenames using the string
14231 @code{%s}, as in @code{/var/log/cups/%s-error_log}.
14232
14233 Defaults to @samp{"/var/log/cups/error_log"}.
14234 @end deftypevr
14235
14236 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} string fatal-errors
14237 Specifies which errors are fatal, causing the scheduler to exit. The
14238 kind strings are:
14239
14240 @table @code
14241 @item none
14242 No errors are fatal.
14243
14244 @item all
14245 All of the errors below are fatal.
14246
14247 @item browse
14248 Browsing initialization errors are fatal, for example failed connections
14249 to the DNS-SD daemon.
14250
14251 @item config
14252 Configuration file syntax errors are fatal.
14253
14254 @item listen
14255 Listen or Port errors are fatal, except for IPv6 failures on the
14256 loopback or @code{any} addresses.
14257
14258 @item log
14259 Log file creation or write errors are fatal.
14260
14261 @item permissions
14262 Bad startup file permissions are fatal, for example shared TLS
14263 certificate and key files with world-read permissions.
14264 @end table
14265
14266 Defaults to @samp{"all -browse"}.
14267 @end deftypevr
14268
14269 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} boolean file-device?
14270 Specifies whether the file pseudo-device can be used for new printer
14271 queues. The URI @uref{file:///dev/null} is always allowed.
14272
14273 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
14274 @end deftypevr
14275
14276 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} string group
14277 Specifies the group name or ID that will be used when executing external
14278 programs.
14279
14280 Defaults to @samp{"lp"}.
14281 @end deftypevr
14282
14283 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} string log-file-perm
14284 Specifies the permissions for all log files that the scheduler writes.
14285
14286 Defaults to @samp{"0644"}.
14287 @end deftypevr
14288
14289 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} log-location page-log
14290 Defines the page log filename. Specifying a blank filename disables
14291 page log generation. The value @code{stderr} causes log entries to be
14292 sent to the standard error file when the scheduler is running in the
14293 foreground, or to the system log daemon when run in the background. The
14294 value @code{syslog} causes log entries to be sent to the system log
14295 daemon. The server name may be included in filenames using the string
14296 @code{%s}, as in @code{/var/log/cups/%s-page_log}.
14297
14298 Defaults to @samp{"/var/log/cups/page_log"}.
14299 @end deftypevr
14300
14301 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} string remote-root
14302 Specifies the username that is associated with unauthenticated accesses
14303 by clients claiming to be the root user. The default is @code{remroot}.
14304
14305 Defaults to @samp{"remroot"}.
14306 @end deftypevr
14307
14308 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} file-name request-root
14309 Specifies the directory that contains print jobs and other HTTP request
14310 data.
14311
14312 Defaults to @samp{"/var/spool/cups"}.
14313 @end deftypevr
14314
14315 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} sandboxing sandboxing
14316 Specifies the level of security sandboxing that is applied to print
14317 filters, backends, and other child processes of the scheduler; either
14318 @code{relaxed} or @code{strict}. This directive is currently only
14319 used/supported on macOS.
14320
14321 Defaults to @samp{strict}.
14322 @end deftypevr
14323
14324 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} file-name server-keychain
14325 Specifies the location of TLS certificates and private keys. CUPS will
14326 look for public and private keys in this directory: a @code{.crt} files
14327 for PEM-encoded certificates and corresponding @code{.key} files for
14328 PEM-encoded private keys.
14329
14330 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/cups/ssl"}.
14331 @end deftypevr
14332
14333 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} file-name server-root
14334 Specifies the directory containing the server configuration files.
14335
14336 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/cups"}.
14337 @end deftypevr
14338
14339 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} boolean sync-on-close?
14340 Specifies whether the scheduler calls fsync(2) after writing
14341 configuration or state files.
14342
14343 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
14344 @end deftypevr
14345
14346 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list system-group
14347 Specifies the group(s) to use for @code{@@SYSTEM} group authentication.
14348 @end deftypevr
14349
14350 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} file-name temp-dir
14351 Specifies the directory where temporary files are stored.
14352
14353 Defaults to @samp{"/var/spool/cups/tmp"}.
14354 @end deftypevr
14355
14356 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} string user
14357 Specifies the user name or ID that is used when running external
14358 programs.
14359
14360 Defaults to @samp{"lp"}.
14361 @end deftypevr
14362
14363 @deftypevr {@code{files-configuration} parameter} string set-env
14364 Set the specified environment variable to be passed to child processes.
14365
14366 Defaults to @samp{"variable value"}.
14367 @end deftypevr
14368 @end deftypevr
14369
14370 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} access-log-level access-log-level
14371 Specifies the logging level for the AccessLog file. The @code{config}
14372 level logs when printers and classes are added, deleted, or modified and
14373 when configuration files are accessed or updated. The @code{actions}
14374 level logs when print jobs are submitted, held, released, modified, or
14375 canceled, and any of the conditions for @code{config}. The @code{all}
14376 level logs all requests.
14377
14378 Defaults to @samp{actions}.
14379 @end deftypevr
14380
14381 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean auto-purge-jobs?
14382 Specifies whether to purge job history data automatically when it is no
14383 longer required for quotas.
14384
14385 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
14386 @end deftypevr
14387
14388 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} comma-separated-string-list browse-dns-sd-sub-types
14389 Specifies a list of DNS-SD sub-types to advertise for each shared printer.
14390 For example, @samp{"_cups" "_print"} will tell network clients that both
14391 CUPS sharing and IPP Everywhere are supported.
14392
14393 Defaults to @samp{"_cups"}.
14394 @end deftypevr
14395
14396 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} browse-local-protocols browse-local-protocols
14397 Specifies which protocols to use for local printer sharing.
14398
14399 Defaults to @samp{dnssd}.
14400 @end deftypevr
14401
14402 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean browse-web-if?
14403 Specifies whether the CUPS web interface is advertised.
14404
14405 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
14406 @end deftypevr
14407
14408 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean browsing?
14409 Specifies whether shared printers are advertised.
14410
14411 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
14412 @end deftypevr
14413
14414 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} string classification
14415 Specifies the security classification of the server. Any valid banner
14416 name can be used, including "classified", "confidential", "secret",
14417 "topsecret", and "unclassified", or the banner can be omitted to disable
14418 secure printing functions.
14419
14420 Defaults to @samp{""}.
14421 @end deftypevr
14422
14423 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean classify-override?
14424 Specifies whether users may override the classification (cover page) of
14425 individual print jobs using the @code{job-sheets} option.
14426
14427 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
14428 @end deftypevr
14429
14430 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} default-auth-type default-auth-type
14431 Specifies the default type of authentication to use.
14432
14433 Defaults to @samp{Basic}.
14434 @end deftypevr
14435
14436 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} default-encryption default-encryption
14437 Specifies whether encryption will be used for authenticated requests.
14438
14439 Defaults to @samp{Required}.
14440 @end deftypevr
14441
14442 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} string default-language
14443 Specifies the default language to use for text and web content.
14444
14445 Defaults to @samp{"en"}.
14446 @end deftypevr
14447
14448 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} string default-paper-size
14449 Specifies the default paper size for new print queues. @samp{"Auto"}
14450 uses a locale-specific default, while @samp{"None"} specifies there is
14451 no default paper size. Specific size names are typically
14452 @samp{"Letter"} or @samp{"A4"}.
14453
14454 Defaults to @samp{"Auto"}.
14455 @end deftypevr
14456
14457 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} string default-policy
14458 Specifies the default access policy to use.
14459
14460 Defaults to @samp{"default"}.
14461 @end deftypevr
14462
14463 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean default-shared?
14464 Specifies whether local printers are shared by default.
14465
14466 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
14467 @end deftypevr
14468
14469 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer dirty-clean-interval
14470 Specifies the delay for updating of configuration and state files, in
14471 seconds. A value of 0 causes the update to happen as soon as possible,
14472 typically within a few milliseconds.
14473
14474 Defaults to @samp{30}.
14475 @end deftypevr
14476
14477 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} error-policy error-policy
14478 Specifies what to do when an error occurs. Possible values are
14479 @code{abort-job}, which will discard the failed print job;
14480 @code{retry-job}, which will retry the job at a later time;
14481 @code{retry-current-job}, which retries the failed job immediately; and
14482 @code{stop-printer}, which stops the printer.
14483
14484 Defaults to @samp{stop-printer}.
14485 @end deftypevr
14486
14487 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer filter-limit
14488 Specifies the maximum cost of filters that are run concurrently, which
14489 can be used to minimize disk, memory, and CPU resource problems. A
14490 limit of 0 disables filter limiting. An average print to a
14491 non-PostScript printer needs a filter limit of about 200. A PostScript
14492 printer needs about half that (100). Setting the limit below these
14493 thresholds will effectively limit the scheduler to printing a single job
14494 at any time.
14495
14496 Defaults to @samp{0}.
14497 @end deftypevr
14498
14499 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer filter-nice
14500 Specifies the scheduling priority of filters that are run to print a
14501 job. The nice value ranges from 0, the highest priority, to 19, the
14502 lowest priority.
14503
14504 Defaults to @samp{0}.
14505 @end deftypevr
14506
14507 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} host-name-lookups host-name-lookups
14508 Specifies whether to do reverse lookups on connecting clients. The
14509 @code{double} setting causes @code{cupsd} to verify that the hostname
14510 resolved from the address matches one of the addresses returned for that
14511 hostname. Double lookups also prevent clients with unregistered
14512 addresses from connecting to your server. Only set this option to
14513 @code{#t} or @code{double} if absolutely required.
14514
14515 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
14516 @end deftypevr
14517
14518 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer job-kill-delay
14519 Specifies the number of seconds to wait before killing the filters and
14520 backend associated with a canceled or held job.
14521
14522 Defaults to @samp{30}.
14523 @end deftypevr
14524
14525 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer job-retry-interval
14526 Specifies the interval between retries of jobs in seconds. This is
14527 typically used for fax queues but can also be used with normal print
14528 queues whose error policy is @code{retry-job} or
14529 @code{retry-current-job}.
14530
14531 Defaults to @samp{30}.
14532 @end deftypevr
14533
14534 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer job-retry-limit
14535 Specifies the number of retries that are done for jobs. This is
14536 typically used for fax queues but can also be used with normal print
14537 queues whose error policy is @code{retry-job} or
14538 @code{retry-current-job}.
14539
14540 Defaults to @samp{5}.
14541 @end deftypevr
14542
14543 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean keep-alive?
14544 Specifies whether to support HTTP keep-alive connections.
14545
14546 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
14547 @end deftypevr
14548
14549 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer keep-alive-timeout
14550 Specifies how long an idle client connection remains open, in seconds.
14551
14552 Defaults to @samp{30}.
14553 @end deftypevr
14554
14555 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer limit-request-body
14556 Specifies the maximum size of print files, IPP requests, and HTML form
14557 data. A limit of 0 disables the limit check.
14558
14559 Defaults to @samp{0}.
14560 @end deftypevr
14561
14562 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} multiline-string-list listen
14563 Listens on the specified interfaces for connections. Valid values are
14564 of the form @var{address}:@var{port}, where @var{address} is either an
14565 IPv6 address enclosed in brackets, an IPv4 address, or @code{*} to
14566 indicate all addresses. Values can also be file names of local UNIX
14567 domain sockets. The Listen directive is similar to the Port directive
14568 but allows you to restrict access to specific interfaces or networks.
14569 @end deftypevr
14570
14571 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer listen-back-log
14572 Specifies the number of pending connections that will be allowed. This
14573 normally only affects very busy servers that have reached the MaxClients
14574 limit, but can also be triggered by large numbers of simultaneous
14575 connections. When the limit is reached, the operating system will
14576 refuse additional connections until the scheduler can accept the pending
14577 ones.
14578
14579 Defaults to @samp{128}.
14580 @end deftypevr
14581
14582 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} location-access-control-list location-access-controls
14583 Specifies a set of additional access controls.
14584
14585 Available @code{location-access-controls} fields are:
14586
14587 @deftypevr {@code{location-access-controls} parameter} file-name path
14588 Specifies the URI path to which the access control applies.
14589 @end deftypevr
14590
14591 @deftypevr {@code{location-access-controls} parameter} access-control-list access-controls
14592 Access controls for all access to this path, in the same format as the
14593 @code{access-controls} of @code{operation-access-control}.
14594
14595 Defaults to @samp{()}.
14596 @end deftypevr
14597
14598 @deftypevr {@code{location-access-controls} parameter} method-access-control-list method-access-controls
14599 Access controls for method-specific access to this path.
14600
14601 Defaults to @samp{()}.
14602
14603 Available @code{method-access-controls} fields are:
14604
14605 @deftypevr {@code{method-access-controls} parameter} boolean reverse?
14606 If @code{#t}, apply access controls to all methods except the listed
14607 methods. Otherwise apply to only the listed methods.
14608
14609 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
14610 @end deftypevr
14611
14612 @deftypevr {@code{method-access-controls} parameter} method-list methods
14613 Methods to which this access control applies.
14614
14615 Defaults to @samp{()}.
14616 @end deftypevr
14617
14618 @deftypevr {@code{method-access-controls} parameter} access-control-list access-controls
14619 Access control directives, as a list of strings. Each string should be
14620 one directive, such as "Order allow,deny".
14621
14622 Defaults to @samp{()}.
14623 @end deftypevr
14624 @end deftypevr
14625 @end deftypevr
14626
14627 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer log-debug-history
14628 Specifies the number of debugging messages that are retained for logging
14629 if an error occurs in a print job. Debug messages are logged regardless
14630 of the LogLevel setting.
14631
14632 Defaults to @samp{100}.
14633 @end deftypevr
14634
14635 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} log-level log-level
14636 Specifies the level of logging for the ErrorLog file. The value
14637 @code{none} stops all logging while @code{debug2} logs everything.
14638
14639 Defaults to @samp{info}.
14640 @end deftypevr
14641
14642 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} log-time-format log-time-format
14643 Specifies the format of the date and time in the log files. The value
14644 @code{standard} logs whole seconds while @code{usecs} logs microseconds.
14645
14646 Defaults to @samp{standard}.
14647 @end deftypevr
14648
14649 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-clients
14650 Specifies the maximum number of simultaneous clients that are allowed by
14651 the scheduler.
14652
14653 Defaults to @samp{100}.
14654 @end deftypevr
14655
14656 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-clients-per-host
14657 Specifies the maximum number of simultaneous clients that are allowed
14658 from a single address.
14659
14660 Defaults to @samp{100}.
14661 @end deftypevr
14662
14663 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-copies
14664 Specifies the maximum number of copies that a user can print of each
14665 job.
14666
14667 Defaults to @samp{9999}.
14668 @end deftypevr
14669
14670 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-hold-time
14671 Specifies the maximum time a job may remain in the @code{indefinite}
14672 hold state before it is canceled. A value of 0 disables cancellation of
14673 held jobs.
14674
14675 Defaults to @samp{0}.
14676 @end deftypevr
14677
14678 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-jobs
14679 Specifies the maximum number of simultaneous jobs that are allowed. Set
14680 to 0 to allow an unlimited number of jobs.
14681
14682 Defaults to @samp{500}.
14683 @end deftypevr
14684
14685 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-jobs-per-printer
14686 Specifies the maximum number of simultaneous jobs that are allowed per
14687 printer. A value of 0 allows up to MaxJobs jobs per printer.
14688
14689 Defaults to @samp{0}.
14690 @end deftypevr
14691
14692 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-jobs-per-user
14693 Specifies the maximum number of simultaneous jobs that are allowed per
14694 user. A value of 0 allows up to MaxJobs jobs per user.
14695
14696 Defaults to @samp{0}.
14697 @end deftypevr
14698
14699 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-job-time
14700 Specifies the maximum time a job may take to print before it is
14701 canceled, in seconds. Set to 0 to disable cancellation of "stuck" jobs.
14702
14703 Defaults to @samp{10800}.
14704 @end deftypevr
14705
14706 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-log-size
14707 Specifies the maximum size of the log files before they are rotated, in
14708 bytes. The value 0 disables log rotation.
14709
14710 Defaults to @samp{1048576}.
14711 @end deftypevr
14712
14713 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer multiple-operation-timeout
14714 Specifies the maximum amount of time to allow between files in a
14715 multiple file print job, in seconds.
14716
14717 Defaults to @samp{300}.
14718 @end deftypevr
14719
14720 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} string page-log-format
14721 Specifies the format of PageLog lines. Sequences beginning with percent
14722 (@samp{%}) characters are replaced with the corresponding information,
14723 while all other characters are copied literally. The following percent
14724 sequences are recognized:
14725
14726 @table @samp
14727 @item %%
14728 insert a single percent character
14729
14730 @item %@{name@}
14731 insert the value of the specified IPP attribute
14732
14733 @item %C
14734 insert the number of copies for the current page
14735
14736 @item %P
14737 insert the current page number
14738
14739 @item %T
14740 insert the current date and time in common log format
14741
14742 @item %j
14743 insert the job ID
14744
14745 @item %p
14746 insert the printer name
14747
14748 @item %u
14749 insert the username
14750 @end table
14751
14752 A value of the empty string disables page logging. The string @code{%p
14753 %u %j %T %P %C %@{job-billing@} %@{job-originating-host-name@}
14754 %@{job-name@} %@{media@} %@{sides@}} creates a page log with the
14755 standard items.
14756
14757 Defaults to @samp{""}.
14758 @end deftypevr
14759
14760 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} environment-variables environment-variables
14761 Passes the specified environment variable(s) to child processes; a list
14762 of strings.
14763
14764 Defaults to @samp{()}.
14765 @end deftypevr
14766
14767 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} policy-configuration-list policies
14768 Specifies named access control policies.
14769
14770 Available @code{policy-configuration} fields are:
14771
14772 @deftypevr {@code{policy-configuration} parameter} string name
14773 Name of the policy.
14774 @end deftypevr
14775
14776 @deftypevr {@code{policy-configuration} parameter} string job-private-access
14777 Specifies an access list for a job's private values. @code{@@ACL} maps
14778 to the printer's requesting-user-name-allowed or
14779 requesting-user-name-denied values. @code{@@OWNER} maps to the job's
14780 owner. @code{@@SYSTEM} maps to the groups listed for the
14781 @code{system-group} field of the @code{files-config} configuration,
14782 which is reified into the @code{cups-files.conf(5)} file. Other
14783 possible elements of the access list include specific user names, and
14784 @code{@@@var{group}} to indicate members of a specific group. The
14785 access list may also be simply @code{all} or @code{default}.
14786
14787 Defaults to @samp{"@@OWNER @@SYSTEM"}.
14788 @end deftypevr
14789
14790 @deftypevr {@code{policy-configuration} parameter} string job-private-values
14791 Specifies the list of job values to make private, or @code{all},
14792 @code{default}, or @code{none}.
14793
14794 Defaults to @samp{"job-name job-originating-host-name
14795 job-originating-user-name phone"}.
14796 @end deftypevr
14797
14798 @deftypevr {@code{policy-configuration} parameter} string subscription-private-access
14799 Specifies an access list for a subscription's private values.
14800 @code{@@ACL} maps to the printer's requesting-user-name-allowed or
14801 requesting-user-name-denied values. @code{@@OWNER} maps to the job's
14802 owner. @code{@@SYSTEM} maps to the groups listed for the
14803 @code{system-group} field of the @code{files-config} configuration,
14804 which is reified into the @code{cups-files.conf(5)} file. Other
14805 possible elements of the access list include specific user names, and
14806 @code{@@@var{group}} to indicate members of a specific group. The
14807 access list may also be simply @code{all} or @code{default}.
14808
14809 Defaults to @samp{"@@OWNER @@SYSTEM"}.
14810 @end deftypevr
14811
14812 @deftypevr {@code{policy-configuration} parameter} string subscription-private-values
14813 Specifies the list of job values to make private, or @code{all},
14814 @code{default}, or @code{none}.
14815
14816 Defaults to @samp{"notify-events notify-pull-method notify-recipient-uri
14817 notify-subscriber-user-name notify-user-data"}.
14818 @end deftypevr
14819
14820 @deftypevr {@code{policy-configuration} parameter} operation-access-control-list access-controls
14821 Access control by IPP operation.
14822
14823 Defaults to @samp{()}.
14824 @end deftypevr
14825 @end deftypevr
14826
14827 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean-or-non-negative-integer preserve-job-files
14828 Specifies whether job files (documents) are preserved after a job is
14829 printed. If a numeric value is specified, job files are preserved for
14830 the indicated number of seconds after printing. Otherwise a boolean
14831 value applies indefinitely.
14832
14833 Defaults to @samp{86400}.
14834 @end deftypevr
14835
14836 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean-or-non-negative-integer preserve-job-history
14837 Specifies whether the job history is preserved after a job is printed.
14838 If a numeric value is specified, the job history is preserved for the
14839 indicated number of seconds after printing. If @code{#t}, the job
14840 history is preserved until the MaxJobs limit is reached.
14841
14842 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
14843 @end deftypevr
14844
14845 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer reload-timeout
14846 Specifies the amount of time to wait for job completion before
14847 restarting the scheduler.
14848
14849 Defaults to @samp{30}.
14850 @end deftypevr
14851
14852 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} string rip-cache
14853 Specifies the maximum amount of memory to use when converting documents
14854 into bitmaps for a printer.
14855
14856 Defaults to @samp{"128m"}.
14857 @end deftypevr
14858
14859 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} string server-admin
14860 Specifies the email address of the server administrator.
14861
14862 Defaults to @samp{"root@@localhost.localdomain"}.
14863 @end deftypevr
14864
14865 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} host-name-list-or-* server-alias
14866 The ServerAlias directive is used for HTTP Host header validation when
14867 clients connect to the scheduler from external interfaces. Using the
14868 special name @code{*} can expose your system to known browser-based DNS
14869 rebinding attacks, even when accessing sites through a firewall. If the
14870 auto-discovery of alternate names does not work, we recommend listing
14871 each alternate name with a ServerAlias directive instead of using
14872 @code{*}.
14873
14874 Defaults to @samp{*}.
14875 @end deftypevr
14876
14877 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} string server-name
14878 Specifies the fully-qualified host name of the server.
14879
14880 Defaults to @samp{"localhost"}.
14881 @end deftypevr
14882
14883 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} server-tokens server-tokens
14884 Specifies what information is included in the Server header of HTTP
14885 responses. @code{None} disables the Server header. @code{ProductOnly}
14886 reports @code{CUPS}. @code{Major} reports @code{CUPS 2}. @code{Minor}
14887 reports @code{CUPS 2.0}. @code{Minimal} reports @code{CUPS 2.0.0}.
14888 @code{OS} reports @code{CUPS 2.0.0 (@var{uname})} where @var{uname} is
14889 the output of the @code{uname} command. @code{Full} reports @code{CUPS
14890 2.0.0 (@var{uname}) IPP/2.0}.
14891
14892 Defaults to @samp{Minimal}.
14893 @end deftypevr
14894
14895 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} multiline-string-list ssl-listen
14896 Listens on the specified interfaces for encrypted connections. Valid
14897 values are of the form @var{address}:@var{port}, where @var{address} is
14898 either an IPv6 address enclosed in brackets, an IPv4 address, or
14899 @code{*} to indicate all addresses.
14900
14901 Defaults to @samp{()}.
14902 @end deftypevr
14903
14904 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} ssl-options ssl-options
14905 Sets encryption options. By default, CUPS only supports encryption
14906 using TLS v1.0 or higher using known secure cipher suites. Security is
14907 reduced when @code{Allow} options are used, and enhanced when @code{Deny}
14908 options are used. The @code{AllowRC4} option enables the 128-bit RC4 cipher
14909 suites, which are required for some older clients. The @code{AllowSSL3} option
14910 enables SSL v3.0, which is required for some older clients that do not support
14911 TLS v1.0. The @code{DenyCBC} option disables all CBC cipher suites. The
14912 @code{DenyTLS1.0} option disables TLS v1.0 support - this sets the minimum
14913 protocol version to TLS v1.1.
14914
14915 Defaults to @samp{()}.
14916 @end deftypevr
14917
14918 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean strict-conformance?
14919 Specifies whether the scheduler requires clients to strictly adhere to
14920 the IPP specifications.
14921
14922 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
14923 @end deftypevr
14924
14925 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer timeout
14926 Specifies the HTTP request timeout, in seconds.
14927
14928 Defaults to @samp{300}.
14929
14930 @end deftypevr
14931
14932 @deftypevr {@code{cups-configuration} parameter} boolean web-interface?
14933 Specifies whether the web interface is enabled.
14934
14935 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
14936 @end deftypevr
14937
14938 At this point you're probably thinking ``oh dear, Guix manual, I like
14939 you but you can stop already with the configuration options''. Indeed.
14940 However, one more point: it could be that you have an existing
14941 @code{cupsd.conf} that you want to use. In that case, you can pass an
14942 @code{opaque-cups-configuration} as the configuration of a
14943 @code{cups-service-type}.
14944
14945 Available @code{opaque-cups-configuration} fields are:
14946
14947 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-cups-configuration} parameter} package cups
14948 The CUPS package.
14949 @end deftypevr
14950
14951 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-cups-configuration} parameter} string cupsd.conf
14952 The contents of the @code{cupsd.conf}, as a string.
14953 @end deftypevr
14954
14955 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-cups-configuration} parameter} string cups-files.conf
14956 The contents of the @code{cups-files.conf} file, as a string.
14957 @end deftypevr
14958
14959 For example, if your @code{cupsd.conf} and @code{cups-files.conf} are in
14960 strings of the same name, you could instantiate a CUPS service like
14961 this:
14962
14963 @lisp
14964 (service cups-service-type
14965 (opaque-cups-configuration
14966 (cupsd.conf cupsd.conf)
14967 (cups-files.conf cups-files.conf)))
14968 @end lisp
14969
14970
14971 @node Desktop Services
14972 @subsection Desktop Services
14973
14974 The @code{(gnu services desktop)} module provides services that are
14975 usually useful in the context of a ``desktop'' setup---that is, on a
14976 machine running a graphical display server, possibly with graphical user
14977 interfaces, etc. It also defines services that provide specific desktop
14978 environments like GNOME, Xfce or MATE.
14979
14980 To simplify things, the module defines a variable containing the set of
14981 services that users typically expect on a machine with a graphical
14982 environment and networking:
14983
14984 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %desktop-services
14985 This is a list of services that builds upon @code{%base-services} and
14986 adds or adjusts services for a typical ``desktop'' setup.
14987
14988 In particular, it adds a graphical login manager (@pxref{X Window,
14989 @code{gdm-service-type}}), screen lockers, a network management tool
14990 (@pxref{Networking Services, @code{network-manager-service-type}}) with modem
14991 support (@pxref{Networking Services, @code{modem-manager-service-type}}),
14992 energy and color management services, the @code{elogind} login and seat
14993 manager, the Polkit privilege service, the GeoClue location service, the
14994 AccountsService daemon that allows authorized users change system passwords,
14995 an NTP client (@pxref{Networking Services}), the Avahi daemon, and has the
14996 name service switch service configured to be able to use @code{nss-mdns}
14997 (@pxref{Name Service Switch, mDNS}).
14998 @end defvr
14999
15000 The @code{%desktop-services} variable can be used as the @code{services}
15001 field of an @code{operating-system} declaration (@pxref{operating-system
15002 Reference, @code{services}}).
15003
15004 Additionally, the @code{gnome-desktop-service-type},
15005 @code{xfce-desktop-service}, @code{mate-desktop-service-type} and
15006 @code{enlightenment-desktop-service-type} procedures can add GNOME, Xfce, MATE
15007 and/or Enlightenment to a system. To ``add GNOME'' means that system-level
15008 services like the backlight adjustment helpers and the power management
15009 utilities are added to the system, extending @code{polkit} and @code{dbus}
15010 appropriately, allowing GNOME to operate with elevated privileges on a
15011 limited number of special-purpose system interfaces. Additionally,
15012 adding a service made by @code{gnome-desktop-service-type} adds the GNOME
15013 metapackage to the system profile. Likewise, adding the Xfce service
15014 not only adds the @code{xfce} metapackage to the system profile, but it
15015 also gives the Thunar file manager the ability to open a ``root-mode''
15016 file management window, if the user authenticates using the
15017 administrator's password via the standard polkit graphical interface.
15018 To ``add MATE'' means that @code{polkit} and @code{dbus} are extended
15019 appropriately, allowing MATE to operate with elevated privileges on a
15020 limited number of special-purpose system interfaces. Additionally,
15021 adding a service of type @code{mate-desktop-service-type} adds the MATE
15022 metapackage to the system profile. ``Adding Enlightenment'' means that
15023 @code{dbus} is extended appropriately, and several of Enlightenment's binaries
15024 are set as setuid, allowing Enlightenment's screen locker and other
15025 functionality to work as expetected.
15026
15027 The desktop environments in Guix use the Xorg display server by
15028 default. If you'd like to use the newer display server protocol
15029 called Wayland, you need to use the @code{sddm-service} instead of
15030 GDM as the graphical login manager. You should then
15031 select the ``GNOME (Wayland)'' session in SDDM. Alternatively you can
15032 also try starting GNOME on Wayland manually from a TTY with the
15033 command ``XDG_SESSION_TYPE=wayland exec dbus-run-session
15034 gnome-session``. Currently only GNOME has support for Wayland.
15035
15036 @defvr {Scheme Variable} gnome-desktop-service-type
15037 This is the type of the service that adds the @uref{https://www.gnome.org,
15038 GNOME} desktop environment. Its value is a @code{gnome-desktop-configuration}
15039 object (see below.)
15040
15041 This service adds the @code{gnome} package to the system profile, and extends
15042 polkit with the actions from @code{gnome-settings-daemon}.
15043 @end defvr
15044
15045 @deftp {Data Type} gnome-desktop-configuration
15046 Configuration record for the GNOME desktop environment.
15047
15048 @table @asis
15049 @item @code{gnome} (default: @code{gnome})
15050 The GNOME package to use.
15051 @end table
15052 @end deftp
15053
15054 @defvr {Scheme Variable} xfce-desktop-service-type
15055 This is the type of a service to run the @uref{Xfce, https://xfce.org/}
15056 desktop environment. Its value is an @code{xfce-desktop-configuration} object
15057 (see below.)
15058
15059 This service adds the @code{xfce} package to the system profile, and
15060 extends polkit with the ability for @code{thunar} to manipulate the file
15061 system as root from within a user session, after the user has authenticated
15062 with the administrator's password.
15063 @end defvr
15064
15065 @deftp {Data Type} xfce-desktop-configuration
15066 Configuration record for the Xfce desktop environment.
15067
15068 @table @asis
15069 @item @code{xfce} (default: @code{xfce})
15070 The Xfce package to use.
15071 @end table
15072 @end deftp
15073
15074 @deffn {Scheme Variable} mate-desktop-service-type
15075 This is the type of the service that runs the @uref{https://mate-desktop.org/,
15076 MATE desktop environment}. Its value is a @code{mate-desktop-configuration}
15077 object (see below.)
15078
15079 This service adds the @code{mate} package to the system
15080 profile, and extends polkit with the actions from
15081 @code{mate-settings-daemon}.
15082 @end deffn
15083
15084 @deftp {Data Type} mate-desktop-configuration
15085 Configuration record for the MATE desktop environment.
15086
15087 @table @asis
15088 @item @code{mate} (default: @code{mate})
15089 The MATE package to use.
15090 @end table
15091 @end deftp
15092
15093 @deffn {Scheme Variable} enlightenment-desktop-service-type
15094 Return a service that adds the @code{enlightenment} package to the system
15095 profile, and extends dbus with actions from @code{efl}.
15096 @end deffn
15097
15098 @deftp {Data Type} enlightenment-desktop-service-configuration
15099 @table @asis
15100 @item @code{enlightenment} (default: @code{enlightenment})
15101 The enlightenment package to use.
15102 @end table
15103 @end deftp
15104
15105 Because the GNOME, Xfce and MATE desktop services pull in so many packages,
15106 the default @code{%desktop-services} variable doesn't include any of
15107 them by default. To add GNOME, Xfce or MATE, just @code{cons} them onto
15108 @code{%desktop-services} in the @code{services} field of your
15109 @code{operating-system}:
15110
15111 @lisp
15112 (use-modules (gnu))
15113 (use-service-modules desktop)
15114 (operating-system
15115 ...
15116 ;; cons* adds items to the list given as its last argument.
15117 (services (cons* (service gnome-desktop-service-type)
15118 (service xfce-desktop-service)
15119 %desktop-services))
15120 ...)
15121 @end lisp
15122
15123 These desktop environments will then be available as options in the
15124 graphical login window.
15125
15126 The actual service definitions included in @code{%desktop-services} and
15127 provided by @code{(gnu services dbus)} and @code{(gnu services desktop)}
15128 are described below.
15129
15130 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} dbus-service [#:dbus @var{dbus}] [#:services '()]
15131 Return a service that runs the ``system bus'', using @var{dbus}, with
15132 support for @var{services}.
15133
15134 @uref{https://dbus.freedesktop.org/, D-Bus} is an inter-process communication
15135 facility. Its system bus is used to allow system services to communicate
15136 and to be notified of system-wide events.
15137
15138 @var{services} must be a list of packages that provide an
15139 @file{etc/dbus-1/system.d} directory containing additional D-Bus configuration
15140 and policy files. For example, to allow avahi-daemon to use the system bus,
15141 @var{services} must be equal to @code{(list avahi)}.
15142 @end deffn
15143
15144 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} elogind-service [#:config @var{config}]
15145 Return a service that runs the @code{elogind} login and
15146 seat management daemon. @uref{https://github.com/elogind/elogind,
15147 Elogind} exposes a D-Bus interface that can be used to know which users
15148 are logged in, know what kind of sessions they have open, suspend the
15149 system, inhibit system suspend, reboot the system, and other tasks.
15150
15151 Elogind handles most system-level power events for a computer, for
15152 example suspending the system when a lid is closed, or shutting it down
15153 when the power button is pressed.
15154
15155 The @var{config} keyword argument specifies the configuration for
15156 elogind, and should be the result of an @code{(elogind-configuration
15157 (@var{parameter} @var{value})...)} invocation. Available parameters and
15158 their default values are:
15159
15160 @table @code
15161 @item kill-user-processes?
15162 @code{#f}
15163 @item kill-only-users
15164 @code{()}
15165 @item kill-exclude-users
15166 @code{("root")}
15167 @item inhibit-delay-max-seconds
15168 @code{5}
15169 @item handle-power-key
15170 @code{poweroff}
15171 @item handle-suspend-key
15172 @code{suspend}
15173 @item handle-hibernate-key
15174 @code{hibernate}
15175 @item handle-lid-switch
15176 @code{suspend}
15177 @item handle-lid-switch-docked
15178 @code{ignore}
15179 @item power-key-ignore-inhibited?
15180 @code{#f}
15181 @item suspend-key-ignore-inhibited?
15182 @code{#f}
15183 @item hibernate-key-ignore-inhibited?
15184 @code{#f}
15185 @item lid-switch-ignore-inhibited?
15186 @code{#t}
15187 @item holdoff-timeout-seconds
15188 @code{30}
15189 @item idle-action
15190 @code{ignore}
15191 @item idle-action-seconds
15192 @code{(* 30 60)}
15193 @item runtime-directory-size-percent
15194 @code{10}
15195 @item runtime-directory-size
15196 @code{#f}
15197 @item remove-ipc?
15198 @code{#t}
15199 @item suspend-state
15200 @code{("mem" "standby" "freeze")}
15201 @item suspend-mode
15202 @code{()}
15203 @item hibernate-state
15204 @code{("disk")}
15205 @item hibernate-mode
15206 @code{("platform" "shutdown")}
15207 @item hybrid-sleep-state
15208 @code{("disk")}
15209 @item hybrid-sleep-mode
15210 @code{("suspend" "platform" "shutdown")}
15211 @end table
15212 @end deffn
15213
15214 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} accountsservice-service @
15215 [#:accountsservice @var{accountsservice}]
15216 Return a service that runs AccountsService, a system service that can
15217 list available accounts, change their passwords, and so on.
15218 AccountsService integrates with PolicyKit to enable unprivileged users
15219 to acquire the capability to modify their system configuration.
15220 @uref{https://www.freedesktop.org/wiki/Software/AccountsService/, the
15221 accountsservice web site} for more information.
15222
15223 The @var{accountsservice} keyword argument is the @code{accountsservice}
15224 package to expose as a service.
15225 @end deffn
15226
15227 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} polkit-service @
15228 [#:polkit @var{polkit}]
15229 Return a service that runs the
15230 @uref{https://www.freedesktop.org/wiki/Software/polkit/, Polkit privilege
15231 management service}, which allows system administrators to grant access to
15232 privileged operations in a structured way. By querying the Polkit service, a
15233 privileged system component can know when it should grant additional
15234 capabilities to ordinary users. For example, an ordinary user can be granted
15235 the capability to suspend the system if the user is logged in locally.
15236 @end deffn
15237
15238 @defvr {Scheme Variable} upower-service-type
15239 Service that runs @uref{https://upower.freedesktop.org/, @command{upowerd}}, a
15240 system-wide monitor for power consumption and battery levels, with the given
15241 configuration settings.
15242
15243 It implements the @code{org.freedesktop.UPower} D-Bus interface, and is
15244 notably used by GNOME.
15245 @end defvr
15246
15247 @deftp {Data Type} upower-configuration
15248 Data type representation the configuration for UPower.
15249
15250 @table @asis
15251
15252 @item @code{upower} (default: @var{upower})
15253 Package to use for @code{upower}.
15254
15255 @item @code{watts-up-pro?} (default: @code{#f})
15256 Enable the Watts Up Pro device.
15257
15258 @item @code{poll-batteries?} (default: @code{#t})
15259 Enable polling the kernel for battery level changes.
15260
15261 @item @code{ignore-lid?} (default: @code{#f})
15262 Ignore the lid state, this can be useful if it's incorrect on a device.
15263
15264 @item @code{use-percentage-for-policy?} (default: @code{#f})
15265 Whether battery percentage based policy should be used. The default is to use
15266 the time left, change to @code{#t} to use the percentage.
15267
15268 @item @code{percentage-low} (default: @code{10})
15269 When @code{use-percentage-for-policy?} is @code{#t}, this sets the percentage
15270 at which the battery is considered low.
15271
15272 @item @code{percentage-critical} (default: @code{3})
15273 When @code{use-percentage-for-policy?} is @code{#t}, this sets the percentage
15274 at which the battery is considered critical.
15275
15276 @item @code{percentage-action} (default: @code{2})
15277 When @code{use-percentage-for-policy?} is @code{#t}, this sets the percentage
15278 at which action will be taken.
15279
15280 @item @code{time-low} (default: @code{1200})
15281 When @code{use-time-for-policy?} is @code{#f}, this sets the time remaining in
15282 seconds at which the battery is considered low.
15283
15284 @item @code{time-critical} (default: @code{300})
15285 When @code{use-time-for-policy?} is @code{#f}, this sets the time remaining in
15286 seconds at which the battery is considered critical.
15287
15288 @item @code{time-action} (default: @code{120})
15289 When @code{use-time-for-policy?} is @code{#f}, this sets the time remaining in
15290 seconds at which action will be taken.
15291
15292 @item @code{critical-power-action} (default: @code{'hybrid-sleep})
15293 The action taken when @code{percentage-action} or @code{time-action} is
15294 reached (depending on the configuration of @code{use-percentage-for-policy?}).
15295
15296 Possible values are:
15297
15298 @itemize @bullet
15299 @item
15300 @code{'power-off}
15301
15302 @item
15303 @code{'hibernate}
15304
15305 @item
15306 @code{'hybrid-sleep}.
15307 @end itemize
15308
15309 @end table
15310 @end deftp
15311
15312 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} udisks-service [#:udisks @var{udisks}]
15313 Return a service for @uref{https://udisks.freedesktop.org/docs/latest/,
15314 UDisks}, a @dfn{disk management} daemon that provides user interfaces with
15315 notifications and ways to mount/unmount disks. Programs that talk to UDisks
15316 include the @command{udisksctl} command, part of UDisks, and GNOME Disks.
15317 @end deffn
15318
15319 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} colord-service [#:colord @var{colord}]
15320 Return a service that runs @command{colord}, a system service with a D-Bus
15321 interface to manage the color profiles of input and output devices such as
15322 screens and scanners. It is notably used by the GNOME Color Manager graphical
15323 tool. See @uref{https://www.freedesktop.org/software/colord/, the colord web
15324 site} for more information.
15325 @end deffn
15326
15327 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} geoclue-application name [#:allowed? #t] [#:system? #f] [#:users '()]
15328 Return a configuration allowing an application to access GeoClue
15329 location data. @var{name} is the Desktop ID of the application, without
15330 the @code{.desktop} part. If @var{allowed?} is true, the application
15331 will have access to location information by default. The boolean
15332 @var{system?} value indicates whether an application is a system component
15333 or not. Finally @var{users} is a list of UIDs of all users for which
15334 this application is allowed location info access. An empty users list
15335 means that all users are allowed.
15336 @end deffn
15337
15338 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %standard-geoclue-applications
15339 The standard list of well-known GeoClue application configurations,
15340 granting authority to the GNOME date-and-time utility to ask for the
15341 current location in order to set the time zone, and allowing the
15342 IceCat and Epiphany web browsers to request location information.
15343 IceCat and Epiphany both query the user before allowing a web page to
15344 know the user's location.
15345 @end defvr
15346
15347 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} geoclue-service [#:colord @var{colord}] @
15348 [#:whitelist '()] @
15349 [#:wifi-geolocation-url "https://location.services.mozilla.com/v1/geolocate?key=geoclue"] @
15350 [#:submit-data? #f]
15351 [#:wifi-submission-url "https://location.services.mozilla.com/v1/submit?key=geoclue"] @
15352 [#:submission-nick "geoclue"] @
15353 [#:applications %standard-geoclue-applications]
15354 Return a service that runs the GeoClue location service. This service
15355 provides a D-Bus interface to allow applications to request access to a
15356 user's physical location, and optionally to add information to online
15357 location databases. See
15358 @uref{https://wiki.freedesktop.org/www/Software/GeoClue/, the GeoClue
15359 web site} for more information.
15360 @end deffn
15361
15362 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} bluetooth-service [#:bluez @var{bluez}] @
15363 [@w{#:auto-enable? #f}]
15364 Return a service that runs the @command{bluetoothd} daemon, which
15365 manages all the Bluetooth devices and provides a number of D-Bus
15366 interfaces. When AUTO-ENABLE? is true, the bluetooth controller is
15367 powered automatically at boot, which can be useful when using a
15368 bluetooth keyboard or mouse.
15369
15370 Users need to be in the @code{lp} group to access the D-Bus service.
15371 @end deffn
15372
15373 @node Sound Services
15374 @subsection Sound Services
15375
15376 @cindex sound support
15377 @cindex ALSA
15378 @cindex PulseAudio, sound support
15379
15380 The @code{(gnu services sound)} module provides a service to configure the
15381 Advanced Linux Sound Architecture (ALSA) system, which makes PulseAudio the
15382 preferred ALSA output driver.
15383
15384 @deffn {Scheme Variable} alsa-service-type
15385 This is the type for the @uref{https://alsa-project.org/, Advanced Linux Sound
15386 Architecture} (ALSA) system, which generates the @file{/etc/asound.conf}
15387 configuration file. The value for this type is a @command{alsa-configuration}
15388 record as in this example:
15389
15390 @lisp
15391 (service alsa-service-type)
15392 @end lisp
15393
15394 See below for details about @code{alsa-configuration}.
15395 @end deffn
15396
15397 @deftp {Data Type} alsa-configuration
15398 Data type representing the configuration for @code{alsa-service}.
15399
15400 @table @asis
15401 @item @code{alsa-plugins} (default: @var{alsa-plugins})
15402 @code{alsa-plugins} package to use.
15403
15404 @item @code{pulseaudio?} (default: @var{#t})
15405 Whether ALSA applications should transparently be made to use the
15406 @uref{http://www.pulseaudio.org/, PulseAudio} sound server.
15407
15408 Using PulseAudio allows you to run several sound-producing applications
15409 at the same time and to individual control them @i{via}
15410 @command{pavucontrol}, among other things.
15411
15412 @item @code{extra-options} (default: @var{""})
15413 String to append to the @file{/etc/asound.conf} file.
15414
15415 @end table
15416 @end deftp
15417
15418 Individual users who want to override the system configuration of ALSA can do
15419 it with the @file{~/.asoundrc} file:
15420
15421 @example
15422 # In guix, we have to specify the absolute path for plugins.
15423 pcm_type.jack @{
15424 lib "/home/alice/.guix-profile/lib/alsa-lib/libasound_module_pcm_jack.so"
15425 @}
15426
15427 # Routing ALSA to jack:
15428 # <http://jackaudio.org/faq/routing_alsa.html>.
15429 pcm.rawjack @{
15430 type jack
15431 playback_ports @{
15432 0 system:playback_1
15433 1 system:playback_2
15434 @}
15435
15436 capture_ports @{
15437 0 system:capture_1
15438 1 system:capture_2
15439 @}
15440 @}
15441
15442 pcm.!default @{
15443 type plug
15444 slave @{
15445 pcm "rawjack"
15446 @}
15447 @}
15448 @end example
15449
15450 See @uref{https://www.alsa-project.org/main/index.php/Asoundrc} for the
15451 details.
15452
15453
15454 @node Database Services
15455 @subsection Database Services
15456
15457 @cindex database
15458 @cindex SQL
15459 The @code{(gnu services databases)} module provides the following services.
15460
15461 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} postgresql-service [#:postgresql postgresql] @
15462 [#:config-file] [#:data-directory ``/var/lib/postgresql/data''] @
15463 [#:port 5432] [#:locale ``en_US.utf8''] [#:extension-packages '()]
15464 Return a service that runs @var{postgresql}, the PostgreSQL database
15465 server.
15466
15467 The PostgreSQL daemon loads its runtime configuration from @var{config-file},
15468 creates a database cluster with @var{locale} as the default
15469 locale, stored in @var{data-directory}. It then listens on @var{port}.
15470
15471 @cindex postgresql extension-packages
15472 Additional extensions are loaded from packages listed in
15473 @var{extension-packages}. Extensions are available at runtime. For instance,
15474 to create a geographic database using the @code{postgis} extension, a user can
15475 configure the postgresql-service as in this example:
15476
15477 @cindex postgis
15478 @lisp
15479 (use-package-modules databases geo)
15480
15481 (operating-system
15482 ...
15483 ;; postgresql is required to run `psql' but postgis is not required for
15484 ;; proper operation.
15485 (packages (cons* postgresql %base-packages))
15486 (services
15487 (cons*
15488 (postgresql-service #:extension-packages (list postgis))
15489 %base-services)))
15490 @end lisp
15491
15492 Then the extension becomes visible and you can initialise an empty geographic
15493 database in this way:
15494
15495 @example
15496 psql -U postgres
15497 > create database postgistest;
15498 > \connect postgistest;
15499 > create extension postgis;
15500 > create extension postgis_topology;
15501 @end example
15502
15503 There is no need to add this field for contrib extensions such as hstore or
15504 dblink as they are already loadable by postgresql. This field is only
15505 required to add extensions provided by other packages.
15506 @end deffn
15507
15508 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} mysql-service [#:config (mysql-configuration)]
15509 Return a service that runs @command{mysqld}, the MySQL or MariaDB
15510 database server.
15511
15512 The optional @var{config} argument specifies the configuration for
15513 @command{mysqld}, which should be a @code{<mysql-configuration>} object.
15514 @end deffn
15515
15516 @deftp {Data Type} mysql-configuration
15517 Data type representing the configuration of @var{mysql-service}.
15518
15519 @table @asis
15520 @item @code{mysql} (default: @var{mariadb})
15521 Package object of the MySQL database server, can be either @var{mariadb}
15522 or @var{mysql}.
15523
15524 For MySQL, a temporary root password will be displayed at activation time.
15525 For MariaDB, the root password is empty.
15526
15527 @item @code{port} (default: @code{3306})
15528 TCP port on which the database server listens for incoming connections.
15529 @end table
15530 @end deftp
15531
15532 @defvr {Scheme Variable} memcached-service-type
15533 This is the service type for the @uref{https://memcached.org/,
15534 Memcached} service, which provides a distributed in memory cache. The
15535 value for the service type is a @code{memcached-configuration} object.
15536 @end defvr
15537
15538 @lisp
15539 (service memcached-service-type)
15540 @end lisp
15541
15542 @deftp {Data Type} memcached-configuration
15543 Data type representing the configuration of memcached.
15544
15545 @table @asis
15546 @item @code{memcached} (default: @code{memcached})
15547 The Memcached package to use.
15548
15549 @item @code{interfaces} (default: @code{'("0.0.0.0")})
15550 Network interfaces on which to listen.
15551
15552 @item @code{tcp-port} (default: @code{11211})
15553 Port on which to accept connections on,
15554
15555 @item @code{udp-port} (default: @code{11211})
15556 Port on which to accept UDP connections on, a value of 0 will disable
15557 listening on a UDP socket.
15558
15559 @item @code{additional-options} (default: @code{'()})
15560 Additional command line options to pass to @code{memcached}.
15561 @end table
15562 @end deftp
15563
15564 @defvr {Scheme Variable} mongodb-service-type
15565 This is the service type for @uref{https://www.mongodb.com/, MongoDB}.
15566 The value for the service type is a @code{mongodb-configuration} object.
15567 @end defvr
15568
15569 @lisp
15570 (service mongodb-service-type)
15571 @end lisp
15572
15573 @deftp {Data Type} mongodb-configuration
15574 Data type representing the configuration of mongodb.
15575
15576 @table @asis
15577 @item @code{mongodb} (default: @code{mongodb})
15578 The MongoDB package to use.
15579
15580 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{%default-mongodb-configuration-file})
15581 The configuration file for MongoDB.
15582
15583 @item @code{data-directory} (default: @code{"/var/lib/mongodb"})
15584 This value is used to create the directory, so that it exists and is
15585 owned by the mongodb user. It should match the data-directory which
15586 MongoDB is configured to use through the configuration file.
15587 @end table
15588 @end deftp
15589
15590 @defvr {Scheme Variable} redis-service-type
15591 This is the service type for the @uref{https://redis.io/, Redis}
15592 key/value store, whose value is a @code{redis-configuration} object.
15593 @end defvr
15594
15595 @deftp {Data Type} redis-configuration
15596 Data type representing the configuration of redis.
15597
15598 @table @asis
15599 @item @code{redis} (default: @code{redis})
15600 The Redis package to use.
15601
15602 @item @code{bind} (default: @code{"127.0.0.1"})
15603 Network interface on which to listen.
15604
15605 @item @code{port} (default: @code{6379})
15606 Port on which to accept connections on, a value of 0 will disable
15607 listening on a TCP socket.
15608
15609 @item @code{working-directory} (default: @code{"/var/lib/redis"})
15610 Directory in which to store the database and related files.
15611 @end table
15612 @end deftp
15613
15614 @node Mail Services
15615 @subsection Mail Services
15616
15617 @cindex mail
15618 @cindex email
15619 The @code{(gnu services mail)} module provides Guix service definitions
15620 for email services: IMAP, POP3, and LMTP servers, as well as mail
15621 transport agents (MTAs). Lots of acronyms! These services are detailed
15622 in the subsections below.
15623
15624 @subsubheading Dovecot Service
15625
15626 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} dovecot-service [#:config (dovecot-configuration)]
15627 Return a service that runs the Dovecot IMAP/POP3/LMTP mail server.
15628 @end deffn
15629
15630 By default, Dovecot does not need much configuration; the default
15631 configuration object created by @code{(dovecot-configuration)} will
15632 suffice if your mail is delivered to @code{~/Maildir}. A self-signed
15633 certificate will be generated for TLS-protected connections, though
15634 Dovecot will also listen on cleartext ports by default. There are a
15635 number of options, though, which mail administrators might need to change,
15636 and as is the case with other services, Guix allows the system
15637 administrator to specify these parameters via a uniform Scheme interface.
15638
15639 For example, to specify that mail is located at @code{maildir~/.mail},
15640 one would instantiate the Dovecot service like this:
15641
15642 @lisp
15643 (dovecot-service #:config
15644 (dovecot-configuration
15645 (mail-location "maildir:~/.mail")))
15646 @end lisp
15647
15648 The available configuration parameters follow. Each parameter
15649 definition is preceded by its type; for example, @samp{string-list foo}
15650 indicates that the @code{foo} parameter should be specified as a list of
15651 strings. There is also a way to specify the configuration as a string,
15652 if you have an old @code{dovecot.conf} file that you want to port over
15653 from some other system; see the end for more details.
15654
15655 @c The following documentation was initially generated by
15656 @c (generate-documentation) in (gnu services mail). Manually maintained
15657 @c documentation is better, so we shouldn't hesitate to edit below as
15658 @c needed. However if the change you want to make to this documentation
15659 @c can be done in an automated way, it's probably easier to change
15660 @c (generate-documentation) than to make it below and have to deal with
15661 @c the churn as dovecot updates.
15662
15663 Available @code{dovecot-configuration} fields are:
15664
15665 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} package dovecot
15666 The dovecot package.
15667 @end deftypevr
15668
15669 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} comma-separated-string-list listen
15670 A list of IPs or hosts where to listen for connections. @samp{*}
15671 listens on all IPv4 interfaces, @samp{::} listens on all IPv6
15672 interfaces. If you want to specify non-default ports or anything more
15673 complex, customize the address and port fields of the
15674 @samp{inet-listener} of the specific services you are interested in.
15675 @end deftypevr
15676
15677 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} protocol-configuration-list protocols
15678 List of protocols we want to serve. Available protocols include
15679 @samp{imap}, @samp{pop3}, and @samp{lmtp}.
15680
15681 Available @code{protocol-configuration} fields are:
15682
15683 @deftypevr {@code{protocol-configuration} parameter} string name
15684 The name of the protocol.
15685 @end deftypevr
15686
15687 @deftypevr {@code{protocol-configuration} parameter} string auth-socket-path
15688 UNIX socket path to the master authentication server to find users.
15689 This is used by imap (for shared users) and lda.
15690 It defaults to @samp{"/var/run/dovecot/auth-userdb"}.
15691 @end deftypevr
15692
15693 @deftypevr {@code{protocol-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list mail-plugins
15694 Space separated list of plugins to load.
15695 @end deftypevr
15696
15697 @deftypevr {@code{protocol-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer mail-max-userip-connections
15698 Maximum number of IMAP connections allowed for a user from each IP
15699 address. NOTE: The username is compared case-sensitively.
15700 Defaults to @samp{10}.
15701 @end deftypevr
15702
15703 @end deftypevr
15704
15705 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} service-configuration-list services
15706 List of services to enable. Available services include @samp{imap},
15707 @samp{imap-login}, @samp{pop3}, @samp{pop3-login}, @samp{auth}, and
15708 @samp{lmtp}.
15709
15710 Available @code{service-configuration} fields are:
15711
15712 @deftypevr {@code{service-configuration} parameter} string kind
15713 The service kind. Valid values include @code{director},
15714 @code{imap-login}, @code{pop3-login}, @code{lmtp}, @code{imap},
15715 @code{pop3}, @code{auth}, @code{auth-worker}, @code{dict},
15716 @code{tcpwrap}, @code{quota-warning}, or anything else.
15717 @end deftypevr
15718
15719 @deftypevr {@code{service-configuration} parameter} listener-configuration-list listeners
15720 Listeners for the service. A listener is either a
15721 @code{unix-listener-configuration}, a @code{fifo-listener-configuration}, or
15722 an @code{inet-listener-configuration}.
15723 Defaults to @samp{()}.
15724
15725 Available @code{unix-listener-configuration} fields are:
15726
15727 @deftypevr {@code{unix-listener-configuration} parameter} string path
15728 Path to the file, relative to @code{base-dir} field. This is also used as
15729 the section name.
15730 @end deftypevr
15731
15732 @deftypevr {@code{unix-listener-configuration} parameter} string mode
15733 The access mode for the socket.
15734 Defaults to @samp{"0600"}.
15735 @end deftypevr
15736
15737 @deftypevr {@code{unix-listener-configuration} parameter} string user
15738 The user to own the socket.
15739 Defaults to @samp{""}.
15740 @end deftypevr
15741
15742 @deftypevr {@code{unix-listener-configuration} parameter} string group
15743 The group to own the socket.
15744 Defaults to @samp{""}.
15745 @end deftypevr
15746
15747
15748 Available @code{fifo-listener-configuration} fields are:
15749
15750 @deftypevr {@code{fifo-listener-configuration} parameter} string path
15751 Path to the file, relative to @code{base-dir} field. This is also used as
15752 the section name.
15753 @end deftypevr
15754
15755 @deftypevr {@code{fifo-listener-configuration} parameter} string mode
15756 The access mode for the socket.
15757 Defaults to @samp{"0600"}.
15758 @end deftypevr
15759
15760 @deftypevr {@code{fifo-listener-configuration} parameter} string user
15761 The user to own the socket.
15762 Defaults to @samp{""}.
15763 @end deftypevr
15764
15765 @deftypevr {@code{fifo-listener-configuration} parameter} string group
15766 The group to own the socket.
15767 Defaults to @samp{""}.
15768 @end deftypevr
15769
15770
15771 Available @code{inet-listener-configuration} fields are:
15772
15773 @deftypevr {@code{inet-listener-configuration} parameter} string protocol
15774 The protocol to listen for.
15775 @end deftypevr
15776
15777 @deftypevr {@code{inet-listener-configuration} parameter} string address
15778 The address on which to listen, or empty for all addresses.
15779 Defaults to @samp{""}.
15780 @end deftypevr
15781
15782 @deftypevr {@code{inet-listener-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer port
15783 The port on which to listen.
15784 @end deftypevr
15785
15786 @deftypevr {@code{inet-listener-configuration} parameter} boolean ssl?
15787 Whether to use SSL for this service; @samp{yes}, @samp{no}, or
15788 @samp{required}.
15789 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
15790 @end deftypevr
15791
15792 @end deftypevr
15793
15794 @deftypevr {@code{service-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer client-limit
15795 Maximum number of simultaneous client connections per process. Once
15796 this number of connections is received, the next incoming connection
15797 will prompt Dovecot to spawn another process. If set to 0,
15798 @code{default-client-limit} is used instead.
15799
15800 Defaults to @samp{0}.
15801
15802 @end deftypevr
15803
15804 @deftypevr {@code{service-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer service-count
15805 Number of connections to handle before starting a new process.
15806 Typically the only useful values are 0 (unlimited) or 1. 1 is more
15807 secure, but 0 is faster. <doc/wiki/LoginProcess.txt>.
15808 Defaults to @samp{1}.
15809
15810 @end deftypevr
15811
15812 @deftypevr {@code{service-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer process-limit
15813 Maximum number of processes that can exist for this service. If set to
15814 0, @code{default-process-limit} is used instead.
15815
15816 Defaults to @samp{0}.
15817
15818 @end deftypevr
15819
15820 @deftypevr {@code{service-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer process-min-avail
15821 Number of processes to always keep waiting for more connections.
15822 Defaults to @samp{0}.
15823 @end deftypevr
15824
15825 @deftypevr {@code{service-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer vsz-limit
15826 If you set @samp{service-count 0}, you probably need to grow
15827 this.
15828 Defaults to @samp{256000000}.
15829 @end deftypevr
15830
15831 @end deftypevr
15832
15833 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} dict-configuration dict
15834 Dict configuration, as created by the @code{dict-configuration}
15835 constructor.
15836
15837 Available @code{dict-configuration} fields are:
15838
15839 @deftypevr {@code{dict-configuration} parameter} free-form-fields entries
15840 A list of key-value pairs that this dict should hold.
15841 Defaults to @samp{()}.
15842 @end deftypevr
15843
15844 @end deftypevr
15845
15846 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} passdb-configuration-list passdbs
15847 A list of passdb configurations, each one created by the
15848 @code{passdb-configuration} constructor.
15849
15850 Available @code{passdb-configuration} fields are:
15851
15852 @deftypevr {@code{passdb-configuration} parameter} string driver
15853 The driver that the passdb should use. Valid values include
15854 @samp{pam}, @samp{passwd}, @samp{shadow}, @samp{bsdauth}, and
15855 @samp{static}.
15856 Defaults to @samp{"pam"}.
15857 @end deftypevr
15858
15859 @deftypevr {@code{passdb-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list args
15860 Space separated list of arguments to the passdb driver.
15861 Defaults to @samp{""}.
15862 @end deftypevr
15863
15864 @end deftypevr
15865
15866 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} userdb-configuration-list userdbs
15867 List of userdb configurations, each one created by the
15868 @code{userdb-configuration} constructor.
15869
15870 Available @code{userdb-configuration} fields are:
15871
15872 @deftypevr {@code{userdb-configuration} parameter} string driver
15873 The driver that the userdb should use. Valid values include
15874 @samp{passwd} and @samp{static}.
15875 Defaults to @samp{"passwd"}.
15876 @end deftypevr
15877
15878 @deftypevr {@code{userdb-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list args
15879 Space separated list of arguments to the userdb driver.
15880 Defaults to @samp{""}.
15881 @end deftypevr
15882
15883 @deftypevr {@code{userdb-configuration} parameter} free-form-args override-fields
15884 Override fields from passwd.
15885 Defaults to @samp{()}.
15886 @end deftypevr
15887
15888 @end deftypevr
15889
15890 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} plugin-configuration plugin-configuration
15891 Plug-in configuration, created by the @code{plugin-configuration}
15892 constructor.
15893 @end deftypevr
15894
15895 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} list-of-namespace-configuration namespaces
15896 List of namespaces. Each item in the list is created by the
15897 @code{namespace-configuration} constructor.
15898
15899 Available @code{namespace-configuration} fields are:
15900
15901 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} string name
15902 Name for this namespace.
15903 @end deftypevr
15904
15905 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} string type
15906 Namespace type: @samp{private}, @samp{shared} or @samp{public}.
15907 Defaults to @samp{"private"}.
15908 @end deftypevr
15909
15910 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} string separator
15911 Hierarchy separator to use. You should use the same separator for
15912 all namespaces or some clients get confused. @samp{/} is usually a good
15913 one. The default however depends on the underlying mail storage
15914 format.
15915 Defaults to @samp{""}.
15916 @end deftypevr
15917
15918 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} string prefix
15919 Prefix required to access this namespace. This needs to be
15920 different for all namespaces. For example @samp{Public/}.
15921 Defaults to @samp{""}.
15922 @end deftypevr
15923
15924 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} string location
15925 Physical location of the mailbox. This is in the same format as
15926 mail_location, which is also the default for it.
15927 Defaults to @samp{""}.
15928 @end deftypevr
15929
15930 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} boolean inbox?
15931 There can be only one INBOX, and this setting defines which
15932 namespace has it.
15933 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
15934 @end deftypevr
15935
15936 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} boolean hidden?
15937 If namespace is hidden, it's not advertised to clients via NAMESPACE
15938 extension. You'll most likely also want to set @samp{list? #f}. This is mostly
15939 useful when converting from another server with different namespaces
15940 which you want to deprecate but still keep working. For example you can
15941 create hidden namespaces with prefixes @samp{~/mail/}, @samp{~%u/mail/}
15942 and @samp{mail/}.
15943 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
15944 @end deftypevr
15945
15946 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} boolean list?
15947 Show the mailboxes under this namespace with the LIST command. This
15948 makes the namespace visible for clients that do not support the NAMESPACE
15949 extension. The special @code{children} value lists child mailboxes, but
15950 hides the namespace prefix.
15951 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
15952 @end deftypevr
15953
15954 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} boolean subscriptions?
15955 Namespace handles its own subscriptions. If set to @code{#f}, the
15956 parent namespace handles them. The empty prefix should always have this
15957 as @code{#t}).
15958 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
15959 @end deftypevr
15960
15961 @deftypevr {@code{namespace-configuration} parameter} mailbox-configuration-list mailboxes
15962 List of predefined mailboxes in this namespace.
15963 Defaults to @samp{()}.
15964
15965 Available @code{mailbox-configuration} fields are:
15966
15967 @deftypevr {@code{mailbox-configuration} parameter} string name
15968 Name for this mailbox.
15969 @end deftypevr
15970
15971 @deftypevr {@code{mailbox-configuration} parameter} string auto
15972 @samp{create} will automatically create this mailbox.
15973 @samp{subscribe} will both create and subscribe to the mailbox.
15974 Defaults to @samp{"no"}.
15975 @end deftypevr
15976
15977 @deftypevr {@code{mailbox-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list special-use
15978 List of IMAP @code{SPECIAL-USE} attributes as specified by RFC 6154.
15979 Valid values are @code{\All}, @code{\Archive}, @code{\Drafts},
15980 @code{\Flagged}, @code{\Junk}, @code{\Sent}, and @code{\Trash}.
15981 Defaults to @samp{()}.
15982 @end deftypevr
15983
15984 @end deftypevr
15985
15986 @end deftypevr
15987
15988 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} file-name base-dir
15989 Base directory where to store runtime data.
15990 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/dovecot/"}.
15991 @end deftypevr
15992
15993 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string login-greeting
15994 Greeting message for clients.
15995 Defaults to @samp{"Dovecot ready."}.
15996 @end deftypevr
15997
15998 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list login-trusted-networks
15999 List of trusted network ranges. Connections from these IPs are
16000 allowed to override their IP addresses and ports (for logging and for
16001 authentication checks). @samp{disable-plaintext-auth} is also ignored
16002 for these networks. Typically you would specify your IMAP proxy servers
16003 here.
16004 Defaults to @samp{()}.
16005 @end deftypevr
16006
16007 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list login-access-sockets
16008 List of login access check sockets (e.g.@: tcpwrap).
16009 Defaults to @samp{()}.
16010 @end deftypevr
16011
16012 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean verbose-proctitle?
16013 Show more verbose process titles (in ps). Currently shows user name
16014 and IP address. Useful for seeing who is actually using the IMAP
16015 processes (e.g.@: shared mailboxes or if the same uid is used for multiple
16016 accounts).
16017 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
16018 @end deftypevr
16019
16020 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean shutdown-clients?
16021 Should all processes be killed when Dovecot master process shuts down.
16022 Setting this to @code{#f} means that Dovecot can be upgraded without
16023 forcing existing client connections to close (although that could also
16024 be a problem if the upgrade is e.g.@: due to a security fix).
16025 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
16026 @end deftypevr
16027
16028 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer doveadm-worker-count
16029 If non-zero, run mail commands via this many connections to doveadm
16030 server, instead of running them directly in the same process.
16031 Defaults to @samp{0}.
16032 @end deftypevr
16033
16034 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string doveadm-socket-path
16035 UNIX socket or host:port used for connecting to doveadm server.
16036 Defaults to @samp{"doveadm-server"}.
16037 @end deftypevr
16038
16039 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list import-environment
16040 List of environment variables that are preserved on Dovecot startup
16041 and passed down to all of its child processes. You can also give
16042 key=value pairs to always set specific settings.
16043 @end deftypevr
16044
16045 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean disable-plaintext-auth?
16046 Disable LOGIN command and all other plaintext authentications unless
16047 SSL/TLS is used (LOGINDISABLED capability). Note that if the remote IP
16048 matches the local IP (i.e.@: you're connecting from the same computer),
16049 the connection is considered secure and plaintext authentication is
16050 allowed. See also ssl=required setting.
16051 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
16052 @end deftypevr
16053
16054 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer auth-cache-size
16055 Authentication cache size (e.g.@: @samp{#e10e6}). 0 means it's disabled.
16056 Note that bsdauth, PAM and vpopmail require @samp{cache-key} to be set
16057 for caching to be used.
16058 Defaults to @samp{0}.
16059 @end deftypevr
16060
16061 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-cache-ttl
16062 Time to live for cached data. After TTL expires the cached record
16063 is no longer used, *except* if the main database lookup returns internal
16064 failure. We also try to handle password changes automatically: If
16065 user's previous authentication was successful, but this one wasn't, the
16066 cache isn't used. For now this works only with plaintext
16067 authentication.
16068 Defaults to @samp{"1 hour"}.
16069 @end deftypevr
16070
16071 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-cache-negative-ttl
16072 TTL for negative hits (user not found, password mismatch).
16073 0 disables caching them completely.
16074 Defaults to @samp{"1 hour"}.
16075 @end deftypevr
16076
16077 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list auth-realms
16078 List of realms for SASL authentication mechanisms that need them.
16079 You can leave it empty if you don't want to support multiple realms.
16080 Many clients simply use the first one listed here, so keep the default
16081 realm first.
16082 Defaults to @samp{()}.
16083 @end deftypevr
16084
16085 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-default-realm
16086 Default realm/domain to use if none was specified. This is used for
16087 both SASL realms and appending @@domain to username in plaintext
16088 logins.
16089 Defaults to @samp{""}.
16090 @end deftypevr
16091
16092 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-username-chars
16093 List of allowed characters in username. If the user-given username
16094 contains a character not listed in here, the login automatically fails.
16095 This is just an extra check to make sure user can't exploit any
16096 potential quote escaping vulnerabilities with SQL/LDAP databases. If
16097 you want to allow all characters, set this value to empty.
16098 Defaults to @samp{"abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyzABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ01234567890.-_@@"}.
16099 @end deftypevr
16100
16101 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-username-translation
16102 Username character translations before it's looked up from
16103 databases. The value contains series of from -> to characters. For
16104 example @samp{#@@/@@} means that @samp{#} and @samp{/} characters are
16105 translated to @samp{@@}.
16106 Defaults to @samp{""}.
16107 @end deftypevr
16108
16109 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-username-format
16110 Username formatting before it's looked up from databases. You can
16111 use the standard variables here, e.g.@: %Lu would lowercase the username,
16112 %n would drop away the domain if it was given, or @samp{%n-AT-%d} would
16113 change the @samp{@@} into @samp{-AT-}. This translation is done after
16114 @samp{auth-username-translation} changes.
16115 Defaults to @samp{"%Lu"}.
16116 @end deftypevr
16117
16118 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-master-user-separator
16119 If you want to allow master users to log in by specifying the master
16120 username within the normal username string (i.e.@: not using SASL
16121 mechanism's support for it), you can specify the separator character
16122 here. The format is then <username><separator><master username>.
16123 UW-IMAP uses @samp{*} as the separator, so that could be a good
16124 choice.
16125 Defaults to @samp{""}.
16126 @end deftypevr
16127
16128 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-anonymous-username
16129 Username to use for users logging in with ANONYMOUS SASL
16130 mechanism.
16131 Defaults to @samp{"anonymous"}.
16132 @end deftypevr
16133
16134 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer auth-worker-max-count
16135 Maximum number of dovecot-auth worker processes. They're used to
16136 execute blocking passdb and userdb queries (e.g.@: MySQL and PAM).
16137 They're automatically created and destroyed as needed.
16138 Defaults to @samp{30}.
16139 @end deftypevr
16140
16141 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-gssapi-hostname
16142 Host name to use in GSSAPI principal names. The default is to use
16143 the name returned by gethostname(). Use @samp{$ALL} (with quotes) to
16144 allow all keytab entries.
16145 Defaults to @samp{""}.
16146 @end deftypevr
16147
16148 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-krb5-keytab
16149 Kerberos keytab to use for the GSSAPI mechanism. Will use the
16150 system default (usually @file{/etc/krb5.keytab}) if not specified. You may
16151 need to change the auth service to run as root to be able to read this
16152 file.
16153 Defaults to @samp{""}.
16154 @end deftypevr
16155
16156 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-use-winbind?
16157 Do NTLM and GSS-SPNEGO authentication using Samba's winbind daemon
16158 and @samp{ntlm-auth} helper.
16159 <doc/wiki/Authentication/Mechanisms/Winbind.txt>.
16160 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
16161 @end deftypevr
16162
16163 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} file-name auth-winbind-helper-path
16164 Path for Samba's @samp{ntlm-auth} helper binary.
16165 Defaults to @samp{"/usr/bin/ntlm_auth"}.
16166 @end deftypevr
16167
16168 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-failure-delay
16169 Time to delay before replying to failed authentications.
16170 Defaults to @samp{"2 secs"}.
16171 @end deftypevr
16172
16173 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-ssl-require-client-cert?
16174 Require a valid SSL client certificate or the authentication
16175 fails.
16176 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
16177 @end deftypevr
16178
16179 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-ssl-username-from-cert?
16180 Take the username from client's SSL certificate, using
16181 @code{X509_NAME_get_text_by_NID()} which returns the subject's DN's
16182 CommonName.
16183 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
16184 @end deftypevr
16185
16186 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list auth-mechanisms
16187 List of wanted authentication mechanisms. Supported mechanisms are:
16188 @samp{plain}, @samp{login}, @samp{digest-md5}, @samp{cram-md5},
16189 @samp{ntlm}, @samp{rpa}, @samp{apop}, @samp{anonymous}, @samp{gssapi},
16190 @samp{otp}, @samp{skey}, and @samp{gss-spnego}. NOTE: See also
16191 @samp{disable-plaintext-auth} setting.
16192 @end deftypevr
16193
16194 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list director-servers
16195 List of IPs or hostnames to all director servers, including ourself.
16196 Ports can be specified as ip:port. The default port is the same as what
16197 director service's @samp{inet-listener} is using.
16198 Defaults to @samp{()}.
16199 @end deftypevr
16200
16201 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list director-mail-servers
16202 List of IPs or hostnames to all backend mail servers. Ranges are
16203 allowed too, like 10.0.0.10-10.0.0.30.
16204 Defaults to @samp{()}.
16205 @end deftypevr
16206
16207 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string director-user-expire
16208 How long to redirect users to a specific server after it no longer
16209 has any connections.
16210 Defaults to @samp{"15 min"}.
16211 @end deftypevr
16212
16213 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string director-username-hash
16214 How the username is translated before being hashed. Useful values
16215 include %Ln if user can log in with or without @@domain, %Ld if mailboxes
16216 are shared within domain.
16217 Defaults to @samp{"%Lu"}.
16218 @end deftypevr
16219
16220 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string log-path
16221 Log file to use for error messages. @samp{syslog} logs to syslog,
16222 @samp{/dev/stderr} logs to stderr.
16223 Defaults to @samp{"syslog"}.
16224 @end deftypevr
16225
16226 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string info-log-path
16227 Log file to use for informational messages. Defaults to
16228 @samp{log-path}.
16229 Defaults to @samp{""}.
16230 @end deftypevr
16231
16232 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string debug-log-path
16233 Log file to use for debug messages. Defaults to
16234 @samp{info-log-path}.
16235 Defaults to @samp{""}.
16236 @end deftypevr
16237
16238 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string syslog-facility
16239 Syslog facility to use if you're logging to syslog. Usually if you
16240 don't want to use @samp{mail}, you'll use local0..local7. Also other
16241 standard facilities are supported.
16242 Defaults to @samp{"mail"}.
16243 @end deftypevr
16244
16245 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-verbose?
16246 Log unsuccessful authentication attempts and the reasons why they
16247 failed.
16248 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
16249 @end deftypevr
16250
16251 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string auth-verbose-passwords
16252 In case of password mismatches, log the attempted password. Valid
16253 values are no, plain and sha1. sha1 can be useful for detecting brute
16254 force password attempts vs. user simply trying the same password over
16255 and over again. You can also truncate the value to n chars by appending
16256 ":n" (e.g.@: sha1:6).
16257 Defaults to @samp{"no"}.
16258 @end deftypevr
16259
16260 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-debug?
16261 Even more verbose logging for debugging purposes. Shows for example
16262 SQL queries.
16263 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
16264 @end deftypevr
16265
16266 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean auth-debug-passwords?
16267 In case of password mismatches, log the passwords and used scheme so
16268 the problem can be debugged. Enabling this also enables
16269 @samp{auth-debug}.
16270 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
16271 @end deftypevr
16272
16273 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mail-debug?
16274 Enable mail process debugging. This can help you figure out why
16275 Dovecot isn't finding your mails.
16276 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
16277 @end deftypevr
16278
16279 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean verbose-ssl?
16280 Show protocol level SSL errors.
16281 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
16282 @end deftypevr
16283
16284 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string log-timestamp
16285 Prefix for each line written to log file. % codes are in
16286 strftime(3) format.
16287 Defaults to @samp{"\"%b %d %H:%M:%S \""}.
16288 @end deftypevr
16289
16290 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list login-log-format-elements
16291 List of elements we want to log. The elements which have a
16292 non-empty variable value are joined together to form a comma-separated
16293 string.
16294 @end deftypevr
16295
16296 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string login-log-format
16297 Login log format. %s contains @samp{login-log-format-elements}
16298 string, %$ contains the data we want to log.
16299 Defaults to @samp{"%$: %s"}.
16300 @end deftypevr
16301
16302 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-log-prefix
16303 Log prefix for mail processes. See doc/wiki/Variables.txt for list
16304 of possible variables you can use.
16305 Defaults to @samp{"\"%s(%u)<%@{pid@}><%@{session@}>: \""}.
16306 @end deftypevr
16307
16308 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string deliver-log-format
16309 Format to use for logging mail deliveries. You can use variables:
16310 @table @code
16311 @item %$
16312 Delivery status message (e.g.@: @samp{saved to INBOX})
16313 @item %m
16314 Message-ID
16315 @item %s
16316 Subject
16317 @item %f
16318 From address
16319 @item %p
16320 Physical size
16321 @item %w
16322 Virtual size.
16323 @end table
16324 Defaults to @samp{"msgid=%m: %$"}.
16325 @end deftypevr
16326
16327 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-location
16328 Location for users' mailboxes. The default is empty, which means
16329 that Dovecot tries to find the mailboxes automatically. This won't work
16330 if the user doesn't yet have any mail, so you should explicitly tell
16331 Dovecot the full location.
16332
16333 If you're using mbox, giving a path to the INBOX
16334 file (e.g.@: /var/mail/%u) isn't enough. You'll also need to tell Dovecot
16335 where the other mailboxes are kept. This is called the "root mail
16336 directory", and it must be the first path given in the
16337 @samp{mail-location} setting.
16338
16339 There are a few special variables you can use, eg.:
16340
16341 @table @samp
16342 @item %u
16343 username
16344 @item %n
16345 user part in user@@domain, same as %u if there's no domain
16346 @item %d
16347 domain part in user@@domain, empty if there's no domain
16348 @item %h
16349 home director
16350 @end table
16351
16352 See doc/wiki/Variables.txt for full list. Some examples:
16353 @table @samp
16354 @item maildir:~/Maildir
16355 @item mbox:~/mail:INBOX=/var/mail/%u
16356 @item mbox:/var/mail/%d/%1n/%n:INDEX=/var/indexes/%d/%1n/%
16357 @end table
16358 Defaults to @samp{""}.
16359 @end deftypevr
16360
16361 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-uid
16362 System user and group used to access mails. If you use multiple,
16363 userdb can override these by returning uid or gid fields. You can use
16364 either numbers or names. <doc/wiki/UserIds.txt>.
16365 Defaults to @samp{""}.
16366 @end deftypevr
16367
16368 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-gid
16369
16370 Defaults to @samp{""}.
16371 @end deftypevr
16372
16373 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-privileged-group
16374 Group to enable temporarily for privileged operations. Currently
16375 this is used only with INBOX when either its initial creation or
16376 dotlocking fails. Typically this is set to "mail" to give access to
16377 /var/mail.
16378 Defaults to @samp{""}.
16379 @end deftypevr
16380
16381 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-access-groups
16382 Grant access to these supplementary groups for mail processes.
16383 Typically these are used to set up access to shared mailboxes. Note
16384 that it may be dangerous to set these if users can create
16385 symlinks (e.g.@: if "mail" group is set here, ln -s /var/mail ~/mail/var
16386 could allow a user to delete others' mailboxes, or ln -s
16387 /secret/shared/box ~/mail/mybox would allow reading it).
16388 Defaults to @samp{""}.
16389 @end deftypevr
16390
16391 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mail-full-filesystem-access?
16392 Allow full file system access to clients. There's no access checks
16393 other than what the operating system does for the active UID/GID. It
16394 works with both maildir and mboxes, allowing you to prefix mailboxes
16395 names with e.g.@: /path/ or ~user/.
16396 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
16397 @end deftypevr
16398
16399 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mmap-disable?
16400 Don't use mmap() at all. This is required if you store indexes to
16401 shared file systems (NFS or clustered file system).
16402 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
16403 @end deftypevr
16404
16405 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean dotlock-use-excl?
16406 Rely on @samp{O_EXCL} to work when creating dotlock files. NFS
16407 supports @samp{O_EXCL} since version 3, so this should be safe to use
16408 nowadays by default.
16409 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
16410 @end deftypevr
16411
16412 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-fsync
16413 When to use fsync() or fdatasync() calls:
16414 @table @code
16415 @item optimized
16416 Whenever necessary to avoid losing important data
16417 @item always
16418 Useful with e.g.@: NFS when write()s are delayed
16419 @item never
16420 Never use it (best performance, but crashes can lose data).
16421 @end table
16422 Defaults to @samp{"optimized"}.
16423 @end deftypevr
16424
16425 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mail-nfs-storage?
16426 Mail storage exists in NFS. Set this to yes to make Dovecot flush
16427 NFS caches whenever needed. If you're using only a single mail server
16428 this isn't needed.
16429 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
16430 @end deftypevr
16431
16432 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mail-nfs-index?
16433 Mail index files also exist in NFS. Setting this to yes requires
16434 @samp{mmap-disable? #t} and @samp{fsync-disable? #f}.
16435 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
16436 @end deftypevr
16437
16438 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string lock-method
16439 Locking method for index files. Alternatives are fcntl, flock and
16440 dotlock. Dotlocking uses some tricks which may create more disk I/O
16441 than other locking methods. NFS users: flock doesn't work, remember to
16442 change @samp{mmap-disable}.
16443 Defaults to @samp{"fcntl"}.
16444 @end deftypevr
16445
16446 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} file-name mail-temp-dir
16447 Directory in which LDA/LMTP temporarily stores incoming mails >128
16448 kB.
16449 Defaults to @samp{"/tmp"}.
16450 @end deftypevr
16451
16452 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer first-valid-uid
16453 Valid UID range for users. This is mostly to make sure that users can't
16454 log in as daemons or other system users. Note that denying root logins is
16455 hardcoded to dovecot binary and can't be done even if @samp{first-valid-uid}
16456 is set to 0.
16457 Defaults to @samp{500}.
16458 @end deftypevr
16459
16460 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer last-valid-uid
16461
16462 Defaults to @samp{0}.
16463 @end deftypevr
16464
16465 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer first-valid-gid
16466 Valid GID range for users. Users having non-valid GID as primary group ID
16467 aren't allowed to log in. If user belongs to supplementary groups with
16468 non-valid GIDs, those groups are not set.
16469 Defaults to @samp{1}.
16470 @end deftypevr
16471
16472 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer last-valid-gid
16473
16474 Defaults to @samp{0}.
16475 @end deftypevr
16476
16477 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer mail-max-keyword-length
16478 Maximum allowed length for mail keyword name. It's only forced when
16479 trying to create new keywords.
16480 Defaults to @samp{50}.
16481 @end deftypevr
16482
16483 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} colon-separated-file-name-list valid-chroot-dirs
16484 List of directories under which chrooting is allowed for mail
16485 processes (i.e.@: /var/mail will allow chrooting to /var/mail/foo/bar
16486 too). This setting doesn't affect @samp{login-chroot}
16487 @samp{mail-chroot} or auth chroot settings. If this setting is empty,
16488 "/./" in home dirs are ignored. WARNING: Never add directories here
16489 which local users can modify, that may lead to root exploit. Usually
16490 this should be done only if you don't allow shell access for users.
16491 <doc/wiki/Chrooting.txt>.
16492 Defaults to @samp{()}.
16493 @end deftypevr
16494
16495 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-chroot
16496 Default chroot directory for mail processes. This can be overridden
16497 for specific users in user database by giving /./ in user's home
16498 directory (e.g.@: /home/./user chroots into /home). Note that usually
16499 there is no real need to do chrooting, Dovecot doesn't allow users to
16500 access files outside their mail directory anyway. If your home
16501 directories are prefixed with the chroot directory, append "/."@: to
16502 @samp{mail-chroot}. <doc/wiki/Chrooting.txt>.
16503 Defaults to @samp{""}.
16504 @end deftypevr
16505
16506 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} file-name auth-socket-path
16507 UNIX socket path to master authentication server to find users.
16508 This is used by imap (for shared users) and lda.
16509 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/dovecot/auth-userdb"}.
16510 @end deftypevr
16511
16512 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} file-name mail-plugin-dir
16513 Directory where to look up mail plugins.
16514 Defaults to @samp{"/usr/lib/dovecot"}.
16515 @end deftypevr
16516
16517 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list mail-plugins
16518 List of plugins to load for all services. Plugins specific to IMAP,
16519 LDA, etc.@: are added to this list in their own .conf files.
16520 Defaults to @samp{()}.
16521 @end deftypevr
16522
16523 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer mail-cache-min-mail-count
16524 The minimum number of mails in a mailbox before updates are done to
16525 cache file. This allows optimizing Dovecot's behavior to do less disk
16526 writes at the cost of more disk reads.
16527 Defaults to @samp{0}.
16528 @end deftypevr
16529
16530 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mailbox-idle-check-interval
16531 When IDLE command is running, mailbox is checked once in a while to
16532 see if there are any new mails or other changes. This setting defines
16533 the minimum time to wait between those checks. Dovecot can also use
16534 dnotify, inotify and kqueue to find out immediately when changes
16535 occur.
16536 Defaults to @samp{"30 secs"}.
16537 @end deftypevr
16538
16539 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mail-save-crlf?
16540 Save mails with CR+LF instead of plain LF. This makes sending those
16541 mails take less CPU, especially with sendfile() syscall with Linux and
16542 FreeBSD. But it also creates a bit more disk I/O which may just make it
16543 slower. Also note that if other software reads the mboxes/maildirs,
16544 they may handle the extra CRs wrong and cause problems.
16545 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
16546 @end deftypevr
16547
16548 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean maildir-stat-dirs?
16549 By default LIST command returns all entries in maildir beginning
16550 with a dot. Enabling this option makes Dovecot return only entries
16551 which are directories. This is done by stat()ing each entry, so it
16552 causes more disk I/O.
16553 (For systems setting struct @samp{dirent->d_type} this check is free
16554 and it's done always regardless of this setting).
16555 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
16556 @end deftypevr
16557
16558 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean maildir-copy-with-hardlinks?
16559 When copying a message, do it with hard links whenever possible.
16560 This makes the performance much better, and it's unlikely to have any
16561 side effects.
16562 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
16563 @end deftypevr
16564
16565 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean maildir-very-dirty-syncs?
16566 Assume Dovecot is the only MUA accessing Maildir: Scan cur/
16567 directory only when its mtime changes unexpectedly or when we can't find
16568 the mail otherwise.
16569 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
16570 @end deftypevr
16571
16572 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list mbox-read-locks
16573 Which locking methods to use for locking mbox. There are four
16574 available:
16575
16576 @table @code
16577 @item dotlock
16578 Create <mailbox>.lock file. This is the oldest and most NFS-safe
16579 solution. If you want to use /var/mail/ like directory, the users will
16580 need write access to that directory.
16581 @item dotlock-try
16582 Same as dotlock, but if it fails because of permissions or because there
16583 isn't enough disk space, just skip it.
16584 @item fcntl
16585 Use this if possible. Works with NFS too if lockd is used.
16586 @item flock
16587 May not exist in all systems. Doesn't work with NFS.
16588 @item lockf
16589 May not exist in all systems. Doesn't work with NFS.
16590 @end table
16591
16592 You can use multiple locking methods; if you do the order they're declared
16593 in is important to avoid deadlocks if other MTAs/MUAs are using multiple
16594 locking methods as well. Some operating systems don't allow using some of
16595 them simultaneously.
16596 @end deftypevr
16597
16598 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list mbox-write-locks
16599
16600 @end deftypevr
16601
16602 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mbox-lock-timeout
16603 Maximum time to wait for lock (all of them) before aborting.
16604 Defaults to @samp{"5 mins"}.
16605 @end deftypevr
16606
16607 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mbox-dotlock-change-timeout
16608 If dotlock exists but the mailbox isn't modified in any way,
16609 override the lock file after this much time.
16610 Defaults to @samp{"2 mins"}.
16611 @end deftypevr
16612
16613 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mbox-dirty-syncs?
16614 When mbox changes unexpectedly we have to fully read it to find out
16615 what changed. If the mbox is large this can take a long time. Since
16616 the change is usually just a newly appended mail, it'd be faster to
16617 simply read the new mails. If this setting is enabled, Dovecot does
16618 this but still safely fallbacks to re-reading the whole mbox file
16619 whenever something in mbox isn't how it's expected to be. The only real
16620 downside to this setting is that if some other MUA changes message
16621 flags, Dovecot doesn't notice it immediately. Note that a full sync is
16622 done with SELECT, EXAMINE, EXPUNGE and CHECK commands.
16623 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
16624 @end deftypevr
16625
16626 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mbox-very-dirty-syncs?
16627 Like @samp{mbox-dirty-syncs}, but don't do full syncs even with SELECT,
16628 EXAMINE, EXPUNGE or CHECK commands. If this is set,
16629 @samp{mbox-dirty-syncs} is ignored.
16630 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
16631 @end deftypevr
16632
16633 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mbox-lazy-writes?
16634 Delay writing mbox headers until doing a full write sync (EXPUNGE
16635 and CHECK commands and when closing the mailbox). This is especially
16636 useful for POP3 where clients often delete all mails. The downside is
16637 that our changes aren't immediately visible to other MUAs.
16638 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
16639 @end deftypevr
16640
16641 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer mbox-min-index-size
16642 If mbox size is smaller than this (e.g.@: 100k), don't write index
16643 files. If an index file already exists it's still read, just not
16644 updated.
16645 Defaults to @samp{0}.
16646 @end deftypevr
16647
16648 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer mdbox-rotate-size
16649 Maximum dbox file size until it's rotated.
16650 Defaults to @samp{10000000}.
16651 @end deftypevr
16652
16653 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mdbox-rotate-interval
16654 Maximum dbox file age until it's rotated. Typically in days. Day
16655 begins from midnight, so 1d = today, 2d = yesterday, etc. 0 = check
16656 disabled.
16657 Defaults to @samp{"1d"}.
16658 @end deftypevr
16659
16660 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean mdbox-preallocate-space?
16661 When creating new mdbox files, immediately preallocate their size to
16662 @samp{mdbox-rotate-size}. This setting currently works only in Linux
16663 with some file systems (ext4, xfs).
16664 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
16665 @end deftypevr
16666
16667 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-attachment-dir
16668 sdbox and mdbox support saving mail attachments to external files,
16669 which also allows single instance storage for them. Other backends
16670 don't support this for now.
16671
16672 WARNING: This feature hasn't been tested much yet. Use at your own risk.
16673
16674 Directory root where to store mail attachments. Disabled, if empty.
16675 Defaults to @samp{""}.
16676 @end deftypevr
16677
16678 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer mail-attachment-min-size
16679 Attachments smaller than this aren't saved externally. It's also
16680 possible to write a plugin to disable saving specific attachments
16681 externally.
16682 Defaults to @samp{128000}.
16683 @end deftypevr
16684
16685 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-attachment-fs
16686 File system backend to use for saving attachments:
16687 @table @code
16688 @item posix
16689 No SiS done by Dovecot (but this might help FS's own deduplication)
16690 @item sis posix
16691 SiS with immediate byte-by-byte comparison during saving
16692 @item sis-queue posix
16693 SiS with delayed comparison and deduplication.
16694 @end table
16695 Defaults to @samp{"sis posix"}.
16696 @end deftypevr
16697
16698 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string mail-attachment-hash
16699 Hash format to use in attachment filenames. You can add any text and
16700 variables: @code{%@{md4@}}, @code{%@{md5@}}, @code{%@{sha1@}},
16701 @code{%@{sha256@}}, @code{%@{sha512@}}, @code{%@{size@}}. Variables can be
16702 truncated, e.g.@: @code{%@{sha256:80@}} returns only first 80 bits.
16703 Defaults to @samp{"%@{sha1@}"}.
16704 @end deftypevr
16705
16706 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer default-process-limit
16707
16708 Defaults to @samp{100}.
16709 @end deftypevr
16710
16711 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer default-client-limit
16712
16713 Defaults to @samp{1000}.
16714 @end deftypevr
16715
16716 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer default-vsz-limit
16717 Default VSZ (virtual memory size) limit for service processes.
16718 This is mainly intended to catch and kill processes that leak memory
16719 before they eat up everything.
16720 Defaults to @samp{256000000}.
16721 @end deftypevr
16722
16723 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string default-login-user
16724 Login user is internally used by login processes. This is the most
16725 untrusted user in Dovecot system. It shouldn't have access to anything
16726 at all.
16727 Defaults to @samp{"dovenull"}.
16728 @end deftypevr
16729
16730 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string default-internal-user
16731 Internal user is used by unprivileged processes. It should be
16732 separate from login user, so that login processes can't disturb other
16733 processes.
16734 Defaults to @samp{"dovecot"}.
16735 @end deftypevr
16736
16737 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl?
16738 SSL/TLS support: yes, no, required. <doc/wiki/SSL.txt>.
16739 Defaults to @samp{"required"}.
16740 @end deftypevr
16741
16742 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-cert
16743 PEM encoded X.509 SSL/TLS certificate (public key).
16744 Defaults to @samp{"</etc/dovecot/default.pem"}.
16745 @end deftypevr
16746
16747 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-key
16748 PEM encoded SSL/TLS private key. The key is opened before
16749 dropping root privileges, so keep the key file unreadable by anyone but
16750 root.
16751 Defaults to @samp{"</etc/dovecot/private/default.pem"}.
16752 @end deftypevr
16753
16754 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-key-password
16755 If key file is password protected, give the password here.
16756 Alternatively give it when starting dovecot with -p parameter. Since
16757 this file is often world-readable, you may want to place this setting
16758 instead to a different.
16759 Defaults to @samp{""}.
16760 @end deftypevr
16761
16762 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-ca
16763 PEM encoded trusted certificate authority. Set this only if you
16764 intend to use @samp{ssl-verify-client-cert? #t}. The file should
16765 contain the CA certificate(s) followed by the matching
16766 CRL(s). (e.g.@: @samp{ssl-ca </etc/ssl/certs/ca.pem}).
16767 Defaults to @samp{""}.
16768 @end deftypevr
16769
16770 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean ssl-require-crl?
16771 Require that CRL check succeeds for client certificates.
16772 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
16773 @end deftypevr
16774
16775 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean ssl-verify-client-cert?
16776 Request client to send a certificate. If you also want to require
16777 it, set @samp{auth-ssl-require-client-cert? #t} in auth section.
16778 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
16779 @end deftypevr
16780
16781 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-cert-username-field
16782 Which field from certificate to use for username. commonName and
16783 x500UniqueIdentifier are the usual choices. You'll also need to set
16784 @samp{auth-ssl-username-from-cert? #t}.
16785 Defaults to @samp{"commonName"}.
16786 @end deftypevr
16787
16788 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-min-protocol
16789 Minimum SSL protocol version to accept.
16790 Defaults to @samp{"TLSv1"}.
16791 @end deftypevr
16792
16793 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-cipher-list
16794 SSL ciphers to use.
16795 Defaults to @samp{"ALL:!kRSA:!SRP:!kDHd:!DSS:!aNULL:!eNULL:!EXPORT:!DES:!3DES:!MD5:!PSK:!RC4:!ADH:!LOW@@STRENGTH"}.
16796 @end deftypevr
16797
16798 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string ssl-crypto-device
16799 SSL crypto device to use, for valid values run "openssl engine".
16800 Defaults to @samp{""}.
16801 @end deftypevr
16802
16803 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string postmaster-address
16804 Address to use when sending rejection mails.
16805 %d expands to recipient domain.
16806 Defaults to @samp{"postmaster@@%d"}.
16807 @end deftypevr
16808
16809 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string hostname
16810 Hostname to use in various parts of sent mails (e.g.@: in Message-Id)
16811 and in LMTP replies. Default is the system's real hostname@@domain.
16812 Defaults to @samp{""}.
16813 @end deftypevr
16814
16815 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean quota-full-tempfail?
16816 If user is over quota, return with temporary failure instead of
16817 bouncing the mail.
16818 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
16819 @end deftypevr
16820
16821 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} file-name sendmail-path
16822 Binary to use for sending mails.
16823 Defaults to @samp{"/usr/sbin/sendmail"}.
16824 @end deftypevr
16825
16826 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string submission-host
16827 If non-empty, send mails via this SMTP host[:port] instead of
16828 sendmail.
16829 Defaults to @samp{""}.
16830 @end deftypevr
16831
16832 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string rejection-subject
16833 Subject: header to use for rejection mails. You can use the same
16834 variables as for @samp{rejection-reason} below.
16835 Defaults to @samp{"Rejected: %s"}.
16836 @end deftypevr
16837
16838 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string rejection-reason
16839 Human readable error message for rejection mails. You can use
16840 variables:
16841
16842 @table @code
16843 @item %n
16844 CRLF
16845 @item %r
16846 reason
16847 @item %s
16848 original subject
16849 @item %t
16850 recipient
16851 @end table
16852 Defaults to @samp{"Your message to <%t> was automatically rejected:%n%r"}.
16853 @end deftypevr
16854
16855 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string recipient-delimiter
16856 Delimiter character between local-part and detail in email
16857 address.
16858 Defaults to @samp{"+"}.
16859 @end deftypevr
16860
16861 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string lda-original-recipient-header
16862 Header where the original recipient address (SMTP's RCPT TO:
16863 address) is taken from if not available elsewhere. With dovecot-lda -a
16864 parameter overrides this. A commonly used header for this is
16865 X-Original-To.
16866 Defaults to @samp{""}.
16867 @end deftypevr
16868
16869 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean lda-mailbox-autocreate?
16870 Should saving a mail to a nonexistent mailbox automatically create
16871 it?.
16872 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
16873 @end deftypevr
16874
16875 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} boolean lda-mailbox-autosubscribe?
16876 Should automatically created mailboxes be also automatically
16877 subscribed?.
16878 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
16879 @end deftypevr
16880
16881 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer imap-max-line-length
16882 Maximum IMAP command line length. Some clients generate very long
16883 command lines with huge mailboxes, so you may need to raise this if you
16884 get "Too long argument" or "IMAP command line too large" errors
16885 often.
16886 Defaults to @samp{64000}.
16887 @end deftypevr
16888
16889 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string imap-logout-format
16890 IMAP logout format string:
16891 @table @code
16892 @item %i
16893 total number of bytes read from client
16894 @item %o
16895 total number of bytes sent to client.
16896 @end table
16897 See @file{doc/wiki/Variables.txt} for a list of all the variables you can use.
16898 Defaults to @samp{"in=%i out=%o deleted=%@{deleted@} expunged=%@{expunged@} trashed=%@{trashed@} hdr_count=%@{fetch_hdr_count@} hdr_bytes=%@{fetch_hdr_bytes@} body_count=%@{fetch_body_count@} body_bytes=%@{fetch_body_bytes@}"}.
16899 @end deftypevr
16900
16901 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string imap-capability
16902 Override the IMAP CAPABILITY response. If the value begins with '+',
16903 add the given capabilities on top of the defaults (e.g.@: +XFOO XBAR).
16904 Defaults to @samp{""}.
16905 @end deftypevr
16906
16907 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string imap-idle-notify-interval
16908 How long to wait between "OK Still here" notifications when client
16909 is IDLEing.
16910 Defaults to @samp{"2 mins"}.
16911 @end deftypevr
16912
16913 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string imap-id-send
16914 ID field names and values to send to clients. Using * as the value
16915 makes Dovecot use the default value. The following fields have default
16916 values currently: name, version, os, os-version, support-url,
16917 support-email.
16918 Defaults to @samp{""}.
16919 @end deftypevr
16920
16921 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string imap-id-log
16922 ID fields sent by client to log. * means everything.
16923 Defaults to @samp{""}.
16924 @end deftypevr
16925
16926 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list imap-client-workarounds
16927 Workarounds for various client bugs:
16928
16929 @table @code
16930 @item delay-newmail
16931 Send EXISTS/RECENT new mail notifications only when replying to NOOP and
16932 CHECK commands. Some clients ignore them otherwise, for example OSX
16933 Mail (<v2.1). Outlook Express breaks more badly though, without this it
16934 may show user "Message no longer in server" errors. Note that OE6
16935 still breaks even with this workaround if synchronization is set to
16936 "Headers Only".
16937
16938 @item tb-extra-mailbox-sep
16939 Thunderbird gets somehow confused with LAYOUT=fs (mbox and dbox) and
16940 adds extra @samp{/} suffixes to mailbox names. This option causes Dovecot to
16941 ignore the extra @samp{/} instead of treating it as invalid mailbox name.
16942
16943 @item tb-lsub-flags
16944 Show \Noselect flags for LSUB replies with LAYOUT=fs (e.g.@: mbox).
16945 This makes Thunderbird realize they aren't selectable and show them
16946 greyed out, instead of only later giving "not selectable" popup error.
16947 @end table
16948 Defaults to @samp{()}.
16949 @end deftypevr
16950
16951 @deftypevr {@code{dovecot-configuration} parameter} string imap-urlauth-host
16952 Host allowed in URLAUTH URLs sent by client. "*" allows all.
16953 Defaults to @samp{""}.
16954 @end deftypevr
16955
16956
16957 Whew! Lots of configuration options. The nice thing about it though is
16958 that Guix has a complete interface to Dovecot's configuration
16959 language. This allows not only a nice way to declare configurations,
16960 but also offers reflective capabilities as well: users can write code to
16961 inspect and transform configurations from within Scheme.
16962
16963 However, it could be that you just want to get a @code{dovecot.conf} up
16964 and running. In that case, you can pass an
16965 @code{opaque-dovecot-configuration} as the @code{#:config} parameter to
16966 @code{dovecot-service}. As its name indicates, an opaque configuration
16967 does not have easy reflective capabilities.
16968
16969 Available @code{opaque-dovecot-configuration} fields are:
16970
16971 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-dovecot-configuration} parameter} package dovecot
16972 The dovecot package.
16973 @end deftypevr
16974
16975 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-dovecot-configuration} parameter} string string
16976 The contents of the @code{dovecot.conf}, as a string.
16977 @end deftypevr
16978
16979 For example, if your @code{dovecot.conf} is just the empty string, you
16980 could instantiate a dovecot service like this:
16981
16982 @lisp
16983 (dovecot-service #:config
16984 (opaque-dovecot-configuration
16985 (string "")))
16986 @end lisp
16987
16988 @subsubheading OpenSMTPD Service
16989
16990 @deffn {Scheme Variable} opensmtpd-service-type
16991 This is the type of the @uref{https://www.opensmtpd.org, OpenSMTPD}
16992 service, whose value should be an @code{opensmtpd-configuration} object
16993 as in this example:
16994
16995 @lisp
16996 (service opensmtpd-service-type
16997 (opensmtpd-configuration
16998 (config-file (local-file "./my-smtpd.conf"))))
16999 @end lisp
17000 @end deffn
17001
17002 @deftp {Data Type} opensmtpd-configuration
17003 Data type representing the configuration of opensmtpd.
17004
17005 @table @asis
17006 @item @code{package} (default: @var{opensmtpd})
17007 Package object of the OpenSMTPD SMTP server.
17008
17009 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{%default-opensmtpd-file})
17010 File-like object of the OpenSMTPD configuration file to use. By default
17011 it listens on the loopback network interface, and allows for mail from
17012 users and daemons on the local machine, as well as permitting email to
17013 remote servers. Run @command{man smtpd.conf} for more information.
17014
17015 @end table
17016 @end deftp
17017
17018 @subsubheading Exim Service
17019
17020 @cindex mail transfer agent (MTA)
17021 @cindex MTA (mail transfer agent)
17022 @cindex SMTP
17023
17024 @deffn {Scheme Variable} exim-service-type
17025 This is the type of the @uref{https://exim.org, Exim} mail transfer
17026 agent (MTA), whose value should be an @code{exim-configuration} object
17027 as in this example:
17028
17029 @lisp
17030 (service exim-service-type
17031 (exim-configuration
17032 (config-file (local-file "./my-exim.conf"))))
17033 @end lisp
17034 @end deffn
17035
17036 In order to use an @code{exim-service-type} service you must also have a
17037 @code{mail-aliases-service-type} service present in your
17038 @code{operating-system} (even if it has no aliases).
17039
17040 @deftp {Data Type} exim-configuration
17041 Data type representing the configuration of exim.
17042
17043 @table @asis
17044 @item @code{package} (default: @var{exim})
17045 Package object of the Exim server.
17046
17047 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{#f})
17048 File-like object of the Exim configuration file to use. If its value is
17049 @code{#f} then use the default configuration file from the package
17050 provided in @code{package}. The resulting configuration file is loaded
17051 after setting the @code{exim_user} and @code{exim_group} configuration
17052 variables.
17053
17054 @end table
17055 @end deftp
17056
17057 @subsubheading Getmail service
17058
17059 @cindex IMAP
17060 @cindex POP
17061
17062 @deffn {Scheme Variable} getmail-service-type
17063 This is the type of the @uref{http://pyropus.ca/software/getmail/, Getmail}
17064 mail retriever, whose value should be an @code{getmail-configuration}.
17065 @end deffn
17066
17067 Available @code{getmail-configuration} fields are:
17068
17069 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-configuration} parameter} symbol name
17070 A symbol to identify the getmail service.
17071
17072 Defaults to @samp{"unset"}.
17073
17074 @end deftypevr
17075
17076 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-configuration} parameter} package package
17077 The getmail package to use.
17078
17079 @end deftypevr
17080
17081 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-configuration} parameter} string user
17082 The user to run getmail as.
17083
17084 Defaults to @samp{"getmail"}.
17085
17086 @end deftypevr
17087
17088 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-configuration} parameter} string group
17089 The group to run getmail as.
17090
17091 Defaults to @samp{"getmail"}.
17092
17093 @end deftypevr
17094
17095 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-configuration} parameter} string directory
17096 The getmail directory to use.
17097
17098 Defaults to @samp{"/var/lib/getmail/default"}.
17099
17100 @end deftypevr
17101
17102 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-configuration} parameter} getmail-configuration-file rcfile
17103 The getmail configuration file to use.
17104
17105 Available @code{getmail-configuration-file} fields are:
17106
17107 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-configuration-file} parameter} getmail-retriever-configuration retriever
17108 What mail account to retrieve mail from, and how to access that account.
17109
17110 Available @code{getmail-retriever-configuration} fields are:
17111
17112 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-retriever-configuration} parameter} string type
17113 The type of mail retriever to use. Valid values include @samp{passwd}
17114 and @samp{static}.
17115
17116 Defaults to @samp{"SimpleIMAPSSLRetriever"}.
17117
17118 @end deftypevr
17119
17120 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-retriever-configuration} parameter} string server
17121 Space separated list of arguments to the userdb driver.
17122
17123 Defaults to @samp{unset}.
17124
17125 @end deftypevr
17126
17127 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-retriever-configuration} parameter} string username
17128 Space separated list of arguments to the userdb driver.
17129
17130 Defaults to @samp{unset}.
17131
17132 @end deftypevr
17133
17134 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-retriever-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer port
17135 Space separated list of arguments to the userdb driver.
17136
17137 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
17138
17139 @end deftypevr
17140
17141 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-retriever-configuration} parameter} string password
17142 Override fields from passwd.
17143
17144 Defaults to @samp{""}.
17145
17146 @end deftypevr
17147
17148 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-retriever-configuration} parameter} list password-command
17149 Override fields from passwd.
17150
17151 Defaults to @samp{()}.
17152
17153 @end deftypevr
17154
17155 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-retriever-configuration} parameter} string keyfile
17156 PEM-formatted key file to use for the TLS negotiation
17157
17158 Defaults to @samp{""}.
17159
17160 @end deftypevr
17161
17162 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-retriever-configuration} parameter} string certfile
17163 PEM-formatted certificate file to use for the TLS negotiation
17164
17165 Defaults to @samp{""}.
17166
17167 @end deftypevr
17168
17169 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-retriever-configuration} parameter} string ca-certs
17170 CA certificates to use
17171
17172 Defaults to @samp{""}.
17173
17174 @end deftypevr
17175
17176 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-retriever-configuration} parameter} parameter-alist extra-parameters
17177 Extra retriever parameters
17178
17179 Defaults to @samp{()}.
17180
17181 @end deftypevr
17182
17183 @end deftypevr
17184
17185 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-configuration-file} parameter} getmail-destination-configuration destination
17186 What to do with retrieved messages.
17187
17188 Available @code{getmail-destination-configuration} fields are:
17189
17190 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-destination-configuration} parameter} string type
17191 The type of mail destination. Valid values include @samp{Maildir},
17192 @samp{Mboxrd} and @samp{MDA_external}.
17193
17194 Defaults to @samp{unset}.
17195
17196 @end deftypevr
17197
17198 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-destination-configuration} parameter} string-or-filelike path
17199 The path option for the mail destination. The behaviour depends on the
17200 chosen type.
17201
17202 Defaults to @samp{""}.
17203
17204 @end deftypevr
17205
17206 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-destination-configuration} parameter} parameter-alist extra-parameters
17207 Extra destination parameters
17208
17209 Defaults to @samp{()}.
17210
17211 @end deftypevr
17212
17213 @end deftypevr
17214
17215 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-configuration-file} parameter} getmail-options-configuration options
17216 Configure getmail.
17217
17218 Available @code{getmail-options-configuration} fields are:
17219
17220 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer verbose
17221 If set to @samp{0}, getmail will only print warnings and errors. A
17222 value of @samp{1} means that messages will be printed about retrieving
17223 and deleting messages. If set to @samp{2}, getmail will print messages
17224 about each of it's actions.
17225
17226 Defaults to @samp{1}.
17227
17228 @end deftypevr
17229
17230 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} boolean read-all
17231 If true, getmail will retrieve all available messages. Otherwise it
17232 will only retrieve messages it hasn't seen previously.
17233
17234 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
17235
17236 @end deftypevr
17237
17238 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} boolean delete
17239 If set to true, messages will be deleted from the server after
17240 retrieving and successfully delivering them. Otherwise, messages will
17241 be left on the server.
17242
17243 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
17244
17245 @end deftypevr
17246
17247 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer delete-after
17248 Getmail will delete messages this number of days after seeing them, if
17249 they have not been delivered. This means messages will be left on the
17250 server this number of days after delivering them. A value of @samp{0}
17251 disabled this feature.
17252
17253 Defaults to @samp{0}.
17254
17255 @end deftypevr
17256
17257 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer delete-bigger-than
17258 Delete messages larger than this of bytes after retrieving them, even if
17259 the delete and delete-after options are disabled. A value of @samp{0}
17260 disables this feature.
17261
17262 Defaults to @samp{0}.
17263
17264 @end deftypevr
17265
17266 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-bytes-per-session
17267 Retrieve messages totalling up to this number of bytes before closing
17268 the session with the server. A value of @samp{0} disables this feature.
17269
17270 Defaults to @samp{0}.
17271
17272 @end deftypevr
17273
17274 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-message-size
17275 Don't retrieve messages larger than this number of bytes. A value of
17276 @samp{0} disables this feature.
17277
17278 Defaults to @samp{0}.
17279
17280 @end deftypevr
17281
17282 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} boolean delivered-to
17283 If true, getmail will add a Delivered-To header to messages.
17284
17285 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
17286
17287 @end deftypevr
17288
17289 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} boolean received
17290 If set, getmail adds a Received header to the messages.
17291
17292 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
17293
17294 @end deftypevr
17295
17296 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} string message-log
17297 Getmail will record a log of its actions to the named file. A value of
17298 @samp{""} disables this feature.
17299
17300 Defaults to @samp{""}.
17301
17302 @end deftypevr
17303
17304 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} boolean message-log-syslog
17305 If true, getmail will record a log of its actions using the system
17306 logger.
17307
17308 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
17309
17310 @end deftypevr
17311
17312 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} boolean message-log-verbose
17313 If true, getmail will log information about messages not retrieved and
17314 the reason for not retrieving them, as well as starting and ending
17315 information lines.
17316
17317 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
17318
17319 @end deftypevr
17320
17321 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-options-configuration} parameter} parameter-alist extra-parameters
17322 Extra options to include.
17323
17324 Defaults to @samp{()}.
17325
17326 @end deftypevr
17327
17328 @end deftypevr
17329
17330 @end deftypevr
17331
17332 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-configuration} parameter} list idle
17333 A list of mailboxes that getmail should wait on the server for new mail
17334 notifications. This depends on the server supporting the IDLE
17335 extension.
17336
17337 Defaults to @samp{()}.
17338
17339 @end deftypevr
17340
17341 @deftypevr {@code{getmail-configuration} parameter} list environment-variables
17342 Environment variables to set for getmail.
17343
17344 Defaults to @samp{()}.
17345
17346 @end deftypevr
17347
17348 @subsubheading Mail Aliases Service
17349
17350 @cindex email aliases
17351 @cindex aliases, for email addresses
17352
17353 @deffn {Scheme Variable} mail-aliases-service-type
17354 This is the type of the service which provides @code{/etc/aliases},
17355 specifying how to deliver mail to users on this system.
17356
17357 @lisp
17358 (service mail-aliases-service-type
17359 '(("postmaster" "bob")
17360 ("bob" "bob@@example.com" "bob@@example2.com")))
17361 @end lisp
17362 @end deffn
17363
17364 The configuration for a @code{mail-aliases-service-type} service is an
17365 association list denoting how to deliver mail that comes to this
17366 system. Each entry is of the form @code{(alias addresses ...)}, with
17367 @code{alias} specifying the local alias and @code{addresses} specifying
17368 where to deliver this user's mail.
17369
17370 The aliases aren't required to exist as users on the local system. In
17371 the above example, there doesn't need to be a @code{postmaster} entry in
17372 the @code{operating-system}'s @code{user-accounts} in order to deliver
17373 the @code{postmaster} mail to @code{bob} (which subsequently would
17374 deliver mail to @code{bob@@example.com} and @code{bob@@example2.com}).
17375
17376 @subsubheading GNU Mailutils IMAP4 Daemon
17377 @cindex GNU Mailutils IMAP4 Daemon
17378
17379 @deffn {Scheme Variable} imap4d-service-type
17380 This is the type of the GNU Mailutils IMAP4 Daemon (@pxref{imap4d,,,
17381 mailutils, GNU Mailutils Manual}), whose value should be an
17382 @code{imap4d-configuration} object as in this example:
17383
17384 @lisp
17385 (service imap4d-service-type
17386 (imap4d-configuration
17387 (config-file (local-file "imap4d.conf"))))
17388 @end lisp
17389 @end deffn
17390
17391 @deftp {Data Type} imap4d-configuration
17392 Data type representing the configuration of @command{imap4d}.
17393
17394 @table @asis
17395 @item @code{package} (default: @code{mailutils})
17396 The package that provides @command{imap4d}.
17397
17398 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{%default-imap4d-config-file})
17399 File-like object of the configuration file to use, by default it will listen
17400 on TCP port 143 of @code{localhost}. @xref{Conf-imap4d,,, mailutils, GNU
17401 Mailutils Manual}, for details.
17402
17403 @end table
17404 @end deftp
17405
17406 @node Messaging Services
17407 @subsection Messaging Services
17408
17409 @cindex messaging
17410 @cindex jabber
17411 @cindex XMPP
17412 The @code{(gnu services messaging)} module provides Guix service
17413 definitions for messaging services: currently only Prosody is supported.
17414
17415 @subsubheading Prosody Service
17416
17417 @deffn {Scheme Variable} prosody-service-type
17418 This is the type for the @uref{https://prosody.im, Prosody XMPP
17419 communication server}. Its value must be a @code{prosody-configuration}
17420 record as in this example:
17421
17422 @lisp
17423 (service prosody-service-type
17424 (prosody-configuration
17425 (modules-enabled (cons "groups" "mam" %default-modules-enabled))
17426 (int-components
17427 (list
17428 (int-component-configuration
17429 (hostname "conference.example.net")
17430 (plugin "muc")
17431 (mod-muc (mod-muc-configuration)))))
17432 (virtualhosts
17433 (list
17434 (virtualhost-configuration
17435 (domain "example.net"))))))
17436 @end lisp
17437
17438 See below for details about @code{prosody-configuration}.
17439
17440 @end deffn
17441
17442 By default, Prosody does not need much configuration. Only one
17443 @code{virtualhosts} field is needed: it specifies the domain you wish
17444 Prosody to serve.
17445
17446 You can perform various sanity checks on the generated configuration
17447 with the @code{prosodyctl check} command.
17448
17449 Prosodyctl will also help you to import certificates from the
17450 @code{letsencrypt} directory so that the @code{prosody} user can access
17451 them. See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/letsencrypt}.
17452
17453 @example
17454 prosodyctl --root cert import /etc/letsencrypt/live
17455 @end example
17456
17457 The available configuration parameters follow. Each parameter
17458 definition is preceded by its type; for example, @samp{string-list foo}
17459 indicates that the @code{foo} parameter should be specified as a list of
17460 strings. Types starting with @code{maybe-} denote parameters that won't
17461 show up in @code{prosody.cfg.lua} when their value is @code{'disabled}.
17462
17463 There is also a way to specify the configuration as a string, if you
17464 have an old @code{prosody.cfg.lua} file that you want to port over from
17465 some other system; see the end for more details.
17466
17467 The @code{file-object} type designates either a file-like object
17468 (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like objects}) or a file name.
17469
17470 @c The following documentation was initially generated by
17471 @c (generate-documentation) in (gnu services messaging). Manually maintained
17472 @c documentation is better, so we shouldn't hesitate to edit below as
17473 @c needed. However if the change you want to make to this documentation
17474 @c can be done in an automated way, it's probably easier to change
17475 @c (generate-documentation) than to make it below and have to deal with
17476 @c the churn as Prosody updates.
17477
17478 Available @code{prosody-configuration} fields are:
17479
17480 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} package prosody
17481 The Prosody package.
17482 @end deftypevr
17483
17484 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} file-name data-path
17485 Location of the Prosody data storage directory. See
17486 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/configure}.
17487 Defaults to @samp{"/var/lib/prosody"}.
17488 @end deftypevr
17489
17490 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} file-object-list plugin-paths
17491 Additional plugin directories. They are searched in all the specified
17492 paths in order. See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/plugins_directory}.
17493 Defaults to @samp{()}.
17494 @end deftypevr
17495
17496 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} file-name certificates
17497 Every virtual host and component needs a certificate so that clients and
17498 servers can securely verify its identity. Prosody will automatically load
17499 certificates/keys from the directory specified here.
17500 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/prosody/certs"}.
17501 @end deftypevr
17502
17503 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} string-list admins
17504 This is a list of accounts that are admins for the server. Note that you
17505 must create the accounts separately. See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/admins} and
17506 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/creating_accounts}.
17507 Example: @code{(admins '("user1@@example.com" "user2@@example.net"))}
17508 Defaults to @samp{()}.
17509 @end deftypevr
17510
17511 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} boolean use-libevent?
17512 Enable use of libevent for better performance under high load. See
17513 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/libevent}.
17514 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
17515 @end deftypevr
17516
17517 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} module-list modules-enabled
17518 This is the list of modules Prosody will load on startup. It looks for
17519 @code{mod_modulename.lua} in the plugins folder, so make sure that exists too.
17520 Documentation on modules can be found at:
17521 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/modules}.
17522 Defaults to @samp{("roster" "saslauth" "tls" "dialback" "disco" "carbons" "private" "blocklist" "vcard" "version" "uptime" "time" "ping" "pep" "register" "admin_adhoc")}.
17523 @end deftypevr
17524
17525 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} string-list modules-disabled
17526 @samp{"offline"}, @samp{"c2s"} and @samp{"s2s"} are auto-loaded, but
17527 should you want to disable them then add them to this list.
17528 Defaults to @samp{()}.
17529 @end deftypevr
17530
17531 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} file-object groups-file
17532 Path to a text file where the shared groups are defined. If this path is
17533 empty then @samp{mod_groups} does nothing. See
17534 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/modules/mod_groups}.
17535 Defaults to @samp{"/var/lib/prosody/sharedgroups.txt"}.
17536 @end deftypevr
17537
17538 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} boolean allow-registration?
17539 Disable account creation by default, for security. See
17540 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/creating_accounts}.
17541 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
17542 @end deftypevr
17543
17544 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} maybe-ssl-configuration ssl
17545 These are the SSL/TLS-related settings. Most of them are disabled so to
17546 use Prosody's defaults. If you do not completely understand these options, do
17547 not add them to your config, it is easy to lower the security of your server
17548 using them. See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/advanced_ssl_config}.
17549
17550 Available @code{ssl-configuration} fields are:
17551
17552 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-string protocol
17553 This determines what handshake to use.
17554 @end deftypevr
17555
17556 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-file-name key
17557 Path to your private key file.
17558 @end deftypevr
17559
17560 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-file-name certificate
17561 Path to your certificate file.
17562 @end deftypevr
17563
17564 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} file-object capath
17565 Path to directory containing root certificates that you wish Prosody to
17566 trust when verifying the certificates of remote servers.
17567 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/ssl/certs"}.
17568 @end deftypevr
17569
17570 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-file-object cafile
17571 Path to a file containing root certificates that you wish Prosody to trust.
17572 Similar to @code{capath} but with all certificates concatenated together.
17573 @end deftypevr
17574
17575 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-string-list verify
17576 A list of verification options (these mostly map to OpenSSL's
17577 @code{set_verify()} flags).
17578 @end deftypevr
17579
17580 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-string-list options
17581 A list of general options relating to SSL/TLS. These map to OpenSSL's
17582 @code{set_options()}. For a full list of options available in LuaSec, see the
17583 LuaSec source.
17584 @end deftypevr
17585
17586 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer depth
17587 How long a chain of certificate authorities to check when looking for a
17588 trusted root certificate.
17589 @end deftypevr
17590
17591 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-string ciphers
17592 An OpenSSL cipher string. This selects what ciphers Prosody will offer to
17593 clients, and in what order.
17594 @end deftypevr
17595
17596 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-file-name dhparam
17597 A path to a file containing parameters for Diffie-Hellman key exchange. You
17598 can create such a file with:
17599 @code{openssl dhparam -out /etc/prosody/certs/dh-2048.pem 2048}
17600 @end deftypevr
17601
17602 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-string curve
17603 Curve for Elliptic curve Diffie-Hellman. Prosody's default is
17604 @samp{"secp384r1"}.
17605 @end deftypevr
17606
17607 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-string-list verifyext
17608 A list of "extra" verification options.
17609 @end deftypevr
17610
17611 @deftypevr {@code{ssl-configuration} parameter} maybe-string password
17612 Password for encrypted private keys.
17613 @end deftypevr
17614
17615 @end deftypevr
17616
17617 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} boolean c2s-require-encryption?
17618 Whether to force all client-to-server connections to be encrypted or not.
17619 See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/modules/mod_tls}.
17620 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
17621 @end deftypevr
17622
17623 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} string-list disable-sasl-mechanisms
17624 Set of mechanisms that will never be offered. See
17625 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/modules/mod_saslauth}.
17626 Defaults to @samp{("DIGEST-MD5")}.
17627 @end deftypevr
17628
17629 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} boolean s2s-require-encryption?
17630 Whether to force all server-to-server connections to be encrypted or not.
17631 See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/modules/mod_tls}.
17632 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
17633 @end deftypevr
17634
17635 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} boolean s2s-secure-auth?
17636 Whether to require encryption and certificate authentication. This
17637 provides ideal security, but requires servers you communicate with to support
17638 encryption AND present valid, trusted certificates. See
17639 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/s2s#security}.
17640 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
17641 @end deftypevr
17642
17643 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} string-list s2s-insecure-domains
17644 Many servers don't support encryption or have invalid or self-signed
17645 certificates. You can list domains here that will not be required to
17646 authenticate using certificates. They will be authenticated using DNS. See
17647 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/s2s#security}.
17648 Defaults to @samp{()}.
17649 @end deftypevr
17650
17651 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} string-list s2s-secure-domains
17652 Even if you leave @code{s2s-secure-auth?} disabled, you can still require
17653 valid certificates for some domains by specifying a list here. See
17654 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/s2s#security}.
17655 Defaults to @samp{()}.
17656 @end deftypevr
17657
17658 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} string authentication
17659 Select the authentication backend to use. The default provider stores
17660 passwords in plaintext and uses Prosody's configured data storage to store the
17661 authentication data. If you do not trust your server please see
17662 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/modules/mod_auth_internal_hashed} for information
17663 about using the hashed backend. See also
17664 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/authentication}
17665 Defaults to @samp{"internal_plain"}.
17666 @end deftypevr
17667
17668 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} maybe-string log
17669 Set logging options. Advanced logging configuration is not yet supported
17670 by the Prosody service. See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/logging}.
17671 Defaults to @samp{"*syslog"}.
17672 @end deftypevr
17673
17674 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} file-name pidfile
17675 File to write pid in. See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/modules/mod_posix}.
17676 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/prosody/prosody.pid"}.
17677 @end deftypevr
17678
17679 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer http-max-content-size
17680 Maximum allowed size of the HTTP body (in bytes).
17681 @end deftypevr
17682
17683 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} maybe-string http-external-url
17684 Some modules expose their own URL in various ways. This URL is built
17685 from the protocol, host and port used. If Prosody sits behind a proxy, the
17686 public URL will be @code{http-external-url} instead. See
17687 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/http#external_url}.
17688 @end deftypevr
17689
17690 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} virtualhost-configuration-list virtualhosts
17691 A host in Prosody is a domain on which user accounts can be created. For
17692 example if you want your users to have addresses like
17693 @samp{"john.smith@@example.com"} then you need to add a host
17694 @samp{"example.com"}. All options in this list will apply only to this host.
17695
17696 Note: the name "virtual" host is used in configuration to avoid confusion with
17697 the actual physical host that Prosody is installed on. A single Prosody
17698 instance can serve many domains, each one defined as a VirtualHost entry in
17699 Prosody's configuration. Conversely a server that hosts a single domain would
17700 have just one VirtualHost entry.
17701
17702 See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/configure#virtual_host_settings}.
17703
17704 Available @code{virtualhost-configuration} fields are:
17705
17706 all these @code{prosody-configuration} fields: @code{admins}, @code{use-libevent?}, @code{modules-enabled}, @code{modules-disabled}, @code{groups-file}, @code{allow-registration?}, @code{ssl}, @code{c2s-require-encryption?}, @code{disable-sasl-mechanisms}, @code{s2s-require-encryption?}, @code{s2s-secure-auth?}, @code{s2s-insecure-domains}, @code{s2s-secure-domains}, @code{authentication}, @code{log}, @code{http-max-content-size}, @code{http-external-url}, @code{raw-content}, plus:
17707 @deftypevr {@code{virtualhost-configuration} parameter} string domain
17708 Domain you wish Prosody to serve.
17709 @end deftypevr
17710
17711 @end deftypevr
17712
17713 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} int-component-configuration-list int-components
17714 Components are extra services on a server which are available to clients,
17715 usually on a subdomain of the main server (such as
17716 @samp{"mycomponent.example.com"}). Example components might be chatroom
17717 servers, user directories, or gateways to other protocols.
17718
17719 Internal components are implemented with Prosody-specific plugins. To add an
17720 internal component, you simply fill the hostname field, and the plugin you wish
17721 to use for the component.
17722
17723 See @url{https://prosody.im/doc/components}.
17724 Defaults to @samp{()}.
17725
17726 Available @code{int-component-configuration} fields are:
17727
17728 all these @code{prosody-configuration} fields: @code{admins}, @code{use-libevent?}, @code{modules-enabled}, @code{modules-disabled}, @code{groups-file}, @code{allow-registration?}, @code{ssl}, @code{c2s-require-encryption?}, @code{disable-sasl-mechanisms}, @code{s2s-require-encryption?}, @code{s2s-secure-auth?}, @code{s2s-insecure-domains}, @code{s2s-secure-domains}, @code{authentication}, @code{log}, @code{http-max-content-size}, @code{http-external-url}, @code{raw-content}, plus:
17729 @deftypevr {@code{int-component-configuration} parameter} string hostname
17730 Hostname of the component.
17731 @end deftypevr
17732
17733 @deftypevr {@code{int-component-configuration} parameter} string plugin
17734 Plugin you wish to use for the component.
17735 @end deftypevr
17736
17737 @deftypevr {@code{int-component-configuration} parameter} maybe-mod-muc-configuration mod-muc
17738 Multi-user chat (MUC) is Prosody's module for allowing you to create
17739 hosted chatrooms/conferences for XMPP users.
17740
17741 General information on setting up and using multi-user chatrooms can be found
17742 in the "Chatrooms" documentation (@url{https://prosody.im/doc/chatrooms}),
17743 which you should read if you are new to XMPP chatrooms.
17744
17745 See also @url{https://prosody.im/doc/modules/mod_muc}.
17746
17747 Available @code{mod-muc-configuration} fields are:
17748
17749 @deftypevr {@code{mod-muc-configuration} parameter} string name
17750 The name to return in service discovery responses.
17751 Defaults to @samp{"Prosody Chatrooms"}.
17752 @end deftypevr
17753
17754 @deftypevr {@code{mod-muc-configuration} parameter} string-or-boolean restrict-room-creation
17755 If @samp{#t}, this will only allow admins to create new chatrooms.
17756 Otherwise anyone can create a room. The value @samp{"local"} restricts room
17757 creation to users on the service's parent domain. E.g.@: @samp{user@@example.com}
17758 can create rooms on @samp{rooms.example.com}. The value @samp{"admin"}
17759 restricts to service administrators only.
17760 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
17761 @end deftypevr
17762
17763 @deftypevr {@code{mod-muc-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-history-messages
17764 Maximum number of history messages that will be sent to the member that has
17765 just joined the room.
17766 Defaults to @samp{20}.
17767 @end deftypevr
17768
17769 @end deftypevr
17770
17771 @end deftypevr
17772
17773 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} ext-component-configuration-list ext-components
17774 External components use XEP-0114, which most standalone components
17775 support. To add an external component, you simply fill the hostname field. See
17776 @url{https://prosody.im/doc/components}.
17777 Defaults to @samp{()}.
17778
17779 Available @code{ext-component-configuration} fields are:
17780
17781 all these @code{prosody-configuration} fields: @code{admins}, @code{use-libevent?}, @code{modules-enabled}, @code{modules-disabled}, @code{groups-file}, @code{allow-registration?}, @code{ssl}, @code{c2s-require-encryption?}, @code{disable-sasl-mechanisms}, @code{s2s-require-encryption?}, @code{s2s-secure-auth?}, @code{s2s-insecure-domains}, @code{s2s-secure-domains}, @code{authentication}, @code{log}, @code{http-max-content-size}, @code{http-external-url}, @code{raw-content}, plus:
17782 @deftypevr {@code{ext-component-configuration} parameter} string component-secret
17783 Password which the component will use to log in.
17784 @end deftypevr
17785
17786 @deftypevr {@code{ext-component-configuration} parameter} string hostname
17787 Hostname of the component.
17788 @end deftypevr
17789
17790 @end deftypevr
17791
17792 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer-list component-ports
17793 Port(s) Prosody listens on for component connections.
17794 Defaults to @samp{(5347)}.
17795 @end deftypevr
17796
17797 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} string component-interface
17798 Interface Prosody listens on for component connections.
17799 Defaults to @samp{"127.0.0.1"}.
17800 @end deftypevr
17801
17802 @deftypevr {@code{prosody-configuration} parameter} maybe-raw-content raw-content
17803 Raw content that will be added to the configuration file.
17804 @end deftypevr
17805
17806 It could be that you just want to get a @code{prosody.cfg.lua}
17807 up and running. In that case, you can pass an
17808 @code{opaque-prosody-configuration} record as the value of
17809 @code{prosody-service-type}. As its name indicates, an opaque configuration
17810 does not have easy reflective capabilities.
17811 Available @code{opaque-prosody-configuration} fields are:
17812
17813 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-prosody-configuration} parameter} package prosody
17814 The prosody package.
17815 @end deftypevr
17816
17817 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-prosody-configuration} parameter} string prosody.cfg.lua
17818 The contents of the @code{prosody.cfg.lua} to use.
17819 @end deftypevr
17820
17821 For example, if your @code{prosody.cfg.lua} is just the empty
17822 string, you could instantiate a prosody service like this:
17823
17824 @lisp
17825 (service prosody-service-type
17826 (opaque-prosody-configuration
17827 (prosody.cfg.lua "")))
17828 @end lisp
17829
17830 @c end of Prosody auto-generated documentation
17831
17832 @subsubheading BitlBee Service
17833
17834 @cindex IRC (Internet Relay Chat)
17835 @cindex IRC gateway
17836 @url{https://bitlbee.org,BitlBee} is a gateway that provides an IRC
17837 interface to a variety of messaging protocols such as XMPP.
17838
17839 @defvr {Scheme Variable} bitlbee-service-type
17840 This is the service type for the @url{https://bitlbee.org,BitlBee} IRC
17841 gateway daemon. Its value is a @code{bitlbee-configuration} (see
17842 below).
17843
17844 To have BitlBee listen on port 6667 on localhost, add this line to your
17845 services:
17846
17847 @lisp
17848 (service bitlbee-service-type)
17849 @end lisp
17850 @end defvr
17851
17852 @deftp {Data Type} bitlbee-configuration
17853 This is the configuration for BitlBee, with the following fields:
17854
17855 @table @asis
17856 @item @code{interface} (default: @code{"127.0.0.1"})
17857 @itemx @code{port} (default: @code{6667})
17858 Listen on the network interface corresponding to the IP address
17859 specified in @var{interface}, on @var{port}.
17860
17861 When @var{interface} is @code{127.0.0.1}, only local clients can
17862 connect; when it is @code{0.0.0.0}, connections can come from any
17863 networking interface.
17864
17865 @item @code{package} (default: @code{bitlbee})
17866 The BitlBee package to use.
17867
17868 @item @code{plugins} (default: @code{'()})
17869 List of plugin packages to use---e.g., @code{bitlbee-discord}.
17870
17871 @item @code{extra-settings} (default: @code{""})
17872 Configuration snippet added as-is to the BitlBee configuration file.
17873 @end table
17874 @end deftp
17875
17876 @subsubheading Quassel Service
17877
17878 @cindex IRC (Internet Relay Chat)
17879 @url{https://quassel-irc.org/,Quassel} is a distributed IRC client,
17880 meaning that one or more clients can attach to and detach from the
17881 central core.
17882
17883 @defvr {Scheme Variable} quassel-service-type
17884 This is the service type for the @url{https://quassel-irc.org/,Quassel}
17885 IRC backend daemon. Its value is a @code{quassel-configuration}
17886 (see below).
17887 @end defvr
17888
17889 @deftp {Data Type} quassel-configuration
17890 This is the configuration for Quassel, with the following fields:
17891
17892 @table @asis
17893 @item @code{quassel} (default: @code{quassel})
17894 The Quassel package to use.
17895
17896 @item @code{interface} (default: @code{"::,0.0.0.0"})
17897 @item @code{port} (default: @code{4242})
17898 Listen on the network interface(s) corresponding to the IPv4 or IPv6
17899 interfaces specified in the comma delimited @var{interface}, on
17900 @var{port}.
17901
17902 @item @code{loglevel} (default: @code{"Info"})
17903 The level of logging desired. Accepted values are Debug, Info, Warning
17904 and Error.
17905 @end table
17906 @end deftp
17907
17908 @node Telephony Services
17909 @subsection Telephony Services
17910
17911 @cindex Murmur (VoIP server)
17912 @cindex VoIP server
17913 This section describes how to set up and run a Murmur server. Murmur is
17914 the server of the @uref{https://mumble.info, Mumble} voice-over-IP
17915 (VoIP) suite.
17916
17917 @deftp {Data Type} murmur-configuration
17918 The service type for the Murmur server. An example configuration can
17919 look like this:
17920
17921 @lisp
17922 (service murmur-service-type
17923 (murmur-configuration
17924 (welcome-text
17925 "Welcome to this Mumble server running on Guix!")
17926 (cert-required? #t) ;disallow text password logins
17927 (ssl-cert "/etc/letsencrypt/live/mumble.example.com/fullchain.pem")
17928 (ssl-key "/etc/letsencrypt/live/mumble.example.com/privkey.pem")))
17929 @end lisp
17930
17931 After reconfiguring your system, you can manually set the murmur @code{SuperUser}
17932 password with the command that is printed during the activation phase.
17933
17934 It is recommended to register a normal Mumble user account
17935 and grant it admin or moderator rights.
17936 You can use the @code{mumble} client to
17937 login as new normal user, register yourself, and log out.
17938 For the next step login with the name @code{SuperUser} use
17939 the @code{SuperUser} password that you set previously,
17940 and grant your newly registered mumble user administrator or moderator
17941 rights and create some channels.
17942
17943 Available @code{murmur-configuration} fields are:
17944
17945 @table @asis
17946 @item @code{package} (default: @code{mumble})
17947 Package that contains @code{bin/murmurd}.
17948
17949 @item @code{user} (default: @code{"murmur"})
17950 User who will run the Murmur server.
17951
17952 @item @code{group} (default: @code{"murmur"})
17953 Group of the user who will run the murmur server.
17954
17955 @item @code{port} (default: @code{64738})
17956 Port on which the server will listen.
17957
17958 @item @code{welcome-text} (default: @code{""})
17959 Welcome text sent to clients when they connect.
17960
17961 @item @code{server-password} (default: @code{""})
17962 Password the clients have to enter in order to connect.
17963
17964 @item @code{max-users} (default: @code{100})
17965 Maximum of users that can be connected to the server at once.
17966
17967 @item @code{max-user-bandwidth} (default: @code{#f})
17968 Maximum voice traffic a user can send per second.
17969
17970 @item @code{database-file} (default: @code{"/var/lib/murmur/db.sqlite"})
17971 File name of the sqlite database.
17972 The service's user will become the owner of the directory.
17973
17974 @item @code{log-file} (default: @code{"/var/log/murmur/murmur.log"})
17975 File name of the log file.
17976 The service's user will become the owner of the directory.
17977
17978 @item @code{autoban-attempts} (default: @code{10})
17979 Maximum number of logins a user can make in @code{autoban-timeframe}
17980 without getting auto banned for @code{autoban-time}.
17981
17982 @item @code{autoban-timeframe} (default: @code{120})
17983 Timeframe for autoban in seconds.
17984
17985 @item @code{autoban-time} (default: @code{300})
17986 Amount of time in seconds for which a client gets banned
17987 when violating the autoban limits.
17988
17989 @item @code{opus-threshold} (default: @code{100})
17990 Percentage of clients that need to support opus
17991 before switching over to opus audio codec.
17992
17993 @item @code{channel-nesting-limit} (default: @code{10})
17994 How deep channels can be nested at maximum.
17995
17996 @item @code{channelname-regex} (default: @code{#f})
17997 A string in form of a Qt regular expression that channel names must conform to.
17998
17999 @item @code{username-regex} (default: @code{#f})
18000 A string in form of a Qt regular expression that user names must conform to.
18001
18002 @item @code{text-message-length} (default: @code{5000})
18003 Maximum size in bytes that a user can send in one text chat message.
18004
18005 @item @code{image-message-length} (default: @code{(* 128 1024)})
18006 Maximum size in bytes that a user can send in one image message.
18007
18008 @item @code{cert-required?} (default: @code{#f})
18009 If it is set to @code{#t} clients that use weak password authentication
18010 will not be accepted. Users must have completed the certificate wizard to join.
18011
18012 @item @code{remember-channel?} (default: @code{#f})
18013 Should murmur remember the last channel each user was in when they disconnected
18014 and put them into the remembered channel when they rejoin.
18015
18016 @item @code{allow-html?} (default: @code{#f})
18017 Should html be allowed in text messages, user comments, and channel descriptions.
18018
18019 @item @code{allow-ping?} (default: @code{#f})
18020 Setting to true exposes the current user count, the maximum user count, and
18021 the server's maximum bandwidth per client to unauthenticated users. In the
18022 Mumble client, this information is shown in the Connect dialog.
18023
18024 Disabling this setting will prevent public listing of the server.
18025
18026 @item @code{bonjour?} (default: @code{#f})
18027 Should the server advertise itself in the local network through the bonjour protocol.
18028
18029 @item @code{send-version?} (default: @code{#f})
18030 Should the murmur server version be exposed in ping requests.
18031
18032 @item @code{log-days} (default: @code{31})
18033 Murmur also stores logs in the database, which are accessible via RPC.
18034 The default is 31 days of months, but you can set this setting to 0 to keep logs forever,
18035 or -1 to disable logging to the database.
18036
18037 @item @code{obfuscate-ips?} (default: @code{#t})
18038 Should logged ips be obfuscated to protect the privacy of users.
18039
18040 @item @code{ssl-cert} (default: @code{#f})
18041 File name of the SSL/TLS certificate used for encrypted connections.
18042
18043 @lisp
18044 (ssl-cert "/etc/letsencrypt/live/example.com/fullchain.pem")
18045 @end lisp
18046 @item @code{ssl-key} (default: @code{#f})
18047 Filepath to the ssl private key used for encrypted connections.
18048 @lisp
18049 (ssl-key "/etc/letsencrypt/live/example.com/privkey.pem")
18050 @end lisp
18051
18052 @item @code{ssl-dh-params} (default: @code{#f})
18053 File name of a PEM-encoded file with Diffie-Hellman parameters
18054 for the SSL/TLS encryption. Alternatively you set it to
18055 @code{"@@ffdhe2048"}, @code{"@@ffdhe3072"}, @code{"@@ffdhe4096"}, @code{"@@ffdhe6144"}
18056 or @code{"@@ffdhe8192"} to use bundled parameters from RFC 7919.
18057
18058 @item @code{ssl-ciphers} (default: @code{#f})
18059 The @code{ssl-ciphers} option chooses the cipher suites to make available for use
18060 in SSL/TLS.
18061
18062 This option is specified using
18063 @uref{https://www.openssl.org/docs/apps/ciphers.html#CIPHER-LIST-FORMAT,
18064 OpenSSL cipher list notation}.
18065
18066 It is recommended that you try your cipher string using 'openssl ciphers <string>'
18067 before setting it here, to get a feel for which cipher suites you will get.
18068 After setting this option, it is recommend that you inspect your Murmur log
18069 to ensure that Murmur is using the cipher suites that you expected it to.
18070
18071 Note: Changing this option may impact the backwards compatibility of your
18072 Murmur server, and can remove the ability for older Mumble clients to be able
18073 to connect to it.
18074
18075 @item @code{public-registration} (default: @code{#f})
18076 Must be a @code{<murmur-public-registration-configuration>} record or @code{#f}.
18077
18078 You can optionally register your server in the public server list that the
18079 @code{mumble} client shows on startup.
18080 You cannot register your server if you have set a @code{server-password},
18081 or set @code{allow-ping} to @code{#f}.
18082
18083 It might take a few hours until it shows up in the public list.
18084
18085 @item @code{file} (default: @code{#f})
18086 Optional alternative override for this configuration.
18087 @end table
18088 @end deftp
18089
18090 @deftp {Data Type} murmur-public-registration-configuration
18091 Configuration for public registration of a murmur service.
18092
18093 @table @asis
18094 @item @code{name}
18095 This is a display name for your server. Not to be confused with the hostname.
18096
18097 @item @code{password}
18098 A password to identify your registration.
18099 Subsequent updates will need the same password. Don't lose your password.
18100
18101 @item @code{url}
18102 This should be a @code{http://} or @code{https://} link to your web
18103 site.
18104
18105 @item @code{hostname} (default: @code{#f})
18106 By default your server will be listed by its IP address.
18107 If it is set your server will be linked by this host name instead.
18108 @end table
18109 @end deftp
18110
18111
18112
18113 @node Monitoring Services
18114 @subsection Monitoring Services
18115
18116 @subsubheading Tailon Service
18117
18118 @uref{https://tailon.readthedocs.io/, Tailon} is a web application for
18119 viewing and searching log files.
18120
18121 The following example will configure the service with default values.
18122 By default, Tailon can be accessed on port 8080 (@code{http://localhost:8080}).
18123
18124 @lisp
18125 (service tailon-service-type)
18126 @end lisp
18127
18128 The following example customises more of the Tailon configuration,
18129 adding @command{sed} to the list of allowed commands.
18130
18131 @lisp
18132 (service tailon-service-type
18133 (tailon-configuration
18134 (config-file
18135 (tailon-configuration-file
18136 (allowed-commands '("tail" "grep" "awk" "sed"))))))
18137 @end lisp
18138
18139
18140 @deftp {Data Type} tailon-configuration
18141 Data type representing the configuration of Tailon.
18142 This type has the following parameters:
18143
18144 @table @asis
18145 @item @code{config-file} (default: @code{(tailon-configuration-file)})
18146 The configuration file to use for Tailon. This can be set to a
18147 @dfn{tailon-configuration-file} record value, or any gexp
18148 (@pxref{G-Expressions}).
18149
18150 For example, to instead use a local file, the @code{local-file} function
18151 can be used:
18152
18153 @lisp
18154 (service tailon-service-type
18155 (tailon-configuration
18156 (config-file (local-file "./my-tailon.conf"))))
18157 @end lisp
18158
18159 @item @code{package} (default: @code{tailon})
18160 The tailon package to use.
18161
18162 @end table
18163 @end deftp
18164
18165 @deftp {Data Type} tailon-configuration-file
18166 Data type representing the configuration options for Tailon.
18167 This type has the following parameters:
18168
18169 @table @asis
18170 @item @code{files} (default: @code{(list "/var/log")})
18171 List of files to display. The list can include strings for a single file
18172 or directory, or a list, where the first item is the name of a
18173 subsection, and the remaining items are the files or directories in that
18174 subsection.
18175
18176 @item @code{bind} (default: @code{"localhost:8080"})
18177 Address and port to which Tailon should bind on.
18178
18179 @item @code{relative-root} (default: @code{#f})
18180 URL path to use for Tailon, set to @code{#f} to not use a path.
18181
18182 @item @code{allow-transfers?} (default: @code{#t})
18183 Allow downloading the log files in the web interface.
18184
18185 @item @code{follow-names?} (default: @code{#t})
18186 Allow tailing of not-yet existent files.
18187
18188 @item @code{tail-lines} (default: @code{200})
18189 Number of lines to read initially from each file.
18190
18191 @item @code{allowed-commands} (default: @code{(list "tail" "grep" "awk")})
18192 Commands to allow running. By default, @code{sed} is disabled.
18193
18194 @item @code{debug?} (default: @code{#f})
18195 Set @code{debug?} to @code{#t} to show debug messages.
18196
18197 @item @code{wrap-lines} (default: @code{#t})
18198 Initial line wrapping state in the web interface. Set to @code{#t} to
18199 initially wrap lines (the default), or to @code{#f} to initially not
18200 wrap lines.
18201
18202 @item @code{http-auth} (default: @code{#f})
18203 HTTP authentication type to use. Set to @code{#f} to disable
18204 authentication (the default). Supported values are @code{"digest"} or
18205 @code{"basic"}.
18206
18207 @item @code{users} (default: @code{#f})
18208 If HTTP authentication is enabled (see @code{http-auth}), access will be
18209 restricted to the credentials provided here. To configure users, use a
18210 list of pairs, where the first element of the pair is the username, and
18211 the 2nd element of the pair is the password.
18212
18213 @lisp
18214 (tailon-configuration-file
18215 (http-auth "basic")
18216 (users '(("user1" . "password1")
18217 ("user2" . "password2"))))
18218 @end lisp
18219
18220 @end table
18221 @end deftp
18222
18223
18224 @subsubheading Darkstat Service
18225 @cindex darkstat
18226 Darkstat is a packet sniffer that captures network traffic, calculates
18227 statistics about usage, and serves reports over HTTP.
18228
18229 @defvar {Scheme Variable} darkstat-service-type
18230 This is the service type for the
18231 @uref{https://unix4lyfe.org/darkstat/, darkstat}
18232 service, its value must be a @code{darkstat-configuration} record as in
18233 this example:
18234
18235 @lisp
18236 (service darkstat-service-type
18237 (darkstat-configuration
18238 (interface "eno1")))
18239 @end lisp
18240 @end defvar
18241
18242 @deftp {Data Type} darkstat-configuration
18243 Data type representing the configuration of @command{darkstat}.
18244
18245 @table @asis
18246 @item @code{package} (default: @code{darkstat})
18247 The darkstat package to use.
18248
18249 @item @code{interface}
18250 Capture traffic on the specified network interface.
18251
18252 @item @code{port} (default: @code{"667"})
18253 Bind the web interface to the specified port.
18254
18255 @item @code{bind-address} (default: @code{"127.0.0.1"})
18256 Bind the web interface to the specified address.
18257
18258 @item @code{base} (default: @code{"/"})
18259 Specify the path of the base URL. This can be useful if
18260 @command{darkstat} is accessed via a reverse proxy.
18261
18262 @end table
18263 @end deftp
18264
18265 @subsubheading Prometheus Node Exporter Service
18266
18267 @cindex prometheus-node-exporter
18268 The Prometheus ``node exporter'' makes hardware and operating system statistics
18269 provided by the Linux kernel available for the Prometheus monitoring system.
18270 This service should be deployed on all physical nodes and virtual machines,
18271 where monitoring these statistics is desirable.
18272
18273 @defvar {Scheme variable} prometheus-node-exporter-service-type
18274 This is the service type for the
18275 @uref{https://github.com/prometheus/node_exporter/, prometheus-node-exporter}
18276 service, its value must be a @code{prometheus-node-exporter-configuration}
18277 record as in this example:
18278
18279 @lisp
18280 (service prometheus-node-exporter-service-type
18281 (prometheus-node-exporter-configuration
18282 (web-listen-address ":9100")))
18283 @end lisp
18284 @end defvar
18285
18286 @deftp {Data Type} prometheus-node-exporter-configuration
18287 Data type representing the configuration of @command{node_exporter}.
18288
18289 @table @asis
18290 @item @code{package} (default: @code{go-github-com-prometheus-node-exporter})
18291 The prometheus-node-exporter package to use.
18292
18293 @item @code{web-listen-address} (default: @code{":9100"})
18294 Bind the web interface to the specified address.
18295
18296 @end table
18297 @end deftp
18298
18299 @subsubheading Zabbix server
18300 @cindex zabbix zabbix-server
18301 Zabbix provides monitoring metrics, among others network utilization, CPU load
18302 and disk space consumption:
18303
18304 @itemize
18305 @item High performance, high capacity (able to monitor hundreds of thousands of devices).
18306 @item Auto-discovery of servers and network devices and interfaces.
18307 @item Low-level discovery, allows to automatically start monitoring new items, file systems or network interfaces among others.
18308 @item Distributed monitoring with centralized web administration.
18309 @item Native high performance agents.
18310 @item SLA, and ITIL KPI metrics on reporting.
18311 @item High-level (business) view of monitored resources through user-defined visual console screens and dashboards.
18312 @item Remote command execution through Zabbix proxies.
18313 @end itemize
18314
18315 @c %start of fragment
18316
18317 Available @code{zabbix-server-configuration} fields are:
18318
18319 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} package zabbix-server
18320 The zabbix-server package.
18321
18322 @end deftypevr
18323
18324 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string user
18325 User who will run the Zabbix server.
18326
18327 Defaults to @samp{"zabbix"}.
18328
18329 @end deftypevr
18330
18331 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} group group
18332 Group who will run the Zabbix server.
18333
18334 Defaults to @samp{"zabbix"}.
18335
18336 @end deftypevr
18337
18338 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string db-host
18339 Database host name.
18340
18341 Defaults to @samp{"127.0.0.1"}.
18342
18343 @end deftypevr
18344
18345 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string db-name
18346 Database name.
18347
18348 Defaults to @samp{"zabbix"}.
18349
18350 @end deftypevr
18351
18352 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string db-user
18353 Database user.
18354
18355 Defaults to @samp{"zabbix"}.
18356
18357 @end deftypevr
18358
18359 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string db-password
18360 Database password. Please, use @code{include-files} with
18361 @code{DBPassword=SECRET} inside a specified file instead.
18362
18363 Defaults to @samp{""}.
18364
18365 @end deftypevr
18366
18367 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} number db-port
18368 Database port.
18369
18370 Defaults to @samp{5432}.
18371
18372 @end deftypevr
18373
18374 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string log-type
18375 Specifies where log messages are written to:
18376
18377 @itemize @bullet
18378 @item
18379 @code{system} - syslog.
18380
18381 @item
18382 @code{file} - file specified with @code{log-file} parameter.
18383
18384 @item
18385 @code{console} - standard output.
18386
18387 @end itemize
18388
18389 Defaults to @samp{""}.
18390
18391 @end deftypevr
18392
18393 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string log-file
18394 Log file name for @code{log-type} @code{file} parameter.
18395
18396 Defaults to @samp{"/var/log/zabbix/server.log"}.
18397
18398 @end deftypevr
18399
18400 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string pid-file
18401 Name of PID file.
18402
18403 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/zabbix/zabbix_server.pid"}.
18404
18405 @end deftypevr
18406
18407 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string ssl-ca-location
18408 The location of certificate authority (CA) files for SSL server
18409 certificate verification.
18410
18411 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/ssl/certs/ca-certificates.crt"}.
18412
18413 @end deftypevr
18414
18415 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string ssl-cert-location
18416 Location of SSL client certificates.
18417
18418 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/ssl/certs"}.
18419
18420 @end deftypevr
18421
18422 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} string extra-options
18423 Extra options will be appended to Zabbix server configuration file.
18424
18425 Defaults to @samp{""}.
18426
18427 @end deftypevr
18428
18429 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-server-configuration} parameter} include-files include-files
18430 You may include individual files or all files in a directory in the
18431 configuration file.
18432
18433 Defaults to @samp{()}.
18434
18435 @end deftypevr
18436
18437 @c %end of fragment
18438
18439 @subsubheading Zabbix agent
18440 @cindex zabbix zabbix-agent
18441
18442 Zabbix agent gathers information for Zabbix server.
18443
18444 @c %start of fragment
18445
18446 Available @code{zabbix-agent-configuration} fields are:
18447
18448 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} package zabbix-agent
18449 The zabbix-agent package.
18450
18451 @end deftypevr
18452
18453 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} string user
18454 User who will run the Zabbix agent.
18455
18456 Defaults to @samp{"zabbix"}.
18457
18458 @end deftypevr
18459
18460 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} group group
18461 Group who will run the Zabbix agent.
18462
18463 Defaults to @samp{"zabbix"}.
18464
18465 @end deftypevr
18466
18467 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} string hostname
18468 Unique, case sensitive hostname which is required for active checks and
18469 must match hostname as configured on the server.
18470
18471 Defaults to @samp{"Zabbix server"}.
18472
18473 @end deftypevr
18474
18475 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} string log-type
18476 Specifies where log messages are written to:
18477
18478 @itemize @bullet
18479 @item
18480 @code{system} - syslog.
18481
18482 @item
18483 @code{file} - file specified with @code{log-file} parameter.
18484
18485 @item
18486 @code{console} - standard output.
18487
18488 @end itemize
18489
18490 Defaults to @samp{""}.
18491
18492 @end deftypevr
18493
18494 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} string log-file
18495 Log file name for @code{log-type} @code{file} parameter.
18496
18497 Defaults to @samp{"/var/log/zabbix/agent.log"}.
18498
18499 @end deftypevr
18500
18501 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} string pid-file
18502 Name of PID file.
18503
18504 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/zabbix/zabbix_agent.pid"}.
18505
18506 @end deftypevr
18507
18508 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} list server
18509 List of IP addresses, optionally in CIDR notation, or hostnames of
18510 Zabbix servers and Zabbix proxies. Incoming connections will be
18511 accepted only from the hosts listed here.
18512
18513 Defaults to @samp{("127.0.0.1")}.
18514
18515 @end deftypevr
18516
18517 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} list server-active
18518 List of IP:port (or hostname:port) pairs of Zabbix servers and Zabbix
18519 proxies for active checks. If port is not specified, default port is
18520 used. If this parameter is not specified, active checks are disabled.
18521
18522 Defaults to @samp{("127.0.0.1")}.
18523
18524 @end deftypevr
18525
18526 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} string extra-options
18527 Extra options will be appended to Zabbix server configuration file.
18528
18529 Defaults to @samp{""}.
18530
18531 @end deftypevr
18532
18533 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-agent-configuration} parameter} include-files include-files
18534 You may include individual files or all files in a directory in the
18535 configuration file.
18536
18537 Defaults to @samp{()}.
18538
18539 @end deftypevr
18540
18541 @c %end of fragment
18542
18543 @subsubheading Zabbix front-end
18544 @cindex zabbix zabbix-front-end
18545
18546 This service provides a WEB interface to Zabbix server.
18547
18548 @c %start of fragment
18549
18550 Available @code{zabbix-front-end-configuration} fields are:
18551
18552 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-front-end-configuration} parameter} nginx-server-configuration-list nginx
18553 NGINX configuration.
18554
18555 @end deftypevr
18556
18557 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-front-end-configuration} parameter} string db-host
18558 Database host name.
18559
18560 Defaults to @samp{"localhost"}.
18561
18562 @end deftypevr
18563
18564 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-front-end-configuration} parameter} number db-port
18565 Database port.
18566
18567 Defaults to @samp{5432}.
18568
18569 @end deftypevr
18570
18571 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-front-end-configuration} parameter} string db-name
18572 Database name.
18573
18574 Defaults to @samp{"zabbix"}.
18575
18576 @end deftypevr
18577
18578 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-front-end-configuration} parameter} string db-user
18579 Database user.
18580
18581 Defaults to @samp{"zabbix"}.
18582
18583 @end deftypevr
18584
18585 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-front-end-configuration} parameter} string db-password
18586 Database password. Please, use @code{db-secret-file} instead.
18587
18588 Defaults to @samp{""}.
18589
18590 @end deftypevr
18591
18592 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-front-end-configuration} parameter} string db-secret-file
18593 Secret file which will be appended to @file{zabbix.conf.php} file. This
18594 file contains credentials for use by Zabbix front-end. You are expected
18595 to create it manually.
18596
18597 Defaults to @samp{""}.
18598
18599 @end deftypevr
18600
18601 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-front-end-configuration} parameter} string zabbix-host
18602 Zabbix server hostname.
18603
18604 Defaults to @samp{"localhost"}.
18605
18606 @end deftypevr
18607
18608 @deftypevr {@code{zabbix-front-end-configuration} parameter} number zabbix-port
18609 Zabbix server port.
18610
18611 Defaults to @samp{10051}.
18612
18613 @end deftypevr
18614
18615
18616 @c %end of fragment
18617
18618 @node Kerberos Services
18619 @subsection Kerberos Services
18620 @cindex Kerberos
18621
18622 The @code{(gnu services kerberos)} module provides services relating to
18623 the authentication protocol @dfn{Kerberos}.
18624
18625 @subsubheading Krb5 Service
18626
18627 Programs using a Kerberos client library normally
18628 expect a configuration file in @file{/etc/krb5.conf}.
18629 This service generates such a file from a definition provided in the
18630 operating system declaration.
18631 It does not cause any daemon to be started.
18632
18633 No ``keytab'' files are provided by this service---you must explicitly create them.
18634 This service is known to work with the MIT client library, @code{mit-krb5}.
18635 Other implementations have not been tested.
18636
18637 @defvr {Scheme Variable} krb5-service-type
18638 A service type for Kerberos 5 clients.
18639 @end defvr
18640
18641 @noindent
18642 Here is an example of its use:
18643 @lisp
18644 (service krb5-service-type
18645 (krb5-configuration
18646 (default-realm "EXAMPLE.COM")
18647 (allow-weak-crypto? #t)
18648 (realms (list
18649 (krb5-realm
18650 (name "EXAMPLE.COM")
18651 (admin-server "groucho.example.com")
18652 (kdc "karl.example.com"))
18653 (krb5-realm
18654 (name "ARGRX.EDU")
18655 (admin-server "kerb-admin.argrx.edu")
18656 (kdc "keys.argrx.edu"))))))
18657 @end lisp
18658
18659 @noindent
18660 This example provides a Kerberos@tie{}5 client configuration which:
18661 @itemize
18662 @item Recognizes two realms, @i{viz:} ``EXAMPLE.COM'' and ``ARGRX.EDU'', both
18663 of which have distinct administration servers and key distribution centers;
18664 @item Will default to the realm ``EXAMPLE.COM'' if the realm is not explicitly
18665 specified by clients;
18666 @item Accepts services which only support encryption types known to be weak.
18667 @end itemize
18668
18669 The @code{krb5-realm} and @code{krb5-configuration} types have many fields.
18670 Only the most commonly used ones are described here.
18671 For a full list, and more detailed explanation of each, see the MIT
18672 @uref{https://web.mit.edu/kerberos/krb5-devel/doc/admin/conf_files/krb5_conf.html,,krb5.conf}
18673 documentation.
18674
18675
18676 @deftp {Data Type} krb5-realm
18677 @cindex realm, kerberos
18678 @table @asis
18679 @item @code{name}
18680 This field is a string identifying the name of the realm.
18681 A common convention is to use the fully qualified DNS name of your organization,
18682 converted to upper case.
18683
18684 @item @code{admin-server}
18685 This field is a string identifying the host where the administration server is
18686 running.
18687
18688 @item @code{kdc}
18689 This field is a string identifying the key distribution center
18690 for the realm.
18691 @end table
18692 @end deftp
18693
18694 @deftp {Data Type} krb5-configuration
18695
18696 @table @asis
18697 @item @code{allow-weak-crypto?} (default: @code{#f})
18698 If this flag is @code{#t} then services which only offer encryption algorithms
18699 known to be weak will be accepted.
18700
18701 @item @code{default-realm} (default: @code{#f})
18702 This field should be a string identifying the default Kerberos
18703 realm for the client.
18704 You should set this field to the name of your Kerberos realm.
18705 If this value is @code{#f}
18706 then a realm must be specified with every Kerberos principal when invoking programs
18707 such as @command{kinit}.
18708
18709 @item @code{realms}
18710 This should be a non-empty list of @code{krb5-realm} objects, which clients may
18711 access.
18712 Normally, one of them will have a @code{name} field matching the @code{default-realm}
18713 field.
18714 @end table
18715 @end deftp
18716
18717
18718 @subsubheading PAM krb5 Service
18719 @cindex pam-krb5
18720
18721 The @code{pam-krb5} service allows for login authentication and password
18722 management via Kerberos.
18723 You will need this service if you want PAM enabled applications to authenticate
18724 users using Kerberos.
18725
18726 @defvr {Scheme Variable} pam-krb5-service-type
18727 A service type for the Kerberos 5 PAM module.
18728 @end defvr
18729
18730 @deftp {Data Type} pam-krb5-configuration
18731 Data type representing the configuration of the Kerberos 5 PAM module.
18732 This type has the following parameters:
18733 @table @asis
18734 @item @code{pam-krb5} (default: @code{pam-krb5})
18735 The pam-krb5 package to use.
18736
18737 @item @code{minimum-uid} (default: @code{1000})
18738 The smallest user ID for which Kerberos authentications should be attempted.
18739 Local accounts with lower values will silently fail to authenticate.
18740 @end table
18741 @end deftp
18742
18743
18744 @node LDAP Services
18745 @subsection LDAP Services
18746 @cindex LDAP
18747 @cindex nslcd, LDAP service
18748
18749 The @code{(gnu services authentication)} module provides the
18750 @code{nslcd-service-type}, which can be used to authenticate against an LDAP
18751 server. In addition to configuring the service itself, you may want to add
18752 @code{ldap} as a name service to the Name Service Switch. @xref{Name Service
18753 Switch} for detailed information.
18754
18755 Here is a simple operating system declaration with a default configuration of
18756 the @code{nslcd-service-type} and a Name Service Switch configuration that
18757 consults the @code{ldap} name service last:
18758
18759 @lisp
18760 (use-service-modules authentication)
18761 (use-modules (gnu system nss))
18762 ...
18763 (operating-system
18764 ...
18765 (services
18766 (cons*
18767 (service nslcd-service-type)
18768 (service dhcp-client-service-type)
18769 %base-services))
18770 (name-service-switch
18771 (let ((services (list (name-service (name "db"))
18772 (name-service (name "files"))
18773 (name-service (name "ldap")))))
18774 (name-service-switch
18775 (inherit %mdns-host-lookup-nss)
18776 (password services)
18777 (shadow services)
18778 (group services)
18779 (netgroup services)
18780 (gshadow services)))))
18781 @end lisp
18782
18783 @c %start of generated documentation for nslcd-configuration
18784
18785 Available @code{nslcd-configuration} fields are:
18786
18787 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} package nss-pam-ldapd
18788 The @code{nss-pam-ldapd} package to use.
18789
18790 @end deftypevr
18791
18792 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-number threads
18793 The number of threads to start that can handle requests and perform LDAP
18794 queries. Each thread opens a separate connection to the LDAP server.
18795 The default is to start 5 threads.
18796
18797 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
18798
18799 @end deftypevr
18800
18801 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} string uid
18802 This specifies the user id with which the daemon should be run.
18803
18804 Defaults to @samp{"nslcd"}.
18805
18806 @end deftypevr
18807
18808 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} string gid
18809 This specifies the group id with which the daemon should be run.
18810
18811 Defaults to @samp{"nslcd"}.
18812
18813 @end deftypevr
18814
18815 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} log-option log
18816 This option controls the way logging is done via a list containing
18817 SCHEME and LEVEL. The SCHEME argument may either be the symbols "none"
18818 or "syslog", or an absolute file name. The LEVEL argument is optional
18819 and specifies the log level. The log level may be one of the following
18820 symbols: "crit", "error", "warning", "notice", "info" or "debug". All
18821 messages with the specified log level or higher are logged.
18822
18823 Defaults to @samp{("/var/log/nslcd" info)}.
18824
18825 @end deftypevr
18826
18827 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} list uri
18828 The list of LDAP server URIs. Normally, only the first server will be
18829 used with the following servers as fall-back.
18830
18831 Defaults to @samp{("ldap://localhost:389/")}.
18832
18833 @end deftypevr
18834
18835 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string ldap-version
18836 The version of the LDAP protocol to use. The default is to use the
18837 maximum version supported by the LDAP library.
18838
18839 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
18840
18841 @end deftypevr
18842
18843 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string binddn
18844 Specifies the distinguished name with which to bind to the directory
18845 server for lookups. The default is to bind anonymously.
18846
18847 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
18848
18849 @end deftypevr
18850
18851 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string bindpw
18852 Specifies the credentials with which to bind. This option is only
18853 applicable when used with binddn.
18854
18855 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
18856
18857 @end deftypevr
18858
18859 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string rootpwmoddn
18860 Specifies the distinguished name to use when the root user tries to
18861 modify a user's password using the PAM module.
18862
18863 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
18864
18865 @end deftypevr
18866
18867 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string rootpwmodpw
18868 Specifies the credentials with which to bind if the root user tries to
18869 change a user's password. This option is only applicable when used with
18870 rootpwmoddn
18871
18872 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
18873
18874 @end deftypevr
18875
18876 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string sasl-mech
18877 Specifies the SASL mechanism to be used when performing SASL
18878 authentication.
18879
18880 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
18881
18882 @end deftypevr
18883
18884 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string sasl-realm
18885 Specifies the SASL realm to be used when performing SASL authentication.
18886
18887 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
18888
18889 @end deftypevr
18890
18891 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string sasl-authcid
18892 Specifies the authentication identity to be used when performing SASL
18893 authentication.
18894
18895 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
18896
18897 @end deftypevr
18898
18899 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string sasl-authzid
18900 Specifies the authorization identity to be used when performing SASL
18901 authentication.
18902
18903 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
18904
18905 @end deftypevr
18906
18907 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-boolean sasl-canonicalize?
18908 Determines whether the LDAP server host name should be canonicalised. If
18909 this is enabled the LDAP library will do a reverse host name lookup. By
18910 default, it is left up to the LDAP library whether this check is
18911 performed or not.
18912
18913 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
18914
18915 @end deftypevr
18916
18917 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string krb5-ccname
18918 Set the name for the GSS-API Kerberos credentials cache.
18919
18920 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
18921
18922 @end deftypevr
18923
18924 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} string base
18925 The directory search base.
18926
18927 Defaults to @samp{"dc=example,dc=com"}.
18928
18929 @end deftypevr
18930
18931 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} scope-option scope
18932 Specifies the search scope (subtree, onelevel, base or children). The
18933 default scope is subtree; base scope is almost never useful for name
18934 service lookups; children scope is not supported on all servers.
18935
18936 Defaults to @samp{(subtree)}.
18937
18938 @end deftypevr
18939
18940 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-deref-option deref
18941 Specifies the policy for dereferencing aliases. The default policy is
18942 to never dereference aliases.
18943
18944 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
18945
18946 @end deftypevr
18947
18948 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-boolean referrals
18949 Specifies whether automatic referral chasing should be enabled. The
18950 default behaviour is to chase referrals.
18951
18952 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
18953
18954 @end deftypevr
18955
18956 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} list-of-map-entries maps
18957 This option allows for custom attributes to be looked up instead of the
18958 default RFC 2307 attributes. It is a list of maps, each consisting of
18959 the name of a map, the RFC 2307 attribute to match and the query
18960 expression for the attribute as it is available in the directory.
18961
18962 Defaults to @samp{()}.
18963
18964 @end deftypevr
18965
18966 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} list-of-filter-entries filters
18967 A list of filters consisting of the name of a map to which the filter
18968 applies and an LDAP search filter expression.
18969
18970 Defaults to @samp{()}.
18971
18972 @end deftypevr
18973
18974 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-number bind-timelimit
18975 Specifies the time limit in seconds to use when connecting to the
18976 directory server. The default value is 10 seconds.
18977
18978 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
18979
18980 @end deftypevr
18981
18982 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-number timelimit
18983 Specifies the time limit (in seconds) to wait for a response from the
18984 LDAP server. A value of zero, which is the default, is to wait
18985 indefinitely for searches to be completed.
18986
18987 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
18988
18989 @end deftypevr
18990
18991 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-number idle-timelimit
18992 Specifies the period if inactivity (in seconds) after which the con‐
18993 nection to the LDAP server will be closed. The default is not to time
18994 out connections.
18995
18996 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
18997
18998 @end deftypevr
18999
19000 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-number reconnect-sleeptime
19001 Specifies the number of seconds to sleep when connecting to all LDAP
19002 servers fails. By default one second is waited between the first
19003 failure and the first retry.
19004
19005 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
19006
19007 @end deftypevr
19008
19009 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-number reconnect-retrytime
19010 Specifies the time after which the LDAP server is considered to be
19011 permanently unavailable. Once this time is reached retries will be done
19012 only once per this time period. The default value is 10 seconds.
19013
19014 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
19015
19016 @end deftypevr
19017
19018 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-ssl-option ssl
19019 Specifies whether to use SSL/TLS or not (the default is not to). If
19020 'start-tls is specified then StartTLS is used rather than raw LDAP over
19021 SSL.
19022
19023 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
19024
19025 @end deftypevr
19026
19027 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-tls-reqcert-option tls-reqcert
19028 Specifies what checks to perform on a server-supplied certificate. The
19029 meaning of the values is described in the ldap.conf(5) manual page.
19030
19031 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
19032
19033 @end deftypevr
19034
19035 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string tls-cacertdir
19036 Specifies the directory containing X.509 certificates for peer authen‐
19037 tication. This parameter is ignored when using GnuTLS.
19038
19039 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
19040
19041 @end deftypevr
19042
19043 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string tls-cacertfile
19044 Specifies the path to the X.509 certificate for peer authentication.
19045
19046 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
19047
19048 @end deftypevr
19049
19050 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string tls-randfile
19051 Specifies the path to an entropy source. This parameter is ignored when
19052 using GnuTLS.
19053
19054 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
19055
19056 @end deftypevr
19057
19058 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string tls-ciphers
19059 Specifies the ciphers to use for TLS as a string.
19060
19061 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
19062
19063 @end deftypevr
19064
19065 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string tls-cert
19066 Specifies the path to the file containing the local certificate for
19067 client TLS authentication.
19068
19069 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
19070
19071 @end deftypevr
19072
19073 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string tls-key
19074 Specifies the path to the file containing the private key for client TLS
19075 authentication.
19076
19077 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
19078
19079 @end deftypevr
19080
19081 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-number pagesize
19082 Set this to a number greater than 0 to request paged results from the
19083 LDAP server in accordance with RFC2696. The default (0) is to not
19084 request paged results.
19085
19086 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
19087
19088 @end deftypevr
19089
19090 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-ignore-users-option nss-initgroups-ignoreusers
19091 This option prevents group membership lookups through LDAP for the
19092 specified users. Alternatively, the value 'all-local may be used. With
19093 that value nslcd builds a full list of non-LDAP users on startup.
19094
19095 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
19096
19097 @end deftypevr
19098
19099 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-number nss-min-uid
19100 This option ensures that LDAP users with a numeric user id lower than
19101 the specified value are ignored.
19102
19103 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
19104
19105 @end deftypevr
19106
19107 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-number nss-uid-offset
19108 This option specifies an offset that is added to all LDAP numeric user
19109 ids. This can be used to avoid user id collisions with local users.
19110
19111 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
19112
19113 @end deftypevr
19114
19115 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-number nss-gid-offset
19116 This option specifies an offset that is added to all LDAP numeric group
19117 ids. This can be used to avoid user id collisions with local groups.
19118
19119 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
19120
19121 @end deftypevr
19122
19123 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-boolean nss-nested-groups
19124 If this option is set, the member attribute of a group may point to
19125 another group. Members of nested groups are also returned in the higher
19126 level group and parent groups are returned when finding groups for a
19127 specific user. The default is not to perform extra searches for nested
19128 groups.
19129
19130 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
19131
19132 @end deftypevr
19133
19134 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-boolean nss-getgrent-skipmembers
19135 If this option is set, the group member list is not retrieved when
19136 looking up groups. Lookups for finding which groups a user belongs to
19137 will remain functional so the user will likely still get the correct
19138 groups assigned on login.
19139
19140 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
19141
19142 @end deftypevr
19143
19144 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-boolean nss-disable-enumeration
19145 If this option is set, functions which cause all user/group entries to
19146 be loaded from the directory will not succeed in doing so. This can
19147 dramatically reduce LDAP server load in situations where there are a
19148 great number of users and/or groups. This option is not recommended for
19149 most configurations.
19150
19151 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
19152
19153 @end deftypevr
19154
19155 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string validnames
19156 This option can be used to specify how user and group names are verified
19157 within the system. This pattern is used to check all user and group
19158 names that are requested and returned from LDAP.
19159
19160 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
19161
19162 @end deftypevr
19163
19164 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-boolean ignorecase
19165 This specifies whether or not to perform searches using case-insensitive
19166 matching. Enabling this could open up the system to authorization
19167 bypass vulnerabilities and introduce nscd cache poisoning
19168 vulnerabilities which allow denial of service.
19169
19170 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
19171
19172 @end deftypevr
19173
19174 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-boolean pam-authc-ppolicy
19175 This option specifies whether password policy controls are requested and
19176 handled from the LDAP server when performing user authentication.
19177
19178 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
19179
19180 @end deftypevr
19181
19182 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string pam-authc-search
19183 By default nslcd performs an LDAP search with the user's credentials
19184 after BIND (authentication) to ensure that the BIND operation was
19185 successful. The default search is a simple check to see if the user's
19186 DN exists. A search filter can be specified that will be used instead.
19187 It should return at least one entry.
19188
19189 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
19190
19191 @end deftypevr
19192
19193 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string pam-authz-search
19194 This option allows flexible fine tuning of the authorisation check that
19195 should be performed. The search filter specified is executed and if any
19196 entries match, access is granted, otherwise access is denied.
19197
19198 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
19199
19200 @end deftypevr
19201
19202 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} maybe-string pam-password-prohibit-message
19203 If this option is set password modification using pam_ldap will be
19204 denied and the specified message will be presented to the user instead.
19205 The message can be used to direct the user to an alternative means of
19206 changing their password.
19207
19208 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
19209
19210 @end deftypevr
19211
19212 @deftypevr {@code{nslcd-configuration} parameter} list pam-services
19213 List of pam service names for which LDAP authentication should suffice.
19214
19215 Defaults to @samp{()}.
19216
19217 @end deftypevr
19218
19219 @c %end of generated documentation for nslcd-configuration
19220
19221
19222 @node Web Services
19223 @subsection Web Services
19224
19225 @cindex web
19226 @cindex www
19227 @cindex HTTP
19228 The @code{(gnu services web)} module provides the Apache HTTP Server,
19229 the nginx web server, and also a fastcgi wrapper daemon.
19230
19231 @subsubheading Apache HTTP Server
19232
19233 @deffn {Scheme Variable} httpd-service-type
19234 Service type for the @uref{https://httpd.apache.org/,Apache HTTP} server
19235 (@dfn{httpd}). The value for this service type is a
19236 @code{httpd-configuration} record.
19237
19238 A simple example configuration is given below.
19239
19240 @lisp
19241 (service httpd-service-type
19242 (httpd-configuration
19243 (config
19244 (httpd-config-file
19245 (server-name "www.example.com")
19246 (document-root "/srv/http/www.example.com")))))
19247 @end lisp
19248
19249 Other services can also extend the @code{httpd-service-type} to add to
19250 the configuration.
19251
19252 @lisp
19253 (simple-service 'my-extra-server httpd-service-type
19254 (list
19255 (httpd-virtualhost
19256 "*:80"
19257 (list (string-append
19258 "ServerName "www.example.com
19259 DocumentRoot \"/srv/http/www.example.com\"")))))
19260 @end lisp
19261 @end deffn
19262
19263 The details for the @code{httpd-configuration}, @code{httpd-module},
19264 @code{httpd-config-file} and @code{httpd-virtualhost} record types are
19265 given below.
19266
19267 @deffn {Data Type} httpd-configuration
19268 This data type represents the configuration for the httpd service.
19269
19270 @table @asis
19271 @item @code{package} (default: @code{httpd})
19272 The httpd package to use.
19273
19274 @item @code{pid-file} (default: @code{"/var/run/httpd"})
19275 The pid file used by the shepherd-service.
19276
19277 @item @code{config} (default: @code{(httpd-config-file)})
19278 The configuration file to use with the httpd service. The default value
19279 is a @code{httpd-config-file} record, but this can also be a different
19280 G-expression that generates a file, for example a @code{plain-file}. A
19281 file outside of the store can also be specified through a string.
19282
19283 @end table
19284 @end deffn
19285
19286 @deffn {Data Type} httpd-module
19287 This data type represents a module for the httpd service.
19288
19289 @table @asis
19290 @item @code{name}
19291 The name of the module.
19292
19293 @item @code{file}
19294 The file for the module. This can be relative to the httpd package being
19295 used, the absolute location of a file, or a G-expression for a file
19296 within the store, for example @code{(file-append mod-wsgi
19297 "/modules/mod_wsgi.so")}.
19298
19299 @end table
19300 @end deffn
19301
19302 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %default-httpd-modules
19303 A default list of @code{httpd-module} objects.
19304 @end defvr
19305
19306 @deffn {Data Type} httpd-config-file
19307 This data type represents a configuration file for the httpd service.
19308
19309 @table @asis
19310 @item @code{modules} (default: @code{%default-httpd-modules})
19311 The modules to load. Additional modules can be added here, or loaded by
19312 additional configuration.
19313
19314 For example, in order to handle requests for PHP files, you can use Apache’s
19315 @code{mod_proxy_fcgi} module along with @code{php-fpm-service-type}:
19316
19317 @lisp
19318 (service httpd-service-type
19319 (httpd-configuration
19320 (config
19321 (httpd-config-file
19322 (modules (cons*
19323 (httpd-module
19324 (name "proxy_module")
19325 (file "modules/mod_proxy.so"))
19326 (httpd-module
19327 (name "proxy_fcgi_module")
19328 (file "modules/mod_proxy_fcgi.so"))
19329 %default-httpd-modules))
19330 (extra-config (list "\
19331 <FilesMatch \\.php$>
19332 SetHandler \"proxy:unix:/var/run/php-fpm.sock|fcgi://localhost/\"
19333 </FilesMatch>"))))))
19334 (service php-fpm-service-type
19335 (php-fpm-configuration
19336 (socket "/var/run/php-fpm.sock")
19337 (socket-group "httpd")))
19338 @end lisp
19339
19340 @item @code{server-root} (default: @code{httpd})
19341 The @code{ServerRoot} in the configuration file, defaults to the httpd
19342 package. Directives including @code{Include} and @code{LoadModule} are
19343 taken as relative to the server root.
19344
19345 @item @code{server-name} (default: @code{#f})
19346 The @code{ServerName} in the configuration file, used to specify the
19347 request scheme, hostname and port that the server uses to identify
19348 itself.
19349
19350 This doesn't need to be set in the server config, and can be specifyed
19351 in virtual hosts. The default is @code{#f} to not specify a
19352 @code{ServerName}.
19353
19354 @item @code{document-root} (default: @code{"/srv/http"})
19355 The @code{DocumentRoot} from which files will be served.
19356
19357 @item @code{listen} (default: @code{'("80")})
19358 The list of values for the @code{Listen} directives in the config
19359 file. The value should be a list of strings, when each string can
19360 specify the port number to listen on, and optionally the IP address and
19361 protocol to use.
19362
19363 @item @code{pid-file} (default: @code{"/var/run/httpd"})
19364 The @code{PidFile} to use. This should match the @code{pid-file} set in
19365 the @code{httpd-configuration} so that the Shepherd service is
19366 configured correctly.
19367
19368 @item @code{error-log} (default: @code{"/var/log/httpd/error_log"})
19369 The @code{ErrorLog} to which the server will log errors.
19370
19371 @item @code{user} (default: @code{"httpd"})
19372 The @code{User} which the server will answer requests as.
19373
19374 @item @code{group} (default: @code{"httpd"})
19375 The @code{Group} which the server will answer requests as.
19376
19377 @item @code{extra-config} (default: @code{(list "TypesConfig etc/httpd/mime.types")})
19378 A flat list of strings and G-expressions which will be added to the end
19379 of the configuration file.
19380
19381 Any values which the service is extended with will be appended to this
19382 list.
19383
19384 @end table
19385 @end deffn
19386
19387 @deffn {Data Type} httpd-virtualhost
19388 This data type represents a virtualhost configuration block for the httpd service.
19389
19390 These should be added to the extra-config for the httpd-service.
19391
19392 @lisp
19393 (simple-service 'my-extra-server httpd-service-type
19394 (list
19395 (httpd-virtualhost
19396 "*:80"
19397 (list (string-append
19398 "ServerName "www.example.com
19399 DocumentRoot \"/srv/http/www.example.com\"")))))
19400 @end lisp
19401
19402 @table @asis
19403 @item @code{addresses-and-ports}
19404 The addresses and ports for the @code{VirtualHost} directive.
19405
19406 @item @code{contents}
19407 The contents of the @code{VirtualHost} directive, this should be a list
19408 of strings and G-expressions.
19409
19410 @end table
19411 @end deffn
19412
19413 @subsubheading NGINX
19414
19415 @deffn {Scheme Variable} nginx-service-type
19416 Service type for the @uref{https://nginx.org/,NGinx} web server. The
19417 value for this service type is a @code{<nginx-configuration>} record.
19418
19419 A simple example configuration is given below.
19420
19421 @lisp
19422 (service nginx-service-type
19423 (nginx-configuration
19424 (server-blocks
19425 (list (nginx-server-configuration
19426 (server-name '("www.example.com"))
19427 (root "/srv/http/www.example.com"))))))
19428 @end lisp
19429
19430 In addition to adding server blocks to the service configuration
19431 directly, this service can be extended by other services to add server
19432 blocks, as in this example:
19433
19434 @lisp
19435 (simple-service 'my-extra-server nginx-service-type
19436 (list (nginx-server-configuration
19437 (root "/srv/http/extra-website")
19438 (try-files (list "$uri" "$uri/index.html")))))
19439 @end lisp
19440 @end deffn
19441
19442 At startup, @command{nginx} has not yet read its configuration file, so
19443 it uses a default file to log error messages. If it fails to load its
19444 configuration file, that is where error messages are logged. After the
19445 configuration file is loaded, the default error log file changes as per
19446 configuration. In our case, startup error messages can be found in
19447 @file{/var/run/nginx/logs/error.log}, and after configuration in
19448 @file{/var/log/nginx/error.log}. The second location can be changed
19449 with the @var{log-directory} configuration option.
19450
19451 @deffn {Data Type} nginx-configuration
19452 This data type represents the configuration for NGinx. Some
19453 configuration can be done through this and the other provided record
19454 types, or alternatively, a config file can be provided.
19455
19456 @table @asis
19457 @item @code{nginx} (default: @code{nginx})
19458 The nginx package to use.
19459
19460 @item @code{log-directory} (default: @code{"/var/log/nginx"})
19461 The directory to which NGinx will write log files.
19462
19463 @item @code{run-directory} (default: @code{"/var/run/nginx"})
19464 The directory in which NGinx will create a pid file, and write temporary
19465 files.
19466
19467 @item @code{server-blocks} (default: @code{'()})
19468 A list of @dfn{server blocks} to create in the generated configuration
19469 file, the elements should be of type
19470 @code{<nginx-server-configuration>}.
19471
19472 The following example would setup NGinx to serve @code{www.example.com}
19473 from the @code{/srv/http/www.example.com} directory, without using
19474 HTTPS.
19475 @lisp
19476 (service nginx-service-type
19477 (nginx-configuration
19478 (server-blocks
19479 (list (nginx-server-configuration
19480 (server-name '("www.example.com"))
19481 (root "/srv/http/www.example.com"))))))
19482 @end lisp
19483
19484 @item @code{upstream-blocks} (default: @code{'()})
19485 A list of @dfn{upstream blocks} to create in the generated configuration
19486 file, the elements should be of type
19487 @code{<nginx-upstream-configuration>}.
19488
19489 Configuring upstreams through the @code{upstream-blocks} can be useful
19490 when combined with @code{locations} in the
19491 @code{<nginx-server-configuration>} records. The following example
19492 creates a server configuration with one location configuration, that
19493 will proxy requests to a upstream configuration, which will handle
19494 requests with two servers.
19495
19496 @lisp
19497 (service
19498 nginx-service-type
19499 (nginx-configuration
19500 (server-blocks
19501 (list (nginx-server-configuration
19502 (server-name '("www.example.com"))
19503 (root "/srv/http/www.example.com")
19504 (locations
19505 (list
19506 (nginx-location-configuration
19507 (uri "/path1")
19508 (body '("proxy_pass http://server-proxy;"))))))))
19509 (upstream-blocks
19510 (list (nginx-upstream-configuration
19511 (name "server-proxy")
19512 (servers (list "server1.example.com"
19513 "server2.example.com")))))))
19514 @end lisp
19515
19516 @item @code{file} (default: @code{#f})
19517 If a configuration @var{file} is provided, this will be used, rather than
19518 generating a configuration file from the provided @code{log-directory},
19519 @code{run-directory}, @code{server-blocks} and @code{upstream-blocks}. For
19520 proper operation, these arguments should match what is in @var{file} to ensure
19521 that the directories are created when the service is activated.
19522
19523 This can be useful if you have an existing configuration file, or it's
19524 not possible to do what is required through the other parts of the
19525 nginx-configuration record.
19526
19527 @item @code{server-names-hash-bucket-size} (default: @code{#f})
19528 Bucket size for the server names hash tables, defaults to @code{#f} to
19529 use the size of the processors cache line.
19530
19531 @item @code{server-names-hash-bucket-max-size} (default: @code{#f})
19532 Maximum bucket size for the server names hash tables.
19533
19534 @item @code{extra-content} (default: @code{""})
19535 Extra content for the @code{http} block. Should be string or a string
19536 valued G-expression.
19537
19538 @end table
19539 @end deffn
19540
19541 @deftp {Data Type} nginx-server-configuration
19542 Data type representing the configuration of an nginx server block.
19543 This type has the following parameters:
19544
19545 @table @asis
19546 @item @code{listen} (default: @code{'("80" "443 ssl")})
19547 Each @code{listen} directive sets the address and port for IP, or the
19548 path for a UNIX-domain socket on which the server will accept requests.
19549 Both address and port, or only address or only port can be specified.
19550 An address may also be a hostname, for example:
19551
19552 @lisp
19553 '("127.0.0.1:8000" "127.0.0.1" "8000" "*:8000" "localhost:8000")
19554 @end lisp
19555
19556 @item @code{server-name} (default: @code{(list 'default)})
19557 A list of server names this server represents. @code{'default} represents the
19558 default server for connections matching no other server.
19559
19560 @item @code{root} (default: @code{"/srv/http"})
19561 Root of the website nginx will serve.
19562
19563 @item @code{locations} (default: @code{'()})
19564 A list of @dfn{nginx-location-configuration} or
19565 @dfn{nginx-named-location-configuration} records to use within this
19566 server block.
19567
19568 @item @code{index} (default: @code{(list "index.html")})
19569 Index files to look for when clients ask for a directory. If it cannot be found,
19570 Nginx will send the list of files in the directory.
19571
19572 @item @code{try-files} (default: @code{'()})
19573 A list of files whose existence is checked in the specified order.
19574 @code{nginx} will use the first file it finds to process the request.
19575
19576 @item @code{ssl-certificate} (default: @code{#f})
19577 Where to find the certificate for secure connections. Set it to @code{#f} if
19578 you don't have a certificate or you don't want to use HTTPS.
19579
19580 @item @code{ssl-certificate-key} (default: @code{#f})
19581 Where to find the private key for secure connections. Set it to @code{#f} if
19582 you don't have a key or you don't want to use HTTPS.
19583
19584 @item @code{server-tokens?} (default: @code{#f})
19585 Whether the server should add its configuration to response.
19586
19587 @item @code{raw-content} (default: @code{'()})
19588 A list of raw lines added to the server block.
19589
19590 @end table
19591 @end deftp
19592
19593 @deftp {Data Type} nginx-upstream-configuration
19594 Data type representing the configuration of an nginx @code{upstream}
19595 block. This type has the following parameters:
19596
19597 @table @asis
19598 @item @code{name}
19599 Name for this group of servers.
19600
19601 @item @code{servers}
19602 Specify the addresses of the servers in the group. The address can be
19603 specified as a IP address (e.g.@: @samp{127.0.0.1}), domain name
19604 (e.g.@: @samp{backend1.example.com}) or a path to a UNIX socket using the
19605 prefix @samp{unix:}. For addresses using an IP address or domain name,
19606 the default port is 80, and a different port can be specified
19607 explicitly.
19608
19609 @end table
19610 @end deftp
19611
19612 @deftp {Data Type} nginx-location-configuration
19613 Data type representing the configuration of an nginx @code{location}
19614 block. This type has the following parameters:
19615
19616 @table @asis
19617 @item @code{uri}
19618 URI which this location block matches.
19619
19620 @anchor{nginx-location-configuration body}
19621 @item @code{body}
19622 Body of the location block, specified as a list of strings. This can contain
19623 many
19624 configuration directives. For example, to pass requests to a upstream
19625 server group defined using an @code{nginx-upstream-configuration} block,
19626 the following directive would be specified in the body @samp{(list "proxy_pass
19627 http://upstream-name;")}.
19628
19629 @end table
19630 @end deftp
19631
19632 @deftp {Data Type} nginx-named-location-configuration
19633 Data type representing the configuration of an nginx named location
19634 block. Named location blocks are used for request redirection, and not
19635 used for regular request processing. This type has the following
19636 parameters:
19637
19638 @table @asis
19639 @item @code{name}
19640 Name to identify this location block.
19641
19642 @item @code{body}
19643 @xref{nginx-location-configuration body}, as the body for named location
19644 blocks can be used in a similar way to the
19645 @code{nginx-location-configuration body}. One restriction is that the
19646 body of a named location block cannot contain location blocks.
19647
19648 @end table
19649 @end deftp
19650
19651 @subsubheading Varnish Cache
19652 @cindex Varnish
19653 Varnish is a fast cache server that sits in between web applications
19654 and end users. It proxies requests from clients and caches the
19655 accessed URLs such that multiple requests for the same resource only
19656 creates one request to the back-end.
19657
19658 @defvr {Scheme Variable} varnish-service-type
19659 Service type for the Varnish daemon.
19660 @end defvr
19661
19662 @deftp {Data Type} varnish-configuration
19663 Data type representing the @code{varnish} service configuration.
19664 This type has the following parameters:
19665
19666 @table @asis
19667 @item @code{package} (default: @code{varnish})
19668 The Varnish package to use.
19669
19670 @item @code{name} (default: @code{"default"})
19671 A name for this Varnish instance. Varnish will create a directory in
19672 @file{/var/varnish/} with this name and keep temporary files there. If
19673 the name starts with a forward slash, it is interpreted as an absolute
19674 directory name.
19675
19676 Pass the @code{-n} argument to other Varnish programs to connect to the
19677 named instance, e.g.@: @command{varnishncsa -n default}.
19678
19679 @item @code{backend} (default: @code{"localhost:8080"})
19680 The backend to use. This option has no effect if @code{vcl} is set.
19681
19682 @item @code{vcl} (default: #f)
19683 The @dfn{VCL} (Varnish Configuration Language) program to run. If this
19684 is @code{#f}, Varnish will proxy @code{backend} using the default
19685 configuration. Otherwise this must be a file-like object with valid
19686 VCL syntax.
19687
19688 @c Varnish does not support HTTPS, so keep this URL to avoid confusion.
19689 For example, to mirror @url{http://www.gnu.org,www.gnu.org} with VCL you
19690 can do something along these lines:
19691
19692 @lisp
19693 (define %gnu-mirror
19694 (plain-file
19695 "gnu.vcl"
19696 "vcl 4.1;
19697 backend gnu @{ .host = "www.gnu.org"; @}"))
19698
19699 (operating-system
19700 ...
19701 (services (cons (service varnish-service-type
19702 (varnish-configuration
19703 (listen '(":80"))
19704 (vcl %gnu-mirror)))
19705 %base-services)))
19706 @end lisp
19707
19708 The configuration of an already running Varnish instance can be inspected
19709 and changed using the @command{varnishadm} program.
19710
19711 Consult the @url{https://varnish-cache.org/docs/,Varnish User Guide} and
19712 @url{https://book.varnish-software.com/4.0/,Varnish Book} for
19713 comprehensive documentation on Varnish and its configuration language.
19714
19715 @item @code{listen} (default: @code{'("localhost:80")})
19716 List of addresses Varnish will listen on.
19717
19718 @item @code{storage} (default: @code{'("malloc,128m")})
19719 List of storage backends that will be available in VCL.
19720
19721 @item @code{parameters} (default: @code{'()})
19722 List of run-time parameters in the form @code{'(("parameter" . "value"))}.
19723
19724 @item @code{extra-options} (default: @code{'()})
19725 Additional arguments to pass to the @command{varnishd} process.
19726
19727 @end table
19728 @end deftp
19729
19730 @subsubheading Patchwork
19731 @cindex Patchwork
19732 Patchwork is a patch tracking system. It can collect patches sent to a
19733 mailing list, and display them in a web interface.
19734
19735 @defvr {Scheme Variable} patchwork-service-type
19736 Service type for Patchwork.
19737 @end defvr
19738
19739 The following example is an example of a minimal service for Patchwork, for
19740 the @code{patchwork.example.com} domain.
19741
19742 @lisp
19743 (service patchwork-service-type
19744 (patchwork-configuration
19745 (domain "patchwork.example.com")
19746 (settings-module
19747 (patchwork-settings-module
19748 (allowed-hosts (list domain))
19749 (default-from-email "patchwork@@patchwork.example.com")))
19750 (getmail-retriever-config
19751 (getmail-retriever-configuration
19752 (type "SimpleIMAPSSLRetriever")
19753 (server "imap.example.com")
19754 (port 993)
19755 (username "patchwork")
19756 (password-command
19757 (list (file-append coreutils "/bin/cat")
19758 "/etc/getmail-patchwork-imap-password"))
19759 (extra-parameters
19760 '((mailboxes . ("Patches"))))))))
19761
19762 @end lisp
19763
19764 There are three records for configuring the Patchwork service. The
19765 @code{<patchwork-configuration>} relates to the configuration for Patchwork
19766 within the HTTPD service.
19767
19768 The @code{settings-module} field within the @code{<patchwork-configuration>}
19769 record can be populated with the @code{<patchwork-settings-module>} record,
19770 which describes a settings module that is generated within the Guix store.
19771
19772 For the @code{database-configuration} field within the
19773 @code{<patchwork-settings-module>}, the
19774 @code{<patchwork-database-configuration>} must be used.
19775
19776 @deftp {Data Type} patchwork-configuration
19777 Data type representing the Patchwork service configuration. This type has the
19778 following parameters:
19779
19780 @table @asis
19781 @item @code{patchwork} (default: @code{patchwork})
19782 The Patchwork package to use.
19783
19784 @item @code{domain}
19785 The domain to use for Patchwork, this is used in the HTTPD service virtual
19786 host.
19787
19788 @item @code{settings-module}
19789 The settings module to use for Patchwork. As a Django application, Patchwork
19790 is configured with a Python module containing the settings. This can either be
19791 an instance of the @code{<patchwork-settings-module>} record, any other record
19792 that represents the settings in the store, or a directory outside of the
19793 store.
19794
19795 @item @code{static-path} (default: @code{"/static/"})
19796 The path under which the HTTPD service should serve the static files.
19797
19798 @item @code{getmail-retriever-config}
19799 The getmail-retriever-configuration record value to use with
19800 Patchwork. Getmail will be configured with this value, the messages will be
19801 delivered to Patchwork.
19802
19803 @end table
19804 @end deftp
19805
19806 @deftp {Data Type} patchwork-settings-module
19807 Data type representing a settings module for Patchwork. Some of these
19808 settings relate directly to Patchwork, but others relate to Django, the web
19809 framework used by Patchwork, or the Django Rest Framework library. This type
19810 has the following parameters:
19811
19812 @table @asis
19813 @item @code{database-configuration} (default: @code{(patchwork-database-configuration)})
19814 The database connection settings used for Patchwork. See the
19815 @code{<patchwork-database-configuration>} record type for more information.
19816
19817 @item @code{secret-key-file} (default: @code{"/etc/patchwork/django-secret-key"})
19818 Patchwork, as a Django web application uses a secret key for cryptographically
19819 signing values. This file should contain a unique unpredictable value.
19820
19821 If this file does not exist, it will be created and populated with a random
19822 value by the patchwork-setup shepherd service.
19823
19824 This setting relates to Django.
19825
19826 @item @code{allowed-hosts}
19827 A list of valid hosts for this Patchwork service. This should at least include
19828 the domain specified in the @code{<patchwork-configuration>} record.
19829
19830 This is a Django setting.
19831
19832 @item @code{default-from-email}
19833 The email address from which Patchwork should send email by default.
19834
19835 This is a Patchwork setting.
19836
19837 @item @code{static-url} (default: @code{#f})
19838 The URL to use when serving static assets. It can be part of a URL, or a full
19839 URL, but must end in a @code{/}.
19840
19841 If the default value is used, the @code{static-path} value from the
19842 @code{<patchwork-configuration>} record will be used.
19843
19844 This is a Django setting.
19845
19846 @item @code{admins} (default: @code{'()})
19847 Email addresses to send the details of errors that occur. Each value should
19848 be a list containing two elements, the name and then the email address.
19849
19850 This is a Django setting.
19851
19852 @item @code{debug?} (default: @code{#f})
19853 Whether to run Patchwork in debug mode. If set to @code{#t}, detailed error
19854 messages will be shown.
19855
19856 This is a Django setting.
19857
19858 @item @code{enable-rest-api?} (default: @code{#t})
19859 Whether to enable the Patchwork REST API.
19860
19861 This is a Patchwork setting.
19862
19863 @item @code{enable-xmlrpc?} (default: @code{#t})
19864 Whether to enable the XML RPC API.
19865
19866 This is a Patchwork setting.
19867
19868 @item @code{force-https-links?} (default: @code{#t})
19869 Whether to use HTTPS links on Patchwork pages.
19870
19871 This is a Patchwork setting.
19872
19873 @item @code{extra-settings} (default: @code{""})
19874 Extra code to place at the end of the Patchwork settings module.
19875
19876 @end table
19877 @end deftp
19878
19879 @deftp {Data Type} patchwork-database-configuration
19880 Data type representing the database configuration for Patchwork.
19881
19882 @table @asis
19883 @item @code{engine} (default: @code{"django.db.backends.postgresql_psycopg2"})
19884 The database engine to use.
19885
19886 @item @code{name} (default: @code{"patchwork"})
19887 The name of the database to use.
19888
19889 @item @code{user} (default: @code{"httpd"})
19890 The user to connect to the database as.
19891
19892 @item @code{password} (default: @code{""})
19893 The password to use when connecting to the database.
19894
19895 @item @code{host} (default: @code{""})
19896 The host to make the database connection to.
19897
19898 @item @code{port} (default: @code{""})
19899 The port on which to connect to the database.
19900
19901 @end table
19902 @end deftp
19903
19904 @subsubheading FastCGI
19905 @cindex fastcgi
19906 @cindex fcgiwrap
19907 FastCGI is an interface between the front-end and the back-end of a web
19908 service. It is a somewhat legacy facility; new web services should
19909 generally just talk HTTP between the front-end and the back-end.
19910 However there are a number of back-end services such as PHP or the
19911 optimized HTTP Git repository access that use FastCGI, so we have
19912 support for it in Guix.
19913
19914 To use FastCGI, you configure the front-end web server (e.g., nginx) to
19915 dispatch some subset of its requests to the fastcgi backend, which
19916 listens on a local TCP or UNIX socket. There is an intermediary
19917 @code{fcgiwrap} program that sits between the actual backend process and
19918 the web server. The front-end indicates which backend program to run,
19919 passing that information to the @code{fcgiwrap} process.
19920
19921 @defvr {Scheme Variable} fcgiwrap-service-type
19922 A service type for the @code{fcgiwrap} FastCGI proxy.
19923 @end defvr
19924
19925 @deftp {Data Type} fcgiwrap-configuration
19926 Data type representing the configuration of the @code{fcgiwrap} service.
19927 This type has the following parameters:
19928 @table @asis
19929 @item @code{package} (default: @code{fcgiwrap})
19930 The fcgiwrap package to use.
19931
19932 @item @code{socket} (default: @code{tcp:127.0.0.1:9000})
19933 The socket on which the @code{fcgiwrap} process should listen, as a
19934 string. Valid @var{socket} values include
19935 @code{unix:@var{/path/to/unix/socket}},
19936 @code{tcp:@var{dot.ted.qu.ad}:@var{port}} and
19937 @code{tcp6:[@var{ipv6_addr}]:port}.
19938
19939 @item @code{user} (default: @code{fcgiwrap})
19940 @itemx @code{group} (default: @code{fcgiwrap})
19941 The user and group names, as strings, under which to run the
19942 @code{fcgiwrap} process. The @code{fastcgi} service will ensure that if
19943 the user asks for the specific user or group names @code{fcgiwrap} that
19944 the corresponding user and/or group is present on the system.
19945
19946 It is possible to configure a FastCGI-backed web service to pass HTTP
19947 authentication information from the front-end to the back-end, and to
19948 allow @code{fcgiwrap} to run the back-end process as a corresponding
19949 local user. To enable this capability on the back-end., run
19950 @code{fcgiwrap} as the @code{root} user and group. Note that this
19951 capability also has to be configured on the front-end as well.
19952 @end table
19953 @end deftp
19954
19955 @cindex php-fpm
19956 PHP-FPM (FastCGI Process Manager) is an alternative PHP FastCGI implementation
19957 with some additional features useful for sites of any size.
19958
19959 These features include:
19960 @itemize @bullet
19961 @item Adaptive process spawning
19962 @item Basic statistics (similar to Apache's mod_status)
19963 @item Advanced process management with graceful stop/start
19964 @item Ability to start workers with different uid/gid/chroot/environment
19965 and different php.ini (replaces safe_mode)
19966 @item Stdout & stderr logging
19967 @item Emergency restart in case of accidental opcode cache destruction
19968 @item Accelerated upload support
19969 @item Support for a "slowlog"
19970 @item Enhancements to FastCGI, such as fastcgi_finish_request() -
19971 a special function to finish request & flush all data while continuing to do
19972 something time-consuming (video converting, stats processing, etc.)
19973 @end itemize
19974 ...@: and much more.
19975
19976 @defvr {Scheme Variable} php-fpm-service-type
19977 A Service type for @code{php-fpm}.
19978 @end defvr
19979
19980 @deftp {Data Type} php-fpm-configuration
19981 Data Type for php-fpm service configuration.
19982 @table @asis
19983 @item @code{php} (default: @code{php})
19984 The php package to use.
19985 @item @code{socket} (default: @code{(string-append "/var/run/php" (version-major (package-version php)) "-fpm.sock")})
19986 The address on which to accept FastCGI requests. Valid syntaxes are:
19987 @table @asis
19988 @item @code{"ip.add.re.ss:port"}
19989 Listen on a TCP socket to a specific address on a specific port.
19990 @item @code{"port"}
19991 Listen on a TCP socket to all addresses on a specific port.
19992 @item @code{"/path/to/unix/socket"}
19993 Listen on a unix socket.
19994 @end table
19995
19996 @item @code{user} (default: @code{php-fpm})
19997 User who will own the php worker processes.
19998 @item @code{group} (default: @code{php-fpm})
19999 Group of the worker processes.
20000 @item @code{socket-user} (default: @code{php-fpm})
20001 User who can speak to the php-fpm socket.
20002 @item @code{socket-group} (default: @code{php-fpm})
20003 Group that can speak to the php-fpm socket.
20004 @item @code{pid-file} (default: @code{(string-append "/var/run/php" (version-major (package-version php)) "-fpm.pid")})
20005 The process id of the php-fpm process is written to this file
20006 once the service has started.
20007 @item @code{log-file} (default: @code{(string-append "/var/log/php" (version-major (package-version php)) "-fpm.log")})
20008 Log for the php-fpm master process.
20009 @item @code{process-manager} (default: @code{(php-fpm-dynamic-process-manager-configuration)})
20010 Detailed settings for the php-fpm process manager.
20011 Must be either:
20012 @table @asis
20013 @item @code{<php-fpm-dynamic-process-manager-configuration>}
20014 @item @code{<php-fpm-static-process-manager-configuration>}
20015 @item @code{<php-fpm-on-demand-process-manager-configuration>}
20016 @end table
20017 @item @code{display-errors} (default @code{#f})
20018 Determines whether php errors and warning should be sent to clients
20019 and displayed in their browsers.
20020 This is useful for local php development, but a security risk for public sites,
20021 as error messages can reveal passwords and personal data.
20022 @item @code{timezone} (default @code{#f})
20023 Specifies @code{php_admin_value[date.timezone]} parameter.
20024 @item @code{workers-logfile} (default @code{(string-append "/var/log/php" (version-major (package-version php)) "-fpm.www.log")})
20025 This file will log the @code{stderr} outputs of php worker processes.
20026 Can be set to @code{#f} to disable logging.
20027 @item @code{file} (default @code{#f})
20028 An optional override of the whole configuration.
20029 You can use the @code{mixed-text-file} function or an absolute filepath for it.
20030 @end table
20031 @end deftp
20032
20033 @deftp {Data type} php-fpm-dynamic-process-manager-configuration
20034 Data Type for the @code{dynamic} php-fpm process manager. With the
20035 @code{dynamic} process manager, spare worker processes are kept around
20036 based on it's configured limits.
20037 @table @asis
20038 @item @code{max-children} (default: @code{5})
20039 Maximum of worker processes.
20040 @item @code{start-servers} (default: @code{2})
20041 How many worker processes should be started on start-up.
20042 @item @code{min-spare-servers} (default: @code{1})
20043 How many spare worker processes should be kept around at minimum.
20044 @item @code{max-spare-servers} (default: @code{3})
20045 How many spare worker processes should be kept around at maximum.
20046 @end table
20047 @end deftp
20048
20049 @deftp {Data type} php-fpm-static-process-manager-configuration
20050 Data Type for the @code{static} php-fpm process manager. With the
20051 @code{static} process manager, an unchanging number of worker processes
20052 are created.
20053 @table @asis
20054 @item @code{max-children} (default: @code{5})
20055 Maximum of worker processes.
20056 @end table
20057 @end deftp
20058
20059 @deftp {Data type} php-fpm-on-demand-process-manager-configuration
20060 Data Type for the @code{on-demand} php-fpm process manager. With the
20061 @code{on-demand} process manager, worker processes are only created as
20062 requests arrive.
20063 @table @asis
20064 @item @code{max-children} (default: @code{5})
20065 Maximum of worker processes.
20066 @item @code{process-idle-timeout} (default: @code{10})
20067 The time in seconds after which a process with no requests is killed.
20068 @end table
20069 @end deftp
20070
20071
20072 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} nginx-php-fpm-location @
20073 [#:nginx-package nginx] @
20074 [socket (string-append "/var/run/php" @
20075 (version-major (package-version php)) @
20076 "-fpm.sock")]
20077 A helper function to quickly add php to an @code{nginx-server-configuration}.
20078 @end deffn
20079
20080 A simple services setup for nginx with php can look like this:
20081 @lisp
20082 (services (cons* (service dhcp-client-service-type)
20083 (service php-fpm-service-type)
20084 (service nginx-service-type
20085 (nginx-server-configuration
20086 (server-name '("example.com"))
20087 (root "/srv/http/")
20088 (locations
20089 (list (nginx-php-location)))
20090 (listen '("80"))
20091 (ssl-certificate #f)
20092 (ssl-certificate-key #f)))
20093 %base-services))
20094 @end lisp
20095
20096 @cindex cat-avatar-generator
20097 The cat avatar generator is a simple service to demonstrate the use of php-fpm
20098 in @code{Nginx}. It is used to generate cat avatar from a seed, for instance
20099 the hash of a user's email address.
20100
20101 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} cat-avatar-generator-service @
20102 [#:cache-dir "/var/cache/cat-avatar-generator"] @
20103 [#:package cat-avatar-generator] @
20104 [#:configuration (nginx-server-configuration)]
20105 Returns an nginx-server-configuration that inherits @code{configuration}. It
20106 extends the nginx configuration to add a server block that serves @code{package},
20107 a version of cat-avatar-generator. During execution, cat-avatar-generator will
20108 be able to use @code{cache-dir} as its cache directory.
20109 @end deffn
20110
20111 A simple setup for cat-avatar-generator can look like this:
20112 @lisp
20113 (services (cons* (cat-avatar-generator-service
20114 #:configuration
20115 (nginx-server-configuration
20116 (server-name '("example.com"))))
20117 ...
20118 %base-services))
20119 @end lisp
20120
20121 @subsubheading Hpcguix-web
20122
20123 @cindex hpcguix-web
20124 The @uref{https://github.com/UMCUGenetics/hpcguix-web/, hpcguix-web}
20125 program is a customizable web interface to browse Guix packages,
20126 initially designed for users of high-performance computing (HPC)
20127 clusters.
20128
20129 @defvr {Scheme Variable} hpcguix-web-service-type
20130 The service type for @code{hpcguix-web}.
20131 @end defvr
20132
20133 @deftp {Data Type} hpcguix-web-configuration
20134 Data type for the hpcguix-web service configuration.
20135
20136 @table @asis
20137 @item @code{specs}
20138 A gexp (@pxref{G-Expressions}) specifying the hpcguix-web service
20139 configuration. The main items available in this spec are:
20140
20141 @table @asis
20142 @item @code{title-prefix} (default: @code{"hpcguix | "})
20143 The page title prefix.
20144
20145 @item @code{guix-command} (default: @code{"guix"})
20146 The @command{guix} command.
20147
20148 @item @code{package-filter-proc} (default: @code{(const #t)})
20149 A procedure specifying how to filter packages that are displayed.
20150
20151 @item @code{package-page-extension-proc} (default: @code{(const '())})
20152 Extension package for @code{hpcguix-web}.
20153
20154 @item @code{menu} (default: @code{'()})
20155 Additional entry in page @code{menu}.
20156
20157 @item @code{channels} (default: @code{%default-channels})
20158 List of channels from which the package list is built (@pxref{Channels}).
20159
20160 @item @code{package-list-expiration} (default: @code{(* 12 3600)})
20161 The expiration time, in seconds, after which the package list is rebuilt from
20162 the latest instances of the given channels.
20163 @end table
20164
20165 See the hpcguix-web repository for a
20166 @uref{https://github.com/UMCUGenetics/hpcguix-web/blob/master/hpcweb-configuration.scm,
20167 complete example}.
20168
20169 @item @code{package} (default: @code{hpcguix-web})
20170 The hpcguix-web package to use.
20171 @end table
20172 @end deftp
20173
20174 A typical hpcguix-web service declaration looks like this:
20175
20176 @lisp
20177 (service hpcguix-web-service-type
20178 (hpcguix-web-configuration
20179 (specs
20180 #~(define site-config
20181 (hpcweb-configuration
20182 (title-prefix "Guix-HPC - ")
20183 (menu '(("/about" "ABOUT"))))))))
20184 @end lisp
20185
20186 @quotation Note
20187 The hpcguix-web service periodically updates the package list it publishes by
20188 pulling channels from Git. To that end, it needs to access X.509 certificates
20189 so that it can authenticate Git servers when communicating over HTTPS, and it
20190 assumes that @file{/etc/ssl/certs} contains those certificates.
20191
20192 Thus, make sure to add @code{nss-certs} or another certificate package to the
20193 @code{packages} field of your configuration. @ref{X.509 Certificates}, for
20194 more information on X.509 certificates.
20195 @end quotation
20196
20197 @node Certificate Services
20198 @subsection Certificate Services
20199
20200 @cindex Web
20201 @cindex HTTP, HTTPS
20202 @cindex Let's Encrypt
20203 @cindex TLS certificates
20204 The @code{(gnu services certbot)} module provides a service to
20205 automatically obtain a valid TLS certificate from the Let's Encrypt
20206 certificate authority. These certificates can then be used to serve
20207 content securely over HTTPS or other TLS-based protocols, with the
20208 knowledge that the client will be able to verify the server's
20209 authenticity.
20210
20211 @url{https://letsencrypt.org/, Let's Encrypt} provides the
20212 @code{certbot} tool to automate the certification process. This tool
20213 first securely generates a key on the server. It then makes a request
20214 to the Let's Encrypt certificate authority (CA) to sign the key. The CA
20215 checks that the request originates from the host in question by using a
20216 challenge-response protocol, requiring the server to provide its
20217 response over HTTP. If that protocol completes successfully, the CA
20218 signs the key, resulting in a certificate. That certificate is valid
20219 for a limited period of time, and therefore to continue to provide TLS
20220 services, the server needs to periodically ask the CA to renew its
20221 signature.
20222
20223 The certbot service automates this process: the initial key
20224 generation, the initial certification request to the Let's Encrypt
20225 service, the web server challenge/response integration, writing the
20226 certificate to disk, the automated periodic renewals, and the deployment
20227 tasks associated with the renewal (e.g.@: reloading services, copying keys
20228 with different permissions).
20229
20230 Certbot is run twice a day, at a random minute within the hour. It
20231 won't do anything until your certificates are due for renewal or
20232 revoked, but running it regularly would give your service a chance of
20233 staying online in case a Let's Encrypt-initiated revocation happened for
20234 some reason.
20235
20236 By using this service, you agree to the ACME Subscriber Agreement, which
20237 can be found there:
20238 @url{https://acme-v01.api.letsencrypt.org/directory}.
20239
20240 @defvr {Scheme Variable} certbot-service-type
20241 A service type for the @code{certbot} Let's Encrypt client. Its value
20242 must be a @code{certbot-configuration} record as in this example:
20243
20244 @lisp
20245 (define %nginx-deploy-hook
20246 (program-file
20247 "nginx-deploy-hook"
20248 #~(let ((pid (call-with-input-file "/var/run/nginx/pid" read)))
20249 (kill pid SIGHUP))))
20250
20251 (service certbot-service-type
20252 (certbot-configuration
20253 (email "foo@@example.net")
20254 (certificates
20255 (list
20256 (certificate-configuration
20257 (domains '("example.net" "www.example.net"))
20258 (deploy-hook %nginx-deploy-hook))
20259 (certificate-configuration
20260 (domains '("bar.example.net")))))))
20261 @end lisp
20262
20263 See below for details about @code{certbot-configuration}.
20264 @end defvr
20265
20266 @deftp {Data Type} certbot-configuration
20267 Data type representing the configuration of the @code{certbot} service.
20268 This type has the following parameters:
20269
20270 @table @asis
20271 @item @code{package} (default: @code{certbot})
20272 The certbot package to use.
20273
20274 @item @code{webroot} (default: @code{/var/www})
20275 The directory from which to serve the Let's Encrypt challenge/response
20276 files.
20277
20278 @item @code{certificates} (default: @code{()})
20279 A list of @code{certificates-configuration}s for which to generate
20280 certificates and request signatures. Each certificate has a @code{name}
20281 and several @code{domains}.
20282
20283 @item @code{email}
20284 Mandatory email used for registration, recovery contact, and important
20285 account notifications.
20286
20287 @item @code{rsa-key-size} (default: @code{2048})
20288 Size of the RSA key.
20289
20290 @item @code{default-location} (default: @i{see below})
20291 The default @code{nginx-location-configuration}. Because @code{certbot}
20292 needs to be able to serve challenges and responses, it needs to be able
20293 to run a web server. It does so by extending the @code{nginx} web
20294 service with an @code{nginx-server-configuration} listening on the
20295 @var{domains} on port 80, and which has a
20296 @code{nginx-location-configuration} for the @code{/.well-known/} URI
20297 path subspace used by Let's Encrypt. @xref{Web Services}, for more on
20298 these nginx configuration data types.
20299
20300 Requests to other URL paths will be matched by the
20301 @code{default-location}, which if present is added to all
20302 @code{nginx-server-configuration}s.
20303
20304 By default, the @code{default-location} will issue a redirect from
20305 @code{http://@var{domain}/...} to @code{https://@var{domain}/...}, leaving
20306 you to define what to serve on your site via @code{https}.
20307
20308 Pass @code{#f} to not issue a default location.
20309 @end table
20310 @end deftp
20311
20312 @deftp {Data Type} certificate-configuration
20313 Data type representing the configuration of a certificate.
20314 This type has the following parameters:
20315
20316 @table @asis
20317 @item @code{name} (default: @i{see below})
20318 This name is used by Certbot for housekeeping and in file paths; it
20319 doesn't affect the content of the certificate itself. To see
20320 certificate names, run @code{certbot certificates}.
20321
20322 Its default is the first provided domain.
20323
20324 @item @code{domains} (default: @code{()})
20325 The first domain provided will be the subject CN of the certificate, and
20326 all domains will be Subject Alternative Names on the certificate.
20327
20328 @item @code{challenge} (default: @code{#f})
20329 The challenge type that has to be run by certbot. If @code{#f} is specified,
20330 default to the HTTP challenge. If a value is specified, defaults to the
20331 manual plugin (see @code{authentication-hook}, @code{cleanup-hook} and
20332 the documentation at @url{https://certbot.eff.org/docs/using.html#hooks}),
20333 and gives Let's Encrypt permission to log the public IP address of the
20334 requesting machine.
20335
20336 @item @code{authentication-hook} (default: @code{#f})
20337 Command to be run in a shell once for each certificate challenge to be
20338 answered. For this command, the shell variable @code{$CERTBOT_DOMAIN}
20339 will contain the domain being authenticated, @code{$CERTBOT_VALIDATION}
20340 contains the validation string and @code{$CERTBOT_TOKEN} contains the
20341 file name of the resource requested when performing an HTTP-01 challenge.
20342
20343 @item @code{cleanup-hook} (default: @code{#f})
20344 Command to be run in a shell once for each certificate challenge that
20345 have been answered by the @code{auth-hook}. For this command, the shell
20346 variables available in the @code{auth-hook} script are still available, and
20347 additionally @code{$CERTBOT_AUTH_OUTPUT} will contain the standard output
20348 of the @code{auth-hook} script.
20349
20350 @item @code{deploy-hook} (default: @code{#f})
20351 Command to be run in a shell once for each successfully issued
20352 certificate. For this command, the shell variable
20353 @code{$RENEWED_LINEAGE} will point to the config live subdirectory (for
20354 example, @samp{"/etc/letsencrypt/live/example.com"}) containing the new
20355 certificates and keys; the shell variable @code{$RENEWED_DOMAINS} will
20356 contain a space-delimited list of renewed certificate domains (for
20357 example, @samp{"example.com www.example.com"}.
20358
20359 @end table
20360 @end deftp
20361
20362 For each @code{certificate-configuration}, the certificate is saved to
20363 @code{/etc/letsencrypt/live/@var{name}/fullchain.pem} and the key is
20364 saved to @code{/etc/letsencrypt/live/@var{name}/privkey.pem}.
20365 @node DNS Services
20366 @subsection DNS Services
20367 @cindex DNS (domain name system)
20368 @cindex domain name system (DNS)
20369
20370 The @code{(gnu services dns)} module provides services related to the
20371 @dfn{domain name system} (DNS). It provides a server service for hosting
20372 an @emph{authoritative} DNS server for multiple zones, slave or master.
20373 This service uses @uref{https://www.knot-dns.cz/, Knot DNS}. And also a
20374 caching and forwarding DNS server for the LAN, which uses
20375 @uref{http://www.thekelleys.org.uk/dnsmasq/doc.html, dnsmasq}.
20376
20377 @subsubheading Knot Service
20378
20379 An example configuration of an authoritative server for two zones, one master
20380 and one slave, is:
20381
20382 @lisp
20383 (define-zone-entries example.org.zone
20384 ;; Name TTL Class Type Data
20385 ("@@" "" "IN" "A" "127.0.0.1")
20386 ("@@" "" "IN" "NS" "ns")
20387 ("ns" "" "IN" "A" "127.0.0.1"))
20388
20389 (define master-zone
20390 (knot-zone-configuration
20391 (domain "example.org")
20392 (zone (zone-file
20393 (origin "example.org")
20394 (entries example.org.zone)))))
20395
20396 (define slave-zone
20397 (knot-zone-configuration
20398 (domain "plop.org")
20399 (dnssec-policy "default")
20400 (master (list "plop-master"))))
20401
20402 (define plop-master
20403 (knot-remote-configuration
20404 (id "plop-master")
20405 (address (list "208.76.58.171"))))
20406
20407 (operating-system
20408 ;; ...
20409 (services (cons* (service knot-service-type
20410 (knot-configuration
20411 (remotes (list plop-master))
20412 (zones (list master-zone slave-zone))))
20413 ;; ...
20414 %base-services)))
20415 @end lisp
20416
20417 @deffn {Scheme Variable} knot-service-type
20418 This is the type for the Knot DNS server.
20419
20420 Knot DNS is an authoritative DNS server, meaning that it can serve multiple
20421 zones, that is to say domain names you would buy from a registrar. This server
20422 is not a resolver, meaning that it can only resolve names for which it is
20423 authoritative. This server can be configured to serve zones as a master server
20424 or a slave server as a per-zone basis. Slave zones will get their data from
20425 masters, and will serve it as an authoritative server. From the point of view
20426 of a resolver, there is no difference between master and slave.
20427
20428 The following data types are used to configure the Knot DNS server:
20429 @end deffn
20430
20431 @deftp {Data Type} knot-key-configuration
20432 Data type representing a key.
20433 This type has the following parameters:
20434
20435 @table @asis
20436 @item @code{id} (default: @code{""})
20437 An identifier for other configuration fields to refer to this key. IDs must
20438 be unique and must not be empty.
20439
20440 @item @code{algorithm} (default: @code{#f})
20441 The algorithm to use. Choose between @code{#f}, @code{'hmac-md5},
20442 @code{'hmac-sha1}, @code{'hmac-sha224}, @code{'hmac-sha256}, @code{'hmac-sha384}
20443 and @code{'hmac-sha512}.
20444
20445 @item @code{secret} (default: @code{""})
20446 The secret key itself.
20447
20448 @end table
20449 @end deftp
20450
20451 @deftp {Data Type} knot-acl-configuration
20452 Data type representing an Access Control List (ACL) configuration.
20453 This type has the following parameters:
20454
20455 @table @asis
20456 @item @code{id} (default: @code{""})
20457 An identifier for ether configuration fields to refer to this key. IDs must be
20458 unique and must not be empty.
20459
20460 @item @code{address} (default: @code{'()})
20461 An ordered list of IP addresses, network subnets, or network ranges represented
20462 with strings. The query must match one of them. Empty value means that
20463 address match is not required.
20464
20465 @item @code{key} (default: @code{'()})
20466 An ordered list of references to keys represented with strings. The string
20467 must match a key ID defined in a @code{knot-key-configuration}. No key means
20468 that a key is not require to match that ACL.
20469
20470 @item @code{action} (default: @code{'()})
20471 An ordered list of actions that are permitted or forbidden by this ACL. Possible
20472 values are lists of zero or more elements from @code{'transfer}, @code{'notify}
20473 and @code{'update}.
20474
20475 @item @code{deny?} (default: @code{#f})
20476 When true, the ACL defines restrictions. Listed actions are forbidden. When
20477 false, listed actions are allowed.
20478
20479 @end table
20480 @end deftp
20481
20482 @deftp {Data Type} zone-entry
20483 Data type represnting a record entry in a zone file.
20484 This type has the following parameters:
20485
20486 @table @asis
20487 @item @code{name} (default: @code{"@@"})
20488 The name of the record. @code{"@@"} refers to the origin of the zone. Names
20489 are relative to the origin of the zone. For example, in the @code{example.org}
20490 zone, @code{"ns.example.org"} actually refers to @code{ns.example.org.example.org}.
20491 Names ending with a dot are absolute, which means that @code{"ns.example.org."}
20492 refers to @code{ns.example.org}.
20493
20494 @item @code{ttl} (default: @code{""})
20495 The Time-To-Live (TTL) of this record. If not set, the default TTL is used.
20496
20497 @item @code{class} (default: @code{"IN"})
20498 The class of the record. Knot currently supports only @code{"IN"} and
20499 partially @code{"CH"}.
20500
20501 @item @code{type} (default: @code{"A"})
20502 The type of the record. Common types include A (IPv4 address), AAAA (IPv6
20503 address), NS (Name Server) and MX (Mail eXchange). Many other types are
20504 defined.
20505
20506 @item @code{data} (default: @code{""})
20507 The data contained in the record. For instance an IP address associated with
20508 an A record, or a domain name associated with an NS record. Remember that
20509 domain names are relative to the origin unless they end with a dot.
20510
20511 @end table
20512 @end deftp
20513
20514 @deftp {Data Type} zone-file
20515 Data type representing the content of a zone file.
20516 This type has the following parameters:
20517
20518 @table @asis
20519 @item @code{entries} (default: @code{'()})
20520 The list of entries. The SOA record is taken care of, so you don't need to
20521 put it in the list of entries. This list should probably contain an entry
20522 for your primary authoritative DNS server. Other than using a list of entries
20523 directly, you can use @code{define-zone-entries} to define a object containing
20524 the list of entries more easily, that you can later pass to the @code{entries}
20525 field of the @code{zone-file}.
20526
20527 @item @code{origin} (default: @code{""})
20528 The name of your zone. This parameter cannot be empty.
20529
20530 @item @code{ns} (default: @code{"ns"})
20531 The domain of your primary authoritative DNS server. The name is relative to
20532 the origin, unless it ends with a dot. It is mandatory that this primary
20533 DNS server corresponds to an NS record in the zone and that it is associated
20534 to an IP address in the list of entries.
20535
20536 @item @code{mail} (default: @code{"hostmaster"})
20537 An email address people can contact you at, as the owner of the zone. This
20538 is translated as @code{<mail>@@<origin>}.
20539
20540 @item @code{serial} (default: @code{1})
20541 The serial number of the zone. As this is used to keep track of changes by
20542 both slaves and resolvers, it is mandatory that it @emph{never} decreases.
20543 Always increment it when you make a change in your zone.
20544
20545 @item @code{refresh} (default: @code{(* 2 24 3600)})
20546 The frequency at which slaves will do a zone transfer. This value is a number
20547 of seconds. It can be computed by multiplications or with
20548 @code{(string->duration)}.
20549
20550 @item @code{retry} (default: @code{(* 15 60)})
20551 The period after which a slave will retry to contact its master when it fails
20552 to do so a first time.
20553
20554 @item @code{expiry} (default: @code{(* 14 24 3600)})
20555 Default TTL of records. Existing records are considered correct for at most
20556 this amount of time. After this period, resolvers will invalidate their cache
20557 and check again that it still exists.
20558
20559 @item @code{nx} (default: @code{3600})
20560 Default TTL of inexistant records. This delay is usually short because you want
20561 your new domains to reach everyone quickly.
20562
20563 @end table
20564 @end deftp
20565
20566 @deftp {Data Type} knot-remote-configuration
20567 Data type representing a remote configuration.
20568 This type has the following parameters:
20569
20570 @table @asis
20571 @item @code{id} (default: @code{""})
20572 An identifier for other configuration fields to refer to this remote. IDs must
20573 be unique and must not be empty.
20574
20575 @item @code{address} (default: @code{'()})
20576 An ordered list of destination IP addresses. Addresses are tried in sequence.
20577 An optional port can be given with the @@ separator. For instance:
20578 @code{(list "1.2.3.4" "2.3.4.5@@53")}. Default port is 53.
20579
20580 @item @code{via} (default: @code{'()})
20581 An ordered list of source IP addresses. An empty list will have Knot choose
20582 an appropriate source IP. An optional port can be given with the @@ separator.
20583 The default is to choose at random.
20584
20585 @item @code{key} (default: @code{#f})
20586 A reference to a key, that is a string containing the identifier of a key
20587 defined in a @code{knot-key-configuration} field.
20588
20589 @end table
20590 @end deftp
20591
20592 @deftp {Data Type} knot-keystore-configuration
20593 Data type representing a keystore to hold dnssec keys.
20594 This type has the following parameters:
20595
20596 @table @asis
20597 @item @code{id} (default: @code{""})
20598 The id of the keystore. It must not be empty.
20599
20600 @item @code{backend} (default: @code{'pem})
20601 The backend to store the keys in. Can be @code{'pem} or @code{'pkcs11}.
20602
20603 @item @code{config} (default: @code{"/var/lib/knot/keys/keys"})
20604 The configuration string of the backend. An example for the PKCS#11 is:
20605 @code{"pkcs11:token=knot;pin-value=1234 /gnu/store/.../lib/pkcs11/libsofthsm2.so"}.
20606 For the pem backend, the string reprensents a path in the file system.
20607
20608 @end table
20609 @end deftp
20610
20611 @deftp {Data Type} knot-policy-configuration
20612 Data type representing a dnssec policy. Knot DNS is able to automatically
20613 sign your zones. It can either generate and manage your keys automatically or
20614 use keys that you generate.
20615
20616 Dnssec is usually implemented using two keys: a Key Signing Key (KSK) that is
20617 used to sign the second, and a Zone Signing Key (ZSK) that is used to sign the
20618 zone. In order to be trusted, the KSK needs to be present in the parent zone
20619 (usually a top-level domain). If your registrar supports dnssec, you will
20620 have to send them your KSK's hash so they can add a DS record in their zone.
20621 This is not automated and need to be done each time you change your KSK.
20622
20623 The policy also defines the lifetime of keys. Usually, ZSK can be changed
20624 easily and use weaker cryptographic functions (they use lower parameters) in
20625 order to sign records quickly, so they are changed often. The KSK however
20626 requires manual interaction with the registrar, so they are changed less often
20627 and use stronger parameters because they sign only one record.
20628
20629 This type has the following parameters:
20630
20631 @table @asis
20632 @item @code{id} (default: @code{""})
20633 The id of the policy. It must not be empty.
20634
20635 @item @code{keystore} (default: @code{"default"})
20636 A reference to a keystore, that is a string containing the identifier of a
20637 keystore defined in a @code{knot-keystore-configuration} field. The
20638 @code{"default"} identifier means the default keystore (a kasp database that
20639 was setup by this service).
20640
20641 @item @code{manual?} (default: @code{#f})
20642 Whether the key management is manual or automatic.
20643
20644 @item @code{single-type-signing?} (default: @code{#f})
20645 When @code{#t}, use the Single-Type Signing Scheme.
20646
20647 @item @code{algorithm} (default: @code{"ecdsap256sha256"})
20648 An algorithm of signing keys and issued signatures.
20649
20650 @item @code{ksk-size} (default: @code{256})
20651 The length of the KSK. Note that this value is correct for the default
20652 algorithm, but would be unsecure for other algorithms.
20653
20654 @item @code{zsk-size} (default: @code{256})
20655 The length of the ZSK. Note that this value is correct for the default
20656 algorithm, but would be unsecure for other algorithms.
20657
20658 @item @code{dnskey-ttl} (default: @code{'default})
20659 The TTL value for DNSKEY records added into zone apex. The special
20660 @code{'default} value means same as the zone SOA TTL.
20661
20662 @item @code{zsk-lifetime} (default: @code{(* 30 24 3600)})
20663 The period between ZSK publication and the next rollover initiation.
20664
20665 @item @code{propagation-delay} (default: @code{(* 24 3600)})
20666 An extra delay added for each key rollover step. This value should be high
20667 enough to cover propagation of data from the master server to all slaves.
20668
20669 @item @code{rrsig-lifetime} (default: @code{(* 14 24 3600)})
20670 A validity period of newly issued signatures.
20671
20672 @item @code{rrsig-refresh} (default: @code{(* 7 24 3600)})
20673 A period how long before a signature expiration the signature will be refreshed.
20674
20675 @item @code{nsec3?} (default: @code{#f})
20676 When @code{#t}, NSEC3 will be used instead of NSEC.
20677
20678 @item @code{nsec3-iterations} (default: @code{5})
20679 The number of additional times the hashing is performed.
20680
20681 @item @code{nsec3-salt-length} (default: @code{8})
20682 The length of a salt field in octets, which is appended to the original owner
20683 name before hashing.
20684
20685 @item @code{nsec3-salt-lifetime} (default: @code{(* 30 24 3600)})
20686 The validity period of newly issued salt field.
20687
20688 @end table
20689 @end deftp
20690
20691 @deftp {Data Type} knot-zone-configuration
20692 Data type representing a zone served by Knot.
20693 This type has the following parameters:
20694
20695 @table @asis
20696 @item @code{domain} (default: @code{""})
20697 The domain served by this configuration. It must not be empty.
20698
20699 @item @code{file} (default: @code{""})
20700 The file where this zone is saved. This parameter is ignored by master zones.
20701 Empty means default location that depends on the domain name.
20702
20703 @item @code{zone} (default: @code{(zone-file)})
20704 The content of the zone file. This parameter is ignored by slave zones. It
20705 must contain a zone-file record.
20706
20707 @item @code{master} (default: @code{'()})
20708 A list of master remotes. When empty, this zone is a master. When set, this
20709 zone is a slave. This is a list of remotes identifiers.
20710
20711 @item @code{ddns-master} (default: @code{#f})
20712 The main master. When empty, it defaults to the first master in the list of
20713 masters.
20714
20715 @item @code{notify} (default: @code{'()})
20716 A list of slave remote identifiers.
20717
20718 @item @code{acl} (default: @code{'()})
20719 A list of acl identifiers.
20720
20721 @item @code{semantic-checks?} (default: @code{#f})
20722 When set, this adds more semantic checks to the zone.
20723
20724 @item @code{disable-any?} (default: @code{#f})
20725 When set, this forbids queries of the ANY type.
20726
20727 @item @code{zonefile-sync} (default: @code{0})
20728 The delay between a modification in memory and on disk. 0 means immediate
20729 synchronization.
20730
20731 @item @code{zonefile-load} (default: @code{#f})
20732 The way the zone file contents are applied during zone load. Possible values
20733 are:
20734
20735 @itemize
20736 @item @code{#f} for using the default value from Knot,
20737 @item @code{'none} for not using the zone file at all,
20738 @item @code{'difference} for computing the difference between already available
20739 contents and zone contents and applying it to the current zone contents,
20740 @item @code{'difference-no-serial} for the same as @code{'difference}, but
20741 ignoring the SOA serial in the zone file, while the server takes care of it
20742 automatically.
20743 @item @code{'whole} for loading zone contents from the zone file.
20744 @end itemize
20745
20746 @item @code{journal-content} (default: @code{#f})
20747 The way the journal is used to store zone and its changes. Possible values
20748 are @code{'none} to not use it at all, @code{'changes} to store changes and
20749 @code{'all} to store contents. @code{#f} does not set this option, so the
20750 default value from Knot is used.
20751
20752 @item @code{max-journal-usage} (default: @code{#f})
20753 The maximum size for the journal on disk. @code{#f} does not set this option,
20754 so the default value from Knot is used.
20755
20756 @item @code{max-journal-depth} (default: @code{#f})
20757 The maximum size of the history. @code{#f} does not set this option, so the
20758 default value from Knot is used.
20759
20760 @item @code{max-zone-size} (default: @code{#f})
20761 The maximum size of the zone file. This limit is enforced for incoming
20762 transfer and updates. @code{#f} does not set this option, so the default
20763 value from Knot is used.
20764
20765 @item @code{dnssec-policy} (default: @code{#f})
20766 A reference to a @code{knot-policy-configuration} record, or the special
20767 name @code{"default"}. If the value is @code{#f}, there is no dnssec signing
20768 on this zone.
20769
20770 @item @code{serial-policy} (default: @code{'increment})
20771 A policy between @code{'increment} and @code{'unixtime}.
20772
20773 @end table
20774 @end deftp
20775
20776 @deftp {Data Type} knot-configuration
20777 Data type representing the Knot configuration.
20778 This type has the following parameters:
20779
20780 @table @asis
20781 @item @code{knot} (default: @code{knot})
20782 The Knot package.
20783
20784 @item @code{run-directory} (default: @code{"/var/run/knot"})
20785 The run directory. This directory will be used for pid file and sockets.
20786
20787 @item @code{includes} (default: @code{'()})
20788 A list of strings or file-like objects denoting other files that must be
20789 included at the top of the configuration file.
20790
20791 @cindex secrets, Knot service
20792 This can be used to manage secrets out-of-band. For example, secret
20793 keys may be stored in an out-of-band file not managed by Guix, and
20794 thus not visible in @file{/gnu/store}---e.g., you could store secret
20795 key configuration in @file{/etc/knot/secrets.conf} and add this file
20796 to the @code{includes} list.
20797
20798 One can generate a secret tsig key (for nsupdate and zone transfers with the
20799 keymgr command from the knot package. Note that the package is not automatically
20800 installed by the service. The following example shows how to generate a new
20801 tsig key:
20802
20803 @example
20804 keymgr -t mysecret > /etc/knot/secrets.conf
20805 chmod 600 /etc/knot/secrets.conf
20806 @end example
20807
20808 Also note that the generated key will be named @var{mysecret}, so it is the
20809 name that needs to be used in the @var{key} field of the
20810 @code{knot-acl-configuration} record and in other places that need to refer
20811 to that key.
20812
20813 It can also be used to add configuration not supported by this interface.
20814
20815 @item @code{listen-v4} (default: @code{"0.0.0.0"})
20816 An ip address on which to listen.
20817
20818 @item @code{listen-v6} (default: @code{"::"})
20819 An ip address on which to listen.
20820
20821 @item @code{listen-port} (default: @code{53})
20822 A port on which to listen.
20823
20824 @item @code{keys} (default: @code{'()})
20825 The list of knot-key-configuration used by this configuration.
20826
20827 @item @code{acls} (default: @code{'()})
20828 The list of knot-acl-configuration used by this configuration.
20829
20830 @item @code{remotes} (default: @code{'()})
20831 The list of knot-remote-configuration used by this configuration.
20832
20833 @item @code{zones} (default: @code{'()})
20834 The list of knot-zone-configuration used by this configuration.
20835
20836 @end table
20837 @end deftp
20838
20839 @subsubheading Dnsmasq Service
20840
20841 @deffn {Scheme Variable} dnsmasq-service-type
20842 This is the type of the dnsmasq service, whose value should be an
20843 @code{dnsmasq-configuration} object as in this example:
20844
20845 @lisp
20846 (service dnsmasq-service-type
20847 (dnsmasq-configuration
20848 (no-resolv? #t)
20849 (servers '("192.168.1.1"))))
20850 @end lisp
20851 @end deffn
20852
20853 @deftp {Data Type} dnsmasq-configuration
20854 Data type representing the configuration of dnsmasq.
20855
20856 @table @asis
20857 @item @code{package} (default: @var{dnsmasq})
20858 Package object of the dnsmasq server.
20859
20860 @item @code{no-hosts?} (default: @code{#f})
20861 When true, don't read the hostnames in /etc/hosts.
20862
20863 @item @code{port} (default: @code{53})
20864 The port to listen on. Setting this to zero completely disables DNS
20865 responses, leaving only DHCP and/or TFTP functions.
20866
20867 @item @code{local-service?} (default: @code{#t})
20868 Accept DNS queries only from hosts whose address is on a local subnet,
20869 ie a subnet for which an interface exists on the server.
20870
20871 @item @code{listen-addresses} (default: @code{'()})
20872 Listen on the given IP addresses.
20873
20874 @item @code{resolv-file} (default: @code{"/etc/resolv.conf"})
20875 The file to read the IP address of the upstream nameservers from.
20876
20877 @item @code{no-resolv?} (default: @code{#f})
20878 When true, don't read @var{resolv-file}.
20879
20880 @item @code{servers} (default: @code{'()})
20881 Specify IP address of upstream servers directly.
20882
20883 @item @code{cache-size} (default: @code{150})
20884 Set the size of dnsmasq's cache. Setting the cache size to zero
20885 disables caching.
20886
20887 @item @code{negative-cache?} (default: @code{#t})
20888 When false, disable negative caching.
20889
20890 @end table
20891 @end deftp
20892
20893 @subsubheading ddclient Service
20894
20895 @cindex ddclient
20896 The ddclient service described below runs the ddclient daemon, which takes
20897 care of automatically updating DNS entries for service providers such as
20898 @uref{https://dyn.com/dns/, Dyn}.
20899
20900 The following example show instantiates the service with its default
20901 configuration:
20902
20903 @lisp
20904 (service ddclient-service-type)
20905 @end lisp
20906
20907 Note that ddclient needs to access credentials that are stored in a
20908 @dfn{secret file}, by default @file{/etc/ddclient/secrets} (see
20909 @code{secret-file} below.) You are expected to create this file manually, in
20910 an ``out-of-band'' fashion (you @emph{could} make this file part of the
20911 service configuration, for instance by using @code{plain-file}, but it will be
20912 world-readable @i{via} @file{/gnu/store}.) See the examples in the
20913 @file{share/ddclient} directory of the @code{ddclient} package.
20914
20915 @c %start of fragment
20916
20917 Available @code{ddclient-configuration} fields are:
20918
20919 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} package ddclient
20920 The ddclient package.
20921
20922 @end deftypevr
20923
20924 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} integer daemon
20925 The period after which ddclient will retry to check IP and domain name.
20926
20927 Defaults to @samp{300}.
20928
20929 @end deftypevr
20930
20931 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} boolean syslog
20932 Use syslog for the output.
20933
20934 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
20935
20936 @end deftypevr
20937
20938 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} string mail
20939 Mail to user.
20940
20941 Defaults to @samp{"root"}.
20942
20943 @end deftypevr
20944
20945 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} string mail-failure
20946 Mail failed update to user.
20947
20948 Defaults to @samp{"root"}.
20949
20950 @end deftypevr
20951
20952 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} string pid
20953 The ddclient PID file.
20954
20955 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/ddclient/ddclient.pid"}.
20956
20957 @end deftypevr
20958
20959 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} boolean ssl
20960 Enable SSL support.
20961
20962 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
20963
20964 @end deftypevr
20965
20966 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} string user
20967 Specifies the user name or ID that is used when running ddclient
20968 program.
20969
20970 Defaults to @samp{"ddclient"}.
20971
20972 @end deftypevr
20973
20974 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} string group
20975 Group of the user who will run the ddclient program.
20976
20977 Defaults to @samp{"ddclient"}.
20978
20979 @end deftypevr
20980
20981 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} string secret-file
20982 Secret file which will be appended to @file{ddclient.conf} file. This
20983 file contains credentials for use by ddclient. You are expected to
20984 create it manually.
20985
20986 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/ddclient/secrets.conf"}.
20987
20988 @end deftypevr
20989
20990 @deftypevr {@code{ddclient-configuration} parameter} list extra-options
20991 Extra options will be appended to @file{ddclient.conf} file.
20992
20993 Defaults to @samp{()}.
20994
20995 @end deftypevr
20996
20997
20998 @c %end of fragment
20999
21000
21001 @node VPN Services
21002 @subsection VPN Services
21003 @cindex VPN (virtual private network)
21004 @cindex virtual private network (VPN)
21005
21006 The @code{(gnu services vpn)} module provides services related to
21007 @dfn{virtual private networks} (VPNs). It provides a @emph{client} service for
21008 your machine to connect to a VPN, and a @emph{server} service for your machine
21009 to host a VPN. Both services use @uref{https://openvpn.net/, OpenVPN}.
21010
21011 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} openvpn-client-service @
21012 [#:config (openvpn-client-configuration)]
21013
21014 Return a service that runs @command{openvpn}, a VPN daemon, as a client.
21015 @end deffn
21016
21017 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} openvpn-server-service @
21018 [#:config (openvpn-server-configuration)]
21019
21020 Return a service that runs @command{openvpn}, a VPN daemon, as a server.
21021
21022 Both can be run simultaneously.
21023 @end deffn
21024
21025 @c %automatically generated documentation
21026
21027 Available @code{openvpn-client-configuration} fields are:
21028
21029 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} package openvpn
21030 The OpenVPN package.
21031
21032 @end deftypevr
21033
21034 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} string pid-file
21035 The OpenVPN pid file.
21036
21037 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/openvpn/openvpn.pid"}.
21038
21039 @end deftypevr
21040
21041 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} proto proto
21042 The protocol (UDP or TCP) used to open a channel between clients and
21043 servers.
21044
21045 Defaults to @samp{udp}.
21046
21047 @end deftypevr
21048
21049 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} dev dev
21050 The device type used to represent the VPN connection.
21051
21052 Defaults to @samp{tun}.
21053
21054 @end deftypevr
21055
21056 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} string ca
21057 The certificate authority to check connections against.
21058
21059 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/openvpn/ca.crt"}.
21060
21061 @end deftypevr
21062
21063 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} string cert
21064 The certificate of the machine the daemon is running on. It should be
21065 signed by the authority given in @code{ca}.
21066
21067 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/openvpn/client.crt"}.
21068
21069 @end deftypevr
21070
21071 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} string key
21072 The key of the machine the daemon is running on. It must be the key whose
21073 certificate is @code{cert}.
21074
21075 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/openvpn/client.key"}.
21076
21077 @end deftypevr
21078
21079 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} boolean comp-lzo?
21080 Whether to use the lzo compression algorithm.
21081
21082 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
21083
21084 @end deftypevr
21085
21086 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} boolean persist-key?
21087 Don't re-read key files across SIGUSR1 or --ping-restart.
21088
21089 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
21090
21091 @end deftypevr
21092
21093 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} boolean persist-tun?
21094 Don't close and reopen TUN/TAP device or run up/down scripts across
21095 SIGUSR1 or --ping-restart restarts.
21096
21097 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
21098
21099 @end deftypevr
21100
21101 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} number verbosity
21102 Verbosity level.
21103
21104 Defaults to @samp{3}.
21105
21106 @end deftypevr
21107
21108 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} tls-auth-client tls-auth
21109 Add an additional layer of HMAC authentication on top of the TLS control
21110 channel to protect against DoS attacks.
21111
21112 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
21113
21114 @end deftypevr
21115
21116 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} key-usage verify-key-usage?
21117 Whether to check the server certificate has server usage extension.
21118
21119 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
21120
21121 @end deftypevr
21122
21123 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} bind bind?
21124 Bind to a specific local port number.
21125
21126 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
21127
21128 @end deftypevr
21129
21130 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} resolv-retry resolv-retry?
21131 Retry resolving server address.
21132
21133 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
21134
21135 @end deftypevr
21136
21137 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-client-configuration} parameter} openvpn-remote-list remote
21138 A list of remote servers to connect to.
21139
21140 Defaults to @samp{()}.
21141
21142 Available @code{openvpn-remote-configuration} fields are:
21143
21144 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-remote-configuration} parameter} string name
21145 Server name.
21146
21147 Defaults to @samp{"my-server"}.
21148
21149 @end deftypevr
21150
21151 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-remote-configuration} parameter} number port
21152 Port number the server listens to.
21153
21154 Defaults to @samp{1194}.
21155
21156 @end deftypevr
21157
21158 @end deftypevr
21159 @c %end of automatic openvpn-client documentation
21160
21161 @c %automatically generated documentation
21162
21163 Available @code{openvpn-server-configuration} fields are:
21164
21165 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} package openvpn
21166 The OpenVPN package.
21167
21168 @end deftypevr
21169
21170 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} string pid-file
21171 The OpenVPN pid file.
21172
21173 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/openvpn/openvpn.pid"}.
21174
21175 @end deftypevr
21176
21177 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} proto proto
21178 The protocol (UDP or TCP) used to open a channel between clients and
21179 servers.
21180
21181 Defaults to @samp{udp}.
21182
21183 @end deftypevr
21184
21185 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} dev dev
21186 The device type used to represent the VPN connection.
21187
21188 Defaults to @samp{tun}.
21189
21190 @end deftypevr
21191
21192 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} string ca
21193 The certificate authority to check connections against.
21194
21195 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/openvpn/ca.crt"}.
21196
21197 @end deftypevr
21198
21199 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} string cert
21200 The certificate of the machine the daemon is running on. It should be
21201 signed by the authority given in @code{ca}.
21202
21203 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/openvpn/client.crt"}.
21204
21205 @end deftypevr
21206
21207 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} string key
21208 The key of the machine the daemon is running on. It must be the key whose
21209 certificate is @code{cert}.
21210
21211 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/openvpn/client.key"}.
21212
21213 @end deftypevr
21214
21215 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} boolean comp-lzo?
21216 Whether to use the lzo compression algorithm.
21217
21218 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
21219
21220 @end deftypevr
21221
21222 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} boolean persist-key?
21223 Don't re-read key files across SIGUSR1 or --ping-restart.
21224
21225 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
21226
21227 @end deftypevr
21228
21229 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} boolean persist-tun?
21230 Don't close and reopen TUN/TAP device or run up/down scripts across
21231 SIGUSR1 or --ping-restart restarts.
21232
21233 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
21234
21235 @end deftypevr
21236
21237 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} number verbosity
21238 Verbosity level.
21239
21240 Defaults to @samp{3}.
21241
21242 @end deftypevr
21243
21244 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} tls-auth-server tls-auth
21245 Add an additional layer of HMAC authentication on top of the TLS control
21246 channel to protect against DoS attacks.
21247
21248 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
21249
21250 @end deftypevr
21251
21252 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} number port
21253 Specifies the port number on which the server listens.
21254
21255 Defaults to @samp{1194}.
21256
21257 @end deftypevr
21258
21259 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} ip-mask server
21260 An ip and mask specifying the subnet inside the virtual network.
21261
21262 Defaults to @samp{"10.8.0.0 255.255.255.0"}.
21263
21264 @end deftypevr
21265
21266 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} cidr6 server-ipv6
21267 A CIDR notation specifying the IPv6 subnet inside the virtual network.
21268
21269 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
21270
21271 @end deftypevr
21272
21273 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} string dh
21274 The Diffie-Hellman parameters file.
21275
21276 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/openvpn/dh2048.pem"}.
21277
21278 @end deftypevr
21279
21280 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} string ifconfig-pool-persist
21281 The file that records client IPs.
21282
21283 Defaults to @samp{"/etc/openvpn/ipp.txt"}.
21284
21285 @end deftypevr
21286
21287 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} gateway redirect-gateway?
21288 When true, the server will act as a gateway for its clients.
21289
21290 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
21291
21292 @end deftypevr
21293
21294 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} boolean client-to-client?
21295 When true, clients are allowed to talk to each other inside the VPN.
21296
21297 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
21298
21299 @end deftypevr
21300
21301 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} keepalive keepalive
21302 Causes ping-like messages to be sent back and forth over the link so
21303 that each side knows when the other side has gone down. @code{keepalive}
21304 requires a pair. The first element is the period of the ping sending,
21305 and the second element is the timeout before considering the other side
21306 down.
21307
21308 @end deftypevr
21309
21310 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} number max-clients
21311 The maximum number of clients.
21312
21313 Defaults to @samp{100}.
21314
21315 @end deftypevr
21316
21317 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} string status
21318 The status file. This file shows a small report on current connection.
21319 It is truncated and rewritten every minute.
21320
21321 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/openvpn/status"}.
21322
21323 @end deftypevr
21324
21325 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-server-configuration} parameter} openvpn-ccd-list client-config-dir
21326 The list of configuration for some clients.
21327
21328 Defaults to @samp{()}.
21329
21330 Available @code{openvpn-ccd-configuration} fields are:
21331
21332 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-ccd-configuration} parameter} string name
21333 Client name.
21334
21335 Defaults to @samp{"client"}.
21336
21337 @end deftypevr
21338
21339 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-ccd-configuration} parameter} ip-mask iroute
21340 Client own network
21341
21342 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
21343
21344 @end deftypevr
21345
21346 @deftypevr {@code{openvpn-ccd-configuration} parameter} ip-mask ifconfig-push
21347 Client VPN IP.
21348
21349 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
21350
21351 @end deftypevr
21352
21353 @end deftypevr
21354
21355
21356 @c %end of automatic openvpn-server documentation
21357
21358
21359 @node Network File System
21360 @subsection Network File System
21361 @cindex NFS
21362
21363 The @code{(gnu services nfs)} module provides the following services,
21364 which are most commonly used in relation to mounting or exporting
21365 directory trees as @dfn{network file systems} (NFS).
21366
21367 @subsubheading RPC Bind Service
21368 @cindex rpcbind
21369
21370 The RPC Bind service provides a facility to map program numbers into
21371 universal addresses.
21372 Many NFS related services use this facility. Hence it is automatically
21373 started when a dependent service starts.
21374
21375 @defvr {Scheme Variable} rpcbind-service-type
21376 A service type for the RPC portmapper daemon.
21377 @end defvr
21378
21379
21380 @deftp {Data Type} rpcbind-configuration
21381 Data type representing the configuration of the RPC Bind Service.
21382 This type has the following parameters:
21383 @table @asis
21384 @item @code{rpcbind} (default: @code{rpcbind})
21385 The rpcbind package to use.
21386
21387 @item @code{warm-start?} (default: @code{#t})
21388 If this parameter is @code{#t}, then the daemon will read a
21389 state file on startup thus reloading state information saved by a previous
21390 instance.
21391 @end table
21392 @end deftp
21393
21394
21395 @subsubheading Pipefs Pseudo File System
21396 @cindex pipefs
21397 @cindex rpc_pipefs
21398
21399 The pipefs file system is used to transfer NFS related data
21400 between the kernel and user space programs.
21401
21402 @defvr {Scheme Variable} pipefs-service-type
21403 A service type for the pipefs pseudo file system.
21404 @end defvr
21405
21406 @deftp {Data Type} pipefs-configuration
21407 Data type representing the configuration of the pipefs pseudo file system service.
21408 This type has the following parameters:
21409 @table @asis
21410 @item @code{mount-point} (default: @code{"/var/lib/nfs/rpc_pipefs"})
21411 The directory to which the file system is to be attached.
21412 @end table
21413 @end deftp
21414
21415
21416 @subsubheading GSS Daemon Service
21417 @cindex GSSD
21418 @cindex GSS
21419 @cindex global security system
21420
21421 The @dfn{global security system} (GSS) daemon provides strong security for RPC
21422 based protocols.
21423 Before exchanging RPC requests an RPC client must establish a security
21424 context. Typically this is done using the Kerberos command @command{kinit}
21425 or automatically at login time using PAM services (@pxref{Kerberos Services}).
21426
21427 @defvr {Scheme Variable} gss-service-type
21428 A service type for the Global Security System (GSS) daemon.
21429 @end defvr
21430
21431 @deftp {Data Type} gss-configuration
21432 Data type representing the configuration of the GSS daemon service.
21433 This type has the following parameters:
21434 @table @asis
21435 @item @code{nfs-utils} (default: @code{nfs-utils})
21436 The package in which the @command{rpc.gssd} command is to be found.
21437
21438 @item @code{pipefs-directory} (default: @code{"/var/lib/nfs/rpc_pipefs"})
21439 The directory where the pipefs file system is mounted.
21440
21441 @end table
21442 @end deftp
21443
21444
21445 @subsubheading IDMAP Daemon Service
21446 @cindex idmapd
21447 @cindex name mapper
21448
21449 The idmap daemon service provides mapping between user IDs and user names.
21450 Typically it is required in order to access file systems mounted via NFSv4.
21451
21452 @defvr {Scheme Variable} idmap-service-type
21453 A service type for the Identity Mapper (IDMAP) daemon.
21454 @end defvr
21455
21456 @deftp {Data Type} idmap-configuration
21457 Data type representing the configuration of the IDMAP daemon service.
21458 This type has the following parameters:
21459 @table @asis
21460 @item @code{nfs-utils} (default: @code{nfs-utils})
21461 The package in which the @command{rpc.idmapd} command is to be found.
21462
21463 @item @code{pipefs-directory} (default: @code{"/var/lib/nfs/rpc_pipefs"})
21464 The directory where the pipefs file system is mounted.
21465
21466 @item @code{domain} (default: @code{#f})
21467 The local NFSv4 domain name.
21468 This must be a string or @code{#f}.
21469 If it is @code{#f} then the daemon will use the host's fully qualified domain name.
21470
21471 @end table
21472 @end deftp
21473
21474 @node Continuous Integration
21475 @subsection Continuous Integration
21476
21477 @cindex continuous integration
21478 @uref{https://git.savannah.gnu.org/cgit/guix/guix-cuirass.git, Cuirass} is a
21479 continuous integration tool for Guix. It can be used both for development and
21480 for providing substitutes to others (@pxref{Substitutes}).
21481
21482 The @code{(gnu services cuirass)} module provides the following service.
21483
21484 @defvr {Scheme Procedure} cuirass-service-type
21485 The type of the Cuirass service. Its value must be a
21486 @code{cuirass-configuration} object, as described below.
21487 @end defvr
21488
21489 To add build jobs, you have to set the @code{specifications} field of the
21490 configuration. Here is an example of a service that polls the Guix repository
21491 and builds the packages from a manifest. Some of the packages are defined in
21492 the @code{"custom-packages"} input, which is the equivalent of
21493 @code{GUIX_PACKAGE_PATH}.
21494
21495 @lisp
21496 (define %cuirass-specs
21497 #~(list
21498 '((#:name . "my-manifest")
21499 (#:load-path-inputs . ("guix"))
21500 (#:package-path-inputs . ("custom-packages"))
21501 (#:proc-input . "guix")
21502 (#:proc-file . "build-aux/cuirass/gnu-system.scm")
21503 (#:proc . cuirass-jobs)
21504 (#:proc-args . ((subset . "manifests")
21505 (systems . ("x86_64-linux"))
21506 (manifests . (("config" . "guix/manifest.scm")))))
21507 (#:inputs . (((#:name . "guix")
21508 (#:url . "git://git.savannah.gnu.org/guix.git")
21509 (#:load-path . ".")
21510 (#:branch . "master")
21511 (#:no-compile? . #t))
21512 ((#:name . "config")
21513 (#:url . "https://git.example.org/config.git")
21514 (#:load-path . ".")
21515 (#:branch . "master")
21516 (#:no-compile? . #t))
21517 ((#:name . "custom-packages")
21518 (#:url . "https://git.example.org/custom-packages.git")
21519 (#:load-path . ".")
21520 (#:branch . "master")
21521 (#:no-compile? . #t)))))))
21522
21523 (service cuirass-service-type
21524 (cuirass-configuration
21525 (specifications %cuirass-specs)))
21526 @end lisp
21527
21528 While information related to build jobs is located directly in the
21529 specifications, global settings for the @command{cuirass} process are
21530 accessible in other @code{cuirass-configuration} fields.
21531
21532 @deftp {Data Type} cuirass-configuration
21533 Data type representing the configuration of Cuirass.
21534
21535 @table @asis
21536 @item @code{log-file} (default: @code{"/var/log/cuirass.log"})
21537 Location of the log file.
21538
21539 @item @code{web-log-file} (default: @code{"/var/log/cuirass-web.log"})
21540 Location of the log file used by the web interface.
21541
21542 @item @code{cache-directory} (default: @code{"/var/cache/cuirass"})
21543 Location of the repository cache.
21544
21545 @item @code{user} (default: @code{"cuirass"})
21546 Owner of the @code{cuirass} process.
21547
21548 @item @code{group} (default: @code{"cuirass"})
21549 Owner's group of the @code{cuirass} process.
21550
21551 @item @code{interval} (default: @code{60})
21552 Number of seconds between the poll of the repositories followed by the
21553 Cuirass jobs.
21554
21555 @item @code{database} (default: @code{"/var/lib/cuirass/cuirass.db"})
21556 Location of sqlite database which contains the build results and previously
21557 added specifications.
21558
21559 @item @code{ttl} (default: @code{(* 30 24 3600)})
21560 Specifies the time-to-live (TTL) in seconds of garbage collector roots that
21561 are registered for build results. This means that build results are protected
21562 from garbage collection for at least @var{ttl} seconds.
21563
21564 @item @code{port} (default: @code{8081})
21565 Port number used by the HTTP server.
21566
21567 @item @code{host} (default: @code{"localhost"})
21568 Listen on the network interface for @var{host}. The default is to
21569 accept connections from localhost.
21570
21571 @item @code{specifications} (default: @code{#~'()})
21572 A gexp (@pxref{G-Expressions}) that evaluates to a list of specifications,
21573 where a specification is an association list
21574 (@pxref{Associations Lists,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}) whose
21575 keys are keywords (@code{#:keyword-example}) as shown in the example
21576 above.
21577
21578 @item @code{use-substitutes?} (default: @code{#f})
21579 This allows using substitutes to avoid building every dependencies of a job
21580 from source.
21581
21582 @item @code{one-shot?} (default: @code{#f})
21583 Only evaluate specifications and build derivations once.
21584
21585 @item @code{fallback?} (default: @code{#f})
21586 When substituting a pre-built binary fails, fall back to building
21587 packages locally.
21588
21589 @item @code{cuirass} (default: @code{cuirass})
21590 The Cuirass package to use.
21591 @end table
21592 @end deftp
21593
21594 @node Power Management Services
21595 @subsection Power Management Services
21596
21597 @cindex tlp
21598 @cindex power management with TLP
21599 @subsubheading TLP daemon
21600
21601 The @code{(gnu services pm)} module provides a Guix service definition
21602 for the Linux power management tool TLP.
21603
21604 TLP enables various powersaving modes in userspace and kernel.
21605 Contrary to @code{upower-service}, it is not a passive,
21606 monitoring tool, as it will apply custom settings each time a new power
21607 source is detected. More information can be found at
21608 @uref{https://linrunner.de/en/tlp/tlp.html, TLP home page}.
21609
21610 @deffn {Scheme Variable} tlp-service-type
21611 The service type for the TLP tool. Its value should be a valid
21612 TLP configuration (see below). To use the default settings, simply
21613 write:
21614 @lisp
21615 (service tlp-service-type)
21616 @end lisp
21617 @end deffn
21618
21619 By default TLP does not need much configuration but most TLP parameters
21620 can be tweaked using @code{tlp-configuration}.
21621
21622 Each parameter definition is preceded by its type; for example,
21623 @samp{boolean foo} indicates that the @code{foo} parameter
21624 should be specified as a boolean. Types starting with
21625 @code{maybe-} denote parameters that won't show up in TLP config file
21626 when their value is @code{'disabled}.
21627
21628 @c The following documentation was initially generated by
21629 @c (generate-tlp-documentation) in (gnu services pm). Manually maintained
21630 @c documentation is better, so we shouldn't hesitate to edit below as
21631 @c needed. However if the change you want to make to this documentation
21632 @c can be done in an automated way, it's probably easier to change
21633 @c (generate-documentation) than to make it below and have to deal with
21634 @c the churn as TLP updates.
21635
21636 Available @code{tlp-configuration} fields are:
21637
21638 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} package tlp
21639 The TLP package.
21640
21641 @end deftypevr
21642
21643 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} boolean tlp-enable?
21644 Set to true if you wish to enable TLP.
21645
21646 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
21647
21648 @end deftypevr
21649
21650 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string tlp-default-mode
21651 Default mode when no power supply can be detected. Alternatives are AC
21652 and BAT.
21653
21654 Defaults to @samp{"AC"}.
21655
21656 @end deftypevr
21657
21658 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer disk-idle-secs-on-ac
21659 Number of seconds Linux kernel has to wait after the disk goes idle,
21660 before syncing on AC.
21661
21662 Defaults to @samp{0}.
21663
21664 @end deftypevr
21665
21666 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer disk-idle-secs-on-bat
21667 Same as @code{disk-idle-ac} but on BAT mode.
21668
21669 Defaults to @samp{2}.
21670
21671 @end deftypevr
21672
21673 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-lost-work-secs-on-ac
21674 Dirty pages flushing periodicity, expressed in seconds.
21675
21676 Defaults to @samp{15}.
21677
21678 @end deftypevr
21679
21680 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer max-lost-work-secs-on-bat
21681 Same as @code{max-lost-work-secs-on-ac} but on BAT mode.
21682
21683 Defaults to @samp{60}.
21684
21685 @end deftypevr
21686
21687 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-space-separated-string-list cpu-scaling-governor-on-ac
21688 CPU frequency scaling governor on AC mode. With intel_pstate driver,
21689 alternatives are powersave and performance. With acpi-cpufreq driver,
21690 alternatives are ondemand, powersave, performance and conservative.
21691
21692 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
21693
21694 @end deftypevr
21695
21696 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-space-separated-string-list cpu-scaling-governor-on-bat
21697 Same as @code{cpu-scaling-governor-on-ac} but on BAT mode.
21698
21699 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
21700
21701 @end deftypevr
21702
21703 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer cpu-scaling-min-freq-on-ac
21704 Set the min available frequency for the scaling governor on AC.
21705
21706 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
21707
21708 @end deftypevr
21709
21710 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer cpu-scaling-max-freq-on-ac
21711 Set the max available frequency for the scaling governor on AC.
21712
21713 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
21714
21715 @end deftypevr
21716
21717 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer cpu-scaling-min-freq-on-bat
21718 Set the min available frequency for the scaling governor on BAT.
21719
21720 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
21721
21722 @end deftypevr
21723
21724 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer cpu-scaling-max-freq-on-bat
21725 Set the max available frequency for the scaling governor on BAT.
21726
21727 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
21728
21729 @end deftypevr
21730
21731 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer cpu-min-perf-on-ac
21732 Limit the min P-state to control the power dissipation of the CPU, in AC
21733 mode. Values are stated as a percentage of the available performance.
21734
21735 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
21736
21737 @end deftypevr
21738
21739 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer cpu-max-perf-on-ac
21740 Limit the max P-state to control the power dissipation of the CPU, in AC
21741 mode. Values are stated as a percentage of the available performance.
21742
21743 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
21744
21745 @end deftypevr
21746
21747 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer cpu-min-perf-on-bat
21748 Same as @code{cpu-min-perf-on-ac} on BAT mode.
21749
21750 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
21751
21752 @end deftypevr
21753
21754 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-non-negative-integer cpu-max-perf-on-bat
21755 Same as @code{cpu-max-perf-on-ac} on BAT mode.
21756
21757 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
21758
21759 @end deftypevr
21760
21761 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-boolean cpu-boost-on-ac?
21762 Enable CPU turbo boost feature on AC mode.
21763
21764 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
21765
21766 @end deftypevr
21767
21768 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-boolean cpu-boost-on-bat?
21769 Same as @code{cpu-boost-on-ac?} on BAT mode.
21770
21771 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
21772
21773 @end deftypevr
21774
21775 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} boolean sched-powersave-on-ac?
21776 Allow Linux kernel to minimize the number of CPU cores/hyper-threads
21777 used under light load conditions.
21778
21779 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
21780
21781 @end deftypevr
21782
21783 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} boolean sched-powersave-on-bat?
21784 Same as @code{sched-powersave-on-ac?} but on BAT mode.
21785
21786 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
21787
21788 @end deftypevr
21789
21790 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} boolean nmi-watchdog?
21791 Enable Linux kernel NMI watchdog.
21792
21793 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
21794
21795 @end deftypevr
21796
21797 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-string phc-controls
21798 For Linux kernels with PHC patch applied, change CPU voltages. An
21799 example value would be @samp{"F:V F:V F:V F:V"}.
21800
21801 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
21802
21803 @end deftypevr
21804
21805 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string energy-perf-policy-on-ac
21806 Set CPU performance versus energy saving policy on AC. Alternatives are
21807 performance, normal, powersave.
21808
21809 Defaults to @samp{"performance"}.
21810
21811 @end deftypevr
21812
21813 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string energy-perf-policy-on-bat
21814 Same as @code{energy-perf-policy-ac} but on BAT mode.
21815
21816 Defaults to @samp{"powersave"}.
21817
21818 @end deftypevr
21819
21820 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list disks-devices
21821 Hard disk devices.
21822
21823 @end deftypevr
21824
21825 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list disk-apm-level-on-ac
21826 Hard disk advanced power management level.
21827
21828 @end deftypevr
21829
21830 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list disk-apm-level-on-bat
21831 Same as @code{disk-apm-bat} but on BAT mode.
21832
21833 @end deftypevr
21834
21835 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-space-separated-string-list disk-spindown-timeout-on-ac
21836 Hard disk spin down timeout. One value has to be specified for each
21837 declared hard disk.
21838
21839 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
21840
21841 @end deftypevr
21842
21843 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-space-separated-string-list disk-spindown-timeout-on-bat
21844 Same as @code{disk-spindown-timeout-on-ac} but on BAT mode.
21845
21846 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
21847
21848 @end deftypevr
21849
21850 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-space-separated-string-list disk-iosched
21851 Select IO scheduler for disk devices. One value has to be specified for
21852 each declared hard disk. Example alternatives are cfq, deadline and
21853 noop.
21854
21855 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
21856
21857 @end deftypevr
21858
21859 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string sata-linkpwr-on-ac
21860 SATA aggressive link power management (ALPM) level. Alternatives are
21861 min_power, medium_power, max_performance.
21862
21863 Defaults to @samp{"max_performance"}.
21864
21865 @end deftypevr
21866
21867 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string sata-linkpwr-on-bat
21868 Same as @code{sata-linkpwr-ac} but on BAT mode.
21869
21870 Defaults to @samp{"min_power"}.
21871
21872 @end deftypevr
21873
21874 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-string sata-linkpwr-blacklist
21875 Exclude specified SATA host devices for link power management.
21876
21877 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
21878
21879 @end deftypevr
21880
21881 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-on-off-boolean ahci-runtime-pm-on-ac?
21882 Enable Runtime Power Management for AHCI controller and disks on AC
21883 mode.
21884
21885 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
21886
21887 @end deftypevr
21888
21889 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-on-off-boolean ahci-runtime-pm-on-bat?
21890 Same as @code{ahci-runtime-pm-on-ac} on BAT mode.
21891
21892 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
21893
21894 @end deftypevr
21895
21896 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer ahci-runtime-pm-timeout
21897 Seconds of inactivity before disk is suspended.
21898
21899 Defaults to @samp{15}.
21900
21901 @end deftypevr
21902
21903 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string pcie-aspm-on-ac
21904 PCI Express Active State Power Management level. Alternatives are
21905 default, performance, powersave.
21906
21907 Defaults to @samp{"performance"}.
21908
21909 @end deftypevr
21910
21911 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string pcie-aspm-on-bat
21912 Same as @code{pcie-aspm-ac} but on BAT mode.
21913
21914 Defaults to @samp{"powersave"}.
21915
21916 @end deftypevr
21917
21918 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string radeon-power-profile-on-ac
21919 Radeon graphics clock speed level. Alternatives are low, mid, high,
21920 auto, default.
21921
21922 Defaults to @samp{"high"}.
21923
21924 @end deftypevr
21925
21926 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string radeon-power-profile-on-bat
21927 Same as @code{radeon-power-ac} but on BAT mode.
21928
21929 Defaults to @samp{"low"}.
21930
21931 @end deftypevr
21932
21933 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string radeon-dpm-state-on-ac
21934 Radeon dynamic power management method (DPM). Alternatives are battery,
21935 performance.
21936
21937 Defaults to @samp{"performance"}.
21938
21939 @end deftypevr
21940
21941 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string radeon-dpm-state-on-bat
21942 Same as @code{radeon-dpm-state-ac} but on BAT mode.
21943
21944 Defaults to @samp{"battery"}.
21945
21946 @end deftypevr
21947
21948 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string radeon-dpm-perf-level-on-ac
21949 Radeon DPM performance level. Alternatives are auto, low, high.
21950
21951 Defaults to @samp{"auto"}.
21952
21953 @end deftypevr
21954
21955 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string radeon-dpm-perf-level-on-bat
21956 Same as @code{radeon-dpm-perf-ac} but on BAT mode.
21957
21958 Defaults to @samp{"auto"}.
21959
21960 @end deftypevr
21961
21962 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} on-off-boolean wifi-pwr-on-ac?
21963 Wifi power saving mode.
21964
21965 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
21966
21967 @end deftypevr
21968
21969 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} on-off-boolean wifi-pwr-on-bat?
21970 Same as @code{wifi-power-ac?} but on BAT mode.
21971
21972 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
21973
21974 @end deftypevr
21975
21976 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} y-n-boolean wol-disable?
21977 Disable wake on LAN.
21978
21979 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
21980
21981 @end deftypevr
21982
21983 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer sound-power-save-on-ac
21984 Timeout duration in seconds before activating audio power saving on
21985 Intel HDA and AC97 devices. A value of 0 disables power saving.
21986
21987 Defaults to @samp{0}.
21988
21989 @end deftypevr
21990
21991 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} non-negative-integer sound-power-save-on-bat
21992 Same as @code{sound-powersave-ac} but on BAT mode.
21993
21994 Defaults to @samp{1}.
21995
21996 @end deftypevr
21997
21998 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} y-n-boolean sound-power-save-controller?
21999 Disable controller in powersaving mode on Intel HDA devices.
22000
22001 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
22002
22003 @end deftypevr
22004
22005 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} boolean bay-poweroff-on-bat?
22006 Enable optical drive in UltraBay/MediaBay on BAT mode. Drive can be
22007 powered on again by releasing (and reinserting) the eject lever or by
22008 pressing the disc eject button on newer models.
22009
22010 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
22011
22012 @end deftypevr
22013
22014 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string bay-device
22015 Name of the optical drive device to power off.
22016
22017 Defaults to @samp{"sr0"}.
22018
22019 @end deftypevr
22020
22021 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string runtime-pm-on-ac
22022 Runtime Power Management for PCI(e) bus devices. Alternatives are on
22023 and auto.
22024
22025 Defaults to @samp{"on"}.
22026
22027 @end deftypevr
22028
22029 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} string runtime-pm-on-bat
22030 Same as @code{runtime-pm-ac} but on BAT mode.
22031
22032 Defaults to @samp{"auto"}.
22033
22034 @end deftypevr
22035
22036 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} boolean runtime-pm-all?
22037 Runtime Power Management for all PCI(e) bus devices, except blacklisted
22038 ones.
22039
22040 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
22041
22042 @end deftypevr
22043
22044 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-space-separated-string-list runtime-pm-blacklist
22045 Exclude specified PCI(e) device addresses from Runtime Power Management.
22046
22047 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
22048
22049 @end deftypevr
22050
22051 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} space-separated-string-list runtime-pm-driver-blacklist
22052 Exclude PCI(e) devices assigned to the specified drivers from Runtime
22053 Power Management.
22054
22055 @end deftypevr
22056
22057 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} boolean usb-autosuspend?
22058 Enable USB autosuspend feature.
22059
22060 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
22061
22062 @end deftypevr
22063
22064 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-string usb-blacklist
22065 Exclude specified devices from USB autosuspend.
22066
22067 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
22068
22069 @end deftypevr
22070
22071 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} boolean usb-blacklist-wwan?
22072 Exclude WWAN devices from USB autosuspend.
22073
22074 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
22075
22076 @end deftypevr
22077
22078 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-string usb-whitelist
22079 Include specified devices into USB autosuspend, even if they are already
22080 excluded by the driver or via @code{usb-blacklist-wwan?}.
22081
22082 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
22083
22084 @end deftypevr
22085
22086 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} maybe-boolean usb-autosuspend-disable-on-shutdown?
22087 Enable USB autosuspend before shutdown.
22088
22089 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
22090
22091 @end deftypevr
22092
22093 @deftypevr {@code{tlp-configuration} parameter} boolean restore-device-state-on-startup?
22094 Restore radio device state (bluetooth, wifi, wwan) from previous
22095 shutdown on system startup.
22096
22097 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
22098
22099 @end deftypevr
22100
22101 @cindex thermald
22102 @cindex CPU frequency scaling with thermald
22103 @subsubheading Thermald daemon
22104
22105 The @code{(gnu services pm)} module provides an interface to
22106 thermald, a CPU frequency scaling service which helps prevent overheating.
22107
22108 @defvr {Scheme Variable} thermald-service-type
22109 This is the service type for
22110 @uref{https://01.org/linux-thermal-daemon/, thermald}, the Linux
22111 Thermal Daemon, which is responsible for controlling the thermal state
22112 of processors and preventing overheating.
22113 @end defvr
22114
22115 @deftp {Data Type} thermald-configuration
22116 Data type representing the configuration of @code{thermald-service-type}.
22117
22118 @table @asis
22119 @item @code{ignore-cpuid-check?} (default: @code{#f})
22120 Ignore cpuid check for supported CPU models.
22121
22122 @item @code{thermald} (default: @var{thermald})
22123 Package object of thermald.
22124
22125 @end table
22126 @end deftp
22127
22128 @node Audio Services
22129 @subsection Audio Services
22130
22131 The @code{(gnu services audio)} module provides a service to start MPD
22132 (the Music Player Daemon).
22133
22134 @cindex mpd
22135 @subsubheading Music Player Daemon
22136
22137 The Music Player Daemon (MPD) is a service that can play music while
22138 being controlled from the local machine or over the network by a variety
22139 of clients.
22140
22141 The following example shows how one might run @code{mpd} as user
22142 @code{"bob"} on port @code{6666}. It uses pulseaudio for output.
22143
22144 @lisp
22145 (service mpd-service-type
22146 (mpd-configuration
22147 (user "bob")
22148 (port "6666")))
22149 @end lisp
22150
22151 @defvr {Scheme Variable} mpd-service-type
22152 The service type for @command{mpd}
22153 @end defvr
22154
22155 @deftp {Data Type} mpd-configuration
22156 Data type representing the configuration of @command{mpd}.
22157
22158 @table @asis
22159 @item @code{user} (default: @code{"mpd"})
22160 The user to run mpd as.
22161
22162 @item @code{music-dir} (default: @code{"~/Music"})
22163 The directory to scan for music files.
22164
22165 @item @code{playlist-dir} (default: @code{"~/.mpd/playlists"})
22166 The directory to store playlists.
22167
22168 @item @code{db-file} (default: @code{"~/.mpd/tag_cache"})
22169 The location of the music database.
22170
22171 @item @code{state-file} (default: @code{"~/.mpd/state"})
22172 The location of the file that stores current MPD's state.
22173
22174 @item @code{sticker-file} (default: @code{"~/.mpd/sticker.sql"})
22175 The location of the sticker database.
22176
22177 @item @code{port} (default: @code{"6600"})
22178 The port to run mpd on.
22179
22180 @item @code{address} (default: @code{"any"})
22181 The address that mpd will bind to. To use a Unix domain socket,
22182 an absolute path can be specified here.
22183
22184 @end table
22185 @end deftp
22186
22187 @node Virtualization Services
22188 @subsection Virtualization services
22189
22190 The @code{(gnu services virtualization)} module provides services for
22191 the libvirt and virtlog daemons, as well as other virtualization-related
22192 services.
22193
22194 @subsubheading Libvirt daemon
22195 @code{libvirtd} is the server side daemon component of the libvirt
22196 virtualization management system. This daemon runs on host servers
22197 and performs required management tasks for virtualized guests.
22198
22199 @deffn {Scheme Variable} libvirt-service-type
22200 This is the type of the @uref{https://libvirt.org, libvirt daemon}.
22201 Its value must be a @code{libvirt-configuration}.
22202
22203 @lisp
22204 (service libvirt-service-type
22205 (libvirt-configuration
22206 (unix-sock-group "libvirt")
22207 (tls-port "16555")))
22208 @end lisp
22209 @end deffn
22210
22211 @c Auto-generated with (generate-libvirt-documentation)
22212 Available @code{libvirt-configuration} fields are:
22213
22214 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} package libvirt
22215 Libvirt package.
22216
22217 @end deftypevr
22218
22219 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} boolean listen-tls?
22220 Flag listening for secure TLS connections on the public TCP/IP port.
22221 must set @code{listen} for this to have any effect.
22222
22223 It is necessary to setup a CA and issue server certificates before using
22224 this capability.
22225
22226 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
22227
22228 @end deftypevr
22229
22230 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} boolean listen-tcp?
22231 Listen for unencrypted TCP connections on the public TCP/IP port. must
22232 set @code{listen} for this to have any effect.
22233
22234 Using the TCP socket requires SASL authentication by default. Only SASL
22235 mechanisms which support data encryption are allowed. This is
22236 DIGEST_MD5 and GSSAPI (Kerberos5)
22237
22238 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
22239
22240 @end deftypevr
22241
22242 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string tls-port
22243 Port for accepting secure TLS connections This can be a port number, or
22244 service name
22245
22246 Defaults to @samp{"16514"}.
22247
22248 @end deftypevr
22249
22250 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string tcp-port
22251 Port for accepting insecure TCP connections This can be a port number,
22252 or service name
22253
22254 Defaults to @samp{"16509"}.
22255
22256 @end deftypevr
22257
22258 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string listen-addr
22259 IP address or hostname used for client connections.
22260
22261 Defaults to @samp{"0.0.0.0"}.
22262
22263 @end deftypevr
22264
22265 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} boolean mdns-adv?
22266 Flag toggling mDNS advertisement of the libvirt service.
22267
22268 Alternatively can disable for all services on a host by stopping the
22269 Avahi daemon.
22270
22271 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
22272
22273 @end deftypevr
22274
22275 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string mdns-name
22276 Default mDNS advertisement name. This must be unique on the immediate
22277 broadcast network.
22278
22279 Defaults to @samp{"Virtualization Host <hostname>"}.
22280
22281 @end deftypevr
22282
22283 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string unix-sock-group
22284 UNIX domain socket group ownership. This can be used to allow a
22285 'trusted' set of users access to management capabilities without
22286 becoming root.
22287
22288 Defaults to @samp{"root"}.
22289
22290 @end deftypevr
22291
22292 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string unix-sock-ro-perms
22293 UNIX socket permissions for the R/O socket. This is used for monitoring
22294 VM status only.
22295
22296 Defaults to @samp{"0777"}.
22297
22298 @end deftypevr
22299
22300 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string unix-sock-rw-perms
22301 UNIX socket permissions for the R/W socket. Default allows only root.
22302 If PolicyKit is enabled on the socket, the default will change to allow
22303 everyone (eg, 0777)
22304
22305 Defaults to @samp{"0770"}.
22306
22307 @end deftypevr
22308
22309 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string unix-sock-admin-perms
22310 UNIX socket permissions for the admin socket. Default allows only owner
22311 (root), do not change it unless you are sure to whom you are exposing
22312 the access to.
22313
22314 Defaults to @samp{"0777"}.
22315
22316 @end deftypevr
22317
22318 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string unix-sock-dir
22319 The directory in which sockets will be found/created.
22320
22321 Defaults to @samp{"/var/run/libvirt"}.
22322
22323 @end deftypevr
22324
22325 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string auth-unix-ro
22326 Authentication scheme for UNIX read-only sockets. By default socket
22327 permissions allow anyone to connect
22328
22329 Defaults to @samp{"polkit"}.
22330
22331 @end deftypevr
22332
22333 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string auth-unix-rw
22334 Authentication scheme for UNIX read-write sockets. By default socket
22335 permissions only allow root. If PolicyKit support was compiled into
22336 libvirt, the default will be to use 'polkit' auth.
22337
22338 Defaults to @samp{"polkit"}.
22339
22340 @end deftypevr
22341
22342 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string auth-tcp
22343 Authentication scheme for TCP sockets. If you don't enable SASL, then
22344 all TCP traffic is cleartext. Don't do this outside of a dev/test
22345 scenario.
22346
22347 Defaults to @samp{"sasl"}.
22348
22349 @end deftypevr
22350
22351 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string auth-tls
22352 Authentication scheme for TLS sockets. TLS sockets already have
22353 encryption provided by the TLS layer, and limited authentication is done
22354 by certificates.
22355
22356 It is possible to make use of any SASL authentication mechanism as well,
22357 by using 'sasl' for this option
22358
22359 Defaults to @samp{"none"}.
22360
22361 @end deftypevr
22362
22363 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} optional-list access-drivers
22364 API access control scheme.
22365
22366 By default an authenticated user is allowed access to all APIs. Access
22367 drivers can place restrictions on this.
22368
22369 Defaults to @samp{()}.
22370
22371 @end deftypevr
22372
22373 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string key-file
22374 Server key file path. If set to an empty string, then no private key is
22375 loaded.
22376
22377 Defaults to @samp{""}.
22378
22379 @end deftypevr
22380
22381 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string cert-file
22382 Server key file path. If set to an empty string, then no certificate is
22383 loaded.
22384
22385 Defaults to @samp{""}.
22386
22387 @end deftypevr
22388
22389 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string ca-file
22390 Server key file path. If set to an empty string, then no CA certificate
22391 is loaded.
22392
22393 Defaults to @samp{""}.
22394
22395 @end deftypevr
22396
22397 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string crl-file
22398 Certificate revocation list path. If set to an empty string, then no
22399 CRL is loaded.
22400
22401 Defaults to @samp{""}.
22402
22403 @end deftypevr
22404
22405 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} boolean tls-no-sanity-cert
22406 Disable verification of our own server certificates.
22407
22408 When libvirtd starts it performs some sanity checks against its own
22409 certificates.
22410
22411 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
22412
22413 @end deftypevr
22414
22415 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} boolean tls-no-verify-cert
22416 Disable verification of client certificates.
22417
22418 Client certificate verification is the primary authentication mechanism.
22419 Any client which does not present a certificate signed by the CA will be
22420 rejected.
22421
22422 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
22423
22424 @end deftypevr
22425
22426 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} optional-list tls-allowed-dn-list
22427 Whitelist of allowed x509 Distinguished Name.
22428
22429 Defaults to @samp{()}.
22430
22431 @end deftypevr
22432
22433 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} optional-list sasl-allowed-usernames
22434 Whitelist of allowed SASL usernames. The format for username depends on
22435 the SASL authentication mechanism.
22436
22437 Defaults to @samp{()}.
22438
22439 @end deftypevr
22440
22441 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string tls-priority
22442 Override the compile time default TLS priority string. The default is
22443 usually "NORMAL" unless overridden at build time. Only set this is it
22444 is desired for libvirt to deviate from the global default settings.
22445
22446 Defaults to @samp{"NORMAL"}.
22447
22448 @end deftypevr
22449
22450 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer max-clients
22451 Maximum number of concurrent client connections to allow over all
22452 sockets combined.
22453
22454 Defaults to @samp{5000}.
22455
22456 @end deftypevr
22457
22458 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer max-queued-clients
22459 Maximum length of queue of connections waiting to be accepted by the
22460 daemon. Note, that some protocols supporting retransmission may obey
22461 this so that a later reattempt at connection succeeds.
22462
22463 Defaults to @samp{1000}.
22464
22465 @end deftypevr
22466
22467 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer max-anonymous-clients
22468 Maximum length of queue of accepted but not yet authenticated clients.
22469 Set this to zero to turn this feature off
22470
22471 Defaults to @samp{20}.
22472
22473 @end deftypevr
22474
22475 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer min-workers
22476 Number of workers to start up initially.
22477
22478 Defaults to @samp{5}.
22479
22480 @end deftypevr
22481
22482 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer max-workers
22483 Maximum number of worker threads.
22484
22485 If the number of active clients exceeds @code{min-workers}, then more
22486 threads are spawned, up to max_workers limit. Typically you'd want
22487 max_workers to equal maximum number of clients allowed.
22488
22489 Defaults to @samp{20}.
22490
22491 @end deftypevr
22492
22493 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer prio-workers
22494 Number of priority workers. If all workers from above pool are stuck,
22495 some calls marked as high priority (notably domainDestroy) can be
22496 executed in this pool.
22497
22498 Defaults to @samp{5}.
22499
22500 @end deftypevr
22501
22502 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer max-requests
22503 Total global limit on concurrent RPC calls.
22504
22505 Defaults to @samp{20}.
22506
22507 @end deftypevr
22508
22509 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer max-client-requests
22510 Limit on concurrent requests from a single client connection. To avoid
22511 one client monopolizing the server this should be a small fraction of
22512 the global max_requests and max_workers parameter.
22513
22514 Defaults to @samp{5}.
22515
22516 @end deftypevr
22517
22518 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer admin-min-workers
22519 Same as @code{min-workers} but for the admin interface.
22520
22521 Defaults to @samp{1}.
22522
22523 @end deftypevr
22524
22525 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer admin-max-workers
22526 Same as @code{max-workers} but for the admin interface.
22527
22528 Defaults to @samp{5}.
22529
22530 @end deftypevr
22531
22532 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer admin-max-clients
22533 Same as @code{max-clients} but for the admin interface.
22534
22535 Defaults to @samp{5}.
22536
22537 @end deftypevr
22538
22539 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer admin-max-queued-clients
22540 Same as @code{max-queued-clients} but for the admin interface.
22541
22542 Defaults to @samp{5}.
22543
22544 @end deftypevr
22545
22546 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer admin-max-client-requests
22547 Same as @code{max-client-requests} but for the admin interface.
22548
22549 Defaults to @samp{5}.
22550
22551 @end deftypevr
22552
22553 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer log-level
22554 Logging level. 4 errors, 3 warnings, 2 information, 1 debug.
22555
22556 Defaults to @samp{3}.
22557
22558 @end deftypevr
22559
22560 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string log-filters
22561 Logging filters.
22562
22563 A filter allows to select a different logging level for a given category
22564 of logs The format for a filter is one of:
22565
22566 @itemize @bullet
22567 @item
22568 x:name
22569
22570 @item
22571 x:+name
22572
22573 @end itemize
22574
22575 where @code{name} is a string which is matched against the category
22576 given in the @code{VIR_LOG_INIT()} at the top of each libvirt source
22577 file, e.g., "remote", "qemu", or "util.json" (the name in the filter can
22578 be a substring of the full category name, in order to match multiple
22579 similar categories), the optional "+" prefix tells libvirt to log stack
22580 trace for each message matching name, and @code{x} is the minimal level
22581 where matching messages should be logged:
22582
22583 @itemize @bullet
22584 @item
22585 1: DEBUG
22586
22587 @item
22588 2: INFO
22589
22590 @item
22591 3: WARNING
22592
22593 @item
22594 4: ERROR
22595
22596 @end itemize
22597
22598 Multiple filters can be defined in a single filters statement, they just
22599 need to be separated by spaces.
22600
22601 Defaults to @samp{"3:remote 4:event"}.
22602
22603 @end deftypevr
22604
22605 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string log-outputs
22606 Logging outputs.
22607
22608 An output is one of the places to save logging information. The format
22609 for an output can be:
22610
22611 @table @code
22612 @item x:stderr
22613 output goes to stderr
22614
22615 @item x:syslog:name
22616 use syslog for the output and use the given name as the ident
22617
22618 @item x:file:file_path
22619 output to a file, with the given filepath
22620
22621 @item x:journald
22622 output to journald logging system
22623
22624 @end table
22625
22626 In all case the x prefix is the minimal level, acting as a filter
22627
22628 @itemize @bullet
22629 @item
22630 1: DEBUG
22631
22632 @item
22633 2: INFO
22634
22635 @item
22636 3: WARNING
22637
22638 @item
22639 4: ERROR
22640
22641 @end itemize
22642
22643 Multiple outputs can be defined, they just need to be separated by
22644 spaces.
22645
22646 Defaults to @samp{"3:stderr"}.
22647
22648 @end deftypevr
22649
22650 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer audit-level
22651 Allows usage of the auditing subsystem to be altered
22652
22653 @itemize @bullet
22654 @item
22655 0: disable all auditing
22656
22657 @item
22658 1: enable auditing, only if enabled on host
22659
22660 @item
22661 2: enable auditing, and exit if disabled on host.
22662
22663 @end itemize
22664
22665 Defaults to @samp{1}.
22666
22667 @end deftypevr
22668
22669 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} boolean audit-logging
22670 Send audit messages via libvirt logging infrastructure.
22671
22672 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
22673
22674 @end deftypevr
22675
22676 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} optional-string host-uuid
22677 Host UUID. UUID must not have all digits be the same.
22678
22679 Defaults to @samp{""}.
22680
22681 @end deftypevr
22682
22683 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} string host-uuid-source
22684 Source to read host UUID.
22685
22686 @itemize @bullet
22687 @item
22688 @code{smbios}: fetch the UUID from @code{dmidecode -s system-uuid}
22689
22690 @item
22691 @code{machine-id}: fetch the UUID from @code{/etc/machine-id}
22692
22693 @end itemize
22694
22695 If @code{dmidecode} does not provide a valid UUID a temporary UUID will
22696 be generated.
22697
22698 Defaults to @samp{"smbios"}.
22699
22700 @end deftypevr
22701
22702 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer keepalive-interval
22703 A keepalive message is sent to a client after @code{keepalive_interval}
22704 seconds of inactivity to check if the client is still responding. If
22705 set to -1, libvirtd will never send keepalive requests; however clients
22706 can still send them and the daemon will send responses.
22707
22708 Defaults to @samp{5}.
22709
22710 @end deftypevr
22711
22712 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer keepalive-count
22713 Maximum number of keepalive messages that are allowed to be sent to the
22714 client without getting any response before the connection is considered
22715 broken.
22716
22717 In other words, the connection is automatically closed approximately
22718 after @code{keepalive_interval * (keepalive_count + 1)} seconds since
22719 the last message received from the client. When @code{keepalive-count}
22720 is set to 0, connections will be automatically closed after
22721 @code{keepalive-interval} seconds of inactivity without sending any
22722 keepalive messages.
22723
22724 Defaults to @samp{5}.
22725
22726 @end deftypevr
22727
22728 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer admin-keepalive-interval
22729 Same as above but for admin interface.
22730
22731 Defaults to @samp{5}.
22732
22733 @end deftypevr
22734
22735 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer admin-keepalive-count
22736 Same as above but for admin interface.
22737
22738 Defaults to @samp{5}.
22739
22740 @end deftypevr
22741
22742 @deftypevr {@code{libvirt-configuration} parameter} integer ovs-timeout
22743 Timeout for Open vSwitch calls.
22744
22745 The @code{ovs-vsctl} utility is used for the configuration and its
22746 timeout option is set by default to 5 seconds to avoid potential
22747 infinite waits blocking libvirt.
22748
22749 Defaults to @samp{5}.
22750
22751 @end deftypevr
22752
22753 @c %end of autogenerated docs
22754
22755 @subsubheading Virtlog daemon
22756 The virtlogd service is a server side daemon component of libvirt that is
22757 used to manage logs from virtual machine consoles.
22758
22759 This daemon is not used directly by libvirt client applications, rather it
22760 is called on their behalf by @code{libvirtd}. By maintaining the logs in a
22761 standalone daemon, the main @code{libvirtd} daemon can be restarted without
22762 risk of losing logs. The @code{virtlogd} daemon has the ability to re-exec()
22763 itself upon receiving @code{SIGUSR1}, to allow live upgrades without downtime.
22764
22765 @deffn {Scheme Variable} virtlog-service-type
22766 This is the type of the virtlog daemon.
22767 Its value must be a @code{virtlog-configuration}.
22768
22769 @lisp
22770 (service virtlog-service-type
22771 (virtlog-configuration
22772 (max-clients 1000)))
22773 @end lisp
22774 @end deffn
22775
22776 @deftypevr {@code{virtlog-configuration} parameter} integer log-level
22777 Logging level. 4 errors, 3 warnings, 2 information, 1 debug.
22778
22779 Defaults to @samp{3}.
22780
22781 @end deftypevr
22782
22783 @deftypevr {@code{virtlog-configuration} parameter} string log-filters
22784 Logging filters.
22785
22786 A filter allows to select a different logging level for a given category
22787 of logs The format for a filter is one of:
22788
22789 @itemize @bullet
22790 @item
22791 x:name
22792
22793 @item
22794 x:+name
22795
22796 @end itemize
22797
22798 where @code{name} is a string which is matched against the category
22799 given in the @code{VIR_LOG_INIT()} at the top of each libvirt source
22800 file, e.g., "remote", "qemu", or "util.json" (the name in the filter can
22801 be a substring of the full category name, in order to match multiple
22802 similar categories), the optional "+" prefix tells libvirt to log stack
22803 trace for each message matching name, and @code{x} is the minimal level
22804 where matching messages should be logged:
22805
22806 @itemize @bullet
22807 @item
22808 1: DEBUG
22809
22810 @item
22811 2: INFO
22812
22813 @item
22814 3: WARNING
22815
22816 @item
22817 4: ERROR
22818
22819 @end itemize
22820
22821 Multiple filters can be defined in a single filters statement, they just
22822 need to be separated by spaces.
22823
22824 Defaults to @samp{"3:remote 4:event"}.
22825
22826 @end deftypevr
22827
22828 @deftypevr {@code{virtlog-configuration} parameter} string log-outputs
22829 Logging outputs.
22830
22831 An output is one of the places to save logging information The format
22832 for an output can be:
22833
22834 @table @code
22835 @item x:stderr
22836 output goes to stderr
22837
22838 @item x:syslog:name
22839 use syslog for the output and use the given name as the ident
22840
22841 @item x:file:file_path
22842 output to a file, with the given filepath
22843
22844 @item x:journald
22845 output to journald logging system
22846
22847 @end table
22848
22849 In all case the x prefix is the minimal level, acting as a filter
22850
22851 @itemize @bullet
22852 @item
22853 1: DEBUG
22854
22855 @item
22856 2: INFO
22857
22858 @item
22859 3: WARNING
22860
22861 @item
22862 4: ERROR
22863
22864 @end itemize
22865
22866 Multiple outputs can be defined, they just need to be separated by
22867 spaces.
22868
22869 Defaults to @samp{"3:stderr"}.
22870
22871 @end deftypevr
22872
22873 @deftypevr {@code{virtlog-configuration} parameter} integer max-clients
22874 Maximum number of concurrent client connections to allow over all
22875 sockets combined.
22876
22877 Defaults to @samp{1024}.
22878
22879 @end deftypevr
22880
22881 @deftypevr {@code{virtlog-configuration} parameter} integer max-size
22882 Maximum file size before rolling over.
22883
22884 Defaults to @samp{2MB}
22885
22886 @end deftypevr
22887
22888 @deftypevr {@code{virtlog-configuration} parameter} integer max-backups
22889 Maximum number of backup files to keep.
22890
22891 Defaults to @samp{3}
22892
22893 @end deftypevr
22894
22895 @subsubheading Transparent Emulation with QEMU
22896
22897 @cindex emulation
22898 @cindex @code{binfmt_misc}
22899 @code{qemu-binfmt-service-type} provides support for transparent
22900 emulation of program binaries built for different architectures---e.g.,
22901 it allows you to transparently execute an ARMv7 program on an x86_64
22902 machine. It achieves this by combining the @uref{https://www.qemu.org,
22903 QEMU} emulator and the @code{binfmt_misc} feature of the kernel Linux.
22904
22905 @defvr {Scheme Variable} qemu-binfmt-service-type
22906 This is the type of the QEMU/binfmt service for transparent emulation.
22907 Its value must be a @code{qemu-binfmt-configuration} object, which
22908 specifies the QEMU package to use as well as the architecture we want to
22909 emulated:
22910
22911 @lisp
22912 (service qemu-binfmt-service-type
22913 (qemu-binfmt-configuration
22914 (platforms (lookup-qemu-platforms "arm" "aarch64" "mips64el"))))
22915 @end lisp
22916
22917 In this example, we enable transparent emulation for the ARM and aarch64
22918 platforms. Running @code{herd stop qemu-binfmt} turns it off, and
22919 running @code{herd start qemu-binfmt} turns it back on (@pxref{Invoking
22920 herd, the @command{herd} command,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}).
22921 @end defvr
22922
22923 @deftp {Data Type} qemu-binfmt-configuration
22924 This is the configuration for the @code{qemu-binfmt} service.
22925
22926 @table @asis
22927 @item @code{platforms} (default: @code{'()})
22928 The list of emulated QEMU platforms. Each item must be a @dfn{platform
22929 object} as returned by @code{lookup-qemu-platforms} (see below).
22930
22931 @item @code{guix-support?} (default: @code{#f})
22932 When it is true, QEMU and all its dependencies are added to the build
22933 environment of @command{guix-daemon} (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon,
22934 @code{--chroot-directory} option}). This allows the @code{binfmt_misc}
22935 handlers to be used within the build environment, which in turn means
22936 that you can transparently build programs for another architecture.
22937
22938 For example, let's suppose you're on an x86_64 machine and you have this
22939 service:
22940
22941 @lisp
22942 (service qemu-binfmt-service-type
22943 (qemu-binfmt-configuration
22944 (platforms (lookup-qemu-platforms "arm"))
22945 (guix-support? #t)))
22946 @end lisp
22947
22948 You can run:
22949
22950 @example
22951 guix build -s armhf-linux inkscape
22952 @end example
22953
22954 @noindent
22955 and it will build Inkscape for ARMv7 @emph{as if it were a native
22956 build}, transparently using QEMU to emulate the ARMv7 CPU. Pretty handy
22957 if you'd like to test a package build for an architecture you don't have
22958 access to!
22959
22960 @item @code{qemu} (default: @code{qemu})
22961 The QEMU package to use.
22962 @end table
22963 @end deftp
22964
22965 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} lookup-qemu-platforms @var{platforms}@dots{}
22966 Return the list of QEMU platform objects corresponding to
22967 @var{platforms}@dots{}. @var{platforms} must be a list of strings
22968 corresponding to platform names, such as @code{"arm"}, @code{"sparc"},
22969 @code{"mips64el"}, and so on.
22970 @end deffn
22971
22972 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} qemu-platform? @var{obj}
22973 Return true if @var{obj} is a platform object.
22974 @end deffn
22975
22976 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} qemu-platform-name @var{platform}
22977 Return the name of @var{platform}---a string such as @code{"arm"}.
22978 @end deffn
22979
22980 @node Version Control Services
22981 @subsection Version Control Services
22982
22983 The @code{(gnu services version-control)} module provides a service to
22984 allow remote access to local Git repositories. There are three options:
22985 the @code{git-daemon-service}, which provides access to repositories via
22986 the @code{git://} unsecured TCP-based protocol, extending the
22987 @code{nginx} web server to proxy some requests to
22988 @code{git-http-backend}, or providing a web interface with
22989 @code{cgit-service-type}.
22990
22991 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} git-daemon-service [#:config (git-daemon-configuration)]
22992
22993 Return a service that runs @command{git daemon}, a simple TCP server to
22994 expose repositories over the Git protocol for anonymous access.
22995
22996 The optional @var{config} argument should be a
22997 @code{<git-daemon-configuration>} object, by default it allows read-only
22998 access to exported@footnote{By creating the magic file
22999 "git-daemon-export-ok" in the repository directory.} repositories under
23000 @file{/srv/git}.
23001
23002 @end deffn
23003
23004 @deftp {Data Type} git-daemon-configuration
23005 Data type representing the configuration for @code{git-daemon-service}.
23006
23007 @table @asis
23008 @item @code{package} (default: @var{git})
23009 Package object of the Git distributed version control system.
23010
23011 @item @code{export-all?} (default: @var{#f})
23012 Whether to allow access for all Git repositories, even if they do not
23013 have the @file{git-daemon-export-ok} file.
23014
23015 @item @code{base-path} (default: @file{/srv/git})
23016 Whether to remap all the path requests as relative to the given path.
23017 If you run git daemon with @var{(base-path "/srv/git")} on example.com,
23018 then if you later try to pull @code{git://example.com/hello.git}, git
23019 daemon will interpret the path as @code{/srv/git/hello.git}.
23020
23021 @item @code{user-path} (default: @var{#f})
23022 Whether to allow @code{~user} notation to be used in requests. When
23023 specified with empty string, requests to @code{git://host/~alice/foo} is
23024 taken as a request to access @code{foo} repository in the home directory
23025 of user @code{alice}. If @var{(user-path "path")} is specified, the
23026 same request is taken as a request to access @code{path/foo} repository
23027 in the home directory of user @code{alice}.
23028
23029 @item @code{listen} (default: @var{'()})
23030 Whether to listen on specific IP addresses or hostnames, defaults to
23031 all.
23032
23033 @item @code{port} (default: @var{#f})
23034 Whether to listen on an alternative port, which defaults to 9418.
23035
23036 @item @code{whitelist} (default: @var{'()})
23037 If not empty, only allow access to this list of directories.
23038
23039 @item @code{extra-options} (default: @var{'()})
23040 Extra options will be passed to @code{git daemon}, please run
23041 @command{man git-daemon} for more information.
23042
23043 @end table
23044 @end deftp
23045
23046 The @code{git://} protocol lacks authentication. When you pull from a
23047 repository fetched via @code{git://}, you don't know whether the data you
23048 receive was modified or is even coming from the specified host, and your
23049 connection is subject to eavesdropping. It's better to use an authenticated
23050 and encrypted transport, such as @code{https}. Although Git allows you
23051 to serve repositories using unsophisticated file-based web servers,
23052 there is a faster protocol implemented by the @code{git-http-backend}
23053 program. This program is the back-end of a proper Git web service. It
23054 is designed to sit behind a FastCGI proxy. @xref{Web Services}, for more
23055 on running the necessary @code{fcgiwrap} daemon.
23056
23057 Guix has a separate configuration data type for serving Git repositories
23058 over HTTP.
23059
23060 @deftp {Data Type} git-http-configuration
23061 Data type representing the configuration for @code{git-http-service}.
23062
23063 @table @asis
23064 @item @code{package} (default: @var{git})
23065 Package object of the Git distributed version control system.
23066
23067 @item @code{git-root} (default: @file{/srv/git})
23068 Directory containing the Git repositories to expose to the world.
23069
23070 @item @code{export-all?} (default: @var{#f})
23071 Whether to expose access for all Git repositories in @var{git-root},
23072 even if they do not have the @file{git-daemon-export-ok} file.
23073
23074 @item @code{uri-path} (default: @file{/git/})
23075 Path prefix for Git access. With the default @code{/git/} prefix, this
23076 will map @code{http://@var{server}/git/@var{repo}.git} to
23077 @code{/srv/git/@var{repo}.git}. Requests whose URI paths do not begin
23078 with this prefix are not passed on to this Git instance.
23079
23080 @item @code{fcgiwrap-socket} (default: @code{127.0.0.1:9000})
23081 The socket on which the @code{fcgiwrap} daemon is listening. @xref{Web
23082 Services}.
23083 @end table
23084 @end deftp
23085
23086 There is no @code{git-http-service-type}, currently; instead you can
23087 create an @code{nginx-location-configuration} from a
23088 @code{git-http-configuration} and then add that location to a web
23089 server.
23090
23091 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} git-http-nginx-location-configuration @
23092 [config=(git-http-configuration)]
23093 Compute an @code{nginx-location-configuration} that corresponds to the
23094 given Git http configuration. An example nginx service definition to
23095 serve the default @file{/srv/git} over HTTPS might be:
23096
23097 @lisp
23098 (service nginx-service-type
23099 (nginx-configuration
23100 (server-blocks
23101 (list
23102 (nginx-server-configuration
23103 (listen '("443 ssl"))
23104 (server-name "git.my-host.org")
23105 (ssl-certificate
23106 "/etc/letsencrypt/live/git.my-host.org/fullchain.pem")
23107 (ssl-certificate-key
23108 "/etc/letsencrypt/live/git.my-host.org/privkey.pem")
23109 (locations
23110 (list
23111 (git-http-nginx-location-configuration
23112 (git-http-configuration (uri-path "/"))))))))))
23113 @end lisp
23114
23115 This example assumes that you are using Let's Encrypt to get your TLS
23116 certificate. @xref{Certificate Services}. The default @code{certbot}
23117 service will redirect all HTTP traffic on @code{git.my-host.org} to
23118 HTTPS. You will also need to add an @code{fcgiwrap} proxy to your
23119 system services. @xref{Web Services}.
23120 @end deffn
23121
23122 @subsubheading Cgit Service
23123
23124 @cindex Cgit service
23125 @cindex Git, web interface
23126 @uref{https://git.zx2c4.com/cgit/, Cgit} is a web frontend for Git
23127 repositories written in C.
23128
23129 The following example will configure the service with default values.
23130 By default, Cgit can be accessed on port 80 (@code{http://localhost:80}).
23131
23132 @lisp
23133 (service cgit-service-type)
23134 @end lisp
23135
23136 The @code{file-object} type designates either a file-like object
23137 (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like objects}) or a string.
23138
23139 @c %start of fragment
23140
23141 Available @code{cgit-configuration} fields are:
23142
23143 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} package package
23144 The CGIT package.
23145
23146 @end deftypevr
23147
23148 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} nginx-server-configuration-list nginx
23149 NGINX configuration.
23150
23151 @end deftypevr
23152
23153 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object about-filter
23154 Specifies a command which will be invoked to format the content of about
23155 pages (both top-level and for each repository).
23156
23157 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23158
23159 @end deftypevr
23160
23161 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string agefile
23162 Specifies a path, relative to each repository path, which can be used to
23163 specify the date and time of the youngest commit in the repository.
23164
23165 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23166
23167 @end deftypevr
23168
23169 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object auth-filter
23170 Specifies a command that will be invoked for authenticating repository
23171 access.
23172
23173 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23174
23175 @end deftypevr
23176
23177 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string branch-sort
23178 Flag which, when set to @samp{age}, enables date ordering in the branch
23179 ref list, and when set @samp{name} enables ordering by branch name.
23180
23181 Defaults to @samp{"name"}.
23182
23183 @end deftypevr
23184
23185 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string cache-root
23186 Path used to store the cgit cache entries.
23187
23188 Defaults to @samp{"/var/cache/cgit"}.
23189
23190 @end deftypevr
23191
23192 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer cache-static-ttl
23193 Number which specifies the time-to-live, in minutes, for the cached
23194 version of repository pages accessed with a fixed SHA1.
23195
23196 Defaults to @samp{-1}.
23197
23198 @end deftypevr
23199
23200 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer cache-dynamic-ttl
23201 Number which specifies the time-to-live, in minutes, for the cached
23202 version of repository pages accessed without a fixed SHA1.
23203
23204 Defaults to @samp{5}.
23205
23206 @end deftypevr
23207
23208 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer cache-repo-ttl
23209 Number which specifies the time-to-live, in minutes, for the cached
23210 version of the repository summary page.
23211
23212 Defaults to @samp{5}.
23213
23214 @end deftypevr
23215
23216 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer cache-root-ttl
23217 Number which specifies the time-to-live, in minutes, for the cached
23218 version of the repository index page.
23219
23220 Defaults to @samp{5}.
23221
23222 @end deftypevr
23223
23224 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer cache-scanrc-ttl
23225 Number which specifies the time-to-live, in minutes, for the result of
23226 scanning a path for Git repositories.
23227
23228 Defaults to @samp{15}.
23229
23230 @end deftypevr
23231
23232 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer cache-about-ttl
23233 Number which specifies the time-to-live, in minutes, for the cached
23234 version of the repository about page.
23235
23236 Defaults to @samp{15}.
23237
23238 @end deftypevr
23239
23240 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer cache-snapshot-ttl
23241 Number which specifies the time-to-live, in minutes, for the cached
23242 version of snapshots.
23243
23244 Defaults to @samp{5}.
23245
23246 @end deftypevr
23247
23248 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer cache-size
23249 The maximum number of entries in the cgit cache. When set to @samp{0},
23250 caching is disabled.
23251
23252 Defaults to @samp{0}.
23253
23254 @end deftypevr
23255
23256 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean case-sensitive-sort?
23257 Sort items in the repo list case sensitively.
23258
23259 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
23260
23261 @end deftypevr
23262
23263 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} list clone-prefix
23264 List of common prefixes which, when combined with a repository URL,
23265 generates valid clone URLs for the repository.
23266
23267 Defaults to @samp{()}.
23268
23269 @end deftypevr
23270
23271 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} list clone-url
23272 List of @code{clone-url} templates.
23273
23274 Defaults to @samp{()}.
23275
23276 @end deftypevr
23277
23278 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object commit-filter
23279 Command which will be invoked to format commit messages.
23280
23281 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23282
23283 @end deftypevr
23284
23285 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string commit-sort
23286 Flag which, when set to @samp{date}, enables strict date ordering in the
23287 commit log, and when set to @samp{topo} enables strict topological
23288 ordering.
23289
23290 Defaults to @samp{"git log"}.
23291
23292 @end deftypevr
23293
23294 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object css
23295 URL which specifies the css document to include in all cgit pages.
23296
23297 Defaults to @samp{"/share/cgit/cgit.css"}.
23298
23299 @end deftypevr
23300
23301 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object email-filter
23302 Specifies a command which will be invoked to format names and email
23303 address of committers, authors, and taggers, as represented in various
23304 places throughout the cgit interface.
23305
23306 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23307
23308 @end deftypevr
23309
23310 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean embedded?
23311 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, will make cgit generate a HTML
23312 fragment suitable for embedding in other HTML pages.
23313
23314 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
23315
23316 @end deftypevr
23317
23318 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-commit-graph?
23319 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, will make cgit print an ASCII-art
23320 commit history graph to the left of the commit messages in the
23321 repository log page.
23322
23323 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
23324
23325 @end deftypevr
23326
23327 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-filter-overrides?
23328 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, allows all filter settings to be
23329 overridden in repository-specific cgitrc files.
23330
23331 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
23332
23333 @end deftypevr
23334
23335 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-follow-links?
23336 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, allows users to follow a file in the
23337 log view.
23338
23339 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
23340
23341 @end deftypevr
23342
23343 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-http-clone?
23344 If set to @samp{#t}, cgit will act as an dumb HTTP endpoint for Git
23345 clones.
23346
23347 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
23348
23349 @end deftypevr
23350
23351 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-index-links?
23352 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, will make cgit generate extra links
23353 "summary", "commit", "tree" for each repo in the repository index.
23354
23355 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
23356
23357 @end deftypevr
23358
23359 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-index-owner?
23360 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, will make cgit display the owner of
23361 each repo in the repository index.
23362
23363 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
23364
23365 @end deftypevr
23366
23367 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-log-filecount?
23368 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, will make cgit print the number of
23369 modified files for each commit on the repository log page.
23370
23371 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
23372
23373 @end deftypevr
23374
23375 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-log-linecount?
23376 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, will make cgit print the number of
23377 added and removed lines for each commit on the repository log page.
23378
23379 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
23380
23381 @end deftypevr
23382
23383 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-remote-branches?
23384 Flag which, when set to @code{#t}, will make cgit display remote
23385 branches in the summary and refs views.
23386
23387 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
23388
23389 @end deftypevr
23390
23391 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-subject-links?
23392 Flag which, when set to @code{1}, will make cgit use the subject of the
23393 parent commit as link text when generating links to parent commits in
23394 commit view.
23395
23396 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
23397
23398 @end deftypevr
23399
23400 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-html-serving?
23401 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, will make cgit use the subject of the
23402 parent commit as link text when generating links to parent commits in
23403 commit view.
23404
23405 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
23406
23407 @end deftypevr
23408
23409 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-tree-linenumbers?
23410 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, will make cgit generate linenumber
23411 links for plaintext blobs printed in the tree view.
23412
23413 Defaults to @samp{#t}.
23414
23415 @end deftypevr
23416
23417 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean enable-git-config?
23418 Flag which, when set to @samp{#f}, will allow cgit to use Git config to
23419 set any repo specific settings.
23420
23421 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
23422
23423 @end deftypevr
23424
23425 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object favicon
23426 URL used as link to a shortcut icon for cgit.
23427
23428 Defaults to @samp{"/favicon.ico"}.
23429
23430 @end deftypevr
23431
23432 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string footer
23433 The content of the file specified with this option will be included
23434 verbatim at the bottom of all pages (i.e.@: it replaces the standard
23435 "generated by..."@: message).
23436
23437 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23438
23439 @end deftypevr
23440
23441 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string head-include
23442 The content of the file specified with this option will be included
23443 verbatim in the HTML HEAD section on all pages.
23444
23445 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23446
23447 @end deftypevr
23448
23449 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string header
23450 The content of the file specified with this option will be included
23451 verbatim at the top of all pages.
23452
23453 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23454
23455 @end deftypevr
23456
23457 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object include
23458 Name of a configfile to include before the rest of the current config-
23459 file is parsed.
23460
23461 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23462
23463 @end deftypevr
23464
23465 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string index-header
23466 The content of the file specified with this option will be included
23467 verbatim above the repository index.
23468
23469 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23470
23471 @end deftypevr
23472
23473 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string index-info
23474 The content of the file specified with this option will be included
23475 verbatim below the heading on the repository index page.
23476
23477 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23478
23479 @end deftypevr
23480
23481 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean local-time?
23482 Flag which, if set to @samp{#t}, makes cgit print commit and tag times
23483 in the servers timezone.
23484
23485 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
23486
23487 @end deftypevr
23488
23489 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object logo
23490 URL which specifies the source of an image which will be used as a logo
23491 on all cgit pages.
23492
23493 Defaults to @samp{"/share/cgit/cgit.png"}.
23494
23495 @end deftypevr
23496
23497 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string logo-link
23498 URL loaded when clicking on the cgit logo image.
23499
23500 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23501
23502 @end deftypevr
23503
23504 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object owner-filter
23505 Command which will be invoked to format the Owner column of the main
23506 page.
23507
23508 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23509
23510 @end deftypevr
23511
23512 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer max-atom-items
23513 Number of items to display in atom feeds view.
23514
23515 Defaults to @samp{10}.
23516
23517 @end deftypevr
23518
23519 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer max-commit-count
23520 Number of entries to list per page in "log" view.
23521
23522 Defaults to @samp{50}.
23523
23524 @end deftypevr
23525
23526 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer max-message-length
23527 Number of commit message characters to display in "log" view.
23528
23529 Defaults to @samp{80}.
23530
23531 @end deftypevr
23532
23533 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer max-repo-count
23534 Specifies the number of entries to list per page on the repository index
23535 page.
23536
23537 Defaults to @samp{50}.
23538
23539 @end deftypevr
23540
23541 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer max-repodesc-length
23542 Specifies the maximum number of repo description characters to display
23543 on the repository index page.
23544
23545 Defaults to @samp{80}.
23546
23547 @end deftypevr
23548
23549 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer max-blob-size
23550 Specifies the maximum size of a blob to display HTML for in KBytes.
23551
23552 Defaults to @samp{0}.
23553
23554 @end deftypevr
23555
23556 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string max-stats
23557 Maximum statistics period. Valid values are @samp{week},@samp{month},
23558 @samp{quarter} and @samp{year}.
23559
23560 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23561
23562 @end deftypevr
23563
23564 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} mimetype-alist mimetype
23565 Mimetype for the specified filename extension.
23566
23567 Defaults to @samp{((gif "image/gif") (html "text/html") (jpg
23568 "image/jpeg") (jpeg "image/jpeg") (pdf "application/pdf") (png
23569 "image/png") (svg "image/svg+xml"))}.
23570
23571 @end deftypevr
23572
23573 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object mimetype-file
23574 Specifies the file to use for automatic mimetype lookup.
23575
23576 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23577
23578 @end deftypevr
23579
23580 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string module-link
23581 Text which will be used as the formatstring for a hyperlink when a
23582 submodule is printed in a directory listing.
23583
23584 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23585
23586 @end deftypevr
23587
23588 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean nocache?
23589 If set to the value @samp{#t} caching will be disabled.
23590
23591 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
23592
23593 @end deftypevr
23594
23595 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean noplainemail?
23596 If set to @samp{#t} showing full author email addresses will be
23597 disabled.
23598
23599 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
23600
23601 @end deftypevr
23602
23603 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean noheader?
23604 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, will make cgit omit the standard
23605 header on all pages.
23606
23607 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
23608
23609 @end deftypevr
23610
23611 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} project-list project-list
23612 A list of subdirectories inside of @code{repository-directory}, relative
23613 to it, that should loaded as Git repositories. An empty list means that
23614 all subdirectories will be loaded.
23615
23616 Defaults to @samp{()}.
23617
23618 @end deftypevr
23619
23620 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object readme
23621 Text which will be used as default value for @code{cgit-repo-readme}.
23622
23623 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23624
23625 @end deftypevr
23626
23627 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean remove-suffix?
23628 If set to @code{#t} and @code{repository-directory} is enabled, if any
23629 repositories are found with a suffix of @code{.git}, this suffix will be
23630 removed for the URL and name.
23631
23632 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
23633
23634 @end deftypevr
23635
23636 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer renamelimit
23637 Maximum number of files to consider when detecting renames.
23638
23639 Defaults to @samp{-1}.
23640
23641 @end deftypevr
23642
23643 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string repository-sort
23644 The way in which repositories in each section are sorted.
23645
23646 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23647
23648 @end deftypevr
23649
23650 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} robots-list robots
23651 Text used as content for the @code{robots} meta-tag.
23652
23653 Defaults to @samp{("noindex" "nofollow")}.
23654
23655 @end deftypevr
23656
23657 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string root-desc
23658 Text printed below the heading on the repository index page.
23659
23660 Defaults to @samp{"a fast webinterface for the git dscm"}.
23661
23662 @end deftypevr
23663
23664 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string root-readme
23665 The content of the file specified with this option will be included
23666 verbatim below thef "about" link on the repository index page.
23667
23668 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23669
23670 @end deftypevr
23671
23672 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string root-title
23673 Text printed as heading on the repository index page.
23674
23675 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23676
23677 @end deftypevr
23678
23679 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean scan-hidden-path
23680 If set to @samp{#t} and repository-directory is enabled,
23681 repository-directory will recurse into directories whose name starts
23682 with a period. Otherwise, repository-directory will stay away from such
23683 directories, considered as "hidden". Note that this does not apply to
23684 the ".git" directory in non-bare repos.
23685
23686 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
23687
23688 @end deftypevr
23689
23690 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} list snapshots
23691 Text which specifies the default set of snapshot formats that cgit
23692 generates links for.
23693
23694 Defaults to @samp{()}.
23695
23696 @end deftypevr
23697
23698 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} repository-directory repository-directory
23699 Name of the directory to scan for repositories (represents
23700 @code{scan-path}).
23701
23702 Defaults to @samp{"/srv/git"}.
23703
23704 @end deftypevr
23705
23706 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string section
23707 The name of the current repository section - all repositories defined
23708 after this option will inherit the current section name.
23709
23710 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23711
23712 @end deftypevr
23713
23714 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string section-sort
23715 Flag which, when set to @samp{1}, will sort the sections on the
23716 repository listing by name.
23717
23718 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23719
23720 @end deftypevr
23721
23722 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer section-from-path
23723 A number which, if defined prior to repository-directory, specifies how
23724 many path elements from each repo path to use as a default section name.
23725
23726 Defaults to @samp{0}.
23727
23728 @end deftypevr
23729
23730 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} boolean side-by-side-diffs?
23731 If set to @samp{#t} shows side-by-side diffs instead of unidiffs per
23732 default.
23733
23734 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
23735
23736 @end deftypevr
23737
23738 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} file-object source-filter
23739 Specifies a command which will be invoked to format plaintext blobs in
23740 the tree view.
23741
23742 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23743
23744 @end deftypevr
23745
23746 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer summary-branches
23747 Specifies the number of branches to display in the repository "summary"
23748 view.
23749
23750 Defaults to @samp{10}.
23751
23752 @end deftypevr
23753
23754 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer summary-log
23755 Specifies the number of log entries to display in the repository
23756 "summary" view.
23757
23758 Defaults to @samp{10}.
23759
23760 @end deftypevr
23761
23762 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} integer summary-tags
23763 Specifies the number of tags to display in the repository "summary"
23764 view.
23765
23766 Defaults to @samp{10}.
23767
23768 @end deftypevr
23769
23770 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string strict-export
23771 Filename which, if specified, needs to be present within the repository
23772 for cgit to allow access to that repository.
23773
23774 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23775
23776 @end deftypevr
23777
23778 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} string virtual-root
23779 URL which, if specified, will be used as root for all cgit links.
23780
23781 Defaults to @samp{"/"}.
23782
23783 @end deftypevr
23784
23785 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} repository-cgit-configuration-list repositories
23786 A list of @dfn{cgit-repo} records to use with config.
23787
23788 Defaults to @samp{()}.
23789
23790 Available @code{repository-cgit-configuration} fields are:
23791
23792 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-list snapshots
23793 A mask of snapshot formats for this repo that cgit generates links for,
23794 restricted by the global @code{snapshots} setting.
23795
23796 Defaults to @samp{()}.
23797
23798 @end deftypevr
23799
23800 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-file-object source-filter
23801 Override the default @code{source-filter}.
23802
23803 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23804
23805 @end deftypevr
23806
23807 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string url
23808 The relative URL used to access the repository.
23809
23810 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23811
23812 @end deftypevr
23813
23814 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-file-object about-filter
23815 Override the default @code{about-filter}.
23816
23817 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23818
23819 @end deftypevr
23820
23821 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string branch-sort
23822 Flag which, when set to @samp{age}, enables date ordering in the branch
23823 ref list, and when set to @samp{name} enables ordering by branch name.
23824
23825 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23826
23827 @end deftypevr
23828
23829 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-list clone-url
23830 A list of URLs which can be used to clone repo.
23831
23832 Defaults to @samp{()}.
23833
23834 @end deftypevr
23835
23836 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-file-object commit-filter
23837 Override the default @code{commit-filter}.
23838
23839 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23840
23841 @end deftypevr
23842
23843 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string commit-sort
23844 Flag which, when set to @samp{date}, enables strict date ordering in the
23845 commit log, and when set to @samp{topo} enables strict topological
23846 ordering.
23847
23848 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23849
23850 @end deftypevr
23851
23852 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string defbranch
23853 The name of the default branch for this repository. If no such branch
23854 exists in the repository, the first branch name (when sorted) is used as
23855 default instead. By default branch pointed to by HEAD, or "master" if
23856 there is no suitable HEAD.
23857
23858 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23859
23860 @end deftypevr
23861
23862 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string desc
23863 The value to show as repository description.
23864
23865 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23866
23867 @end deftypevr
23868
23869 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string homepage
23870 The value to show as repository homepage.
23871
23872 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23873
23874 @end deftypevr
23875
23876 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-file-object email-filter
23877 Override the default @code{email-filter}.
23878
23879 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23880
23881 @end deftypevr
23882
23883 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} maybe-repo-boolean enable-commit-graph?
23884 A flag which can be used to disable the global setting
23885 @code{enable-commit-graph?}.
23886
23887 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
23888
23889 @end deftypevr
23890
23891 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} maybe-repo-boolean enable-log-filecount?
23892 A flag which can be used to disable the global setting
23893 @code{enable-log-filecount?}.
23894
23895 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
23896
23897 @end deftypevr
23898
23899 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} maybe-repo-boolean enable-log-linecount?
23900 A flag which can be used to disable the global setting
23901 @code{enable-log-linecount?}.
23902
23903 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
23904
23905 @end deftypevr
23906
23907 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} maybe-repo-boolean enable-remote-branches?
23908 Flag which, when set to @code{#t}, will make cgit display remote
23909 branches in the summary and refs views.
23910
23911 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
23912
23913 @end deftypevr
23914
23915 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} maybe-repo-boolean enable-subject-links?
23916 A flag which can be used to override the global setting
23917 @code{enable-subject-links?}.
23918
23919 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
23920
23921 @end deftypevr
23922
23923 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} maybe-repo-boolean enable-html-serving?
23924 A flag which can be used to override the global setting
23925 @code{enable-html-serving?}.
23926
23927 Defaults to @samp{disabled}.
23928
23929 @end deftypevr
23930
23931 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-boolean hide?
23932 Flag which, when set to @code{#t}, hides the repository from the
23933 repository index.
23934
23935 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
23936
23937 @end deftypevr
23938
23939 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-boolean ignore?
23940 Flag which, when set to @samp{#t}, ignores the repository.
23941
23942 Defaults to @samp{#f}.
23943
23944 @end deftypevr
23945
23946 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-file-object logo
23947 URL which specifies the source of an image which will be used as a logo
23948 on this repo’s pages.
23949
23950 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23951
23952 @end deftypevr
23953
23954 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string logo-link
23955 URL loaded when clicking on the cgit logo image.
23956
23957 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23958
23959 @end deftypevr
23960
23961 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-file-object owner-filter
23962 Override the default @code{owner-filter}.
23963
23964 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23965
23966 @end deftypevr
23967
23968 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string module-link
23969 Text which will be used as the formatstring for a hyperlink when a
23970 submodule is printed in a directory listing. The arguments for the
23971 formatstring are the path and SHA1 of the submodule commit.
23972
23973 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23974
23975 @end deftypevr
23976
23977 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} module-link-path module-link-path
23978 Text which will be used as the formatstring for a hyperlink when a
23979 submodule with the specified subdirectory path is printed in a directory
23980 listing.
23981
23982 Defaults to @samp{()}.
23983
23984 @end deftypevr
23985
23986 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string max-stats
23987 Override the default maximum statistics period.
23988
23989 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23990
23991 @end deftypevr
23992
23993 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string name
23994 The value to show as repository name.
23995
23996 Defaults to @samp{""}.
23997
23998 @end deftypevr
23999
24000 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string owner
24001 A value used to identify the owner of the repository.
24002
24003 Defaults to @samp{""}.
24004
24005 @end deftypevr
24006
24007 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string path
24008 An absolute path to the repository directory.
24009
24010 Defaults to @samp{""}.
24011
24012 @end deftypevr
24013
24014 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string readme
24015 A path (relative to repo) which specifies a file to include verbatim as
24016 the "About" page for this repo.
24017
24018 Defaults to @samp{""}.
24019
24020 @end deftypevr
24021
24022 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-string section
24023 The name of the current repository section - all repositories defined
24024 after this option will inherit the current section name.
24025
24026 Defaults to @samp{""}.
24027
24028 @end deftypevr
24029
24030 @deftypevr {@code{repository-cgit-configuration} parameter} repo-list extra-options
24031 Extra options will be appended to cgitrc file.
24032
24033 Defaults to @samp{()}.
24034
24035 @end deftypevr
24036
24037 @end deftypevr
24038
24039 @deftypevr {@code{cgit-configuration} parameter} list extra-options
24040 Extra options will be appended to cgitrc file.
24041
24042 Defaults to @samp{()}.
24043
24044 @end deftypevr
24045
24046
24047 @c %end of fragment
24048
24049 However, it could be that you just want to get a @code{cgitrc} up and
24050 running. In that case, you can pass an @code{opaque-cgit-configuration}
24051 as a record to @code{cgit-service-type}. As its name indicates, an
24052 opaque configuration does not have easy reflective capabilities.
24053
24054 Available @code{opaque-cgit-configuration} fields are:
24055
24056 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-cgit-configuration} parameter} package cgit
24057 The cgit package.
24058 @end deftypevr
24059
24060 @deftypevr {@code{opaque-cgit-configuration} parameter} string string
24061 The contents of the @code{cgitrc}, as a string.
24062 @end deftypevr
24063
24064 For example, if your @code{cgitrc} is just the empty string, you
24065 could instantiate a cgit service like this:
24066
24067 @lisp
24068 (service cgit-service-type
24069 (opaque-cgit-configuration
24070 (cgitrc "")))
24071 @end lisp
24072
24073 @subsubheading Gitolite Service
24074
24075 @cindex Gitolite service
24076 @cindex Git, hosting
24077 @uref{https://gitolite.com/gitolite/, Gitolite} is a tool for hosting Git
24078 repositories on a central server.
24079
24080 Gitolite can handle multiple repositories and users, and supports flexible
24081 configuration of the permissions for the users on the repositories.
24082
24083 The following example will configure Gitolite using the default @code{git}
24084 user, and the provided SSH public key.
24085
24086 @lisp
24087 (service gitolite-service-type
24088 (gitolite-configuration
24089 (admin-pubkey (plain-file
24090 "yourname.pub"
24091 "ssh-rsa AAAA... guix@@example.com"))))
24092 @end lisp
24093
24094 Gitolite is configured through a special admin repository which you can clone,
24095 for example, if you setup Gitolite on @code{example.com}, you would run the
24096 following command to clone the admin repository.
24097
24098 @example
24099 git clone git@@example.com:gitolite-admin
24100 @end example
24101
24102 When the Gitolite service is activated, the provided @code{admin-pubkey} will
24103 be inserted in to the @file{keydir} directory in the gitolite-admin
24104 repository. If this results in a change in the repository, it will be
24105 committed using the message ``gitolite setup by GNU Guix''.
24106
24107 @deftp {Data Type} gitolite-configuration
24108 Data type representing the configuration for @code{gitolite-service-type}.
24109
24110 @table @asis
24111 @item @code{package} (default: @var{gitolite})
24112 Gitolite package to use.
24113
24114 @item @code{user} (default: @var{git})
24115 User to use for Gitolite. This will be user that you use when accessing
24116 Gitolite over SSH.
24117
24118 @item @code{group} (default: @var{git})
24119 Group to use for Gitolite.
24120
24121 @item @code{home-directory} (default: @var{"/var/lib/gitolite"})
24122 Directory in which to store the Gitolite configuration and repositories.
24123
24124 @item @code{rc-file} (default: @var{(gitolite-rc-file)})
24125 A ``file-like'' object (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like objects}),
24126 representing the configuration for Gitolite.
24127
24128 @item @code{admin-pubkey} (default: @var{#f})
24129 A ``file-like'' object (@pxref{G-Expressions, file-like objects}) used to
24130 setup Gitolite. This will be inserted in to the @file{keydir} directory
24131 within the gitolite-admin repository.
24132
24133 To specify the SSH key as a string, use the @code{plain-file} function.
24134
24135 @lisp
24136 (plain-file "yourname.pub" "ssh-rsa AAAA... guix@@example.com")
24137 @end lisp
24138
24139 @end table
24140 @end deftp
24141
24142 @deftp {Data Type} gitolite-rc-file
24143 Data type representing the Gitolite RC file.
24144
24145 @table @asis
24146 @item @code{umask} (default: @code{#o0077})
24147 This controls the permissions Gitolite sets on the repositories and their
24148 contents.
24149
24150 A value like @code{#o0027} will give read access to the group used by Gitolite
24151 (by default: @code{git}). This is necessary when using Gitolite with software
24152 like cgit or gitweb.
24153
24154 @item @code{git-config-keys} (default: @code{""})
24155 Gitolite allows you to set git config values using the "config" keyword. This
24156 setting allows control over the config keys to accept.
24157
24158 @item @code{roles} (default: @code{'(("READERS" . 1) ("WRITERS" . ))})
24159 Set the role names allowed to be used by users running the perms command.
24160
24161 @item @code{enable} (default: @code{'("help" "desc" "info" "perms" "writable" "ssh-authkeys" "git-config" "daemon" "gitweb")})
24162 This setting controls the commands and features to enable within Gitolite.
24163
24164 @end table
24165 @end deftp
24166
24167
24168 @node Game Services
24169 @subsection Game Services
24170
24171 @subsubheading The Battle for Wesnoth Service
24172 @cindex wesnothd
24173 @uref{https://wesnoth.org, The Battle for Wesnoth} is a fantasy, turn
24174 based tactical strategy game, with several single player campaigns, and
24175 multiplayer games (both networked and local).
24176
24177 @defvar {Scheme Variable} wesnothd-service-type
24178 Service type for the wesnothd service. Its value must be a
24179 @code{wesnothd-configuration} object. To run wesnothd in the default
24180 configuration, instantiate it as:
24181
24182 @lisp
24183 (service wesnothd-service-type)
24184 @end lisp
24185 @end defvar
24186
24187 @deftp {Data Type} wesnothd-configuration
24188 Data type representing the configuration of @command{wesnothd}.
24189
24190 @table @asis
24191 @item @code{package} (default: @code{wesnoth-server})
24192 The wesnoth server package to use.
24193
24194 @item @code{port} (default: @code{15000})
24195 The port to bind the server to.
24196 @end table
24197 @end deftp
24198
24199 @node Miscellaneous Services
24200 @subsection Miscellaneous Services
24201
24202 @cindex fingerprint
24203 @subsubheading Fingerprint Service
24204
24205 The @code{(gnu services authentication)} module provides a DBus service to
24206 read and identify fingerprints via a fingerprint sensor.
24207
24208 @defvr {Scheme Variable} fprintd-service-type
24209 The service type for @command{fprintd}, which provides the fingerprint
24210 reading capability.
24211
24212 @lisp
24213 (service fprintd-service-type)
24214 @end lisp
24215 @end defvr
24216
24217 @cindex sysctl
24218 @subsubheading System Control Service
24219
24220 The @code{(gnu services sysctl)} provides a service to configure kernel
24221 parameters at boot.
24222
24223 @defvr {Scheme Variable} sysctl-service-type
24224 The service type for @command{sysctl}, which modifies kernel parameters
24225 under @file{/proc/sys/}. To enable IPv4 forwarding, it can be
24226 instantiated as:
24227
24228 @lisp
24229 (service sysctl-service-type
24230 (sysctl-configuration
24231 (settings '(("net.ipv4.ip_forward" . "1")))))
24232 @end lisp
24233 @end defvr
24234
24235 @deftp {Data Type} sysctl-configuration
24236 The data type representing the configuration of @command{sysctl}.
24237
24238 @table @asis
24239 @item @code{sysctl} (default: @code{(file-append procps "/sbin/sysctl"})
24240 The @command{sysctl} executable to use.
24241
24242 @item @code{settings} (default: @code{'()})
24243 An association list specifies kernel parameters and their values.
24244 @end table
24245 @end deftp
24246
24247 @cindex pcscd
24248 @subsubheading PC/SC Smart Card Daemon Service
24249
24250 The @code{(gnu services security-token)} module provides the following service
24251 to run @command{pcscd}, the PC/SC Smart Card Daemon. @command{pcscd} is the
24252 daemon program for pcsc-lite and the MuscleCard framework. It is a resource
24253 manager that coordinates communications with smart card readers, smart cards
24254 and cryptographic tokens that are connected to the system.
24255
24256 @defvr {Scheme Variable} pcscd-service-type
24257 Service type for the @command{pcscd} service. Its value must be a
24258 @code{pcscd-configuration} object. To run pcscd in the default
24259 configuration, instantiate it as:
24260
24261 @lisp
24262 (service pcscd-service-type)
24263 @end lisp
24264 @end defvr
24265
24266 @deftp {Data Type} pcscd-configuration
24267 The data type representing the configuration of @command{pcscd}.
24268
24269 @table @asis
24270 @item @code{pcsc-lite} (default: @code{pcsc-lite})
24271 The pcsc-lite package that provides pcscd.
24272 @item @code{usb-drivers} (default: @code{(list ccid)})
24273 List of packages that provide USB drivers to pcscd. Drivers are expected to be
24274 under @file{pcsc/drivers} in the store directory of the package.
24275 @end table
24276 @end deftp
24277
24278 @cindex lirc
24279 @subsubheading Lirc Service
24280
24281 The @code{(gnu services lirc)} module provides the following service.
24282
24283 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} lirc-service [#:lirc lirc] @
24284 [#:device #f] [#:driver #f] [#:config-file #f] @
24285 [#:extra-options '()]
24286 Return a service that runs @url{http://www.lirc.org,LIRC}, a daemon that
24287 decodes infrared signals from remote controls.
24288
24289 Optionally, @var{device}, @var{driver} and @var{config-file}
24290 (configuration file name) may be specified. See @command{lircd} manual
24291 for details.
24292
24293 Finally, @var{extra-options} is a list of additional command-line options
24294 passed to @command{lircd}.
24295 @end deffn
24296
24297 @cindex spice
24298 @subsubheading Spice Service
24299
24300 The @code{(gnu services spice)} module provides the following service.
24301
24302 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} spice-vdagent-service [#:spice-vdagent]
24303 Returns a service that runs @url{https://www.spice-space.org,VDAGENT}, a daemon
24304 that enables sharing the clipboard with a vm and setting the guest display
24305 resolution when the graphical console window resizes.
24306 @end deffn
24307
24308 @cindex inputattach
24309 @subsubheading inputattach Service
24310
24311 @cindex tablet input, for Xorg
24312 @cindex touchscreen input, for Xorg
24313 The @uref{https://linuxwacom.github.io/, inputattach} service allows you to
24314 use input devices such as Wacom tablets, touchscreens, or joysticks with the
24315 Xorg display server.
24316
24317 @deffn {Scheme Variable} inputattach-service-type
24318 Type of a service that runs @command{inputattach} on a device and
24319 dispatches events from it.
24320 @end deffn
24321
24322 @deftp {Data Type} inputattach-configuration
24323 @table @asis
24324 @item @code{device-type} (default: @code{"wacom"})
24325 The type of device to connect to. Run @command{inputattach --help}, from the
24326 @code{inputattach} package, to see the list of supported device types.
24327
24328 @item @code{device} (default: @code{"/dev/ttyS0"})
24329 The device file to connect to the device.
24330
24331 @item @code{log-file} (default: @code{#f})
24332 If true, this must be the name of a file to log messages to.
24333 @end table
24334 @end deftp
24335
24336 @subsection Dictionary Services
24337 @cindex dictionary
24338 The @code{(gnu services dict)} module provides the following service:
24339
24340 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} dicod-service [#:config (dicod-configuration)]
24341 Return a service that runs the @command{dicod} daemon, an implementation
24342 of DICT server (@pxref{Dicod,,, dico, GNU Dico Manual}).
24343
24344 The optional @var{config} argument specifies the configuration for
24345 @command{dicod}, which should be a @code{<dicod-configuration>} object, by
24346 default it serves the GNU Collaborative International Dictonary of English.
24347
24348 You can add @command{open localhost} to your @file{~/.dico} file to make
24349 @code{localhost} the default server for @command{dico} client
24350 (@pxref{Initialization File,,, dico, GNU Dico Manual}).
24351 @end deffn
24352
24353 @deftp {Data Type} dicod-configuration
24354 Data type representing the configuration of dicod.
24355
24356 @table @asis
24357 @item @code{dico} (default: @var{dico})
24358 Package object of the GNU Dico dictionary server.
24359
24360 @item @code{interfaces} (default: @var{'("localhost")})
24361 This is the list of IP addresses and ports and possibly socket file
24362 names to listen to (@pxref{Server Settings, @code{listen} directive,,
24363 dico, GNU Dico Manual}).
24364
24365 @item @code{handlers} (default: @var{'()})
24366 List of @code{<dicod-handler>} objects denoting handlers (module instances).
24367
24368 @item @code{databases} (default: @var{(list %dicod-database:gcide)})
24369 List of @code{<dicod-database>} objects denoting dictionaries to be served.
24370 @end table
24371 @end deftp
24372
24373 @deftp {Data Type} dicod-handler
24374 Data type representing a dictionary handler (module instance).
24375
24376 @table @asis
24377 @item @code{name}
24378 Name of the handler (module instance).
24379
24380 @item @code{module} (default: @var{#f})
24381 Name of the dicod module of the handler (instance). If it is @code{#f},
24382 the module has the same name as the handler.
24383 (@pxref{Modules,,, dico, GNU Dico Manual}).
24384
24385 @item @code{options}
24386 List of strings or gexps representing the arguments for the module handler
24387 @end table
24388 @end deftp
24389
24390 @deftp {Data Type} dicod-database
24391 Data type representing a dictionary database.
24392
24393 @table @asis
24394 @item @code{name}
24395 Name of the database, will be used in DICT commands.
24396
24397 @item @code{handler}
24398 Name of the dicod handler (module instance) used by this database
24399 (@pxref{Handlers,,, dico, GNU Dico Manual}).
24400
24401 @item @code{complex?} (default: @var{#f})
24402 Whether the database configuration complex. The complex configuration
24403 will need a corresponding @code{<dicod-handler>} object, otherwise not.
24404
24405 @item @code{options}
24406 List of strings or gexps representing the arguments for the database
24407 (@pxref{Databases,,, dico, GNU Dico Manual}).
24408 @end table
24409 @end deftp
24410
24411 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %dicod-database:gcide
24412 A @code{<dicod-database>} object serving the GNU Collaborative International
24413 Dictionary of English using the @code{gcide} package.
24414 @end defvr
24415
24416 The following is an example @code{dicod-service} configuration.
24417
24418 @lisp
24419 (dicod-service #:config
24420 (dicod-configuration
24421 (handlers (list (dicod-handler
24422 (name "wordnet")
24423 (module "dictorg")
24424 (options
24425 (list #~(string-append "dbdir=" #$wordnet))))))
24426 (databases (list (dicod-database
24427 (name "wordnet")
24428 (complex? #t)
24429 (handler "wordnet")
24430 (options '("database=wn")))
24431 %dicod-database:gcide))))
24432 @end lisp
24433
24434 @cindex Docker
24435 @subsubheading Docker Service
24436
24437 The @code{(gnu services docker)} module provides the following services.
24438
24439 @defvr {Scheme Variable} docker-service-type
24440
24441 This is the type of the service that runs @url{https://www.docker.com,Docker},
24442 a daemon that can execute application bundles (sometimes referred to as
24443 ``containers'') in isolated environments.
24444
24445 @end defvr
24446
24447 @deftp {Data Type} docker-configuration
24448 This is the data type representing the configuration of Docker and Containerd.
24449
24450 @table @asis
24451
24452 @item @code{package} (default: @code{docker})
24453 The Docker package to use.
24454
24455 @item @code{containerd} (default: @var{containerd})
24456 The Containerd package to use.
24457
24458 @end table
24459 @end deftp
24460
24461 @cindex Audit
24462 @subsubheading Auditd Service
24463
24464 The @code{(gnu services auditd)} module provides the following service.
24465
24466 @defvr {Scheme Variable} auditd-service-type
24467
24468 This is the type of the service that runs
24469 @url{https://people.redhat.com/sgrubb/audit/,auditd},
24470 a daemon that tracks security-relevant information on your system.
24471
24472 Examples of things that can be tracked:
24473
24474 @enumerate
24475 @item
24476 File accesses
24477 @item
24478 System calls
24479 @item
24480 Invoked commands
24481 @item
24482 Failed login attempts
24483 @item
24484 Firewall filtering
24485 @item
24486 Network access
24487 @end enumerate
24488
24489 @command{auditctl} from the @code{audit} package can be used in order
24490 to add or remove events to be tracked (until the next reboot).
24491 In order to permanently track events, put the command line arguments
24492 of auditctl into @file{/etc/audit/audit.rules}.
24493 @command{aureport} from the @code{audit} package can be used in order
24494 to view a report of all recorded events.
24495 The audit daemon usually logs into the directory @file{/var/log/audit}.
24496
24497 @end defvr
24498
24499 @deftp {Data Type} auditd-configuration
24500 This is the data type representing the configuration of auditd.
24501
24502 @table @asis
24503
24504 @item @code{audit} (default: @code{audit})
24505 The audit package to use.
24506
24507 @end table
24508 @end deftp
24509
24510 @defvr {Scheme Variable} singularity-service-type
24511 This is the type of the service that allows you to run
24512 @url{https://www.sylabs.io/singularity/, Singularity}, a Docker-style tool to
24513 create and run application bundles (aka. ``containers''). The value for this
24514 service is the Singularity package to use.
24515
24516 The service does not install a daemon; instead, it installs helper programs as
24517 setuid-root (@pxref{Setuid Programs}) such that unprivileged users can invoke
24518 @command{singularity run} and similar commands.
24519 @end defvr
24520
24521 @cindex Nix
24522 @subsubheading Nix service
24523
24524 The @code{(gnu services nix)} module provides the following service.
24525
24526 @defvr {Scheme Variable} nix-service-type
24527
24528 This is the type of the service that runs build daemon of the
24529 @url{https://nixos.org/nix/, Nix} package manager. Here is an example showing
24530 how to use it:
24531
24532 @lisp
24533 (use-modules (gnu))
24534 (use-service-modules nix)
24535 (use-package-modules package-management)
24536
24537 (operating-system
24538 ;; @dots{}
24539 (packages (append (list nix)
24540 %base-packages))
24541
24542 (services (append (list (service nix-service-type))
24543 %base-services)))
24544 @end lisp
24545
24546 After @command{guix system reconfigure} configure Nix for your user:
24547
24548 @itemize
24549 @item Add a Nix channel and update it. See
24550 @url{https://nixos.org/nix/manual/, Nix Package Manager Guide}.
24551
24552 @item Create a symlink to your profile and activate Nix profile:
24553 @end itemize
24554
24555 @example
24556 $ ln -s "/nix/var/nix/profiles/per-user/$USER/profile" ~/.nix-profile
24557 $ source /run/current-system/profile/etc/profile.d/nix.sh
24558 @end example
24559
24560 @end defvr
24561
24562 @node Setuid Programs
24563 @section Setuid Programs
24564
24565 @cindex setuid programs
24566 Some programs need to run with ``root'' privileges, even when they are
24567 launched by unprivileged users. A notorious example is the
24568 @command{passwd} program, which users can run to change their
24569 password, and which needs to access the @file{/etc/passwd} and
24570 @file{/etc/shadow} files---something normally restricted to root, for
24571 obvious security reasons. To address that, these executables are
24572 @dfn{setuid-root}, meaning that they always run with root privileges
24573 (@pxref{How Change Persona,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual},
24574 for more info about the setuid mechanism.)
24575
24576 The store itself @emph{cannot} contain setuid programs: that would be a
24577 security issue since any user on the system can write derivations that
24578 populate the store (@pxref{The Store}). Thus, a different mechanism is
24579 used: instead of changing the setuid bit directly on files that are in
24580 the store, we let the system administrator @emph{declare} which programs
24581 should be setuid root.
24582
24583 The @code{setuid-programs} field of an @code{operating-system}
24584 declaration contains a list of G-expressions denoting the names of
24585 programs to be setuid-root (@pxref{Using the Configuration System}).
24586 For instance, the @command{passwd} program, which is part of the Shadow
24587 package, can be designated by this G-expression (@pxref{G-Expressions}):
24588
24589 @example
24590 #~(string-append #$shadow "/bin/passwd")
24591 @end example
24592
24593 A default set of setuid programs is defined by the
24594 @code{%setuid-programs} variable of the @code{(gnu system)} module.
24595
24596 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %setuid-programs
24597 A list of G-expressions denoting common programs that are setuid-root.
24598
24599 The list includes commands such as @command{passwd}, @command{ping},
24600 @command{su}, and @command{sudo}.
24601 @end defvr
24602
24603 Under the hood, the actual setuid programs are created in the
24604 @file{/run/setuid-programs} directory at system activation time. The
24605 files in this directory refer to the ``real'' binaries, which are in the
24606 store.
24607
24608 @node X.509 Certificates
24609 @section X.509 Certificates
24610
24611 @cindex HTTPS, certificates
24612 @cindex X.509 certificates
24613 @cindex TLS
24614 Web servers available over HTTPS (that is, HTTP over the transport-layer
24615 security mechanism, TLS) send client programs an @dfn{X.509 certificate}
24616 that the client can then use to @emph{authenticate} the server. To do
24617 that, clients verify that the server's certificate is signed by a
24618 so-called @dfn{certificate authority} (CA). But to verify the CA's
24619 signature, clients must have first acquired the CA's certificate.
24620
24621 Web browsers such as GNU@tie{}IceCat include their own set of CA
24622 certificates, such that they are able to verify CA signatures
24623 out-of-the-box.
24624
24625 However, most other programs that can talk HTTPS---@command{wget},
24626 @command{git}, @command{w3m}, etc.---need to be told where CA
24627 certificates can be found.
24628
24629 @cindex @code{nss-certs}
24630 In Guix, this is done by adding a package that provides certificates
24631 to the @code{packages} field of the @code{operating-system} declaration
24632 (@pxref{operating-system Reference}). Guix includes one such package,
24633 @code{nss-certs}, which is a set of CA certificates provided as part of
24634 Mozilla's Network Security Services.
24635
24636 Note that it is @emph{not} part of @code{%base-packages}, so you need to
24637 explicitly add it. The @file{/etc/ssl/certs} directory, which is where
24638 most applications and libraries look for certificates by default, points
24639 to the certificates installed globally.
24640
24641 Unprivileged users, including users of Guix on a foreign distro,
24642 can also install their own certificate package in
24643 their profile. A number of environment variables need to be defined so
24644 that applications and libraries know where to find them. Namely, the
24645 OpenSSL library honors the @code{SSL_CERT_DIR} and @code{SSL_CERT_FILE}
24646 variables. Some applications add their own environment variables; for
24647 instance, the Git version control system honors the certificate bundle
24648 pointed to by the @code{GIT_SSL_CAINFO} environment variable. Thus, you
24649 would typically run something like:
24650
24651 @example
24652 $ guix install nss-certs
24653 $ export SSL_CERT_DIR="$HOME/.guix-profile/etc/ssl/certs"
24654 $ export SSL_CERT_FILE="$HOME/.guix-profile/etc/ssl/certs/ca-certificates.crt"
24655 $ export GIT_SSL_CAINFO="$SSL_CERT_FILE"
24656 @end example
24657
24658 As another example, R requires the @code{CURL_CA_BUNDLE} environment
24659 variable to point to a certificate bundle, so you would have to run
24660 something like this:
24661
24662 @example
24663 $ guix install nss-certs
24664 $ export CURL_CA_BUNDLE="$HOME/.guix-profile/etc/ssl/certs/ca-certificates.crt"
24665 @end example
24666
24667 For other applications you may want to look up the required environment
24668 variable in the relevant documentation.
24669
24670
24671 @node Name Service Switch
24672 @section Name Service Switch
24673
24674 @cindex name service switch
24675 @cindex NSS
24676 The @code{(gnu system nss)} module provides bindings to the
24677 configuration file of the libc @dfn{name service switch} or @dfn{NSS}
24678 (@pxref{NSS Configuration File,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference
24679 Manual}). In a nutshell, the NSS is a mechanism that allows libc to be
24680 extended with new ``name'' lookup methods for system databases, which
24681 includes host names, service names, user accounts, and more (@pxref{Name
24682 Service Switch, System Databases and Name Service Switch,, libc, The GNU
24683 C Library Reference Manual}).
24684
24685 The NSS configuration specifies, for each system database, which lookup
24686 method is to be used, and how the various methods are chained
24687 together---for instance, under which circumstances NSS should try the
24688 next method in the list. The NSS configuration is given in the
24689 @code{name-service-switch} field of @code{operating-system} declarations
24690 (@pxref{operating-system Reference, @code{name-service-switch}}).
24691
24692 @cindex nss-mdns
24693 @cindex .local, host name lookup
24694 As an example, the declaration below configures the NSS to use the
24695 @uref{http://0pointer.de/lennart/projects/nss-mdns/, @code{nss-mdns}
24696 back-end}, which supports host name lookups over multicast DNS (mDNS)
24697 for host names ending in @code{.local}:
24698
24699 @lisp
24700 (name-service-switch
24701 (hosts (list %files ;first, check /etc/hosts
24702
24703 ;; If the above did not succeed, try
24704 ;; with 'mdns_minimal'.
24705 (name-service
24706 (name "mdns_minimal")
24707
24708 ;; 'mdns_minimal' is authoritative for
24709 ;; '.local'. When it returns "not found",
24710 ;; no need to try the next methods.
24711 (reaction (lookup-specification
24712 (not-found => return))))
24713
24714 ;; Then fall back to DNS.
24715 (name-service
24716 (name "dns"))
24717
24718 ;; Finally, try with the "full" 'mdns'.
24719 (name-service
24720 (name "mdns")))))
24721 @end lisp
24722
24723 Do not worry: the @code{%mdns-host-lookup-nss} variable (see below)
24724 contains this configuration, so you will not have to type it if all you
24725 want is to have @code{.local} host lookup working.
24726
24727 Note that, in this case, in addition to setting the
24728 @code{name-service-switch} of the @code{operating-system} declaration,
24729 you also need to use @code{avahi-service-type} (@pxref{Networking Services,
24730 @code{avahi-service-type}}), or @code{%desktop-services}, which includes it
24731 (@pxref{Desktop Services}). Doing this makes @code{nss-mdns} accessible
24732 to the name service cache daemon (@pxref{Base Services,
24733 @code{nscd-service}}).
24734
24735 For convenience, the following variables provide typical NSS
24736 configurations.
24737
24738 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %default-nss
24739 This is the default name service switch configuration, a
24740 @code{name-service-switch} object.
24741 @end defvr
24742
24743 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %mdns-host-lookup-nss
24744 This is the name service switch configuration with support for host name
24745 lookup over multicast DNS (mDNS) for host names ending in @code{.local}.
24746 @end defvr
24747
24748 The reference for name service switch configuration is given below. It
24749 is a direct mapping of the configuration file format of the C library , so
24750 please refer to the C library manual for more information (@pxref{NSS
24751 Configuration File,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
24752 Compared to the configuration file format of libc NSS, it has the advantage
24753 not only of adding this warm parenthetic feel that we like, but also
24754 static checks: you will know about syntax errors and typos as soon as you
24755 run @command{guix system}.
24756
24757 @deftp {Data Type} name-service-switch
24758
24759 This is the data type representation the configuration of libc's name
24760 service switch (NSS). Each field below represents one of the supported
24761 system databases.
24762
24763 @table @code
24764 @item aliases
24765 @itemx ethers
24766 @itemx group
24767 @itemx gshadow
24768 @itemx hosts
24769 @itemx initgroups
24770 @itemx netgroup
24771 @itemx networks
24772 @itemx password
24773 @itemx public-key
24774 @itemx rpc
24775 @itemx services
24776 @itemx shadow
24777 The system databases handled by the NSS. Each of these fields must be a
24778 list of @code{<name-service>} objects (see below).
24779 @end table
24780 @end deftp
24781
24782 @deftp {Data Type} name-service
24783
24784 This is the data type representing an actual name service and the
24785 associated lookup action.
24786
24787 @table @code
24788 @item name
24789 A string denoting the name service (@pxref{Services in the NSS
24790 configuration,,, libc, The GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
24791
24792 Note that name services listed here must be visible to nscd. This is
24793 achieved by passing the @code{#:name-services} argument to
24794 @code{nscd-service} the list of packages providing the needed name
24795 services (@pxref{Base Services, @code{nscd-service}}).
24796
24797 @item reaction
24798 An action specified using the @code{lookup-specification} macro
24799 (@pxref{Actions in the NSS configuration,,, libc, The GNU C Library
24800 Reference Manual}). For example:
24801
24802 @lisp
24803 (lookup-specification (unavailable => continue)
24804 (success => return))
24805 @end lisp
24806 @end table
24807 @end deftp
24808
24809 @node Initial RAM Disk
24810 @section Initial RAM Disk
24811
24812 @cindex initrd
24813 @cindex initial RAM disk
24814 For bootstrapping purposes, the Linux-Libre kernel is passed an
24815 @dfn{initial RAM disk}, or @dfn{initrd}. An initrd contains a temporary
24816 root file system as well as an initialization script. The latter is
24817 responsible for mounting the real root file system, and for loading any
24818 kernel modules that may be needed to achieve that.
24819
24820 The @code{initrd-modules} field of an @code{operating-system}
24821 declaration allows you to specify Linux-libre kernel modules that must
24822 be available in the initrd. In particular, this is where you would list
24823 modules needed to actually drive the hard disk where your root partition
24824 is---although the default value of @code{initrd-modules} should cover
24825 most use cases. For example, assuming you need the @code{megaraid_sas}
24826 module in addition to the default modules to be able to access your root
24827 file system, you would write:
24828
24829 @lisp
24830 (operating-system
24831 ;; @dots{}
24832 (initrd-modules (cons "megaraid_sas" %base-initrd-modules)))
24833 @end lisp
24834
24835 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %base-initrd-modules
24836 This is the list of kernel modules included in the initrd by default.
24837 @end defvr
24838
24839 Furthermore, if you need lower-level customization, the @code{initrd}
24840 field of an @code{operating-system} declaration allows
24841 you to specify which initrd you would like to use. The @code{(gnu
24842 system linux-initrd)} module provides three ways to build an initrd: the
24843 high-level @code{base-initrd} procedure and the low-level
24844 @code{raw-initrd} and @code{expression->initrd} procedures.
24845
24846 The @code{base-initrd} procedure is intended to cover most common uses.
24847 For example, if you want to add a bunch of kernel modules to be loaded
24848 at boot time, you can define the @code{initrd} field of the operating
24849 system declaration like this:
24850
24851 @lisp
24852 (initrd (lambda (file-systems . rest)
24853 ;; Create a standard initrd but set up networking
24854 ;; with the parameters QEMU expects by default.
24855 (apply base-initrd file-systems
24856 #:qemu-networking? #t
24857 rest)))
24858 @end lisp
24859
24860 The @code{base-initrd} procedure also handles common use cases that
24861 involves using the system as a QEMU guest, or as a ``live'' system with
24862 volatile root file system.
24863
24864 The @code{base-initrd} procedure is built from @code{raw-initrd} procedure.
24865 Unlike @code{base-initrd}, @code{raw-initrd} doesn't do anything high-level,
24866 such as trying to guess which kernel modules and packages should be included
24867 to the initrd. An example use of @code{raw-initrd} is when a user has
24868 a custom Linux kernel configuration and default kernel modules included by
24869 @code{base-initrd} are not available.
24870
24871 The initial RAM disk produced by @code{base-initrd} or @code{raw-initrd}
24872 honors several options passed on the Linux kernel command line
24873 (that is, arguments passed @i{via} the @code{linux} command of GRUB, or the
24874 @code{-append} option of QEMU), notably:
24875
24876 @table @code
24877 @item --load=@var{boot}
24878 Tell the initial RAM disk to load @var{boot}, a file containing a Scheme
24879 program, once it has mounted the root file system.
24880
24881 Guix uses this option to yield control to a boot program that runs the
24882 service activation programs and then spawns the GNU@tie{}Shepherd, the
24883 initialization system.
24884
24885 @item --root=@var{root}
24886 Mount @var{root} as the root file system. @var{root} can be a
24887 device name like @code{/dev/sda1}, a file system label, or a file system
24888 UUID.
24889
24890 @item --system=@var{system}
24891 Have @file{/run/booted-system} and @file{/run/current-system} point to
24892 @var{system}.
24893
24894 @item modprobe.blacklist=@var{modules}@dots{}
24895 @cindex module, black-listing
24896 @cindex black list, of kernel modules
24897 Instruct the initial RAM disk as well as the @command{modprobe} command
24898 (from the kmod package) to refuse to load @var{modules}. @var{modules}
24899 must be a comma-separated list of module names---e.g.,
24900 @code{usbkbd,9pnet}.
24901
24902 @item --repl
24903 Start a read-eval-print loop (REPL) from the initial RAM disk before it
24904 tries to load kernel modules and to mount the root file system. Our
24905 marketing team calls it @dfn{boot-to-Guile}. The Schemer in you will
24906 love it. @xref{Using Guile Interactively,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference
24907 Manual}, for more information on Guile's REPL.
24908
24909 @end table
24910
24911 Now that you know all the features that initial RAM disks produced by
24912 @code{base-initrd} and @code{raw-initrd} provide,
24913 here is how to use it and customize it further.
24914
24915 @cindex initrd
24916 @cindex initial RAM disk
24917 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} raw-initrd @var{file-systems} @
24918 [#:linux-modules '()] [#:mapped-devices '()] @
24919 [#:keyboard-layout #f] @
24920 [#:helper-packages '()] [#:qemu-networking? #f] [#:volatile-root? #f]
24921 Return a derivation that builds a raw initrd. @var{file-systems} is
24922 a list of file systems to be mounted by the initrd, possibly in addition to
24923 the root file system specified on the kernel command line via @code{--root}.
24924 @var{linux-modules} is a list of kernel modules to be loaded at boot time.
24925 @var{mapped-devices} is a list of device mappings to realize before
24926 @var{file-systems} are mounted (@pxref{Mapped Devices}).
24927 @var{helper-packages} is a list of packages to be copied in the initrd. It may
24928 include @code{e2fsck/static} or other packages needed by the initrd to check
24929 the root file system.
24930
24931 When true, @var{keyboard-layout} is a @code{<keyboard-layout>} record denoting
24932 the desired console keyboard layout. This is done before @var{mapped-devices}
24933 are set up and before @var{file-systems} are mounted such that, should the
24934 user need to enter a passphrase or use the REPL, this happens using the
24935 intended keyboard layout.
24936
24937 When @var{qemu-networking?} is true, set up networking with the standard QEMU
24938 parameters. When @var{virtio?} is true, load additional modules so that the
24939 initrd can be used as a QEMU guest with para-virtualized I/O drivers.
24940
24941 When @var{volatile-root?} is true, the root file system is writable but any changes
24942 to it are lost.
24943 @end deffn
24944
24945 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} base-initrd @var{file-systems} @
24946 [#:mapped-devices '()] [#:keyboard-layout #f] @
24947 [#:qemu-networking? #f] [#:volatile-root? #f] @
24948 [#:linux-modules '()]
24949 Return as a file-like object a generic initrd, with kernel
24950 modules taken from @var{linux}. @var{file-systems} is a list of file-systems to be
24951 mounted by the initrd, possibly in addition to the root file system specified
24952 on the kernel command line via @code{--root}. @var{mapped-devices} is a list of device
24953 mappings to realize before @var{file-systems} are mounted.
24954
24955 When true, @var{keyboard-layout} is a @code{<keyboard-layout>} record denoting
24956 the desired console keyboard layout. This is done before @var{mapped-devices}
24957 are set up and before @var{file-systems} are mounted such that, should the
24958 user need to enter a passphrase or use the REPL, this happens using the
24959 intended keyboard layout.
24960
24961 @var{qemu-networking?} and @var{volatile-root?} behaves as in @code{raw-initrd}.
24962
24963 The initrd is automatically populated with all the kernel modules necessary
24964 for @var{file-systems} and for the given options. Additional kernel
24965 modules can be listed in @var{linux-modules}. They will be added to the initrd, and
24966 loaded at boot time in the order in which they appear.
24967 @end deffn
24968
24969 Needless to say, the initrds we produce and use embed a
24970 statically-linked Guile, and the initialization program is a Guile
24971 program. That gives a lot of flexibility. The
24972 @code{expression->initrd} procedure builds such an initrd, given the
24973 program to run in that initrd.
24974
24975 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} expression->initrd @var{exp} @
24976 [#:guile %guile-static-stripped] [#:name "guile-initrd"]
24977 Return as a file-like object a Linux initrd (a gzipped cpio archive)
24978 containing @var{guile} and that evaluates @var{exp}, a G-expression,
24979 upon booting. All the derivations referenced by @var{exp} are
24980 automatically copied to the initrd.
24981 @end deffn
24982
24983 @node Bootloader Configuration
24984 @section Bootloader Configuration
24985
24986 @cindex bootloader
24987 @cindex boot loader
24988
24989 The operating system supports multiple bootloaders. The bootloader is
24990 configured using @code{bootloader-configuration} declaration. All the
24991 fields of this structure are bootloader agnostic except for one field,
24992 @code{bootloader} that indicates the bootloader to be configured and
24993 installed.
24994
24995 Some of the bootloaders do not honor every field of
24996 @code{bootloader-configuration}. For instance, the extlinux
24997 bootloader does not support themes and thus ignores the @code{theme}
24998 field.
24999
25000 @deftp {Data Type} bootloader-configuration
25001 The type of a bootloader configuration declaration.
25002
25003 @table @asis
25004
25005 @item @code{bootloader}
25006 @cindex EFI, bootloader
25007 @cindex UEFI, bootloader
25008 @cindex BIOS, bootloader
25009 The bootloader to use, as a @code{bootloader} object. For now
25010 @code{grub-bootloader}, @code{grub-efi-bootloader},
25011 @code{extlinux-bootloader} and @code{u-boot-bootloader} are supported.
25012
25013 @vindex grub-efi-bootloader
25014 @code{grub-efi-bootloader} allows to boot on modern systems using the
25015 @dfn{Unified Extensible Firmware Interface} (UEFI). This is what you should
25016 use if the installation image contains a @file{/sys/firmware/efi} directory
25017 when you boot it on your system.
25018
25019 @vindex grub-bootloader
25020 @code{grub-bootloader} allows you to boot in particular Intel-based machines
25021 in ``legacy'' BIOS mode.
25022
25023 @cindex ARM, bootloaders
25024 @cindex AArch64, bootloaders
25025 Available bootloaders are described in @code{(gnu bootloader @dots{})}
25026 modules. In particular, @code{(gnu bootloader u-boot)} contains definitions
25027 of bootloaders for a wide range of ARM and AArch64 systems, using the
25028 @uref{https://www.denx.de/wiki/U-Boot/, U-Boot bootloader}.
25029
25030 @item @code{target}
25031 This is a string denoting the target onto which to install the
25032 bootloader.
25033
25034 The interpretation depends on the bootloader in question. For
25035 @code{grub-bootloader}, for example, it should be a device name understood by
25036 the bootloader @command{installer} command, such as @code{/dev/sda} or
25037 @code{(hd0)} (@pxref{Invoking grub-install,,, grub, GNU GRUB Manual}). For
25038 @code{grub-efi-bootloader}, it should be the mount point of the EFI file
25039 system, usually @file{/boot/efi}.
25040
25041 @item @code{menu-entries} (default: @code{()})
25042 A possibly empty list of @code{menu-entry} objects (see below), denoting
25043 entries to appear in the bootloader menu, in addition to the current
25044 system entry and the entry pointing to previous system generations.
25045
25046 @item @code{default-entry} (default: @code{0})
25047 The index of the default boot menu entry. Index 0 is for the entry of the
25048 current system.
25049
25050 @item @code{timeout} (default: @code{5})
25051 The number of seconds to wait for keyboard input before booting. Set to
25052 0 to boot immediately, and to -1 to wait indefinitely.
25053
25054 @cindex keyboard layout, for the bootloader
25055 @item @code{keyboard-layout} (default: @code{#f})
25056 If this is @code{#f}, the bootloader's menu (if any) uses the default keyboard
25057 layout, usually US@tie{}English (``qwerty'').
25058
25059 Otherwise, this must be a @code{keyboard-layout} object (@pxref{Keyboard
25060 Layout}).
25061
25062 @quotation Note
25063 This option is currently ignored by bootloaders other than @code{grub} and
25064 @code{grub-efi}.
25065 @end quotation
25066
25067 @item @code{theme} (default: @var{#f})
25068 The bootloader theme object describing the theme to use. If no theme
25069 is provided, some bootloaders might use a default theme, that's true
25070 for GRUB.
25071
25072 @item @code{terminal-outputs} (default: @code{'(gfxterm)})
25073 The output terminals used for the bootloader boot menu, as a list of
25074 symbols. GRUB accepts the values: @code{console}, @code{serial},
25075 @code{serial_@{0-3@}}, @code{gfxterm}, @code{vga_text},
25076 @code{mda_text}, @code{morse}, and @code{pkmodem}. This field
25077 corresponds to the GRUB variable @code{GRUB_TERMINAL_OUTPUT} (@pxref{Simple
25078 configuration,,, grub,GNU GRUB manual}).
25079
25080 @item @code{terminal-inputs} (default: @code{'()})
25081 The input terminals used for the bootloader boot menu, as a list of
25082 symbols. For GRUB, the default is the native platform terminal as
25083 determined at run-time. GRUB accepts the values: @code{console},
25084 @code{serial}, @code{serial_@{0-3@}}, @code{at_keyboard}, and
25085 @code{usb_keyboard}. This field corresponds to the GRUB variable
25086 @code{GRUB_TERMINAL_INPUT} (@pxref{Simple configuration,,, grub,GNU GRUB
25087 manual}).
25088
25089 @item @code{serial-unit} (default: @code{#f})
25090 The serial unit used by the bootloader, as an integer from 0 to 3.
25091 For GRUB, it is chosen at run-time; currently GRUB chooses 0, which
25092 corresponds to COM1 (@pxref{Serial terminal,,, grub,GNU GRUB manual}).
25093
25094 @item @code{serial-speed} (default: @code{#f})
25095 The speed of the serial interface, as an integer. For GRUB, the
25096 default value is chosen at run-time; currently GRUB chooses
25097 9600@tie{}bps (@pxref{Serial terminal,,, grub,GNU GRUB manual}).
25098 @end table
25099
25100 @end deftp
25101
25102 @cindex dual boot
25103 @cindex boot menu
25104 Should you want to list additional boot menu entries @i{via} the
25105 @code{menu-entries} field above, you will need to create them with the
25106 @code{menu-entry} form. For example, imagine you want to be able to
25107 boot another distro (hard to imagine!), you can define a menu entry
25108 along these lines:
25109
25110 @lisp
25111 (menu-entry
25112 (label "The Other Distro")
25113 (linux "/boot/old/vmlinux-2.6.32")
25114 (linux-arguments '("root=/dev/sda2"))
25115 (initrd "/boot/old/initrd"))
25116 @end lisp
25117
25118 Details below.
25119
25120 @deftp {Data Type} menu-entry
25121 The type of an entry in the bootloader menu.
25122
25123 @table @asis
25124
25125 @item @code{label}
25126 The label to show in the menu---e.g., @code{"GNU"}.
25127
25128 @item @code{linux}
25129 The Linux kernel image to boot, for example:
25130
25131 @lisp
25132 (file-append linux-libre "/bzImage")
25133 @end lisp
25134
25135 For GRUB, it is also possible to specify a device explicitly in the
25136 file path using GRUB's device naming convention (@pxref{Naming
25137 convention,,, grub, GNU GRUB manual}), for example:
25138
25139 @example
25140 "(hd0,msdos1)/boot/vmlinuz"
25141 @end example
25142
25143 If the device is specified explicitly as above, then the @code{device}
25144 field is ignored entirely.
25145
25146 @item @code{linux-arguments} (default: @code{()})
25147 The list of extra Linux kernel command-line arguments---e.g.,
25148 @code{("console=ttyS0")}.
25149
25150 @item @code{initrd}
25151 A G-Expression or string denoting the file name of the initial RAM disk
25152 to use (@pxref{G-Expressions}).
25153 @item @code{device} (default: @code{#f})
25154 The device where the kernel and initrd are to be found---i.e., for GRUB,
25155 @dfn{root} for this menu entry (@pxref{root,,, grub, GNU GRUB manual}).
25156
25157 This may be a file system label (a string), a file system UUID (a
25158 bytevector, @pxref{File Systems}), or @code{#f}, in which case
25159 the bootloader will search the device containing the file specified by
25160 the @code{linux} field (@pxref{search,,, grub, GNU GRUB manual}). It
25161 must @emph{not} be an OS device name such as @file{/dev/sda1}.
25162
25163 @end table
25164 @end deftp
25165
25166 @c FIXME: Write documentation once it's stable.
25167 For now only GRUB has theme support. GRUB themes are created using
25168 the @code{grub-theme} form, which is not documented yet.
25169
25170 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %default-theme
25171 This is the default GRUB theme used by the operating system if no
25172 @code{theme} field is specified in @code{bootloader-configuration}
25173 record.
25174
25175 It comes with a fancy background image displaying the GNU and Guix
25176 logos.
25177 @end defvr
25178
25179
25180 @node Invoking guix system
25181 @section Invoking @code{guix system}
25182
25183 Once you have written an operating system declaration as seen in the
25184 previous section, it can be @dfn{instantiated} using the @command{guix
25185 system} command. The synopsis is:
25186
25187 @example
25188 guix system @var{options}@dots{} @var{action} @var{file}
25189 @end example
25190
25191 @var{file} must be the name of a file containing an
25192 @code{operating-system} declaration. @var{action} specifies how the
25193 operating system is instantiated. Currently the following values are
25194 supported:
25195
25196 @table @code
25197 @item search
25198 Display available service type definitions that match the given regular
25199 expressions, sorted by relevance:
25200
25201 @example
25202 $ guix system search console font
25203 name: console-fonts
25204 location: gnu/services/base.scm:729:2
25205 extends: shepherd-root
25206 description: Install the given fonts on the specified ttys (fonts are
25207 + per virtual console on GNU/Linux). The value of this service is a list
25208 + of tty/font pairs like:
25209 +
25210 + '(("tty1" . "LatGrkCyr-8x16"))
25211 relevance: 20
25212
25213 name: mingetty
25214 location: gnu/services/base.scm:1048:2
25215 extends: shepherd-root
25216 description: Provide console login using the `mingetty' program.
25217 relevance: 2
25218
25219 name: login
25220 location: gnu/services/base.scm:775:2
25221 extends: pam
25222 description: Provide a console log-in service as specified by its
25223 + configuration value, a `login-configuration' object.
25224 relevance: 2
25225
25226 @dots{}
25227 @end example
25228
25229 As for @command{guix package --search}, the result is written in
25230 @code{recutils} format, which makes it easy to filter the output
25231 (@pxref{Top, GNU recutils databases,, recutils, GNU recutils manual}).
25232
25233 @item reconfigure
25234 Build the operating system described in @var{file}, activate it, and
25235 switch to it@footnote{This action (and the related actions
25236 @code{switch-generation} and @code{roll-back}) are usable only on
25237 systems already running Guix System.}.
25238
25239 This effects all the configuration specified in @var{file}: user
25240 accounts, system services, global package list, setuid programs, etc.
25241 The command starts system services specified in @var{file} that are not
25242 currently running; if a service is currently running this command will
25243 arrange for it to be upgraded the next time it is stopped (e.g.@: by
25244 @code{herd stop X} or @code{herd restart X}).
25245
25246 This command creates a new generation whose number is one greater than
25247 the current generation (as reported by @command{guix system
25248 list-generations}). If that generation already exists, it will be
25249 overwritten. This behavior mirrors that of @command{guix package}
25250 (@pxref{Invoking guix package}).
25251
25252 It also adds a bootloader menu entry for the new OS configuration,
25253 ---unless @option{--no-bootloader} is passed. For GRUB, it moves
25254 entries for older configurations to a submenu, allowing you to choose
25255 an older system generation at boot time should you need it.
25256
25257 @quotation Note
25258 @c The paragraph below refers to the problem discussed at
25259 @c <https://lists.gnu.org/archive/html/guix-devel/2014-08/msg00057.html>.
25260 It is highly recommended to run @command{guix pull} once before you run
25261 @command{guix system reconfigure} for the first time (@pxref{Invoking
25262 guix pull}). Failing to do that you would see an older version of Guix
25263 once @command{reconfigure} has completed.
25264 @end quotation
25265
25266 @item switch-generation
25267 @cindex generations
25268 Switch to an existing system generation. This action atomically
25269 switches the system profile to the specified system generation. It
25270 also rearranges the system's existing bootloader menu entries. It
25271 makes the menu entry for the specified system generation the default,
25272 and it moves the entries for the other generatiors to a submenu, if
25273 supported by the bootloader being used. The next time the system
25274 boots, it will use the specified system generation.
25275
25276 The bootloader itself is not being reinstalled when using this
25277 command. Thus, the installed bootloader is used with an updated
25278 configuration file.
25279
25280 The target generation can be specified explicitly by its generation
25281 number. For example, the following invocation would switch to system
25282 generation 7:
25283
25284 @example
25285 guix system switch-generation 7
25286 @end example
25287
25288 The target generation can also be specified relative to the current
25289 generation with the form @code{+N} or @code{-N}, where @code{+3} means
25290 ``3 generations ahead of the current generation,'' and @code{-1} means
25291 ``1 generation prior to the current generation.'' When specifying a
25292 negative value such as @code{-1}, you must precede it with @code{--} to
25293 prevent it from being parsed as an option. For example:
25294
25295 @example
25296 guix system switch-generation -- -1
25297 @end example
25298
25299 Currently, the effect of invoking this action is @emph{only} to switch
25300 the system profile to an existing generation and rearrange the
25301 bootloader menu entries. To actually start using the target system
25302 generation, you must reboot after running this action. In the future,
25303 it will be updated to do the same things as @command{reconfigure},
25304 like activating and deactivating services.
25305
25306 This action will fail if the specified generation does not exist.
25307
25308 @item roll-back
25309 @cindex rolling back
25310 Switch to the preceding system generation. The next time the system
25311 boots, it will use the preceding system generation. This is the inverse
25312 of @command{reconfigure}, and it is exactly the same as invoking
25313 @command{switch-generation} with an argument of @code{-1}.
25314
25315 Currently, as with @command{switch-generation}, you must reboot after
25316 running this action to actually start using the preceding system
25317 generation.
25318
25319 @item delete-generations
25320 @cindex deleting system generations
25321 @cindex saving space
25322 Delete system generations, making them candidates for garbage collection
25323 (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}, for information on how to run the ``garbage
25324 collector'').
25325
25326 This works in the same way as @command{guix package --delete-generations}
25327 (@pxref{Invoking guix package, @code{--delete-generations}}). With no
25328 arguments, all system generations but the current one are deleted:
25329
25330 @example
25331 guix system delete-generations
25332 @end example
25333
25334 You can also select the generations you want to delete. The example below
25335 deletes all the system generations that are more than two month old:
25336
25337 @example
25338 guix system delete-generations 2m
25339 @end example
25340
25341 Running this command automatically reinstalls the bootloader with an updated
25342 list of menu entries---e.g., the ``old generations'' sub-menu in GRUB no
25343 longer lists the generations that have been deleted.
25344
25345 @item build
25346 Build the derivation of the operating system, which includes all the
25347 configuration files and programs needed to boot and run the system.
25348 This action does not actually install anything.
25349
25350 @item init
25351 Populate the given directory with all the files necessary to run the
25352 operating system specified in @var{file}. This is useful for first-time
25353 installations of Guix System. For instance:
25354
25355 @example
25356 guix system init my-os-config.scm /mnt
25357 @end example
25358
25359 copies to @file{/mnt} all the store items required by the configuration
25360 specified in @file{my-os-config.scm}. This includes configuration
25361 files, packages, and so on. It also creates other essential files
25362 needed for the system to operate correctly---e.g., the @file{/etc},
25363 @file{/var}, and @file{/run} directories, and the @file{/bin/sh} file.
25364
25365 This command also installs bootloader on the target specified in
25366 @file{my-os-config}, unless the @option{--no-bootloader} option was
25367 passed.
25368
25369 @item vm
25370 @cindex virtual machine
25371 @cindex VM
25372 @anchor{guix system vm}
25373 Build a virtual machine that contains the operating system declared in
25374 @var{file}, and return a script to run that virtual machine (VM).
25375
25376 @quotation Note
25377 The @code{vm} action and others below
25378 can use KVM support in the Linux-libre kernel. Specifically, if the
25379 machine has hardware virtualization support, the corresponding
25380 KVM kernel module should be loaded, and the @file{/dev/kvm} device node
25381 must exist and be readable and writable by the user and by the
25382 build users of the daemon (@pxref{Build Environment Setup}).
25383 @end quotation
25384
25385 Arguments given to the script are passed to QEMU as in the example
25386 below, which enables networking and requests 1@tie{}GiB of RAM for the
25387 emulated machine:
25388
25389 @example
25390 $ /gnu/store/@dots{}-run-vm.sh -m 1024 -net user
25391 @end example
25392
25393 The VM shares its store with the host system.
25394
25395 Additional file systems can be shared between the host and the VM using
25396 the @code{--share} and @code{--expose} command-line options: the former
25397 specifies a directory to be shared with write access, while the latter
25398 provides read-only access to the shared directory.
25399
25400 The example below creates a VM in which the user's home directory is
25401 accessible read-only, and where the @file{/exchange} directory is a
25402 read-write mapping of @file{$HOME/tmp} on the host:
25403
25404 @example
25405 guix system vm my-config.scm \
25406 --expose=$HOME --share=$HOME/tmp=/exchange
25407 @end example
25408
25409 On GNU/Linux, the default is to boot directly to the kernel; this has
25410 the advantage of requiring only a very tiny root disk image since the
25411 store of the host can then be mounted.
25412
25413 The @code{--full-boot} option forces a complete boot sequence, starting
25414 with the bootloader. This requires more disk space since a root image
25415 containing at least the kernel, initrd, and bootloader data files must
25416 be created. The @code{--image-size} option can be used to specify the
25417 size of the image.
25418
25419 @cindex System images, creation in various formats
25420 @cindex Creating system images in various formats
25421 @item vm-image
25422 @itemx disk-image
25423 @itemx docker-image
25424 Return a virtual machine, disk image, or Docker image of the operating
25425 system declared in @var{file} that stands alone. By default,
25426 @command{guix system} estimates the size of the image needed to store
25427 the system, but you can use the @option{--image-size} option to specify
25428 a value. Docker images are built to contain exactly what they need, so
25429 the @option{--image-size} option is ignored in the case of
25430 @code{docker-image}.
25431
25432 You can specify the root file system type by using the
25433 @option{--file-system-type} option. It defaults to @code{ext4}.
25434
25435 When using @code{vm-image}, the returned image is in qcow2 format, which
25436 the QEMU emulator can efficiently use. @xref{Running Guix in a VM},
25437 for more information on how to run the image in a virtual machine.
25438
25439 When using @code{disk-image}, a raw disk image is produced; it can be
25440 copied as is to a USB stick, for instance. Assuming @code{/dev/sdc} is
25441 the device corresponding to a USB stick, one can copy the image to it
25442 using the following command:
25443
25444 @example
25445 # dd if=$(guix system disk-image my-os.scm) of=/dev/sdc
25446 @end example
25447
25448 When using @code{docker-image}, a Docker image is produced. Guix builds
25449 the image from scratch, not from a pre-existing Docker base image. As a
25450 result, it contains @emph{exactly} what you define in the operating
25451 system configuration file. You can then load the image and launch a
25452 Docker container using commands like the following:
25453
25454 @example
25455 image_id="`docker load < guix-system-docker-image.tar.gz`"
25456 container_id="`docker create $image_id`"
25457 docker start $container_id
25458 @end example
25459
25460 This command starts a new Docker container from the specified image. It
25461 will boot the Guix system in the usual manner, which means it will
25462 start any services you have defined in the operating system
25463 configuration. You can get an interactive shell running in the container
25464 using @command{docker exec}:
25465
25466 @example
25467 docker exec -ti $container_id /run/current-system/profile/bin/bash --login
25468 @end example
25469
25470 Depending on what you run in the Docker container, it
25471 may be necessary to give the container additional permissions. For
25472 example, if you intend to build software using Guix inside of the Docker
25473 container, you may need to pass the @option{--privileged} option to
25474 @code{docker create}.
25475
25476 @item container
25477 Return a script to run the operating system declared in @var{file}
25478 within a container. Containers are a set of lightweight isolation
25479 mechanisms provided by the kernel Linux-libre. Containers are
25480 substantially less resource-demanding than full virtual machines since
25481 the kernel, shared objects, and other resources can be shared with the
25482 host system; this also means they provide thinner isolation.
25483
25484 Currently, the script must be run as root in order to support more than
25485 a single user and group. The container shares its store with the host
25486 system.
25487
25488 As with the @code{vm} action (@pxref{guix system vm}), additional file
25489 systems to be shared between the host and container can be specified
25490 using the @option{--share} and @option{--expose} options:
25491
25492 @example
25493 guix system container my-config.scm \
25494 --expose=$HOME --share=$HOME/tmp=/exchange
25495 @end example
25496
25497 @quotation Note
25498 This option requires Linux-libre 3.19 or newer.
25499 @end quotation
25500
25501 @end table
25502
25503 @var{options} can contain any of the common build options (@pxref{Common
25504 Build Options}). In addition, @var{options} can contain one of the
25505 following:
25506
25507 @table @option
25508 @item --expression=@var{expr}
25509 @itemx -e @var{expr}
25510 Consider the operating-system @var{expr} evaluates to.
25511 This is an alternative to specifying a file which evaluates to an
25512 operating system.
25513 This is used to generate the Guix system installer @pxref{Building the
25514 Installation Image}).
25515
25516 @item --system=@var{system}
25517 @itemx -s @var{system}
25518 Attempt to build for @var{system} instead of the host system type.
25519 This works as per @command{guix build} (@pxref{Invoking guix build}).
25520
25521 @item --derivation
25522 @itemx -d
25523 Return the derivation file name of the given operating system without
25524 building anything.
25525
25526 @item --file-system-type=@var{type}
25527 @itemx -t @var{type}
25528 For the @code{disk-image} action, create a file system of the given
25529 @var{type} on the image.
25530
25531 When this option is omitted, @command{guix system} uses @code{ext4}.
25532
25533 @cindex ISO-9660 format
25534 @cindex CD image format
25535 @cindex DVD image format
25536 @code{--file-system-type=iso9660} produces an ISO-9660 image, suitable
25537 for burning on CDs and DVDs.
25538
25539 @item --image-size=@var{size}
25540 For the @code{vm-image} and @code{disk-image} actions, create an image
25541 of the given @var{size}. @var{size} may be a number of bytes, or it may
25542 include a unit as a suffix (@pxref{Block size, size specifications,,
25543 coreutils, GNU Coreutils}).
25544
25545 When this option is omitted, @command{guix system} computes an estimate
25546 of the image size as a function of the size of the system declared in
25547 @var{file}.
25548
25549 @item --network
25550 @itemx -N
25551 For the @code{container} action, allow containers to access the host network,
25552 that is, do not create a network namespace.
25553
25554 @item --root=@var{file}
25555 @itemx -r @var{file}
25556 Make @var{file} a symlink to the result, and register it as a garbage
25557 collector root.
25558
25559 @item --skip-checks
25560 Skip pre-installation safety checks.
25561
25562 By default, @command{guix system init} and @command{guix system
25563 reconfigure} perform safety checks: they make sure the file systems that
25564 appear in the @code{operating-system} declaration actually exist
25565 (@pxref{File Systems}), and that any Linux kernel modules that may be
25566 needed at boot time are listed in @code{initrd-modules} (@pxref{Initial
25567 RAM Disk}). Passing this option skips these tests altogether.
25568
25569 @cindex on-error
25570 @cindex on-error strategy
25571 @cindex error strategy
25572 @item --on-error=@var{strategy}
25573 Apply @var{strategy} when an error occurs when reading @var{file}.
25574 @var{strategy} may be one of the following:
25575
25576 @table @code
25577 @item nothing-special
25578 Report the error concisely and exit. This is the default strategy.
25579
25580 @item backtrace
25581 Likewise, but also display a backtrace.
25582
25583 @item debug
25584 Report the error and enter Guile's debugger. From there, you can run
25585 commands such as @code{,bt} to get a backtrace, @code{,locals} to
25586 display local variable values, and more generally inspect the state of the
25587 program. @xref{Debug Commands,,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual}, for
25588 a list of available debugging commands.
25589 @end table
25590 @end table
25591
25592 Once you have built, configured, re-configured, and re-re-configured
25593 your Guix installation, you may find it useful to list the operating
25594 system generations available on disk---and that you can choose from the
25595 bootloader boot menu:
25596
25597 @table @code
25598
25599 @item list-generations
25600 List a summary of each generation of the operating system available on
25601 disk, in a human-readable way. This is similar to the
25602 @option{--list-generations} option of @command{guix package}
25603 (@pxref{Invoking guix package}).
25604
25605 Optionally, one can specify a pattern, with the same syntax that is used
25606 in @command{guix package --list-generations}, to restrict the list of
25607 generations displayed. For instance, the following command displays
25608 generations that are up to 10 days old:
25609
25610 @example
25611 $ guix system list-generations 10d
25612 @end example
25613
25614 @end table
25615
25616 The @command{guix system} command has even more to offer! The following
25617 sub-commands allow you to visualize how your system services relate to
25618 each other:
25619
25620 @anchor{system-extension-graph}
25621 @table @code
25622
25623 @item extension-graph
25624 Emit in Dot/Graphviz format to standard output the @dfn{service
25625 extension graph} of the operating system defined in @var{file}
25626 (@pxref{Service Composition}, for more information on service
25627 extensions.)
25628
25629 The command:
25630
25631 @example
25632 $ guix system extension-graph @var{file} | dot -Tpdf > services.pdf
25633 @end example
25634
25635 produces a PDF file showing the extension relations among services.
25636
25637 @anchor{system-shepherd-graph}
25638 @item shepherd-graph
25639 Emit in Dot/Graphviz format to standard output the @dfn{dependency
25640 graph} of shepherd services of the operating system defined in
25641 @var{file}. @xref{Shepherd Services}, for more information and for an
25642 example graph.
25643
25644 @end table
25645
25646 @node Invoking guix deploy
25647 @section Invoking @code{guix deploy}
25648
25649 We've already seen @code{operating-system} declarations used to manage a
25650 machine's configuration locally. Suppose you need to configure multiple
25651 machines, though---perhaps you're managing a service on the web that's
25652 comprised of several servers. @command{guix deploy} enables you to use those
25653 same @code{operating-system} declarations to manage multiple remote hosts at
25654 once as a logical ``deployment''.
25655
25656 @quotation Note
25657 The functionality described in this section is still under development
25658 and is subject to change. Get in touch with us on
25659 @email{guix-devel@@gnu.org}!
25660 @end quotation
25661
25662 @example
25663 guix deploy @var{file}
25664 @end example
25665
25666 Such an invocation will deploy the machines that the code within @var{file}
25667 evaluates to. As an example, @var{file} might contain a definition like this:
25668
25669 @lisp
25670 ;; This is a Guix deployment of a "bare bones" setup, with
25671 ;; no X11 display server, to a machine with an SSH daemon
25672 ;; listening on localhost:2222. A configuration such as this
25673 ;; may be appropriate for virtual machine with ports
25674 ;; forwarded to the host's loopback interface.
25675
25676 (use-service-modules networking ssh)
25677 (use-package-modules bootloaders)
25678
25679 (define %system
25680 (operating-system
25681 (host-name "gnu-deployed")
25682 (timezone "Etc/UTC")
25683 (bootloader (bootloader-configuration
25684 (bootloader grub-bootloader)
25685 (target "/dev/vda")
25686 (terminal-outputs '(console))))
25687 (file-systems (cons (file-system
25688 (mount-point "/")
25689 (device "/dev/vda1")
25690 (type "ext4"))
25691 %base-file-systems))
25692 (services
25693 (append (list (service dhcp-client-service-type)
25694 (service openssh-service-type
25695 (openssh-configuration
25696 (permit-root-login #t)
25697 (allow-empty-passwords? #t))))
25698 %base-services))))
25699
25700 (list (machine
25701 (operating-system %system)
25702 (environment managed-host-environment-type)
25703 (configuration (machine-ssh-configuration
25704 (host-name "localhost")
25705 (system "x86_64-linux")
25706 (user "alice")
25707 (identity "./id_rsa")
25708 (port 2222)))))
25709 @end lisp
25710
25711 The file should evaluate to a list of @var{machine} objects. This example,
25712 upon being deployed, will create a new generation on the remote system
25713 realizing the @code{operating-system} declaration @var{%system}.
25714 @var{environment} and @var{configuration} specify how the machine should be
25715 provisioned---that is, how the computing resources should be created and
25716 managed. The above example does not create any resources, as a
25717 @code{'managed-host} is a machine that is already running the Guix system and
25718 available over the network. This is a particularly simple case; a more
25719 complex deployment may involve, for example, starting virtual machines through
25720 a Virtual Private Server (VPS) provider. In such a case, a different
25721 @var{environment} type would be used.
25722
25723 Do note that you first need to generate a key pair on the coordinator machine
25724 to allow the daemon to export signed archives of files from the store
25725 (@pxref{Invoking guix archive}).
25726
25727 @example
25728 # guix archive --generate-key
25729 @end example
25730
25731 @noindent
25732 Each target machine must authorize the key of the master machine so that it
25733 accepts store items it receives from the coordinator:
25734
25735 @example
25736 # guix archive --authorize < coordinator-public-key.txt
25737 @end example
25738
25739 @code{user}, in this example, specifies the name of the user account to log in
25740 as to perform the deployment. Its default value is @code{root}, but root
25741 login over SSH may be forbidden in some cases. To work around this,
25742 @command{guix deploy} can log in as an unprivileged user and employ
25743 @code{sudo} to escalate privileges. This will only work if @code{sudo} is
25744 currently installed on the remote and can be invoked non-interactively as
25745 @code{user}. That is: the line in @code{sudoers} granting @code{user} the
25746 ability to use @code{sudo} must contain the @code{NOPASSWD} tag.
25747
25748 @deftp {Data Type} machine
25749 This is the data type representing a single machine in a heterogeneous Guix
25750 deployment.
25751
25752 @table @asis
25753 @item @code{operating-system}
25754 The object of the operating system configuration to deploy.
25755
25756 @item @code{environment}
25757 An @code{environment-type} describing how the machine should be provisioned.
25758 At the moment, the only supported value is
25759 @code{managed-host-environment-type}.
25760
25761 @item @code{configuration} (default: @code{#f})
25762 An object describing the configuration for the machine's @code{environment}.
25763 If the @code{environment} has a default configuration, @code{#f} maybe used.
25764 If @code{#f} is used for an environment with no default configuration,
25765 however, an error will be thrown.
25766 @end table
25767 @end deftp
25768
25769 @deftp {Data Type} machine-ssh-configuration
25770 This is the data type representing the SSH client parameters for a machine
25771 with an @code{environment} of @code{managed-host-environment-type}.
25772
25773 @table @asis
25774 @item @code{host-name}
25775 @item @code{build-locally?} (default: @code{#t})
25776 If false, system derivations will be built on the machine being deployed to.
25777 @item @code{system}
25778 The Nix system type describing the architecture of the machine being deployed
25779 to. This should look something like ``x86_64-linux''.
25780 @item @code{authorize?} (default: @code{#t})
25781 If true, the coordinator's signing key will be added to the remote's ACL
25782 keyring.
25783 @item @code{port} (default: @code{22})
25784 @item @code{user} (default: @code{"root"})
25785 @item @code{identity} (default: @code{#f})
25786 If specified, the path to the SSH private key to use to authenticate with the
25787 remote host.
25788 @end table
25789 @end deftp
25790
25791 @node Running Guix in a VM
25792 @section Running Guix in a Virtual Machine
25793
25794 @cindex virtual machine
25795 To run Guix in a virtual machine (VM), one can use the pre-built Guix VM image
25796 distributed at
25797 @url{@value{BASE-URL}/guix-system-vm-image-@value{VERSION}.x86_64-linux.xz}.
25798 This image is a compressed image in QCOW format. You will first need to
25799 decompress with @command{xz -d}, and then you can pass it to an emulator such
25800 as QEMU (see below for details).
25801
25802 This image boots the Xfce graphical environment and it contains some
25803 commonly-used tools. You can install more software in the image by running
25804 @command{guix package} in a terminal (@pxref{Invoking guix package}). You can
25805 also reconfigure the system based on its initial configuration file available
25806 as @file{/etc/config.scm} (@pxref{Using the Configuration System}).
25807
25808 Instead of using this pre-built image, one can also build their own virtual
25809 machine image using @command{guix system vm-image} (@pxref{Invoking guix
25810 system}). The returned image is in qcow2 format, which the
25811 @uref{https://qemu.org/, QEMU emulator} can efficiently use.
25812
25813 @cindex QEMU
25814 If you built your own image, you must copy it out of the store
25815 (@pxref{The Store}) and give yourself permission to write to the copy
25816 before you can use it. When invoking QEMU, you must choose a system
25817 emulator that is suitable for your hardware platform. Here is a minimal
25818 QEMU invocation that will boot the result of @command{guix system
25819 vm-image} on x86_64 hardware:
25820
25821 @example
25822 $ qemu-system-x86_64 \
25823 -net user -net nic,model=virtio \
25824 -enable-kvm -m 1024 \
25825 -device virtio-blk,drive=myhd \
25826 -drive if=none,file=/tmp/qemu-image,id=myhd
25827 @end example
25828
25829 Here is what each of these options means:
25830
25831 @table @code
25832 @item qemu-system-x86_64
25833 This specifies the hardware platform to emulate. This should match the
25834 host.
25835
25836 @item -net user
25837 Enable the unprivileged user-mode network stack. The guest OS can
25838 access the host but not vice versa. This is the simplest way to get the
25839 guest OS online.
25840
25841 @item -net nic,model=virtio
25842 You must create a network interface of a given model. If you do not
25843 create a NIC, the boot will fail. Assuming your hardware platform is
25844 x86_64, you can get a list of available NIC models by running
25845 @command{qemu-system-x86_64 -net nic,model=help}.
25846
25847 @item -enable-kvm
25848 If your system has hardware virtualization extensions, enabling the
25849 virtual machine support (KVM) of the Linux kernel will make things run
25850 faster.
25851
25852 @c To run Xfce + 'guix pull', we need at least 1G of RAM.
25853 @item -m 1024
25854 RAM available to the guest OS, in mebibytes. Defaults to 128@tie{}MiB,
25855 which may be insufficient for some operations.
25856
25857 @item -device virtio-blk,drive=myhd
25858 Create a @code{virtio-blk} drive called ``myhd''. @code{virtio-blk} is a
25859 ``paravirtualization'' mechanism for block devices that allows QEMU to achieve
25860 better performance than if it were emulating a complete disk drive. See the
25861 QEMU and KVM documentation for more info.
25862
25863 @item -drive if=none,file=/tmp/qemu-image,id=myhd
25864 Use our QCOW image, the @file{/tmp/qemu-image} file, as the backing store the
25865 the ``myhd'' drive.
25866 @end table
25867
25868 The default @command{run-vm.sh} script that is returned by an invocation of
25869 @command{guix system vm} does not add a @command{-net user} flag by default.
25870 To get network access from within the vm add the @code{(dhcp-client-service)}
25871 to your system definition and start the VM using
25872 @command{`guix system vm config.scm` -net user}. An important caveat of using
25873 @command{-net user} for networking is that @command{ping} will not work, because
25874 it uses the ICMP protocol. You'll have to use a different command to check for
25875 network connectivity, for example @command{guix download}.
25876
25877 @subsection Connecting Through SSH
25878
25879 @cindex SSH
25880 @cindex SSH server
25881 To enable SSH inside a VM you need to add an SSH server like
25882 @code{openssh-service-type} to your VM (@pxref{Networking Services,
25883 @code{openssh-service-type}}). In addition you need to forward the SSH port,
25884 22 by default, to the host. You can do this with
25885
25886 @example
25887 `guix system vm config.scm` -net user,hostfwd=tcp::10022-:22
25888 @end example
25889
25890 To connect to the VM you can run
25891
25892 @example
25893 ssh -o UserKnownHostsFile=/dev/null -o StrictHostKeyChecking=no -p 10022
25894 @end example
25895
25896 The @command{-p} tells @command{ssh} the port you want to connect to.
25897 @command{-o UserKnownHostsFile=/dev/null} prevents @command{ssh} from complaining
25898 every time you modify your @command{config.scm} file and the
25899 @command{-o StrictHostKeyChecking=no} prevents you from having to allow a
25900 connection to an unknown host every time you connect.
25901
25902 @subsection Using @command{virt-viewer} with Spice
25903
25904 As an alternative to the default @command{qemu} graphical client you can
25905 use the @command{remote-viewer} from the @command{virt-viewer} package. To
25906 connect pass the @command{-spice port=5930,disable-ticketing} flag to
25907 @command{qemu}. See previous section for further information on how to do this.
25908
25909 Spice also allows you to do some nice stuff like share your clipboard with your
25910 VM. To enable that you'll also have to pass the following flags to @command{qemu}:
25911
25912 @example
25913 -device virtio-serial-pci,id=virtio-serial0,max_ports=16,bus=pci.0,addr=0x5
25914 -chardev spicevmc,name=vdagent,id=vdagent
25915 -device virtserialport,nr=1,bus=virtio-serial0.0,chardev=vdagent,
25916 name=com.redhat.spice.0
25917 @end example
25918
25919 You'll also need to add the @pxref{Miscellaneous Services, Spice service}.
25920
25921 @node Defining Services
25922 @section Defining Services
25923
25924 The previous sections show the available services and how one can combine
25925 them in an @code{operating-system} declaration. But how do we define
25926 them in the first place? And what is a service anyway?
25927
25928 @menu
25929 * Service Composition:: The model for composing services.
25930 * Service Types and Services:: Types and services.
25931 * Service Reference:: API reference.
25932 * Shepherd Services:: A particular type of service.
25933 @end menu
25934
25935 @node Service Composition
25936 @subsection Service Composition
25937
25938 @cindex services
25939 @cindex daemons
25940 Here we define a @dfn{service} as, broadly, something that extends the
25941 functionality of the operating system. Often a service is a process---a
25942 @dfn{daemon}---started when the system boots: a secure shell server, a
25943 Web server, the Guix build daemon, etc. Sometimes a service is a daemon
25944 whose execution can be triggered by another daemon---e.g., an FTP server
25945 started by @command{inetd} or a D-Bus service activated by
25946 @command{dbus-daemon}. Occasionally, a service does not map to a
25947 daemon. For instance, the ``account'' service collects user accounts
25948 and makes sure they exist when the system runs; the ``udev'' service
25949 collects device management rules and makes them available to the eudev
25950 daemon; the @file{/etc} service populates the @file{/etc} directory
25951 of the system.
25952
25953 @cindex service extensions
25954 Guix system services are connected by @dfn{extensions}. For instance, the
25955 secure shell service @emph{extends} the Shepherd---the
25956 initialization system, running as PID@tie{}1---by giving it the command
25957 lines to start and stop the secure shell daemon (@pxref{Networking
25958 Services, @code{openssh-service-type}}); the UPower service extends the D-Bus
25959 service by passing it its @file{.service} specification, and extends the
25960 udev service by passing it device management rules (@pxref{Desktop
25961 Services, @code{upower-service}}); the Guix daemon service extends the
25962 Shepherd by passing it the command lines to start and stop the daemon,
25963 and extends the account service by passing it a list of required build
25964 user accounts (@pxref{Base Services}).
25965
25966 All in all, services and their ``extends'' relations form a directed
25967 acyclic graph (DAG). If we represent services as boxes and extensions
25968 as arrows, a typical system might provide something like this:
25969
25970 @image{images/service-graph,,5in,Typical service extension graph.}
25971
25972 @cindex system service
25973 At the bottom, we see the @dfn{system service}, which produces the
25974 directory containing everything to run and boot the system, as returned
25975 by the @command{guix system build} command. @xref{Service Reference},
25976 to learn about the other service types shown here.
25977 @xref{system-extension-graph, the @command{guix system extension-graph}
25978 command}, for information on how to generate this representation for a
25979 particular operating system definition.
25980
25981 @cindex service types
25982 Technically, developers can define @dfn{service types} to express these
25983 relations. There can be any number of services of a given type on the
25984 system---for instance, a system running two instances of the GNU secure
25985 shell server (lsh) has two instances of @code{lsh-service-type}, with
25986 different parameters.
25987
25988 The following section describes the programming interface for service
25989 types and services.
25990
25991 @node Service Types and Services
25992 @subsection Service Types and Services
25993
25994 A @dfn{service type} is a node in the DAG described above. Let us start
25995 with a simple example, the service type for the Guix build daemon
25996 (@pxref{Invoking guix-daemon}):
25997
25998 @lisp
25999 (define guix-service-type
26000 (service-type
26001 (name 'guix)
26002 (extensions
26003 (list (service-extension shepherd-root-service-type guix-shepherd-service)
26004 (service-extension account-service-type guix-accounts)
26005 (service-extension activation-service-type guix-activation)))
26006 (default-value (guix-configuration))))
26007 @end lisp
26008
26009 @noindent
26010 It defines three things:
26011
26012 @enumerate
26013 @item
26014 A name, whose sole purpose is to make inspection and debugging easier.
26015
26016 @item
26017 A list of @dfn{service extensions}, where each extension designates the
26018 target service type and a procedure that, given the parameters of the
26019 service, returns a list of objects to extend the service of that type.
26020
26021 Every service type has at least one service extension. The only
26022 exception is the @dfn{boot service type}, which is the ultimate service.
26023
26024 @item
26025 Optionally, a default value for instances of this type.
26026 @end enumerate
26027
26028 In this example, @code{guix-service-type} extends three services:
26029
26030 @table @code
26031 @item shepherd-root-service-type
26032 The @code{guix-shepherd-service} procedure defines how the Shepherd
26033 service is extended. Namely, it returns a @code{<shepherd-service>}
26034 object that defines how @command{guix-daemon} is started and stopped
26035 (@pxref{Shepherd Services}).
26036
26037 @item account-service-type
26038 This extension for this service is computed by @code{guix-accounts},
26039 which returns a list of @code{user-group} and @code{user-account}
26040 objects representing the build user accounts (@pxref{Invoking
26041 guix-daemon}).
26042
26043 @item activation-service-type
26044 Here @code{guix-activation} is a procedure that returns a gexp, which is
26045 a code snippet to run at ``activation time''---e.g., when the service is
26046 booted.
26047 @end table
26048
26049 A service of this type is instantiated like this:
26050
26051 @lisp
26052 (service guix-service-type
26053 (guix-configuration
26054 (build-accounts 5)
26055 (use-substitutes? #f)))
26056 @end lisp
26057
26058 The second argument to the @code{service} form is a value representing
26059 the parameters of this specific service instance.
26060 @xref{guix-configuration-type, @code{guix-configuration}}, for
26061 information about the @code{guix-configuration} data type. When the
26062 value is omitted, the default value specified by
26063 @code{guix-service-type} is used:
26064
26065 @lisp
26066 (service guix-service-type)
26067 @end lisp
26068
26069 @code{guix-service-type} is quite simple because it extends other
26070 services but is not extensible itself.
26071
26072 @c @subsubsubsection Extensible Service Types
26073
26074 The service type for an @emph{extensible} service looks like this:
26075
26076 @lisp
26077 (define udev-service-type
26078 (service-type (name 'udev)
26079 (extensions
26080 (list (service-extension shepherd-root-service-type
26081 udev-shepherd-service)))
26082
26083 (compose concatenate) ;concatenate the list of rules
26084 (extend (lambda (config rules)
26085 (match config
26086 (($ <udev-configuration> udev initial-rules)
26087 (udev-configuration
26088 (udev udev) ;the udev package to use
26089 (rules (append initial-rules rules)))))))))
26090 @end lisp
26091
26092 This is the service type for the
26093 @uref{https://wiki.gentoo.org/wiki/Project:Eudev, eudev device
26094 management daemon}. Compared to the previous example, in addition to an
26095 extension of @code{shepherd-root-service-type}, we see two new fields:
26096
26097 @table @code
26098 @item compose
26099 This is the procedure to @dfn{compose} the list of extensions to
26100 services of this type.
26101
26102 Services can extend the udev service by passing it lists of rules; we
26103 compose those extensions simply by concatenating them.
26104
26105 @item extend
26106 This procedure defines how the value of the service is @dfn{extended} with
26107 the composition of the extensions.
26108
26109 Udev extensions are composed into a list of rules, but the udev service
26110 value is itself a @code{<udev-configuration>} record. So here, we
26111 extend that record by appending the list of rules it contains to the
26112 list of contributed rules.
26113
26114 @item description
26115 This is a string giving an overview of the service type. The string can
26116 contain Texinfo markup (@pxref{Overview,,, texinfo, GNU Texinfo}). The
26117 @command{guix system search} command searches these strings and displays
26118 them (@pxref{Invoking guix system}).
26119 @end table
26120
26121 There can be only one instance of an extensible service type such as
26122 @code{udev-service-type}. If there were more, the
26123 @code{service-extension} specifications would be ambiguous.
26124
26125 Still here? The next section provides a reference of the programming
26126 interface for services.
26127
26128 @node Service Reference
26129 @subsection Service Reference
26130
26131 We have seen an overview of service types (@pxref{Service Types and
26132 Services}). This section provides a reference on how to manipulate
26133 services and service types. This interface is provided by the
26134 @code{(gnu services)} module.
26135
26136 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} service @var{type} [@var{value}]
26137 Return a new service of @var{type}, a @code{<service-type>} object (see
26138 below.) @var{value} can be any object; it represents the parameters of
26139 this particular service instance.
26140
26141 When @var{value} is omitted, the default value specified by @var{type}
26142 is used; if @var{type} does not specify a default value, an error is
26143 raised.
26144
26145 For instance, this:
26146
26147 @lisp
26148 (service openssh-service-type)
26149 @end lisp
26150
26151 @noindent
26152 is equivalent to this:
26153
26154 @lisp
26155 (service openssh-service-type
26156 (openssh-configuration))
26157 @end lisp
26158
26159 In both cases the result is an instance of @code{openssh-service-type}
26160 with the default configuration.
26161 @end deffn
26162
26163 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} service? @var{obj}
26164 Return true if @var{obj} is a service.
26165 @end deffn
26166
26167 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} service-kind @var{service}
26168 Return the type of @var{service}---i.e., a @code{<service-type>} object.
26169 @end deffn
26170
26171 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} service-value @var{service}
26172 Return the value associated with @var{service}. It represents its
26173 parameters.
26174 @end deffn
26175
26176 Here is an example of how a service is created and manipulated:
26177
26178 @lisp
26179 (define s
26180 (service nginx-service-type
26181 (nginx-configuration
26182 (nginx nginx)
26183 (log-directory log-directory)
26184 (run-directory run-directory)
26185 (file config-file))))
26186
26187 (service? s)
26188 @result{} #t
26189
26190 (eq? (service-kind s) nginx-service-type)
26191 @result{} #t
26192 @end lisp
26193
26194 The @code{modify-services} form provides a handy way to change the
26195 parameters of some of the services of a list such as
26196 @code{%base-services} (@pxref{Base Services, @code{%base-services}}). It
26197 evaluates to a list of services. Of course, you could always use
26198 standard list combinators such as @code{map} and @code{fold} to do that
26199 (@pxref{SRFI-1, List Library,, guile, GNU Guile Reference Manual});
26200 @code{modify-services} simply provides a more concise form for this
26201 common pattern.
26202
26203 @deffn {Scheme Syntax} modify-services @var{services} @
26204 (@var{type} @var{variable} => @var{body}) @dots{}
26205
26206 Modify the services listed in @var{services} according to the given
26207 clauses. Each clause has the form:
26208
26209 @example
26210 (@var{type} @var{variable} => @var{body})
26211 @end example
26212
26213 where @var{type} is a service type---e.g.,
26214 @code{guix-service-type}---and @var{variable} is an identifier that is
26215 bound within the @var{body} to the service parameters---e.g., a
26216 @code{guix-configuration} instance---of the original service of that
26217 @var{type}.
26218
26219 The @var{body} should evaluate to the new service parameters, which will
26220 be used to configure the new service. This new service will replace the
26221 original in the resulting list. Because a service's service parameters
26222 are created using @code{define-record-type*}, you can write a succinct
26223 @var{body} that evaluates to the new service parameters by using the
26224 @code{inherit} feature that @code{define-record-type*} provides.
26225
26226 @xref{Using the Configuration System}, for example usage.
26227
26228 @end deffn
26229
26230 Next comes the programming interface for service types. This is
26231 something you want to know when writing new service definitions, but not
26232 necessarily when simply looking for ways to customize your
26233 @code{operating-system} declaration.
26234
26235 @deftp {Data Type} service-type
26236 @cindex service type
26237 This is the representation of a @dfn{service type} (@pxref{Service Types
26238 and Services}).
26239
26240 @table @asis
26241 @item @code{name}
26242 This is a symbol, used only to simplify inspection and debugging.
26243
26244 @item @code{extensions}
26245 A non-empty list of @code{<service-extension>} objects (see below).
26246
26247 @item @code{compose} (default: @code{#f})
26248 If this is @code{#f}, then the service type denotes services that cannot
26249 be extended---i.e., services that do not receive ``values'' from other
26250 services.
26251
26252 Otherwise, it must be a one-argument procedure. The procedure is called
26253 by @code{fold-services} and is passed a list of values collected from
26254 extensions. It may return any single value.
26255
26256 @item @code{extend} (default: @code{#f})
26257 If this is @code{#f}, services of this type cannot be extended.
26258
26259 Otherwise, it must be a two-argument procedure: @code{fold-services}
26260 calls it, passing it the initial value of the service as the first
26261 argument and the result of applying @code{compose} to the extension
26262 values as the second argument. It must return a value that is a valid
26263 parameter value for the service instance.
26264 @end table
26265
26266 @xref{Service Types and Services}, for examples.
26267 @end deftp
26268
26269 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} service-extension @var{target-type} @
26270 @var{compute}
26271 Return a new extension for services of type @var{target-type}.
26272 @var{compute} must be a one-argument procedure: @code{fold-services}
26273 calls it, passing it the value associated with the service that provides
26274 the extension; it must return a valid value for the target service.
26275 @end deffn
26276
26277 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} service-extension? @var{obj}
26278 Return true if @var{obj} is a service extension.
26279 @end deffn
26280
26281 Occasionally, you might want to simply extend an existing service. This
26282 involves creating a new service type and specifying the extension of
26283 interest, which can be verbose; the @code{simple-service} procedure
26284 provides a shorthand for this.
26285
26286 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} simple-service @var{name} @var{target} @var{value}
26287 Return a service that extends @var{target} with @var{value}. This works
26288 by creating a singleton service type @var{name}, of which the returned
26289 service is an instance.
26290
26291 For example, this extends mcron (@pxref{Scheduled Job Execution}) with
26292 an additional job:
26293
26294 @lisp
26295 (simple-service 'my-mcron-job mcron-service-type
26296 #~(job '(next-hour (3)) "guix gc -F 2G"))
26297 @end lisp
26298 @end deffn
26299
26300 At the core of the service abstraction lies the @code{fold-services}
26301 procedure, which is responsible for ``compiling'' a list of services
26302 down to a single directory that contains everything needed to boot and
26303 run the system---the directory shown by the @command{guix system build}
26304 command (@pxref{Invoking guix system}). In essence, it propagates
26305 service extensions down the service graph, updating each node parameters
26306 on the way, until it reaches the root node.
26307
26308 @deffn {Scheme Procedure} fold-services @var{services} @
26309 [#:target-type @var{system-service-type}]
26310 Fold @var{services} by propagating their extensions down to the root of
26311 type @var{target-type}; return the root service adjusted accordingly.
26312 @end deffn
26313
26314 Lastly, the @code{(gnu services)} module also defines several essential
26315 service types, some of which are listed below.
26316
26317 @defvr {Scheme Variable} system-service-type
26318 This is the root of the service graph. It produces the system directory
26319 as returned by the @command{guix system build} command.
26320 @end defvr
26321
26322 @defvr {Scheme Variable} boot-service-type
26323 The type of the ``boot service'', which produces the @dfn{boot script}.
26324 The boot script is what the initial RAM disk runs when booting.
26325 @end defvr
26326
26327 @defvr {Scheme Variable} etc-service-type
26328 The type of the @file{/etc} service. This service is used to create
26329 files under @file{/etc} and can be extended by
26330 passing it name/file tuples such as:
26331
26332 @lisp
26333 (list `("issue" ,(plain-file "issue" "Welcome!\n")))
26334 @end lisp
26335
26336 In this example, the effect would be to add an @file{/etc/issue} file
26337 pointing to the given file.
26338 @end defvr
26339
26340 @defvr {Scheme Variable} setuid-program-service-type
26341 Type for the ``setuid-program service''. This service collects lists of
26342 executable file names, passed as gexps, and adds them to the set of
26343 setuid-root programs on the system (@pxref{Setuid Programs}).
26344 @end defvr
26345
26346 @defvr {Scheme Variable} profile-service-type
26347 Type of the service that populates the @dfn{system profile}---i.e., the
26348 programs under @file{/run/current-system/profile}. Other services can
26349 extend it by passing it lists of packages to add to the system profile.
26350 @end defvr
26351
26352
26353 @node Shepherd Services
26354 @subsection Shepherd Services
26355
26356 @cindex shepherd services
26357 @cindex PID 1
26358 @cindex init system
26359 The @code{(gnu services shepherd)} module provides a way to define
26360 services managed by the GNU@tie{}Shepherd, which is the
26361 initialization system---the first process that is started when the
26362 system boots, also known as PID@tie{}1
26363 (@pxref{Introduction,,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}).
26364
26365 Services in the Shepherd can depend on each other. For instance, the
26366 SSH daemon may need to be started after the syslog daemon has been
26367 started, which in turn can only happen once all the file systems have
26368 been mounted. The simple operating system defined earlier (@pxref{Using
26369 the Configuration System}) results in a service graph like this:
26370
26371 @image{images/shepherd-graph,,5in,Typical shepherd service graph.}
26372
26373 You can actually generate such a graph for any operating system
26374 definition using the @command{guix system shepherd-graph} command
26375 (@pxref{system-shepherd-graph, @command{guix system shepherd-graph}}).
26376
26377 The @code{%shepherd-root-service} is a service object representing
26378 PID@tie{}1, of type @code{shepherd-root-service-type}; it can be extended
26379 by passing it lists of @code{<shepherd-service>} objects.
26380
26381 @deftp {Data Type} shepherd-service
26382 The data type representing a service managed by the Shepherd.
26383
26384 @table @asis
26385 @item @code{provision}
26386 This is a list of symbols denoting what the service provides.
26387
26388 These are the names that may be passed to @command{herd start},
26389 @command{herd status}, and similar commands (@pxref{Invoking herd,,,
26390 shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}). @xref{Slots of services, the
26391 @code{provides} slot,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}, for details.
26392
26393 @item @code{requirement} (default: @code{'()})
26394 List of symbols denoting the Shepherd services this one depends on.
26395
26396 @cindex one-shot services, for the Shepherd
26397 @item @code{one-shot?} (default: @code{#f})
26398 Whether this service is @dfn{one-shot}. One-shot services stop immediately
26399 after their @code{start} action has completed. @xref{Slots of services,,,
26400 shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}, for more info.
26401
26402 @item @code{respawn?} (default: @code{#t})
26403 Whether to restart the service when it stops, for instance when the
26404 underlying process dies.
26405
26406 @item @code{start}
26407 @itemx @code{stop} (default: @code{#~(const #f)})
26408 The @code{start} and @code{stop} fields refer to the Shepherd's
26409 facilities to start and stop processes (@pxref{Service De- and
26410 Constructors,,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}). They are given as
26411 G-expressions that get expanded in the Shepherd configuration file
26412 (@pxref{G-Expressions}).
26413
26414 @item @code{actions} (default: @code{'()})
26415 @cindex actions, of Shepherd services
26416 This is a list of @code{shepherd-action} objects (see below) defining
26417 @dfn{actions} supported by the service, in addition to the standard
26418 @code{start} and @code{stop} actions. Actions listed here become available as
26419 @command{herd} sub-commands:
26420
26421 @example
26422 herd @var{action} @var{service} [@var{arguments}@dots{}]
26423 @end example
26424
26425 @item @code{auto-start?} (default: @code{#t})
26426 Whether this service should be started automatically by the Shepherd. If it
26427 is @code{#f} the service has to be started manually with @code{herd start}.
26428
26429 @item @code{documentation}
26430 A documentation string, as shown when running:
26431
26432 @example
26433 herd doc @var{service-name}
26434 @end example
26435
26436 where @var{service-name} is one of the symbols in @code{provision}
26437 (@pxref{Invoking herd,,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}).
26438
26439 @item @code{modules} (default: @code{%default-modules})
26440 This is the list of modules that must be in scope when @code{start} and
26441 @code{stop} are evaluated.
26442
26443 @end table
26444 @end deftp
26445
26446 @deftp {Data Type} shepherd-action
26447 This is the data type that defines additional actions implemented by a
26448 Shepherd service (see above).
26449
26450 @table @code
26451 @item name
26452 Symbol naming the action.
26453
26454 @item documentation
26455 This is a documentation string for the action. It can be viewed by running:
26456
26457 @example
26458 herd doc @var{service} action @var{action}
26459 @end example
26460
26461 @item procedure
26462 This should be a gexp that evaluates to a procedure of at least one argument,
26463 which is the ``running value'' of the service (@pxref{Slots of services,,,
26464 shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}).
26465 @end table
26466
26467 The following example defines an action called @code{say-hello} that kindly
26468 greets the user:
26469
26470 @lisp
26471 (shepherd-action
26472 (name 'say-hello)
26473 (documentation "Say hi!")
26474 (procedure #~(lambda (running . args)
26475 (format #t "Hello, friend! arguments: ~s\n"
26476 args)
26477 #t)))
26478 @end lisp
26479
26480 Assuming this action is added to the @code{example} service, then you can do:
26481
26482 @example
26483 # herd say-hello example
26484 Hello, friend! arguments: ()
26485 # herd say-hello example a b c
26486 Hello, friend! arguments: ("a" "b" "c")
26487 @end example
26488
26489 This, as you can see, is a fairly sophisticated way to say hello.
26490 @xref{Service Convenience,,, shepherd, The GNU Shepherd Manual}, for more
26491 info on actions.
26492 @end deftp
26493
26494 @defvr {Scheme Variable} shepherd-root-service-type
26495 The service type for the Shepherd ``root service''---i.e., PID@tie{}1.
26496
26497 This is the service type that extensions target when they want to create
26498 shepherd services (@pxref{Service Types and Services}, for an example).
26499 Each extension must pass a list of @code{<shepherd-service>}.
26500 @end defvr
26501
26502 @defvr {Scheme Variable} %shepherd-root-service
26503 This service represents PID@tie{}1.
26504 @end defvr
26505
26506
26507 @node Documentation
26508 @chapter Documentation
26509
26510 @cindex documentation, searching for
26511 @cindex searching for documentation
26512 @cindex Info, documentation format
26513 @cindex man pages
26514 @cindex manual pages
26515 In most cases packages installed with Guix come with documentation.
26516 There are two main documentation formats: ``Info'', a browseable
26517 hypertext format used for GNU software, and ``manual pages'' (or ``man
26518 pages''), the linear documentation format traditionally found on Unix.
26519 Info manuals are accessed with the @command{info} command or with Emacs,
26520 and man pages are accessed using @command{man}.
26521
26522 You can look for documentation of software installed on your system by
26523 keyword. For example, the following command searches for information
26524 about ``TLS'' in Info manuals:
26525
26526 @example
26527 $ info -k TLS
26528 "(emacs)Network Security" -- STARTTLS
26529 "(emacs)Network Security" -- TLS
26530 "(gnutls)Core TLS API" -- gnutls_certificate_set_verify_flags
26531 "(gnutls)Core TLS API" -- gnutls_certificate_set_verify_function
26532 @dots{}
26533 @end example
26534
26535 @noindent
26536 The command below searches for the same keyword in man pages:
26537
26538 @example
26539 $ man -k TLS
26540 SSL (7) - OpenSSL SSL/TLS library
26541 certtool (1) - GnuTLS certificate tool
26542 @dots {}
26543 @end example
26544
26545 These searches are purely local to your computer so you have the
26546 guarantee that documentation you find corresponds to what you have
26547 actually installed, you can access it off-line, and your privacy is
26548 respected.
26549
26550 Once you have these results, you can view the relevant documentation by
26551 running, say:
26552
26553 @example
26554 $ info "(gnutls)Core TLS API"
26555 @end example
26556
26557 @noindent
26558 or:
26559
26560 @example
26561 $ man certtool
26562 @end example
26563
26564 Info manuals contain sections and indices as well as hyperlinks like
26565 those found in Web pages. The @command{info} reader (@pxref{Top, Info
26566 reader,, info-stnd, Stand-alone GNU Info}) and its Emacs counterpart
26567 (@pxref{Misc Help,,, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}) provide intuitive key
26568 bindings to navigate manuals. @xref{Getting Started,,, info, Info: An
26569 Introduction}, for an introduction to Info navigation.
26570
26571 @node Installing Debugging Files
26572 @chapter Installing Debugging Files
26573
26574 @cindex debugging files
26575 Program binaries, as produced by the GCC compilers for instance, are
26576 typically written in the ELF format, with a section containing
26577 @dfn{debugging information}. Debugging information is what allows the
26578 debugger, GDB, to map binary code to source code; it is required to
26579 debug a compiled program in good conditions.
26580
26581 The problem with debugging information is that is takes up a fair amount
26582 of disk space. For example, debugging information for the GNU C Library
26583 weighs in at more than 60 MiB. Thus, as a user, keeping all the
26584 debugging info of all the installed programs is usually not an option.
26585 Yet, space savings should not come at the cost of an impediment to
26586 debugging---especially in the GNU system, which should make it easier
26587 for users to exert their computing freedom (@pxref{GNU Distribution}).
26588
26589 Thankfully, the GNU Binary Utilities (Binutils) and GDB provide a
26590 mechanism that allows users to get the best of both worlds: debugging
26591 information can be stripped from the binaries and stored in separate
26592 files. GDB is then able to load debugging information from those files,
26593 when they are available (@pxref{Separate Debug Files,,, gdb, Debugging
26594 with GDB}).
26595
26596 The GNU distribution takes advantage of this by storing debugging
26597 information in the @code{lib/debug} sub-directory of a separate package
26598 output unimaginatively called @code{debug} (@pxref{Packages with
26599 Multiple Outputs}). Users can choose to install the @code{debug} output
26600 of a package when they need it. For instance, the following command
26601 installs the debugging information for the GNU C Library and for GNU
26602 Guile:
26603
26604 @example
26605 guix install glibc:debug guile:debug
26606 @end example
26607
26608 GDB must then be told to look for debug files in the user's profile, by
26609 setting the @code{debug-file-directory} variable (consider setting it
26610 from the @file{~/.gdbinit} file, @pxref{Startup,,, gdb, Debugging with
26611 GDB}):
26612
26613 @example
26614 (gdb) set debug-file-directory ~/.guix-profile/lib/debug
26615 @end example
26616
26617 From there on, GDB will pick up debugging information from the
26618 @code{.debug} files under @file{~/.guix-profile/lib/debug}.
26619
26620 In addition, you will most likely want GDB to be able to show the source
26621 code being debugged. To do that, you will have to unpack the source
26622 code of the package of interest (obtained with @code{guix build
26623 --source}, @pxref{Invoking guix build}), and to point GDB to that source
26624 directory using the @code{directory} command (@pxref{Source Path,
26625 @code{directory},, gdb, Debugging with GDB}).
26626
26627 @c XXX: keep me up-to-date
26628 The @code{debug} output mechanism in Guix is implemented by the
26629 @code{gnu-build-system} (@pxref{Build Systems}). Currently, it is
26630 opt-in---debugging information is available only for the packages
26631 with definitions explicitly declaring a @code{debug} output. This may be
26632 changed to opt-out in the future if our build farm servers can handle
26633 the load. To check whether a package has a @code{debug} output, use
26634 @command{guix package --list-available} (@pxref{Invoking guix package}).
26635
26636
26637 @node Security Updates
26638 @chapter Security Updates
26639
26640 @cindex security updates
26641 @cindex security vulnerabilities
26642 Occasionally, important security vulnerabilities are discovered in software
26643 packages and must be patched. Guix developers try hard to keep track of
26644 known vulnerabilities and to apply fixes as soon as possible in the
26645 @code{master} branch of Guix (we do not yet provide a ``stable'' branch
26646 containing only security updates.) The @command{guix lint} tool helps
26647 developers find out about vulnerable versions of software packages in the
26648 distribution:
26649
26650 @smallexample
26651 $ guix lint -c cve
26652 gnu/packages/base.scm:652:2: glibc@@2.21: probably vulnerable to CVE-2015-1781, CVE-2015-7547
26653 gnu/packages/gcc.scm:334:2: gcc@@4.9.3: probably vulnerable to CVE-2015-5276
26654 gnu/packages/image.scm:312:2: openjpeg@@2.1.0: probably vulnerable to CVE-2016-1923, CVE-2016-1924
26655 @dots{}
26656 @end smallexample
26657
26658 @xref{Invoking guix lint}, for more information.
26659
26660 Guix follows a functional
26661 package management discipline (@pxref{Introduction}), which implies
26662 that, when a package is changed, @emph{every package that depends on it}
26663 must be rebuilt. This can significantly slow down the deployment of
26664 fixes in core packages such as libc or Bash, since basically the whole
26665 distribution would need to be rebuilt. Using pre-built binaries helps
26666 (@pxref{Substitutes}), but deployment may still take more time than
26667 desired.
26668
26669 @cindex grafts
26670 To address this, Guix implements @dfn{grafts}, a mechanism that allows
26671 for fast deployment of critical updates without the costs associated
26672 with a whole-distribution rebuild. The idea is to rebuild only the
26673 package that needs to be patched, and then to ``graft'' it onto packages
26674 explicitly installed by the user and that were previously referring to
26675 the original package. The cost of grafting is typically very low, and
26676 order of magnitudes lower than a full rebuild of the dependency chain.
26677
26678 @cindex replacements of packages, for grafts
26679 For instance, suppose a security update needs to be applied to Bash.
26680 Guix developers will provide a package definition for the ``fixed''
26681 Bash, say @code{bash-fixed}, in the usual way (@pxref{Defining
26682 Packages}). Then, the original package definition is augmented with a
26683 @code{replacement} field pointing to the package containing the bug fix:
26684
26685 @lisp
26686 (define bash
26687 (package
26688 (name "bash")
26689 ;; @dots{}
26690 (replacement bash-fixed)))
26691 @end lisp
26692
26693 From there on, any package depending directly or indirectly on Bash---as
26694 reported by @command{guix gc --requisites} (@pxref{Invoking guix
26695 gc})---that is installed is automatically ``rewritten'' to refer to
26696 @code{bash-fixed} instead of @code{bash}. This grafting process takes
26697 time proportional to the size of the package, usually less than a
26698 minute for an ``average'' package on a recent machine. Grafting is
26699 recursive: when an indirect dependency requires grafting, then grafting
26700 ``propagates'' up to the package that the user is installing.
26701
26702 Currently, the length of the name and version of the graft and that of
26703 the package it replaces (@code{bash-fixed} and @code{bash} in the example
26704 above) must be equal. This restriction mostly comes from the fact that
26705 grafting works by patching files, including binary files, directly.
26706 Other restrictions may apply: for instance, when adding a graft to a
26707 package providing a shared library, the original shared library and its
26708 replacement must have the same @code{SONAME} and be binary-compatible.
26709
26710 The @option{--no-grafts} command-line option allows you to forcefully
26711 avoid grafting (@pxref{Common Build Options, @option{--no-grafts}}).
26712 Thus, the command:
26713
26714 @example
26715 guix build bash --no-grafts
26716 @end example
26717
26718 @noindent
26719 returns the store file name of the original Bash, whereas:
26720
26721 @example
26722 guix build bash
26723 @end example
26724
26725 @noindent
26726 returns the store file name of the ``fixed'', replacement Bash. This
26727 allows you to distinguish between the two variants of Bash.
26728
26729 To verify which Bash your whole profile refers to, you can run
26730 (@pxref{Invoking guix gc}):
26731
26732 @example
26733 guix gc -R `readlink -f ~/.guix-profile` | grep bash
26734 @end example
26735
26736 @noindent
26737 @dots{} and compare the store file names that you get with those above.
26738 Likewise for a complete Guix system generation:
26739
26740 @example
26741 guix gc -R `guix system build my-config.scm` | grep bash
26742 @end example
26743
26744 Lastly, to check which Bash running processes are using, you can use the
26745 @command{lsof} command:
26746
26747 @example
26748 lsof | grep /gnu/store/.*bash
26749 @end example
26750
26751
26752 @node Bootstrapping
26753 @chapter Bootstrapping
26754
26755 @c Adapted from the ELS 2013 paper.
26756
26757 @cindex bootstrapping
26758
26759 Bootstrapping in our context refers to how the distribution gets built
26760 ``from nothing''. Remember that the build environment of a derivation
26761 contains nothing but its declared inputs (@pxref{Introduction}). So
26762 there's an obvious chicken-and-egg problem: how does the first package
26763 get built? How does the first compiler get compiled? Note that this is
26764 a question of interest only to the curious hacker, not to the regular
26765 user, so you can shamelessly skip this section if you consider yourself
26766 a ``regular user''.
26767
26768 @cindex bootstrap binaries
26769 The GNU system is primarily made of C code, with libc at its core. The
26770 GNU build system itself assumes the availability of a Bourne shell and
26771 command-line tools provided by GNU Coreutils, Awk, Findutils, `sed', and
26772 `grep'. Furthermore, build programs---programs that run
26773 @code{./configure}, @code{make}, etc.---are written in Guile Scheme
26774 (@pxref{Derivations}). Consequently, to be able to build anything at
26775 all, from scratch, Guix relies on pre-built binaries of Guile, GCC,
26776 Binutils, libc, and the other packages mentioned above---the
26777 @dfn{bootstrap binaries}.
26778
26779 These bootstrap binaries are ``taken for granted'', though we can also
26780 re-create them if needed (more on that later).
26781
26782 @unnumberedsec Preparing to Use the Bootstrap Binaries
26783
26784 @c As of Emacs 24.3, Info-mode displays the image, but since it's a
26785 @c large image, it's hard to scroll. Oh well.
26786 @image{images/bootstrap-graph,6in,,Dependency graph of the early bootstrap derivations}
26787
26788 The figure above shows the very beginning of the dependency graph of the
26789 distribution, corresponding to the package definitions of the @code{(gnu
26790 packages bootstrap)} module. A similar figure can be generated with
26791 @command{guix graph} (@pxref{Invoking guix graph}), along the lines of:
26792
26793 @example
26794 guix graph -t derivation \
26795 -e '(@@@@ (gnu packages bootstrap) %bootstrap-gcc)' \
26796 | dot -Tps > t.ps
26797 @end example
26798
26799 At this level of detail, things are
26800 slightly complex. First, Guile itself consists of an ELF executable,
26801 along with many source and compiled Scheme files that are dynamically
26802 loaded when it runs. This gets stored in the @file{guile-2.0.7.tar.xz}
26803 tarball shown in this graph. This tarball is part of Guix's ``source''
26804 distribution, and gets inserted into the store with @code{add-to-store}
26805 (@pxref{The Store}).
26806
26807 But how do we write a derivation that unpacks this tarball and adds it
26808 to the store? To solve this problem, the @code{guile-bootstrap-2.0.drv}
26809 derivation---the first one that gets built---uses @code{bash} as its
26810 builder, which runs @code{build-bootstrap-guile.sh}, which in turn calls
26811 @code{tar} to unpack the tarball. Thus, @file{bash}, @file{tar},
26812 @file{xz}, and @file{mkdir} are statically-linked binaries, also part of
26813 the Guix source distribution, whose sole purpose is to allow the Guile
26814 tarball to be unpacked.
26815
26816 Once @code{guile-bootstrap-2.0.drv} is built, we have a functioning
26817 Guile that can be used to run subsequent build programs. Its first task
26818 is to download tarballs containing the other pre-built binaries---this
26819 is what the @code{.tar.xz.drv} derivations do. Guix modules such as
26820 @code{ftp-client.scm} are used for this purpose. The
26821 @code{module-import.drv} derivations import those modules in a directory
26822 in the store, using the original layout. The
26823 @code{module-import-compiled.drv} derivations compile those modules, and
26824 write them in an output directory with the right layout. This
26825 corresponds to the @code{#:modules} argument of
26826 @code{build-expression->derivation} (@pxref{Derivations}).
26827
26828 Finally, the various tarballs are unpacked by the
26829 derivations @code{gcc-bootstrap-0.drv}, @code{glibc-bootstrap-0.drv},
26830 etc., at which point we have a working C tool chain.
26831
26832
26833 @unnumberedsec Building the Build Tools
26834
26835 Bootstrapping is complete when we have a full tool chain that does not
26836 depend on the pre-built bootstrap tools discussed above. This
26837 no-dependency requirement is verified by checking whether the files of
26838 the final tool chain contain references to the @file{/gnu/store}
26839 directories of the bootstrap inputs. The process that leads to this
26840 ``final'' tool chain is described by the package definitions found in
26841 the @code{(gnu packages commencement)} module.
26842
26843 The @command{guix graph} command allows us to ``zoom out'' compared to
26844 the graph above, by looking at the level of package objects instead of
26845 individual derivations---remember that a package may translate to
26846 several derivations, typically one derivation to download its source,
26847 one to build the Guile modules it needs, and one to actually build the
26848 package from source. The command:
26849
26850 @example
26851 guix graph -t bag \
26852 -e '(@@@@ (gnu packages commencement)
26853 glibc-final-with-bootstrap-bash)' | dot -Tps > t.ps
26854 @end example
26855
26856 @noindent
26857 produces the dependency graph leading to the ``final'' C
26858 library@footnote{You may notice the @code{glibc-intermediate} label,
26859 suggesting that it is not @emph{quite} final, but as a good
26860 approximation, we will consider it final.}, depicted below.
26861
26862 @image{images/bootstrap-packages,6in,,Dependency graph of the early packages}
26863
26864 @c See <https://lists.gnu.org/archive/html/gnu-system-discuss/2012-10/msg00000.html>.
26865 The first tool that gets built with the bootstrap binaries is
26866 GNU@tie{}Make---noted @code{make-boot0} above---which is a prerequisite
26867 for all the following packages. From there Findutils and Diffutils get
26868 built.
26869
26870 Then come the first-stage Binutils and GCC, built as pseudo cross
26871 tools---i.e., with @code{--target} equal to @code{--host}. They are
26872 used to build libc. Thanks to this cross-build trick, this libc is
26873 guaranteed not to hold any reference to the initial tool chain.
26874
26875 From there the final Binutils and GCC (not shown above) are built.
26876 GCC uses @code{ld}
26877 from the final Binutils, and links programs against the just-built libc.
26878 This tool chain is used to build the other packages used by Guix and by
26879 the GNU Build System: Guile, Bash, Coreutils, etc.
26880
26881 And voilà! At this point we have the complete set of build tools that
26882 the GNU Build System expects. These are in the @code{%final-inputs}
26883 variable of the @code{(gnu packages commencement)} module, and are
26884 implicitly used by any package that uses @code{gnu-build-system}
26885 (@pxref{Build Systems, @code{gnu-build-system}}).
26886
26887
26888 @unnumberedsec Building the Bootstrap Binaries
26889
26890 @cindex bootstrap binaries
26891 Because the final tool chain does not depend on the bootstrap binaries,
26892 those rarely need to be updated. Nevertheless, it is useful to have an
26893 automated way to produce them, should an update occur, and this is what
26894 the @code{(gnu packages make-bootstrap)} module provides.
26895
26896 The following command builds the tarballs containing the bootstrap
26897 binaries (Guile, Binutils, GCC, libc, and a tarball containing a mixture
26898 of Coreutils and other basic command-line tools):
26899
26900 @example
26901 guix build bootstrap-tarballs
26902 @end example
26903
26904 The generated tarballs are those that should be referred to in the
26905 @code{(gnu packages bootstrap)} module mentioned at the beginning of
26906 this section.
26907
26908 Still here? Then perhaps by now you've started to wonder: when do we
26909 reach a fixed point? That is an interesting question! The answer is
26910 unknown, but if you would like to investigate further (and have
26911 significant computational and storage resources to do so), then let us
26912 know.
26913
26914 @unnumberedsec Reducing the Set of Bootstrap Binaries
26915
26916 Our bootstrap binaries currently include GCC, Guile, etc. That's a lot
26917 of binary code! Why is that a problem? It's a problem because these
26918 big chunks of binary code are practically non-auditable, which makes it
26919 hard to establish what source code produced them. Every unauditable
26920 binary also leaves us vulnerable to compiler backdoors as described by
26921 Ken Thompson in the 1984 paper @emph{Reflections on Trusting Trust}.
26922
26923 This is mitigated by the fact that our bootstrap binaries were generated
26924 from an earlier Guix revision. Nevertheless it lacks the level of
26925 transparency that we get in the rest of the package dependency graph,
26926 where Guix always gives us a source-to-binary mapping. Thus, our goal
26927 is to reduce the set of bootstrap binaries to the bare minimum.
26928
26929 The @uref{http://bootstrappable.org, Bootstrappable.org web site} lists
26930 on-going projects to do that. One of these is about replacing the
26931 bootstrap GCC with a sequence of assemblers, interpreters, and compilers
26932 of increasing complexity, which could be built from source starting from
26933 a simple and auditable assembler. Your help is welcome!
26934
26935
26936 @node Porting
26937 @chapter Porting to a New Platform
26938
26939 As discussed above, the GNU distribution is self-contained, and
26940 self-containment is achieved by relying on pre-built ``bootstrap
26941 binaries'' (@pxref{Bootstrapping}). These binaries are specific to an
26942 operating system kernel, CPU architecture, and application binary
26943 interface (ABI). Thus, to port the distribution to a platform that is
26944 not yet supported, one must build those bootstrap binaries, and update
26945 the @code{(gnu packages bootstrap)} module to use them on that platform.
26946
26947 Fortunately, Guix can @emph{cross compile} those bootstrap binaries.
26948 When everything goes well, and assuming the GNU tool chain supports the
26949 target platform, this can be as simple as running a command like this
26950 one:
26951
26952 @example
26953 guix build --target=armv5tel-linux-gnueabi bootstrap-tarballs
26954 @end example
26955
26956 For this to work, the @code{glibc-dynamic-linker} procedure in
26957 @code{(gnu packages bootstrap)} must be augmented to return the right
26958 file name for libc's dynamic linker on that platform; likewise,
26959 @code{system->linux-architecture} in @code{(gnu packages linux)} must be
26960 taught about the new platform.
26961
26962 Once these are built, the @code{(gnu packages bootstrap)} module needs
26963 to be updated to refer to these binaries on the target platform. That
26964 is, the hashes and URLs of the bootstrap tarballs for the new platform
26965 must be added alongside those of the currently supported platforms. The
26966 bootstrap Guile tarball is treated specially: it is expected to be
26967 available locally, and @file{gnu/local.mk} has rules to download it for
26968 the supported architectures; a rule for the new platform must be added
26969 as well.
26970
26971 In practice, there may be some complications. First, it may be that the
26972 extended GNU triplet that specifies an ABI (like the @code{eabi} suffix
26973 above) is not recognized by all the GNU tools. Typically, glibc
26974 recognizes some of these, whereas GCC uses an extra @code{--with-abi}
26975 configure flag (see @code{gcc.scm} for examples of how to handle this).
26976 Second, some of the required packages could fail to build for that
26977 platform. Lastly, the generated binaries could be broken for some
26978 reason.
26979
26980 @c *********************************************************************
26981 @include contributing.texi
26982
26983 @c *********************************************************************
26984 @node Acknowledgments
26985 @chapter Acknowledgments
26986
26987 Guix is based on the @uref{https://nixos.org/nix/, Nix package manager},
26988 which was designed and
26989 implemented by Eelco Dolstra, with contributions from other people (see
26990 the @file{nix/AUTHORS} file in Guix.) Nix pioneered functional package
26991 management, and promoted unprecedented features, such as transactional
26992 package upgrades and rollbacks, per-user profiles, and referentially
26993 transparent build processes. Without this work, Guix would not exist.
26994
26995 The Nix-based software distributions, Nixpkgs and NixOS, have also been
26996 an inspiration for Guix.
26997
26998 GNU@tie{}Guix itself is a collective work with contributions from a
26999 number of people. See the @file{AUTHORS} file in Guix for more
27000 information on these fine people. The @file{THANKS} file lists people
27001 who have helped by reporting bugs, taking care of the infrastructure,
27002 providing artwork and themes, making suggestions, and more---thank you!
27003
27004
27005 @c *********************************************************************
27006 @node GNU Free Documentation License
27007 @appendix GNU Free Documentation License
27008 @cindex license, GNU Free Documentation License
27009 @include fdl-1.3.texi
27010
27011 @c *********************************************************************
27012 @node Concept Index
27013 @unnumbered Concept Index
27014 @printindex cp
27015
27016 @node Programming Index
27017 @unnumbered Programming Index
27018 @syncodeindex tp fn
27019 @syncodeindex vr fn
27020 @printindex fn
27021
27022 @bye
27023
27024 @c Local Variables:
27025 @c ispell-local-dictionary: "american";
27026 @c End: